]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/ada/gnat_ugn.texi
gnat_ugn.texi: Gcov is not supported on static library on AIX.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / ada / gnat_ugn.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3
4 @c oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
5 @c o
6 @c GNAT DOCUMENTATION o
7 @c o
8 @c G N A T _ U G N o
9 @c o
10 @c GNAT is maintained by Ada Core Technologies Inc (http://www.gnat.com). o
11 @c o
12 @c oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
13
14 @setfilename gnat_ugn.info
15
16 @copying
17 Copyright @copyright{} 1995-2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation,
18 Inc.
19
20 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
21 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
22 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
23 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts and with no Back-Cover
24 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled
25 ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
26 @end copying
27
28 @c oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
29 @c
30 @c GNAT_UGN Style Guide
31 @c
32 @c 1. Always put a @noindent on the line before the first paragraph
33 @c after any of these commands:
34 @c
35 @c @chapter
36 @c @section
37 @c @subsection
38 @c @subsubsection
39 @c @subsubsubsection
40 @c
41 @c @end smallexample
42 @c @end itemize
43 @c @end enumerate
44 @c
45 @c 2. DO NOT use @example. Use @smallexample instead.
46 @c a) DO NOT use highlighting commands (@b{}, @i{}) inside an @smallexample
47 @c context. These can interfere with the readability of the texi
48 @c source file. Instead, use one of the following annotated
49 @c @smallexample commands, and preprocess the texi file with the
50 @c ada2texi tool (which generates appropriate highlighting):
51 @c @smallexample @c ada
52 @c @smallexample @c adanocomment
53 @c @smallexample @c projectfile
54 @c b) The "@c ada" markup will result in boldface for reserved words
55 @c and italics for comments
56 @c c) The "@c adanocomment" markup will result only in boldface for
57 @c reserved words (comments are left alone)
58 @c d) The "@c projectfile" markup is like "@c ada" except that the set
59 @c of reserved words include the new reserved words for project files
60 @c
61 @c 3. Each @chapter, @section, @subsection, @subsubsection, etc.
62 @c command must be preceded by two empty lines
63 @c
64 @c 4. The @item command should be on a line of its own if it is in an
65 @c @itemize or @enumerate command.
66 @c
67 @c 5. When talking about ALI files use "ALI" (all uppercase), not "Ali"
68 @c or "ali".
69 @c
70 @c 6. DO NOT put trailing spaces at the end of a line. Such spaces will
71 @c cause the document build to fail.
72 @c
73 @c 7. DO NOT use @cartouche for examples that are longer than around 10 lines.
74 @c This command inhibits page breaks, so long examples in a @cartouche can
75 @c lead to large, ugly patches of empty space on a page.
76 @c
77 @c NOTE: This file should be submitted to xgnatugn with either the vms flag
78 @c or the unw flag set. The unw flag covers topics for both Unix and
79 @c Windows.
80 @c
81 @c oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
82
83 @set NOW January 2007
84 @c This flag is used where the text refers to conditions that exist when the
85 @c text was entered into the document but which may change over time.
86 @c Update the setting for the flag, and (if necessary) the text surrounding,
87 @c the references to the flag, on future doc revisions:
88 @c search for @value{NOW}.
89
90 @set FSFEDITION
91 @set EDITION GNAT
92 @set DEFAULTLANGUAGEVERSION Ada 2005
93 @set NONDEFAULTLANGUAGEVERSION Ada 95
94
95 @ifset unw
96 @set PLATFORM
97 @end ifset
98
99 @ifset vms
100 @set PLATFORM OpenVMS
101 @end ifset
102
103 @c @ovar(ARG)
104 @c ----------
105 @c The ARG is an optional argument. To be used for macro arguments in
106 @c their documentation (@defmac).
107 @macro ovar{varname}
108 @r{[}@var{\varname\}@r{]}@c
109 @end macro
110
111 @settitle @value{EDITION} User's Guide @value{PLATFORM}
112 @dircategory GNU Ada tools
113 @direntry
114 * @value{EDITION} User's Guide (gnat_ugn) @value{PLATFORM}
115 @end direntry
116
117 @include gcc-common.texi
118
119 @setchapternewpage odd
120 @syncodeindex fn cp
121 @c %**end of header
122
123 @titlepage
124 @title @value{EDITION} User's Guide
125 @ifset vms
126 @sp 1
127 @flushright
128 @titlefont{@i{@value{PLATFORM}}}
129 @end flushright
130 @end ifset
131
132 @sp 2
133
134 @subtitle GNAT, The GNU Ada Compiler
135 @versionsubtitle
136 @author AdaCore
137
138 @page
139 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
140
141 @insertcopying
142
143 @end titlepage
144
145 @ifnottex
146 @node Top, About This Guide, (dir), (dir)
147 @top @value{EDITION} User's Guide
148
149 @noindent
150 @value{EDITION} User's Guide @value{PLATFORM}
151
152 @noindent
153 GNAT, The GNU Ada Compiler@*
154 GCC version @value{version-GCC}@*
155
156 @noindent
157 AdaCore@*
158
159 @menu
160 * About This Guide::
161 * Getting Started with GNAT::
162 * The GNAT Compilation Model::
163 * Compiling Using gcc::
164 * Binding Using gnatbind::
165 * Linking Using gnatlink::
166 * The GNAT Make Program gnatmake::
167 * Improving Performance::
168 * Renaming Files Using gnatchop::
169 * Configuration Pragmas::
170 * Handling Arbitrary File Naming Conventions Using gnatname::
171 * GNAT Project Manager::
172 * The Cross-Referencing Tools gnatxref and gnatfind::
173 * The GNAT Pretty-Printer gnatpp::
174 * The GNAT Metric Tool gnatmetric::
175 * File Name Krunching Using gnatkr::
176 * Preprocessing Using gnatprep::
177 @ifset vms
178 * The GNAT Run-Time Library Builder gnatlbr::
179 @end ifset
180 * The GNAT Library Browser gnatls::
181 * Cleaning Up Using gnatclean::
182 @ifclear vms
183 * GNAT and Libraries::
184 * Using the GNU make Utility::
185 @end ifclear
186 * Memory Management Issues::
187 * Stack Related Facilities::
188 * Verifying Properties Using gnatcheck::
189 * Creating Sample Bodies Using gnatstub::
190 * Other Utility Programs::
191 * Running and Debugging Ada Programs::
192 @ifclear vms
193 * Code Coverage and Profiling::
194 @end ifclear
195 @ifset vms
196 * Compatibility with HP Ada::
197 @end ifset
198 * Platform-Specific Information for the Run-Time Libraries::
199 * Example of Binder Output File::
200 * Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT::
201 * Conditional Compilation::
202 * Inline Assembler::
203 * Compatibility and Porting Guide::
204 @ifset unw
205 * Microsoft Windows Topics::
206 @end ifset
207 * GNU Free Documentation License::
208 * Index::
209
210 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
211
212 About This Guide
213
214 * What This Guide Contains::
215 * What You Should Know before Reading This Guide::
216 * Related Information::
217 * Conventions::
218
219 Getting Started with GNAT
220
221 * Running GNAT::
222 * Running a Simple Ada Program::
223 * Running a Program with Multiple Units::
224 * Using the gnatmake Utility::
225 @ifset vms
226 * Editing with Emacs::
227 @end ifset
228 @ifclear vms
229 * Introduction to GPS::
230 @end ifclear
231
232 The GNAT Compilation Model
233
234 * Source Representation::
235 * Foreign Language Representation::
236 * File Naming Rules::
237 * Using Other File Names::
238 * Alternative File Naming Schemes::
239 * Generating Object Files::
240 * Source Dependencies::
241 * The Ada Library Information Files::
242 * Binding an Ada Program::
243 * Mixed Language Programming::
244 @ifclear vms
245 * Building Mixed Ada & C++ Programs::
246 * Comparison between GNAT and C/C++ Compilation Models::
247 @end ifclear
248 * Comparison between GNAT and Conventional Ada Library Models::
249 @ifset vms
250 * Placement of temporary files::
251 @end ifset
252
253 Foreign Language Representation
254
255 * Latin-1::
256 * Other 8-Bit Codes::
257 * Wide Character Encodings::
258
259 Compiling Ada Programs With gcc
260
261 * Compiling Programs::
262 * Switches for gcc::
263 * Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)::
264 * Order of Compilation Issues::
265 * Examples::
266
267 Switches for gcc
268
269 * Output and Error Message Control::
270 * Warning Message Control::
271 * Debugging and Assertion Control::
272 * Validity Checking::
273 * Style Checking::
274 * Run-Time Checks::
275 * Using gcc for Syntax Checking::
276 * Using gcc for Semantic Checking::
277 * Compiling Different Versions of Ada::
278 * Character Set Control::
279 * File Naming Control::
280 * Subprogram Inlining Control::
281 * Auxiliary Output Control::
282 * Debugging Control::
283 * Exception Handling Control::
284 * Units to Sources Mapping Files::
285 * Integrated Preprocessing::
286 @ifset vms
287 * Return Codes::
288 @end ifset
289
290 Binding Ada Programs With gnatbind
291
292 * Running gnatbind::
293 * Switches for gnatbind::
294 * Command-Line Access::
295 * Search Paths for gnatbind::
296 * Examples of gnatbind Usage::
297
298 Switches for gnatbind
299
300 * Consistency-Checking Modes::
301 * Binder Error Message Control::
302 * Elaboration Control::
303 * Output Control::
304 * Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs::
305 * Binding Programs with No Main Subprogram::
306
307 Linking Using gnatlink
308
309 * Running gnatlink::
310 * Switches for gnatlink::
311
312 The GNAT Make Program gnatmake
313
314 * Running gnatmake::
315 * Switches for gnatmake::
316 * Mode Switches for gnatmake::
317 * Notes on the Command Line::
318 * How gnatmake Works::
319 * Examples of gnatmake Usage::
320
321 Improving Performance
322 * Performance Considerations::
323 * Text_IO Suggestions::
324 * Reducing Size of Ada Executables with gnatelim::
325 * Reducing Size of Executables with unused subprogram/data elimination::
326
327 Performance Considerations
328 * Controlling Run-Time Checks::
329 * Use of Restrictions::
330 * Optimization Levels::
331 * Debugging Optimized Code::
332 * Inlining of Subprograms::
333 * Other Optimization Switches::
334 * Optimization and Strict Aliasing::
335 @ifset vms
336 * Coverage Analysis::
337 @end ifset
338
339 Reducing Size of Ada Executables with gnatelim
340 * About gnatelim::
341 * Running gnatelim::
342 * Correcting the List of Eliminate Pragmas::
343 * Making Your Executables Smaller::
344 * Summary of the gnatelim Usage Cycle::
345
346 Reducing Size of Executables with unused subprogram/data elimination
347 * About unused subprogram/data elimination::
348 * Compilation options::
349
350 Renaming Files Using gnatchop
351
352 * Handling Files with Multiple Units::
353 * Operating gnatchop in Compilation Mode::
354 * Command Line for gnatchop::
355 * Switches for gnatchop::
356 * Examples of gnatchop Usage::
357
358 Configuration Pragmas
359
360 * Handling of Configuration Pragmas::
361 * The Configuration Pragmas Files::
362
363 Handling Arbitrary File Naming Conventions Using gnatname
364
365 * Arbitrary File Naming Conventions::
366 * Running gnatname::
367 * Switches for gnatname::
368 * Examples of gnatname Usage::
369
370 GNAT Project Manager
371
372 * Introduction::
373 * Examples of Project Files::
374 * Project File Syntax::
375 * Objects and Sources in Project Files::
376 * Importing Projects::
377 * Project Extension::
378 * Project Hierarchy Extension::
379 * External References in Project Files::
380 * Packages in Project Files::
381 * Variables from Imported Projects::
382 * Naming Schemes::
383 * Library Projects::
384 * Stand-alone Library Projects::
385 * Switches Related to Project Files::
386 * Tools Supporting Project Files::
387 * An Extended Example::
388 * Project File Complete Syntax::
389
390 The Cross-Referencing Tools gnatxref and gnatfind
391
392 * gnatxref Switches::
393 * gnatfind Switches::
394 * Project Files for gnatxref and gnatfind::
395 * Regular Expressions in gnatfind and gnatxref::
396 * Examples of gnatxref Usage::
397 * Examples of gnatfind Usage::
398
399 The GNAT Pretty-Printer gnatpp
400
401 * Switches for gnatpp::
402 * Formatting Rules::
403
404 The GNAT Metrics Tool gnatmetric
405
406 * Switches for gnatmetric::
407
408 File Name Krunching Using gnatkr
409
410 * About gnatkr::
411 * Using gnatkr::
412 * Krunching Method::
413 * Examples of gnatkr Usage::
414
415 Preprocessing Using gnatprep
416 * Preprocessing Symbols::
417 * Using gnatprep::
418 * Switches for gnatprep::
419 * Form of Definitions File::
420 * Form of Input Text for gnatprep::
421
422 @ifset vms
423 The GNAT Run-Time Library Builder gnatlbr
424
425 * Running gnatlbr::
426 * Switches for gnatlbr::
427 * Examples of gnatlbr Usage::
428 @end ifset
429
430 The GNAT Library Browser gnatls
431
432 * Running gnatls::
433 * Switches for gnatls::
434 * Examples of gnatls Usage::
435
436 Cleaning Up Using gnatclean
437
438 * Running gnatclean::
439 * Switches for gnatclean::
440 @c * Examples of gnatclean Usage::
441
442 @ifclear vms
443
444 GNAT and Libraries
445
446 * Introduction to Libraries in GNAT::
447 * General Ada Libraries::
448 * Stand-alone Ada Libraries::
449 * Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library::
450
451 Using the GNU make Utility
452
453 * Using gnatmake in a Makefile::
454 * Automatically Creating a List of Directories::
455 * Generating the Command Line Switches::
456 * Overcoming Command Line Length Limits::
457 @end ifclear
458
459 Memory Management Issues
460
461 * Some Useful Memory Pools::
462 * The GNAT Debug Pool Facility::
463 @ifclear vms
464 * The gnatmem Tool::
465 @end ifclear
466
467 Stack Related Facilities
468
469 * Stack Overflow Checking::
470 * Static Stack Usage Analysis::
471 * Dynamic Stack Usage Analysis::
472
473 Some Useful Memory Pools
474
475 The GNAT Debug Pool Facility
476
477 @ifclear vms
478 The gnatmem Tool
479
480 * Running gnatmem::
481 * Switches for gnatmem::
482 * Example of gnatmem Usage::
483 @end ifclear
484
485 Verifying Properties Using gnatcheck
486
487 * Format of the Report File::
488 * General gnatcheck Switches::
489 * gnatcheck Rule Options::
490 * Adding the Results of Compiler Checks to gnatcheck Output::
491 * Project-Wide Checks::
492 * Predefined Rules::
493
494 Sample Bodies Using gnatstub
495
496 * Running gnatstub::
497 * Switches for gnatstub::
498
499 Other Utility Programs
500
501 * Using Other Utility Programs with GNAT::
502 * The External Symbol Naming Scheme of GNAT::
503 * Converting Ada Files to html with gnathtml::
504
505 @ifclear vms
506 Code Coverage and Profiling
507
508 * Code Coverage of Ada Programs using gcov::
509 * Profiling an Ada Program using gprof::
510 @end ifclear
511
512 Running and Debugging Ada Programs
513
514 * The GNAT Debugger GDB::
515 * Running GDB::
516 * Introduction to GDB Commands::
517 * Using Ada Expressions::
518 * Calling User-Defined Subprograms::
519 * Using the Next Command in a Function::
520 * Ada Exceptions::
521 * Ada Tasks::
522 * Debugging Generic Units::
523 * GNAT Abnormal Termination or Failure to Terminate::
524 * Naming Conventions for GNAT Source Files::
525 * Getting Internal Debugging Information::
526 * Stack Traceback::
527
528 @ifset vms
529 * LSE::
530 @end ifset
531
532 @ifset vms
533 Compatibility with HP Ada
534
535 * Ada Language Compatibility::
536 * Differences in the Definition of Package System::
537 * Language-Related Features::
538 * The Package STANDARD::
539 * The Package SYSTEM::
540 * Tasking and Task-Related Features::
541 * Pragmas and Pragma-Related Features::
542 * Library of Predefined Units::
543 * Bindings::
544 * Main Program Definition::
545 * Implementation-Defined Attributes::
546 * Compiler and Run-Time Interfacing::
547 * Program Compilation and Library Management::
548 * Input-Output::
549 * Implementation Limits::
550 * Tools and Utilities::
551
552 Language-Related Features
553
554 * Integer Types and Representations::
555 * Floating-Point Types and Representations::
556 * Pragmas Float_Representation and Long_Float::
557 * Fixed-Point Types and Representations::
558 * Record and Array Component Alignment::
559 * Address Clauses::
560 * Other Representation Clauses::
561
562 Tasking and Task-Related Features
563
564 * Implementation of Tasks in HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha Systems::
565 * Assigning Task IDs::
566 * Task IDs and Delays::
567 * Task-Related Pragmas::
568 * Scheduling and Task Priority::
569 * The Task Stack::
570 * External Interrupts::
571
572 Pragmas and Pragma-Related Features
573
574 * Restrictions on the Pragma INLINE::
575 * Restrictions on the Pragma INTERFACE::
576 * Restrictions on the Pragma SYSTEM_NAME::
577
578 Library of Predefined Units
579
580 * Changes to DECLIB::
581
582 Bindings
583
584 * Shared Libraries and Options Files::
585 * Interfaces to C::
586 @end ifset
587
588 Platform-Specific Information for the Run-Time Libraries
589
590 * Summary of Run-Time Configurations::
591 * Specifying a Run-Time Library::
592 * Choosing the Scheduling Policy::
593 * Solaris-Specific Considerations::
594 * Linux-Specific Considerations::
595 * AIX-Specific Considerations::
596 * Irix-Specific Considerations::
597
598 Example of Binder Output File
599
600 Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT
601
602 * Elaboration Code::
603 * Checking the Elaboration Order::
604 * Controlling the Elaboration Order::
605 * Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - Internal Calls::
606 * Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - External Calls::
607 * Default Behavior in GNAT - Ensuring Safety::
608 * Treatment of Pragma Elaborate::
609 * Elaboration Issues for Library Tasks::
610 * Mixing Elaboration Models::
611 * What to Do If the Default Elaboration Behavior Fails::
612 * Elaboration for Access-to-Subprogram Values::
613 * Summary of Procedures for Elaboration Control::
614 * Other Elaboration Order Considerations::
615
616 Conditional Compilation
617 * Use of Boolean Constants::
618 * Debugging - A Special Case::
619 * Conditionalizing Declarations::
620 * Use of Alternative Implementations::
621 * Preprocessing::
622
623 Inline Assembler
624
625 * Basic Assembler Syntax::
626 * A Simple Example of Inline Assembler::
627 * Output Variables in Inline Assembler::
628 * Input Variables in Inline Assembler::
629 * Inlining Inline Assembler Code::
630 * Other Asm Functionality::
631
632 Compatibility and Porting Guide
633
634 * Compatibility with Ada 83::
635 * Compatibility between Ada 95 and Ada 2005::
636 * Implementation-dependent characteristics::
637 @ifclear vms
638 @c This brief section is only in the non-VMS version
639 @c The complete chapter on HP Ada issues is in the VMS version
640 * Compatibility with HP Ada 83::
641 @end ifclear
642 * Compatibility with Other Ada Systems::
643 * Representation Clauses::
644 @ifset vms
645 * Transitioning to 64-Bit GNAT for OpenVMS::
646 @end ifset
647
648 @ifset unw
649 Microsoft Windows Topics
650
651 * Using GNAT on Windows::
652 * CONSOLE and WINDOWS subsystems::
653 * Temporary Files::
654 * Mixed-Language Programming on Windows::
655 * Windows Calling Conventions::
656 * Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)::
657 * Using DLLs with GNAT::
658 * Building DLLs with GNAT::
659 * GNAT and Windows Resources::
660 * Debugging a DLL::
661 * Setting Stack Size from gnatlink::
662 * Setting Heap Size from gnatlink::
663 @end ifset
664
665 * Index::
666 @end menu
667 @end ifnottex
668
669 @node About This Guide
670 @unnumbered About This Guide
671
672 @noindent
673 @ifset vms
674 This guide describes the use of @value{EDITION},
675 a compiler and software development toolset for the full Ada
676 programming language, implemented on OpenVMS for HP's Alpha and
677 Integrity server (I64) platforms.
678 @end ifset
679 @ifclear vms
680 This guide describes the use of @value{EDITION},
681 a compiler and software development
682 toolset for the full Ada programming language.
683 @end ifclear
684 It documents the features of the compiler and tools, and explains
685 how to use them to build Ada applications.
686
687 @value{EDITION} implements Ada 95 and Ada 2005, and it may also be invoked in
688 Ada 83 compatibility mode.
689 By default, @value{EDITION} assumes @value{DEFAULTLANGUAGEVERSION},
690 but you can override with a compiler switch
691 (@pxref{Compiling Different Versions of Ada})
692 to explicitly specify the language version.
693 Throughout this manual, references to ``Ada'' without a year suffix
694 apply to both the Ada 95 and Ada 2005 versions of the language.
695
696
697 @ifclear FSFEDITION
698 For ease of exposition, ``@value{EDITION}'' will be referred to simply as
699 ``GNAT'' in the remainder of this document.
700 @end ifclear
701
702
703
704
705 @menu
706 * What This Guide Contains::
707 * What You Should Know before Reading This Guide::
708 * Related Information::
709 * Conventions::
710 @end menu
711
712 @node What This Guide Contains
713 @unnumberedsec What This Guide Contains
714
715 @noindent
716 This guide contains the following chapters:
717 @itemize @bullet
718
719 @item
720 @ref{Getting Started with GNAT}, describes how to get started compiling
721 and running Ada programs with the GNAT Ada programming environment.
722 @item
723 @ref{The GNAT Compilation Model}, describes the compilation model used
724 by GNAT.
725
726 @item
727 @ref{Compiling Using gcc}, describes how to compile
728 Ada programs with @command{gcc}, the Ada compiler.
729
730 @item
731 @ref{Binding Using gnatbind}, describes how to
732 perform binding of Ada programs with @code{gnatbind}, the GNAT binding
733 utility.
734
735 @item
736 @ref{Linking Using gnatlink},
737 describes @command{gnatlink}, a
738 program that provides for linking using the GNAT run-time library to
739 construct a program. @command{gnatlink} can also incorporate foreign language
740 object units into the executable.
741
742 @item
743 @ref{The GNAT Make Program gnatmake}, describes @command{gnatmake}, a
744 utility that automatically determines the set of sources
745 needed by an Ada compilation unit, and executes the necessary compilations
746 binding and link.
747
748 @item
749 @ref{Improving Performance}, shows various techniques for making your
750 Ada program run faster or take less space.
751 It discusses the effect of the compiler's optimization switch and
752 also describes the @command{gnatelim} tool and unused subprogram/data
753 elimination.
754
755 @item
756 @ref{Renaming Files Using gnatchop}, describes
757 @code{gnatchop}, a utility that allows you to preprocess a file that
758 contains Ada source code, and split it into one or more new files, one
759 for each compilation unit.
760
761 @item
762 @ref{Configuration Pragmas}, describes the configuration pragmas
763 handled by GNAT.
764
765 @item
766 @ref{Handling Arbitrary File Naming Conventions Using gnatname},
767 shows how to override the default GNAT file naming conventions,
768 either for an individual unit or globally.
769
770 @item
771 @ref{GNAT Project Manager}, describes how to use project files
772 to organize large projects.
773
774 @item
775 @ref{The Cross-Referencing Tools gnatxref and gnatfind}, discusses
776 @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind}, two tools that provide an easy
777 way to navigate through sources.
778
779 @item
780 @ref{The GNAT Pretty-Printer gnatpp}, shows how to produce a reformatted
781 version of an Ada source file with control over casing, indentation,
782 comment placement, and other elements of program presentation style.
783
784 @item
785 @ref{The GNAT Metric Tool gnatmetric}, shows how to compute various
786 metrics for an Ada source file, such as the number of types and subprograms,
787 and assorted complexity measures.
788
789 @item
790 @ref{File Name Krunching Using gnatkr}, describes the @code{gnatkr}
791 file name krunching utility, used to handle shortened
792 file names on operating systems with a limit on the length of names.
793
794 @item
795 @ref{Preprocessing Using gnatprep}, describes @code{gnatprep}, a
796 preprocessor utility that allows a single source file to be used to
797 generate multiple or parameterized source files by means of macro
798 substitution.
799
800 @ifset vms
801 @item
802 @ref{The GNAT Run-Time Library Builder gnatlbr}, describes @command{gnatlbr},
803 a tool for rebuilding the GNAT run time with user-supplied
804 configuration pragmas.
805 @end ifset
806
807 @item
808 @ref{The GNAT Library Browser gnatls}, describes @code{gnatls}, a
809 utility that displays information about compiled units, including dependences
810 on the corresponding sources files, and consistency of compilations.
811
812 @item
813 @ref{Cleaning Up Using gnatclean}, describes @code{gnatclean}, a utility
814 to delete files that are produced by the compiler, binder and linker.
815
816 @ifclear vms
817 @item
818 @ref{GNAT and Libraries}, describes the process of creating and using
819 Libraries with GNAT. It also describes how to recompile the GNAT run-time
820 library.
821
822 @item
823 @ref{Using the GNU make Utility}, describes some techniques for using
824 the GNAT toolset in Makefiles.
825 @end ifclear
826
827 @item
828 @ref{Memory Management Issues}, describes some useful predefined storage pools
829 and in particular the GNAT Debug Pool facility, which helps detect incorrect
830 memory references.
831 @ifclear vms
832 It also describes @command{gnatmem}, a utility that monitors dynamic
833 allocation and deallocation and helps detect ``memory leaks''.
834 @end ifclear
835
836 @item
837 @ref{Stack Related Facilities}, describes some useful tools associated with
838 stack checking and analysis.
839
840 @item
841 @ref{Verifying Properties Using gnatcheck}, discusses @code{gnatcheck},
842 a utility that checks Ada code against a set of rules.
843
844 @item
845 @ref{Creating Sample Bodies Using gnatstub}, discusses @code{gnatstub},
846 a utility that generates empty but compilable bodies for library units.
847
848 @item
849 @ref{Other Utility Programs}, discusses several other GNAT utilities,
850 including @code{gnathtml}.
851
852 @ifclear vms
853 @item
854 @ref{Code Coverage and Profiling}, describes how to perform a structural
855 coverage and profile the execution of Ada programs.
856 @end ifclear
857
858 @item
859 @ref{Running and Debugging Ada Programs}, describes how to run and debug
860 Ada programs.
861
862 @ifset vms
863 @item
864 @ref{Compatibility with HP Ada}, details the compatibility of GNAT with
865 HP Ada 83 @footnote{``HP Ada'' refers to the legacy product originally
866 developed by Digital Equipment Corporation and currently supported by HP.}
867 for OpenVMS Alpha. This product was formerly known as DEC Ada,
868 @cindex DEC Ada
869 and for
870 historical compatibility reasons, the relevant libraries still use the
871 DEC prefix.
872 @end ifset
873
874 @item
875 @ref{Platform-Specific Information for the Run-Time Libraries},
876 describes the various run-time
877 libraries supported by GNAT on various platforms and explains how to
878 choose a particular library.
879
880 @item
881 @ref{Example of Binder Output File}, shows the source code for the binder
882 output file for a sample program.
883
884 @item
885 @ref{Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT}, describes how GNAT helps
886 you deal with elaboration order issues.
887
888 @item
889 @ref{Conditional Compilation}, describes how to model conditional compilation,
890 both with Ada in general and with GNAT facilities in particular.
891
892 @item
893 @ref{Inline Assembler}, shows how to use the inline assembly facility
894 in an Ada program.
895
896 @item
897 @ref{Compatibility and Porting Guide}, contains sections on compatibility
898 of GNAT with other Ada development environments (including Ada 83 systems),
899 to assist in porting code from those environments.
900
901 @ifset unw
902 @item
903 @ref{Microsoft Windows Topics}, presents information relevant to the
904 Microsoft Windows platform.
905 @end ifset
906 @end itemize
907
908 @c *************************************************
909 @node What You Should Know before Reading This Guide
910 @c *************************************************
911 @unnumberedsec What You Should Know before Reading This Guide
912
913 @cindex Ada 95 Language Reference Manual
914 @cindex Ada 2005 Language Reference Manual
915 @noindent
916 This guide assumes a basic familiarity with the Ada 95 language, as
917 described in the International Standard ANSI/ISO/IEC-8652:1995, January
918 1995.
919 It does not require knowledge of the new features introduced by Ada 2005,
920 (officially known as ISO/IEC 8652:1995 with Technical Corrigendum 1
921 and Amendment 1).
922 Both reference manuals are included in the GNAT documentation
923 package.
924
925 @node Related Information
926 @unnumberedsec Related Information
927
928 @noindent
929 For further information about related tools, refer to the following
930 documents:
931
932 @itemize @bullet
933 @item
934 @xref{Top, GNAT Reference Manual, About This Guide, gnat_rm, GNAT
935 Reference Manual}, which contains all reference material for the GNAT
936 implementation of Ada.
937
938 @ifset unw
939 @item
940 @cite{Using the GNAT Programming Studio}, which describes the GPS
941 Integrated Development Environment.
942
943 @item
944 @cite{GNAT Programming Studio Tutorial}, which introduces the
945 main GPS features through examples.
946 @end ifset
947
948 @item
949 @cite{Ada 95 Reference Manual}, which contains reference
950 material for the Ada 95 programming language.
951
952 @item
953 @cite{Ada 2005 Reference Manual}, which contains reference
954 material for the Ada 2005 programming language.
955
956 @item
957 @xref{Top,, Debugging with GDB, gdb, Debugging with GDB},
958 @ifset vms
959 in the GNU:[DOCS] directory,
960 @end ifset
961 for all details on the use of the GNU source-level debugger.
962
963 @item
964 @xref{Top,, The extensible self-documenting text editor, emacs,
965 GNU Emacs Manual},
966 @ifset vms
967 located in the GNU:[DOCS] directory if the EMACS kit is installed,
968 @end ifset
969 for full information on the extensible editor and programming
970 environment Emacs.
971
972 @end itemize
973
974 @c **************
975 @node Conventions
976 @unnumberedsec Conventions
977 @cindex Conventions
978 @cindex Typographical conventions
979
980 @noindent
981 Following are examples of the typographical and graphic conventions used
982 in this guide:
983
984 @itemize @bullet
985 @item
986 @code{Functions}, @command{utility program names}, @code{standard names},
987 and @code{classes}.
988
989 @item
990 @option{Option flags}
991
992 @item
993 @file{File names}, @samp{button names}, and @samp{field names}.
994
995 @item
996 @code{Variables}, @env{environment variables}, and @var{metasyntactic
997 variables}.
998
999 @item
1000 @emph{Emphasis}.
1001
1002 @item
1003 @r{[}optional information or parameters@r{]}
1004
1005 @item
1006 Examples are described by text
1007 @smallexample
1008 and then shown this way.
1009 @end smallexample
1010 @end itemize
1011
1012 @noindent
1013 Commands that are entered by the user are preceded in this manual by the
1014 characters @w{``@code{$ }''} (dollar sign followed by space). If your system
1015 uses this sequence as a prompt, then the commands will appear exactly as
1016 you see them in the manual. If your system uses some other prompt, then
1017 the command will appear with the @code{$} replaced by whatever prompt
1018 character you are using.
1019
1020 @ifset unw
1021 Full file names are shown with the ``@code{/}'' character
1022 as the directory separator; e.g., @file{parent-dir/subdir/myfile.adb}.
1023 If you are using GNAT on a Windows platform, please note that
1024 the ``@code{\}'' character should be used instead.
1025 @end ifset
1026
1027 @c ****************************
1028 @node Getting Started with GNAT
1029 @chapter Getting Started with GNAT
1030
1031 @noindent
1032 This chapter describes some simple ways of using GNAT to build
1033 executable Ada programs.
1034 @ifset unw
1035 @ref{Running GNAT}, through @ref{Using the gnatmake Utility},
1036 show how to use the command line environment.
1037 @ref{Introduction to GPS}, provides a brief
1038 introduction to the GNAT Programming Studio, a visually-oriented
1039 Integrated Development Environment for GNAT.
1040 GPS offers a graphical ``look and feel'', support for development in
1041 other programming languages, comprehensive browsing features, and
1042 many other capabilities.
1043 For information on GPS please refer to
1044 @cite{Using the GNAT Programming Studio}.
1045 @end ifset
1046
1047 @menu
1048 * Running GNAT::
1049 * Running a Simple Ada Program::
1050 * Running a Program with Multiple Units::
1051 * Using the gnatmake Utility::
1052 @ifset vms
1053 * Editing with Emacs::
1054 @end ifset
1055 @ifclear vms
1056 * Introduction to GPS::
1057 @end ifclear
1058 @end menu
1059
1060 @node Running GNAT
1061 @section Running GNAT
1062
1063 @noindent
1064 Three steps are needed to create an executable file from an Ada source
1065 file:
1066
1067 @enumerate
1068 @item
1069 The source file(s) must be compiled.
1070 @item
1071 The file(s) must be bound using the GNAT binder.
1072 @item
1073 All appropriate object files must be linked to produce an executable.
1074 @end enumerate
1075
1076 @noindent
1077 All three steps are most commonly handled by using the @command{gnatmake}
1078 utility program that, given the name of the main program, automatically
1079 performs the necessary compilation, binding and linking steps.
1080
1081 @node Running a Simple Ada Program
1082 @section Running a Simple Ada Program
1083
1084 @noindent
1085 Any text editor may be used to prepare an Ada program.
1086 (If @code{Emacs} is
1087 used, the optional Ada mode may be helpful in laying out the program.)
1088 The
1089 program text is a normal text file. We will assume in our initial
1090 example that you have used your editor to prepare the following
1091 standard format text file:
1092
1093 @smallexample @c ada
1094 @cartouche
1095 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
1096 procedure Hello is
1097 begin
1098 Put_Line ("Hello WORLD!");
1099 end Hello;
1100 @end cartouche
1101 @end smallexample
1102
1103 @noindent
1104 This file should be named @file{hello.adb}.
1105 With the normal default file naming conventions, GNAT requires
1106 that each file
1107 contain a single compilation unit whose file name is the
1108 unit name,
1109 with periods replaced by hyphens; the
1110 extension is @file{ads} for a
1111 spec and @file{adb} for a body.
1112 You can override this default file naming convention by use of the
1113 special pragma @code{Source_File_Name} (@pxref{Using Other File Names}).
1114 Alternatively, if you want to rename your files according to this default
1115 convention, which is probably more convenient if you will be using GNAT
1116 for all your compilations, then the @code{gnatchop} utility
1117 can be used to generate correctly-named source files
1118 (@pxref{Renaming Files Using gnatchop}).
1119
1120 You can compile the program using the following command (@code{$} is used
1121 as the command prompt in the examples in this document):
1122
1123 @smallexample
1124 $ gcc -c hello.adb
1125 @end smallexample
1126
1127 @noindent
1128 @command{gcc} is the command used to run the compiler. This compiler is
1129 capable of compiling programs in several languages, including Ada and
1130 C. It assumes that you have given it an Ada program if the file extension is
1131 either @file{.ads} or @file{.adb}, and it will then call
1132 the GNAT compiler to compile the specified file.
1133
1134 @ifclear vms
1135 The @option{-c} switch is required. It tells @command{gcc} to only do a
1136 compilation. (For C programs, @command{gcc} can also do linking, but this
1137 capability is not used directly for Ada programs, so the @option{-c}
1138 switch must always be present.)
1139 @end ifclear
1140
1141 This compile command generates a file
1142 @file{hello.o}, which is the object
1143 file corresponding to your Ada program. It also generates
1144 an ``Ada Library Information'' file @file{hello.ali},
1145 which contains additional information used to check
1146 that an Ada program is consistent.
1147 To build an executable file,
1148 use @code{gnatbind} to bind the program
1149 and @command{gnatlink} to link it. The
1150 argument to both @code{gnatbind} and @command{gnatlink} is the name of the
1151 @file{ALI} file, but the default extension of @file{.ali} can
1152 be omitted. This means that in the most common case, the argument
1153 is simply the name of the main program:
1154
1155 @smallexample
1156 $ gnatbind hello
1157 $ gnatlink hello
1158 @end smallexample
1159
1160 @noindent
1161 A simpler method of carrying out these steps is to use
1162 @command{gnatmake},
1163 a master program that invokes all the required
1164 compilation, binding and linking tools in the correct order. In particular,
1165 @command{gnatmake} automatically recompiles any sources that have been
1166 modified since they were last compiled, or sources that depend
1167 on such modified sources, so that ``version skew'' is avoided.
1168 @cindex Version skew (avoided by @command{gnatmake})
1169
1170 @smallexample
1171 $ gnatmake hello.adb
1172 @end smallexample
1173
1174 @noindent
1175 The result is an executable program called @file{hello}, which can be
1176 run by entering:
1177
1178 @smallexample
1179 $ ^hello^RUN HELLO^
1180 @end smallexample
1181
1182 @noindent
1183 assuming that the current directory is on the search path
1184 for executable programs.
1185
1186 @noindent
1187 and, if all has gone well, you will see
1188
1189 @smallexample
1190 Hello WORLD!
1191 @end smallexample
1192
1193 @noindent
1194 appear in response to this command.
1195
1196 @c ****************************************
1197 @node Running a Program with Multiple Units
1198 @section Running a Program with Multiple Units
1199
1200 @noindent
1201 Consider a slightly more complicated example that has three files: a
1202 main program, and the spec and body of a package:
1203
1204 @smallexample @c ada
1205 @cartouche
1206 @group
1207 package Greetings is
1208 procedure Hello;
1209 procedure Goodbye;
1210 end Greetings;
1211
1212 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
1213 package body Greetings is
1214 procedure Hello is
1215 begin
1216 Put_Line ("Hello WORLD!");
1217 end Hello;
1218
1219 procedure Goodbye is
1220 begin
1221 Put_Line ("Goodbye WORLD!");
1222 end Goodbye;
1223 end Greetings;
1224 @end group
1225
1226 @group
1227 with Greetings;
1228 procedure Gmain is
1229 begin
1230 Greetings.Hello;
1231 Greetings.Goodbye;
1232 end Gmain;
1233 @end group
1234 @end cartouche
1235 @end smallexample
1236
1237 @noindent
1238 Following the one-unit-per-file rule, place this program in the
1239 following three separate files:
1240
1241 @table @file
1242 @item greetings.ads
1243 spec of package @code{Greetings}
1244
1245 @item greetings.adb
1246 body of package @code{Greetings}
1247
1248 @item gmain.adb
1249 body of main program
1250 @end table
1251
1252 @noindent
1253 To build an executable version of
1254 this program, we could use four separate steps to compile, bind, and link
1255 the program, as follows:
1256
1257 @smallexample
1258 $ gcc -c gmain.adb
1259 $ gcc -c greetings.adb
1260 $ gnatbind gmain
1261 $ gnatlink gmain
1262 @end smallexample
1263
1264 @noindent
1265 Note that there is no required order of compilation when using GNAT.
1266 In particular it is perfectly fine to compile the main program first.
1267 Also, it is not necessary to compile package specs in the case where
1268 there is an accompanying body; you only need to compile the body. If you want
1269 to submit these files to the compiler for semantic checking and not code
1270 generation, then use the
1271 @option{-gnatc} switch:
1272
1273 @smallexample
1274 $ gcc -c greetings.ads -gnatc
1275 @end smallexample
1276
1277 @noindent
1278 Although the compilation can be done in separate steps as in the
1279 above example, in practice it is almost always more convenient
1280 to use the @command{gnatmake} tool. All you need to know in this case
1281 is the name of the main program's source file. The effect of the above four
1282 commands can be achieved with a single one:
1283
1284 @smallexample
1285 $ gnatmake gmain.adb
1286 @end smallexample
1287
1288 @noindent
1289 In the next section we discuss the advantages of using @command{gnatmake} in
1290 more detail.
1291
1292 @c *****************************
1293 @node Using the gnatmake Utility
1294 @section Using the @command{gnatmake} Utility
1295
1296 @noindent
1297 If you work on a program by compiling single components at a time using
1298 @command{gcc}, you typically keep track of the units you modify. In order to
1299 build a consistent system, you compile not only these units, but also any
1300 units that depend on the units you have modified.
1301 For example, in the preceding case,
1302 if you edit @file{gmain.adb}, you only need to recompile that file. But if
1303 you edit @file{greetings.ads}, you must recompile both
1304 @file{greetings.adb} and @file{gmain.adb}, because both files contain
1305 units that depend on @file{greetings.ads}.
1306
1307 @code{gnatbind} will warn you if you forget one of these compilation
1308 steps, so that it is impossible to generate an inconsistent program as a
1309 result of forgetting to do a compilation. Nevertheless it is tedious and
1310 error-prone to keep track of dependencies among units.
1311 One approach to handle the dependency-bookkeeping is to use a
1312 makefile. However, makefiles present maintenance problems of their own:
1313 if the dependencies change as you change the program, you must make
1314 sure that the makefile is kept up-to-date manually, which is also an
1315 error-prone process.
1316
1317 The @command{gnatmake} utility takes care of these details automatically.
1318 Invoke it using either one of the following forms:
1319
1320 @smallexample
1321 $ gnatmake gmain.adb
1322 $ gnatmake ^gmain^GMAIN^
1323 @end smallexample
1324
1325 @noindent
1326 The argument is the name of the file containing the main program;
1327 you may omit the extension. @command{gnatmake}
1328 examines the environment, automatically recompiles any files that need
1329 recompiling, and binds and links the resulting set of object files,
1330 generating the executable file, @file{^gmain^GMAIN.EXE^}.
1331 In a large program, it
1332 can be extremely helpful to use @command{gnatmake}, because working out by hand
1333 what needs to be recompiled can be difficult.
1334
1335 Note that @command{gnatmake}
1336 takes into account all the Ada rules that
1337 establish dependencies among units. These include dependencies that result
1338 from inlining subprogram bodies, and from
1339 generic instantiation. Unlike some other
1340 Ada make tools, @command{gnatmake} does not rely on the dependencies that were
1341 found by the compiler on a previous compilation, which may possibly
1342 be wrong when sources change. @command{gnatmake} determines the exact set of
1343 dependencies from scratch each time it is run.
1344
1345 @ifset vms
1346 @node Editing with Emacs
1347 @section Editing with Emacs
1348 @cindex Emacs
1349
1350 @noindent
1351 Emacs is an extensible self-documenting text editor that is available in a
1352 separate VMSINSTAL kit.
1353
1354 Invoke Emacs by typing @kbd{Emacs} at the command prompt. To get started,
1355 click on the Emacs Help menu and run the Emacs Tutorial.
1356 In a character cell terminal, Emacs help is invoked with @kbd{Ctrl-h} (also
1357 written as @kbd{C-h}), and the tutorial by @kbd{C-h t}.
1358
1359 Documentation on Emacs and other tools is available in Emacs under the
1360 pull-down menu button: @code{Help - Info}. After selecting @code{Info},
1361 use the middle mouse button to select a topic (e.g.@: Emacs).
1362
1363 In a character cell terminal, do @kbd{C-h i} to invoke info, and then @kbd{m}
1364 (stands for menu) followed by the menu item desired, as in @kbd{m Emacs}, to
1365 get to the Emacs manual.
1366 Help on Emacs is also available by typing @kbd{HELP EMACS} at the DCL command
1367 prompt.
1368
1369 The tutorial is highly recommended in order to learn the intricacies of Emacs,
1370 which is sufficiently extensible to provide for a complete programming
1371 environment and shell for the sophisticated user.
1372 @end ifset
1373
1374 @ifclear vms
1375 @node Introduction to GPS
1376 @section Introduction to GPS
1377 @cindex GPS (GNAT Programming Studio)
1378 @cindex GNAT Programming Studio (GPS)
1379 @noindent
1380 Although the command line interface (@command{gnatmake}, etc.) alone
1381 is sufficient, a graphical Interactive Development
1382 Environment can make it easier for you to compose, navigate, and debug
1383 programs. This section describes the main features of GPS
1384 (``GNAT Programming Studio''), the GNAT graphical IDE.
1385 You will see how to use GPS to build and debug an executable, and
1386 you will also learn some of the basics of the GNAT ``project'' facility.
1387
1388 GPS enables you to do much more than is presented here;
1389 e.g., you can produce a call graph, interface to a third-party
1390 Version Control System, and inspect the generated assembly language
1391 for a program.
1392 Indeed, GPS also supports languages other than Ada.
1393 Such additional information, and an explanation of all of the GPS menu
1394 items. may be found in the on-line help, which includes
1395 a user's guide and a tutorial (these are also accessible from the GNAT
1396 startup menu).
1397
1398 @menu
1399 * Building a New Program with GPS::
1400 * Simple Debugging with GPS::
1401 @end menu
1402
1403 @node Building a New Program with GPS
1404 @subsection Building a New Program with GPS
1405 @noindent
1406 GPS invokes the GNAT compilation tools using information
1407 contained in a @emph{project} (also known as a @emph{project file}):
1408 a collection of properties such
1409 as source directories, identities of main subprograms, tool switches, etc.,
1410 and their associated values.
1411 See @ref{GNAT Project Manager} for details.
1412 In order to run GPS, you will need to either create a new project
1413 or else open an existing one.
1414
1415 This section will explain how you can use GPS to create a project,
1416 to associate Ada source files with a project, and to build and run
1417 programs.
1418
1419 @enumerate
1420 @item @emph{Creating a project}
1421
1422 Invoke GPS, either from the command line or the platform's IDE.
1423 After it starts, GPS will display a ``Welcome'' screen with three
1424 radio buttons:
1425
1426 @itemize @bullet
1427 @item
1428 @code{Start with default project in directory}
1429
1430 @item
1431 @code{Create new project with wizard}
1432
1433 @item
1434 @code{Open existing project}
1435 @end itemize
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 Select @code{Create new project with wizard} and press @code{OK}.
1439 A new window will appear. In the text box labeled with
1440 @code{Enter the name of the project to create}, type @file{sample}
1441 as the project name.
1442 In the next box, browse to choose the directory in which you
1443 would like to create the project file.
1444 After selecting an appropriate directory, press @code{Forward}.
1445
1446 A window will appear with the title
1447 @code{Version Control System Configuration}.
1448 Simply press @code{Forward}.
1449
1450 A window will appear with the title
1451 @code{Please select the source directories for this project}.
1452 The directory that you specified for the project file will be selected
1453 by default as the one to use for sources; simply press @code{Forward}.
1454
1455 A window will appear with the title
1456 @code{Please select the build directory for this project}.
1457 The directory that you specified for the project file will be selected
1458 by default for object files and executables;
1459 simply press @code{Forward}.
1460
1461 A window will appear with the title
1462 @code{Please select the main units for this project}.
1463 You will supply this information later, after creating the source file.
1464 Simply press @code{Forward} for now.
1465
1466 A window will appear with the title
1467 @code{Please select the switches to build the project}.
1468 Press @code{Apply}. This will create a project file named
1469 @file{sample.prj} in the directory that you had specified.
1470
1471 @item @emph{Creating and saving the source file}
1472
1473 After you create the new project, a GPS window will appear, which is
1474 partitioned into two main sections:
1475
1476 @itemize @bullet
1477 @item
1478 A @emph{Workspace area}, initially greyed out, which you will use for
1479 creating and editing source files
1480
1481 @item
1482 Directly below, a @emph{Messages area}, which initially displays a
1483 ``Welcome'' message.
1484 (If the Messages area is not visible, drag its border upward to expand it.)
1485 @end itemize
1486
1487 @noindent
1488 Select @code{File} on the menu bar, and then the @code{New} command.
1489 The Workspace area will become white, and you can now
1490 enter the source program explicitly.
1491 Type the following text
1492
1493 @smallexample @c ada
1494 @group
1495 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
1496 procedure Hello is
1497 begin
1498 Put_Line("Hello from GPS!");
1499 end Hello;
1500 @end group
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 @noindent
1504 Select @code{File}, then @code{Save As}, and enter the source file name
1505 @file{hello.adb}.
1506 The file will be saved in the same directory you specified as the
1507 location of the default project file.
1508
1509 @item @emph{Updating the project file}
1510
1511 You need to add the new source file to the project.
1512 To do this, select
1513 the @code{Project} menu and then @code{Edit project properties}.
1514 Click the @code{Main files} tab on the left, and then the
1515 @code{Add} button.
1516 Choose @file{hello.adb} from the list, and press @code{Open}.
1517 The project settings window will reflect this action.
1518 Click @code{OK}.
1519
1520 @item @emph{Building and running the program}
1521
1522 In the main GPS window, now choose the @code{Build} menu, then @code{Make},
1523 and select @file{hello.adb}.
1524 The Messages window will display the resulting invocations of @command{gcc},
1525 @command{gnatbind}, and @command{gnatlink}
1526 (reflecting the default switch settings from the
1527 project file that you created) and then a ``successful compilation/build''
1528 message.
1529
1530 To run the program, choose the @code{Build} menu, then @code{Run}, and
1531 select @command{hello}.
1532 An @emph{Arguments Selection} window will appear.
1533 There are no command line arguments, so just click @code{OK}.
1534
1535 The Messages window will now display the program's output (the string
1536 @code{Hello from GPS}), and at the bottom of the GPS window a status
1537 update is displayed (@code{Run: hello}).
1538 Close the GPS window (or select @code{File}, then @code{Exit}) to
1539 terminate this GPS session.
1540 @end enumerate
1541
1542 @node Simple Debugging with GPS
1543 @subsection Simple Debugging with GPS
1544 @noindent
1545 This section illustrates basic debugging techniques (setting breakpoints,
1546 examining/modifying variables, single stepping).
1547
1548 @enumerate
1549 @item @emph{Opening a project}
1550
1551 Start GPS and select @code{Open existing project}; browse to
1552 specify the project file @file{sample.prj} that you had created in the
1553 earlier example.
1554
1555 @item @emph{Creating a source file}
1556
1557 Select @code{File}, then @code{New}, and type in the following program:
1558
1559 @smallexample @c ada
1560 @group
1561 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
1562 procedure Example is
1563 Line : String (1..80);
1564 N : Natural;
1565 begin
1566 Put_Line("Type a line of text at each prompt; an empty line to exit");
1567 loop
1568 Put(": ");
1569 Get_Line (Line, N);
1570 Put_Line (Line (1..N) );
1571 exit when N=0;
1572 end loop;
1573 end Example;
1574 @end group
1575 @end smallexample
1576
1577 @noindent
1578 Select @code{File}, then @code{Save as}, and enter the file name
1579 @file{example.adb}.
1580
1581 @item @emph{Updating the project file}
1582
1583 Add @code{Example} as a new main unit for the project:
1584 @enumerate a
1585 @item
1586 Select @code{Project}, then @code{Edit Project Properties}.
1587
1588 @item
1589 Select the @code{Main files} tab, click @code{Add}, then
1590 select the file @file{example.adb} from the list, and
1591 click @code{Open}.
1592 You will see the file name appear in the list of main units
1593
1594 @item
1595 Click @code{OK}
1596 @end enumerate
1597
1598 @item @emph{Building/running the executable}
1599
1600 To build the executable
1601 select @code{Build}, then @code{Make}, and then choose @file{example.adb}.
1602
1603 Run the program to see its effect (in the Messages area).
1604 Each line that you enter is displayed; an empty line will
1605 cause the loop to exit and the program to terminate.
1606
1607 @item @emph{Debugging the program}
1608
1609 Note that the @option{-g} switches to @command{gcc} and @command{gnatlink},
1610 which are required for debugging, are on by default when you create
1611 a new project.
1612 Thus unless you intentionally remove these settings, you will be able
1613 to debug any program that you develop using GPS.
1614
1615 @enumerate a
1616 @item @emph{Initializing}
1617
1618 Select @code{Debug}, then @code{Initialize}, then @file{example}
1619
1620 @item @emph{Setting a breakpoint}
1621
1622 After performing the initialization step, you will observe a small
1623 icon to the right of each line number.
1624 This serves as a toggle for breakpoints; clicking the icon will
1625 set a breakpoint at the corresponding line (the icon will change to
1626 a red circle with an ``x''), and clicking it again
1627 will remove the breakpoint / reset the icon.
1628
1629 For purposes of this example, set a breakpoint at line 10 (the
1630 statement @code{Put_Line@ (Line@ (1..N));}
1631
1632 @item @emph{Starting program execution}
1633
1634 Select @code{Debug}, then @code{Run}. When the
1635 @code{Program Arguments} window appears, click @code{OK}.
1636 A console window will appear; enter some line of text,
1637 e.g.@: @code{abcde}, at the prompt.
1638 The program will pause execution when it gets to the
1639 breakpoint, and the corresponding line is highlighted.
1640
1641 @item @emph{Examining a variable}
1642
1643 Move the mouse over one of the occurrences of the variable @code{N}.
1644 You will see the value (5) displayed, in ``tool tip'' fashion.
1645 Right click on @code{N}, select @code{Debug}, then select @code{Display N}.
1646 You will see information about @code{N} appear in the @code{Debugger Data}
1647 pane, showing the value as 5.
1648
1649 @item @emph{Assigning a new value to a variable}
1650
1651 Right click on the @code{N} in the @code{Debugger Data} pane, and
1652 select @code{Set value of N}.
1653 When the input window appears, enter the value @code{4} and click
1654 @code{OK}.
1655 This value does not automatically appear in the @code{Debugger Data}
1656 pane; to see it, right click again on the @code{N} in the
1657 @code{Debugger Data} pane and select @code{Update value}.
1658 The new value, 4, will appear in red.
1659
1660 @item @emph{Single stepping}
1661
1662 Select @code{Debug}, then @code{Next}.
1663 This will cause the next statement to be executed, in this case the
1664 call of @code{Put_Line} with the string slice.
1665 Notice in the console window that the displayed string is simply
1666 @code{abcd} and not @code{abcde} which you had entered.
1667 This is because the upper bound of the slice is now 4 rather than 5.
1668
1669 @item @emph{Removing a breakpoint}
1670
1671 Toggle the breakpoint icon at line 10.
1672
1673 @item @emph{Resuming execution from a breakpoint}
1674
1675 Select @code{Debug}, then @code{Continue}.
1676 The program will reach the next iteration of the loop, and
1677 wait for input after displaying the prompt.
1678 This time, just hit the @kbd{Enter} key.
1679 The value of @code{N} will be 0, and the program will terminate.
1680 The console window will disappear.
1681 @end enumerate
1682 @end enumerate
1683 @end ifclear
1684
1685 @node The GNAT Compilation Model
1686 @chapter The GNAT Compilation Model
1687 @cindex GNAT compilation model
1688 @cindex Compilation model
1689
1690 @menu
1691 * Source Representation::
1692 * Foreign Language Representation::
1693 * File Naming Rules::
1694 * Using Other File Names::
1695 * Alternative File Naming Schemes::
1696 * Generating Object Files::
1697 * Source Dependencies::
1698 * The Ada Library Information Files::
1699 * Binding an Ada Program::
1700 * Mixed Language Programming::
1701 @ifclear vms
1702 * Building Mixed Ada & C++ Programs::
1703 * Comparison between GNAT and C/C++ Compilation Models::
1704 @end ifclear
1705 * Comparison between GNAT and Conventional Ada Library Models::
1706 @ifset vms
1707 * Placement of temporary files::
1708 @end ifset
1709 @end menu
1710
1711 @noindent
1712 This chapter describes the compilation model used by GNAT. Although
1713 similar to that used by other languages, such as C and C++, this model
1714 is substantially different from the traditional Ada compilation models,
1715 which are based on a library. The model is initially described without
1716 reference to the library-based model. If you have not previously used an
1717 Ada compiler, you need only read the first part of this chapter. The
1718 last section describes and discusses the differences between the GNAT
1719 model and the traditional Ada compiler models. If you have used other
1720 Ada compilers, this section will help you to understand those
1721 differences, and the advantages of the GNAT model.
1722
1723 @node Source Representation
1724 @section Source Representation
1725 @cindex Latin-1
1726
1727 @noindent
1728 Ada source programs are represented in standard text files, using
1729 Latin-1 coding. Latin-1 is an 8-bit code that includes the familiar
1730 7-bit ASCII set, plus additional characters used for
1731 representing foreign languages (@pxref{Foreign Language Representation}
1732 for support of non-USA character sets). The format effector characters
1733 are represented using their standard ASCII encodings, as follows:
1734
1735 @table @code
1736 @item VT
1737 @findex VT
1738 Vertical tab, @code{16#0B#}
1739
1740 @item HT
1741 @findex HT
1742 Horizontal tab, @code{16#09#}
1743
1744 @item CR
1745 @findex CR
1746 Carriage return, @code{16#0D#}
1747
1748 @item LF
1749 @findex LF
1750 Line feed, @code{16#0A#}
1751
1752 @item FF
1753 @findex FF
1754 Form feed, @code{16#0C#}
1755 @end table
1756
1757 @noindent
1758 Source files are in standard text file format. In addition, GNAT will
1759 recognize a wide variety of stream formats, in which the end of
1760 physical lines is marked by any of the following sequences:
1761 @code{LF}, @code{CR}, @code{CR-LF}, or @code{LF-CR}. This is useful
1762 in accommodating files that are imported from other operating systems.
1763
1764 @cindex End of source file
1765 @cindex Source file, end
1766 @findex SUB
1767 The end of a source file is normally represented by the physical end of
1768 file. However, the control character @code{16#1A#} (@code{SUB}) is also
1769 recognized as signalling the end of the source file. Again, this is
1770 provided for compatibility with other operating systems where this
1771 code is used to represent the end of file.
1772
1773 Each file contains a single Ada compilation unit, including any pragmas
1774 associated with the unit. For example, this means you must place a
1775 package declaration (a package @dfn{spec}) and the corresponding body in
1776 separate files. An Ada @dfn{compilation} (which is a sequence of
1777 compilation units) is represented using a sequence of files. Similarly,
1778 you will place each subunit or child unit in a separate file.
1779
1780 @node Foreign Language Representation
1781 @section Foreign Language Representation
1782
1783 @noindent
1784 GNAT supports the standard character sets defined in Ada as well as
1785 several other non-standard character sets for use in localized versions
1786 of the compiler (@pxref{Character Set Control}).
1787 @menu
1788 * Latin-1::
1789 * Other 8-Bit Codes::
1790 * Wide Character Encodings::
1791 @end menu
1792
1793 @node Latin-1
1794 @subsection Latin-1
1795 @cindex Latin-1
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 The basic character set is Latin-1. This character set is defined by ISO
1799 standard 8859, part 1. The lower half (character codes @code{16#00#}
1800 @dots{} @code{16#7F#)} is identical to standard ASCII coding, but the upper half
1801 is used to represent additional characters. These include extended letters
1802 used by European languages, such as French accents, the vowels with umlauts
1803 used in German, and the extra letter A-ring used in Swedish.
1804
1805 @findex Ada.Characters.Latin_1
1806 For a complete list of Latin-1 codes and their encodings, see the source
1807 file of library unit @code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1} in file
1808 @file{a-chlat1.ads}.
1809 You may use any of these extended characters freely in character or
1810 string literals. In addition, the extended characters that represent
1811 letters can be used in identifiers.
1812
1813 @node Other 8-Bit Codes
1814 @subsection Other 8-Bit Codes
1815
1816 @noindent
1817 GNAT also supports several other 8-bit coding schemes:
1818
1819 @table @asis
1820 @item ISO 8859-2 (Latin-2)
1821 @cindex Latin-2
1822 @cindex ISO 8859-2
1823 Latin-2 letters allowed in identifiers, with uppercase and lowercase
1824 equivalence.
1825
1826 @item ISO 8859-3 (Latin-3)
1827 @cindex Latin-3
1828 @cindex ISO 8859-3
1829 Latin-3 letters allowed in identifiers, with uppercase and lowercase
1830 equivalence.
1831
1832 @item ISO 8859-4 (Latin-4)
1833 @cindex Latin-4
1834 @cindex ISO 8859-4
1835 Latin-4 letters allowed in identifiers, with uppercase and lowercase
1836 equivalence.
1837
1838 @item ISO 8859-5 (Cyrillic)
1839 @cindex ISO 8859-5
1840 @cindex Cyrillic
1841 ISO 8859-5 letters (Cyrillic) allowed in identifiers, with uppercase and
1842 lowercase equivalence.
1843
1844 @item ISO 8859-15 (Latin-9)
1845 @cindex ISO 8859-15
1846 @cindex Latin-9
1847 ISO 8859-15 (Latin-9) letters allowed in identifiers, with uppercase and
1848 lowercase equivalence
1849
1850 @item IBM PC (code page 437)
1851 @cindex code page 437
1852 This code page is the normal default for PCs in the U.S. It corresponds
1853 to the original IBM PC character set. This set has some, but not all, of
1854 the extended Latin-1 letters, but these letters do not have the same
1855 encoding as Latin-1. In this mode, these letters are allowed in
1856 identifiers with uppercase and lowercase equivalence.
1857
1858 @item IBM PC (code page 850)
1859 @cindex code page 850
1860 This code page is a modification of 437 extended to include all the
1861 Latin-1 letters, but still not with the usual Latin-1 encoding. In this
1862 mode, all these letters are allowed in identifiers with uppercase and
1863 lowercase equivalence.
1864
1865 @item Full Upper 8-bit
1866 Any character in the range 80-FF allowed in identifiers, and all are
1867 considered distinct. In other words, there are no uppercase and lowercase
1868 equivalences in this range. This is useful in conjunction with
1869 certain encoding schemes used for some foreign character sets (e.g.,
1870 the typical method of representing Chinese characters on the PC).
1871
1872 @item No Upper-Half
1873 No upper-half characters in the range 80-FF are allowed in identifiers.
1874 This gives Ada 83 compatibility for identifier names.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 @noindent
1878 For precise data on the encodings permitted, and the uppercase and lowercase
1879 equivalences that are recognized, see the file @file{csets.adb} in
1880 the GNAT compiler sources. You will need to obtain a full source release
1881 of GNAT to obtain this file.
1882
1883 @node Wide Character Encodings
1884 @subsection Wide Character Encodings
1885
1886 @noindent
1887 GNAT allows wide character codes to appear in character and string
1888 literals, and also optionally in identifiers, by means of the following
1889 possible encoding schemes:
1890
1891 @table @asis
1892
1893 @item Hex Coding
1894 In this encoding, a wide character is represented by the following five
1895 character sequence:
1896
1897 @smallexample
1898 ESC a b c d
1899 @end smallexample
1900
1901 @noindent
1902 Where @code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d} are the four hexadecimal
1903 characters (using uppercase letters) of the wide character code. For
1904 example, ESC A345 is used to represent the wide character with code
1905 @code{16#A345#}.
1906 This scheme is compatible with use of the full Wide_Character set.
1907
1908 @item Upper-Half Coding
1909 @cindex Upper-Half Coding
1910 The wide character with encoding @code{16#abcd#} where the upper bit is on
1911 (in other words, ``a'' is in the range 8-F) is represented as two bytes,
1912 @code{16#ab#} and @code{16#cd#}. The second byte cannot be a format control
1913 character, but is not required to be in the upper half. This method can
1914 be also used for shift-JIS or EUC, where the internal coding matches the
1915 external coding.
1916
1917 @item Shift JIS Coding
1918 @cindex Shift JIS Coding
1919 A wide character is represented by a two-character sequence,
1920 @code{16#ab#} and
1921 @code{16#cd#}, with the restrictions described for upper-half encoding as
1922 described above. The internal character code is the corresponding JIS
1923 character according to the standard algorithm for Shift-JIS
1924 conversion. Only characters defined in the JIS code set table can be
1925 used with this encoding method.
1926
1927 @item EUC Coding
1928 @cindex EUC Coding
1929 A wide character is represented by a two-character sequence
1930 @code{16#ab#} and
1931 @code{16#cd#}, with both characters being in the upper half. The internal
1932 character code is the corresponding JIS character according to the EUC
1933 encoding algorithm. Only characters defined in the JIS code set table
1934 can be used with this encoding method.
1935
1936 @item UTF-8 Coding
1937 A wide character is represented using
1938 UCS Transformation Format 8 (UTF-8) as defined in Annex R of ISO
1939 10646-1/Am.2. Depending on the character value, the representation
1940 is a one, two, or three byte sequence:
1941 @smallexample
1942 @iftex
1943 @leftskip=.7cm
1944 @end iftex
1945 16#0000#-16#007f#: 2#0@var{xxxxxxx}#
1946 16#0080#-16#07ff#: 2#110@var{xxxxx}# 2#10@var{xxxxxx}#
1947 16#0800#-16#ffff#: 2#1110@var{xxxx}# 2#10@var{xxxxxx}# 2#10@var{xxxxxx}#
1948
1949 @end smallexample
1950
1951 @noindent
1952 where the @var{xxx} bits correspond to the left-padded bits of the
1953 16-bit character value. Note that all lower half ASCII characters
1954 are represented as ASCII bytes and all upper half characters and
1955 other wide characters are represented as sequences of upper-half
1956 (The full UTF-8 scheme allows for encoding 31-bit characters as
1957 6-byte sequences, but in this implementation, all UTF-8 sequences
1958 of four or more bytes length will be treated as illegal).
1959 @item Brackets Coding
1960 In this encoding, a wide character is represented by the following eight
1961 character sequence:
1962
1963 @smallexample
1964 [ " a b c d " ]
1965 @end smallexample
1966
1967 @noindent
1968 Where @code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d} are the four hexadecimal
1969 characters (using uppercase letters) of the wide character code. For
1970 example, [``A345''] is used to represent the wide character with code
1971 @code{16#A345#}. It is also possible (though not required) to use the
1972 Brackets coding for upper half characters. For example, the code
1973 @code{16#A3#} can be represented as @code{[``A3'']}.
1974
1975 This scheme is compatible with use of the full Wide_Character set,
1976 and is also the method used for wide character encoding in the standard
1977 ACVC (Ada Compiler Validation Capability) test suite distributions.
1978
1979 @end table
1980
1981 @noindent
1982 Note: Some of these coding schemes do not permit the full use of the
1983 Ada character set. For example, neither Shift JIS, nor EUC allow the
1984 use of the upper half of the Latin-1 set.
1985
1986 @node File Naming Rules
1987 @section File Naming Rules
1988
1989 @noindent
1990 The default file name is determined by the name of the unit that the
1991 file contains. The name is formed by taking the full expanded name of
1992 the unit and replacing the separating dots with hyphens and using
1993 ^lowercase^uppercase^ for all letters.
1994
1995 An exception arises if the file name generated by the above rules starts
1996 with one of the characters
1997 @ifset vms
1998 @samp{A}, @samp{G}, @samp{I}, or @samp{S},
1999 @end ifset
2000 @ifclear vms
2001 @samp{a}, @samp{g}, @samp{i}, or @samp{s},
2002 @end ifclear
2003 and the second character is a
2004 minus. In this case, the character ^tilde^dollar sign^ is used in place
2005 of the minus. The reason for this special rule is to avoid clashes with
2006 the standard names for child units of the packages System, Ada,
2007 Interfaces, and GNAT, which use the prefixes
2008 @ifset vms
2009 @samp{S-}, @samp{A-}, @samp{I-}, and @samp{G-},
2010 @end ifset
2011 @ifclear vms
2012 @samp{s-}, @samp{a-}, @samp{i-}, and @samp{g-},
2013 @end ifclear
2014 respectively.
2015
2016 The file extension is @file{.ads} for a spec and
2017 @file{.adb} for a body. The following list shows some
2018 examples of these rules.
2019
2020 @table @file
2021 @item main.ads
2022 Main (spec)
2023 @item main.adb
2024 Main (body)
2025 @item arith_functions.ads
2026 Arith_Functions (package spec)
2027 @item arith_functions.adb
2028 Arith_Functions (package body)
2029 @item func-spec.ads
2030 Func.Spec (child package spec)
2031 @item func-spec.adb
2032 Func.Spec (child package body)
2033 @item main-sub.adb
2034 Sub (subunit of Main)
2035 @item ^a~bad.adb^A$BAD.ADB^
2036 A.Bad (child package body)
2037 @end table
2038
2039 @noindent
2040 Following these rules can result in excessively long
2041 file names if corresponding
2042 unit names are long (for example, if child units or subunits are
2043 heavily nested). An option is available to shorten such long file names
2044 (called file name ``krunching''). This may be particularly useful when
2045 programs being developed with GNAT are to be used on operating systems
2046 with limited file name lengths. @xref{Using gnatkr}.
2047
2048 Of course, no file shortening algorithm can guarantee uniqueness over
2049 all possible unit names; if file name krunching is used, it is your
2050 responsibility to ensure no name clashes occur. Alternatively you
2051 can specify the exact file names that you want used, as described
2052 in the next section. Finally, if your Ada programs are migrating from a
2053 compiler with a different naming convention, you can use the gnatchop
2054 utility to produce source files that follow the GNAT naming conventions.
2055 (For details @pxref{Renaming Files Using gnatchop}.)
2056
2057 Note: in the case of @code{Windows NT/XP} or @code{OpenVMS} operating
2058 systems, case is not significant. So for example on @code{Windows XP}
2059 if the canonical name is @code{main-sub.adb}, you can use the file name
2060 @code{Main-Sub.adb} instead. However, case is significant for other
2061 operating systems, so for example, if you want to use other than
2062 canonically cased file names on a Unix system, you need to follow
2063 the procedures described in the next section.
2064
2065 @node Using Other File Names
2066 @section Using Other File Names
2067 @cindex File names
2068
2069 @noindent
2070 In the previous section, we have described the default rules used by
2071 GNAT to determine the file name in which a given unit resides. It is
2072 often convenient to follow these default rules, and if you follow them,
2073 the compiler knows without being explicitly told where to find all
2074 the files it needs.
2075
2076 However, in some cases, particularly when a program is imported from
2077 another Ada compiler environment, it may be more convenient for the
2078 programmer to specify which file names contain which units. GNAT allows
2079 arbitrary file names to be used by means of the Source_File_Name pragma.
2080 The form of this pragma is as shown in the following examples:
2081 @cindex Source_File_Name pragma
2082
2083 @smallexample @c ada
2084 @cartouche
2085 pragma Source_File_Name (My_Utilities.Stacks,
2086 Spec_File_Name => "myutilst_a.ada");
2087 pragma Source_File_name (My_Utilities.Stacks,
2088 Body_File_Name => "myutilst.ada");
2089 @end cartouche
2090 @end smallexample
2091
2092 @noindent
2093 As shown in this example, the first argument for the pragma is the unit
2094 name (in this example a child unit). The second argument has the form
2095 of a named association. The identifier
2096 indicates whether the file name is for a spec or a body;
2097 the file name itself is given by a string literal.
2098
2099 The source file name pragma is a configuration pragma, which means that
2100 normally it will be placed in the @file{gnat.adc}
2101 file used to hold configuration
2102 pragmas that apply to a complete compilation environment.
2103 For more details on how the @file{gnat.adc} file is created and used
2104 see @ref{Handling of Configuration Pragmas}.
2105 @cindex @file{gnat.adc}
2106
2107 @ifclear vms
2108 GNAT allows completely arbitrary file names to be specified using the
2109 source file name pragma. However, if the file name specified has an
2110 extension other than @file{.ads} or @file{.adb} it is necessary to use
2111 a special syntax when compiling the file. The name in this case must be
2112 preceded by the special sequence @option{-x} followed by a space and the name
2113 of the language, here @code{ada}, as in:
2114
2115 @smallexample
2116 $ gcc -c -x ada peculiar_file_name.sim
2117 @end smallexample
2118 @end ifclear
2119
2120 @noindent
2121 @command{gnatmake} handles non-standard file names in the usual manner (the
2122 non-standard file name for the main program is simply used as the
2123 argument to gnatmake). Note that if the extension is also non-standard,
2124 then it must be included in the @command{gnatmake} command, it may not
2125 be omitted.
2126
2127 @node Alternative File Naming Schemes
2128 @section Alternative File Naming Schemes
2129 @cindex File naming schemes, alternative
2130 @cindex File names
2131
2132 In the previous section, we described the use of the @code{Source_File_Name}
2133 pragma to allow arbitrary names to be assigned to individual source files.
2134 However, this approach requires one pragma for each file, and especially in
2135 large systems can result in very long @file{gnat.adc} files, and also create
2136 a maintenance problem.
2137
2138 GNAT also provides a facility for specifying systematic file naming schemes
2139 other than the standard default naming scheme previously described. An
2140 alternative scheme for naming is specified by the use of
2141 @code{Source_File_Name} pragmas having the following format:
2142 @cindex Source_File_Name pragma
2143
2144 @smallexample @c ada
2145 pragma Source_File_Name (
2146 Spec_File_Name => FILE_NAME_PATTERN
2147 @r{[},Casing => CASING_SPEC@r{]}
2148 @r{[},Dot_Replacement => STRING_LITERAL@r{]});
2149
2150 pragma Source_File_Name (
2151 Body_File_Name => FILE_NAME_PATTERN
2152 @r{[},Casing => CASING_SPEC@r{]}
2153 @r{[},Dot_Replacement => STRING_LITERAL@r{]});
2154
2155 pragma Source_File_Name (
2156 Subunit_File_Name => FILE_NAME_PATTERN
2157 @r{[},Casing => CASING_SPEC@r{]}
2158 @r{[},Dot_Replacement => STRING_LITERAL@r{]});
2159
2160 FILE_NAME_PATTERN ::= STRING_LITERAL
2161 CASING_SPEC ::= Lowercase | Uppercase | Mixedcase
2162 @end smallexample
2163
2164 @noindent
2165 The @code{FILE_NAME_PATTERN} string shows how the file name is constructed.
2166 It contains a single asterisk character, and the unit name is substituted
2167 systematically for this asterisk. The optional parameter
2168 @code{Casing} indicates
2169 whether the unit name is to be all upper-case letters, all lower-case letters,
2170 or mixed-case. If no
2171 @code{Casing} parameter is used, then the default is all
2172 ^lower-case^upper-case^.
2173
2174 The optional @code{Dot_Replacement} string is used to replace any periods
2175 that occur in subunit or child unit names. If no @code{Dot_Replacement}
2176 argument is used then separating dots appear unchanged in the resulting
2177 file name.
2178 Although the above syntax indicates that the
2179 @code{Casing} argument must appear
2180 before the @code{Dot_Replacement} argument, but it
2181 is also permissible to write these arguments in the opposite order.
2182
2183 As indicated, it is possible to specify different naming schemes for
2184 bodies, specs, and subunits. Quite often the rule for subunits is the
2185 same as the rule for bodies, in which case, there is no need to give
2186 a separate @code{Subunit_File_Name} rule, and in this case the
2187 @code{Body_File_name} rule is used for subunits as well.
2188
2189 The separate rule for subunits can also be used to implement the rather
2190 unusual case of a compilation environment (e.g.@: a single directory) which
2191 contains a subunit and a child unit with the same unit name. Although
2192 both units cannot appear in the same partition, the Ada Reference Manual
2193 allows (but does not require) the possibility of the two units coexisting
2194 in the same environment.
2195
2196 The file name translation works in the following steps:
2197
2198 @itemize @bullet
2199
2200 @item
2201 If there is a specific @code{Source_File_Name} pragma for the given unit,
2202 then this is always used, and any general pattern rules are ignored.
2203
2204 @item
2205 If there is a pattern type @code{Source_File_Name} pragma that applies to
2206 the unit, then the resulting file name will be used if the file exists. If
2207 more than one pattern matches, the latest one will be tried first, and the
2208 first attempt resulting in a reference to a file that exists will be used.
2209
2210 @item
2211 If no pattern type @code{Source_File_Name} pragma that applies to the unit
2212 for which the corresponding file exists, then the standard GNAT default
2213 naming rules are used.
2214
2215 @end itemize
2216
2217 @noindent
2218 As an example of the use of this mechanism, consider a commonly used scheme
2219 in which file names are all lower case, with separating periods copied
2220 unchanged to the resulting file name, and specs end with @file{.1.ada}, and
2221 bodies end with @file{.2.ada}. GNAT will follow this scheme if the following
2222 two pragmas appear:
2223
2224 @smallexample @c ada
2225 pragma Source_File_Name
2226 (Spec_File_Name => "*.1.ada");
2227 pragma Source_File_Name
2228 (Body_File_Name => "*.2.ada");
2229 @end smallexample
2230
2231 @noindent
2232 The default GNAT scheme is actually implemented by providing the following
2233 default pragmas internally:
2234
2235 @smallexample @c ada
2236 pragma Source_File_Name
2237 (Spec_File_Name => "*.ads", Dot_Replacement => "-");
2238 pragma Source_File_Name
2239 (Body_File_Name => "*.adb", Dot_Replacement => "-");
2240 @end smallexample
2241
2242 @noindent
2243 Our final example implements a scheme typically used with one of the
2244 Ada 83 compilers, where the separator character for subunits was ``__''
2245 (two underscores), specs were identified by adding @file{_.ADA}, bodies
2246 by adding @file{.ADA}, and subunits by
2247 adding @file{.SEP}. All file names were
2248 upper case. Child units were not present of course since this was an
2249 Ada 83 compiler, but it seems reasonable to extend this scheme to use
2250 the same double underscore separator for child units.
2251
2252 @smallexample @c ada
2253 pragma Source_File_Name
2254 (Spec_File_Name => "*_.ADA",
2255 Dot_Replacement => "__",
2256 Casing = Uppercase);
2257 pragma Source_File_Name
2258 (Body_File_Name => "*.ADA",
2259 Dot_Replacement => "__",
2260 Casing = Uppercase);
2261 pragma Source_File_Name
2262 (Subunit_File_Name => "*.SEP",
2263 Dot_Replacement => "__",
2264 Casing = Uppercase);
2265 @end smallexample
2266
2267 @node Generating Object Files
2268 @section Generating Object Files
2269
2270 @noindent
2271 An Ada program consists of a set of source files, and the first step in
2272 compiling the program is to generate the corresponding object files.
2273 These are generated by compiling a subset of these source files.
2274 The files you need to compile are the following:
2275
2276 @itemize @bullet
2277 @item
2278 If a package spec has no body, compile the package spec to produce the
2279 object file for the package.
2280
2281 @item
2282 If a package has both a spec and a body, compile the body to produce the
2283 object file for the package. The source file for the package spec need
2284 not be compiled in this case because there is only one object file, which
2285 contains the code for both the spec and body of the package.
2286
2287 @item
2288 For a subprogram, compile the subprogram body to produce the object file
2289 for the subprogram. The spec, if one is present, is as usual in a
2290 separate file, and need not be compiled.
2291
2292 @item
2293 @cindex Subunits
2294 In the case of subunits, only compile the parent unit. A single object
2295 file is generated for the entire subunit tree, which includes all the
2296 subunits.
2297
2298 @item
2299 Compile child units independently of their parent units
2300 (though, of course, the spec of all the ancestor unit must be present in order
2301 to compile a child unit).
2302
2303 @item
2304 @cindex Generics
2305 Compile generic units in the same manner as any other units. The object
2306 files in this case are small dummy files that contain at most the
2307 flag used for elaboration checking. This is because GNAT always handles generic
2308 instantiation by means of macro expansion. However, it is still necessary to
2309 compile generic units, for dependency checking and elaboration purposes.
2310 @end itemize
2311
2312 @noindent
2313 The preceding rules describe the set of files that must be compiled to
2314 generate the object files for a program. Each object file has the same
2315 name as the corresponding source file, except that the extension is
2316 @file{.o} as usual.
2317
2318 You may wish to compile other files for the purpose of checking their
2319 syntactic and semantic correctness. For example, in the case where a
2320 package has a separate spec and body, you would not normally compile the
2321 spec. However, it is convenient in practice to compile the spec to make
2322 sure it is error-free before compiling clients of this spec, because such
2323 compilations will fail if there is an error in the spec.
2324
2325 GNAT provides an option for compiling such files purely for the
2326 purposes of checking correctness; such compilations are not required as
2327 part of the process of building a program. To compile a file in this
2328 checking mode, use the @option{-gnatc} switch.
2329
2330 @node Source Dependencies
2331 @section Source Dependencies
2332
2333 @noindent
2334 A given object file clearly depends on the source file which is compiled
2335 to produce it. Here we are using @dfn{depends} in the sense of a typical
2336 @code{make} utility; in other words, an object file depends on a source
2337 file if changes to the source file require the object file to be
2338 recompiled.
2339 In addition to this basic dependency, a given object may depend on
2340 additional source files as follows:
2341
2342 @itemize @bullet
2343 @item
2344 If a file being compiled @code{with}'s a unit @var{X}, the object file
2345 depends on the file containing the spec of unit @var{X}. This includes
2346 files that are @code{with}'ed implicitly either because they are parents
2347 of @code{with}'ed child units or they are run-time units required by the
2348 language constructs used in a particular unit.
2349
2350 @item
2351 If a file being compiled instantiates a library level generic unit, the
2352 object file depends on both the spec and body files for this generic
2353 unit.
2354
2355 @item
2356 If a file being compiled instantiates a generic unit defined within a
2357 package, the object file depends on the body file for the package as
2358 well as the spec file.
2359
2360 @item
2361 @findex Inline
2362 @cindex @option{-gnatn} switch
2363 If a file being compiled contains a call to a subprogram for which
2364 pragma @code{Inline} applies and inlining is activated with the
2365 @option{-gnatn} switch, the object file depends on the file containing the
2366 body of this subprogram as well as on the file containing the spec. Note
2367 that for inlining to actually occur as a result of the use of this switch,
2368 it is necessary to compile in optimizing mode.
2369
2370 @cindex @option{-gnatN} switch
2371 The use of @option{-gnatN} activates inlining optimization
2372 that is performed by the front end of the compiler. This inlining does
2373 not require that the code generation be optimized. Like @option{-gnatn},
2374 the use of this switch generates additional dependencies.
2375 Note that
2376 @option{-gnatN} automatically implies @option{-gnatn} so it is not necessary
2377 to specify both options.
2378
2379 When using a gcc-based back end (in practice this means using any version
2380 of GNAT other than the JGNAT, .NET or GNAAMP versions), then the use of
2381 @option{-gnatN} is deprecated, and the use of @option{-gnatn} is preferred.
2382 Historically front end inlining was more extensive than the gcc back end
2383 inlining, but that is no longer the case.
2384
2385 @item
2386 If an object file @file{O} depends on the proper body of a subunit through
2387 inlining or instantiation, it depends on the parent unit of the subunit.
2388 This means that any modification of the parent unit or one of its subunits
2389 affects the compilation of @file{O}.
2390
2391 @item
2392 The object file for a parent unit depends on all its subunit body files.
2393
2394 @item
2395 The previous two rules meant that for purposes of computing dependencies and
2396 recompilation, a body and all its subunits are treated as an indivisible whole.
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 These rules are applied transitively: if unit @code{A} @code{with}'s
2400 unit @code{B}, whose elaboration calls an inlined procedure in package
2401 @code{C}, the object file for unit @code{A} will depend on the body of
2402 @code{C}, in file @file{c.adb}.
2403
2404 The set of dependent files described by these rules includes all the
2405 files on which the unit is semantically dependent, as dictated by the
2406 Ada language standard. However, it is a superset of what the
2407 standard describes, because it includes generic, inline, and subunit
2408 dependencies.
2409
2410 An object file must be recreated by recompiling the corresponding source
2411 file if any of the source files on which it depends are modified. For
2412 example, if the @code{make} utility is used to control compilation,
2413 the rule for an Ada object file must mention all the source files on
2414 which the object file depends, according to the above definition.
2415 The determination of the necessary
2416 recompilations is done automatically when one uses @command{gnatmake}.
2417 @end itemize
2418
2419 @node The Ada Library Information Files
2420 @section The Ada Library Information Files
2421 @cindex Ada Library Information files
2422 @cindex @file{ALI} files
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 Each compilation actually generates two output files. The first of these
2426 is the normal object file that has a @file{.o} extension. The second is a
2427 text file containing full dependency information. It has the same
2428 name as the source file, but an @file{.ali} extension.
2429 This file is known as the Ada Library Information (@file{ALI}) file.
2430 The following information is contained in the @file{ALI} file.
2431
2432 @itemize @bullet
2433 @item
2434 Version information (indicates which version of GNAT was used to compile
2435 the unit(s) in question)
2436
2437 @item
2438 Main program information (including priority and time slice settings,
2439 as well as the wide character encoding used during compilation).
2440
2441 @item
2442 List of arguments used in the @command{gcc} command for the compilation
2443
2444 @item
2445 Attributes of the unit, including configuration pragmas used, an indication
2446 of whether the compilation was successful, exception model used etc.
2447
2448 @item
2449 A list of relevant restrictions applying to the unit (used for consistency)
2450 checking.
2451
2452 @item
2453 Categorization information (e.g.@: use of pragma @code{Pure}).
2454
2455 @item
2456 Information on all @code{with}'ed units, including presence of
2457 @code{Elaborate} or @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas.
2458
2459 @item
2460 Information from any @code{Linker_Options} pragmas used in the unit
2461
2462 @item
2463 Information on the use of @code{Body_Version} or @code{Version}
2464 attributes in the unit.
2465
2466 @item
2467 Dependency information. This is a list of files, together with
2468 time stamp and checksum information. These are files on which
2469 the unit depends in the sense that recompilation is required
2470 if any of these units are modified.
2471
2472 @item
2473 Cross-reference data. Contains information on all entities referenced
2474 in the unit. Used by tools like @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind} to
2475 provide cross-reference information.
2476
2477 @end itemize
2478
2479 @noindent
2480 For a full detailed description of the format of the @file{ALI} file,
2481 see the source of the body of unit @code{Lib.Writ}, contained in file
2482 @file{lib-writ.adb} in the GNAT compiler sources.
2483
2484 @node Binding an Ada Program
2485 @section Binding an Ada Program
2486
2487 @noindent
2488 When using languages such as C and C++, once the source files have been
2489 compiled the only remaining step in building an executable program
2490 is linking the object modules together. This means that it is possible to
2491 link an inconsistent version of a program, in which two units have
2492 included different versions of the same header.
2493
2494 The rules of Ada do not permit such an inconsistent program to be built.
2495 For example, if two clients have different versions of the same package,
2496 it is illegal to build a program containing these two clients.
2497 These rules are enforced by the GNAT binder, which also determines an
2498 elaboration order consistent with the Ada rules.
2499
2500 The GNAT binder is run after all the object files for a program have
2501 been created. It is given the name of the main program unit, and from
2502 this it determines the set of units required by the program, by reading the
2503 corresponding ALI files. It generates error messages if the program is
2504 inconsistent or if no valid order of elaboration exists.
2505
2506 If no errors are detected, the binder produces a main program, in Ada by
2507 default, that contains calls to the elaboration procedures of those
2508 compilation unit that require them, followed by
2509 a call to the main program. This Ada program is compiled to generate the
2510 object file for the main program. The name of
2511 the Ada file is @file{b~@var{xxx}.adb} (with the corresponding spec
2512 @file{b~@var{xxx}.ads}) where @var{xxx} is the name of the
2513 main program unit.
2514
2515 Finally, the linker is used to build the resulting executable program,
2516 using the object from the main program from the bind step as well as the
2517 object files for the Ada units of the program.
2518
2519 @node Mixed Language Programming
2520 @section Mixed Language Programming
2521 @cindex Mixed Language Programming
2522
2523 @noindent
2524 This section describes how to develop a mixed-language program,
2525 specifically one that comprises units in both Ada and C.
2526
2527 @menu
2528 * Interfacing to C::
2529 * Calling Conventions::
2530 @end menu
2531
2532 @node Interfacing to C
2533 @subsection Interfacing to C
2534 @noindent
2535 Interfacing Ada with a foreign language such as C involves using
2536 compiler directives to import and/or export entity definitions in each
2537 language---using @code{extern} statements in C, for instance, and the
2538 @code{Import}, @code{Export}, and @code{Convention} pragmas in Ada.
2539 A full treatment of these topics is provided in Appendix B, section 1
2540 of the Ada Reference Manual.
2541
2542 There are two ways to build a program using GNAT that contains some Ada
2543 sources and some foreign language sources, depending on whether or not
2544 the main subprogram is written in Ada. Here is a source example with
2545 the main subprogram in Ada:
2546
2547 @smallexample
2548 /* file1.c */
2549 #include <stdio.h>
2550
2551 void print_num (int num)
2552 @{
2553 printf ("num is %d.\n", num);
2554 return;
2555 @}
2556
2557 /* file2.c */
2558
2559 /* num_from_Ada is declared in my_main.adb */
2560 extern int num_from_Ada;
2561
2562 int get_num (void)
2563 @{
2564 return num_from_Ada;
2565 @}
2566 @end smallexample
2567
2568 @smallexample @c ada
2569 -- my_main.adb
2570 procedure My_Main is
2571
2572 -- Declare then export an Integer entity called num_from_Ada
2573 My_Num : Integer := 10;
2574 pragma Export (C, My_Num, "num_from_Ada");
2575
2576 -- Declare an Ada function spec for Get_Num, then use
2577 -- C function get_num for the implementation.
2578 function Get_Num return Integer;
2579 pragma Import (C, Get_Num, "get_num");
2580
2581 -- Declare an Ada procedure spec for Print_Num, then use
2582 -- C function print_num for the implementation.
2583 procedure Print_Num (Num : Integer);
2584 pragma Import (C, Print_Num, "print_num");
2585
2586 begin
2587 Print_Num (Get_Num);
2588 end My_Main;
2589 @end smallexample
2590
2591 @enumerate
2592 @item
2593 To build this example, first compile the foreign language files to
2594 generate object files:
2595 @smallexample
2596 ^gcc -c file1.c^gcc -c FILE1.C^
2597 ^gcc -c file2.c^gcc -c FILE2.C^
2598 @end smallexample
2599
2600 @item
2601 Then, compile the Ada units to produce a set of object files and ALI
2602 files:
2603 @smallexample
2604 gnatmake ^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^ my_main.adb
2605 @end smallexample
2606
2607 @item
2608 Run the Ada binder on the Ada main program:
2609 @smallexample
2610 gnatbind my_main.ali
2611 @end smallexample
2612
2613 @item
2614 Link the Ada main program, the Ada objects and the other language
2615 objects:
2616 @smallexample
2617 gnatlink my_main.ali file1.o file2.o
2618 @end smallexample
2619 @end enumerate
2620
2621 The last three steps can be grouped in a single command:
2622 @smallexample
2623 gnatmake my_main.adb -largs file1.o file2.o
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 @cindex Binder output file
2627 @noindent
2628 If the main program is in a language other than Ada, then you may have
2629 more than one entry point into the Ada subsystem. You must use a special
2630 binder option to generate callable routines that initialize and
2631 finalize the Ada units (@pxref{Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs}).
2632 Calls to the initialization and finalization routines must be inserted
2633 in the main program, or some other appropriate point in the code. The
2634 call to initialize the Ada units must occur before the first Ada
2635 subprogram is called, and the call to finalize the Ada units must occur
2636 after the last Ada subprogram returns. The binder will place the
2637 initialization and finalization subprograms into the
2638 @file{b~@var{xxx}.adb} file where they can be accessed by your C
2639 sources. To illustrate, we have the following example:
2640
2641 @smallexample
2642 /* main.c */
2643 extern void adainit (void);
2644 extern void adafinal (void);
2645 extern int add (int, int);
2646 extern int sub (int, int);
2647
2648 int main (int argc, char *argv[])
2649 @{
2650 int a = 21, b = 7;
2651
2652 adainit();
2653
2654 /* Should print "21 + 7 = 28" */
2655 printf ("%d + %d = %d\n", a, b, add (a, b));
2656 /* Should print "21 - 7 = 14" */
2657 printf ("%d - %d = %d\n", a, b, sub (a, b));
2658
2659 adafinal();
2660 @}
2661 @end smallexample
2662
2663 @smallexample @c ada
2664 -- unit1.ads
2665 package Unit1 is
2666 function Add (A, B : Integer) return Integer;
2667 pragma Export (C, Add, "add");
2668 end Unit1;
2669
2670 -- unit1.adb
2671 package body Unit1 is
2672 function Add (A, B : Integer) return Integer is
2673 begin
2674 return A + B;
2675 end Add;
2676 end Unit1;
2677
2678 -- unit2.ads
2679 package Unit2 is
2680 function Sub (A, B : Integer) return Integer;
2681 pragma Export (C, Sub, "sub");
2682 end Unit2;
2683
2684 -- unit2.adb
2685 package body Unit2 is
2686 function Sub (A, B : Integer) return Integer is
2687 begin
2688 return A - B;
2689 end Sub;
2690 end Unit2;
2691 @end smallexample
2692
2693 @enumerate
2694 @item
2695 The build procedure for this application is similar to the last
2696 example's. First, compile the foreign language files to generate object
2697 files:
2698 @smallexample
2699 ^gcc -c main.c^gcc -c main.c^
2700 @end smallexample
2701
2702 @item
2703 Next, compile the Ada units to produce a set of object files and ALI
2704 files:
2705 @smallexample
2706 gnatmake ^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^ unit1.adb
2707 gnatmake ^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^ unit2.adb
2708 @end smallexample
2709
2710 @item
2711 Run the Ada binder on every generated ALI file. Make sure to use the
2712 @option{-n} option to specify a foreign main program:
2713 @smallexample
2714 gnatbind ^-n^/NOMAIN^ unit1.ali unit2.ali
2715 @end smallexample
2716
2717 @item
2718 Link the Ada main program, the Ada objects and the foreign language
2719 objects. You need only list the last ALI file here:
2720 @smallexample
2721 gnatlink unit2.ali main.o -o exec_file
2722 @end smallexample
2723
2724 This procedure yields a binary executable called @file{exec_file}.
2725 @end enumerate
2726
2727 @noindent
2728 Depending on the circumstances (for example when your non-Ada main object
2729 does not provide symbol @code{main}), you may also need to instruct the
2730 GNAT linker not to include the standard startup objects by passing the
2731 @option{^-nostartfiles^/NOSTART_FILES^} switch to @command{gnatlink}.
2732
2733 @node Calling Conventions
2734 @subsection Calling Conventions
2735 @cindex Foreign Languages
2736 @cindex Calling Conventions
2737 GNAT follows standard calling sequence conventions and will thus interface
2738 to any other language that also follows these conventions. The following
2739 Convention identifiers are recognized by GNAT:
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @cindex Interfacing to Ada
2743 @cindex Other Ada compilers
2744 @cindex Convention Ada
2745 @item Ada
2746 This indicates that the standard Ada calling sequence will be
2747 used and all Ada data items may be passed without any limitations in the
2748 case where GNAT is used to generate both the caller and callee. It is also
2749 possible to mix GNAT generated code and code generated by another Ada
2750 compiler. In this case, the data types should be restricted to simple
2751 cases, including primitive types. Whether complex data types can be passed
2752 depends on the situation. Probably it is safe to pass simple arrays, such
2753 as arrays of integers or floats. Records may or may not work, depending
2754 on whether both compilers lay them out identically. Complex structures
2755 involving variant records, access parameters, tasks, or protected types,
2756 are unlikely to be able to be passed.
2757
2758 Note that in the case of GNAT running
2759 on a platform that supports HP Ada 83, a higher degree of compatibility
2760 can be guaranteed, and in particular records are layed out in an identical
2761 manner in the two compilers. Note also that if output from two different
2762 compilers is mixed, the program is responsible for dealing with elaboration
2763 issues. Probably the safest approach is to write the main program in the
2764 version of Ada other than GNAT, so that it takes care of its own elaboration
2765 requirements, and then call the GNAT-generated adainit procedure to ensure
2766 elaboration of the GNAT components. Consult the documentation of the other
2767 Ada compiler for further details on elaboration.
2768
2769 However, it is not possible to mix the tasking run time of GNAT and
2770 HP Ada 83, All the tasking operations must either be entirely within
2771 GNAT compiled sections of the program, or entirely within HP Ada 83
2772 compiled sections of the program.
2773
2774 @cindex Interfacing to Assembly
2775 @cindex Convention Assembler
2776 @item Assembler
2777 Specifies assembler as the convention. In practice this has the
2778 same effect as convention Ada (but is not equivalent in the sense of being
2779 considered the same convention).
2780
2781 @cindex Convention Asm
2782 @findex Asm
2783 @item Asm
2784 Equivalent to Assembler.
2785
2786 @cindex Interfacing to COBOL
2787 @cindex Convention COBOL
2788 @findex COBOL
2789 @item COBOL
2790 Data will be passed according to the conventions described
2791 in section B.4 of the Ada Reference Manual.
2792
2793 @findex C
2794 @cindex Interfacing to C
2795 @cindex Convention C
2796 @item C
2797 Data will be passed according to the conventions described
2798 in section B.3 of the Ada Reference Manual.
2799
2800 A note on interfacing to a C ``varargs'' function:
2801 @findex C varargs function
2802 @cindex Interfacing to C varargs function
2803 @cindex varargs function interfaces
2804
2805 @itemize @bullet
2806 @item
2807 In C, @code{varargs} allows a function to take a variable number of
2808 arguments. There is no direct equivalent in this to Ada. One
2809 approach that can be used is to create a C wrapper for each
2810 different profile and then interface to this C wrapper. For
2811 example, to print an @code{int} value using @code{printf},
2812 create a C function @code{printfi} that takes two arguments, a
2813 pointer to a string and an int, and calls @code{printf}.
2814 Then in the Ada program, use pragma @code{Import} to
2815 interface to @code{printfi}.
2816
2817 @item
2818 It may work on some platforms to directly interface to
2819 a @code{varargs} function by providing a specific Ada profile
2820 for a particular call. However, this does not work on
2821 all platforms, since there is no guarantee that the
2822 calling sequence for a two argument normal C function
2823 is the same as for calling a @code{varargs} C function with
2824 the same two arguments.
2825 @end itemize
2826
2827 @cindex Convention Default
2828 @findex Default
2829 @item Default
2830 Equivalent to C.
2831
2832 @cindex Convention External
2833 @findex External
2834 @item External
2835 Equivalent to C.
2836
2837 @ifclear vms
2838 @findex C++
2839 @cindex Interfacing to C++
2840 @cindex Convention C++
2841 @item C_Plus_Plus (or CPP)
2842 This stands for C++. For most purposes this is identical to C.
2843 See the separate description of the specialized GNAT pragmas relating to
2844 C++ interfacing for further details.
2845 @end ifclear
2846
2847 @findex Fortran
2848 @cindex Interfacing to Fortran
2849 @cindex Convention Fortran
2850 @item Fortran
2851 Data will be passed according to the conventions described
2852 in section B.5 of the Ada Reference Manual.
2853
2854 @item Intrinsic
2855 This applies to an intrinsic operation, as defined in the Ada
2856 Reference Manual. If a pragma Import (Intrinsic) applies to a subprogram,
2857 this means that the body of the subprogram is provided by the compiler itself,
2858 usually by means of an efficient code sequence, and that the user does not
2859 supply an explicit body for it. In an application program, the pragma may
2860 be applied to the following sets of names:
2861
2862 @itemize @bullet
2863 @item
2864 Rotate_Left, Rotate_Right, Shift_Left, Shift_Right,
2865 Shift_Right_Arithmetic. The corresponding subprogram declaration must have
2866 two formal parameters. The
2867 first one must be a signed integer type or a modular type with a binary
2868 modulus, and the second parameter must be of type Natural.
2869 The return type must be the same as the type of the first argument. The size
2870 of this type can only be 8, 16, 32, or 64.
2871
2872 @item
2873 Binary arithmetic operators: ``+'', ``-'', ``*'', ``/''
2874 The corresponding operator declaration must have parameters and result type
2875 that have the same root numeric type (for example, all three are long_float
2876 types). This simplifies the definition of operations that use type checking
2877 to perform dimensional checks:
2878
2879 @smallexample @c ada
2880 type Distance is new Long_Float;
2881 type Time is new Long_Float;
2882 type Velocity is new Long_Float;
2883 function "/" (D : Distance; T : Time)
2884 return Velocity;
2885 pragma Import (Intrinsic, "/");
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 This common idiom is often programmed with a generic definition and an
2890 explicit body. The pragma makes it simpler to introduce such declarations.
2891 It incurs no overhead in compilation time or code size, because it is
2892 implemented as a single machine instruction.
2893
2894 @item
2895 General subprogram entities, to bind an Ada subprogram declaration to
2896 a compiler builtin by name with back-ends where such interfaces are
2897 available. A typical example is the set of ``__builtin'' functions
2898 exposed by the GCC back-end, as in the following example:
2899
2900 @smallexample @c ada
2901 function builtin_sqrt (F : Float) return Float;
2902 pragma Import (Intrinsic, builtin_sqrt, "__builtin_sqrtf");
2903 @end smallexample
2904
2905 Most of the GCC builtins are accessible this way, and as for other
2906 import conventions (e.g. C), it is the user's responsibility to ensure
2907 that the Ada subprogram profile matches the underlying builtin
2908 expectations.
2909 @end itemize
2910
2911 @noindent
2912
2913 @ifset unw
2914 @findex Stdcall
2915 @cindex Convention Stdcall
2916 @item Stdcall
2917 This is relevant only to Windows XP/2000/NT implementations of GNAT,
2918 and specifies that the @code{Stdcall} calling sequence will be used,
2919 as defined by the NT API. Nevertheless, to ease building
2920 cross-platform bindings this convention will be handled as a @code{C} calling
2921 convention on non-Windows platforms.
2922
2923 @findex DLL
2924 @cindex Convention DLL
2925 @item DLL
2926 This is equivalent to @code{Stdcall}.
2927
2928 @findex Win32
2929 @cindex Convention Win32
2930 @item Win32
2931 This is equivalent to @code{Stdcall}.
2932 @end ifset
2933
2934 @findex Stubbed
2935 @cindex Convention Stubbed
2936 @item Stubbed
2937 This is a special convention that indicates that the compiler
2938 should provide a stub body that raises @code{Program_Error}.
2939 @end table
2940
2941 @noindent
2942 GNAT additionally provides a useful pragma @code{Convention_Identifier}
2943 that can be used to parametrize conventions and allow additional synonyms
2944 to be specified. For example if you have legacy code in which the convention
2945 identifier Fortran77 was used for Fortran, you can use the configuration
2946 pragma:
2947
2948 @smallexample @c ada
2949 pragma Convention_Identifier (Fortran77, Fortran);
2950 @end smallexample
2951
2952 @noindent
2953 And from now on the identifier Fortran77 may be used as a convention
2954 identifier (for example in an @code{Import} pragma) with the same
2955 meaning as Fortran.
2956
2957 @ifclear vms
2958 @node Building Mixed Ada & C++ Programs
2959 @section Building Mixed Ada and C++ Programs
2960
2961 @noindent
2962 A programmer inexperienced with mixed-language development may find that
2963 building an application containing both Ada and C++ code can be a
2964 challenge. This section gives a few
2965 hints that should make this task easier. The first section addresses
2966 the differences between interfacing with C and interfacing with C++.
2967 The second section
2968 looks into the delicate problem of linking the complete application from
2969 its Ada and C++ parts. The last section gives some hints on how the GNAT
2970 run-time library can be adapted in order to allow inter-language dispatching
2971 with a new C++ compiler.
2972
2973 @menu
2974 * Interfacing to C++::
2975 * Linking a Mixed C++ & Ada Program::
2976 * A Simple Example::
2977 * Interfacing with C++ at the Class Level::
2978 @end menu
2979
2980 @node Interfacing to C++
2981 @subsection Interfacing to C++
2982
2983 @noindent
2984 GNAT supports interfacing with the G++ compiler (or any C++ compiler
2985 generating code that is compatible with the G++ Application Binary
2986 Interface ---see http://www.codesourcery.com/archives/cxx-abi).
2987
2988 @noindent
2989 Interfacing can be done at 3 levels: simple data, subprograms, and
2990 classes. In the first two cases, GNAT offers a specific @code{Convention
2991 C_Plus_Plus} (or @code{CPP}) that behaves exactly like @code{Convention C}.
2992 Usually, C++ mangles the names of subprograms, and currently, GNAT does
2993 not provide any help to solve the demangling problem. This problem can be
2994 addressed in two ways:
2995 @itemize @bullet
2996 @item
2997 by modifying the C++ code in order to force a C convention using
2998 the @code{extern "C"} syntax.
2999
3000 @item
3001 by figuring out the mangled name and use it as the Link_Name argument of
3002 the pragma import.
3003 @end itemize
3004
3005 @noindent
3006 Interfacing at the class level can be achieved by using the GNAT specific
3007 pragmas such as @code{CPP_Constructor}. @xref{Interfacing to C++,,,
3008 gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}, for additional information.
3009
3010 @node Linking a Mixed C++ & Ada Program
3011 @subsection Linking a Mixed C++ & Ada Program
3012
3013 @noindent
3014 Usually the linker of the C++ development system must be used to link
3015 mixed applications because most C++ systems will resolve elaboration
3016 issues (such as calling constructors on global class instances)
3017 transparently during the link phase. GNAT has been adapted to ease the
3018 use of a foreign linker for the last phase. Three cases can be
3019 considered:
3020 @enumerate
3021
3022 @item
3023 Using GNAT and G++ (GNU C++ compiler) from the same GCC installation:
3024 The C++ linker can simply be called by using the C++ specific driver
3025 called @code{c++}. Note that this setup is not very common because it
3026 may involve recompiling the whole GCC tree from sources, which makes it
3027 harder to upgrade the compilation system for one language without
3028 destabilizing the other.
3029
3030 @smallexample
3031 $ c++ -c file1.C
3032 $ c++ -c file2.C
3033 $ gnatmake ada_unit -largs file1.o file2.o --LINK=c++
3034 @end smallexample
3035
3036 @item
3037 Using GNAT and G++ from two different GCC installations: If both
3038 compilers are on the @env{PATH}, the previous method may be used. It is
3039 important to note that environment variables such as
3040 @env{C_INCLUDE_PATH}, @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, @env{BINUTILS_ROOT}, and
3041 @env{GCC_ROOT} will affect both compilers
3042 at the same time and may make one of the two compilers operate
3043 improperly if set during invocation of the wrong compiler. It is also
3044 very important that the linker uses the proper @file{libgcc.a} GCC
3045 library -- that is, the one from the C++ compiler installation. The
3046 implicit link command as suggested in the @command{gnatmake} command
3047 from the former example can be replaced by an explicit link command with
3048 the full-verbosity option in order to verify which library is used:
3049 @smallexample
3050 $ gnatbind ada_unit
3051 $ gnatlink -v -v ada_unit file1.o file2.o --LINK=c++
3052 @end smallexample
3053 If there is a problem due to interfering environment variables, it can
3054 be worked around by using an intermediate script. The following example
3055 shows the proper script to use when GNAT has not been installed at its
3056 default location and g++ has been installed at its default location:
3057
3058 @smallexample
3059 $ cat ./my_script
3060 #!/bin/sh
3061 unset BINUTILS_ROOT
3062 unset GCC_ROOT
3063 c++ $*
3064 $ gnatlink -v -v ada_unit file1.o file2.o --LINK=./my_script
3065 @end smallexample
3066
3067 @item
3068 Using a non-GNU C++ compiler: The commands previously described can be
3069 used to insure that the C++ linker is used. Nonetheless, you need to add
3070 a few more parameters to the link command line, depending on the exception
3071 mechanism used.
3072
3073 If the @code{setjmp/longjmp} exception mechanism is used, only the paths
3074 to the libgcc libraries are required:
3075
3076 @smallexample
3077 $ cat ./my_script
3078 #!/bin/sh
3079 CC $* `gcc -print-file-name=libgcc.a` `gcc -print-file-name=libgcc_eh.a`
3080 $ gnatlink ada_unit file1.o file2.o --LINK=./my_script
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 Where CC is the name of the non-GNU C++ compiler.
3084
3085 If the @code{zero cost} exception mechanism is used, and the platform
3086 supports automatic registration of exception tables (e.g.@: Solaris or IRIX),
3087 paths to more objects are required:
3088
3089 @smallexample
3090 $ cat ./my_script
3091 #!/bin/sh
3092 CC `gcc -print-file-name=crtbegin.o` $* \
3093 `gcc -print-file-name=libgcc.a` `gcc -print-file-name=libgcc_eh.a` \
3094 `gcc -print-file-name=crtend.o`
3095 $ gnatlink ada_unit file1.o file2.o --LINK=./my_script
3096 @end smallexample
3097
3098 If the @code{zero cost} exception mechanism is used, and the platform
3099 doesn't support automatic registration of exception tables (e.g.@: HP-UX,
3100 Tru64 or AIX), the simple approach described above will not work and
3101 a pre-linking phase using GNAT will be necessary.
3102
3103 @end enumerate
3104
3105 @node A Simple Example
3106 @subsection A Simple Example
3107 @noindent
3108 The following example, provided as part of the GNAT examples, shows how
3109 to achieve procedural interfacing between Ada and C++ in both
3110 directions. The C++ class A has two methods. The first method is exported
3111 to Ada by the means of an extern C wrapper function. The second method
3112 calls an Ada subprogram. On the Ada side, The C++ calls are modelled by
3113 a limited record with a layout comparable to the C++ class. The Ada
3114 subprogram, in turn, calls the C++ method. So, starting from the C++
3115 main program, the process passes back and forth between the two
3116 languages.
3117
3118 @noindent
3119 Here are the compilation commands:
3120 @smallexample
3121 $ gnatmake -c simple_cpp_interface
3122 $ c++ -c cpp_main.C
3123 $ c++ -c ex7.C
3124 $ gnatbind -n simple_cpp_interface
3125 $ gnatlink simple_cpp_interface -o cpp_main --LINK=$(CPLUSPLUS)
3126 -lstdc++ ex7.o cpp_main.o
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @noindent
3130 Here are the corresponding sources:
3131 @smallexample
3132
3133 //cpp_main.C
3134
3135 #include "ex7.h"
3136
3137 extern "C" @{
3138 void adainit (void);
3139 void adafinal (void);
3140 void method1 (A *t);
3141 @}
3142
3143 void method1 (A *t)
3144 @{
3145 t->method1 ();
3146 @}
3147
3148 int main ()
3149 @{
3150 A obj;
3151 adainit ();
3152 obj.method2 (3030);
3153 adafinal ();
3154 @}
3155
3156 //ex7.h
3157
3158 class Origin @{
3159 public:
3160 int o_value;
3161 @};
3162 class A : public Origin @{
3163 public:
3164 void method1 (void);
3165 void method2 (int v);
3166 A();
3167 int a_value;
3168 @};
3169
3170 //ex7.C
3171
3172 #include "ex7.h"
3173 #include <stdio.h>
3174
3175 extern "C" @{ void ada_method2 (A *t, int v);@}
3176
3177 void A::method1 (void)
3178 @{
3179 a_value = 2020;
3180 printf ("in A::method1, a_value = %d \n",a_value);
3181
3182 @}
3183
3184 void A::method2 (int v)
3185 @{
3186 ada_method2 (this, v);
3187 printf ("in A::method2, a_value = %d \n",a_value);
3188
3189 @}
3190
3191 A::A(void)
3192 @{
3193 a_value = 1010;
3194 printf ("in A::A, a_value = %d \n",a_value);
3195 @}
3196 @end smallexample
3197
3198 @smallexample @c ada
3199 -- Ada sources
3200 package body Simple_Cpp_Interface is
3201
3202 procedure Ada_Method2 (This : in out A; V : Integer) is
3203 begin
3204 Method1 (This);
3205 This.A_Value := V;
3206 end Ada_Method2;
3207
3208 end Simple_Cpp_Interface;
3209
3210 with System;
3211 package Simple_Cpp_Interface is
3212 type A is limited
3213 record
3214 Vptr : System.Address;
3215 O_Value : Integer;
3216 A_Value : Integer;
3217 end record;
3218 pragma Convention (C, A);
3219
3220 procedure Method1 (This : in out A);
3221 pragma Import (C, Method1);
3222
3223 procedure Ada_Method2 (This : in out A; V : Integer);
3224 pragma Export (C, Ada_Method2);
3225
3226 end Simple_Cpp_Interface;
3227 @end smallexample
3228
3229 @node Interfacing with C++ at the Class Level
3230 @subsection Interfacing with C++ at the Class Level
3231 @noindent
3232 In this section we demonstrate the GNAT features for interfacing with
3233 C++ by means of an example making use of Ada 2005 abstract interface
3234 types. This example consists of a classification of animals; classes
3235 have been used to model our main classification of animals, and
3236 interfaces provide support for the management of secondary
3237 classifications. We first demonstrate a case in which the types and
3238 constructors are defined on the C++ side and imported from the Ada
3239 side, and latter the reverse case.
3240
3241 The root of our derivation will be the @code{Animal} class, with a
3242 single private attribute (the @code{Age} of the animal) and two public
3243 primitives to set and get the value of this attribute.
3244
3245 @smallexample
3246 @b{class} Animal @{
3247 @b{public}:
3248 @b{virtual} void Set_Age (int New_Age);
3249 @b{virtual} int Age ();
3250 @b{private}:
3251 int Age_Count;
3252 @};
3253 @end smallexample
3254
3255 Abstract interface types are defined in C++ by means of classes with pure
3256 virtual functions and no data members. In our example we will use two
3257 interfaces that provide support for the common management of @code{Carnivore}
3258 and @code{Domestic} animals:
3259
3260 @smallexample
3261 @b{class} Carnivore @{
3262 @b{public}:
3263 @b{virtual} int Number_Of_Teeth () = 0;
3264 @};
3265
3266 @b{class} Domestic @{
3267 @b{public}:
3268 @b{virtual void} Set_Owner (char* Name) = 0;
3269 @};
3270 @end smallexample
3271
3272 Using these declarations, we can now say that a @code{Dog} is an animal that is
3273 both Carnivore and Domestic, that is:
3274
3275 @smallexample
3276 @b{class} Dog : Animal, Carnivore, Domestic @{
3277 @b{public}:
3278 @b{virtual} int Number_Of_Teeth ();
3279 @b{virtual} void Set_Owner (char* Name);
3280
3281 Dog(); // Constructor
3282 @b{private}:
3283 int Tooth_Count;
3284 char *Owner;
3285 @};
3286 @end smallexample
3287
3288 In the following examples we will assume that the previous declarations are
3289 located in a file named @code{animals.h}. The following package demonstrates
3290 how to import these C++ declarations from the Ada side:
3291
3292 @smallexample @c ada
3293 with Interfaces.C.Strings; use Interfaces.C.Strings;
3294 package Animals is
3295 type Carnivore is interface;
3296 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Carnivore);
3297 function Number_Of_Teeth (X : Carnivore)
3298 return Natural is abstract;
3299
3300 type Domestic is interface;
3301 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Owner);
3302 procedure Set_Owner
3303 (X : in out Domestic;
3304 Name : Chars_Ptr) is abstract;
3305
3306 type Animal is tagged record
3307 Age : Natural := 0;
3308 end record;
3309 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Animal);
3310
3311 procedure Set_Age (X : in out Animal; Age : Integer);
3312 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Age);
3313
3314 function Age (X : Animal) return Integer;
3315 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Age);
3316
3317 type Dog is new Animal and Carnivore and Domestic with record
3318 Tooth_Count : Natural;
3319 Owner : String (1 .. 30);
3320 end record;
3321 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Dog);
3322
3323 function Number_Of_Teeth (A : Dog) return Integer;
3324 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Number_Of_Teeth);
3325
3326 procedure Set_Owner (A : in out Dog; Name : Chars_Ptr);
3327 pragma Import (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Owner);
3328
3329 function New_Dog return Dog'Class;
3330 pragma CPP_Constructor (New_Dog);
3331 pragma Import (CPP, New_Dog, "_ZN3DogC2Ev");
3332 end Animals;
3333 @end smallexample
3334
3335 Thanks to the compatibility between GNAT run-time structures and the C++ ABI,
3336 interfacing with these C++ classes is easy. The only requirement is that all
3337 the primitives and components must be declared exactly in the same order in
3338 the two languages.
3339
3340 Regarding the abstract interfaces, we must indicate to the GNAT compiler by
3341 means of a @code{pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus)}, the convention used to pass
3342 the arguments to the called primitives will be the same as for C++. For the
3343 imported classes we use @code{pragma Import} with convention @code{C_Plus_Plus}
3344 to indicate that they have been defined on the C++ side; this is required
3345 because the dispatch table associated with these tagged types will be built
3346 in the C++ side and therefore will not contain the predefined Ada primitives
3347 which Ada would otherwise expect.
3348
3349 As the reader can see there is no need to indicate the C++ mangled names
3350 associated with each subprogram because it is assumed that all the calls to
3351 these primitives will be dispatching calls. The only exception is the
3352 constructor, which must be registered with the compiler by means of
3353 @code{pragma CPP_Constructor} and needs to provide its associated C++
3354 mangled name because the Ada compiler generates direct calls to it.
3355
3356 With the above packages we can now declare objects of type Dog on the Ada side
3357 and dispatch calls to the corresponding subprograms on the C++ side. We can
3358 also extend the tagged type Dog with further fields and primitives, and
3359 override some of its C++ primitives on the Ada side. For example, here we have
3360 a type derivation defined on the Ada side that inherits all the dispatching
3361 primitives of the ancestor from the C++ side.
3362
3363 @smallexample
3364 @b{with} Animals; @b{use} Animals;
3365 @b{package} Vaccinated_Animals @b{is}
3366 @b{type} Vaccinated_Dog @b{is new} Dog @b{with null record};
3367 @b{function} Vaccination_Expired (A : Vaccinated_Dog) @b{return} Boolean;
3368 @b{end} Vaccinated_Animals;
3369 @end smallexample
3370
3371 It is important to note that, because of the ABI compatibility, the programmer
3372 does not need to add any further information to indicate either the object
3373 layout or the dispatch table entry associated with each dispatching operation.
3374
3375 Now let us define all the types and constructors on the Ada side and export
3376 them to C++, using the same hierarchy of our previous example:
3377
3378 @smallexample @c ada
3379 with Interfaces.C.Strings;
3380 use Interfaces.C.Strings;
3381 package Animals is
3382 type Carnivore is interface;
3383 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Carnivore);
3384 function Number_Of_Teeth (X : Carnivore)
3385 return Natural is abstract;
3386
3387 type Domestic is interface;
3388 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Owner);
3389 procedure Set_Owner
3390 (X : in out Domestic;
3391 Name : Chars_Ptr) is abstract;
3392
3393 type Animal is tagged record
3394 Age : Natural := 0;
3395 end record;
3396 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Animal);
3397
3398 procedure Set_Age (X : in out Animal; Age : Integer);
3399 pragma Export (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Age);
3400
3401 function Age (X : Animal) return Integer;
3402 pragma Export (C_Plus_Plus, Age);
3403
3404 type Dog is new Animal and Carnivore and Domestic with record
3405 Tooth_Count : Natural;
3406 Owner : String (1 .. 30);
3407 end record;
3408 pragma Convention (C_Plus_Plus, Dog);
3409
3410 function Number_Of_Teeth (A : Dog) return Integer;
3411 pragma Export (C_Plus_Plus, Number_Of_Teeth);
3412
3413 procedure Set_Owner (A : in out Dog; Name : Chars_Ptr);
3414 pragma Export (C_Plus_Plus, Set_Owner);
3415
3416 function New_Dog return Dog'Class;
3417 pragma Export (C_Plus_Plus, New_Dog);
3418 end Animals;
3419 @end smallexample
3420
3421 Compared with our previous example the only difference is the use of
3422 @code{pragma Export} to indicate to the GNAT compiler that the primitives will
3423 be available to C++. Thanks to the ABI compatibility, on the C++ side there is
3424 nothing else to be done; as explained above, the only requirement is that all
3425 the primitives and components are declared in exactly the same order.
3426
3427 For completeness, let us see a brief C++ main program that uses the
3428 declarations available in @code{animals.h} (presented in our first example) to
3429 import and use the declarations from the Ada side, properly initializing and
3430 finalizing the Ada run-time system along the way:
3431
3432 @smallexample
3433 @b{#include} "animals.h"
3434 @b{#include} <iostream>
3435 @b{using namespace} std;
3436
3437 void Check_Carnivore (Carnivore *obj) @{@dots{}@}
3438 void Check_Domestic (Domestic *obj) @{@dots{}@}
3439 void Check_Animal (Animal *obj) @{@dots{}@}
3440 void Check_Dog (Dog *obj) @{@dots{}@}
3441
3442 @b{extern} "C" @{
3443 void adainit (void);
3444 void adafinal (void);
3445 Dog* new_dog ();
3446 @}
3447
3448 void test ()
3449 @{
3450 Dog *obj = new_dog(); // Ada constructor
3451 Check_Carnivore (obj); // Check secondary DT
3452 Check_Domestic (obj); // Check secondary DT
3453 Check_Animal (obj); // Check primary DT
3454 Check_Dog (obj); // Check primary DT
3455 @}
3456
3457 int main ()
3458 @{
3459 adainit (); test(); adafinal ();
3460 return 0;
3461 @}
3462 @end smallexample
3463
3464 @node Comparison between GNAT and C/C++ Compilation Models
3465 @section Comparison between GNAT and C/C++ Compilation Models
3466
3467 @noindent
3468 The GNAT model of compilation is close to the C and C++ models. You can
3469 think of Ada specs as corresponding to header files in C. As in C, you
3470 don't need to compile specs; they are compiled when they are used. The
3471 Ada @code{with} is similar in effect to the @code{#include} of a C
3472 header.
3473
3474 One notable difference is that, in Ada, you may compile specs separately
3475 to check them for semantic and syntactic accuracy. This is not always
3476 possible with C headers because they are fragments of programs that have
3477 less specific syntactic or semantic rules.
3478
3479 The other major difference is the requirement for running the binder,
3480 which performs two important functions. First, it checks for
3481 consistency. In C or C++, the only defense against assembling
3482 inconsistent programs lies outside the compiler, in a makefile, for
3483 example. The binder satisfies the Ada requirement that it be impossible
3484 to construct an inconsistent program when the compiler is used in normal
3485 mode.
3486
3487 @cindex Elaboration order control
3488 The other important function of the binder is to deal with elaboration
3489 issues. There are also elaboration issues in C++ that are handled
3490 automatically. This automatic handling has the advantage of being
3491 simpler to use, but the C++ programmer has no control over elaboration.
3492 Where @code{gnatbind} might complain there was no valid order of
3493 elaboration, a C++ compiler would simply construct a program that
3494 malfunctioned at run time.
3495 @end ifclear
3496
3497 @node Comparison between GNAT and Conventional Ada Library Models
3498 @section Comparison between GNAT and Conventional Ada Library Models
3499
3500 @noindent
3501 This section is intended for Ada programmers who have
3502 used an Ada compiler implementing the traditional Ada library
3503 model, as described in the Ada Reference Manual.
3504
3505 @cindex GNAT library
3506 In GNAT, there is no ``library'' in the normal sense. Instead, the set of
3507 source files themselves acts as the library. Compiling Ada programs does
3508 not generate any centralized information, but rather an object file and
3509 a ALI file, which are of interest only to the binder and linker.
3510 In a traditional system, the compiler reads information not only from
3511 the source file being compiled, but also from the centralized library.
3512 This means that the effect of a compilation depends on what has been
3513 previously compiled. In particular:
3514
3515 @itemize @bullet
3516 @item
3517 When a unit is @code{with}'ed, the unit seen by the compiler corresponds
3518 to the version of the unit most recently compiled into the library.
3519
3520 @item
3521 Inlining is effective only if the necessary body has already been
3522 compiled into the library.
3523
3524 @item
3525 Compiling a unit may obsolete other units in the library.
3526 @end itemize
3527
3528 @noindent
3529 In GNAT, compiling one unit never affects the compilation of any other
3530 units because the compiler reads only source files. Only changes to source
3531 files can affect the results of a compilation. In particular:
3532
3533 @itemize @bullet
3534 @item
3535 When a unit is @code{with}'ed, the unit seen by the compiler corresponds
3536 to the source version of the unit that is currently accessible to the
3537 compiler.
3538
3539 @item
3540 @cindex Inlining
3541 Inlining requires the appropriate source files for the package or
3542 subprogram bodies to be available to the compiler. Inlining is always
3543 effective, independent of the order in which units are complied.
3544
3545 @item
3546 Compiling a unit never affects any other compilations. The editing of
3547 sources may cause previous compilations to be out of date if they
3548 depended on the source file being modified.
3549 @end itemize
3550
3551 @noindent
3552 The most important result of these differences is that order of compilation
3553 is never significant in GNAT. There is no situation in which one is
3554 required to do one compilation before another. What shows up as order of
3555 compilation requirements in the traditional Ada library becomes, in
3556 GNAT, simple source dependencies; in other words, there is only a set
3557 of rules saying what source files must be present when a file is
3558 compiled.
3559
3560 @ifset vms
3561 @node Placement of temporary files
3562 @section Placement of temporary files
3563 @cindex Temporary files (user control over placement)
3564
3565 @noindent
3566 GNAT creates temporary files in the directory designated by the environment
3567 variable @env{TMPDIR}.
3568 (See the HP @emph{C RTL Reference Manual} on the function @code{getenv()}
3569 for detailed information on how environment variables are resolved.
3570 For most users the easiest way to make use of this feature is to simply
3571 define @env{TMPDIR} as a job level logical name).
3572 For example, if you wish to use a Ramdisk (assuming DECRAM is installed)
3573 for compiler temporary files, then you can include something like the
3574 following command in your @file{LOGIN.COM} file:
3575
3576 @smallexample
3577 $ define/job TMPDIR "/disk$scratchram/000000/temp/"
3578 @end smallexample
3579
3580 @noindent
3581 If @env{TMPDIR} is not defined, then GNAT uses the directory designated by
3582 @env{TMP}; if @env{TMP} is not defined, then GNAT uses the directory
3583 designated by @env{TEMP}.
3584 If none of these environment variables are defined then GNAT uses the
3585 directory designated by the logical name @code{SYS$SCRATCH:}
3586 (by default the user's home directory). If all else fails
3587 GNAT uses the current directory for temporary files.
3588 @end ifset
3589
3590 @c *************************
3591 @node Compiling Using gcc
3592 @chapter Compiling Using @command{gcc}
3593
3594 @noindent
3595 This chapter discusses how to compile Ada programs using the @command{gcc}
3596 command. It also describes the set of switches
3597 that can be used to control the behavior of the compiler.
3598 @menu
3599 * Compiling Programs::
3600 * Switches for gcc::
3601 * Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)::
3602 * Order of Compilation Issues::
3603 * Examples::
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Compiling Programs
3607 @section Compiling Programs
3608
3609 @noindent
3610 The first step in creating an executable program is to compile the units
3611 of the program using the @command{gcc} command. You must compile the
3612 following files:
3613
3614 @itemize @bullet
3615 @item
3616 the body file (@file{.adb}) for a library level subprogram or generic
3617 subprogram
3618
3619 @item
3620 the spec file (@file{.ads}) for a library level package or generic
3621 package that has no body
3622
3623 @item
3624 the body file (@file{.adb}) for a library level package
3625 or generic package that has a body
3626
3627 @end itemize
3628
3629 @noindent
3630 You need @emph{not} compile the following files
3631
3632 @itemize @bullet
3633
3634 @item
3635 the spec of a library unit which has a body
3636
3637 @item
3638 subunits
3639 @end itemize
3640
3641 @noindent
3642 because they are compiled as part of compiling related units. GNAT
3643 package specs
3644 when the corresponding body is compiled, and subunits when the parent is
3645 compiled.
3646
3647 @cindex cannot generate code
3648 If you attempt to compile any of these files, you will get one of the
3649 following error messages (where @var{fff} is the name of the file you compiled):
3650
3651 @smallexample
3652 cannot generate code for file @var{fff} (package spec)
3653 to check package spec, use -gnatc
3654
3655 cannot generate code for file @var{fff} (missing subunits)
3656 to check parent unit, use -gnatc
3657
3658 cannot generate code for file @var{fff} (subprogram spec)
3659 to check subprogram spec, use -gnatc
3660
3661 cannot generate code for file @var{fff} (subunit)
3662 to check subunit, use -gnatc
3663 @end smallexample
3664
3665 @noindent
3666 As indicated by the above error messages, if you want to submit
3667 one of these files to the compiler to check for correct semantics
3668 without generating code, then use the @option{-gnatc} switch.
3669
3670 The basic command for compiling a file containing an Ada unit is
3671
3672 @smallexample
3673 $ gcc -c @ovar{switches} @file{file name}
3674 @end smallexample
3675
3676 @noindent
3677 where @var{file name} is the name of the Ada file (usually
3678 having an extension
3679 @file{.ads} for a spec or @file{.adb} for a body).
3680 @ifclear vms
3681 You specify the
3682 @option{-c} switch to tell @command{gcc} to compile, but not link, the file.
3683 @end ifclear
3684 The result of a successful compilation is an object file, which has the
3685 same name as the source file but an extension of @file{.o} and an Ada
3686 Library Information (ALI) file, which also has the same name as the
3687 source file, but with @file{.ali} as the extension. GNAT creates these
3688 two output files in the current directory, but you may specify a source
3689 file in any directory using an absolute or relative path specification
3690 containing the directory information.
3691
3692 @findex gnat1
3693 @command{gcc} is actually a driver program that looks at the extensions of
3694 the file arguments and loads the appropriate compiler. For example, the
3695 GNU C compiler is @file{cc1}, and the Ada compiler is @file{gnat1}.
3696 These programs are in directories known to the driver program (in some
3697 configurations via environment variables you set), but need not be in
3698 your path. The @command{gcc} driver also calls the assembler and any other
3699 utilities needed to complete the generation of the required object
3700 files.
3701
3702 It is possible to supply several file names on the same @command{gcc}
3703 command. This causes @command{gcc} to call the appropriate compiler for
3704 each file. For example, the following command lists three separate
3705 files to be compiled:
3706
3707 @smallexample
3708 $ gcc -c x.adb y.adb z.c
3709 @end smallexample
3710
3711 @noindent
3712 calls @code{gnat1} (the Ada compiler) twice to compile @file{x.adb} and
3713 @file{y.adb}, and @code{cc1} (the C compiler) once to compile @file{z.c}.
3714 The compiler generates three object files @file{x.o}, @file{y.o} and
3715 @file{z.o} and the two ALI files @file{x.ali} and @file{y.ali} from the
3716 Ada compilations. Any switches apply to all the files ^listed,^listed.^
3717 @ifclear vms
3718 except for
3719 @option{-gnat@var{x}} switches, which apply only to Ada compilations.
3720 @end ifclear
3721
3722 @node Switches for gcc
3723 @section Switches for @command{gcc}
3724
3725 @noindent
3726 The @command{gcc} command accepts switches that control the
3727 compilation process. These switches are fully described in this section.
3728 First we briefly list all the switches, in alphabetical order, then we
3729 describe the switches in more detail in functionally grouped sections.
3730
3731 More switches exist for GCC than those documented here, especially
3732 for specific targets. However, their use is not recommended as
3733 they may change code generation in ways that are incompatible with
3734 the Ada run-time library, or can cause inconsistencies between
3735 compilation units.
3736
3737 @menu
3738 * Output and Error Message Control::
3739 * Warning Message Control::
3740 * Debugging and Assertion Control::
3741 * Validity Checking::
3742 * Style Checking::
3743 * Run-Time Checks::
3744 * Using gcc for Syntax Checking::
3745 * Using gcc for Semantic Checking::
3746 * Compiling Different Versions of Ada::
3747 * Character Set Control::
3748 * File Naming Control::
3749 * Subprogram Inlining Control::
3750 * Auxiliary Output Control::
3751 * Debugging Control::
3752 * Exception Handling Control::
3753 * Units to Sources Mapping Files::
3754 * Integrated Preprocessing::
3755 * Code Generation Control::
3756 @ifset vms
3757 * Return Codes::
3758 @end ifset
3759 @end menu
3760
3761 @table @option
3762 @c !sort!
3763 @ifclear vms
3764 @cindex @option{-b} (@command{gcc})
3765 @item -b @var{target}
3766 Compile your program to run on @var{target}, which is the name of a
3767 system configuration. You must have a GNAT cross-compiler built if
3768 @var{target} is not the same as your host system.
3769
3770 @item -B@var{dir}
3771 @cindex @option{-B} (@command{gcc})
3772 Load compiler executables (for example, @code{gnat1}, the Ada compiler)
3773 from @var{dir} instead of the default location. Only use this switch
3774 when multiple versions of the GNAT compiler are available.
3775 @xref{Directory Options,, Options for Directory Search, gcc, Using the
3776 GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for further details. You would normally
3777 use the @option{-b} or @option{-V} switch instead.
3778
3779 @item -c
3780 @cindex @option{-c} (@command{gcc})
3781 Compile. Always use this switch when compiling Ada programs.
3782
3783 Note: for some other languages when using @command{gcc}, notably in
3784 the case of C and C++, it is possible to use
3785 use @command{gcc} without a @option{-c} switch to
3786 compile and link in one step. In the case of GNAT, you
3787 cannot use this approach, because the binder must be run
3788 and @command{gcc} cannot be used to run the GNAT binder.
3789 @end ifclear
3790
3791 @item -fno-inline
3792 @cindex @option{-fno-inline} (@command{gcc})
3793 Suppresses all back-end inlining, even if other optimization or inlining
3794 switches are set.
3795 This includes suppression of inlining that results
3796 from the use of the pragma @code{Inline_Always}.
3797 Any occurrences of pragma @code{Inline} or @code{Inline_Always}
3798 are ignored, and @option{-gnatn} and @option{-gnatN} have no
3799 effect if this switch is present.
3800
3801 @item -fno-inline-functions
3802 @cindex @option{-fno-inline-functions} (@command{gcc})
3803 Suppresses automatic inlining of small subprograms, which is enabled
3804 if @option{-O3} is used.
3805
3806 @item -fno-inline-functions-called-once
3807 @cindex @option{-fno-inline-functions-called-once} (@command{gcc})
3808 Suppresses inlining of subprograms local to the unit and called once
3809 from within it, which is enabled if @option{-O1} is used.
3810
3811 @item -fno-strict-aliasing
3812 @cindex @option{-fno-strict-aliasing} (@command{gcc})
3813 Causes the compiler to avoid assumptions regarding non-aliasing
3814 of objects of different types. See
3815 @ref{Optimization and Strict Aliasing} for details.
3816
3817 @item -fstack-check
3818 @cindex @option{-fstack-check} (@command{gcc})
3819 Activates stack checking.
3820 See @ref{Stack Overflow Checking} for details.
3821
3822 @item -fstack-usage
3823 @cindex @option{-fstack-usage} (@command{gcc})
3824 Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program, on a
3825 per-function basis. See @ref{Static Stack Usage Analysis} for details.
3826
3827 @item -fcallgraph-info@r{[}=su@r{]}
3828 @cindex @option{-fcallgraph-info} (@command{gcc})
3829 Makes the compiler output callgraph information for the program, on a
3830 per-file basis. The information is generated in the VCG format. It can
3831 be decorated with stack-usage per-node information.
3832
3833 @item ^-g^/DEBUG^
3834 @cindex @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} (@command{gcc})
3835 Generate debugging information. This information is stored in the object
3836 file and copied from there to the final executable file by the linker,
3837 where it can be read by the debugger. You must use the
3838 @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch if you plan on using the debugger.
3839
3840 @item -gnat83
3841 @cindex @option{-gnat83} (@command{gcc})
3842 Enforce Ada 83 restrictions.
3843
3844 @item -gnat95
3845 @cindex @option{-gnat95} (@command{gcc})
3846 Enforce Ada 95 restrictions.
3847
3848 @item -gnat05
3849 @cindex @option{-gnat05} (@command{gcc})
3850 Allow full Ada 2005 features.
3851
3852 @item -gnata
3853 @cindex @option{-gnata} (@command{gcc})
3854 Assertions enabled. @code{Pragma Assert} and @code{pragma Debug} to be
3855 activated. Note that these pragmas can also be controlled using the
3856 configuration pragmas @code{Assertion_Policy} and @code{Debug_Policy}.
3857 It also activates pragmas @code{Check}, @code{Precondition}, and
3858 @code{Postcondition}. Note that these pragmas can also be controlled
3859 using the configuration pragma @code{Check_Policy}.
3860
3861 @item -gnatA
3862 @cindex @option{-gnatA} (@command{gcc})
3863 Avoid processing @file{gnat.adc}. If a @file{gnat.adc} file is present,
3864 it will be ignored.
3865
3866 @item -gnatb
3867 @cindex @option{-gnatb} (@command{gcc})
3868 Generate brief messages to @file{stderr} even if verbose mode set.
3869
3870 @item -gnatc
3871 @cindex @option{-gnatc} (@command{gcc})
3872 Check syntax and semantics only (no code generation attempted).
3873
3874 @item -gnatd
3875 @cindex @option{-gnatd} (@command{gcc})
3876 Specify debug options for the compiler. The string of characters after
3877 the @option{-gnatd} specify the specific debug options. The possible
3878 characters are 0-9, a-z, A-Z, optionally preceded by a dot. See
3879 compiler source file @file{debug.adb} for details of the implemented
3880 debug options. Certain debug options are relevant to applications
3881 programmers, and these are documented at appropriate points in this
3882 users guide.
3883
3884 @item -gnatD
3885 @cindex @option{-gnatD} (@command{gcc})
3886 Create expanded source files for source level debugging. This switch
3887 also suppress generation of cross-reference information
3888 (see @option{-gnatx}).
3889
3890 @item -gnatec=@var{path}
3891 @cindex @option{-gnatec} (@command{gcc})
3892 Specify a configuration pragma file
3893 @ifclear vms
3894 (the equal sign is optional)
3895 @end ifclear
3896 (@pxref{The Configuration Pragmas Files}).
3897
3898 @item ^-gnateD^/DATA_PREPROCESSING=^symbol@r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
3899 @cindex @option{-gnateD} (@command{gcc})
3900 Defines a symbol, associated with @var{value}, for preprocessing.
3901 (@pxref{Integrated Preprocessing}).
3902
3903 @item -gnatef
3904 @cindex @option{-gnatef} (@command{gcc})
3905 Display full source path name in brief error messages.
3906
3907 @item -gnateG
3908 @cindex @option{-gnateG} (@command{gcc})
3909 Save result of preprocessing in a text file.
3910
3911 @item -gnatem=@var{path}
3912 @cindex @option{-gnatem} (@command{gcc})
3913 Specify a mapping file
3914 @ifclear vms
3915 (the equal sign is optional)
3916 @end ifclear
3917 (@pxref{Units to Sources Mapping Files}).
3918
3919 @item -gnatep=@var{file}
3920 @cindex @option{-gnatep} (@command{gcc})
3921 Specify a preprocessing data file
3922 @ifclear vms
3923 (the equal sign is optional)
3924 @end ifclear
3925 (@pxref{Integrated Preprocessing}).
3926
3927 @item -gnatE
3928 @cindex @option{-gnatE} (@command{gcc})
3929 Full dynamic elaboration checks.
3930
3931 @item -gnatf
3932 @cindex @option{-gnatf} (@command{gcc})
3933 Full errors. Multiple errors per line, all undefined references, do not
3934 attempt to suppress cascaded errors.
3935
3936 @item -gnatF
3937 @cindex @option{-gnatF} (@command{gcc})
3938 Externals names are folded to all uppercase.
3939
3940 @item ^-gnatg^/GNAT_INTERNAL^
3941 @cindex @option{^-gnatg^/GNAT_INTERNAL^} (@command{gcc})
3942 Internal GNAT implementation mode. This should not be used for
3943 applications programs, it is intended only for use by the compiler
3944 and its run-time library. For documentation, see the GNAT sources.
3945 Note that @option{^-gnatg^/GNAT_INTERNAL^} implies
3946 @option{^-gnatwae^/WARNINGS=ALL,ERRORS^} and
3947 @option{^-gnatyg^/STYLE_CHECKS=GNAT^}
3948 so that all standard warnings and all standard style options are turned on.
3949 All warnings and style error messages are treated as errors.
3950
3951 @item -gnatG
3952 @cindex @option{-gnatG} (@command{gcc})
3953 List generated expanded code in source form.
3954
3955 @item ^-gnath^/HELP^
3956 @cindex @option{^-gnath^/HELP^} (@command{gcc})
3957 Output usage information. The output is written to @file{stdout}.
3958
3959 @item ^-gnati^/IDENTIFIER_CHARACTER_SET=^@var{c}
3960 @cindex @option{^-gnati^/IDENTIFIER_CHARACTER_SET^} (@command{gcc})
3961 Identifier character set
3962 @ifclear vms
3963 (@var{c}=1/2/3/4/8/9/p/f/n/w).
3964 @end ifclear
3965 For details of the possible selections for @var{c},
3966 see @ref{Character Set Control}.
3967
3968 @item ^-gnatI^/IGNORE_REP_CLAUSES^
3969 @cindex @option{^-gnatI^IGNORE_REP_CLAUSES^} (@command{gcc})
3970 Ignore representation clauses. When this switch is used, all
3971 representation clauses are treated as comments. This is useful
3972 when initially porting code where you want to ignore rep clause
3973 problems, and also for compiling foreign code (particularly
3974 for use with ASIS).
3975
3976 @item -gnatjnn
3977 @cindex @option{-gnatjnn} (@command{gcc})
3978 Reformat error messages to fit on nn character lines
3979
3980 @item -gnatk=@var{n}
3981 @cindex @option{-gnatk} (@command{gcc})
3982 Limit file names to @var{n} (1-999) characters ^(@code{k} = krunch)^^.
3983
3984 @item -gnatl
3985 @cindex @option{-gnatl} (@command{gcc})
3986 Output full source listing with embedded error messages.
3987
3988 @item -gnatL
3989 @cindex @option{-gnatL} (@command{gcc})
3990 Used in conjunction with -gnatG or -gnatD to intersperse original
3991 source lines (as comment lines with line numbers) in the expanded
3992 source output.
3993
3994 @item -gnatm=@var{n}
3995 @cindex @option{-gnatm} (@command{gcc})
3996 Limit number of detected error or warning messages to @var{n}
3997 where @var{n} is in the range 1..999_999. The default setting if
3998 no switch is given is 9999. Compilation is terminated if this
3999 limit is exceeded. The equal sign here is optional.
4000
4001 @item -gnatn
4002 @cindex @option{-gnatn} (@command{gcc})
4003 Activate inlining for subprograms for which
4004 pragma @code{inline} is specified. This inlining is performed
4005 by the GCC back-end.
4006
4007 @item -gnatN
4008 @cindex @option{-gnatN} (@command{gcc})
4009 Activate front end inlining for subprograms for which
4010 pragma @code{Inline} is specified. This inlining is performed
4011 by the front end and will be visible in the
4012 @option{-gnatG} output.
4013 In some cases, this has proved more effective than the back end
4014 inlining resulting from the use of
4015 @option{-gnatn}.
4016 Note that
4017 @option{-gnatN} automatically implies
4018 @option{-gnatn} so it is not necessary
4019 to specify both options. There are a few cases that the back-end inlining
4020 catches that cannot be dealt with in the front-end.
4021
4022 @item -gnato
4023 @cindex @option{-gnato} (@command{gcc})
4024 Enable numeric overflow checking (which is not normally enabled by
4025 default). Note that division by zero is a separate check that is not
4026 controlled by this switch (division by zero checking is on by default).
4027
4028 @item -gnatp
4029 @cindex @option{-gnatp} (@command{gcc})
4030 Suppress all checks. See @ref{Run-Time Checks} for details.
4031
4032 @item -gnatP
4033 @cindex @option{-gnatP} (@command{gcc})
4034 Enable polling. This is required on some systems (notably Windows NT) to
4035 obtain asynchronous abort and asynchronous transfer of control capability.
4036 @xref{Pragma Polling,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}, for full
4037 details.
4038
4039 @item -gnatq
4040 @cindex @option{-gnatq} (@command{gcc})
4041 Don't quit. Try semantics, even if parse errors.
4042
4043 @item -gnatQ
4044 @cindex @option{-gnatQ} (@command{gcc})
4045 Don't quit. Generate @file{ALI} and tree files even if illegalities.
4046
4047 @item -gnatr
4048 @cindex @option{-gnatr} (@command{gcc})
4049 Treat pragma Restrictions as Restriction_Warnings.
4050
4051 @item ^-gnatR@r{[}0@r{/}1@r{/}2@r{/}3@r{[}s@r{]]}^/REPRESENTATION_INFO^
4052 @cindex @option{-gnatR} (@command{gcc})
4053 Output representation information for declared types and objects.
4054
4055 @item -gnats
4056 @cindex @option{-gnats} (@command{gcc})
4057 Syntax check only.
4058
4059 @item -gnatS
4060 @cindex @option{-gnatS} (@command{gcc})
4061 Print package Standard.
4062
4063 @item -gnatt
4064 @cindex @option{-gnatt} (@command{gcc})
4065 Generate tree output file.
4066
4067 @item ^-gnatT^/TABLE_MULTIPLIER=^@var{nnn}
4068 @cindex @option{^-gnatT^/TABLE_MULTIPLIER^} (@command{gcc})
4069 All compiler tables start at @var{nnn} times usual starting size.
4070
4071 @item -gnatu
4072 @cindex @option{-gnatu} (@command{gcc})
4073 List units for this compilation.
4074
4075 @item -gnatU
4076 @cindex @option{-gnatU} (@command{gcc})
4077 Tag all error messages with the unique string ``error:''
4078
4079 @item -gnatv
4080 @cindex @option{-gnatv} (@command{gcc})
4081 Verbose mode. Full error output with source lines to @file{stdout}.
4082
4083 @item -gnatV
4084 @cindex @option{-gnatV} (@command{gcc})
4085 Control level of validity checking. See separate section describing
4086 this feature.
4087
4088 @item ^-gnatw@var{xxx}^/WARNINGS=(@var{option}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]})^
4089 @cindex @option{^-gnatw^/WARNINGS^} (@command{gcc})
4090 Warning mode where
4091 ^@var{xxx} is a string of option letters that^the list of options^ denotes
4092 the exact warnings that
4093 are enabled or disabled (@pxref{Warning Message Control}).
4094
4095 @item ^-gnatW^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING=^@var{e}
4096 @cindex @option{^-gnatW^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} (@command{gcc})
4097 Wide character encoding method
4098 @ifclear vms
4099 (@var{e}=n/h/u/s/e/8).
4100 @end ifclear
4101 @ifset vms
4102 (@var{e}=@code{BRACKETS, NONE, HEX, UPPER, SHIFT_JIS, EUC, UTF8})
4103 @end ifset
4104
4105 @item -gnatx
4106 @cindex @option{-gnatx} (@command{gcc})
4107 Suppress generation of cross-reference information.
4108
4109 @item ^-gnaty^/STYLE_CHECKS=(option,option@dots{})^
4110 @cindex @option{^-gnaty^/STYLE_CHECKS^} (@command{gcc})
4111 Enable built-in style checks (@pxref{Style Checking}).
4112
4113 @item ^-gnatz^/DISTRIBUTION_STUBS=^@var{m}
4114 @cindex @option{^-gnatz^/DISTRIBUTION_STUBS^} (@command{gcc})
4115 Distribution stub generation and compilation
4116 @ifclear vms
4117 (@var{m}=r/c for receiver/caller stubs).
4118 @end ifclear
4119 @ifset vms
4120 (@var{m}=@code{RECEIVER} or @code{CALLER} to specify the type of stubs
4121 to be generated and compiled).
4122 @end ifset
4123
4124 @item ^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}
4125 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@command{gcc})
4126 @cindex RTL
4127 Direct GNAT to search the @var{dir} directory for source files needed by
4128 the current compilation
4129 (@pxref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}).
4130
4131 @item ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
4132 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@command{gcc})
4133 @cindex RTL
4134 Except for the source file named in the command line, do not look for source
4135 files in the directory containing the source file named in the command line
4136 (@pxref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}).
4137
4138 @ifclear vms
4139 @item -mbig-switch
4140 @cindex @option{-mbig-switch} (@command{gcc})
4141 @cindex @code{case} statement (effect of @option{-mbig-switch} option)
4142 This standard gcc switch causes the compiler to use larger offsets in its
4143 jump table representation for @code{case} statements.
4144 This may result in less efficient code, but is sometimes necessary
4145 (for example on HP-UX targets)
4146 @cindex HP-UX and @option{-mbig-switch} option
4147 in order to compile large and/or nested @code{case} statements.
4148
4149 @item -o @var{file}
4150 @cindex @option{-o} (@command{gcc})
4151 This switch is used in @command{gcc} to redirect the generated object file
4152 and its associated ALI file. Beware of this switch with GNAT, because it may
4153 cause the object file and ALI file to have different names which in turn
4154 may confuse the binder and the linker.
4155 @end ifclear
4156
4157 @item -nostdinc
4158 @cindex @option{-nostdinc} (@command{gcc})
4159 Inhibit the search of the default location for the GNAT Run Time
4160 Library (RTL) source files.
4161
4162 @item -nostdlib
4163 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} (@command{gcc})
4164 Inhibit the search of the default location for the GNAT Run Time
4165 Library (RTL) ALI files.
4166
4167 @ifclear vms
4168 @item -O@ovar{n}
4169 @cindex @option{-O} (@command{gcc})
4170 @var{n} controls the optimization level.
4171
4172 @table @asis
4173 @item n = 0
4174 No optimization, the default setting if no @option{-O} appears
4175
4176 @item n = 1
4177 Normal optimization, the default if you specify @option{-O} without
4178 an operand. A good compromise between code quality and compilation
4179 time.
4180
4181 @item n = 2
4182 Extensive optimization, may improve execution time, possibly at the cost of
4183 substantially increased compilation time.
4184
4185 @item n = 3
4186 Same as @option{-O2}, and also includes inline expansion for small subprograms
4187 in the same unit.
4188
4189 @item n = s
4190 Optimize space usage
4191 @end table
4192
4193 @noindent
4194 See also @ref{Optimization Levels}.
4195 @end ifclear
4196
4197 @ifset vms
4198 @item /NOOPTIMIZE
4199 @cindex @option{/NOOPTIMIZE} (@code{GNAT COMPILE})
4200 Equivalent to @option{/OPTIMIZE=NONE}.
4201 This is the default behavior in the absence of an @option{/OPTIMIZE}
4202 qualifier.
4203
4204 @item /OPTIMIZE@r{[}=(keyword@r{[},@dots{}@r{]})@r{]}
4205 @cindex @option{/OPTIMIZE} (@code{GNAT COMPILE})
4206 Selects the level of optimization for your program. The supported
4207 keywords are as follows:
4208 @table @code
4209 @item ALL
4210 Perform most optimizations, including those that
4211 are expensive.
4212 This is the default if the @option{/OPTIMIZE} qualifier is supplied
4213 without keyword options.
4214
4215 @item NONE
4216 Do not do any optimizations. Same as @code{/NOOPTIMIZE}.
4217
4218 @item SOME
4219 Perform some optimizations, but omit ones that are costly.
4220
4221 @item DEVELOPMENT
4222 Same as @code{SOME}.
4223
4224 @item INLINING
4225 Full optimization as in @option{/OPTIMIZE=ALL}, and also attempts
4226 automatic inlining of small subprograms within a unit
4227
4228 @item UNROLL_LOOPS
4229 Try to unroll loops. This keyword may be specified together with
4230 any keyword above other than @code{NONE}. Loop unrolling
4231 usually, but not always, improves the performance of programs.
4232
4233 @item SPACE
4234 Optimize space usage
4235 @end table
4236
4237 @noindent
4238 See also @ref{Optimization Levels}.
4239 @end ifset
4240
4241 @ifclear vms
4242 @item -pass-exit-codes
4243 @cindex @option{-pass-exit-codes} (@command{gcc})
4244 Catch exit codes from the compiler and use the most meaningful as
4245 exit status.
4246 @end ifclear
4247
4248 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
4249 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@command{gcc})
4250 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. Same meaning as the
4251 equivalent @command{gnatmake} flag (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
4252
4253 @item ^-S^/ASM^
4254 @cindex @option{^-S^/ASM^} (@command{gcc})
4255 ^Used in place of @option{-c} to^Used to^
4256 cause the assembler source file to be
4257 generated, using @file{^.s^.S^} as the extension,
4258 instead of the object file.
4259 This may be useful if you need to examine the generated assembly code.
4260
4261 @item ^-fverbose-asm^/VERBOSE_ASM^
4262 @cindex @option{^-fverbose-asm^/VERBOSE_ASM^} (@command{gcc})
4263 ^Used in conjunction with @option{-S}^Used in place of @option{/ASM}^
4264 to cause the generated assembly code file to be annotated with variable
4265 names, making it significantly easier to follow.
4266
4267 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
4268 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@command{gcc})
4269 Show commands generated by the @command{gcc} driver. Normally used only for
4270 debugging purposes or if you need to be sure what version of the
4271 compiler you are executing.
4272
4273 @ifclear vms
4274 @item -V @var{ver}
4275 @cindex @option{-V} (@command{gcc})
4276 Execute @var{ver} version of the compiler. This is the @command{gcc}
4277 version, not the GNAT version.
4278 @end ifclear
4279
4280 @item ^-w^/NO_BACK_END_WARNINGS^
4281 @cindex @option{-w} (@command{gcc})
4282 Turn off warnings generated by the back end of the compiler. Use of
4283 this switch also causes the default for front end warnings to be set
4284 to suppress (as though @option{-gnatws} had appeared at the start of
4285 the options).
4286
4287 @end table
4288
4289 @ifclear vms
4290 @c Combining qualifiers does not work on VMS
4291 You may combine a sequence of GNAT switches into a single switch. For
4292 example, the combined switch
4293
4294 @cindex Combining GNAT switches
4295 @smallexample
4296 -gnatofi3
4297 @end smallexample
4298
4299 @noindent
4300 is equivalent to specifying the following sequence of switches:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 -gnato -gnatf -gnati3
4304 @end smallexample
4305 @end ifclear
4306
4307 @noindent
4308 The following restrictions apply to the combination of switches
4309 in this manner:
4310
4311 @itemize @bullet
4312 @item
4313 The switch @option{-gnatc} if combined with other switches must come
4314 first in the string.
4315
4316 @item
4317 The switch @option{-gnats} if combined with other switches must come
4318 first in the string.
4319
4320 @item
4321 The switches
4322 @option{^-gnatz^/DISTRIBUTION_STUBS^}, @option{-gnatzc}, and @option{-gnatzr}
4323 may not be combined with any other switches.
4324
4325 @ifclear vms
4326 @item
4327 Once a ``y'' appears in the string (that is a use of the @option{-gnaty}
4328 switch), then all further characters in the switch are interpreted
4329 as style modifiers (see description of @option{-gnaty}).
4330
4331 @item
4332 Once a ``d'' appears in the string (that is a use of the @option{-gnatd}
4333 switch), then all further characters in the switch are interpreted
4334 as debug flags (see description of @option{-gnatd}).
4335
4336 @item
4337 Once a ``w'' appears in the string (that is a use of the @option{-gnatw}
4338 switch), then all further characters in the switch are interpreted
4339 as warning mode modifiers (see description of @option{-gnatw}).
4340
4341 @item
4342 Once a ``V'' appears in the string (that is a use of the @option{-gnatV}
4343 switch), then all further characters in the switch are interpreted
4344 as validity checking options (see description of @option{-gnatV}).
4345 @end ifclear
4346 @end itemize
4347
4348 @node Output and Error Message Control
4349 @subsection Output and Error Message Control
4350 @findex stderr
4351
4352 @noindent
4353 The standard default format for error messages is called ``brief format''.
4354 Brief format messages are written to @file{stderr} (the standard error
4355 file) and have the following form:
4356
4357 @smallexample
4358 e.adb:3:04: Incorrect spelling of keyword "function"
4359 e.adb:4:20: ";" should be "is"
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 @noindent
4363 The first integer after the file name is the line number in the file,
4364 and the second integer is the column number within the line.
4365 @ifclear vms
4366 @code{GPS} can parse the error messages
4367 and point to the referenced character.
4368 @end ifclear
4369 The following switches provide control over the error message
4370 format:
4371
4372 @table @option
4373 @c !sort!
4374 @item -gnatv
4375 @cindex @option{-gnatv} (@command{gcc})
4376 @findex stdout
4377 @ifclear vms
4378 The v stands for verbose.
4379 @end ifclear
4380 The effect of this setting is to write long-format error
4381 messages to @file{stdout} (the standard output file.
4382 The same program compiled with the
4383 @option{-gnatv} switch would generate:
4384
4385 @smallexample
4386 @cartouche
4387 3. funcion X (Q : Integer)
4388 |
4389 >>> Incorrect spelling of keyword "function"
4390 4. return Integer;
4391 |
4392 >>> ";" should be "is"
4393 @end cartouche
4394 @end smallexample
4395
4396 @noindent
4397 The vertical bar indicates the location of the error, and the @samp{>>>}
4398 prefix can be used to search for error messages. When this switch is
4399 used the only source lines output are those with errors.
4400
4401 @item -gnatl
4402 @cindex @option{-gnatl} (@command{gcc})
4403 @ifclear vms
4404 The @code{l} stands for list.
4405 @end ifclear
4406 This switch causes a full listing of
4407 the file to be generated. In the case where a body is
4408 compiled, the corresponding spec is also listed, along
4409 with any subunits. Typical output from compiling a package
4410 body @file{p.adb} might look like:
4411
4412 @smallexample @c ada
4413 @cartouche
4414 Compiling: p.adb
4415
4416 1. package body p is
4417 2. procedure a;
4418 3. procedure a is separate;
4419 4. begin
4420 5. null
4421 |
4422 >>> missing ";"
4423
4424 6. end;
4425
4426 Compiling: p.ads
4427
4428 1. package p is
4429 2. pragma Elaborate_Body
4430 |
4431 >>> missing ";"
4432
4433 3. end p;
4434
4435 Compiling: p-a.adb
4436
4437 1. separate p
4438 |
4439 >>> missing "("
4440
4441 2. procedure a is
4442 3. begin
4443 4. null
4444 |
4445 >>> missing ";"
4446
4447 5. end;
4448 @end cartouche
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 @noindent
4452 @findex stderr
4453 When you specify the @option{-gnatv} or @option{-gnatl} switches and
4454 standard output is redirected, a brief summary is written to
4455 @file{stderr} (standard error) giving the number of error messages and
4456 warning messages generated.
4457
4458 @item -^gnatl^OUTPUT_FILE^=file
4459 @cindex @option{^-gnatl^OUTPUT_FILE^=fname} (@command{gcc})
4460 This has the same effect as @option{-gnatl} except that the output is
4461 written to a file instead of to standard output. If the given name
4462 @file{fname} does not start with a period, then it is the full name
4463 of the file to be written. If @file{fname} is an extension, it is
4464 appended to the name of the file being compiled. For example, if
4465 file @file{xyz.adb} is compiled with @option{^-gnatl^OUTPUT_FILE^=.lst},
4466 then the output is written to file ^xyz.adb.lst^xyz.adb_lst^.
4467
4468 @item -gnatU
4469 @cindex @option{-gnatU} (@command{gcc})
4470 This switch forces all error messages to be preceded by the unique
4471 string ``error:''. This means that error messages take a few more
4472 characters in space, but allows easy searching for and identification
4473 of error messages.
4474
4475 @item -gnatb
4476 @cindex @option{-gnatb} (@command{gcc})
4477 @ifclear vms
4478 The @code{b} stands for brief.
4479 @end ifclear
4480 This switch causes GNAT to generate the
4481 brief format error messages to @file{stderr} (the standard error
4482 file) as well as the verbose
4483 format message or full listing (which as usual is written to
4484 @file{stdout} (the standard output file).
4485
4486 @item -gnatm=@var{n}
4487 @cindex @option{-gnatm} (@command{gcc})
4488 @ifclear vms
4489 The @code{m} stands for maximum.
4490 @end ifclear
4491 @var{n} is a decimal integer in the
4492 range of 1 to 999 and limits the number of error messages to be
4493 generated. For example, using @option{-gnatm2} might yield
4494
4495 @smallexample
4496 e.adb:3:04: Incorrect spelling of keyword "function"
4497 e.adb:5:35: missing ".."
4498 fatal error: maximum errors reached
4499 compilation abandoned
4500 @end smallexample
4501
4502 @noindent
4503 Note that the equal sign is optional, so the switches
4504 @option{-gnatm2} and @option{-gnatm=2} are equivalent.
4505
4506 @item -gnatf
4507 @cindex @option{-gnatf} (@command{gcc})
4508 @cindex Error messages, suppressing
4509 @ifclear vms
4510 The @code{f} stands for full.
4511 @end ifclear
4512 Normally, the compiler suppresses error messages that are likely to be
4513 redundant. This switch causes all error
4514 messages to be generated. In particular, in the case of
4515 references to undefined variables. If a given variable is referenced
4516 several times, the normal format of messages is
4517 @smallexample
4518 e.adb:7:07: "V" is undefined (more references follow)
4519 @end smallexample
4520
4521 @noindent
4522 where the parenthetical comment warns that there are additional
4523 references to the variable @code{V}. Compiling the same program with the
4524 @option{-gnatf} switch yields
4525
4526 @smallexample
4527 e.adb:7:07: "V" is undefined
4528 e.adb:8:07: "V" is undefined
4529 e.adb:8:12: "V" is undefined
4530 e.adb:8:16: "V" is undefined
4531 e.adb:9:07: "V" is undefined
4532 e.adb:9:12: "V" is undefined
4533 @end smallexample
4534
4535 @noindent
4536 The @option{-gnatf} switch also generates additional information for
4537 some error messages. Some examples are:
4538
4539 @itemize @bullet
4540 @item
4541 Full details on entities not available in high integrity mode
4542 @item
4543 Details on possibly non-portable unchecked conversion
4544 @item
4545 List possible interpretations for ambiguous calls
4546 @item
4547 Additional details on incorrect parameters
4548 @end itemize
4549
4550 @item -gnatjnn
4551 @cindex @option{-gnatjnn} (@command{gcc})
4552 In normal operation mode (or if @option{-gnatj0} is used, then error messages
4553 with continuation lines are treated as though the continuation lines were
4554 separate messages (and so a warning with two continuation lines counts as
4555 three warnings, and is listed as three separate messages).
4556
4557 If the @option{-gnatjnn} switch is used with a positive value for nn, then
4558 messages are output in a different manner. A message and all its continuation
4559 lines are treated as a unit, and count as only one warning or message in the
4560 statistics totals. Furthermore, the message is reformatted so that no line
4561 is longer than nn characters.
4562
4563 @item -gnatq
4564 @cindex @option{-gnatq} (@command{gcc})
4565 @ifclear vms
4566 The @code{q} stands for quit (really ``don't quit'').
4567 @end ifclear
4568 In normal operation mode, the compiler first parses the program and
4569 determines if there are any syntax errors. If there are, appropriate
4570 error messages are generated and compilation is immediately terminated.
4571 This switch tells
4572 GNAT to continue with semantic analysis even if syntax errors have been
4573 found. This may enable the detection of more errors in a single run. On
4574 the other hand, the semantic analyzer is more likely to encounter some
4575 internal fatal error when given a syntactically invalid tree.
4576
4577 @item -gnatQ
4578 @cindex @option{-gnatQ} (@command{gcc})
4579 In normal operation mode, the @file{ALI} file is not generated if any
4580 illegalities are detected in the program. The use of @option{-gnatQ} forces
4581 generation of the @file{ALI} file. This file is marked as being in
4582 error, so it cannot be used for binding purposes, but it does contain
4583 reasonably complete cross-reference information, and thus may be useful
4584 for use by tools (e.g., semantic browsing tools or integrated development
4585 environments) that are driven from the @file{ALI} file. This switch
4586 implies @option{-gnatq}, since the semantic phase must be run to get a
4587 meaningful ALI file.
4588
4589 In addition, if @option{-gnatt} is also specified, then the tree file is
4590 generated even if there are illegalities. It may be useful in this case
4591 to also specify @option{-gnatq} to ensure that full semantic processing
4592 occurs. The resulting tree file can be processed by ASIS, for the purpose
4593 of providing partial information about illegal units, but if the error
4594 causes the tree to be badly malformed, then ASIS may crash during the
4595 analysis.
4596
4597 When @option{-gnatQ} is used and the generated @file{ALI} file is marked as
4598 being in error, @command{gnatmake} will attempt to recompile the source when it
4599 finds such an @file{ALI} file, including with switch @option{-gnatc}.
4600
4601 Note that @option{-gnatQ} has no effect if @option{-gnats} is specified,
4602 since ALI files are never generated if @option{-gnats} is set.
4603
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @node Warning Message Control
4607 @subsection Warning Message Control
4608 @cindex Warning messages
4609 @noindent
4610 In addition to error messages, which correspond to illegalities as defined
4611 in the Ada Reference Manual, the compiler detects two kinds of warning
4612 situations.
4613
4614 First, the compiler considers some constructs suspicious and generates a
4615 warning message to alert you to a possible error. Second, if the
4616 compiler detects a situation that is sure to raise an exception at
4617 run time, it generates a warning message. The following shows an example
4618 of warning messages:
4619 @smallexample
4620 e.adb:4:24: warning: creation of object may raise Storage_Error
4621 e.adb:10:17: warning: static value out of range
4622 e.adb:10:17: warning: "Constraint_Error" will be raised at run time
4623 @end smallexample
4624
4625 @noindent
4626 GNAT considers a large number of situations as appropriate
4627 for the generation of warning messages. As always, warnings are not
4628 definite indications of errors. For example, if you do an out-of-range
4629 assignment with the deliberate intention of raising a
4630 @code{Constraint_Error} exception, then the warning that may be
4631 issued does not indicate an error. Some of the situations for which GNAT
4632 issues warnings (at least some of the time) are given in the following
4633 list. This list is not complete, and new warnings are often added to
4634 subsequent versions of GNAT. The list is intended to give a general idea
4635 of the kinds of warnings that are generated.
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item
4639 Possible infinitely recursive calls
4640
4641 @item
4642 Out-of-range values being assigned
4643
4644 @item
4645 Possible order of elaboration problems
4646
4647 @item
4648 Assertions (pragma Assert) that are sure to fail
4649
4650 @item
4651 Unreachable code
4652
4653 @item
4654 Address clauses with possibly unaligned values, or where an attempt is
4655 made to overlay a smaller variable with a larger one.
4656
4657 @item
4658 Fixed-point type declarations with a null range
4659
4660 @item
4661 Direct_IO or Sequential_IO instantiated with a type that has access values
4662
4663 @item
4664 Variables that are never assigned a value
4665
4666 @item
4667 Variables that are referenced before being initialized
4668
4669 @item
4670 Task entries with no corresponding @code{accept} statement
4671
4672 @item
4673 Duplicate accepts for the same task entry in a @code{select}
4674
4675 @item
4676 Objects that take too much storage
4677
4678 @item
4679 Unchecked conversion between types of differing sizes
4680
4681 @item
4682 Missing @code{return} statement along some execution path in a function
4683
4684 @item
4685 Incorrect (unrecognized) pragmas
4686
4687 @item
4688 Incorrect external names
4689
4690 @item
4691 Allocation from empty storage pool
4692
4693 @item
4694 Potentially blocking operation in protected type
4695
4696 @item
4697 Suspicious parenthesization of expressions
4698
4699 @item
4700 Mismatching bounds in an aggregate
4701
4702 @item
4703 Attempt to return local value by reference
4704
4705 @item
4706 Premature instantiation of a generic body
4707
4708 @item
4709 Attempt to pack aliased components
4710
4711 @item
4712 Out of bounds array subscripts
4713
4714 @item
4715 Wrong length on string assignment
4716
4717 @item
4718 Violations of style rules if style checking is enabled
4719
4720 @item
4721 Unused @code{with} clauses
4722
4723 @item
4724 @code{Bit_Order} usage that does not have any effect
4725
4726 @item
4727 @code{Standard.Duration} used to resolve universal fixed expression
4728
4729 @item
4730 Dereference of possibly null value
4731
4732 @item
4733 Declaration that is likely to cause storage error
4734
4735 @item
4736 Internal GNAT unit @code{with}'ed by application unit
4737
4738 @item
4739 Values known to be out of range at compile time
4740
4741 @item
4742 Unreferenced labels and variables
4743
4744 @item
4745 Address overlays that could clobber memory
4746
4747 @item
4748 Unexpected initialization when address clause present
4749
4750 @item
4751 Bad alignment for address clause
4752
4753 @item
4754 Useless type conversions
4755
4756 @item
4757 Redundant assignment statements and other redundant constructs
4758
4759 @item
4760 Useless exception handlers
4761
4762 @item
4763 Accidental hiding of name by child unit
4764
4765 @item
4766 Access before elaboration detected at compile time
4767
4768 @item
4769 A range in a @code{for} loop that is known to be null or might be null
4770
4771 @end itemize
4772
4773 @noindent
4774 The following section lists compiler switches that are available
4775 to control the handling of warning messages. It is also possible
4776 to exercise much finer control over what warnings are issued and
4777 suppressed using the GNAT pragma Warnings, @xref{Pragma Warnings,,,
4778 gnat_rm, GNAT Reference manual}.
4779
4780 @table @option
4781 @c !sort!
4782 @item -gnatwa
4783 @emph{Activate all optional errors.}
4784 @cindex @option{-gnatwa} (@command{gcc})
4785 This switch activates most optional warning messages, see remaining list
4786 in this section for details on optional warning messages that can be
4787 individually controlled. The warnings that are not turned on by this
4788 switch are
4789 @option{-gnatwd} (implicit dereferencing),
4790 @option{-gnatwh} (hiding),
4791 @option{-gnatwl} (elaboration warnings),
4792 @option{-gnatw.o} (warn on values set by out parameters ignored)
4793 and @option{-gnatwt} (tracking of deleted conditional code).
4794 All other optional warnings are turned on.
4795
4796 @item -gnatwA
4797 @emph{Suppress all optional errors.}
4798 @cindex @option{-gnatwA} (@command{gcc})
4799 This switch suppresses all optional warning messages, see remaining list
4800 in this section for details on optional warning messages that can be
4801 individually controlled.
4802
4803 @item -gnatw.a
4804 @emph{Activate warnings on failing assertions.}
4805 @cindex @option{-gnatw.a} (@command{gcc})
4806 @cindex Assert failures
4807 This switch activates warnings for assertions where the compiler can tell at
4808 compile time that the assertion will fail. Note that this warning is given
4809 even if assertions are disabled. The default is that such warnings are
4810 generated.
4811
4812 @item -gnatw.A
4813 @emph{Suppress warnings on failing assertions.}
4814 @cindex @option{-gnatw.A} (@command{gcc})
4815 @cindex Assert failures
4816 This switch suppresses warnings for assertions where the compiler can tell at
4817 compile time that the assertion will fail.
4818
4819 @item -gnatwb
4820 @emph{Activate warnings on bad fixed values.}
4821 @cindex @option{-gnatwb} (@command{gcc})
4822 @cindex Bad fixed values
4823 @cindex Fixed-point Small value
4824 @cindex Small value
4825 This switch activates warnings for static fixed-point expressions whose
4826 value is not an exact multiple of Small. Such values are implementation
4827 dependent, since an implementation is free to choose either of the multiples
4828 that surround the value. GNAT always chooses the closer one, but this is not
4829 required behavior, and it is better to specify a value that is an exact
4830 multiple, ensuring predictable execution. The default is that such warnings
4831 are not generated.
4832
4833 @item -gnatwB
4834 @emph{Suppress warnings on bad fixed values.}
4835 @cindex @option{-gnatwB} (@command{gcc})
4836 This switch suppresses warnings for static fixed-point expressions whose
4837 value is not an exact multiple of Small.
4838
4839 @item -gnatw.b
4840 @emph{Activate warnings on biased representation.}
4841 @cindex @option{-gnatw.b} (@command{gcc})
4842 @cindex Biased representation
4843 This switch activates warnings when a size clause, value size clause, component
4844 clause, or component size clause forces the use of biased representation for an
4845 integer type (e.g. representing a range of 10..11 in a single bit by using 0/1
4846 to represent 10/11). The default is that such warnings are generated.
4847
4848 @item -gnatw.B
4849 @emph{Suppress warnings on biased representation.}
4850 @cindex @option{-gnatwB} (@command{gcc})
4851 This switch suppresses warnings for representation clauses that force the use
4852 of biased representation.
4853
4854 @item -gnatwc
4855 @emph{Activate warnings on conditionals.}
4856 @cindex @option{-gnatwc} (@command{gcc})
4857 @cindex Conditionals, constant
4858 This switch activates warnings for conditional expressions used in
4859 tests that are known to be True or False at compile time. The default
4860 is that such warnings are not generated.
4861 Note that this warning does
4862 not get issued for the use of boolean variables or constants whose
4863 values are known at compile time, since this is a standard technique
4864 for conditional compilation in Ada, and this would generate too many
4865 false positive warnings.
4866
4867 This warning option also activates a special test for comparisons using
4868 the operators ``>='' and`` <=''.
4869 If the compiler can tell that only the equality condition is possible,
4870 then it will warn that the ``>'' or ``<'' part of the test
4871 is useless and that the operator could be replaced by ``=''.
4872 An example would be comparing a @code{Natural} variable <= 0.
4873
4874 This warning option also generates warnings if
4875 one or both tests is optimized away in a membership test for integer
4876 values if the result can be determined at compile time. Range tests on
4877 enumeration types are not included, since it is common for such tests
4878 to include an end point.
4879
4880 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
4881
4882 @item -gnatwC
4883 @emph{Suppress warnings on conditionals.}
4884 @cindex @option{-gnatwC} (@command{gcc})
4885 This switch suppresses warnings for conditional expressions used in
4886 tests that are known to be True or False at compile time.
4887
4888 @item -gnatw.c
4889 @emph{Activate warnings on missing component clauses.}
4890 @cindex @option{-gnatw.c} (@command{gcc})
4891 @cindex Component clause, missing
4892 This switch activates warnings for record components where a record
4893 representation clause is present and has component clauses for the
4894 majority, but not all, of the components. A warning is given for each
4895 component for which no component clause is present.
4896
4897 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
4898
4899 @item -gnatw.C
4900 @emph{Suppress warnings on missing component clauses.}
4901 @cindex @option{-gnatwC} (@command{gcc})
4902 This switch suppresses warnings for record components that are
4903 missing a component clause in the situation described above.
4904
4905 @item -gnatwd
4906 @emph{Activate warnings on implicit dereferencing.}
4907 @cindex @option{-gnatwd} (@command{gcc})
4908 If this switch is set, then the use of a prefix of an access type
4909 in an indexed component, slice, or selected component without an
4910 explicit @code{.all} will generate a warning. With this warning
4911 enabled, access checks occur only at points where an explicit
4912 @code{.all} appears in the source code (assuming no warnings are
4913 generated as a result of this switch). The default is that such
4914 warnings are not generated.
4915 Note that @option{-gnatwa} does not affect the setting of
4916 this warning option.
4917
4918 @item -gnatwD
4919 @emph{Suppress warnings on implicit dereferencing.}
4920 @cindex @option{-gnatwD} (@command{gcc})
4921 @cindex Implicit dereferencing
4922 @cindex Dereferencing, implicit
4923 This switch suppresses warnings for implicit dereferences in
4924 indexed components, slices, and selected components.
4925
4926 @item -gnatwe
4927 @emph{Treat warnings as errors.}
4928 @cindex @option{-gnatwe} (@command{gcc})
4929 @cindex Warnings, treat as error
4930 This switch causes warning messages to be treated as errors.
4931 The warning string still appears, but the warning messages are counted
4932 as errors, and prevent the generation of an object file.
4933
4934 @item -gnatw.e
4935 @emph{Activate every optional warning}
4936 @cindex @option{-gnatw.e} (@command{gcc})
4937 @cindex Warnings, activate every optional warning
4938 This switch activates all optional warnings, including those which
4939 are not activated by @code{-gnatwa}.
4940
4941 @item -gnatwf
4942 @emph{Activate warnings on unreferenced formals.}
4943 @cindex @option{-gnatwf} (@command{gcc})
4944 @cindex Formals, unreferenced
4945 This switch causes a warning to be generated if a formal parameter
4946 is not referenced in the body of the subprogram. This warning can
4947 also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa} or @option{-gnatwu}. The
4948 default is that these warnings are not generated.
4949
4950 @item -gnatwF
4951 @emph{Suppress warnings on unreferenced formals.}
4952 @cindex @option{-gnatwF} (@command{gcc})
4953 This switch suppresses warnings for unreferenced formal
4954 parameters. Note that the
4955 combination @option{-gnatwu} followed by @option{-gnatwF} has the
4956 effect of warning on unreferenced entities other than subprogram
4957 formals.
4958
4959 @item -gnatwg
4960 @emph{Activate warnings on unrecognized pragmas.}
4961 @cindex @option{-gnatwg} (@command{gcc})
4962 @cindex Pragmas, unrecognized
4963 This switch causes a warning to be generated if an unrecognized
4964 pragma is encountered. Apart from issuing this warning, the
4965 pragma is ignored and has no effect. This warning can
4966 also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}. The default
4967 is that such warnings are issued (satisfying the Ada Reference
4968 Manual requirement that such warnings appear).
4969
4970 @item -gnatwG
4971 @emph{Suppress warnings on unrecognized pragmas.}
4972 @cindex @option{-gnatwG} (@command{gcc})
4973 This switch suppresses warnings for unrecognized pragmas.
4974
4975 @item -gnatwh
4976 @emph{Activate warnings on hiding.}
4977 @cindex @option{-gnatwh} (@command{gcc})
4978 @cindex Hiding of Declarations
4979 This switch activates warnings on hiding declarations.
4980 A declaration is considered hiding
4981 if it is for a non-overloadable entity, and it declares an entity with the
4982 same name as some other entity that is directly or use-visible. The default
4983 is that such warnings are not generated.
4984 Note that @option{-gnatwa} does not affect the setting of this warning option.
4985
4986 @item -gnatwH
4987 @emph{Suppress warnings on hiding.}
4988 @cindex @option{-gnatwH} (@command{gcc})
4989 This switch suppresses warnings on hiding declarations.
4990
4991 @item -gnatwi
4992 @emph{Activate warnings on implementation units.}
4993 @cindex @option{-gnatwi} (@command{gcc})
4994 This switch activates warnings for a @code{with} of an internal GNAT
4995 implementation unit, defined as any unit from the @code{Ada},
4996 @code{Interfaces}, @code{GNAT},
4997 ^^@code{DEC},^ or @code{System}
4998 hierarchies that is not
4999 documented in either the Ada Reference Manual or the GNAT
5000 Programmer's Reference Manual. Such units are intended only
5001 for internal implementation purposes and should not be @code{with}'ed
5002 by user programs. The default is that such warnings are generated
5003 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5004
5005 @item -gnatwI
5006 @emph{Disable warnings on implementation units.}
5007 @cindex @option{-gnatwI} (@command{gcc})
5008 This switch disables warnings for a @code{with} of an internal GNAT
5009 implementation unit.
5010
5011 @item -gnatwj
5012 @emph{Activate warnings on obsolescent features (Annex J).}
5013 @cindex @option{-gnatwj} (@command{gcc})
5014 @cindex Features, obsolescent
5015 @cindex Obsolescent features
5016 If this warning option is activated, then warnings are generated for
5017 calls to subprograms marked with @code{pragma Obsolescent} and
5018 for use of features in Annex J of the Ada Reference Manual. In the
5019 case of Annex J, not all features are flagged. In particular use
5020 of the renamed packages (like @code{Text_IO}) and use of package
5021 @code{ASCII} are not flagged, since these are very common and
5022 would generate many annoying positive warnings. The default is that
5023 such warnings are not generated. This warning is also turned on by
5024 the use of @option{-gnatwa}.
5025
5026 In addition to the above cases, warnings are also generated for
5027 GNAT features that have been provided in past versions but which
5028 have been superseded (typically by features in the new Ada standard).
5029 For example, @code{pragma Ravenscar} will be flagged since its
5030 function is replaced by @code{pragma Profile(Ravenscar)}.
5031
5032 Note that this warning option functions differently from the
5033 restriction @code{No_Obsolescent_Features} in two respects.
5034 First, the restriction applies only to annex J features.
5035 Second, the restriction does flag uses of package @code{ASCII}.
5036
5037 @item -gnatwJ
5038 @emph{Suppress warnings on obsolescent features (Annex J).}
5039 @cindex @option{-gnatwJ} (@command{gcc})
5040 This switch disables warnings on use of obsolescent features.
5041
5042 @item -gnatwk
5043 @emph{Activate warnings on variables that could be constants.}
5044 @cindex @option{-gnatwk} (@command{gcc})
5045 This switch activates warnings for variables that are initialized but
5046 never modified, and then could be declared constants. The default is that
5047 such warnings are not given.
5048 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5049
5050 @item -gnatwK
5051 @emph{Suppress warnings on variables that could be constants.}
5052 @cindex @option{-gnatwK} (@command{gcc})
5053 This switch disables warnings on variables that could be declared constants.
5054
5055 @item -gnatwl
5056 @emph{Activate warnings for elaboration pragmas.}
5057 @cindex @option{-gnatwl} (@command{gcc})
5058 @cindex Elaboration, warnings
5059 This switch activates warnings on missing
5060 @code{Elaborate_All} and @code{Elaborate} pragmas.
5061 See the section in this guide on elaboration checking for details on
5062 when such pragmas should be used. In dynamic elaboration mode, this switch
5063 generations warnings about the need to add elaboration pragmas. Note however,
5064 that if you blindly follow these warnings, and add @code{Elaborate_All}
5065 warnings wherever they are recommended, you basically end up with the
5066 equivalent of the static elaboration model, which may not be what you want for
5067 legacy code for which the static model does not work.
5068
5069 For the static model, the messages generated are labeled "info:" (for
5070 information messages). They are not warnings to add elaboration pragmas,
5071 merely informational messages showing what implicit elaboration pragmas
5072 have been added, for use in analyzing elaboration circularity problems.
5073
5074 Warnings are also generated if you
5075 are using the static mode of elaboration, and a @code{pragma Elaborate}
5076 is encountered. The default is that such warnings
5077 are not generated.
5078 This warning is not automatically turned on by the use of @option{-gnatwa}.
5079
5080 @item -gnatwL
5081 @emph{Suppress warnings for elaboration pragmas.}
5082 @cindex @option{-gnatwL} (@command{gcc})
5083 This switch suppresses warnings on missing Elaborate and Elaborate_All pragmas.
5084 See the section in this guide on elaboration checking for details on
5085 when such pragmas should be used.
5086
5087 @item -gnatwm
5088 @emph{Activate warnings on modified but unreferenced variables.}
5089 @cindex @option{-gnatwm} (@command{gcc})
5090 This switch activates warnings for variables that are assigned (using
5091 an initialization value or with one or more assignment statements) but
5092 whose value is never read. The warning is suppressed for volatile
5093 variables and also for variables that are renamings of other variables
5094 or for which an address clause is given.
5095 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5096 The default is that these warnings are not given.
5097
5098 @item -gnatwM
5099 @emph{Disable warnings on modified but unreferenced variables.}
5100 @cindex @option{-gnatwM} (@command{gcc})
5101 This switch disables warnings for variables that are assigned or
5102 initialized, but never read.
5103
5104 @item -gnatwn
5105 @emph{Set normal warnings mode.}
5106 @cindex @option{-gnatwn} (@command{gcc})
5107 This switch sets normal warning mode, in which enabled warnings are
5108 issued and treated as warnings rather than errors. This is the default
5109 mode. the switch @option{-gnatwn} can be used to cancel the effect of
5110 an explicit @option{-gnatws} or
5111 @option{-gnatwe}. It also cancels the effect of the
5112 implicit @option{-gnatwe} that is activated by the
5113 use of @option{-gnatg}.
5114
5115 @item -gnatwo
5116 @emph{Activate warnings on address clause overlays.}
5117 @cindex @option{-gnatwo} (@command{gcc})
5118 @cindex Address Clauses, warnings
5119 This switch activates warnings for possibly unintended initialization
5120 effects of defining address clauses that cause one variable to overlap
5121 another. The default is that such warnings are generated.
5122 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5123
5124 @item -gnatwO
5125 @emph{Suppress warnings on address clause overlays.}
5126 @cindex @option{-gnatwO} (@command{gcc})
5127 This switch suppresses warnings on possibly unintended initialization
5128 effects of defining address clauses that cause one variable to overlap
5129 another.
5130
5131 @item -gnatw.o
5132 @emph{Activate warnings on modified but unreferenced out parameters.}
5133 @cindex @option{-gnatw.o} (@command{gcc})
5134 This switch activates warnings for variables that are modified by using
5135 them as actuals for a call to a procedure with an out mode formal, where
5136 the resulting assigned value is never read. It is applicable in the case
5137 where there is more than one out mode formal. If there is only one out
5138 mode formal, the warning is issued by default (controlled by -gnatwu).
5139 The warning is suppressed for volatile
5140 variables and also for variables that are renamings of other variables
5141 or for which an address clause is given.
5142 The default is that these warnings are not given. Note that this warning
5143 is not included in -gnatwa, it must be activated explicitly.
5144
5145 @item -gnatw.O
5146 @emph{Disable warnings on modified but unreferenced out parameters.}
5147 @cindex @option{-gnatw.O} (@command{gcc})
5148 This switch suppresses warnings for variables that are modified by using
5149 them as actuals for a call to a procedure with an out mode formal, where
5150 the resulting assigned value is never read.
5151
5152 @item -gnatwp
5153 @emph{Activate warnings on ineffective pragma Inlines.}
5154 @cindex @option{-gnatwp} (@command{gcc})
5155 @cindex Inlining, warnings
5156 This switch activates warnings for failure of front end inlining
5157 (activated by @option{-gnatN}) to inline a particular call. There are
5158 many reasons for not being able to inline a call, including most
5159 commonly that the call is too complex to inline. The default is
5160 that such warnings are not given.
5161 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5162 Warnings on ineffective inlining by the gcc back-end can be activated
5163 separately, using the gcc switch -Winline.
5164
5165 @item -gnatwP
5166 @emph{Suppress warnings on ineffective pragma Inlines.}
5167 @cindex @option{-gnatwP} (@command{gcc})
5168 This switch suppresses warnings on ineffective pragma Inlines. If the
5169 inlining mechanism cannot inline a call, it will simply ignore the
5170 request silently.
5171
5172 @item -gnatw.p
5173 @emph{Activate warnings on parameter ordering.}
5174 @cindex @option{-gnatw.p} (@command{gcc})
5175 @cindex Parameter order, warnings
5176 This switch activates warnings for cases of suspicious parameter
5177 ordering when the list of arguments are all simple identifiers that
5178 match the names of the formals, but are in a different order. The
5179 warning is suppressed if any use of named parameter notation is used,
5180 so this is the appropriate way to suppress a false positive (and
5181 serves to emphasize that the "misordering" is deliberate). The
5182 default is
5183 that such warnings are not given.
5184 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5185
5186 @item -gnatw.P
5187 @emph{Suppress warnings on parameter ordering.}
5188 @cindex @option{-gnatw.P} (@command{gcc})
5189 This switch suppresses warnings on cases of suspicious parameter
5190 ordering.
5191
5192 @item -gnatwq
5193 @emph{Activate warnings on questionable missing parentheses.}
5194 @cindex @option{-gnatwq} (@command{gcc})
5195 @cindex Parentheses, warnings
5196 This switch activates warnings for cases where parentheses are not used and
5197 the result is potential ambiguity from a readers point of view. For example
5198 (not a > b) when a and b are modular means ((not a) > b) and very likely the
5199 programmer intended (not (a > b)). Similarly (-x mod 5) means (-(x mod 5)) and
5200 quite likely ((-x) mod 5) was intended. In such situations it seems best to
5201 follow the rule of always parenthesizing to make the association clear, and
5202 this warning switch warns if such parentheses are not present. The default
5203 is that these warnings are given.
5204 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5205
5206 @item -gnatwQ
5207 @emph{Suppress warnings on questionable missing parentheses.}
5208 @cindex @option{-gnatwQ} (@command{gcc})
5209 This switch suppresses warnings for cases where the association is not
5210 clear and the use of parentheses is preferred.
5211
5212 @item -gnatwr
5213 @emph{Activate warnings on redundant constructs.}
5214 @cindex @option{-gnatwr} (@command{gcc})
5215 This switch activates warnings for redundant constructs. The following
5216 is the current list of constructs regarded as redundant:
5217
5218 @itemize @bullet
5219 @item
5220 Assignment of an item to itself.
5221 @item
5222 Type conversion that converts an expression to its own type.
5223 @item
5224 Use of the attribute @code{Base} where @code{typ'Base} is the same
5225 as @code{typ}.
5226 @item
5227 Use of pragma @code{Pack} when all components are placed by a record
5228 representation clause.
5229 @item
5230 Exception handler containing only a reraise statement (raise with no
5231 operand) which has no effect.
5232 @item
5233 Use of the operator abs on an operand that is known at compile time
5234 to be non-negative
5235 @item
5236 Comparison of boolean expressions to an explicit True value.
5237 @end itemize
5238
5239 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5240 The default is that warnings for redundant constructs are not given.
5241
5242 @item -gnatwR
5243 @emph{Suppress warnings on redundant constructs.}
5244 @cindex @option{-gnatwR} (@command{gcc})
5245 This switch suppresses warnings for redundant constructs.
5246
5247 @item -gnatws
5248 @emph{Suppress all warnings.}
5249 @cindex @option{-gnatws} (@command{gcc})
5250 This switch completely suppresses the
5251 output of all warning messages from the GNAT front end.
5252 Note that it does not suppress warnings from the @command{gcc} back end.
5253 To suppress these back end warnings as well, use the switch @option{-w}
5254 in addition to @option{-gnatws}.
5255
5256 @item -gnatwt
5257 @emph{Activate warnings for tracking of deleted conditional code.}
5258 @cindex @option{-gnatwt} (@command{gcc})
5259 @cindex Deactivated code, warnings
5260 @cindex Deleted code, warnings
5261 This switch activates warnings for tracking of code in conditionals (IF and
5262 CASE statements) that is detected to be dead code which cannot be executed, and
5263 which is removed by the front end. This warning is off by default, and is not
5264 turned on by @option{-gnatwa}, it has to be turned on explicitly. This may be
5265 useful for detecting deactivated code in certified applications.
5266
5267 @item -gnatwT
5268 @emph{Suppress warnings for tracking of deleted conditional code.}
5269 @cindex @option{-gnatwT} (@command{gcc})
5270 This switch suppresses warnings for tracking of deleted conditional code.
5271
5272 @item -gnatwu
5273 @emph{Activate warnings on unused entities.}
5274 @cindex @option{-gnatwu} (@command{gcc})
5275 This switch activates warnings to be generated for entities that
5276 are declared but not referenced, and for units that are @code{with}'ed
5277 and not
5278 referenced. In the case of packages, a warning is also generated if
5279 no entities in the package are referenced. This means that if the package
5280 is referenced but the only references are in @code{use}
5281 clauses or @code{renames}
5282 declarations, a warning is still generated. A warning is also generated
5283 for a generic package that is @code{with}'ed but never instantiated.
5284 In the case where a package or subprogram body is compiled, and there
5285 is a @code{with} on the corresponding spec
5286 that is only referenced in the body,
5287 a warning is also generated, noting that the
5288 @code{with} can be moved to the body. The default is that
5289 such warnings are not generated.
5290 This switch also activates warnings on unreferenced formals
5291 (it includes the effect of @option{-gnatwf}).
5292 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5293
5294 @item -gnatwU
5295 @emph{Suppress warnings on unused entities.}
5296 @cindex @option{-gnatwU} (@command{gcc})
5297 This switch suppresses warnings for unused entities and packages.
5298 It also turns off warnings on unreferenced formals (and thus includes
5299 the effect of @option{-gnatwF}).
5300
5301 @item -gnatwv
5302 @emph{Activate warnings on unassigned variables.}
5303 @cindex @option{-gnatwv} (@command{gcc})
5304 @cindex Unassigned variable warnings
5305 This switch activates warnings for access to variables which
5306 may not be properly initialized. The default is that
5307 such warnings are generated.
5308 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5309
5310 @item -gnatwV
5311 @emph{Suppress warnings on unassigned variables.}
5312 @cindex @option{-gnatwV} (@command{gcc})
5313 This switch suppresses warnings for access to variables which
5314 may not be properly initialized.
5315 For variables of a composite type, the warning can also be suppressed in
5316 Ada 2005 by using a default initialization with a box. For example, if
5317 Table is an array of records whose components are only partially uninitialized,
5318 then the following code:
5319
5320 @smallexample @c ada
5321 Tab : Table := (others => <>);
5322 @end smallexample
5323
5324 will suppress warnings on subsequent statements that access components
5325 of variable Tab.
5326
5327 @item -gnatww
5328 @emph{Activate warnings on wrong low bound assumption.}
5329 @cindex @option{-gnatww} (@command{gcc})
5330 @cindex String indexing warnings
5331 This switch activates warnings for indexing an unconstrained string parameter
5332 with a literal or S'Length. This is a case where the code is assuming that the
5333 low bound is one, which is in general not true (for example when a slice is
5334 passed). The default is that such warnings are generated.
5335 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5336
5337 @item -gnatwW
5338 @emph{Suppress warnings on wrong low bound assumption.}
5339 @cindex @option{-gnatwW} (@command{gcc})
5340 This switch suppresses warnings for indexing an unconstrained string parameter
5341 with a literal or S'Length. Note that this warning can also be suppressed
5342 in a particular case by adding an
5343 assertion that the lower bound is 1,
5344 as shown in the following example.
5345
5346 @smallexample @c ada
5347 procedure K (S : String) is
5348 pragma Assert (S'First = 1);
5349 @dots{}
5350 @end smallexample
5351
5352 @item -gnatw.w
5353 @emph{Activate warnings on unnecessary Warnings Off pragmas}
5354 @cindex @option{-gnatw.w} (@command{gcc})
5355 @cindex Warnings Off control
5356 This switch activates warnings for use of @code{pragma Warnings (Off, entity}
5357 where either the pragma is entirely useless (because it suppresses no
5358 warnings), or it could be replaced by @code{pragma Unreferenced} or
5359 @code{pragma Unmodified}.The default is that these warnings are not given.
5360 Note that this warning is not included in -gnatwa, it must be
5361 activated explicitly.
5362
5363 @item -gnatw.W
5364 @emph{Suppress warnings on unnecessary Warnings Off pragmas}
5365 @cindex @option{-gnatw.W} (@command{gcc})
5366 This switch suppresses warnings for use of @code{pragma Warnings (Off, entity}.
5367
5368 @item -gnatwx
5369 @emph{Activate warnings on Export/Import pragmas.}
5370 @cindex @option{-gnatwx} (@command{gcc})
5371 @cindex Export/Import pragma warnings
5372 This switch activates warnings on Export/Import pragmas when
5373 the compiler detects a possible conflict between the Ada and
5374 foreign language calling sequences. For example, the use of
5375 default parameters in a convention C procedure is dubious
5376 because the C compiler cannot supply the proper default, so
5377 a warning is issued. The default is that such warnings are
5378 generated.
5379 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5380
5381 @item -gnatwX
5382 @emph{Suppress warnings on Export/Import pragmas.}
5383 @cindex @option{-gnatwX} (@command{gcc})
5384 This switch suppresses warnings on Export/Import pragmas.
5385 The sense of this is that you are telling the compiler that
5386 you know what you are doing in writing the pragma, and it
5387 should not complain at you.
5388
5389 @item -gnatw.x
5390 @emph{Activate warnings for No_Exception_Propagation mode.}
5391 @cindex @option{-gnatwm} (@command{gcc})
5392 This switch activates warnings for exception usage when pragma Restrictions
5393 (No_Exception_Propagation) is in effect. Warnings are given for implicit or
5394 explicit exception raises which are not covered by a local handler, and for
5395 exception handlers which do not cover a local raise. The default is that these
5396 warnings are not given.
5397
5398 @item -gnatw.X
5399 @emph{Disable warnings for No_Exception_Propagation mode.}
5400 This switch disables warnings for exception usage when pragma Restrictions
5401 (No_Exception_Propagation) is in effect.
5402
5403 @item -gnatwy
5404 @emph{Activate warnings for Ada 2005 compatibility issues.}
5405 @cindex @option{-gnatwy} (@command{gcc})
5406 @cindex Ada 2005 compatibility issues warnings
5407 For the most part Ada 2005 is upwards compatible with Ada 95,
5408 but there are some exceptions (for example the fact that
5409 @code{interface} is now a reserved word in Ada 2005). This
5410 switch activates several warnings to help in identifying
5411 and correcting such incompatibilities. The default is that
5412 these warnings are generated. Note that at one point Ada 2005
5413 was called Ada 0Y, hence the choice of character.
5414 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5415
5416 @item -gnatwY
5417 @emph{Disable warnings for Ada 2005 compatibility issues.}
5418 @cindex @option{-gnatwY} (@command{gcc})
5419 @cindex Ada 2005 compatibility issues warnings
5420 This switch suppresses several warnings intended to help in identifying
5421 incompatibilities between Ada 95 and Ada 2005.
5422
5423 @item -gnatwz
5424 @emph{Activate warnings on unchecked conversions.}
5425 @cindex @option{-gnatwz} (@command{gcc})
5426 @cindex Unchecked_Conversion warnings
5427 This switch activates warnings for unchecked conversions
5428 where the types are known at compile time to have different
5429 sizes. The default
5430 is that such warnings are generated. Warnings are also
5431 generated for subprogram pointers with different conventions,
5432 and, on VMS only, for data pointers with different conventions.
5433 This warning can also be turned on using @option{-gnatwa}.
5434
5435 @item -gnatwZ
5436 @emph{Suppress warnings on unchecked conversions.}
5437 @cindex @option{-gnatwZ} (@command{gcc})
5438 This switch suppresses warnings for unchecked conversions
5439 where the types are known at compile time to have different
5440 sizes or conventions.
5441
5442 @item ^-Wunused^WARNINGS=UNUSED^
5443 @cindex @option{-Wunused}
5444 The warnings controlled by the @option{-gnatw} switch are generated by
5445 the front end of the compiler. The @option{GCC} back end can provide
5446 additional warnings and they are controlled by the @option{-W} switch.
5447 For example, @option{^-Wunused^WARNINGS=UNUSED^} activates back end
5448 warnings for entities that are declared but not referenced.
5449
5450 @item ^-Wuninitialized^WARNINGS=UNINITIALIZED^
5451 @cindex @option{-Wuninitialized}
5452 Similarly, @option{^-Wuninitialized^WARNINGS=UNINITIALIZED^} activates
5453 the back end warning for uninitialized variables. This switch must be
5454 used in conjunction with an optimization level greater than zero.
5455
5456 @item ^-Wall^/ALL_BACK_END_WARNINGS^
5457 @cindex @option{-Wall}
5458 This switch enables all the above warnings from the @option{GCC} back end.
5459 The code generator detects a number of warning situations that are missed
5460 by the @option{GNAT} front end, and this switch can be used to activate them.
5461 The use of this switch also sets the default front end warning mode to
5462 @option{-gnatwa}, that is, most front end warnings activated as well.
5463
5464 @item ^-w^/NO_BACK_END_WARNINGS^
5465 @cindex @option{-w}
5466 Conversely, this switch suppresses warnings from the @option{GCC} back end.
5467 The use of this switch also sets the default front end warning mode to
5468 @option{-gnatws}, that is, front end warnings suppressed as well.
5469
5470 @end table
5471
5472 @noindent
5473 @ifclear vms
5474 A string of warning parameters can be used in the same parameter. For example:
5475
5476 @smallexample
5477 -gnatwaLe
5478 @end smallexample
5479
5480 @noindent
5481 will turn on all optional warnings except for elaboration pragma warnings,
5482 and also specify that warnings should be treated as errors.
5483 @end ifclear
5484 When no switch @option{^-gnatw^/WARNINGS^} is used, this is equivalent to:
5485
5486 @table @option
5487 @c !sort!
5488 @item -gnatwC
5489 @item -gnatwD
5490 @item -gnatwF
5491 @item -gnatwg
5492 @item -gnatwH
5493 @item -gnatwi
5494 @item -gnatwJ
5495 @item -gnatwK
5496 @item -gnatwL
5497 @item -gnatwM
5498 @item -gnatwn
5499 @item -gnatwo
5500 @item -gnatwP
5501 @item -gnatwR
5502 @item -gnatwU
5503 @item -gnatwv
5504 @item -gnatwz
5505 @item -gnatwx
5506
5507 @end table
5508
5509 @node Debugging and Assertion Control
5510 @subsection Debugging and Assertion Control
5511
5512 @table @option
5513 @item -gnata
5514 @cindex @option{-gnata} (@command{gcc})
5515 @findex Assert
5516 @findex Debug
5517 @cindex Assertions
5518
5519 @noindent
5520 The pragmas @code{Assert} and @code{Debug} normally have no effect and
5521 are ignored. This switch, where @samp{a} stands for assert, causes
5522 @code{Assert} and @code{Debug} pragmas to be activated.
5523
5524 The pragmas have the form:
5525
5526 @smallexample
5527 @cartouche
5528 @b{pragma} Assert (@var{Boolean-expression} @r{[},
5529 @var{static-string-expression}@r{]})
5530 @b{pragma} Debug (@var{procedure call})
5531 @end cartouche
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @noindent
5535 The @code{Assert} pragma causes @var{Boolean-expression} to be tested.
5536 If the result is @code{True}, the pragma has no effect (other than
5537 possible side effects from evaluating the expression). If the result is
5538 @code{False}, the exception @code{Assert_Failure} declared in the package
5539 @code{System.Assertions} is
5540 raised (passing @var{static-string-expression}, if present, as the
5541 message associated with the exception). If no string expression is
5542 given the default is a string giving the file name and line number
5543 of the pragma.
5544
5545 The @code{Debug} pragma causes @var{procedure} to be called. Note that
5546 @code{pragma Debug} may appear within a declaration sequence, allowing
5547 debugging procedures to be called between declarations.
5548
5549 @ifset vms
5550 @item /DEBUG@r{[}=debug-level@r{]}
5551 @itemx /NODEBUG
5552 Specifies how much debugging information is to be included in
5553 the resulting object file where 'debug-level' is one of the following:
5554 @table @code
5555 @item TRACEBACK
5556 Include both debugger symbol records and traceback
5557 the object file.
5558 This is the default setting.
5559 @item ALL
5560 Include both debugger symbol records and traceback in
5561 object file.
5562 @item NONE
5563 Excludes both debugger symbol records and traceback
5564 the object file. Same as /NODEBUG.
5565 @item SYMBOLS
5566 Includes only debugger symbol records in the object
5567 file. Note that this doesn't include traceback information.
5568 @end table
5569 @end ifset
5570 @end table
5571
5572 @node Validity Checking
5573 @subsection Validity Checking
5574 @findex Validity Checking
5575
5576 @noindent
5577 The Ada Reference Manual has specific requirements for checking
5578 for invalid values. In particular, RM 13.9.1 requires that the
5579 evaluation of invalid values (for example from unchecked conversions),
5580 not result in erroneous execution. In GNAT, the result of such an
5581 evaluation in normal default mode is to either use the value
5582 unmodified, or to raise Constraint_Error in those cases where use
5583 of the unmodified value would cause erroneous execution. The cases
5584 where unmodified values might lead to erroneous execution are case
5585 statements (where a wild jump might result from an invalid value),
5586 and subscripts on the left hand side (where memory corruption could
5587 occur as a result of an invalid value).
5588
5589 The @option{-gnatV^@var{x}^^} switch allows more control over the validity
5590 checking mode.
5591 @ifclear vms
5592 The @code{x} argument is a string of letters that
5593 indicate validity checks that are performed or not performed in addition
5594 to the default checks described above.
5595 @end ifclear
5596 @ifset vms
5597 The options allowed for this qualifier
5598 indicate validity checks that are performed or not performed in addition
5599 to the default checks described above.
5600 @end ifset
5601
5602 @table @option
5603 @c !sort!
5604 @item -gnatVa
5605 @emph{All validity checks.}
5606 @cindex @option{-gnatVa} (@command{gcc})
5607 All validity checks are turned on.
5608 @ifclear vms
5609 That is, @option{-gnatVa} is
5610 equivalent to @option{gnatVcdfimorst}.
5611 @end ifclear
5612
5613 @item -gnatVc
5614 @emph{Validity checks for copies.}
5615 @cindex @option{-gnatVc} (@command{gcc})
5616 The right hand side of assignments, and the initializing values of
5617 object declarations are validity checked.
5618
5619 @item -gnatVd
5620 @emph{Default (RM) validity checks.}
5621 @cindex @option{-gnatVd} (@command{gcc})
5622 Some validity checks are done by default following normal Ada semantics
5623 (RM 13.9.1 (9-11)).
5624 A check is done in case statements that the expression is within the range
5625 of the subtype. If it is not, Constraint_Error is raised.
5626 For assignments to array components, a check is done that the expression used
5627 as index is within the range. If it is not, Constraint_Error is raised.
5628 Both these validity checks may be turned off using switch @option{-gnatVD}.
5629 They are turned on by default. If @option{-gnatVD} is specified, a subsequent
5630 switch @option{-gnatVd} will leave the checks turned on.
5631 Switch @option{-gnatVD} should be used only if you are sure that all such
5632 expressions have valid values. If you use this switch and invalid values
5633 are present, then the program is erroneous, and wild jumps or memory
5634 overwriting may occur.
5635
5636 @item -gnatVe
5637 @emph{Validity checks for elementary components.}
5638 @cindex @option{-gnatVe} (@command{gcc})
5639 In the absence of this switch, assignments to record or array components are
5640 not validity checked, even if validity checks for assignments generally
5641 (@option{-gnatVc}) are turned on. In Ada, assignment of composite values do not
5642 require valid data, but assignment of individual components does. So for
5643 example, there is a difference between copying the elements of an array with a
5644 slice assignment, compared to assigning element by element in a loop. This
5645 switch allows you to turn off validity checking for components, even when they
5646 are assigned component by component.
5647
5648 @item -gnatVf
5649 @emph{Validity checks for floating-point values.}
5650 @cindex @option{-gnatVf} (@command{gcc})
5651 In the absence of this switch, validity checking occurs only for discrete
5652 values. If @option{-gnatVf} is specified, then validity checking also applies
5653 for floating-point values, and NaNs and infinities are considered invalid,
5654 as well as out of range values for constrained types. Note that this means
5655 that standard IEEE infinity mode is not allowed. The exact contexts
5656 in which floating-point values are checked depends on the setting of other
5657 options. For example,
5658 @option{^-gnatVif^VALIDITY_CHECKING=(IN_PARAMS,FLOATS)^} or
5659 @option{^-gnatVfi^VALIDITY_CHECKING=(FLOATS,IN_PARAMS)^}
5660 (the order does not matter) specifies that floating-point parameters of mode
5661 @code{in} should be validity checked.
5662
5663 @item -gnatVi
5664 @emph{Validity checks for @code{in} mode parameters}
5665 @cindex @option{-gnatVi} (@command{gcc})
5666 Arguments for parameters of mode @code{in} are validity checked in function
5667 and procedure calls at the point of call.
5668
5669 @item -gnatVm
5670 @emph{Validity checks for @code{in out} mode parameters.}
5671 @cindex @option{-gnatVm} (@command{gcc})
5672 Arguments for parameters of mode @code{in out} are validity checked in
5673 procedure calls at the point of call. The @code{'m'} here stands for
5674 modify, since this concerns parameters that can be modified by the call.
5675 Note that there is no specific option to test @code{out} parameters,
5676 but any reference within the subprogram will be tested in the usual
5677 manner, and if an invalid value is copied back, any reference to it
5678 will be subject to validity checking.
5679
5680 @item -gnatVn
5681 @emph{No validity checks.}
5682 @cindex @option{-gnatVn} (@command{gcc})
5683 This switch turns off all validity checking, including the default checking
5684 for case statements and left hand side subscripts. Note that the use of
5685 the switch @option{-gnatp} suppresses all run-time checks, including
5686 validity checks, and thus implies @option{-gnatVn}. When this switch
5687 is used, it cancels any other @option{-gnatV} previously issued.
5688
5689 @item -gnatVo
5690 @emph{Validity checks for operator and attribute operands.}
5691 @cindex @option{-gnatVo} (@command{gcc})
5692 Arguments for predefined operators and attributes are validity checked.
5693 This includes all operators in package @code{Standard},
5694 the shift operators defined as intrinsic in package @code{Interfaces}
5695 and operands for attributes such as @code{Pos}. Checks are also made
5696 on individual component values for composite comparisons, and on the
5697 expressions in type conversions and qualified expressions. Checks are
5698 also made on explicit ranges using @samp{..} (e.g.@: slices, loops etc).
5699
5700 @item -gnatVp
5701 @emph{Validity checks for parameters.}
5702 @cindex @option{-gnatVp} (@command{gcc})
5703 This controls the treatment of parameters within a subprogram (as opposed
5704 to @option{-gnatVi} and @option{-gnatVm} which control validity testing
5705 of parameters on a call. If either of these call options is used, then
5706 normally an assumption is made within a subprogram that the input arguments
5707 have been validity checking at the point of call, and do not need checking
5708 again within a subprogram). If @option{-gnatVp} is set, then this assumption
5709 is not made, and parameters are not assumed to be valid, so their validity
5710 will be checked (or rechecked) within the subprogram.
5711
5712 @item -gnatVr
5713 @emph{Validity checks for function returns.}
5714 @cindex @option{-gnatVr} (@command{gcc})
5715 The expression in @code{return} statements in functions is validity
5716 checked.
5717
5718 @item -gnatVs
5719 @emph{Validity checks for subscripts.}
5720 @cindex @option{-gnatVs} (@command{gcc})
5721 All subscripts expressions are checked for validity, whether they appear
5722 on the right side or left side (in default mode only left side subscripts
5723 are validity checked).
5724
5725 @item -gnatVt
5726 @emph{Validity checks for tests.}
5727 @cindex @option{-gnatVt} (@command{gcc})
5728 Expressions used as conditions in @code{if}, @code{while} or @code{exit}
5729 statements are checked, as well as guard expressions in entry calls.
5730
5731 @end table
5732
5733 @noindent
5734 The @option{-gnatV} switch may be followed by
5735 ^a string of letters^a list of options^
5736 to turn on a series of validity checking options.
5737 For example,
5738 @option{^-gnatVcr^/VALIDITY_CHECKING=(COPIES, RETURNS)^}
5739 specifies that in addition to the default validity checking, copies and
5740 function return expressions are to be validity checked.
5741 In order to make it easier
5742 to specify the desired combination of effects,
5743 @ifclear vms
5744 the upper case letters @code{CDFIMORST} may
5745 be used to turn off the corresponding lower case option.
5746 @end ifclear
5747 @ifset vms
5748 the prefix @code{NO} on an option turns off the corresponding validity
5749 checking:
5750 @itemize @bullet
5751 @item @code{NOCOPIES}
5752 @item @code{NODEFAULT}
5753 @item @code{NOFLOATS}
5754 @item @code{NOIN_PARAMS}
5755 @item @code{NOMOD_PARAMS}
5756 @item @code{NOOPERANDS}
5757 @item @code{NORETURNS}
5758 @item @code{NOSUBSCRIPTS}
5759 @item @code{NOTESTS}
5760 @end itemize
5761 @end ifset
5762 Thus
5763 @option{^-gnatVaM^/VALIDITY_CHECKING=(ALL, NOMOD_PARAMS)^}
5764 turns on all validity checking options except for
5765 checking of @code{@b{in out}} procedure arguments.
5766
5767 The specification of additional validity checking generates extra code (and
5768 in the case of @option{-gnatVa} the code expansion can be substantial).
5769 However, these additional checks can be very useful in detecting
5770 uninitialized variables, incorrect use of unchecked conversion, and other
5771 errors leading to invalid values. The use of pragma @code{Initialize_Scalars}
5772 is useful in conjunction with the extra validity checking, since this
5773 ensures that wherever possible uninitialized variables have invalid values.
5774
5775 See also the pragma @code{Validity_Checks} which allows modification of
5776 the validity checking mode at the program source level, and also allows for
5777 temporary disabling of validity checks.
5778
5779 @node Style Checking
5780 @subsection Style Checking
5781 @findex Style checking
5782
5783 @noindent
5784 The @option{-gnaty^x^(option,option,@dots{})^} switch
5785 @cindex @option{-gnaty} (@command{gcc})
5786 causes the compiler to
5787 enforce specified style rules. A limited set of style rules has been used
5788 in writing the GNAT sources themselves. This switch allows user programs
5789 to activate all or some of these checks. If the source program fails a
5790 specified style check, an appropriate warning message is given, preceded by
5791 the character sequence ``(style)''.
5792 @ifset vms
5793 @code{(option,option,@dots{})} is a sequence of keywords
5794 @end ifset
5795 @ifclear vms
5796 The string @var{x} is a sequence of letters or digits
5797 @end ifclear
5798 indicating the particular style
5799 checks to be performed. The following checks are defined:
5800
5801 @table @option
5802 @c !sort!
5803 @item 0-9
5804 @emph{Specify indentation level.}
5805 If a digit from 1-9 appears
5806 ^in the string after @option{-gnaty}^as an option for /STYLE_CHECKS^
5807 then proper indentation is checked, with the digit indicating the
5808 indentation level required. A value of zero turns off this style check.
5809 The general style of required indentation is as specified by
5810 the examples in the Ada Reference Manual. Full line comments must be
5811 aligned with the @code{--} starting on a column that is a multiple of
5812 the alignment level, or they may be aligned the same way as the following
5813 non-blank line (this is useful when full line comments appear in the middle
5814 of a statement.
5815
5816 @item ^a^ATTRIBUTE^
5817 @emph{Check attribute casing.}
5818 Attribute names, including the case of keywords such as @code{digits}
5819 used as attributes names, must be written in mixed case, that is, the
5820 initial letter and any letter following an underscore must be uppercase.
5821 All other letters must be lowercase.
5822
5823 @item ^A^ARRAY_INDEXES^
5824 @emph{Use of array index numbers in array attributes.}
5825 When using the array attributes First, Last, Range,
5826 or Length, the index number must be omitted for one-dimensional arrays
5827 and is required for multi-dimensional arrays.
5828
5829 @item ^b^BLANKS^
5830 @emph{Blanks not allowed at statement end.}
5831 Trailing blanks are not allowed at the end of statements. The purpose of this
5832 rule, together with h (no horizontal tabs), is to enforce a canonical format
5833 for the use of blanks to separate source tokens.
5834
5835 @item ^c^COMMENTS^
5836 @emph{Check comments.}
5837 Comments must meet the following set of rules:
5838
5839 @itemize @bullet
5840
5841 @item
5842 The ``@code{--}'' that starts the column must either start in column one,
5843 or else at least one blank must precede this sequence.
5844
5845 @item
5846 Comments that follow other tokens on a line must have at least one blank
5847 following the ``@code{--}'' at the start of the comment.
5848
5849 @item
5850 Full line comments must have two blanks following the ``@code{--}'' that
5851 starts the comment, with the following exceptions.
5852
5853 @item
5854 A line consisting only of the ``@code{--}'' characters, possibly preceded
5855 by blanks is permitted.
5856
5857 @item
5858 A comment starting with ``@code{--x}'' where @code{x} is a special character
5859 is permitted.
5860 This allows proper processing of the output generated by specialized tools
5861 including @command{gnatprep} (where ``@code{--!}'' is used) and the SPARK
5862 annotation
5863 language (where ``@code{--#}'' is used). For the purposes of this rule, a
5864 special character is defined as being in one of the ASCII ranges
5865 @code{16#21#@dots{}16#2F#} or @code{16#3A#@dots{}16#3F#}.
5866 Note that this usage is not permitted
5867 in GNAT implementation units (i.e., when @option{-gnatg} is used).
5868
5869 @item
5870 A line consisting entirely of minus signs, possibly preceded by blanks, is
5871 permitted. This allows the construction of box comments where lines of minus
5872 signs are used to form the top and bottom of the box.
5873
5874 @item
5875 A comment that starts and ends with ``@code{--}'' is permitted as long as at
5876 least one blank follows the initial ``@code{--}''. Together with the preceding
5877 rule, this allows the construction of box comments, as shown in the following
5878 example:
5879 @smallexample
5880 ---------------------------
5881 -- This is a box comment --
5882 -- with two text lines. --
5883 ---------------------------
5884 @end smallexample
5885 @end itemize
5886
5887 @item ^d^DOS_LINE_ENDINGS^
5888 @emph{Check no DOS line terminators present.}
5889 All lines must be terminated by a single ASCII.LF
5890 character (in particular the DOS line terminator sequence CR/LF is not
5891 allowed).
5892
5893 @item ^e^END^
5894 @emph{Check end/exit labels.}
5895 Optional labels on @code{end} statements ending subprograms and on
5896 @code{exit} statements exiting named loops, are required to be present.
5897
5898 @item ^f^VTABS^
5899 @emph{No form feeds or vertical tabs.}
5900 Neither form feeds nor vertical tab characters are permitted
5901 in the source text.
5902
5903 @item ^g^GNAT^
5904 @emph{GNAT style mode}
5905 The set of style check switches is set to match that used by the GNAT sources.
5906 This may be useful when developing code that is eventually intended to be
5907 incorporated into GNAT. For further details, see GNAT sources.
5908
5909 @item ^h^HTABS^
5910 @emph{No horizontal tabs.}
5911 Horizontal tab characters are not permitted in the source text.
5912 Together with the b (no blanks at end of line) check, this
5913 enforces a canonical form for the use of blanks to separate
5914 source tokens.
5915
5916 @item ^i^IF_THEN^
5917 @emph{Check if-then layout.}
5918 The keyword @code{then} must appear either on the same
5919 line as corresponding @code{if}, or on a line on its own, lined
5920 up under the @code{if} with at least one non-blank line in between
5921 containing all or part of the condition to be tested.
5922
5923 @item ^I^IN_MODE^
5924 @emph{check mode IN keywords}
5925 Mode @code{in} (the default mode) is not
5926 allowed to be given explicitly. @code{in out} is fine,
5927 but not @code{in} on its own.
5928
5929 @item ^k^KEYWORD^
5930 @emph{Check keyword casing.}
5931 All keywords must be in lower case (with the exception of keywords
5932 such as @code{digits} used as attribute names to which this check
5933 does not apply).
5934
5935 @item ^l^LAYOUT^
5936 @emph{Check layout.}
5937 Layout of statement and declaration constructs must follow the
5938 recommendations in the Ada Reference Manual, as indicated by the
5939 form of the syntax rules. For example an @code{else} keyword must
5940 be lined up with the corresponding @code{if} keyword.
5941
5942 There are two respects in which the style rule enforced by this check
5943 option are more liberal than those in the Ada Reference Manual. First
5944 in the case of record declarations, it is permissible to put the
5945 @code{record} keyword on the same line as the @code{type} keyword, and
5946 then the @code{end} in @code{end record} must line up under @code{type}.
5947 This is also permitted when the type declaration is split on two lines.
5948 For example, any of the following three layouts is acceptable:
5949
5950 @smallexample @c ada
5951 @cartouche
5952 type q is record
5953 a : integer;
5954 b : integer;
5955 end record;
5956
5957 type q is
5958 record
5959 a : integer;
5960 b : integer;
5961 end record;
5962
5963 type q is
5964 record
5965 a : integer;
5966 b : integer;
5967 end record;
5968
5969 @end cartouche
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @noindent
5973 Second, in the case of a block statement, a permitted alternative
5974 is to put the block label on the same line as the @code{declare} or
5975 @code{begin} keyword, and then line the @code{end} keyword up under
5976 the block label. For example both the following are permitted:
5977
5978 @smallexample @c ada
5979 @cartouche
5980 Block : declare
5981 A : Integer := 3;
5982 begin
5983 Proc (A, A);
5984 end Block;
5985
5986 Block :
5987 declare
5988 A : Integer := 3;
5989 begin
5990 Proc (A, A);
5991 end Block;
5992 @end cartouche
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @noindent
5996 The same alternative format is allowed for loops. For example, both of
5997 the following are permitted:
5998
5999 @smallexample @c ada
6000 @cartouche
6001 Clear : while J < 10 loop
6002 A (J) := 0;
6003 end loop Clear;
6004
6005 Clear :
6006 while J < 10 loop
6007 A (J) := 0;
6008 end loop Clear;
6009 @end cartouche
6010 @end smallexample
6011
6012 @item ^Lnnn^MAX_NESTING=nnn^
6013 @emph{Set maximum nesting level}
6014 The maximum level of nesting of constructs (including subprograms, loops,
6015 blocks, packages, and conditionals) may not exceed the given value
6016 @option{nnn}. A value of zero disconnects this style check.
6017
6018 @item ^m^LINE_LENGTH^
6019 @emph{Check maximum line length.}
6020 The length of source lines must not exceed 79 characters, including
6021 any trailing blanks. The value of 79 allows convenient display on an
6022 80 character wide device or window, allowing for possible special
6023 treatment of 80 character lines. Note that this count is of
6024 characters in the source text. This means that a tab character counts
6025 as one character in this count but a wide character sequence counts as
6026 a single character (however many bytes are needed in the encoding).
6027
6028 @item ^Mnnn^MAX_LENGTH=nnn^
6029 @emph{Set maximum line length.}
6030 The length of lines must not exceed the
6031 given value @option{nnn}. The maximum value that can be specified is 32767.
6032
6033 @item ^n^STANDARD_CASING^
6034 @emph{Check casing of entities in Standard.}
6035 Any identifier from Standard must be cased
6036 to match the presentation in the Ada Reference Manual (for example,
6037 @code{Integer} and @code{ASCII.NUL}).
6038
6039 @item ^N^NONE^
6040 @emph{Turn off all style checks}
6041 All style check options are turned off.
6042
6043 @item ^o^ORDERED_SUBPROGRAMS^
6044 @emph{Check order of subprogram bodies.}
6045 All subprogram bodies in a given scope
6046 (e.g.@: a package body) must be in alphabetical order. The ordering
6047 rule uses normal Ada rules for comparing strings, ignoring casing
6048 of letters, except that if there is a trailing numeric suffix, then
6049 the value of this suffix is used in the ordering (e.g.@: Junk2 comes
6050 before Junk10).
6051
6052 @item ^p^PRAGMA^
6053 @emph{Check pragma casing.}
6054 Pragma names must be written in mixed case, that is, the
6055 initial letter and any letter following an underscore must be uppercase.
6056 All other letters must be lowercase.
6057
6058 @item ^r^REFERENCES^
6059 @emph{Check references.}
6060 All identifier references must be cased in the same way as the
6061 corresponding declaration. No specific casing style is imposed on
6062 identifiers. The only requirement is for consistency of references
6063 with declarations.
6064
6065 @item ^S^STATEMENTS_AFTER_THEN_ELSE^
6066 @emph{Check no statements after THEN/ELSE.}
6067 No statements are allowed
6068 on the same line as a THEN or ELSE keyword following the
6069 keyword in an IF statement. OR ELSE and AND THEN are not affected,
6070 and a special exception allows a pragma to appear after ELSE.
6071
6072 @item ^s^SPECS^
6073 @emph{Check separate specs.}
6074 Separate declarations (``specs'') are required for subprograms (a
6075 body is not allowed to serve as its own declaration). The only
6076 exception is that parameterless library level procedures are
6077 not required to have a separate declaration. This exception covers
6078 the most frequent form of main program procedures.
6079
6080 @item ^t^TOKEN^
6081 @emph{Check token spacing.}
6082 The following token spacing rules are enforced:
6083
6084 @itemize @bullet
6085
6086 @item
6087 The keywords @code{@b{abs}} and @code{@b{not}} must be followed by a space.
6088
6089 @item
6090 The token @code{=>} must be surrounded by spaces.
6091
6092 @item
6093 The token @code{<>} must be preceded by a space or a left parenthesis.
6094
6095 @item
6096 Binary operators other than @code{**} must be surrounded by spaces.
6097 There is no restriction on the layout of the @code{**} binary operator.
6098
6099 @item
6100 Colon must be surrounded by spaces.
6101
6102 @item
6103 Colon-equal (assignment, initialization) must be surrounded by spaces.
6104
6105 @item
6106 Comma must be the first non-blank character on the line, or be
6107 immediately preceded by a non-blank character, and must be followed
6108 by a space.
6109
6110 @item
6111 If the token preceding a left parenthesis ends with a letter or digit, then
6112 a space must separate the two tokens.
6113
6114 @item
6115 A right parenthesis must either be the first non-blank character on
6116 a line, or it must be preceded by a non-blank character.
6117
6118 @item
6119 A semicolon must not be preceded by a space, and must not be followed by
6120 a non-blank character.
6121
6122 @item
6123 A unary plus or minus may not be followed by a space.
6124
6125 @item
6126 A vertical bar must be surrounded by spaces.
6127 @end itemize
6128
6129 @item ^u^UNNECESSARY_BLANK_LINES^
6130 @emph{Check unnecessary blank lines.}
6131 Unnecessary blank lines are not allowed. A blank line is considered
6132 unnecessary if it appears at the end of the file, or if more than
6133 one blank line occurs in sequence.
6134
6135 @item ^x^XTRA_PARENS^
6136 @emph{Check extra parentheses.}
6137 Unnecessary extra level of parentheses (C-style) are not allowed
6138 around conditions in @code{if} statements, @code{while} statements and
6139 @code{exit} statements.
6140
6141 @item ^y^ALL_BUILTIN^
6142 @emph{Set all standard style check options}
6143 This is equivalent to @code{gnaty3aAbcefhiklmnprst}, that is all checking
6144 options enabled with the exception of @option{-gnatyo}, @option{-gnatyI},
6145 @option{-gnatyS}, @option{-gnatyLnnn},
6146 @option{-gnatyd}, @option{-gnatyu}, and @option{-gnatyx}.
6147
6148 @ifclear vms
6149 @item -
6150 @emph{Remove style check options}
6151 This causes any subsequent options in the string to act as canceling the
6152 corresponding style check option. To cancel maximum nesting level control,
6153 use @option{L} parameter witout any integer value after that, because any
6154 digit following @option{-} in the parameter string of the @option{-gnaty}
6155 option will be threated as canceling indentation check. The same is true
6156 for @option{M} parameter. @option{y} and @option{N} parameters are not
6157 allowed after @option{-}.
6158
6159 @item +
6160 This causes any subsequent options in the string to enable the corresponding
6161 style check option. That is, it cancels the effect of a previous ^-^REMOVE^,
6162 if any.
6163 @end ifclear
6164
6165 @ifset vms
6166 @item NOxxx
6167 @emph{Removing style check options}
6168 If the name of a style check is preceded by @option{NO} then the corresponding
6169 style check is turned off. For example @option{NOCOMMENTS} turns off style
6170 checking for comments.
6171 @end ifset
6172 @end table
6173
6174 @noindent
6175 In the above rules, appearing in column one is always permitted, that is,
6176 counts as meeting either a requirement for a required preceding space,
6177 or as meeting a requirement for no preceding space.
6178
6179 Appearing at the end of a line is also always permitted, that is, counts
6180 as meeting either a requirement for a following space, or as meeting
6181 a requirement for no following space.
6182
6183 @noindent
6184 If any of these style rules is violated, a message is generated giving
6185 details on the violation. The initial characters of such messages are
6186 always ``@code{(style)}''. Note that these messages are treated as warning
6187 messages, so they normally do not prevent the generation of an object
6188 file. The @option{-gnatwe} switch can be used to treat warning messages,
6189 including style messages, as fatal errors.
6190
6191 The switch
6192 @ifclear vms
6193 @option{-gnaty} on its own (that is not
6194 followed by any letters or digits), then the effect is equivalent
6195 to the use of @option{-gnatyy}, as described above, that is all
6196 built-in standard style check options are enabled.
6197
6198 @end ifclear
6199 @ifset vms
6200 /STYLE_CHECKS=ALL_BUILTIN enables all checking options with
6201 the exception of ORDERED_SUBPROGRAMS, UNNECESSARY_BLANK_LINES,
6202 XTRA_PARENS, and DOS_LINE_ENDINGS. In addition
6203 @end ifset
6204
6205
6206
6207 The switch
6208 @ifclear vms
6209 @option{-gnatyN}
6210 @end ifclear
6211 @ifset vms
6212 /STYLE_CHECKS=NONE
6213 @end ifset
6214 clears any previously set style checks.
6215
6216 @node Run-Time Checks
6217 @subsection Run-Time Checks
6218 @cindex Division by zero
6219 @cindex Access before elaboration
6220 @cindex Checks, division by zero
6221 @cindex Checks, access before elaboration
6222 @cindex Checks, stack overflow checking
6223
6224 @noindent
6225 By default, the following checks are suppressed: integer overflow
6226 checks, stack overflow checks, and checks for access before
6227 elaboration on subprogram calls. All other checks, including range
6228 checks and array bounds checks, are turned on by default. The
6229 following @command{gcc} switches refine this default behavior.
6230
6231 @table @option
6232 @c !sort!
6233 @item -gnatp
6234 @cindex @option{-gnatp} (@command{gcc})
6235 @cindex Suppressing checks
6236 @cindex Checks, suppressing
6237 @findex Suppress
6238 Suppress all run-time checks as though @code{pragma Suppress (All_checks)}
6239 had been present in the source. Validity checks are also suppressed (in
6240 other words @option{-gnatp} also implies @option{-gnatVn}.
6241 Use this switch to improve the performance
6242 of the code at the expense of safety in the presence of invalid data or
6243 program bugs.
6244
6245 Note that when checks are suppressed, the compiler is allowed, but not
6246 required, to omit the checking code. If the run-time cost of the
6247 checking code is zero or near-zero, the compiler will generate it even
6248 if checks are suppressed. In particular, if the compiler can prove
6249 that a certain check will necessarily fail, it will generate code to
6250 do an unconditional ``raise'', even if checks are suppressed. The
6251 compiler warns in this case.
6252
6253 Of course, run-time checks are omitted whenever the compiler can prove
6254 that they will not fail, whether or not checks are suppressed.
6255
6256 Note that if you suppress a check that would have failed, program
6257 execution is erroneous, which means the behavior is totally
6258 unpredictable. The program might crash, or print wrong answers, or
6259 do anything else. It might even do exactly what you wanted it to do
6260 (and then it might start failing mysteriously next week or next
6261 year). The compiler will generate code based on the assumption that
6262 the condition being checked is true, which can result in disaster if
6263 that assumption is wrong.
6264
6265 @item -gnato
6266 @cindex @option{-gnato} (@command{gcc})
6267 @cindex Overflow checks
6268 @cindex Check, overflow
6269 Enables overflow checking for integer operations.
6270 This causes GNAT to generate slower and larger executable
6271 programs by adding code to check for overflow (resulting in raising
6272 @code{Constraint_Error} as required by standard Ada
6273 semantics). These overflow checks correspond to situations in which
6274 the true value of the result of an operation may be outside the base
6275 range of the result type. The following example shows the distinction:
6276
6277 @smallexample @c ada
6278 X1 : Integer := "Integer'Last";
6279 X2 : Integer range 1 .. 5 := "5";
6280 X3 : Integer := "Integer'Last";
6281 X4 : Integer range 1 .. 5 := "5";
6282 F : Float := "2.0E+20";
6283 @dots{}
6284 X1 := X1 + 1;
6285 X2 := X2 + 1;
6286 X3 := Integer (F);
6287 X4 := Integer (F);
6288 @end smallexample
6289
6290 @noindent
6291 Note that if explicit values are assigned at compile time, the
6292 compiler may be able to detect overflow at compile time, in which case
6293 no actual run-time checking code is required, and Constraint_Error
6294 will be raised unconditionally, with or without
6295 @option{-gnato}. That's why the assigned values in the above fragment
6296 are in quotes, the meaning is "assign a value not known to the
6297 compiler that happens to be equal to ...". The remaining discussion
6298 assumes that the compiler cannot detect the values at compile time.
6299
6300 Here the first addition results in a value that is outside the base range
6301 of Integer, and hence requires an overflow check for detection of the
6302 constraint error. Thus the first assignment to @code{X1} raises a
6303 @code{Constraint_Error} exception only if @option{-gnato} is set.
6304
6305 The second increment operation results in a violation of the explicit
6306 range constraint; such range checks are performed by default, and are
6307 unaffected by @option{-gnato}.
6308
6309 The two conversions of @code{F} both result in values that are outside
6310 the base range of type @code{Integer} and thus will raise
6311 @code{Constraint_Error} exceptions only if @option{-gnato} is used.
6312 The fact that the result of the second conversion is assigned to
6313 variable @code{X4} with a restricted range is irrelevant, since the problem
6314 is in the conversion, not the assignment.
6315
6316 Basically the rule is that in the default mode (@option{-gnato} not
6317 used), the generated code assures that all integer variables stay
6318 within their declared ranges, or within the base range if there is
6319 no declared range. This prevents any serious problems like indexes
6320 out of range for array operations.
6321
6322 What is not checked in default mode is an overflow that results in
6323 an in-range, but incorrect value. In the above example, the assignments
6324 to @code{X1}, @code{X2}, @code{X3} all give results that are within the
6325 range of the target variable, but the result is wrong in the sense that
6326 it is too large to be represented correctly. Typically the assignment
6327 to @code{X1} will result in wrap around to the largest negative number.
6328 The conversions of @code{F} will result in some @code{Integer} value
6329 and if that integer value is out of the @code{X4} range then the
6330 subsequent assignment would generate an exception.
6331
6332 @findex Machine_Overflows
6333 Note that the @option{-gnato} switch does not affect the code generated
6334 for any floating-point operations; it applies only to integer
6335 semantics).
6336 For floating-point, GNAT has the @code{Machine_Overflows}
6337 attribute set to @code{False} and the normal mode of operation is to
6338 generate IEEE NaN and infinite values on overflow or invalid operations
6339 (such as dividing 0.0 by 0.0).
6340
6341 The reason that we distinguish overflow checking from other kinds of
6342 range constraint checking is that a failure of an overflow check, unlike
6343 for example the failure of a range check, can result in an incorrect
6344 value, but cannot cause random memory destruction (like an out of range
6345 subscript), or a wild jump (from an out of range case value). Overflow
6346 checking is also quite expensive in time and space, since in general it
6347 requires the use of double length arithmetic.
6348
6349 Note again that @option{-gnato} is off by default, so overflow checking is
6350 not performed in default mode. This means that out of the box, with the
6351 default settings, GNAT does not do all the checks expected from the
6352 language description in the Ada Reference Manual. If you want all constraint
6353 checks to be performed, as described in this Manual, then you must
6354 explicitly use the -gnato switch either on the @command{gnatmake} or
6355 @command{gcc} command.
6356
6357 @item -gnatE
6358 @cindex @option{-gnatE} (@command{gcc})
6359 @cindex Elaboration checks
6360 @cindex Check, elaboration
6361 Enables dynamic checks for access-before-elaboration
6362 on subprogram calls and generic instantiations.
6363 Note that @option{-gnatE} is not necessary for safety, because in the
6364 default mode, GNAT ensures statically that the checks would not fail.
6365 For full details of the effect and use of this switch,
6366 @xref{Compiling Using gcc}.
6367
6368 @item -fstack-check
6369 @cindex @option{-fstack-check} (@command{gcc})
6370 @cindex Stack Overflow Checking
6371 @cindex Checks, stack overflow checking
6372 Activates stack overflow checking. For full details of the effect and use of
6373 this switch see @ref{Stack Overflow Checking}.
6374 @end table
6375
6376 @findex Unsuppress
6377 @noindent
6378 The setting of these switches only controls the default setting of the
6379 checks. You may modify them using either @code{Suppress} (to remove
6380 checks) or @code{Unsuppress} (to add back suppressed checks) pragmas in
6381 the program source.
6382
6383 @node Using gcc for Syntax Checking
6384 @subsection Using @command{gcc} for Syntax Checking
6385 @table @option
6386 @item -gnats
6387 @cindex @option{-gnats} (@command{gcc})
6388 @ifclear vms
6389
6390 @noindent
6391 The @code{s} stands for ``syntax''.
6392 @end ifclear
6393
6394 Run GNAT in syntax checking only mode. For
6395 example, the command
6396
6397 @smallexample
6398 $ gcc -c -gnats x.adb
6399 @end smallexample
6400
6401 @noindent
6402 compiles file @file{x.adb} in syntax-check-only mode. You can check a
6403 series of files in a single command
6404 @ifclear vms
6405 , and can use wild cards to specify such a group of files.
6406 Note that you must specify the @option{-c} (compile
6407 only) flag in addition to the @option{-gnats} flag.
6408 @end ifclear
6409 .
6410 You may use other switches in conjunction with @option{-gnats}. In
6411 particular, @option{-gnatl} and @option{-gnatv} are useful to control the
6412 format of any generated error messages.
6413
6414 When the source file is empty or contains only empty lines and/or comments,
6415 the output is a warning:
6416
6417 @smallexample
6418 $ gcc -c -gnats -x ada toto.txt
6419 toto.txt:1:01: warning: empty file, contains no compilation units
6420 $
6421 @end smallexample
6422
6423 Otherwise, the output is simply the error messages, if any. No object file or
6424 ALI file is generated by a syntax-only compilation. Also, no units other
6425 than the one specified are accessed. For example, if a unit @code{X}
6426 @code{with}'s a unit @code{Y}, compiling unit @code{X} in syntax
6427 check only mode does not access the source file containing unit
6428 @code{Y}.
6429
6430 @cindex Multiple units, syntax checking
6431 Normally, GNAT allows only a single unit in a source file. However, this
6432 restriction does not apply in syntax-check-only mode, and it is possible
6433 to check a file containing multiple compilation units concatenated
6434 together. This is primarily used by the @code{gnatchop} utility
6435 (@pxref{Renaming Files Using gnatchop}).
6436 @end table
6437
6438 @node Using gcc for Semantic Checking
6439 @subsection Using @command{gcc} for Semantic Checking
6440 @table @option
6441 @item -gnatc
6442 @cindex @option{-gnatc} (@command{gcc})
6443
6444 @ifclear vms
6445 @noindent
6446 The @code{c} stands for ``check''.
6447 @end ifclear
6448 Causes the compiler to operate in semantic check mode,
6449 with full checking for all illegalities specified in the
6450 Ada Reference Manual, but without generation of any object code
6451 (no object file is generated).
6452
6453 Because dependent files must be accessed, you must follow the GNAT
6454 semantic restrictions on file structuring to operate in this mode:
6455
6456 @itemize @bullet
6457 @item
6458 The needed source files must be accessible
6459 (@pxref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}).
6460
6461 @item
6462 Each file must contain only one compilation unit.
6463
6464 @item
6465 The file name and unit name must match (@pxref{File Naming Rules}).
6466 @end itemize
6467
6468 The output consists of error messages as appropriate. No object file is
6469 generated. An @file{ALI} file is generated for use in the context of
6470 cross-reference tools, but this file is marked as not being suitable
6471 for binding (since no object file is generated).
6472 The checking corresponds exactly to the notion of
6473 legality in the Ada Reference Manual.
6474
6475 Any unit can be compiled in semantics-checking-only mode, including
6476 units that would not normally be compiled (subunits,
6477 and specifications where a separate body is present).
6478 @end table
6479
6480 @node Compiling Different Versions of Ada
6481 @subsection Compiling Different Versions of Ada
6482
6483 @noindent
6484 The switches described in this section allow you to explicitly specify
6485 the version of the Ada language that your programs are written in.
6486 By default @value{EDITION} assumes @value{DEFAULTLANGUAGEVERSION},
6487 but you can also specify @value{NONDEFAULTLANGUAGEVERSION} or
6488 indicate Ada 83 compatibility mode.
6489
6490 @table @option
6491 @cindex Compatibility with Ada 83
6492
6493 @item -gnat83 (Ada 83 Compatibility Mode)
6494 @cindex @option{-gnat83} (@command{gcc})
6495 @cindex ACVC, Ada 83 tests
6496 @cindex Ada 83 mode
6497
6498 @noindent
6499 Although GNAT is primarily an Ada 95 / Ada 2005 compiler, this switch
6500 specifies that the program is to be compiled in Ada 83 mode. With
6501 @option{-gnat83}, GNAT rejects most post-Ada 83 extensions and applies Ada 83
6502 semantics where this can be done easily.
6503 It is not possible to guarantee this switch does a perfect
6504 job; some subtle tests, such as are
6505 found in earlier ACVC tests (and that have been removed from the ACATS suite
6506 for Ada 95), might not compile correctly.
6507 Nevertheless, this switch may be useful in some circumstances, for example
6508 where, due to contractual reasons, existing code needs to be maintained
6509 using only Ada 83 features.
6510
6511 With few exceptions (most notably the need to use @code{<>} on
6512 @cindex Generic formal parameters
6513 unconstrained generic formal parameters, the use of the new Ada 95 / Ada 2005
6514 reserved words, and the use of packages
6515 with optional bodies), it is not necessary to specify the
6516 @option{-gnat83} switch when compiling Ada 83 programs, because, with rare
6517 exceptions, Ada 95 and Ada 2005 are upwardly compatible with Ada 83. Thus
6518 a correct Ada 83 program is usually also a correct program
6519 in these later versions of the language standard.
6520 For further information, please refer to @ref{Compatibility and Porting Guide}.
6521
6522 @item -gnat95 (Ada 95 mode)
6523 @cindex @option{-gnat95} (@command{gcc})
6524 @cindex Ada 95 mode
6525
6526 @noindent
6527 This switch directs the compiler to implement the Ada 95 version of the
6528 language.
6529 Since Ada 95 is almost completely upwards
6530 compatible with Ada 83, Ada 83 programs may generally be compiled using
6531 this switch (see the description of the @option{-gnat83} switch for further
6532 information about Ada 83 mode).
6533 If an Ada 2005 program is compiled in Ada 95 mode,
6534 uses of the new Ada 2005 features will cause error
6535 messages or warnings.
6536
6537 This switch also can be used to cancel the effect of a previous
6538 @option{-gnat83} or @option{-gnat05} switch earlier in the command line.
6539
6540 @item -gnat05 (Ada 2005 mode)
6541 @cindex @option{-gnat05} (@command{gcc})
6542 @cindex Ada 2005 mode
6543
6544 @noindent
6545 This switch directs the compiler to implement the Ada 2005 version of the
6546 language.
6547 Since Ada 2005 is almost completely upwards
6548 compatible with Ada 95 (and thus also with Ada 83), Ada 83 and Ada 95 programs
6549 may generally be compiled using this switch (see the description of the
6550 @option{-gnat83} and @option{-gnat95} switches for further
6551 information).
6552
6553 For information about the approved ``Ada Issues'' that have been incorporated
6554 into Ada 2005, see @url{http://www.ada-auth.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb.cgi/AIs}.
6555 Included with GNAT releases is a file @file{features-ada0y} that describes
6556 the set of implemented Ada 2005 features.
6557 @end table
6558
6559
6560 @node Character Set Control
6561 @subsection Character Set Control
6562 @table @option
6563 @item ^-gnati^/IDENTIFIER_CHARACTER_SET=^@var{c}
6564 @cindex @option{^-gnati^/IDENTIFIER_CHARACTER_SET^} (@command{gcc})
6565
6566 @noindent
6567 Normally GNAT recognizes the Latin-1 character set in source program
6568 identifiers, as described in the Ada Reference Manual.
6569 This switch causes
6570 GNAT to recognize alternate character sets in identifiers. @var{c} is a
6571 single character ^^or word^ indicating the character set, as follows:
6572
6573 @table @code
6574 @item 1
6575 ISO 8859-1 (Latin-1) identifiers
6576
6577 @item 2
6578 ISO 8859-2 (Latin-2) letters allowed in identifiers
6579
6580 @item 3
6581 ISO 8859-3 (Latin-3) letters allowed in identifiers
6582
6583 @item 4
6584 ISO 8859-4 (Latin-4) letters allowed in identifiers
6585
6586 @item 5
6587 ISO 8859-5 (Cyrillic) letters allowed in identifiers
6588
6589 @item 9
6590 ISO 8859-15 (Latin-9) letters allowed in identifiers
6591
6592 @item ^p^PC^
6593 IBM PC letters (code page 437) allowed in identifiers
6594
6595 @item ^8^PC850^
6596 IBM PC letters (code page 850) allowed in identifiers
6597
6598 @item ^f^FULL_UPPER^
6599 Full upper-half codes allowed in identifiers
6600
6601 @item ^n^NO_UPPER^
6602 No upper-half codes allowed in identifiers
6603
6604 @item ^w^WIDE^
6605 Wide-character codes (that is, codes greater than 255)
6606 allowed in identifiers
6607 @end table
6608
6609 @xref{Foreign Language Representation}, for full details on the
6610 implementation of these character sets.
6611
6612 @item ^-gnatW^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING=^@var{e}
6613 @cindex @option{^-gnatW^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} (@command{gcc})
6614 Specify the method of encoding for wide characters.
6615 @var{e} is one of the following:
6616
6617 @table @code
6618
6619 @item ^h^HEX^
6620 Hex encoding (brackets coding also recognized)
6621
6622 @item ^u^UPPER^
6623 Upper half encoding (brackets encoding also recognized)
6624
6625 @item ^s^SHIFT_JIS^
6626 Shift/JIS encoding (brackets encoding also recognized)
6627
6628 @item ^e^EUC^
6629 EUC encoding (brackets encoding also recognized)
6630
6631 @item ^8^UTF8^
6632 UTF-8 encoding (brackets encoding also recognized)
6633
6634 @item ^b^BRACKETS^
6635 Brackets encoding only (default value)
6636 @end table
6637 For full details on these encoding
6638 methods see @ref{Wide Character Encodings}.
6639 Note that brackets coding is always accepted, even if one of the other
6640 options is specified, so for example @option{-gnatW8} specifies that both
6641 brackets and UTF-8 encodings will be recognized. The units that are
6642 with'ed directly or indirectly will be scanned using the specified
6643 representation scheme, and so if one of the non-brackets scheme is
6644 used, it must be used consistently throughout the program. However,
6645 since brackets encoding is always recognized, it may be conveniently
6646 used in standard libraries, allowing these libraries to be used with
6647 any of the available coding schemes.
6648 scheme.
6649
6650 If no @option{-gnatW?} parameter is present, then the default
6651 representation is normally Brackets encoding only. However, if the
6652 first three characters of the file are 16#EF# 16#BB# 16#BF# (the standard
6653 byte order mark or BOM for UTF-8), then these three characters are
6654 skipped and the default representation for the file is set to UTF-8.
6655
6656 Note that the wide character representation that is specified (explicitly
6657 or by default) for the main program also acts as the default encoding used
6658 for Wide_Text_IO files if not specifically overridden by a WCEM form
6659 parameter.
6660
6661 @end table
6662 @node File Naming Control
6663 @subsection File Naming Control
6664
6665 @table @option
6666 @item ^-gnatk^/FILE_NAME_MAX_LENGTH=^@var{n}
6667 @cindex @option{-gnatk} (@command{gcc})
6668 Activates file name ``krunching''. @var{n}, a decimal integer in the range
6669 1-999, indicates the maximum allowable length of a file name (not
6670 including the @file{.ads} or @file{.adb} extension). The default is not
6671 to enable file name krunching.
6672
6673 For the source file naming rules, @xref{File Naming Rules}.
6674 @end table
6675
6676 @node Subprogram Inlining Control
6677 @subsection Subprogram Inlining Control
6678
6679 @table @option
6680 @c !sort!
6681 @item -gnatn
6682 @cindex @option{-gnatn} (@command{gcc})
6683 @ifclear vms
6684 The @code{n} here is intended to suggest the first syllable of the
6685 word ``inline''.
6686 @end ifclear
6687 GNAT recognizes and processes @code{Inline} pragmas. However, for the
6688 inlining to actually occur, optimization must be enabled. To enable
6689 inlining of subprograms specified by pragma @code{Inline},
6690 you must also specify this switch.
6691 In the absence of this switch, GNAT does not attempt
6692 inlining and does not need to access the bodies of
6693 subprograms for which @code{pragma Inline} is specified if they are not
6694 in the current unit.
6695
6696 If you specify this switch the compiler will access these bodies,
6697 creating an extra source dependency for the resulting object file, and
6698 where possible, the call will be inlined.
6699 For further details on when inlining is possible
6700 see @ref{Inlining of Subprograms}.
6701
6702 @item -gnatN
6703 @cindex @option{-gnatN} (@command{gcc})
6704 The front end inlining activated by this switch is generally more extensive,
6705 and quite often more effective than the standard @option{-gnatn} inlining mode.
6706 It will also generate additional dependencies.
6707 Note that
6708 @option{-gnatN} automatically implies @option{-gnatn} so it is not necessary
6709 to specify both options.
6710 @end table
6711
6712 @node Auxiliary Output Control
6713 @subsection Auxiliary Output Control
6714
6715 @table @option
6716 @item -gnatt
6717 @cindex @option{-gnatt} (@command{gcc})
6718 @cindex Writing internal trees
6719 @cindex Internal trees, writing to file
6720 Causes GNAT to write the internal tree for a unit to a file (with the
6721 extension @file{.adt}.
6722 This not normally required, but is used by separate analysis tools.
6723 Typically
6724 these tools do the necessary compilations automatically, so you should
6725 not have to specify this switch in normal operation.
6726
6727 @item -gnatu
6728 @cindex @option{-gnatu} (@command{gcc})
6729 Print a list of units required by this compilation on @file{stdout}.
6730 The listing includes all units on which the unit being compiled depends
6731 either directly or indirectly.
6732
6733 @ifclear vms
6734 @item -pass-exit-codes
6735 @cindex @option{-pass-exit-codes} (@command{gcc})
6736 If this switch is not used, the exit code returned by @command{gcc} when
6737 compiling multiple files indicates whether all source files have
6738 been successfully used to generate object files or not.
6739
6740 When @option{-pass-exit-codes} is used, @command{gcc} exits with an extended
6741 exit status and allows an integrated development environment to better
6742 react to a compilation failure. Those exit status are:
6743
6744 @table @asis
6745 @item 5
6746 There was an error in at least one source file.
6747 @item 3
6748 At least one source file did not generate an object file.
6749 @item 2
6750 The compiler died unexpectedly (internal error for example).
6751 @item 0
6752 An object file has been generated for every source file.
6753 @end table
6754 @end ifclear
6755 @end table
6756
6757 @node Debugging Control
6758 @subsection Debugging Control
6759
6760 @table @option
6761 @c !sort!
6762 @cindex Debugging options
6763 @ifclear vms
6764 @item -gnatd@var{x}
6765 @cindex @option{-gnatd} (@command{gcc})
6766 Activate internal debugging switches. @var{x} is a letter or digit, or
6767 string of letters or digits, which specifies the type of debugging
6768 outputs desired. Normally these are used only for internal development
6769 or system debugging purposes. You can find full documentation for these
6770 switches in the body of the @code{Debug} unit in the compiler source
6771 file @file{debug.adb}.
6772 @end ifclear
6773
6774 @item -gnatG
6775 @cindex @option{-gnatG} (@command{gcc})
6776 This switch causes the compiler to generate auxiliary output containing
6777 a pseudo-source listing of the generated expanded code. Like most Ada
6778 compilers, GNAT works by first transforming the high level Ada code into
6779 lower level constructs. For example, tasking operations are transformed
6780 into calls to the tasking run-time routines. A unique capability of GNAT
6781 is to list this expanded code in a form very close to normal Ada source.
6782 This is very useful in understanding the implications of various Ada
6783 usage on the efficiency of the generated code. There are many cases in
6784 Ada (e.g.@: the use of controlled types), where simple Ada statements can
6785 generate a lot of run-time code. By using @option{-gnatG} you can identify
6786 these cases, and consider whether it may be desirable to modify the coding
6787 approach to improve efficiency.
6788
6789 The format of the output is very similar to standard Ada source, and is
6790 easily understood by an Ada programmer. The following special syntactic
6791 additions correspond to low level features used in the generated code that
6792 do not have any exact analogies in pure Ada source form. The following
6793 is a partial list of these special constructions. See the spec
6794 of package @code{Sprint} in file @file{sprint.ads} for a full list.
6795
6796 If the switch @option{-gnatL} is used in conjunction with
6797 @cindex @option{-gnatL} (@command{gcc})
6798 @option{-gnatG}, then the original source lines are interspersed
6799 in the expanded source (as comment lines with the original line number).
6800
6801 @table @code
6802 @item new @var{xxx} @r{[}storage_pool = @var{yyy}@r{]}
6803 Shows the storage pool being used for an allocator.
6804
6805 @item at end @var{procedure-name};
6806 Shows the finalization (cleanup) procedure for a scope.
6807
6808 @item (if @var{expr} then @var{expr} else @var{expr})
6809 Conditional expression equivalent to the @code{x?y:z} construction in C.
6810
6811 @item @var{target}^^^(@var{source})
6812 A conversion with floating-point truncation instead of rounding.
6813
6814 @item @var{target}?(@var{source})
6815 A conversion that bypasses normal Ada semantic checking. In particular
6816 enumeration types and fixed-point types are treated simply as integers.
6817
6818 @item @var{target}?^^^(@var{source})
6819 Combines the above two cases.
6820
6821 @item @var{x} #/ @var{y}
6822 @itemx @var{x} #mod @var{y}
6823 @itemx @var{x} #* @var{y}
6824 @itemx @var{x} #rem @var{y}
6825 A division or multiplication of fixed-point values which are treated as
6826 integers without any kind of scaling.
6827
6828 @item free @var{expr} @r{[}storage_pool = @var{xxx}@r{]}
6829 Shows the storage pool associated with a @code{free} statement.
6830
6831 @item [subtype or type declaration]
6832 Used to list an equivalent declaration for an internally generated
6833 type that is referenced elsewhere in the listing.
6834
6835 @item freeze @var{type-name} @ovar{actions}
6836 Shows the point at which @var{type-name} is frozen, with possible
6837 associated actions to be performed at the freeze point.
6838
6839 @item reference @var{itype}
6840 Reference (and hence definition) to internal type @var{itype}.
6841
6842 @item @var{function-name}! (@var{arg}, @var{arg}, @var{arg})
6843 Intrinsic function call.
6844
6845 @item @var{label-name} : label
6846 Declaration of label @var{labelname}.
6847
6848 @item #$ @var{subprogram-name}
6849 An implicit call to a run-time support routine
6850 (to meet the requirement of H.3.1(9) in a
6851 convenient manner).
6852
6853 @item @var{expr} && @var{expr} && @var{expr} @dots{} && @var{expr}
6854 A multiple concatenation (same effect as @var{expr} & @var{expr} &
6855 @var{expr}, but handled more efficiently).
6856
6857 @item [constraint_error]
6858 Raise the @code{Constraint_Error} exception.
6859
6860 @item @var{expression}'reference
6861 A pointer to the result of evaluating @var{expression}.
6862
6863 @item @var{target-type}!(@var{source-expression})
6864 An unchecked conversion of @var{source-expression} to @var{target-type}.
6865
6866 @item [@var{numerator}/@var{denominator}]
6867 Used to represent internal real literals (that) have no exact
6868 representation in base 2-16 (for example, the result of compile time
6869 evaluation of the expression 1.0/27.0).
6870 @end table
6871
6872 @item -gnatD
6873 @cindex @option{-gnatD} (@command{gcc})
6874 When used in conjunction with @option{-gnatG}, this switch causes
6875 the expanded source, as described above for
6876 @option{-gnatG} to be written to files with names
6877 @file{^xxx.dg^XXX_DG^}, where @file{xxx} is the normal file name,
6878 instead of to the standard output file. For
6879 example, if the source file name is @file{hello.adb}, then a file
6880 @file{^hello.adb.dg^HELLO.ADB_DG^} will be written. The debugging
6881 information generated by the @command{gcc} @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch
6882 will refer to the generated @file{^xxx.dg^XXX_DG^} file. This allows
6883 you to do source level debugging using the generated code which is
6884 sometimes useful for complex code, for example to find out exactly
6885 which part of a complex construction raised an exception. This switch
6886 also suppress generation of cross-reference information (see
6887 @option{-gnatx}) since otherwise the cross-reference information
6888 would refer to the @file{^.dg^.DG^} file, which would cause
6889 confusion since this is not the original source file.
6890
6891 Note that @option{-gnatD} actually implies @option{-gnatG}
6892 automatically, so it is not necessary to give both options.
6893 In other words @option{-gnatD} is equivalent to @option{-gnatDG}).
6894
6895 If the switch @option{-gnatL} is used in conjunction with
6896 @cindex @option{-gnatL} (@command{gcc})
6897 @option{-gnatDG}, then the original source lines are interspersed
6898 in the expanded source (as comment lines with the original line number).
6899
6900 @item -gnatr
6901 @cindex @option{-gnatr} (@command{gcc})
6902 @cindex pragma Restrictions
6903 This switch causes pragma Restrictions to be treated as Restriction_Warnings
6904 so that violation of restrictions causes warnings rather than illegalities.
6905 This is useful during the development process when new restrictions are added
6906 or investigated. The switch also causes pragma Profile to be treated as
6907 Profile_Warnings, and pragma Restricted_Run_Time and pragma Ravenscar set
6908 restriction warnings rather than restrictions.
6909
6910 @ifclear vms
6911 @item -gnatR@r{[}0@r{|}1@r{|}2@r{|}3@r{[}s@r{]]}
6912 @cindex @option{-gnatR} (@command{gcc})
6913 This switch controls output from the compiler of a listing showing
6914 representation information for declared types and objects. For
6915 @option{-gnatR0}, no information is output (equivalent to omitting
6916 the @option{-gnatR} switch). For @option{-gnatR1} (which is the default,
6917 so @option{-gnatR} with no parameter has the same effect), size and alignment
6918 information is listed for declared array and record types. For
6919 @option{-gnatR2}, size and alignment information is listed for all
6920 declared types and objects. Finally @option{-gnatR3} includes symbolic
6921 expressions for values that are computed at run time for
6922 variant records. These symbolic expressions have a mostly obvious
6923 format with #n being used to represent the value of the n'th
6924 discriminant. See source files @file{repinfo.ads/adb} in the
6925 @code{GNAT} sources for full details on the format of @option{-gnatR3}
6926 output. If the switch is followed by an s (e.g.@: @option{-gnatR2s}), then
6927 the output is to a file with the name @file{^file.rep^file_REP^} where
6928 file is the name of the corresponding source file.
6929 @end ifclear
6930 @ifset vms
6931 @item /REPRESENTATION_INFO
6932 @cindex @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO} (@command{gcc})
6933 This qualifier controls output from the compiler of a listing showing
6934 representation information for declared types and objects. For
6935 @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=NONE}, no information is output
6936 (equivalent to omitting the @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO} qualifier).
6937 @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO} without option is equivalent to
6938 @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=ARRAYS}.
6939 For @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=ARRAYS}, size and alignment
6940 information is listed for declared array and record types. For
6941 @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=OBJECTS}, size and alignment information
6942 is listed for all expression information for values that are computed
6943 at run time for variant records. These symbolic expressions have a mostly
6944 obvious format with #n being used to represent the value of the n'th
6945 discriminant. See source files @file{REPINFO.ADS/ADB} in the
6946 @code{GNAT} sources for full details on the format of
6947 @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=SYMBOLIC} output.
6948 If _FILE is added at the end of an option
6949 (e.g.@: @option{/REPRESENTATION_INFO=ARRAYS_FILE}),
6950 then the output is to a file with the name @file{file_REP} where
6951 file is the name of the corresponding source file.
6952 @end ifset
6953 Note that it is possible for record components to have zero size. In
6954 this case, the component clause uses an obvious extension of permitted
6955 Ada syntax, for example @code{at 0 range 0 .. -1}.
6956
6957 Representation information requires that code be generated (since it is the
6958 code generator that lays out complex data structures). If an attempt is made
6959 to output representation information when no code is generated, for example
6960 when a subunit is compiled on its own, then no information can be generated
6961 and the compiler outputs a message to this effect.
6962
6963 @item -gnatS
6964 @cindex @option{-gnatS} (@command{gcc})
6965 The use of the switch @option{-gnatS} for an
6966 Ada compilation will cause the compiler to output a
6967 representation of package Standard in a form very
6968 close to standard Ada. It is not quite possible to
6969 do this entirely in standard Ada (since new
6970 numeric base types cannot be created in standard
6971 Ada), but the output is easily
6972 readable to any Ada programmer, and is useful to
6973 determine the characteristics of target dependent
6974 types in package Standard.
6975
6976 @item -gnatx
6977 @cindex @option{-gnatx} (@command{gcc})
6978 Normally the compiler generates full cross-referencing information in
6979 the @file{ALI} file. This information is used by a number of tools,
6980 including @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}. The @option{-gnatx} switch
6981 suppresses this information. This saves some space and may slightly
6982 speed up compilation, but means that these tools cannot be used.
6983 @end table
6984
6985 @node Exception Handling Control
6986 @subsection Exception Handling Control
6987
6988 @noindent
6989 GNAT uses two methods for handling exceptions at run-time. The
6990 @code{setjmp/longjmp} method saves the context when entering
6991 a frame with an exception handler. Then when an exception is
6992 raised, the context can be restored immediately, without the
6993 need for tracing stack frames. This method provides very fast
6994 exception propagation, but introduces significant overhead for
6995 the use of exception handlers, even if no exception is raised.
6996
6997 The other approach is called ``zero cost'' exception handling.
6998 With this method, the compiler builds static tables to describe
6999 the exception ranges. No dynamic code is required when entering
7000 a frame containing an exception handler. When an exception is
7001 raised, the tables are used to control a back trace of the
7002 subprogram invocation stack to locate the required exception
7003 handler. This method has considerably poorer performance for
7004 the propagation of exceptions, but there is no overhead for
7005 exception handlers if no exception is raised. Note that in this
7006 mode and in the context of mixed Ada and C/C++ programming,
7007 to propagate an exception through a C/C++ code, the C/C++ code
7008 must be compiled with the @option{-funwind-tables} GCC's
7009 option.
7010
7011 The following switches may be used to control which of the
7012 two exception handling methods is used.
7013
7014 @table @option
7015 @c !sort!
7016
7017 @item --RTS=sjlj
7018 @cindex @option{--RTS=sjlj} (@command{gnatmake})
7019 This switch causes the setjmp/longjmp run-time (when available) to be used
7020 for exception handling. If the default
7021 mechanism for the target is zero cost exceptions, then
7022 this switch can be used to modify this default, and must be
7023 used for all units in the partition.
7024 This option is rarely used. One case in which it may be
7025 advantageous is if you have an application where exception
7026 raising is common and the overall performance of the
7027 application is improved by favoring exception propagation.
7028
7029 @item --RTS=zcx
7030 @cindex @option{--RTS=zcx} (@command{gnatmake})
7031 @cindex Zero Cost Exceptions
7032 This switch causes the zero cost approach to be used
7033 for exception handling. If this is the default mechanism for the
7034 target (see below), then this switch is unneeded. If the default
7035 mechanism for the target is setjmp/longjmp exceptions, then
7036 this switch can be used to modify this default, and must be
7037 used for all units in the partition.
7038 This option can only be used if the zero cost approach
7039 is available for the target in use, otherwise it will generate an error.
7040 @end table
7041
7042 @noindent
7043 The same option @option{--RTS} must be used both for @command{gcc}
7044 and @command{gnatbind}. Passing this option to @command{gnatmake}
7045 (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}) will ensure the required consistency
7046 through the compilation and binding steps.
7047
7048 @node Units to Sources Mapping Files
7049 @subsection Units to Sources Mapping Files
7050
7051 @table @option
7052
7053 @item -gnatem^^=^@var{path}
7054 @cindex @option{-gnatem} (@command{gcc})
7055 A mapping file is a way to communicate to the compiler two mappings:
7056 from unit names to file names (without any directory information) and from
7057 file names to path names (with full directory information). These mappings
7058 are used by the compiler to short-circuit the path search.
7059
7060 The use of mapping files is not required for correct operation of the
7061 compiler, but mapping files can improve efficiency, particularly when
7062 sources are read over a slow network connection. In normal operation,
7063 you need not be concerned with the format or use of mapping files,
7064 and the @option{-gnatem} switch is not a switch that you would use
7065 explicitly. it is intended only for use by automatic tools such as
7066 @command{gnatmake} running under the project file facility. The
7067 description here of the format of mapping files is provided
7068 for completeness and for possible use by other tools.
7069
7070 A mapping file is a sequence of sets of three lines. In each set,
7071 the first line is the unit name, in lower case, with ``@code{%s}''
7072 appended for
7073 specs and ``@code{%b}'' appended for bodies; the second line is the
7074 file name; and the third line is the path name.
7075
7076 Example:
7077 @smallexample
7078 main%b
7079 main.2.ada
7080 /gnat/project1/sources/main.2.ada
7081 @end smallexample
7082
7083 When the switch @option{-gnatem} is specified, the compiler will create
7084 in memory the two mappings from the specified file. If there is any problem
7085 (nonexistent file, truncated file or duplicate entries), no mapping will
7086 be created.
7087
7088 Several @option{-gnatem} switches may be specified; however, only the last
7089 one on the command line will be taken into account.
7090
7091 When using a project file, @command{gnatmake} create a temporary mapping file
7092 and communicates it to the compiler using this switch.
7093
7094 @end table
7095
7096 @node Integrated Preprocessing
7097 @subsection Integrated Preprocessing
7098
7099 @noindent
7100 GNAT sources may be preprocessed immediately before compilation.
7101 In this case, the actual
7102 text of the source is not the text of the source file, but is derived from it
7103 through a process called preprocessing. Integrated preprocessing is specified
7104 through switches @option{-gnatep} and/or @option{-gnateD}. @option{-gnatep}
7105 indicates, through a text file, the preprocessing data to be used.
7106 @option{-gnateD} specifies or modifies the values of preprocessing symbol.
7107
7108 @noindent
7109 Note that when integrated preprocessing is used, the output from the
7110 preprocessor is not written to any external file. Instead it is passed
7111 internally to the compiler. If you need to preserve the result of
7112 preprocessing in a file, then you should use @command{gnatprep}
7113 to perform the desired preprocessing in stand-alone mode.
7114
7115 @noindent
7116 It is recommended that @command{gnatmake} switch ^-s^/SWITCH_CHECK^ should be
7117 used when Integrated Preprocessing is used. The reason is that preprocessing
7118 with another Preprocessing Data file without changing the sources will
7119 not trigger recompilation without this switch.
7120
7121 @noindent
7122 Note that @command{gnatmake} switch ^-m^/MINIMAL_RECOMPILATION^ will almost
7123 always trigger recompilation for sources that are preprocessed,
7124 because @command{gnatmake} cannot compute the checksum of the source after
7125 preprocessing.
7126
7127 @noindent
7128 The actual preprocessing function is described in details in section
7129 @ref{Preprocessing Using gnatprep}. This section only describes how integrated
7130 preprocessing is triggered and parameterized.
7131
7132 @table @code
7133
7134 @item -gnatep=@var{file}
7135 @cindex @option{-gnatep} (@command{gcc})
7136 This switch indicates to the compiler the file name (without directory
7137 information) of the preprocessor data file to use. The preprocessor data file
7138 should be found in the source directories.
7139
7140 @noindent
7141 A preprocessing data file is a text file with significant lines indicating
7142 how should be preprocessed either a specific source or all sources not
7143 mentioned in other lines. A significant line is a nonempty, non-comment line.
7144 Comments are similar to Ada comments.
7145
7146 @noindent
7147 Each significant line starts with either a literal string or the character '*'.
7148 A literal string is the file name (without directory information) of the source
7149 to preprocess. A character '*' indicates the preprocessing for all the sources
7150 that are not specified explicitly on other lines (order of the lines is not
7151 significant). It is an error to have two lines with the same file name or two
7152 lines starting with the character '*'.
7153
7154 @noindent
7155 After the file name or the character '*', another optional literal string
7156 indicating the file name of the definition file to be used for preprocessing
7157 (@pxref{Form of Definitions File}). The definition files are found by the
7158 compiler in one of the source directories. In some cases, when compiling
7159 a source in a directory other than the current directory, if the definition
7160 file is in the current directory, it may be necessary to add the current
7161 directory as a source directory through switch ^-I.^/SEARCH=[]^, otherwise
7162 the compiler would not find the definition file.
7163
7164 @noindent
7165 Then, optionally, ^switches^switches^ similar to those of @code{gnatprep} may
7166 be found. Those ^switches^switches^ are:
7167
7168 @table @code
7169
7170 @item -b
7171 Causes both preprocessor lines and the lines deleted by
7172 preprocessing to be replaced by blank lines, preserving the line number.
7173 This ^switch^switch^ is always implied; however, if specified after @option{-c}
7174 it cancels the effect of @option{-c}.
7175
7176 @item -c
7177 Causes both preprocessor lines and the lines deleted
7178 by preprocessing to be retained as comments marked
7179 with the special string ``@code{--! }''.
7180
7181 @item -Dsymbol=value
7182 Define or redefine a symbol, associated with value. A symbol is an Ada
7183 identifier, or an Ada reserved word, with the exception of @code{if},
7184 @code{else}, @code{elsif}, @code{end}, @code{and}, @code{or} and @code{then}.
7185 @code{value} is either a literal string, an Ada identifier or any Ada reserved
7186 word. A symbol declared with this ^switch^switch^ replaces a symbol with the
7187 same name defined in a definition file.
7188
7189 @item -s
7190 Causes a sorted list of symbol names and values to be
7191 listed on the standard output file.
7192
7193 @item -u
7194 Causes undefined symbols to be treated as having the value @code{FALSE}
7195 in the context
7196 of a preprocessor test. In the absence of this option, an undefined symbol in
7197 a @code{#if} or @code{#elsif} test will be treated as an error.
7198
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @noindent
7202 Examples of valid lines in a preprocessor data file:
7203
7204 @smallexample
7205 "toto.adb" "prep.def" -u
7206 -- preprocess "toto.adb", using definition file "prep.def",
7207 -- undefined symbol are False.
7208
7209 * -c -DVERSION=V101
7210 -- preprocess all other sources without a definition file;
7211 -- suppressed lined are commented; symbol VERSION has the value V101.
7212
7213 "titi.adb" "prep2.def" -s
7214 -- preprocess "titi.adb", using definition file "prep2.def";
7215 -- list all symbols with their values.
7216 @end smallexample
7217
7218 @item ^-gnateD^/DATA_PREPROCESSING=^symbol@r{[}=value@r{]}
7219 @cindex @option{-gnateD} (@command{gcc})
7220 Define or redefine a preprocessing symbol, associated with value. If no value
7221 is given on the command line, then the value of the symbol is @code{True}.
7222 A symbol is an identifier, following normal Ada (case-insensitive)
7223 rules for its syntax, and value is any sequence (including an empty sequence)
7224 of characters from the set (letters, digits, period, underline).
7225 Ada reserved words may be used as symbols, with the exceptions of @code{if},
7226 @code{else}, @code{elsif}, @code{end}, @code{and}, @code{or} and @code{then}.
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 A symbol declared with this ^switch^switch^ on the command line replaces a
7230 symbol with the same name either in a definition file or specified with a
7231 ^switch^switch^ -D in the preprocessor data file.
7232
7233 @noindent
7234 This switch is similar to switch @option{^-D^/ASSOCIATE^} of @code{gnatprep}.
7235
7236 @item -gnateG
7237 When integrated preprocessing is performed and the preprocessor modifies
7238 the source text, write the result of this preprocessing into a file
7239 <source>^.prep^_prep^.
7240
7241 @end table
7242
7243 @node Code Generation Control
7244 @subsection Code Generation Control
7245
7246 @noindent
7247
7248 The GCC technology provides a wide range of target dependent
7249 @option{-m} switches for controlling
7250 details of code generation with respect to different versions of
7251 architectures. This includes variations in instruction sets (e.g.@:
7252 different members of the power pc family), and different requirements
7253 for optimal arrangement of instructions (e.g.@: different members of
7254 the x86 family). The list of available @option{-m} switches may be
7255 found in the GCC documentation.
7256
7257 Use of these @option{-m} switches may in some cases result in improved
7258 code performance.
7259
7260 The GNAT Pro technology is tested and qualified without any
7261 @option{-m} switches,
7262 so generally the most reliable approach is to avoid the use of these
7263 switches. However, we generally expect most of these switches to work
7264 successfully with GNAT Pro, and many customers have reported successful
7265 use of these options.
7266
7267 Our general advice is to avoid the use of @option{-m} switches unless
7268 special needs lead to requirements in this area. In particular,
7269 there is no point in using @option{-m} switches to improve performance
7270 unless you actually see a performance improvement.
7271
7272 @ifset vms
7273 @node Return Codes
7274 @subsection Return Codes
7275 @cindex Return Codes
7276 @cindex @option{/RETURN_CODES=VMS}
7277
7278 @noindent
7279 On VMS, GNAT compiled programs return POSIX-style codes by default,
7280 e.g.@: @option{/RETURN_CODES=POSIX}.
7281
7282 To enable VMS style return codes, use GNAT BIND and LINK with the option
7283 @option{/RETURN_CODES=VMS}. For example:
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 GNAT BIND MYMAIN.ALI /RETURN_CODES=VMS
7287 GNAT LINK MYMAIN.ALI /RETURN_CODES=VMS
7288 @end smallexample
7289
7290 @noindent
7291 Programs built with /RETURN_CODES=VMS are suitable to be called in
7292 VMS DCL scripts. Programs compiled with the default /RETURN_CODES=POSIX
7293 are suitable for spawning with appropriate GNAT RTL routines.
7294
7295 @end ifset
7296
7297 @node Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)
7298 @section Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)
7299
7300 @noindent
7301 With the GNAT source-based library system, the compiler must be able to
7302 find source files for units that are needed by the unit being compiled.
7303 Search paths are used to guide this process.
7304
7305 The compiler compiles one source file whose name must be given
7306 explicitly on the command line. In other words, no searching is done
7307 for this file. To find all other source files that are needed (the most
7308 common being the specs of units), the compiler examines the following
7309 directories, in the following order:
7310
7311 @enumerate
7312 @item
7313 The directory containing the source file of the main unit being compiled
7314 (the file name on the command line).
7315
7316 @item
7317 Each directory named by an @option{^-I^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} switch given on the
7318 @command{gcc} command line, in the order given.
7319
7320 @item
7321 @findex ADA_PRJ_INCLUDE_FILE
7322 Each of the directories listed in the text file whose name is given
7323 by the @env{ADA_PRJ_INCLUDE_FILE} ^environment variable^logical name^.
7324
7325 @noindent
7326 @env{ADA_PRJ_INCLUDE_FILE} is normally set by gnatmake or by the ^gnat^GNAT^
7327 driver when project files are used. It should not normally be set
7328 by other means.
7329
7330 @item
7331 @findex ADA_INCLUDE_PATH
7332 Each of the directories listed in the value of the
7333 @env{ADA_INCLUDE_PATH} ^environment variable^logical name^.
7334 @ifclear vms
7335 Construct this value
7336 exactly as the @env{PATH} environment variable: a list of directory
7337 names separated by colons (semicolons when working with the NT version).
7338 @end ifclear
7339 @ifset vms
7340 Normally, define this value as a logical name containing a comma separated
7341 list of directory names.
7342
7343 This variable can also be defined by means of an environment string
7344 (an argument to the HP C exec* set of functions).
7345
7346 Logical Name:
7347 @smallexample
7348 DEFINE ANOTHER_PATH FOO:[BAG]
7349 DEFINE ADA_INCLUDE_PATH ANOTHER_PATH,FOO:[BAM],FOO:[BAR]
7350 @end smallexample
7351
7352 By default, the path includes GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_x.2_8_x.DECLIB]
7353 first, followed by the standard Ada
7354 libraries in GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_x.2_8_x.ADAINCLUDE].
7355 If this is not redefined, the user will obtain the HP Ada 83 IO packages
7356 (Text_IO, Sequential_IO, etc)
7357 instead of the standard Ada packages. Thus, in order to get the standard Ada
7358 packages by default, ADA_INCLUDE_PATH must be redefined.
7359 @end ifset
7360
7361 @item
7362 The content of the @file{ada_source_path} file which is part of the GNAT
7363 installation tree and is used to store standard libraries such as the
7364 GNAT Run Time Library (RTL) source files.
7365 @ifclear vms
7366 @ref{Installing a library}
7367 @end ifclear
7368 @end enumerate
7369
7370 @noindent
7371 Specifying the switch @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^}
7372 inhibits the use of the directory
7373 containing the source file named in the command line. You can still
7374 have this directory on your search path, but in this case it must be
7375 explicitly requested with a @option{^-I^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} switch.
7376
7377 Specifying the switch @option{-nostdinc}
7378 inhibits the search of the default location for the GNAT Run Time
7379 Library (RTL) source files.
7380
7381 The compiler outputs its object files and ALI files in the current
7382 working directory.
7383 @ifclear vms
7384 Caution: The object file can be redirected with the @option{-o} switch;
7385 however, @command{gcc} and @code{gnat1} have not been coordinated on this
7386 so the @file{ALI} file will not go to the right place. Therefore, you should
7387 avoid using the @option{-o} switch.
7388 @end ifclear
7389
7390 @findex System.IO
7391 The packages @code{Ada}, @code{System}, and @code{Interfaces} and their
7392 children make up the GNAT RTL, together with the simple @code{System.IO}
7393 package used in the @code{"Hello World"} example. The sources for these units
7394 are needed by the compiler and are kept together in one directory. Not
7395 all of the bodies are needed, but all of the sources are kept together
7396 anyway. In a normal installation, you need not specify these directory
7397 names when compiling or binding. Either the environment variables or
7398 the built-in defaults cause these files to be found.
7399
7400 In addition to the language-defined hierarchies (@code{System}, @code{Ada} and
7401 @code{Interfaces}), the GNAT distribution provides a fourth hierarchy,
7402 consisting of child units of @code{GNAT}. This is a collection of generally
7403 useful types, subprograms, etc. @xref{Top, GNAT Reference Manual, About
7404 This Guid, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}, for further details.
7405
7406 Besides simplifying access to the RTL, a major use of search paths is
7407 in compiling sources from multiple directories. This can make
7408 development environments much more flexible.
7409
7410 @node Order of Compilation Issues
7411 @section Order of Compilation Issues
7412
7413 @noindent
7414 If, in our earlier example, there was a spec for the @code{hello}
7415 procedure, it would be contained in the file @file{hello.ads}; yet this
7416 file would not have to be explicitly compiled. This is the result of the
7417 model we chose to implement library management. Some of the consequences
7418 of this model are as follows:
7419
7420 @itemize @bullet
7421 @item
7422 There is no point in compiling specs (except for package
7423 specs with no bodies) because these are compiled as needed by clients. If
7424 you attempt a useless compilation, you will receive an error message.
7425 It is also useless to compile subunits because they are compiled as needed
7426 by the parent.
7427
7428 @item
7429 There are no order of compilation requirements: performing a
7430 compilation never obsoletes anything. The only way you can obsolete
7431 something and require recompilations is to modify one of the
7432 source files on which it depends.
7433
7434 @item
7435 There is no library as such, apart from the ALI files
7436 (@pxref{The Ada Library Information Files}, for information on the format
7437 of these files). For now we find it convenient to create separate ALI files,
7438 but eventually the information therein may be incorporated into the object
7439 file directly.
7440
7441 @item
7442 When you compile a unit, the source files for the specs of all units
7443 that it @code{with}'s, all its subunits, and the bodies of any generics it
7444 instantiates must be available (reachable by the search-paths mechanism
7445 described above), or you will receive a fatal error message.
7446 @end itemize
7447
7448 @node Examples
7449 @section Examples
7450
7451 @noindent
7452 The following are some typical Ada compilation command line examples:
7453
7454 @table @code
7455 @item $ gcc -c xyz.adb
7456 Compile body in file @file{xyz.adb} with all default options.
7457
7458 @ifclear vms
7459 @item $ gcc -c -O2 -gnata xyz-def.adb
7460 @end ifclear
7461 @ifset vms
7462 @item $ GNAT COMPILE /OPTIMIZE=ALL -gnata xyz-def.adb
7463 @end ifset
7464
7465 Compile the child unit package in file @file{xyz-def.adb} with extensive
7466 optimizations, and pragma @code{Assert}/@code{Debug} statements
7467 enabled.
7468
7469 @item $ gcc -c -gnatc abc-def.adb
7470 Compile the subunit in file @file{abc-def.adb} in semantic-checking-only
7471 mode.
7472 @end table
7473
7474 @node Binding Using gnatbind
7475 @chapter Binding Using @code{gnatbind}
7476 @findex gnatbind
7477
7478 @menu
7479 * Running gnatbind::
7480 * Switches for gnatbind::
7481 * Command-Line Access::
7482 * Search Paths for gnatbind::
7483 * Examples of gnatbind Usage::
7484 @end menu
7485
7486 @noindent
7487 This chapter describes the GNAT binder, @code{gnatbind}, which is used
7488 to bind compiled GNAT objects.
7489
7490 Note: to invoke @code{gnatbind} with a project file, use the @code{gnat}
7491 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
7492
7493 The @code{gnatbind} program performs four separate functions:
7494
7495 @enumerate
7496 @item
7497 Checks that a program is consistent, in accordance with the rules in
7498 Chapter 10 of the Ada Reference Manual. In particular, error
7499 messages are generated if a program uses inconsistent versions of a
7500 given unit.
7501
7502 @item
7503 Checks that an acceptable order of elaboration exists for the program
7504 and issues an error message if it cannot find an order of elaboration
7505 that satisfies the rules in Chapter 10 of the Ada Language Manual.
7506
7507 @item
7508 Generates a main program incorporating the given elaboration order.
7509 This program is a small Ada package (body and spec) that
7510 must be subsequently compiled
7511 using the GNAT compiler. The necessary compilation step is usually
7512 performed automatically by @command{gnatlink}. The two most important
7513 functions of this program
7514 are to call the elaboration routines of units in an appropriate order
7515 and to call the main program.
7516
7517 @item
7518 Determines the set of object files required by the given main program.
7519 This information is output in the forms of comments in the generated program,
7520 to be read by the @command{gnatlink} utility used to link the Ada application.
7521 @end enumerate
7522
7523 @node Running gnatbind
7524 @section Running @code{gnatbind}
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 The form of the @code{gnatbind} command is
7528
7529 @smallexample
7530 $ gnatbind @ovar{switches} @var{mainprog}@r{[}.ali@r{]} @ovar{switches}
7531 @end smallexample
7532
7533 @noindent
7534 where @file{@var{mainprog}.adb} is the Ada file containing the main program
7535 unit body. If no switches are specified, @code{gnatbind} constructs an Ada
7536 package in two files whose names are
7537 @file{b~@var{mainprog}.ads}, and @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb}.
7538 For example, if given the
7539 parameter @file{hello.ali}, for a main program contained in file
7540 @file{hello.adb}, the binder output files would be @file{b~hello.ads}
7541 and @file{b~hello.adb}.
7542
7543 When doing consistency checking, the binder takes into consideration
7544 any source files it can locate. For example, if the binder determines
7545 that the given main program requires the package @code{Pack}, whose
7546 @file{.ALI}
7547 file is @file{pack.ali} and whose corresponding source spec file is
7548 @file{pack.ads}, it attempts to locate the source file @file{pack.ads}
7549 (using the same search path conventions as previously described for the
7550 @command{gcc} command). If it can locate this source file, it checks that
7551 the time stamps
7552 or source checksums of the source and its references to in @file{ALI} files
7553 match. In other words, any @file{ALI} files that mentions this spec must have
7554 resulted from compiling this version of the source file (or in the case
7555 where the source checksums match, a version close enough that the
7556 difference does not matter).
7557
7558 @cindex Source files, use by binder
7559 The effect of this consistency checking, which includes source files, is
7560 that the binder ensures that the program is consistent with the latest
7561 version of the source files that can be located at bind time. Editing a
7562 source file without compiling files that depend on the source file cause
7563 error messages to be generated by the binder.
7564
7565 For example, suppose you have a main program @file{hello.adb} and a
7566 package @code{P}, from file @file{p.ads} and you perform the following
7567 steps:
7568
7569 @enumerate
7570 @item
7571 Enter @code{gcc -c hello.adb} to compile the main program.
7572
7573 @item
7574 Enter @code{gcc -c p.ads} to compile package @code{P}.
7575
7576 @item
7577 Edit file @file{p.ads}.
7578
7579 @item
7580 Enter @code{gnatbind hello}.
7581 @end enumerate
7582
7583 @noindent
7584 At this point, the file @file{p.ali} contains an out-of-date time stamp
7585 because the file @file{p.ads} has been edited. The attempt at binding
7586 fails, and the binder generates the following error messages:
7587
7588 @smallexample
7589 error: "hello.adb" must be recompiled ("p.ads" has been modified)
7590 error: "p.ads" has been modified and must be recompiled
7591 @end smallexample
7592
7593 @noindent
7594 Now both files must be recompiled as indicated, and then the bind can
7595 succeed, generating a main program. You need not normally be concerned
7596 with the contents of this file, but for reference purposes a sample
7597 binder output file is given in @ref{Example of Binder Output File}.
7598
7599 In most normal usage, the default mode of @command{gnatbind} which is to
7600 generate the main package in Ada, as described in the previous section.
7601 In particular, this means that any Ada programmer can read and understand
7602 the generated main program. It can also be debugged just like any other
7603 Ada code provided the @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch is used for
7604 @command{gnatbind} and @command{gnatlink}.
7605
7606 However for some purposes it may be convenient to generate the main
7607 program in C rather than Ada. This may for example be helpful when you
7608 are generating a mixed language program with the main program in C. The
7609 GNAT compiler itself is an example.
7610 The use of the @option{^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^} switch
7611 for both @code{gnatbind} and @command{gnatlink} will cause the program to
7612 be generated in C (and compiled using the gnu C compiler).
7613
7614 @node Switches for gnatbind
7615 @section Switches for @command{gnatbind}
7616
7617 @noindent
7618 The following switches are available with @code{gnatbind}; details will
7619 be presented in subsequent sections.
7620
7621 @menu
7622 * Consistency-Checking Modes::
7623 * Binder Error Message Control::
7624 * Elaboration Control::
7625 * Output Control::
7626 * Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs::
7627 * Binding Programs with No Main Subprogram::
7628 @end menu
7629
7630 @table @option
7631 @c !sort!
7632
7633 @item --version
7634 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatbind}
7635 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
7636
7637 @item --help
7638 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatbind}
7639 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
7640 all other options.
7641
7642 @item -a
7643 @cindex @option{-a} @command{gnatbind}
7644 Indicates that, if supported by the platform, the adainit procedure should
7645 be treated as an initialisation routine by the linker (a constructor). This
7646 is intended to be used by the Project Manager to automatically initialize
7647 shared Stand-Alone Libraries.
7648
7649 @item ^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^
7650 @cindex @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
7651 Specify directory to be searched for ALI files.
7652
7653 @item ^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^
7654 @cindex @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
7655 Specify directory to be searched for source file.
7656
7657 @item ^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^
7658 @cindex @option{^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^} (@command{gnatbind})
7659 Generate binder program in Ada (default)
7660
7661 @item ^-b^/REPORT_ERRORS=BRIEF^
7662 @cindex @option{^-b^/REPORT_ERRORS=BRIEF^} (@command{gnatbind})
7663 Generate brief messages to @file{stderr} even if verbose mode set.
7664
7665 @item ^-c^/NOOUTPUT^
7666 @cindex @option{^-c^/NOOUTPUT^} (@command{gnatbind})
7667 Check only, no generation of binder output file.
7668
7669 @item ^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^
7670 @cindex @option{^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^} (@command{gnatbind})
7671 Generate binder program in C
7672
7673 @item ^-d^/DEFAULT_STACK_SIZE=^@var{nn}@r{[}k@r{|}m@r{]}
7674 @cindex @option{^-d^/DEFAULT_STACK_SIZE=^@var{nn}@r{[}k@r{|}m@r{]}} (@command{gnatbind})
7675 This switch can be used to change the default task stack size value
7676 to a specified size @var{nn}, which is expressed in bytes by default, or
7677 in kilobytes when suffixed with @var{k} or in megabytes when suffixed
7678 with @var{m}.
7679 In the absence of a @samp{@r{[}k@r{|}m@r{]}} suffix, this switch is equivalent,
7680 in effect, to completing all task specs with
7681 @smallexample @c ada
7682 pragma Storage_Size (nn);
7683 @end smallexample
7684 When they do not already have such a pragma.
7685
7686 @item ^-D^/DEFAULT_SECONDARY_STACK_SIZE=^@var{nn}@r{[}k@r{|}m@r{]}
7687 @cindex @option{^-D^/DEFAULT_SECONDARY_STACK_SIZE=nnnnn^} (@command{gnatbind})
7688 This switch can be used to change the default secondary stack size value
7689 to a specified size @var{nn}, which is expressed in bytes by default, or
7690 in kilobytes when suffixed with @var{k} or in megabytes when suffixed
7691 with @var{m}.
7692
7693 The secondary stack is used to deal with functions that return a variable
7694 sized result, for example a function returning an unconstrained
7695 String. There are two ways in which this secondary stack is allocated.
7696
7697 For most targets, the secondary stack is growing on demand and is allocated
7698 as a chain of blocks in the heap. The -D option is not very
7699 relevant. It only give some control over the size of the allocated
7700 blocks (whose size is the minimum of the default secondary stack size value,
7701 and the actual size needed for the current allocation request).
7702
7703 For certain targets, notably VxWorks 653,
7704 the secondary stack is allocated by carving off a fixed ratio chunk of the
7705 primary task stack. The -D option is used to define the
7706 size of the environment task's secondary stack.
7707
7708 @item ^-e^/ELABORATION_DEPENDENCIES^
7709 @cindex @option{^-e^/ELABORATION_DEPENDENCIES^} (@command{gnatbind})
7710 Output complete list of elaboration-order dependencies.
7711
7712 @item ^-E^/STORE_TRACEBACKS^
7713 @cindex @option{^-E^/STORE_TRACEBACKS^} (@command{gnatbind})
7714 Store tracebacks in exception occurrences when the target supports it.
7715 This is the default with the zero cost exception mechanism.
7716 @ignore
7717 @c The following may get moved to an appendix
7718 This option is currently supported on the following targets:
7719 all x86 ports, Solaris, Windows, HP-UX, AIX, PowerPC VxWorks and Alpha VxWorks.
7720 @end ignore
7721 See also the packages @code{GNAT.Traceback} and
7722 @code{GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic} for more information.
7723 @ifclear vms
7724 Note that on x86 ports, you must not use @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7725 @command{gcc} option.
7726 @end ifclear
7727
7728 @item ^-F^/FORCE_ELABS_FLAGS^
7729 @cindex @option{^-F^/FORCE_ELABS_FLAGS^} (@command{gnatbind})
7730 Force the checks of elaboration flags. @command{gnatbind} does not normally
7731 generate checks of elaboration flags for the main executable, except when
7732 a Stand-Alone Library is used. However, there are cases when this cannot be
7733 detected by gnatbind. An example is importing an interface of a Stand-Alone
7734 Library through a pragma Import and only specifying through a linker switch
7735 this Stand-Alone Library. This switch is used to guarantee that elaboration
7736 flag checks are generated.
7737
7738 @item ^-h^/HELP^
7739 @cindex @option{^-h^/HELP^} (@command{gnatbind})
7740 Output usage (help) information
7741
7742 @item ^-I^/SEARCH^
7743 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
7744 Specify directory to be searched for source and ALI files.
7745
7746 @item ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
7747 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@command{gnatbind})
7748 Do not look for sources in the current directory where @code{gnatbind} was
7749 invoked, and do not look for ALI files in the directory containing the
7750 ALI file named in the @code{gnatbind} command line.
7751
7752 @item ^-l^/ORDER_OF_ELABORATION^
7753 @cindex @option{^-l^/ORDER_OF_ELABORATION^} (@command{gnatbind})
7754 Output chosen elaboration order.
7755
7756 @item ^-L@var{xxx}^/BUILD_LIBRARY=@var{xxx}^
7757 @cindex @option{^-L^/BUILD_LIBRARY^} (@command{gnatbind})
7758 Bind the units for library building. In this case the adainit and
7759 adafinal procedures (@pxref{Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs})
7760 are renamed to ^@var{xxx}init^@var{XXX}INIT^ and
7761 ^@var{xxx}final^@var{XXX}FINAL^.
7762 Implies ^-n^/NOCOMPILE^.
7763 @ifclear vms
7764 (@xref{GNAT and Libraries}, for more details.)
7765 @end ifclear
7766 @ifset vms
7767 On OpenVMS, these init and final procedures are exported in uppercase
7768 letters. For example if /BUILD_LIBRARY=toto is used, the exported name of
7769 the init procedure will be "TOTOINIT" and the exported name of the final
7770 procedure will be "TOTOFINAL".
7771 @end ifset
7772
7773 @item ^-Mxyz^/RENAME_MAIN=xyz^
7774 @cindex @option{^-M^/RENAME_MAIN^} (@command{gnatbind})
7775 Rename generated main program from main to xyz. This option is
7776 supported on cross environments only.
7777
7778 @item ^-m^/ERROR_LIMIT=^@var{n}
7779 @cindex @option{^-m^/ERROR_LIMIT^} (@command{gnatbind})
7780 Limit number of detected errors to @var{n}, where @var{n} is
7781 in the range 1..999_999. The default value if no switch is
7782 given is 9999. Binding is terminated if the limit is exceeded.
7783 @ifset unw
7784 Furthermore, under Windows, the sources pointed to by the libraries path
7785 set in the registry are not searched for.
7786 @end ifset
7787
7788 @item ^-n^/NOMAIN^
7789 @cindex @option{^-n^/NOMAIN^} (@command{gnatbind})
7790 No main program.
7791
7792 @item -nostdinc
7793 @cindex @option{-nostdinc} (@command{gnatbind})
7794 Do not look for sources in the system default directory.
7795
7796 @item -nostdlib
7797 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} (@command{gnatbind})
7798 Do not look for library files in the system default directory.
7799
7800 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
7801 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@code{gnatbind})
7802 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. Same meaning as the
7803 equivalent @command{gnatmake} flag (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
7804
7805 @item ^-o ^/OUTPUT=^@var{file}
7806 @cindex @option{^-o ^/OUTPUT^} (@command{gnatbind})
7807 Name the output file @var{file} (default is @file{b~@var{xxx}.adb}).
7808 Note that if this option is used, then linking must be done manually,
7809 gnatlink cannot be used.
7810
7811 @item ^-O^/OBJECT_LIST^
7812 @cindex @option{^-O^/OBJECT_LIST^} (@command{gnatbind})
7813 Output object list.
7814
7815 @item ^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^
7816 @cindex @option{^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^} (@command{gnatbind})
7817 Pessimistic (worst-case) elaboration order
7818
7819 @item ^-R^-R^
7820 @cindex @option{^-R^-R^} (@command{gnatbind})
7821 Output closure source list.
7822
7823 @item ^-s^/READ_SOURCES=ALL^
7824 @cindex @option{^-s^/READ_SOURCES=ALL^} (@command{gnatbind})
7825 Require all source files to be present.
7826
7827 @item ^-S@var{xxx}^/INITIALIZE_SCALARS=@var{xxx}^
7828 @cindex @option{^-S^/INITIALIZE_SCALARS^} (@command{gnatbind})
7829 Specifies the value to be used when detecting uninitialized scalar
7830 objects with pragma Initialize_Scalars.
7831 The @var{xxx} ^string specified with the switch^option^ may be either
7832 @itemize @bullet
7833 @item ``@option{^in^INVALID^}'' requesting an invalid value where possible
7834 @item ``@option{^lo^LOW^}'' for the lowest possible value
7835 @item ``@option{^hi^HIGH^}'' for the highest possible value
7836 @item ``@option{@var{xx}}'' for a value consisting of repeated bytes with the
7837 value @code{16#@var{xx}#} (i.e., @var{xx} is a string of two hexadecimal digits).
7838 @end itemize
7839
7840 In addition, you can specify @option{-Sev} to indicate that the value is
7841 to be set at run time. In this case, the program will look for an environment
7842 @cindex GNAT_INIT_SCALARS
7843 variable of the form @env{GNAT_INIT_SCALARS=@var{xx}}, where @var{xx} is one
7844 of @option{in/lo/hi/@var{xx}} with the same meanings as above.
7845 If no environment variable is found, or if it does not have a valid value,
7846 then the default is @option{in} (invalid values).
7847
7848 @ifclear vms
7849 @item -static
7850 @cindex @option{-static} (@code{gnatbind})
7851 Link against a static GNAT run time.
7852
7853 @item -shared
7854 @cindex @option{-shared} (@code{gnatbind})
7855 Link against a shared GNAT run time when available.
7856 @end ifclear
7857
7858 @item ^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^
7859 @cindex @option{^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^} (@code{gnatbind})
7860 Tolerate time stamp and other consistency errors
7861
7862 @item ^-T@var{n}^/TIME_SLICE=@var{n}^
7863 @cindex @option{^-T^/TIME_SLICE^} (@code{gnatbind})
7864 Set the time slice value to @var{n} milliseconds. If the system supports
7865 the specification of a specific time slice value, then the indicated value
7866 is used. If the system does not support specific time slice values, but
7867 does support some general notion of round-robin scheduling, then any
7868 nonzero value will activate round-robin scheduling.
7869
7870 A value of zero is treated specially. It turns off time
7871 slicing, and in addition, indicates to the tasking run time that the
7872 semantics should match as closely as possible the Annex D
7873 requirements of the Ada RM, and in particular sets the default
7874 scheduling policy to @code{FIFO_Within_Priorities}.
7875
7876 @item ^-u@var{n}^/DYNAMIC_STACK_USAGE=@var{n}^
7877 @cindex @option{^-u^/DYNAMIC_STACK_USAGE^} (@code{gnatbind})
7878 Enable dynamic stack usage, with @var{n} results stored and displayed
7879 at program termination. A result is generated when a task
7880 terminates. Results that can't be stored are displayed on the fly, at
7881 task termination. This option is currently not supported on Itanium
7882 platforms. (See @ref{Dynamic Stack Usage Analysis} for details.)
7883
7884 @item ^-v^/REPORT_ERRORS=VERBOSE^
7885 @cindex @option{^-v^/REPORT_ERRORS=VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatbind})
7886 Verbose mode. Write error messages, header, summary output to
7887 @file{stdout}.
7888
7889 @ifclear vms
7890 @item -w@var{x}
7891 @cindex @option{-w} (@code{gnatbind})
7892 Warning mode (@var{x}=s/e for suppress/treat as error)
7893 @end ifclear
7894
7895 @ifset vms
7896 @item /WARNINGS=NORMAL
7897 @cindex @option{/WARNINGS} (@code{gnatbind})
7898 Normal warnings mode. Warnings are issued but ignored
7899
7900 @item /WARNINGS=SUPPRESS
7901 @cindex @option{/WARNINGS} (@code{gnatbind})
7902 All warning messages are suppressed
7903
7904 @item /WARNINGS=ERROR
7905 @cindex @option{/WARNINGS} (@code{gnatbind})
7906 Warning messages are treated as fatal errors
7907 @end ifset
7908
7909 @item ^-Wx^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING=^@var{e}
7910 @cindex @option{^-Wx^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} (@code{gnatbind})
7911 Override default wide character encoding for standard Text_IO files.
7912
7913 @item ^-x^/READ_SOURCES=NONE^
7914 @cindex @option{^-x^/READ_SOURCES^} (@code{gnatbind})
7915 Exclude source files (check object consistency only).
7916
7917 @ifset vms
7918 @item /READ_SOURCES=AVAILABLE
7919 @cindex @option{/READ_SOURCES} (@code{gnatbind})
7920 Default mode, in which sources are checked for consistency only if
7921 they are available.
7922 @end ifset
7923
7924 @item ^-y^/ENABLE_LEAP_SECONDS^
7925 @cindex @option{^-y^/ENABLE_LEAP_SECONDS^} (@code{gnatbind})
7926 Enable leap seconds support in @code{Ada.Calendar} and its children.
7927
7928 @item ^-z^/ZERO_MAIN^
7929 @cindex @option{^-z^/ZERO_MAIN^} (@code{gnatbind})
7930 No main subprogram.
7931 @end table
7932
7933 @ifclear vms
7934 @noindent
7935 You may obtain this listing of switches by running @code{gnatbind} with
7936 no arguments.
7937 @end ifclear
7938
7939 @node Consistency-Checking Modes
7940 @subsection Consistency-Checking Modes
7941
7942 @noindent
7943 As described earlier, by default @code{gnatbind} checks
7944 that object files are consistent with one another and are consistent
7945 with any source files it can locate. The following switches control binder
7946 access to sources.
7947
7948 @table @option
7949 @c !sort!
7950 @item ^-s^/READ_SOURCES=ALL^
7951 @cindex @option{^-s^/READ_SOURCES=ALL^} (@code{gnatbind})
7952 Require source files to be present. In this mode, the binder must be
7953 able to locate all source files that are referenced, in order to check
7954 their consistency. In normal mode, if a source file cannot be located it
7955 is simply ignored. If you specify this switch, a missing source
7956 file is an error.
7957
7958 @item ^-Wx^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING=^@var{e}
7959 @cindex @option{^-Wx^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} (@code{gnatbind})
7960 Override default wide character encoding for standard Text_IO files.
7961 Normally the default wide character encoding method used for standard
7962 [Wide_[Wide_]]Text_IO files is taken from the encoding specified for
7963 the main source input (see description of switch
7964 @option{^-gnatWx^/WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} for the compiler). The
7965 use of this switch for the binder (which has the same set of
7966 possible arguments) overrides this default as specified.
7967
7968 @item ^-x^/READ_SOURCES=NONE^
7969 @cindex @option{^-x^/READ_SOURCES=NONE^} (@code{gnatbind})
7970 Exclude source files. In this mode, the binder only checks that ALI
7971 files are consistent with one another. Source files are not accessed.
7972 The binder runs faster in this mode, and there is still a guarantee that
7973 the resulting program is self-consistent.
7974 If a source file has been edited since it was last compiled, and you
7975 specify this switch, the binder will not detect that the object
7976 file is out of date with respect to the source file. Note that this is the
7977 mode that is automatically used by @command{gnatmake} because in this
7978 case the checking against sources has already been performed by
7979 @command{gnatmake} in the course of compilation (i.e.@: before binding).
7980
7981 @ifset vms
7982 @item /READ_SOURCES=AVAILABLE
7983 @cindex @code{/READ_SOURCES=AVAILABLE} (@code{gnatbind})
7984 This is the default mode in which source files are checked if they are
7985 available, and ignored if they are not available.
7986 @end ifset
7987 @end table
7988
7989 @node Binder Error Message Control
7990 @subsection Binder Error Message Control
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 The following switches provide control over the generation of error
7994 messages from the binder:
7995
7996 @table @option
7997 @c !sort!
7998 @item ^-v^/REPORT_ERRORS=VERBOSE^
7999 @cindex @option{^-v^/REPORT_ERRORS=VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatbind})
8000 Verbose mode. In the normal mode, brief error messages are generated to
8001 @file{stderr}. If this switch is present, a header is written
8002 to @file{stdout} and any error messages are directed to @file{stdout}.
8003 All that is written to @file{stderr} is a brief summary message.
8004
8005 @item ^-b^/REPORT_ERRORS=BRIEF^
8006 @cindex @option{^-b^/REPORT_ERRORS=BRIEF^} (@code{gnatbind})
8007 Generate brief error messages to @file{stderr} even if verbose mode is
8008 specified. This is relevant only when used with the
8009 @option{^-v^/REPORT_ERRORS=VERBOSE^} switch.
8010
8011 @ifclear vms
8012 @item -m@var{n}
8013 @cindex @option{-m} (@code{gnatbind})
8014 Limits the number of error messages to @var{n}, a decimal integer in the
8015 range 1-999. The binder terminates immediately if this limit is reached.
8016
8017 @item -M@var{xxx}
8018 @cindex @option{-M} (@code{gnatbind})
8019 Renames the generated main program from @code{main} to @code{xxx}.
8020 This is useful in the case of some cross-building environments, where
8021 the actual main program is separate from the one generated
8022 by @code{gnatbind}.
8023 @end ifclear
8024
8025 @item ^-ws^/WARNINGS=SUPPRESS^
8026 @cindex @option{^-ws^/WARNINGS=SUPPRESS^} (@code{gnatbind})
8027 @cindex Warnings
8028 Suppress all warning messages.
8029
8030 @item ^-we^/WARNINGS=ERROR^
8031 @cindex @option{^-we^/WARNINGS=ERROR^} (@code{gnatbind})
8032 Treat any warning messages as fatal errors.
8033
8034 @ifset vms
8035 @item /WARNINGS=NORMAL
8036 Standard mode with warnings generated, but warnings do not get treated
8037 as errors.
8038 @end ifset
8039
8040 @item ^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^
8041 @cindex @option{^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^} (@code{gnatbind})
8042 @cindex Time stamp checks, in binder
8043 @cindex Binder consistency checks
8044 @cindex Consistency checks, in binder
8045 The binder performs a number of consistency checks including:
8046
8047 @itemize @bullet
8048 @item
8049 Check that time stamps of a given source unit are consistent
8050 @item
8051 Check that checksums of a given source unit are consistent
8052 @item
8053 Check that consistent versions of @code{GNAT} were used for compilation
8054 @item
8055 Check consistency of configuration pragmas as required
8056 @end itemize
8057
8058 @noindent
8059 Normally failure of such checks, in accordance with the consistency
8060 requirements of the Ada Reference Manual, causes error messages to be
8061 generated which abort the binder and prevent the output of a binder
8062 file and subsequent link to obtain an executable.
8063
8064 The @option{^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^} switch converts these error messages
8065 into warnings, so that
8066 binding and linking can continue to completion even in the presence of such
8067 errors. The result may be a failed link (due to missing symbols), or a
8068 non-functional executable which has undefined semantics.
8069 @emph{This means that
8070 @option{^-t^/NOTIME_STAMP_CHECK^} should be used only in unusual situations,
8071 with extreme care.}
8072 @end table
8073
8074 @node Elaboration Control
8075 @subsection Elaboration Control
8076
8077 @noindent
8078 The following switches provide additional control over the elaboration
8079 order. For full details see @ref{Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT}.
8080
8081 @table @option
8082 @item ^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^
8083 @cindex @option{^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^} (@code{gnatbind})
8084 Normally the binder attempts to choose an elaboration order that is
8085 likely to minimize the likelihood of an elaboration order error resulting
8086 in raising a @code{Program_Error} exception. This switch reverses the
8087 action of the binder, and requests that it deliberately choose an order
8088 that is likely to maximize the likelihood of an elaboration error.
8089 This is useful in ensuring portability and avoiding dependence on
8090 accidental fortuitous elaboration ordering.
8091
8092 Normally it only makes sense to use the @option{^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^}
8093 switch if dynamic
8094 elaboration checking is used (@option{-gnatE} switch used for compilation).
8095 This is because in the default static elaboration mode, all necessary
8096 @code{Elaborate} and @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas are implicitly inserted.
8097 These implicit pragmas are still respected by the binder in
8098 @option{^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^} mode, so a
8099 safe elaboration order is assured.
8100 @end table
8101
8102 @node Output Control
8103 @subsection Output Control
8104
8105 @noindent
8106 The following switches allow additional control over the output
8107 generated by the binder.
8108
8109 @table @option
8110 @c !sort!
8111
8112 @item ^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^
8113 @cindex @option{^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^} (@code{gnatbind})
8114 Generate binder program in Ada (default). The binder program is named
8115 @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb} by default. This can be changed with
8116 @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} @code{gnatbind} option.
8117
8118 @item ^-c^/NOOUTPUT^
8119 @cindex @option{^-c^/NOOUTPUT^} (@code{gnatbind})
8120 Check only. Do not generate the binder output file. In this mode the
8121 binder performs all error checks but does not generate an output file.
8122
8123 @item ^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^
8124 @cindex @option{^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^} (@code{gnatbind})
8125 Generate binder program in C. The binder program is named
8126 @file{b_@var{mainprog}.c}.
8127 This can be changed with @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} @code{gnatbind}
8128 option.
8129
8130 @item ^-e^/ELABORATION_DEPENDENCIES^
8131 @cindex @option{^-e^/ELABORATION_DEPENDENCIES^} (@code{gnatbind})
8132 Output complete list of elaboration-order dependencies, showing the
8133 reason for each dependency. This output can be rather extensive but may
8134 be useful in diagnosing problems with elaboration order. The output is
8135 written to @file{stdout}.
8136
8137 @item ^-h^/HELP^
8138 @cindex @option{^-h^/HELP^} (@code{gnatbind})
8139 Output usage information. The output is written to @file{stdout}.
8140
8141 @item ^-K^/LINKER_OPTION_LIST^
8142 @cindex @option{^-K^/LINKER_OPTION_LIST^} (@code{gnatbind})
8143 Output linker options to @file{stdout}. Includes library search paths,
8144 contents of pragmas Ident and Linker_Options, and libraries added
8145 by @code{gnatbind}.
8146
8147 @item ^-l^/ORDER_OF_ELABORATION^
8148 @cindex @option{^-l^/ORDER_OF_ELABORATION^} (@code{gnatbind})
8149 Output chosen elaboration order. The output is written to @file{stdout}.
8150
8151 @item ^-O^/OBJECT_LIST^
8152 @cindex @option{^-O^/OBJECT_LIST^} (@code{gnatbind})
8153 Output full names of all the object files that must be linked to provide
8154 the Ada component of the program. The output is written to @file{stdout}.
8155 This list includes the files explicitly supplied and referenced by the user
8156 as well as implicitly referenced run-time unit files. The latter are
8157 omitted if the corresponding units reside in shared libraries. The
8158 directory names for the run-time units depend on the system configuration.
8159
8160 @item ^-o ^/OUTPUT=^@var{file}
8161 @cindex @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} (@code{gnatbind})
8162 Set name of output file to @var{file} instead of the normal
8163 @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb} default. Note that @var{file} denote the Ada
8164 binder generated body filename. In C mode you would normally give
8165 @var{file} an extension of @file{.c} because it will be a C source program.
8166 Note that if this option is used, then linking must be done manually.
8167 It is not possible to use gnatlink in this case, since it cannot locate
8168 the binder file.
8169
8170 @item ^-r^/RESTRICTION_LIST^
8171 @cindex @option{^-r^/RESTRICTION_LIST^} (@code{gnatbind})
8172 Generate list of @code{pragma Restrictions} that could be applied to
8173 the current unit. This is useful for code audit purposes, and also may
8174 be used to improve code generation in some cases.
8175
8176 @end table
8177
8178 @node Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs
8179 @subsection Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs
8180
8181 @noindent
8182 In our description so far we have assumed that the main
8183 program is in Ada, and that the task of the binder is to generate a
8184 corresponding function @code{main} that invokes this Ada main
8185 program. GNAT also supports the building of executable programs where
8186 the main program is not in Ada, but some of the called routines are
8187 written in Ada and compiled using GNAT (@pxref{Mixed Language Programming}).
8188 The following switch is used in this situation:
8189
8190 @table @option
8191 @item ^-n^/NOMAIN^
8192 @cindex @option{^-n^/NOMAIN^} (@code{gnatbind})
8193 No main program. The main program is not in Ada.
8194 @end table
8195
8196 @noindent
8197 In this case, most of the functions of the binder are still required,
8198 but instead of generating a main program, the binder generates a file
8199 containing the following callable routines:
8200
8201 @table @code
8202 @item adainit
8203 @findex adainit
8204 You must call this routine to initialize the Ada part of the program by
8205 calling the necessary elaboration routines. A call to @code{adainit} is
8206 required before the first call to an Ada subprogram.
8207
8208 Note that it is assumed that the basic execution environment must be setup
8209 to be appropriate for Ada execution at the point where the first Ada
8210 subprogram is called. In particular, if the Ada code will do any
8211 floating-point operations, then the FPU must be setup in an appropriate
8212 manner. For the case of the x86, for example, full precision mode is
8213 required. The procedure GNAT.Float_Control.Reset may be used to ensure
8214 that the FPU is in the right state.
8215
8216 @item adafinal
8217 @findex adafinal
8218 You must call this routine to perform any library-level finalization
8219 required by the Ada subprograms. A call to @code{adafinal} is required
8220 after the last call to an Ada subprogram, and before the program
8221 terminates.
8222 @end table
8223
8224 @noindent
8225 If the @option{^-n^/NOMAIN^} switch
8226 @cindex @option{^-n^/NOMAIN^} (@command{gnatbind})
8227 @cindex Binder, multiple input files
8228 is given, more than one ALI file may appear on
8229 the command line for @code{gnatbind}. The normal @dfn{closure}
8230 calculation is performed for each of the specified units. Calculating
8231 the closure means finding out the set of units involved by tracing
8232 @code{with} references. The reason it is necessary to be able to
8233 specify more than one ALI file is that a given program may invoke two or
8234 more quite separate groups of Ada units.
8235
8236 The binder takes the name of its output file from the last specified ALI
8237 file, unless overridden by the use of the @option{^-o file^/OUTPUT=file^}.
8238 @cindex @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} (@command{gnatbind})
8239 The output is an Ada unit in source form that can
8240 be compiled with GNAT unless the -C switch is used in which case the
8241 output is a C source file, which must be compiled using the C compiler.
8242 This compilation occurs automatically as part of the @command{gnatlink}
8243 processing.
8244
8245 Currently the GNAT run time requires a FPU using 80 bits mode
8246 precision. Under targets where this is not the default it is required to
8247 call GNAT.Float_Control.Reset before using floating point numbers (this
8248 include float computation, float input and output) in the Ada code. A
8249 side effect is that this could be the wrong mode for the foreign code
8250 where floating point computation could be broken after this call.
8251
8252 @node Binding Programs with No Main Subprogram
8253 @subsection Binding Programs with No Main Subprogram
8254
8255 @noindent
8256 It is possible to have an Ada program which does not have a main
8257 subprogram. This program will call the elaboration routines of all the
8258 packages, then the finalization routines.
8259
8260 The following switch is used to bind programs organized in this manner:
8261
8262 @table @option
8263 @item ^-z^/ZERO_MAIN^
8264 @cindex @option{^-z^/ZERO_MAIN^} (@code{gnatbind})
8265 Normally the binder checks that the unit name given on the command line
8266 corresponds to a suitable main subprogram. When this switch is used,
8267 a list of ALI files can be given, and the execution of the program
8268 consists of elaboration of these units in an appropriate order. Note
8269 that the default wide character encoding method for standard Text_IO
8270 files is always set to Brackets if this switch is set (you can use
8271 the binder switch
8272 @option{^-Wx^WIDE_CHARACTER_ENCODING^} to override this default).
8273 @end table
8274
8275 @node Command-Line Access
8276 @section Command-Line Access
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 The package @code{Ada.Command_Line} provides access to the command-line
8280 arguments and program name. In order for this interface to operate
8281 correctly, the two variables
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 @group
8285 int gnat_argc;
8286 char **gnat_argv;
8287 @end group
8288 @end smallexample
8289
8290 @noindent
8291 @findex gnat_argv
8292 @findex gnat_argc
8293 are declared in one of the GNAT library routines. These variables must
8294 be set from the actual @code{argc} and @code{argv} values passed to the
8295 main program. With no @option{^n^/NOMAIN^} present, @code{gnatbind}
8296 generates the C main program to automatically set these variables.
8297 If the @option{^n^/NOMAIN^} switch is used, there is no automatic way to
8298 set these variables. If they are not set, the procedures in
8299 @code{Ada.Command_Line} will not be available, and any attempt to use
8300 them will raise @code{Constraint_Error}. If command line access is
8301 required, your main program must set @code{gnat_argc} and
8302 @code{gnat_argv} from the @code{argc} and @code{argv} values passed to
8303 it.
8304
8305 @node Search Paths for gnatbind
8306 @section Search Paths for @code{gnatbind}
8307
8308 @noindent
8309 The binder takes the name of an ALI file as its argument and needs to
8310 locate source files as well as other ALI files to verify object consistency.
8311
8312 For source files, it follows exactly the same search rules as @command{gcc}
8313 (@pxref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}). For ALI files the
8314 directories searched are:
8315
8316 @enumerate
8317 @item
8318 The directory containing the ALI file named in the command line, unless
8319 the switch @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} is specified.
8320
8321 @item
8322 All directories specified by @option{^-I^/SEARCH^}
8323 switches on the @code{gnatbind}
8324 command line, in the order given.
8325
8326 @item
8327 @findex ADA_PRJ_OBJECTS_FILE
8328 Each of the directories listed in the text file whose name is given
8329 by the @env{ADA_PRJ_OBJECTS_FILE} ^environment variable^logical name^.
8330
8331 @noindent
8332 @env{ADA_PRJ_OBJECTS_FILE} is normally set by gnatmake or by the ^gnat^GNAT^
8333 driver when project files are used. It should not normally be set
8334 by other means.
8335
8336 @item
8337 @findex ADA_OBJECTS_PATH
8338 Each of the directories listed in the value of the
8339 @env{ADA_OBJECTS_PATH} ^environment variable^logical name^.
8340 @ifset unw
8341 Construct this value
8342 exactly as the @env{PATH} environment variable: a list of directory
8343 names separated by colons (semicolons when working with the NT version
8344 of GNAT).
8345 @end ifset
8346 @ifset vms
8347 Normally, define this value as a logical name containing a comma separated
8348 list of directory names.
8349
8350 This variable can also be defined by means of an environment string
8351 (an argument to the HP C exec* set of functions).
8352
8353 Logical Name:
8354 @smallexample
8355 DEFINE ANOTHER_PATH FOO:[BAG]
8356 DEFINE ADA_OBJECTS_PATH ANOTHER_PATH,FOO:[BAM],FOO:[BAR]
8357 @end smallexample
8358
8359 By default, the path includes GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_x.2_8_x.DECLIB]
8360 first, followed by the standard Ada
8361 libraries in GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_x.2_8_x.ADALIB].
8362 If this is not redefined, the user will obtain the HP Ada 83 IO packages
8363 (Text_IO, Sequential_IO, etc)
8364 instead of the standard Ada packages. Thus, in order to get the standard Ada
8365 packages by default, ADA_OBJECTS_PATH must be redefined.
8366 @end ifset
8367
8368 @item
8369 The content of the @file{ada_object_path} file which is part of the GNAT
8370 installation tree and is used to store standard libraries such as the
8371 GNAT Run Time Library (RTL) unless the switch @option{-nostdlib} is
8372 specified.
8373 @ifclear vms
8374 @ref{Installing a library}
8375 @end ifclear
8376 @end enumerate
8377
8378 @noindent
8379 In the binder the switch @option{^-I^/SEARCH^}
8380 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
8381 is used to specify both source and
8382 library file paths. Use @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^}
8383 @cindex @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
8384 instead if you want to specify
8385 source paths only, and @option{^-aO^/LIBRARY_SEARCH^}
8386 @cindex @option{^-aO^/LIBRARY_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatbind})
8387 if you want to specify library paths
8388 only. This means that for the binder
8389 @option{^-I^/SEARCH=^}@var{dir} is equivalent to
8390 @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^}@var{dir}
8391 @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^}@var{dir}.
8392 The binder generates the bind file (a C language source file) in the
8393 current working directory.
8394
8395 @findex Ada
8396 @findex System
8397 @findex Interfaces
8398 @findex GNAT
8399 The packages @code{Ada}, @code{System}, and @code{Interfaces} and their
8400 children make up the GNAT Run-Time Library, together with the package
8401 GNAT and its children, which contain a set of useful additional
8402 library functions provided by GNAT. The sources for these units are
8403 needed by the compiler and are kept together in one directory. The ALI
8404 files and object files generated by compiling the RTL are needed by the
8405 binder and the linker and are kept together in one directory, typically
8406 different from the directory containing the sources. In a normal
8407 installation, you need not specify these directory names when compiling
8408 or binding. Either the environment variables or the built-in defaults
8409 cause these files to be found.
8410
8411 Besides simplifying access to the RTL, a major use of search paths is
8412 in compiling sources from multiple directories. This can make
8413 development environments much more flexible.
8414
8415 @node Examples of gnatbind Usage
8416 @section Examples of @code{gnatbind} Usage
8417
8418 @noindent
8419 This section contains a number of examples of using the GNAT binding
8420 utility @code{gnatbind}.
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @item gnatbind hello
8424 The main program @code{Hello} (source program in @file{hello.adb}) is
8425 bound using the standard switch settings. The generated main program is
8426 @file{b~hello.adb}. This is the normal, default use of the binder.
8427
8428 @ifclear vms
8429 @item gnatbind hello -o mainprog.adb
8430 @end ifclear
8431 @ifset vms
8432 @item gnatbind HELLO.ALI /OUTPUT=Mainprog.ADB
8433 @end ifset
8434 The main program @code{Hello} (source program in @file{hello.adb}) is
8435 bound using the standard switch settings. The generated main program is
8436 @file{mainprog.adb} with the associated spec in
8437 @file{mainprog.ads}. Note that you must specify the body here not the
8438 spec, in the case where the output is in Ada. Note that if this option
8439 is used, then linking must be done manually, since gnatlink will not
8440 be able to find the generated file.
8441
8442 @ifclear vms
8443 @item gnatbind main -C -o mainprog.c -x
8444 @end ifclear
8445 @ifset vms
8446 @item gnatbind MAIN.ALI /BIND_FILE=C /OUTPUT=Mainprog.C /READ_SOURCES=NONE
8447 @end ifset
8448 The main program @code{Main} (source program in
8449 @file{main.adb}) is bound, excluding source files from the
8450 consistency checking, generating
8451 the file @file{mainprog.c}.
8452
8453 @ifclear vms
8454 @item gnatbind -x main_program -C -o mainprog.c
8455 This command is exactly the same as the previous example. Switches may
8456 appear anywhere in the command line, and single letter switches may be
8457 combined into a single switch.
8458 @end ifclear
8459
8460 @ifclear vms
8461 @item gnatbind -n math dbase -C -o ada-control.c
8462 @end ifclear
8463 @ifset vms
8464 @item gnatbind /NOMAIN math dbase /BIND_FILE=C /OUTPUT=ada-control.c
8465 @end ifset
8466 The main program is in a language other than Ada, but calls to
8467 subprograms in packages @code{Math} and @code{Dbase} appear. This call
8468 to @code{gnatbind} generates the file @file{ada-control.c} containing
8469 the @code{adainit} and @code{adafinal} routines to be called before and
8470 after accessing the Ada units.
8471 @end table
8472
8473 @c ------------------------------------
8474 @node Linking Using gnatlink
8475 @chapter Linking Using @command{gnatlink}
8476 @c ------------------------------------
8477 @findex gnatlink
8478
8479 @noindent
8480 This chapter discusses @command{gnatlink}, a tool that links
8481 an Ada program and builds an executable file. This utility
8482 invokes the system linker ^(via the @command{gcc} command)^^
8483 with a correct list of object files and library references.
8484 @command{gnatlink} automatically determines the list of files and
8485 references for the Ada part of a program. It uses the binder file
8486 generated by the @command{gnatbind} to determine this list.
8487
8488 Note: to invoke @code{gnatlink} with a project file, use the @code{gnat}
8489 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
8490
8491 @menu
8492 * Running gnatlink::
8493 * Switches for gnatlink::
8494 @end menu
8495
8496 @node Running gnatlink
8497 @section Running @command{gnatlink}
8498
8499 @noindent
8500 The form of the @command{gnatlink} command is
8501
8502 @smallexample
8503 $ gnatlink @ovar{switches} @var{mainprog}@r{[}.ali@r{]}
8504 @ovar{non-Ada objects} @ovar{linker options}
8505 @end smallexample
8506
8507 @noindent
8508 The arguments of @command{gnatlink} (switches, main @file{ALI} file,
8509 non-Ada objects
8510 or linker options) may be in any order, provided that no non-Ada object may
8511 be mistaken for a main @file{ALI} file.
8512 Any file name @file{F} without the @file{.ali}
8513 extension will be taken as the main @file{ALI} file if a file exists
8514 whose name is the concatenation of @file{F} and @file{.ali}.
8515
8516 @noindent
8517 @file{@var{mainprog}.ali} references the ALI file of the main program.
8518 The @file{.ali} extension of this file can be omitted. From this
8519 reference, @command{gnatlink} locates the corresponding binder file
8520 @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb} and, using the information in this file along
8521 with the list of non-Ada objects and linker options, constructs a
8522 linker command file to create the executable.
8523
8524 The arguments other than the @command{gnatlink} switches and the main
8525 @file{ALI} file are passed to the linker uninterpreted.
8526 They typically include the names of
8527 object files for units written in other languages than Ada and any library
8528 references required to resolve references in any of these foreign language
8529 units, or in @code{Import} pragmas in any Ada units.
8530
8531 @var{linker options} is an optional list of linker specific
8532 switches.
8533 The default linker called by gnatlink is @command{gcc} which in
8534 turn calls the appropriate system linker.
8535 Standard options for the linker such as @option{-lmy_lib} or
8536 @option{-Ldir} can be added as is.
8537 For options that are not recognized by
8538 @command{gcc} as linker options, use the @command{gcc} switches
8539 @option{-Xlinker} or @option{-Wl,}.
8540 Refer to the GCC documentation for
8541 details. Here is an example showing how to generate a linker map:
8542
8543 @smallexample
8544 $ ^gnatlink my_prog -Wl,-Map,MAPFILE^GNAT LINK my_prog.ali /MAP^
8545 @end smallexample
8546
8547 Using @var{linker options} it is possible to set the program stack and
8548 heap size.
8549 @ifset unw
8550 See @ref{Setting Stack Size from gnatlink} and
8551 @ref{Setting Heap Size from gnatlink}.
8552 @end ifset
8553
8554 @command{gnatlink} determines the list of objects required by the Ada
8555 program and prepends them to the list of objects passed to the linker.
8556 @command{gnatlink} also gathers any arguments set by the use of
8557 @code{pragma Linker_Options} and adds them to the list of arguments
8558 presented to the linker.
8559
8560 @ifset vms
8561 @command{gnatlink} accepts the following types of extra files on the command
8562 line: objects (@file{.OBJ}), libraries (@file{.OLB}), sharable images
8563 (@file{.EXE}), and options files (@file{.OPT}). These are recognized and
8564 handled according to their extension.
8565 @end ifset
8566
8567 @node Switches for gnatlink
8568 @section Switches for @command{gnatlink}
8569
8570 @noindent
8571 The following switches are available with the @command{gnatlink} utility:
8572
8573 @table @option
8574 @c !sort!
8575
8576 @item --version
8577 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatlink}
8578 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
8579
8580 @item --help
8581 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatlink}
8582 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
8583 all other options.
8584
8585 @item ^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^
8586 @cindex @option{^-A^/BIND_FILE=ADA^} (@command{gnatlink})
8587 The binder has generated code in Ada. This is the default.
8588
8589 @item ^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^
8590 @cindex @option{^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^} (@command{gnatlink})
8591 If instead of generating a file in Ada, the binder has generated one in
8592 C, then the linker needs to know about it. Use this switch to signal
8593 to @command{gnatlink} that the binder has generated C code rather than
8594 Ada code.
8595
8596 @item ^-f^/FORCE_OBJECT_FILE_LIST^
8597 @cindex Command line length
8598 @cindex @option{^-f^/FORCE_OBJECT_FILE_LIST^} (@command{gnatlink})
8599 On some targets, the command line length is limited, and @command{gnatlink}
8600 will generate a separate file for the linker if the list of object files
8601 is too long.
8602 The @option{^-f^/FORCE_OBJECT_FILE_LIST^} switch forces this file
8603 to be generated even if
8604 the limit is not exceeded. This is useful in some cases to deal with
8605 special situations where the command line length is exceeded.
8606
8607 @item ^-g^/DEBUG^
8608 @cindex Debugging information, including
8609 @cindex @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} (@command{gnatlink})
8610 The option to include debugging information causes the Ada bind file (in
8611 other words, @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb}) to be compiled with
8612 @option{^-g^/DEBUG^}.
8613 In addition, the binder does not delete the @file{b~@var{mainprog}.adb},
8614 @file{b~@var{mainprog}.o} and @file{b~@var{mainprog}.ali} files.
8615 Without @option{^-g^/DEBUG^}, the binder removes these files by
8616 default. The same procedure apply if a C bind file was generated using
8617 @option{^-C^/BIND_FILE=C^} @code{gnatbind} option, in this case the filenames
8618 are @file{b_@var{mainprog}.c} and @file{b_@var{mainprog}.o}.
8619
8620 @item ^-n^/NOCOMPILE^
8621 @cindex @option{^-n^/NOCOMPILE^} (@command{gnatlink})
8622 Do not compile the file generated by the binder. This may be used when
8623 a link is rerun with different options, but there is no need to recompile
8624 the binder file.
8625
8626 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
8627 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@command{gnatlink})
8628 Causes additional information to be output, including a full list of the
8629 included object files. This switch option is most useful when you want
8630 to see what set of object files are being used in the link step.
8631
8632 @item ^-v -v^/VERBOSE/VERBOSE^
8633 @cindex @option{^-v -v^/VERBOSE/VERBOSE^} (@command{gnatlink})
8634 Very verbose mode. Requests that the compiler operate in verbose mode when
8635 it compiles the binder file, and that the system linker run in verbose mode.
8636
8637 @item ^-o ^/EXECUTABLE=^@var{exec-name}
8638 @cindex @option{^-o^/EXECUTABLE^} (@command{gnatlink})
8639 @var{exec-name} specifies an alternate name for the generated
8640 executable program. If this switch is omitted, the executable has the same
8641 name as the main unit. For example, @code{gnatlink try.ali} creates
8642 an executable called @file{^try^TRY.EXE^}.
8643
8644 @ifclear vms
8645 @item -b @var{target}
8646 @cindex @option{-b} (@command{gnatlink})
8647 Compile your program to run on @var{target}, which is the name of a
8648 system configuration. You must have a GNAT cross-compiler built if
8649 @var{target} is not the same as your host system.
8650
8651 @item -B@var{dir}
8652 @cindex @option{-B} (@command{gnatlink})
8653 Load compiler executables (for example, @code{gnat1}, the Ada compiler)
8654 from @var{dir} instead of the default location. Only use this switch
8655 when multiple versions of the GNAT compiler are available.
8656 @xref{Directory Options,,, gcc, The GNU Compiler Collection},
8657 for further details. You would normally use the @option{-b} or
8658 @option{-V} switch instead.
8659
8660 @item --GCC=@var{compiler_name}
8661 @cindex @option{--GCC=compiler_name} (@command{gnatlink})
8662 Program used for compiling the binder file. The default is
8663 @command{gcc}. You need to use quotes around @var{compiler_name} if
8664 @code{compiler_name} contains spaces or other separator characters.
8665 As an example @option{--GCC="foo -x -y"} will instruct @command{gnatlink} to
8666 use @code{foo -x -y} as your compiler. Note that switch @option{-c} is always
8667 inserted after your command name. Thus in the above example the compiler
8668 command that will be used by @command{gnatlink} will be @code{foo -c -x -y}.
8669 A limitation of this syntax is that the name and path name of the executable
8670 itself must not include any embedded spaces. If the compiler executable is
8671 different from the default one (gcc or <prefix>-gcc), then the back-end
8672 switches in the ALI file are not used to compile the binder generated source.
8673 For example, this is the case with @option{--GCC="foo -x -y"}. But the back end
8674 switches will be used for @option{--GCC="gcc -gnatv"}. If several
8675 @option{--GCC=compiler_name} are used, only the last @var{compiler_name}
8676 is taken into account. However, all the additional switches are also taken
8677 into account. Thus,
8678 @option{--GCC="foo -x -y" --GCC="bar -z -t"} is equivalent to
8679 @option{--GCC="bar -x -y -z -t"}.
8680
8681 @item --LINK=@var{name}
8682 @cindex @option{--LINK=} (@command{gnatlink})
8683 @var{name} is the name of the linker to be invoked. This is especially
8684 useful in mixed language programs since languages such as C++ require
8685 their own linker to be used. When this switch is omitted, the default
8686 name for the linker is @command{gcc}. When this switch is used, the
8687 specified linker is called instead of @command{gcc} with exactly the same
8688 parameters that would have been passed to @command{gcc} so if the desired
8689 linker requires different parameters it is necessary to use a wrapper
8690 script that massages the parameters before invoking the real linker. It
8691 may be useful to control the exact invocation by using the verbose
8692 switch.
8693
8694 @end ifclear
8695
8696 @ifset vms
8697 @item /DEBUG=TRACEBACK
8698 @cindex @code{/DEBUG=TRACEBACK} (@command{gnatlink})
8699 This qualifier causes sufficient information to be included in the
8700 executable file to allow a traceback, but does not include the full
8701 symbol information needed by the debugger.
8702
8703 @item /IDENTIFICATION="<string>"
8704 @code{"<string>"} specifies the string to be stored in the image file
8705 identification field in the image header.
8706 It overrides any pragma @code{Ident} specified string.
8707
8708 @item /NOINHIBIT-EXEC
8709 Generate the executable file even if there are linker warnings.
8710
8711 @item /NOSTART_FILES
8712 Don't link in the object file containing the ``main'' transfer address.
8713 Used when linking with a foreign language main program compiled with an
8714 HP compiler.
8715
8716 @item /STATIC
8717 Prefer linking with object libraries over sharable images, even without
8718 /DEBUG.
8719 @end ifset
8720
8721 @end table
8722
8723 @node The GNAT Make Program gnatmake
8724 @chapter The GNAT Make Program @command{gnatmake}
8725 @findex gnatmake
8726
8727 @menu
8728 * Running gnatmake::
8729 * Switches for gnatmake::
8730 * Mode Switches for gnatmake::
8731 * Notes on the Command Line::
8732 * How gnatmake Works::
8733 * Examples of gnatmake Usage::
8734 @end menu
8735 @noindent
8736 A typical development cycle when working on an Ada program consists of
8737 the following steps:
8738
8739 @enumerate
8740 @item
8741 Edit some sources to fix bugs.
8742
8743 @item
8744 Add enhancements.
8745
8746 @item
8747 Compile all sources affected.
8748
8749 @item
8750 Rebind and relink.
8751
8752 @item
8753 Test.
8754 @end enumerate
8755
8756 @noindent
8757 The third step can be tricky, because not only do the modified files
8758 @cindex Dependency rules
8759 have to be compiled, but any files depending on these files must also be
8760 recompiled. The dependency rules in Ada can be quite complex, especially
8761 in the presence of overloading, @code{use} clauses, generics and inlined
8762 subprograms.
8763
8764 @command{gnatmake} automatically takes care of the third and fourth steps
8765 of this process. It determines which sources need to be compiled,
8766 compiles them, and binds and links the resulting object files.
8767
8768 Unlike some other Ada make programs, the dependencies are always
8769 accurately recomputed from the new sources. The source based approach of
8770 the GNAT compilation model makes this possible. This means that if
8771 changes to the source program cause corresponding changes in
8772 dependencies, they will always be tracked exactly correctly by
8773 @command{gnatmake}.
8774
8775 @node Running gnatmake
8776 @section Running @command{gnatmake}
8777
8778 @noindent
8779 The usual form of the @command{gnatmake} command is
8780
8781 @smallexample
8782 $ gnatmake @ovar{switches} @var{file_name}
8783 @ovar{file_names} @ovar{mode_switches}
8784 @end smallexample
8785
8786 @noindent
8787 The only required argument is one @var{file_name}, which specifies
8788 a compilation unit that is a main program. Several @var{file_names} can be
8789 specified: this will result in several executables being built.
8790 If @code{switches} are present, they can be placed before the first
8791 @var{file_name}, between @var{file_names} or after the last @var{file_name}.
8792 If @var{mode_switches} are present, they must always be placed after
8793 the last @var{file_name} and all @code{switches}.
8794
8795 If you are using standard file extensions (@file{.adb} and @file{.ads}), then the
8796 extension may be omitted from the @var{file_name} arguments. However, if
8797 you are using non-standard extensions, then it is required that the
8798 extension be given. A relative or absolute directory path can be
8799 specified in a @var{file_name}, in which case, the input source file will
8800 be searched for in the specified directory only. Otherwise, the input
8801 source file will first be searched in the directory where
8802 @command{gnatmake} was invoked and if it is not found, it will be search on
8803 the source path of the compiler as described in
8804 @ref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}.
8805
8806 All @command{gnatmake} output (except when you specify
8807 @option{^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^}) is to
8808 @file{stderr}. The output produced by the
8809 @option{^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^} switch is send to
8810 @file{stdout}.
8811
8812 @node Switches for gnatmake
8813 @section Switches for @command{gnatmake}
8814
8815 @noindent
8816 You may specify any of the following switches to @command{gnatmake}:
8817
8818 @table @option
8819 @c !sort!
8820
8821 @item --version
8822 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatmake}
8823 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
8824
8825 @item --help
8826 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatmake}
8827 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
8828 all other options.
8829
8830 @ifclear vms
8831 @item --GCC=@var{compiler_name}
8832 @cindex @option{--GCC=compiler_name} (@command{gnatmake})
8833 Program used for compiling. The default is `@command{gcc}'. You need to use
8834 quotes around @var{compiler_name} if @code{compiler_name} contains
8835 spaces or other separator characters. As an example @option{--GCC="foo -x
8836 -y"} will instruct @command{gnatmake} to use @code{foo -x -y} as your
8837 compiler. A limitation of this syntax is that the name and path name of
8838 the executable itself must not include any embedded spaces. Note that
8839 switch @option{-c} is always inserted after your command name. Thus in the
8840 above example the compiler command that will be used by @command{gnatmake}
8841 will be @code{foo -c -x -y}. If several @option{--GCC=compiler_name} are
8842 used, only the last @var{compiler_name} is taken into account. However,
8843 all the additional switches are also taken into account. Thus,
8844 @option{--GCC="foo -x -y" --GCC="bar -z -t"} is equivalent to
8845 @option{--GCC="bar -x -y -z -t"}.
8846
8847 @item --GNATBIND=@var{binder_name}
8848 @cindex @option{--GNATBIND=binder_name} (@command{gnatmake})
8849 Program used for binding. The default is `@code{gnatbind}'. You need to
8850 use quotes around @var{binder_name} if @var{binder_name} contains spaces
8851 or other separator characters. As an example @option{--GNATBIND="bar -x
8852 -y"} will instruct @command{gnatmake} to use @code{bar -x -y} as your
8853 binder. Binder switches that are normally appended by @command{gnatmake}
8854 to `@code{gnatbind}' are now appended to the end of @code{bar -x -y}.
8855 A limitation of this syntax is that the name and path name of the executable
8856 itself must not include any embedded spaces.
8857
8858 @item --GNATLINK=@var{linker_name}
8859 @cindex @option{--GNATLINK=linker_name} (@command{gnatmake})
8860 Program used for linking. The default is `@command{gnatlink}'. You need to
8861 use quotes around @var{linker_name} if @var{linker_name} contains spaces
8862 or other separator characters. As an example @option{--GNATLINK="lan -x
8863 -y"} will instruct @command{gnatmake} to use @code{lan -x -y} as your
8864 linker. Linker switches that are normally appended by @command{gnatmake} to
8865 `@command{gnatlink}' are now appended to the end of @code{lan -x -y}.
8866 A limitation of this syntax is that the name and path name of the executable
8867 itself must not include any embedded spaces.
8868
8869 @end ifclear
8870
8871 @item ^-a^/ALL_FILES^
8872 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} (@command{gnatmake})
8873 Consider all files in the make process, even the GNAT internal system
8874 files (for example, the predefined Ada library files), as well as any
8875 locked files. Locked files are files whose ALI file is write-protected.
8876 By default,
8877 @command{gnatmake} does not check these files,
8878 because the assumption is that the GNAT internal files are properly up
8879 to date, and also that any write protected ALI files have been properly
8880 installed. Note that if there is an installation problem, such that one
8881 of these files is not up to date, it will be properly caught by the
8882 binder.
8883 You may have to specify this switch if you are working on GNAT
8884 itself. The switch @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} is also useful
8885 in conjunction with @option{^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^}
8886 if you need to recompile an entire application,
8887 including run-time files, using special configuration pragmas,
8888 such as a @code{Normalize_Scalars} pragma.
8889
8890 By default
8891 @code{gnatmake ^-a^/ALL_FILES^} compiles all GNAT
8892 internal files with
8893 @ifclear vms
8894 @code{gcc -c -gnatpg} rather than @code{gcc -c}.
8895 @end ifclear
8896 @ifset vms
8897 the @code{/CHECKS=SUPPRESS_ALL /STYLE_CHECKS=GNAT} switch.
8898 @end ifset
8899
8900 @item ^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^
8901 @cindex @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^} (@command{gnatmake})
8902 Bind only. Can be combined with @option{^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^} to do
8903 compilation and binding, but no link.
8904 Can be combined with @option{^-l^/ACTIONS=LINK^}
8905 to do binding and linking. When not combined with
8906 @option{^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^}
8907 all the units in the closure of the main program must have been previously
8908 compiled and must be up to date. The root unit specified by @var{file_name}
8909 may be given without extension, with the source extension or, if no GNAT
8910 Project File is specified, with the ALI file extension.
8911
8912 @item ^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^
8913 @cindex @option{^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^} (@command{gnatmake})
8914 Compile only. Do not perform binding, except when @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^}
8915 is also specified. Do not perform linking, except if both
8916 @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^} and
8917 @option{^-l^/ACTIONS=LINK^} are also specified.
8918 If the root unit specified by @var{file_name} is not a main unit, this is the
8919 default. Otherwise @command{gnatmake} will attempt binding and linking
8920 unless all objects are up to date and the executable is more recent than
8921 the objects.
8922
8923 @item ^-C^/MAPPING^
8924 @cindex @option{^-C^/MAPPING^} (@command{gnatmake})
8925 Use a temporary mapping file. A mapping file is a way to communicate to the
8926 compiler two mappings: from unit names to file names (without any directory
8927 information) and from file names to path names (with full directory
8928 information). These mappings are used by the compiler to short-circuit the path
8929 search. When @command{gnatmake} is invoked with this switch, it will create
8930 a temporary mapping file, initially populated by the project manager,
8931 if @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} is used, otherwise initially empty.
8932 Each invocation of the compiler will add the newly accessed sources to the
8933 mapping file. This will improve the source search during the next invocation
8934 of the compiler.
8935
8936 @item ^-C=^/USE_MAPPING_FILE=^@var{file}
8937 @cindex @option{^-C=^/USE_MAPPING^} (@command{gnatmake})
8938 Use a specific mapping file. The file, specified as a path name (absolute or
8939 relative) by this switch, should already exist, otherwise the switch is
8940 ineffective. The specified mapping file will be communicated to the compiler.
8941 This switch is not compatible with a project file
8942 (^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@var{file}) or with multiple compiling processes
8943 (^-j^/PROCESSES=^nnn, when nnn is greater than 1).
8944
8945 @item ^-d^/DISPLAY_PROGRESS^
8946 @cindex @option{^-d^/DISPLAY_PROGRESS^} (@command{gnatmake})
8947 Display progress for each source, up to date or not, as a single line
8948
8949 @smallexample
8950 completed x out of y (zz%)
8951 @end smallexample
8952
8953 If the file needs to be compiled this is displayed after the invocation of
8954 the compiler. These lines are displayed even in quiet output mode.
8955
8956 @item ^-D ^/DIRECTORY_OBJECTS=^@var{dir}
8957 @cindex @option{^-D^/DIRECTORY_OBJECTS^} (@command{gnatmake})
8958 Put all object files and ALI file in directory @var{dir}.
8959 If the @option{^-D^/DIRECTORY_OBJECTS^} switch is not used, all object files
8960 and ALI files go in the current working directory.
8961
8962 This switch cannot be used when using a project file.
8963
8964 @ifclear vms
8965 @item -eL
8966 @cindex @option{-eL} (@command{gnatmake})
8967 Follow all symbolic links when processing project files.
8968 @end ifclear
8969
8970 @item ^-eS^/STANDARD_OUTPUT_FOR_COMMANDS^
8971 @cindex @option{^-eS^/STANDARD_OUTPUT_FOR_COMMANDS^} (@command{gnatmake})
8972 Output the commands for the compiler, the binder and the linker
8973 on ^standard output^SYS$OUTPUT^,
8974 instead of ^standard error^SYS$ERROR^.
8975
8976 @item ^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^
8977 @cindex @option{^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^} (@command{gnatmake})
8978 Force recompilations. Recompile all sources, even though some object
8979 files may be up to date, but don't recompile predefined or GNAT internal
8980 files or locked files (files with a write-protected ALI file),
8981 unless the @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} switch is also specified.
8982
8983 @item ^-F^/FULL_PATH_IN_BRIEF_MESSAGES^
8984 @cindex @option{^-F^/FULL_PATH_IN_BRIEF_MESSAGES^} (@command{gnatmake})
8985 When using project files, if some errors or warnings are detected during
8986 parsing and verbose mode is not in effect (no use of switch
8987 ^-v^/VERBOSE^), then error lines start with the full path name of the project
8988 file, rather than its simple file name.
8989
8990 @item ^-g^/DEBUG^
8991 @cindex @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} (@command{gnatmake})
8992 Enable debugging. This switch is simply passed to the compiler and to the
8993 linker.
8994
8995 @item ^-i^/IN_PLACE^
8996 @cindex @option{^-i^/IN_PLACE^} (@command{gnatmake})
8997 In normal mode, @command{gnatmake} compiles all object files and ALI files
8998 into the current directory. If the @option{^-i^/IN_PLACE^} switch is used,
8999 then instead object files and ALI files that already exist are overwritten
9000 in place. This means that once a large project is organized into separate
9001 directories in the desired manner, then @command{gnatmake} will automatically
9002 maintain and update this organization. If no ALI files are found on the
9003 Ada object path (@ref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}),
9004 the new object and ALI files are created in the
9005 directory containing the source being compiled. If another organization
9006 is desired, where objects and sources are kept in different directories,
9007 a useful technique is to create dummy ALI files in the desired directories.
9008 When detecting such a dummy file, @command{gnatmake} will be forced to
9009 recompile the corresponding source file, and it will be put the resulting
9010 object and ALI files in the directory where it found the dummy file.
9011
9012 @item ^-j^/PROCESSES=^@var{n}
9013 @cindex @option{^-j^/PROCESSES^} (@command{gnatmake})
9014 @cindex Parallel make
9015 Use @var{n} processes to carry out the (re)compilations. On a
9016 multiprocessor machine compilations will occur in parallel. In the
9017 event of compilation errors, messages from various compilations might
9018 get interspersed (but @command{gnatmake} will give you the full ordered
9019 list of failing compiles at the end). If this is problematic, rerun
9020 the make process with n set to 1 to get a clean list of messages.
9021
9022 @item ^-k^/CONTINUE_ON_ERROR^
9023 @cindex @option{^-k^/CONTINUE_ON_ERROR^} (@command{gnatmake})
9024 Keep going. Continue as much as possible after a compilation error. To
9025 ease the programmer's task in case of compilation errors, the list of
9026 sources for which the compile fails is given when @command{gnatmake}
9027 terminates.
9028
9029 If @command{gnatmake} is invoked with several @file{file_names} and with this
9030 switch, if there are compilation errors when building an executable,
9031 @command{gnatmake} will not attempt to build the following executables.
9032
9033 @item ^-l^/ACTIONS=LINK^
9034 @cindex @option{^-l^/ACTIONS=LINK^} (@command{gnatmake})
9035 Link only. Can be combined with @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^} to binding
9036 and linking. Linking will not be performed if combined with
9037 @option{^-c^/ACTIONS=COMPILE^}
9038 but not with @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^}.
9039 When not combined with @option{^-b^/ACTIONS=BIND^}
9040 all the units in the closure of the main program must have been previously
9041 compiled and must be up to date, and the main program needs to have been bound.
9042 The root unit specified by @var{file_name}
9043 may be given without extension, with the source extension or, if no GNAT
9044 Project File is specified, with the ALI file extension.
9045
9046 @item ^-m^/MINIMAL_RECOMPILATION^
9047 @cindex @option{^-m^/MINIMAL_RECOMPILATION^} (@command{gnatmake})
9048 Specify that the minimum necessary amount of recompilations
9049 be performed. In this mode @command{gnatmake} ignores time
9050 stamp differences when the only
9051 modifications to a source file consist in adding/removing comments,
9052 empty lines, spaces or tabs. This means that if you have changed the
9053 comments in a source file or have simply reformatted it, using this
9054 switch will tell @command{gnatmake} not to recompile files that depend on it
9055 (provided other sources on which these files depend have undergone no
9056 semantic modifications). Note that the debugging information may be
9057 out of date with respect to the sources if the @option{-m} switch causes
9058 a compilation to be switched, so the use of this switch represents a
9059 trade-off between compilation time and accurate debugging information.
9060
9061 @item ^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^
9062 @cindex Dependencies, producing list
9063 @cindex @option{^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^} (@command{gnatmake})
9064 Check if all objects are up to date. If they are, output the object
9065 dependences to @file{stdout} in a form that can be directly exploited in
9066 a @file{Makefile}. By default, each source file is prefixed with its
9067 (relative or absolute) directory name. This name is whatever you
9068 specified in the various @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^}
9069 and @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} switches. If you use
9070 @code{gnatmake ^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^}
9071 @option{^-q^/QUIET^}
9072 (see below), only the source file names,
9073 without relative paths, are output. If you just specify the
9074 @option{^-M^/DEPENDENCIES_LIST^}
9075 switch, dependencies of the GNAT internal system files are omitted. This
9076 is typically what you want. If you also specify
9077 the @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} switch,
9078 dependencies of the GNAT internal files are also listed. Note that
9079 dependencies of the objects in external Ada libraries (see switch
9080 @option{^-aL^/SKIP_MISSING=^}@var{dir} in the following list)
9081 are never reported.
9082
9083 @item ^-n^/DO_OBJECT_CHECK^
9084 @cindex @option{^-n^/DO_OBJECT_CHECK^} (@command{gnatmake})
9085 Don't compile, bind, or link. Checks if all objects are up to date.
9086 If they are not, the full name of the first file that needs to be
9087 recompiled is printed.
9088 Repeated use of this option, followed by compiling the indicated source
9089 file, will eventually result in recompiling all required units.
9090
9091 @item ^-o ^/EXECUTABLE=^@var{exec_name}
9092 @cindex @option{^-o^/EXECUTABLE^} (@command{gnatmake})
9093 Output executable name. The name of the final executable program will be
9094 @var{exec_name}. If the @option{^-o^/EXECUTABLE^} switch is omitted the default
9095 name for the executable will be the name of the input file in appropriate form
9096 for an executable file on the host system.
9097
9098 This switch cannot be used when invoking @command{gnatmake} with several
9099 @file{file_names}.
9100
9101 @item ^-p or --create-missing-dirs^/CREATE_MISSING_DIRS^
9102 @cindex @option{^-p^/CREATE_MISSING_DIRS^} (@command{gnatmake})
9103 When using project files (^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@var{project}), create
9104 automatically missing object directories, library directories and exec
9105 directories.
9106
9107 @item ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@var{project}
9108 @cindex @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} (@command{gnatmake})
9109 Use project file @var{project}. Only one such switch can be used.
9110 @xref{gnatmake and Project Files}.
9111
9112 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
9113 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@command{gnatmake})
9114 Quiet. When this flag is not set, the commands carried out by
9115 @command{gnatmake} are displayed.
9116
9117 @item ^-s^/SWITCH_CHECK/^
9118 @cindex @option{^-s^/SWITCH_CHECK^} (@command{gnatmake})
9119 Recompile if compiler switches have changed since last compilation.
9120 All compiler switches but -I and -o are taken into account in the
9121 following way:
9122 orders between different ``first letter'' switches are ignored, but
9123 orders between same switches are taken into account. For example,
9124 @option{-O -O2} is different than @option{-O2 -O}, but @option{-g -O}
9125 is equivalent to @option{-O -g}.
9126
9127 This switch is recommended when Integrated Preprocessing is used.
9128
9129 @item ^-u^/UNIQUE^
9130 @cindex @option{^-u^/UNIQUE^} (@command{gnatmake})
9131 Unique. Recompile at most the main files. It implies -c. Combined with
9132 -f, it is equivalent to calling the compiler directly. Note that using
9133 ^-u^/UNIQUE^ with a project file and no main has a special meaning
9134 (@pxref{Project Files and Main Subprograms}).
9135
9136 @item ^-U^/ALL_PROJECTS^
9137 @cindex @option{^-U^/ALL_PROJECTS^} (@command{gnatmake})
9138 When used without a project file or with one or several mains on the command
9139 line, is equivalent to ^-u^/UNIQUE^. When used with a project file and no main
9140 on the command line, all sources of all project files are checked and compiled
9141 if not up to date, and libraries are rebuilt, if necessary.
9142
9143 @item ^-v^/REASONS^
9144 @cindex @option{^-v^/REASONS^} (@command{gnatmake})
9145 Verbose. Display the reason for all recompilations @command{gnatmake}
9146 decides are necessary, with the highest verbosity level.
9147
9148 @item ^-vl^/LOW_VERBOSITY^
9149 @cindex @option{^-vl^/LOW_VERBOSITY^} (@command{gnatmake})
9150 Verbosity level Low. Display fewer lines than in verbosity Medium.
9151
9152 @item ^-vm^/MEDIUM_VERBOSITY^
9153 @cindex @option{^-vm^/MEDIUM_VERBOSITY^} (@command{gnatmake})
9154 Verbosity level Medium. Potentially display fewer lines than in verbosity High.
9155
9156 @item ^-vh^/HIGH_VERBOSITY^
9157 @cindex @option{^-vm^/HIGH_VERBOSITY^} (@command{gnatmake})
9158 Verbosity level High. Equivalent to ^-v^/REASONS^.
9159
9160 @item ^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{x}
9161 Indicate the verbosity of the parsing of GNAT project files.
9162 @xref{Switches Related to Project Files}.
9163
9164 @item ^-x^/NON_PROJECT_UNIT_COMPILATION^
9165 @cindex @option{^-x^/NON_PROJECT_UNIT_COMPILATION^} (@command{gnatmake})
9166 Indicate that sources that are not part of any Project File may be compiled.
9167 Normally, when using Project Files, only sources that are part of a Project
9168 File may be compile. When this switch is used, a source outside of all Project
9169 Files may be compiled. The ALI file and the object file will be put in the
9170 object directory of the main Project. The compilation switches used will only
9171 be those specified on the command line. Even when
9172 @option{^-x^/NON_PROJECT_UNIT_COMPILATION^} is used, mains specified on the
9173 command line need to be sources of a project file.
9174
9175 @item ^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=^@var{name=value}
9176 Indicate that external variable @var{name} has the value @var{value}.
9177 The Project Manager will use this value for occurrences of
9178 @code{external(name)} when parsing the project file.
9179 @xref{Switches Related to Project Files}.
9180
9181 @item ^-z^/NOMAIN^
9182 @cindex @option{^-z^/NOMAIN^} (@command{gnatmake})
9183 No main subprogram. Bind and link the program even if the unit name
9184 given on the command line is a package name. The resulting executable
9185 will execute the elaboration routines of the package and its closure,
9186 then the finalization routines.
9187
9188 @end table
9189
9190 @table @asis
9191 @item @command{gcc} @asis{switches}
9192 @ifclear vms
9193 Any uppercase or multi-character switch that is not a @command{gnatmake} switch
9194 is passed to @command{gcc} (e.g.@: @option{-O}, @option{-gnato,} etc.)
9195 @end ifclear
9196 @ifset vms
9197 Any qualifier that cannot be recognized as a qualifier for @code{GNAT MAKE}
9198 but is recognizable as a valid qualifier for @code{GNAT COMPILE} is
9199 automatically treated as a compiler switch, and passed on to all
9200 compilations that are carried out.
9201 @end ifset
9202 @end table
9203
9204 @noindent
9205 Source and library search path switches:
9206
9207 @table @option
9208 @c !sort!
9209 @item ^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9210 @cindex @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatmake})
9211 When looking for source files also look in directory @var{dir}.
9212 The order in which source files search is undertaken is
9213 described in @ref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}.
9214
9215 @item ^-aL^/SKIP_MISSING=^@var{dir}
9216 @cindex @option{^-aL^/SKIP_MISSING^} (@command{gnatmake})
9217 Consider @var{dir} as being an externally provided Ada library.
9218 Instructs @command{gnatmake} to skip compilation units whose @file{.ALI}
9219 files have been located in directory @var{dir}. This allows you to have
9220 missing bodies for the units in @var{dir} and to ignore out of date bodies
9221 for the same units. You still need to specify
9222 the location of the specs for these units by using the switches
9223 @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}}
9224 or @option{^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}}.
9225 Note: this switch is provided for compatibility with previous versions
9226 of @command{gnatmake}. The easier method of causing standard libraries
9227 to be excluded from consideration is to write-protect the corresponding
9228 ALI files.
9229
9230 @item ^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9231 @cindex @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatmake})
9232 When searching for library and object files, look in directory
9233 @var{dir}. The order in which library files are searched is described in
9234 @ref{Search Paths for gnatbind}.
9235
9236 @item ^-A^/CONDITIONAL_SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9237 @cindex Search paths, for @command{gnatmake}
9238 @cindex @option{^-A^/CONDITIONAL_SOURCE_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatmake})
9239 Equivalent to @option{^-aL^/SKIP_MISSING=^@var{dir}
9240 ^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}}.
9241
9242 @item ^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9243 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@command{gnatmake})
9244 Equivalent to @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9245 ^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}}.
9246
9247 @item ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
9248 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@command{gnatmake})
9249 @cindex Source files, suppressing search
9250 Do not look for source files in the directory containing the source
9251 file named in the command line.
9252 Do not look for ALI or object files in the directory
9253 where @command{gnatmake} was invoked.
9254
9255 @item ^-L^/LIBRARY_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
9256 @cindex @option{^-L^/LIBRARY_SEARCH^} (@command{gnatmake})
9257 @cindex Linker libraries
9258 Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories in which the linker
9259 will search for libraries. This is equivalent to
9260 @option{-largs ^-L^/LIBRARY_SEARCH=^}@var{dir}.
9261 @ifclear vms
9262 Furthermore, under Windows, the sources pointed to by the libraries path
9263 set in the registry are not searched for.
9264 @end ifclear
9265
9266 @item -nostdinc
9267 @cindex @option{-nostdinc} (@command{gnatmake})
9268 Do not look for source files in the system default directory.
9269
9270 @item -nostdlib
9271 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} (@command{gnatmake})
9272 Do not look for library files in the system default directory.
9273
9274 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
9275 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@command{gnatmake})
9276 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. GNAT looks for the
9277 runtime
9278 in the following directories, and stops as soon as a valid runtime is found
9279 (@file{adainclude} or @file{ada_source_path}, and @file{adalib} or
9280 @file{ada_object_path} present):
9281
9282 @itemize @bullet
9283 @item <current directory>/$rts_path
9284
9285 @item <default-search-dir>/$rts_path
9286
9287 @item <default-search-dir>/rts-$rts_path
9288 @end itemize
9289
9290 @noindent
9291 The selected path is handled like a normal RTS path.
9292
9293 @end table
9294
9295 @node Mode Switches for gnatmake
9296 @section Mode Switches for @command{gnatmake}
9297
9298 @noindent
9299 The mode switches (referred to as @code{mode_switches}) allow the
9300 inclusion of switches that are to be passed to the compiler itself, the
9301 binder or the linker. The effect of a mode switch is to cause all
9302 subsequent switches up to the end of the switch list, or up to the next
9303 mode switch, to be interpreted as switches to be passed on to the
9304 designated component of GNAT.
9305
9306 @table @option
9307 @c !sort!
9308 @item -cargs @var{switches}
9309 @cindex @option{-cargs} (@command{gnatmake})
9310 Compiler switches. Here @var{switches} is a list of switches
9311 that are valid switches for @command{gcc}. They will be passed on to
9312 all compile steps performed by @command{gnatmake}.
9313
9314 @item -bargs @var{switches}
9315 @cindex @option{-bargs} (@command{gnatmake})
9316 Binder switches. Here @var{switches} is a list of switches
9317 that are valid switches for @code{gnatbind}. They will be passed on to
9318 all bind steps performed by @command{gnatmake}.
9319
9320 @item -largs @var{switches}
9321 @cindex @option{-largs} (@command{gnatmake})
9322 Linker switches. Here @var{switches} is a list of switches
9323 that are valid switches for @command{gnatlink}. They will be passed on to
9324 all link steps performed by @command{gnatmake}.
9325
9326 @item -margs @var{switches}
9327 @cindex @option{-margs} (@command{gnatmake})
9328 Make switches. The switches are directly interpreted by @command{gnatmake},
9329 regardless of any previous occurrence of @option{-cargs}, @option{-bargs}
9330 or @option{-largs}.
9331 @end table
9332
9333 @node Notes on the Command Line
9334 @section Notes on the Command Line
9335
9336 @noindent
9337 This section contains some additional useful notes on the operation
9338 of the @command{gnatmake} command.
9339
9340 @itemize @bullet
9341 @item
9342 @cindex Recompilation, by @command{gnatmake}
9343 If @command{gnatmake} finds no ALI files, it recompiles the main program
9344 and all other units required by the main program.
9345 This means that @command{gnatmake}
9346 can be used for the initial compile, as well as during subsequent steps of
9347 the development cycle.
9348
9349 @item
9350 If you enter @code{gnatmake @var{file}.adb}, where @file{@var{file}.adb}
9351 is a subunit or body of a generic unit, @command{gnatmake} recompiles
9352 @file{@var{file}.adb} (because it finds no ALI) and stops, issuing a
9353 warning.
9354
9355 @item
9356 In @command{gnatmake} the switch @option{^-I^/SEARCH^}
9357 is used to specify both source and
9358 library file paths. Use @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^}
9359 instead if you just want to specify
9360 source paths only and @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^}
9361 if you want to specify library paths
9362 only.
9363
9364 @item
9365 @command{gnatmake} will ignore any files whose ALI file is write-protected.
9366 This may conveniently be used to exclude standard libraries from
9367 consideration and in particular it means that the use of the
9368 @option{^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^} switch will not recompile these files
9369 unless @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} is also specified.
9370
9371 @item
9372 @command{gnatmake} has been designed to make the use of Ada libraries
9373 particularly convenient. Assume you have an Ada library organized
9374 as follows: @i{^obj-dir^[OBJ_DIR]^} contains the objects and ALI files for
9375 of your Ada compilation units,
9376 whereas @i{^include-dir^[INCLUDE_DIR]^} contains the
9377 specs of these units, but no bodies. Then to compile a unit
9378 stored in @code{main.adb}, which uses this Ada library you would just type
9379
9380 @smallexample
9381 @ifclear vms
9382 $ gnatmake -aI@var{include-dir} -aL@var{obj-dir} main
9383 @end ifclear
9384 @ifset vms
9385 $ gnatmake /SOURCE_SEARCH=@i{[INCLUDE_DIR]}
9386 /SKIP_MISSING=@i{[OBJ_DIR]} main
9387 @end ifset
9388 @end smallexample
9389
9390 @item
9391 Using @command{gnatmake} along with the
9392 @option{^-m (minimal recompilation)^/MINIMAL_RECOMPILATION^}
9393 switch provides a mechanism for avoiding unnecessary recompilations. Using
9394 this switch,
9395 you can update the comments/format of your
9396 source files without having to recompile everything. Note, however, that
9397 adding or deleting lines in a source files may render its debugging
9398 info obsolete. If the file in question is a spec, the impact is rather
9399 limited, as that debugging info will only be useful during the
9400 elaboration phase of your program. For bodies the impact can be more
9401 significant. In all events, your debugger will warn you if a source file
9402 is more recent than the corresponding object, and alert you to the fact
9403 that the debugging information may be out of date.
9404 @end itemize
9405
9406 @node How gnatmake Works
9407 @section How @command{gnatmake} Works
9408
9409 @noindent
9410 Generally @command{gnatmake} automatically performs all necessary
9411 recompilations and you don't need to worry about how it works. However,
9412 it may be useful to have some basic understanding of the @command{gnatmake}
9413 approach and in particular to understand how it uses the results of
9414 previous compilations without incorrectly depending on them.
9415
9416 First a definition: an object file is considered @dfn{up to date} if the
9417 corresponding ALI file exists and if all the source files listed in the
9418 dependency section of this ALI file have time stamps matching those in
9419 the ALI file. This means that neither the source file itself nor any
9420 files that it depends on have been modified, and hence there is no need
9421 to recompile this file.
9422
9423 @command{gnatmake} works by first checking if the specified main unit is up
9424 to date. If so, no compilations are required for the main unit. If not,
9425 @command{gnatmake} compiles the main program to build a new ALI file that
9426 reflects the latest sources. Then the ALI file of the main unit is
9427 examined to find all the source files on which the main program depends,
9428 and @command{gnatmake} recursively applies the above procedure on all these
9429 files.
9430
9431 This process ensures that @command{gnatmake} only trusts the dependencies
9432 in an existing ALI file if they are known to be correct. Otherwise it
9433 always recompiles to determine a new, guaranteed accurate set of
9434 dependencies. As a result the program is compiled ``upside down'' from what may
9435 be more familiar as the required order of compilation in some other Ada
9436 systems. In particular, clients are compiled before the units on which
9437 they depend. The ability of GNAT to compile in any order is critical in
9438 allowing an order of compilation to be chosen that guarantees that
9439 @command{gnatmake} will recompute a correct set of new dependencies if
9440 necessary.
9441
9442 When invoking @command{gnatmake} with several @var{file_names}, if a unit is
9443 imported by several of the executables, it will be recompiled at most once.
9444
9445 Note: when using non-standard naming conventions
9446 (@pxref{Using Other File Names}), changing through a configuration pragmas
9447 file the version of a source and invoking @command{gnatmake} to recompile may
9448 have no effect, if the previous version of the source is still accessible
9449 by @command{gnatmake}. It may be necessary to use the switch
9450 ^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^.
9451
9452 @node Examples of gnatmake Usage
9453 @section Examples of @command{gnatmake} Usage
9454
9455 @table @code
9456 @item gnatmake hello.adb
9457 Compile all files necessary to bind and link the main program
9458 @file{hello.adb} (containing unit @code{Hello}) and bind and link the
9459 resulting object files to generate an executable file @file{^hello^HELLO.EXE^}.
9460
9461 @item gnatmake main1 main2 main3
9462 Compile all files necessary to bind and link the main programs
9463 @file{main1.adb} (containing unit @code{Main1}), @file{main2.adb}
9464 (containing unit @code{Main2}) and @file{main3.adb}
9465 (containing unit @code{Main3}) and bind and link the resulting object files
9466 to generate three executable files @file{^main1^MAIN1.EXE^},
9467 @file{^main2^MAIN2.EXE^}
9468 and @file{^main3^MAIN3.EXE^}.
9469
9470 @ifclear vms
9471 @item gnatmake -q Main_Unit -cargs -O2 -bargs -l
9472 @end ifclear
9473
9474 @ifset vms
9475 @item gnatmake Main_Unit /QUIET
9476 /COMPILER_QUALIFIERS /OPTIMIZE=ALL
9477 /BINDER_QUALIFIERS /ORDER_OF_ELABORATION
9478 @end ifset
9479 Compile all files necessary to bind and link the main program unit
9480 @code{Main_Unit} (from file @file{main_unit.adb}). All compilations will
9481 be done with optimization level 2 and the order of elaboration will be
9482 listed by the binder. @command{gnatmake} will operate in quiet mode, not
9483 displaying commands it is executing.
9484 @end table
9485
9486 @c *************************
9487 @node Improving Performance
9488 @chapter Improving Performance
9489 @cindex Improving performance
9490
9491 @noindent
9492 This chapter presents several topics related to program performance.
9493 It first describes some of the tradeoffs that need to be considered
9494 and some of the techniques for making your program run faster.
9495 It then documents the @command{gnatelim} tool and unused subprogram/data
9496 elimination feature, which can reduce the size of program executables.
9497
9498 Note: to invoke @command{gnatelim} with a project file, use the @code{gnat}
9499 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
9500
9501 @ifnottex
9502 @menu
9503 * Performance Considerations::
9504 * Text_IO Suggestions::
9505 * Reducing Size of Ada Executables with gnatelim::
9506 * Reducing Size of Executables with unused subprogram/data elimination::
9507 @end menu
9508 @end ifnottex
9509
9510 @c *****************************
9511 @node Performance Considerations
9512 @section Performance Considerations
9513
9514 @noindent
9515 The GNAT system provides a number of options that allow a trade-off
9516 between
9517
9518 @itemize @bullet
9519 @item
9520 performance of the generated code
9521
9522 @item
9523 speed of compilation
9524
9525 @item
9526 minimization of dependences and recompilation
9527
9528 @item
9529 the degree of run-time checking.
9530 @end itemize
9531
9532 @noindent
9533 The defaults (if no options are selected) aim at improving the speed
9534 of compilation and minimizing dependences, at the expense of performance
9535 of the generated code:
9536
9537 @itemize @bullet
9538 @item
9539 no optimization
9540
9541 @item
9542 no inlining of subprogram calls
9543
9544 @item
9545 all run-time checks enabled except overflow and elaboration checks
9546 @end itemize
9547
9548 @noindent
9549 These options are suitable for most program development purposes. This
9550 chapter describes how you can modify these choices, and also provides
9551 some guidelines on debugging optimized code.
9552
9553 @menu
9554 * Controlling Run-Time Checks::
9555 * Use of Restrictions::
9556 * Optimization Levels::
9557 * Debugging Optimized Code::
9558 * Inlining of Subprograms::
9559 * Other Optimization Switches::
9560 * Optimization and Strict Aliasing::
9561
9562 @ifset vms
9563 * Coverage Analysis::
9564 @end ifset
9565 @end menu
9566
9567 @node Controlling Run-Time Checks
9568 @subsection Controlling Run-Time Checks
9569
9570 @noindent
9571 By default, GNAT generates all run-time checks, except integer overflow
9572 checks, stack overflow checks, and checks for access before elaboration on
9573 subprogram calls. The latter are not required in default mode, because all
9574 necessary checking is done at compile time.
9575 @cindex @option{-gnatp} (@command{gcc})
9576 @cindex @option{-gnato} (@command{gcc})
9577 Two gnat switches, @option{-gnatp} and @option{-gnato} allow this default to
9578 be modified. @xref{Run-Time Checks}.
9579
9580 Our experience is that the default is suitable for most development
9581 purposes.
9582
9583 We treat integer overflow specially because these
9584 are quite expensive and in our experience are not as important as other
9585 run-time checks in the development process. Note that division by zero
9586 is not considered an overflow check, and divide by zero checks are
9587 generated where required by default.
9588
9589 Elaboration checks are off by default, and also not needed by default, since
9590 GNAT uses a static elaboration analysis approach that avoids the need for
9591 run-time checking. This manual contains a full chapter discussing the issue
9592 of elaboration checks, and if the default is not satisfactory for your use,
9593 you should read this chapter.
9594
9595 For validity checks, the minimal checks required by the Ada Reference
9596 Manual (for case statements and assignments to array elements) are on
9597 by default. These can be suppressed by use of the @option{-gnatVn} switch.
9598 Note that in Ada 83, there were no validity checks, so if the Ada 83 mode
9599 is acceptable (or when comparing GNAT performance with an Ada 83 compiler),
9600 it may be reasonable to routinely use @option{-gnatVn}. Validity checks
9601 are also suppressed entirely if @option{-gnatp} is used.
9602
9603 @cindex Overflow checks
9604 @cindex Checks, overflow
9605 @findex Suppress
9606 @findex Unsuppress
9607 @cindex pragma Suppress
9608 @cindex pragma Unsuppress
9609 Note that the setting of the switches controls the default setting of
9610 the checks. They may be modified using either @code{pragma Suppress} (to
9611 remove checks) or @code{pragma Unsuppress} (to add back suppressed
9612 checks) in the program source.
9613
9614 @node Use of Restrictions
9615 @subsection Use of Restrictions
9616
9617 @noindent
9618 The use of pragma Restrictions allows you to control which features are
9619 permitted in your program. Apart from the obvious point that if you avoid
9620 relatively expensive features like finalization (enforceable by the use
9621 of pragma Restrictions (No_Finalization), the use of this pragma does not
9622 affect the generated code in most cases.
9623
9624 One notable exception to this rule is that the possibility of task abort
9625 results in some distributed overhead, particularly if finalization or
9626 exception handlers are used. The reason is that certain sections of code
9627 have to be marked as non-abortable.
9628
9629 If you use neither the @code{abort} statement, nor asynchronous transfer
9630 of control (@code{select @dots{} then abort}), then this distributed overhead
9631 is removed, which may have a general positive effect in improving
9632 overall performance. Especially code involving frequent use of tasking
9633 constructs and controlled types will show much improved performance.
9634 The relevant restrictions pragmas are
9635
9636 @smallexample @c ada
9637 pragma Restrictions (No_Abort_Statements);
9638 pragma Restrictions (Max_Asynchronous_Select_Nesting => 0);
9639 @end smallexample
9640
9641 @noindent
9642 It is recommended that these restriction pragmas be used if possible. Note
9643 that this also means that you can write code without worrying about the
9644 possibility of an immediate abort at any point.
9645
9646 @node Optimization Levels
9647 @subsection Optimization Levels
9648 @cindex @option{^-O^/OPTIMIZE^} (@command{gcc})
9649
9650 @noindent
9651 Without any optimization ^option,^qualifier,^
9652 the compiler's goal is to reduce the cost of
9653 compilation and to make debugging produce the expected results.
9654 Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a breakpoint between
9655 statements, you can then assign a new value to any variable or change
9656 the program counter to any other statement in the subprogram and get exactly
9657 the results you would expect from the source code.
9658
9659 Turning on optimization makes the compiler attempt to improve the
9660 performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time and
9661 possibly the ability to debug the program.
9662
9663 If you use multiple
9664 ^-O options, with or without level numbers,^/OPTIMIZE qualifiers,^
9665 the last such option is the one that is effective.
9666
9667 @noindent
9668 The default is optimization off. This results in the fastest compile
9669 times, but GNAT makes absolutely no attempt to optimize, and the
9670 generated programs are considerably larger and slower than when
9671 optimization is enabled. You can use the
9672 @ifclear vms
9673 @option{-O} switch (the permitted forms are @option{-O0}, @option{-O1}
9674 @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, and @option{-Os})
9675 @end ifclear
9676 @ifset vms
9677 @code{OPTIMIZE} qualifier
9678 @end ifset
9679 to @command{gcc} to control the optimization level:
9680
9681 @table @option
9682 @item ^-O0^/OPTIMIZE=NONE^
9683 No optimization (the default);
9684 generates unoptimized code but has
9685 the fastest compilation time.
9686
9687 Note that many other compilers do fairly extensive optimization
9688 even if ``no optimization'' is specified. With gcc, it is
9689 very unusual to use ^-O0^/OPTIMIZE=NONE^ for production if
9690 execution time is of any concern, since ^-O0^/OPTIMIZE=NONE^
9691 really does mean no optimization at all. This difference between
9692 gcc and other compilers should be kept in mind when doing
9693 performance comparisons.
9694
9695 @item ^-O1^/OPTIMIZE=SOME^
9696 Moderate optimization;
9697 optimizes reasonably well but does not
9698 degrade compilation time significantly.
9699
9700 @item ^-O2^/OPTIMIZE=ALL^
9701 @ifset vms
9702 @itemx /OPTIMIZE=DEVELOPMENT
9703 @end ifset
9704 Full optimization;
9705 generates highly optimized code and has
9706 the slowest compilation time.
9707
9708 @item ^-O3^/OPTIMIZE=INLINING^
9709 Full optimization as in @option{-O2},
9710 and also attempts automatic inlining of small
9711 subprograms within a unit (@pxref{Inlining of Subprograms}).
9712
9713 @item ^-Os^/OPTIMIZE=SPACE^
9714 Optimize space usage of resulting program.
9715 @end table
9716
9717 @noindent
9718 Higher optimization levels perform more global transformations on the
9719 program and apply more expensive analysis algorithms in order to generate
9720 faster and more compact code. The price in compilation time, and the
9721 resulting improvement in execution time,
9722 both depend on the particular application and the hardware environment.
9723 You should experiment to find the best level for your application.
9724
9725 Since the precise set of optimizations done at each level will vary from
9726 release to release (and sometime from target to target), it is best to think
9727 of the optimization settings in general terms.
9728 @xref{Optimize Options,, Options That Control Optimization, gcc, Using
9729 the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for details about
9730 ^the @option{-O} settings and a number of @option{-f} options that^how to^
9731 individually enable or disable specific optimizations.
9732
9733 Unlike some other compilation systems, ^@command{gcc}^GNAT^ has
9734 been tested extensively at all optimization levels. There are some bugs
9735 which appear only with optimization turned on, but there have also been
9736 bugs which show up only in @emph{unoptimized} code. Selecting a lower
9737 level of optimization does not improve the reliability of the code
9738 generator, which in practice is highly reliable at all optimization
9739 levels.
9740
9741 Note regarding the use of @option{-O3}: The use of this optimization level
9742 is generally discouraged with GNAT, since it often results in larger
9743 executables which run more slowly. See further discussion of this point
9744 in @ref{Inlining of Subprograms}.
9745
9746 @node Debugging Optimized Code
9747 @subsection Debugging Optimized Code
9748 @cindex Debugging optimized code
9749 @cindex Optimization and debugging
9750
9751 @noindent
9752 Although it is possible to do a reasonable amount of debugging at
9753 @ifclear vms
9754 nonzero optimization levels,
9755 the higher the level the more likely that
9756 @end ifclear
9757 @ifset vms
9758 @option{/OPTIMIZE} settings other than @code{NONE},
9759 such settings will make it more likely that
9760 @end ifset
9761 source-level constructs will have been eliminated by optimization.
9762 For example, if a loop is strength-reduced, the loop
9763 control variable may be completely eliminated and thus cannot be
9764 displayed in the debugger.
9765 This can only happen at @option{-O2} or @option{-O3}.
9766 Explicit temporary variables that you code might be eliminated at
9767 ^level^setting^ @option{-O1} or higher.
9768
9769 The use of the @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch,
9770 @cindex @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} (@command{gcc})
9771 which is needed for source-level debugging,
9772 affects the size of the program executable on disk,
9773 and indeed the debugging information can be quite large.
9774 However, it has no effect on the generated code (and thus does not
9775 degrade performance)
9776
9777 Since the compiler generates debugging tables for a compilation unit before
9778 it performs optimizations, the optimizing transformations may invalidate some
9779 of the debugging data. You therefore need to anticipate certain
9780 anomalous situations that may arise while debugging optimized code.
9781 These are the most common cases:
9782
9783 @enumerate
9784 @item
9785 @i{The ``hopping Program Counter'':} Repeated @code{step} or @code{next}
9786 commands show
9787 the PC bouncing back and forth in the code. This may result from any of
9788 the following optimizations:
9789
9790 @itemize @bullet
9791 @item
9792 @i{Common subexpression elimination:} using a single instance of code for a
9793 quantity that the source computes several times. As a result you
9794 may not be able to stop on what looks like a statement.
9795
9796 @item
9797 @i{Invariant code motion:} moving an expression that does not change within a
9798 loop, to the beginning of the loop.
9799
9800 @item
9801 @i{Instruction scheduling:} moving instructions so as to
9802 overlap loads and stores (typically) with other code, or in
9803 general to move computations of values closer to their uses. Often
9804 this causes you to pass an assignment statement without the assignment
9805 happening and then later bounce back to the statement when the
9806 value is actually needed. Placing a breakpoint on a line of code
9807 and then stepping over it may, therefore, not always cause all the
9808 expected side-effects.
9809 @end itemize
9810
9811 @item
9812 @i{The ``big leap'':} More commonly known as @emph{cross-jumping}, in which
9813 two identical pieces of code are merged and the program counter suddenly
9814 jumps to a statement that is not supposed to be executed, simply because
9815 it (and the code following) translates to the same thing as the code
9816 that @emph{was} supposed to be executed. This effect is typically seen in
9817 sequences that end in a jump, such as a @code{goto}, a @code{return}, or
9818 a @code{break} in a C @code{^switch^switch^} statement.
9819
9820 @item
9821 @i{The ``roving variable'':} The symptom is an unexpected value in a variable.
9822 There are various reasons for this effect:
9823
9824 @itemize @bullet
9825 @item
9826 In a subprogram prologue, a parameter may not yet have been moved to its
9827 ``home''.
9828
9829 @item
9830 A variable may be dead, and its register re-used. This is
9831 probably the most common cause.
9832
9833 @item
9834 As mentioned above, the assignment of a value to a variable may
9835 have been moved.
9836
9837 @item
9838 A variable may be eliminated entirely by value propagation or
9839 other means. In this case, GCC may incorrectly generate debugging
9840 information for the variable
9841 @end itemize
9842
9843 @noindent
9844 In general, when an unexpected value appears for a local variable or parameter
9845 you should first ascertain if that value was actually computed by
9846 your program, as opposed to being incorrectly reported by the debugger.
9847 Record fields or
9848 array elements in an object designated by an access value
9849 are generally less of a problem, once you have ascertained that the access
9850 value is sensible.
9851 Typically, this means checking variables in the preceding code and in the
9852 calling subprogram to verify that the value observed is explainable from other
9853 values (one must apply the procedure recursively to those
9854 other values); or re-running the code and stopping a little earlier
9855 (perhaps before the call) and stepping to better see how the variable obtained
9856 the value in question; or continuing to step @emph{from} the point of the
9857 strange value to see if code motion had simply moved the variable's
9858 assignments later.
9859 @end enumerate
9860
9861 @noindent
9862 In light of such anomalies, a recommended technique is to use @option{-O0}
9863 early in the software development cycle, when extensive debugging capabilities
9864 are most needed, and then move to @option{-O1} and later @option{-O2} as
9865 the debugger becomes less critical.
9866 Whether to use the @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch in the release version is
9867 a release management issue.
9868 @ifclear vms
9869 Note that if you use @option{-g} you can then use the @command{strip} program
9870 on the resulting executable,
9871 which removes both debugging information and global symbols.
9872 @end ifclear
9873
9874 @node Inlining of Subprograms
9875 @subsection Inlining of Subprograms
9876
9877 @noindent
9878 A call to a subprogram in the current unit is inlined if all the
9879 following conditions are met:
9880
9881 @itemize @bullet
9882 @item
9883 The optimization level is at least @option{-O1}.
9884
9885 @item
9886 The called subprogram is suitable for inlining: It must be small enough
9887 and not contain something that @command{gcc} cannot support in inlined
9888 subprograms.
9889
9890 @item
9891 @cindex pragma Inline
9892 @findex Inline
9893 Either @code{pragma Inline} applies to the subprogram, or it is local
9894 to the unit and called once from within it, or it is small and automatic
9895 inlining (optimization level @option{-O3}) is specified.
9896 @end itemize
9897
9898 @noindent
9899 Calls to subprograms in @code{with}'ed units are normally not inlined.
9900 To achieve actual inlining (that is, replacement of the call by the code
9901 in the body of the subprogram), the following conditions must all be true.
9902
9903 @itemize @bullet
9904 @item
9905 The optimization level is at least @option{-O1}.
9906
9907 @item
9908 The called subprogram is suitable for inlining: It must be small enough
9909 and not contain something that @command{gcc} cannot support in inlined
9910 subprograms.
9911
9912 @item
9913 The call appears in a body (not in a package spec).
9914
9915 @item
9916 There is a @code{pragma Inline} for the subprogram.
9917
9918 @item
9919 @cindex @option{-gnatn} (@command{gcc})
9920 The @option{^-gnatn^/INLINE^} switch
9921 is used in the @command{gcc} command line
9922 @end itemize
9923
9924 Even if all these conditions are met, it may not be possible for
9925 the compiler to inline the call, due to the length of the body,
9926 or features in the body that make it impossible for the compiler
9927 to do the inlining.
9928
9929 Note that specifying the @option{-gnatn} switch causes additional
9930 compilation dependencies. Consider the following:
9931
9932 @smallexample @c ada
9933 @cartouche
9934 package R is
9935 procedure Q;
9936 pragma Inline (Q);
9937 end R;
9938 package body R is
9939 @dots{}
9940 end R;
9941
9942 with R;
9943 procedure Main is
9944 begin
9945 @dots{}
9946 R.Q;
9947 end Main;
9948 @end cartouche
9949 @end smallexample
9950
9951 @noindent
9952 With the default behavior (no @option{-gnatn} switch specified), the
9953 compilation of the @code{Main} procedure depends only on its own source,
9954 @file{main.adb}, and the spec of the package in file @file{r.ads}. This
9955 means that editing the body of @code{R} does not require recompiling
9956 @code{Main}.
9957
9958 On the other hand, the call @code{R.Q} is not inlined under these
9959 circumstances. If the @option{-gnatn} switch is present when @code{Main}
9960 is compiled, the call will be inlined if the body of @code{Q} is small
9961 enough, but now @code{Main} depends on the body of @code{R} in
9962 @file{r.adb} as well as on the spec. This means that if this body is edited,
9963 the main program must be recompiled. Note that this extra dependency
9964 occurs whether or not the call is in fact inlined by @command{gcc}.
9965
9966 The use of front end inlining with @option{-gnatN} generates similar
9967 additional dependencies.
9968
9969 @cindex @option{^-fno-inline^/INLINE=SUPPRESS^} (@command{gcc})
9970 Note: The @option{^-fno-inline^/INLINE=SUPPRESS^} switch
9971 can be used to prevent
9972 all inlining. This switch overrides all other conditions and ensures
9973 that no inlining occurs. The extra dependences resulting from
9974 @option{-gnatn} will still be active, even if
9975 this switch is used to suppress the resulting inlining actions.
9976
9977 @cindex @option{-fno-inline-functions} (@command{gcc})
9978 Note: The @option{-fno-inline-functions} switch can be used to prevent
9979 automatic inlining of small subprograms if @option{-O3} is used.
9980
9981 @cindex @option{-fno-inline-functions-called-once} (@command{gcc})
9982 Note: The @option{-fno-inline-functions-called-once} switch
9983 can be used to prevent inlining of subprograms local to the unit
9984 and called once from within it if @option{-O1} is used.
9985
9986 Note regarding the use of @option{-O3}: There is no difference in inlining
9987 behavior between @option{-O2} and @option{-O3} for subprograms with an explicit
9988 pragma @code{Inline} assuming the use of @option{-gnatn}
9989 or @option{-gnatN} (the switches that activate inlining). If you have used
9990 pragma @code{Inline} in appropriate cases, then it is usually much better
9991 to use @option{-O2} and @option{-gnatn} and avoid the use of @option{-O3} which
9992 in this case only has the effect of inlining subprograms you did not
9993 think should be inlined. We often find that the use of @option{-O3} slows
9994 down code by performing excessive inlining, leading to increased instruction
9995 cache pressure from the increased code size. So the bottom line here is
9996 that you should not automatically assume that @option{-O3} is better than
9997 @option{-O2}, and indeed you should use @option{-O3} only if tests show that
9998 it actually improves performance.
9999
10000 @node Other Optimization Switches
10001 @subsection Other Optimization Switches
10002 @cindex Optimization Switches
10003
10004 Since @code{GNAT} uses the @command{gcc} back end, all the specialized
10005 @command{gcc} optimization switches are potentially usable. These switches
10006 have not been extensively tested with GNAT but can generally be expected
10007 to work. Examples of switches in this category are
10008 @option{-funroll-loops} and
10009 the various target-specific @option{-m} options (in particular, it has been
10010 observed that @option{-march=pentium4} can significantly improve performance
10011 on appropriate machines). For full details of these switches, see
10012 @ref{Submodel Options,, Hardware Models and Configurations, gcc, Using
10013 the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10014
10015 @node Optimization and Strict Aliasing
10016 @subsection Optimization and Strict Aliasing
10017 @cindex Aliasing
10018 @cindex Strict Aliasing
10019 @cindex No_Strict_Aliasing
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 The strong typing capabilities of Ada allow an optimizer to generate
10023 efficient code in situations where other languages would be forced to
10024 make worst case assumptions preventing such optimizations. Consider
10025 the following example:
10026
10027 @smallexample @c ada
10028 @cartouche
10029 procedure R is
10030 type Int1 is new Integer;
10031 type Int2 is new Integer;
10032 type Int1A is access Int1;
10033 type Int2A is access Int2;
10034 Int1V : Int1A;
10035 Int2V : Int2A;
10036 @dots{}
10037
10038 begin
10039 @dots{}
10040 for J in Data'Range loop
10041 if Data (J) = Int1V.all then
10042 Int2V.all := Int2V.all + 1;
10043 end if;
10044 end loop;
10045 @dots{}
10046 end R;
10047 @end cartouche
10048 @end smallexample
10049
10050 @noindent
10051 In this example, since the variable @code{Int1V} can only access objects
10052 of type @code{Int1}, and @code{Int2V} can only access objects of type
10053 @code{Int2}, there is no possibility that the assignment to
10054 @code{Int2V.all} affects the value of @code{Int1V.all}. This means that
10055 the compiler optimizer can "know" that the value @code{Int1V.all} is constant
10056 for all iterations of the loop and avoid the extra memory reference
10057 required to dereference it each time through the loop.
10058
10059 This kind of optimization, called strict aliasing analysis, is
10060 triggered by specifying an optimization level of @option{-O2} or
10061 higher and allows @code{GNAT} to generate more efficient code
10062 when access values are involved.
10063
10064 However, although this optimization is always correct in terms of
10065 the formal semantics of the Ada Reference Manual, difficulties can
10066 arise if features like @code{Unchecked_Conversion} are used to break
10067 the typing system. Consider the following complete program example:
10068
10069 @smallexample @c ada
10070 @cartouche
10071 package p1 is
10072 type int1 is new integer;
10073 type int2 is new integer;
10074 type a1 is access int1;
10075 type a2 is access int2;
10076 end p1;
10077
10078 with p1; use p1;
10079 package p2 is
10080 function to_a2 (Input : a1) return a2;
10081 end p2;
10082
10083 with Unchecked_Conversion;
10084 package body p2 is
10085 function to_a2 (Input : a1) return a2 is
10086 function to_a2u is
10087 new Unchecked_Conversion (a1, a2);
10088 begin
10089 return to_a2u (Input);
10090 end to_a2;
10091 end p2;
10092
10093 with p2; use p2;
10094 with p1; use p1;
10095 with Text_IO; use Text_IO;
10096 procedure m is
10097 v1 : a1 := new int1;
10098 v2 : a2 := to_a2 (v1);
10099 begin
10100 v1.all := 1;
10101 v2.all := 0;
10102 put_line (int1'image (v1.all));
10103 end;
10104 @end cartouche
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 This program prints out 0 in @option{-O0} or @option{-O1}
10109 mode, but it prints out 1 in @option{-O2} mode. That's
10110 because in strict aliasing mode, the compiler can and
10111 does assume that the assignment to @code{v2.all} could not
10112 affect the value of @code{v1.all}, since different types
10113 are involved.
10114
10115 This behavior is not a case of non-conformance with the standard, since
10116 the Ada RM specifies that an unchecked conversion where the resulting
10117 bit pattern is not a correct value of the target type can result in an
10118 abnormal value and attempting to reference an abnormal value makes the
10119 execution of a program erroneous. That's the case here since the result
10120 does not point to an object of type @code{int2}. This means that the
10121 effect is entirely unpredictable.
10122
10123 However, although that explanation may satisfy a language
10124 lawyer, in practice an applications programmer expects an
10125 unchecked conversion involving pointers to create true
10126 aliases and the behavior of printing 1 seems plain wrong.
10127 In this case, the strict aliasing optimization is unwelcome.
10128
10129 Indeed the compiler recognizes this possibility, and the
10130 unchecked conversion generates a warning:
10131
10132 @smallexample
10133 p2.adb:5:07: warning: possible aliasing problem with type "a2"
10134 p2.adb:5:07: warning: use -fno-strict-aliasing switch for references
10135 p2.adb:5:07: warning: or use "pragma No_Strict_Aliasing (a2);"
10136 @end smallexample
10137
10138 @noindent
10139 Unfortunately the problem is recognized when compiling the body of
10140 package @code{p2}, but the actual "bad" code is generated while
10141 compiling the body of @code{m} and this latter compilation does not see
10142 the suspicious @code{Unchecked_Conversion}.
10143
10144 As implied by the warning message, there are approaches you can use to
10145 avoid the unwanted strict aliasing optimization in a case like this.
10146
10147 One possibility is to simply avoid the use of @option{-O2}, but
10148 that is a bit drastic, since it throws away a number of useful
10149 optimizations that do not involve strict aliasing assumptions.
10150
10151 A less drastic approach is to compile the program using the
10152 option @option{-fno-strict-aliasing}. Actually it is only the
10153 unit containing the dereferencing of the suspicious pointer
10154 that needs to be compiled. So in this case, if we compile
10155 unit @code{m} with this switch, then we get the expected
10156 value of zero printed. Analyzing which units might need
10157 the switch can be painful, so a more reasonable approach
10158 is to compile the entire program with options @option{-O2}
10159 and @option{-fno-strict-aliasing}. If the performance is
10160 satisfactory with this combination of options, then the
10161 advantage is that the entire issue of possible "wrong"
10162 optimization due to strict aliasing is avoided.
10163
10164 To avoid the use of compiler switches, the configuration
10165 pragma @code{No_Strict_Aliasing} with no parameters may be
10166 used to specify that for all access types, the strict
10167 aliasing optimization should be suppressed.
10168
10169 However, these approaches are still overkill, in that they causes
10170 all manipulations of all access values to be deoptimized. A more
10171 refined approach is to concentrate attention on the specific
10172 access type identified as problematic.
10173
10174 First, if a careful analysis of uses of the pointer shows
10175 that there are no possible problematic references, then
10176 the warning can be suppressed by bracketing the
10177 instantiation of @code{Unchecked_Conversion} to turn
10178 the warning off:
10179
10180 @smallexample @c ada
10181 pragma Warnings (Off);
10182 function to_a2u is
10183 new Unchecked_Conversion (a1, a2);
10184 pragma Warnings (On);
10185 @end smallexample
10186
10187 @noindent
10188 Of course that approach is not appropriate for this particular
10189 example, since indeed there is a problematic reference. In this
10190 case we can take one of two other approaches.
10191
10192 The first possibility is to move the instantiation of unchecked
10193 conversion to the unit in which the type is declared. In
10194 this example, we would move the instantiation of
10195 @code{Unchecked_Conversion} from the body of package
10196 @code{p2} to the spec of package @code{p1}. Now the
10197 warning disappears. That's because any use of the
10198 access type knows there is a suspicious unchecked
10199 conversion, and the strict aliasing optimization
10200 is automatically suppressed for the type.
10201
10202 If it is not practical to move the unchecked conversion to the same unit
10203 in which the destination access type is declared (perhaps because the
10204 source type is not visible in that unit), you may use pragma
10205 @code{No_Strict_Aliasing} for the type. This pragma must occur in the
10206 same declarative sequence as the declaration of the access type:
10207
10208 @smallexample @c ada
10209 type a2 is access int2;
10210 pragma No_Strict_Aliasing (a2);
10211 @end smallexample
10212
10213 @noindent
10214 Here again, the compiler now knows that the strict aliasing optimization
10215 should be suppressed for any reference to type @code{a2} and the
10216 expected behavior is obtained.
10217
10218 Finally, note that although the compiler can generate warnings for
10219 simple cases of unchecked conversions, there are tricker and more
10220 indirect ways of creating type incorrect aliases which the compiler
10221 cannot detect. Examples are the use of address overlays and unchecked
10222 conversions involving composite types containing access types as
10223 components. In such cases, no warnings are generated, but there can
10224 still be aliasing problems. One safe coding practice is to forbid the
10225 use of address clauses for type overlaying, and to allow unchecked
10226 conversion only for primitive types. This is not really a significant
10227 restriction since any possible desired effect can be achieved by
10228 unchecked conversion of access values.
10229
10230 @ifset vms
10231 @node Coverage Analysis
10232 @subsection Coverage Analysis
10233
10234 @noindent
10235 GNAT supports the HP Performance Coverage Analyzer (PCA), which allows
10236 the user to determine the distribution of execution time across a program,
10237 @pxref{Profiling} for details of usage.
10238 @end ifset
10239
10240
10241 @node Text_IO Suggestions
10242 @section @code{Text_IO} Suggestions
10243 @cindex @code{Text_IO} and performance
10244
10245 @noindent
10246 The @code{Ada.Text_IO} package has fairly high overheads due in part to
10247 the requirement of maintaining page and line counts. If performance
10248 is critical, a recommendation is to use @code{Stream_IO} instead of
10249 @code{Text_IO} for volume output, since this package has less overhead.
10250
10251 If @code{Text_IO} must be used, note that by default output to the standard
10252 output and standard error files is unbuffered (this provides better
10253 behavior when output statements are used for debugging, or if the
10254 progress of a program is observed by tracking the output, e.g. by
10255 using the Unix @command{tail -f} command to watch redirected output.
10256
10257 If you are generating large volumes of output with @code{Text_IO} and
10258 performance is an important factor, use a designated file instead
10259 of the standard output file, or change the standard output file to
10260 be buffered using @code{Interfaces.C_Streams.setvbuf}.
10261
10262
10263
10264 @node Reducing Size of Ada Executables with gnatelim
10265 @section Reducing Size of Ada Executables with @code{gnatelim}
10266 @findex gnatelim
10267
10268 @noindent
10269 This section describes @command{gnatelim}, a tool which detects unused
10270 subprograms and helps the compiler to create a smaller executable for your
10271 program.
10272
10273 @menu
10274 * About gnatelim::
10275 * Running gnatelim::
10276 * Correcting the List of Eliminate Pragmas::
10277 * Making Your Executables Smaller::
10278 * Summary of the gnatelim Usage Cycle::
10279 @end menu
10280
10281 @node About gnatelim
10282 @subsection About @code{gnatelim}
10283
10284 @noindent
10285 When a program shares a set of Ada
10286 packages with other programs, it may happen that this program uses
10287 only a fraction of the subprograms defined in these packages. The code
10288 created for these unused subprograms increases the size of the executable.
10289
10290 @code{gnatelim} tracks unused subprograms in an Ada program and
10291 outputs a list of GNAT-specific pragmas @code{Eliminate} marking all the
10292 subprograms that are declared but never called. By placing the list of
10293 @code{Eliminate} pragmas in the GNAT configuration file @file{gnat.adc} and
10294 recompiling your program, you may decrease the size of its executable,
10295 because the compiler will not generate the code for 'eliminated' subprograms.
10296 @xref{Pragma Eliminate,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}, for more
10297 information about this pragma.
10298
10299 @code{gnatelim} needs as its input data the name of the main subprogram
10300 and a bind file for a main subprogram.
10301
10302 To create a bind file for @code{gnatelim}, run @code{gnatbind} for
10303 the main subprogram. @code{gnatelim} can work with both Ada and C
10304 bind files; when both are present, it uses the Ada bind file.
10305 The following commands will build the program and create the bind file:
10306
10307 @smallexample
10308 $ gnatmake ^-c Main_Prog^/ACTIONS=COMPILE MAIN_PROG^
10309 $ gnatbind main_prog
10310 @end smallexample
10311
10312 Note that @code{gnatelim} needs neither object nor ALI files.
10313
10314 @node Running gnatelim
10315 @subsection Running @code{gnatelim}
10316
10317 @noindent
10318 @code{gnatelim} has the following command-line interface:
10319
10320 @smallexample
10321 $ gnatelim @ovar{options} name
10322 @end smallexample
10323
10324 @noindent
10325 @code{name} should be a name of a source file that contains the main subprogram
10326 of a program (partition).
10327
10328 @code{gnatelim} has the following switches:
10329
10330 @table @option
10331 @c !sort!
10332 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
10333 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@command{gnatelim})
10334 Quiet mode: by default @code{gnatelim} outputs to the standard error
10335 stream the number of program units left to be processed. This option turns
10336 this trace off.
10337
10338 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
10339 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@command{gnatelim})
10340 Verbose mode: @code{gnatelim} version information is printed as Ada
10341 comments to the standard output stream. Also, in addition to the number of
10342 program units left @code{gnatelim} will output the name of the current unit
10343 being processed.
10344
10345 @item ^-a^/ALL^
10346 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL^} (@command{gnatelim})
10347 Also look for subprograms from the GNAT run time that can be eliminated. Note
10348 that when @file{gnat.adc} is produced using this switch, the entire program
10349 must be recompiled with switch @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} to @command{gnatmake}.
10350
10351 @item ^-I^/INCLUDE_DIRS=^@var{dir}
10352 @cindex @option{^-I^/INCLUDE_DIRS^} (@command{gnatelim})
10353 When looking for source files also look in directory @var{dir}. Specifying
10354 @option{^-I-^/INCLUDE_DIRS=-^} instructs @code{gnatelim} not to look for
10355 sources in the current directory.
10356
10357 @item ^-b^/BIND_FILE=^@var{bind_file}
10358 @cindex @option{^-b^/BIND_FILE^} (@command{gnatelim})
10359 Specifies @var{bind_file} as the bind file to process. If not set, the name
10360 of the bind file is computed from the full expanded Ada name
10361 of a main subprogram.
10362
10363 @item ^-C^/CONFIG_FILE=^@var{config_file}
10364 @cindex @option{^-C^/CONFIG_FILE^} (@command{gnatelim})
10365 Specifies a file @var{config_file} that contains configuration pragmas. The
10366 file must be specified with full path.
10367
10368 @item ^--GCC^/COMPILER^=@var{compiler_name}
10369 @cindex @option{^-GCC^/COMPILER^} (@command{gnatelim})
10370 Instructs @code{gnatelim} to use specific @command{gcc} compiler instead of one
10371 available on the path.
10372
10373 @item ^--GNATMAKE^/GNATMAKE^=@var{gnatmake_name}
10374 @cindex @option{^--GNATMAKE^/GNATMAKE^} (@command{gnatelim})
10375 Instructs @code{gnatelim} to use specific @command{gnatmake} instead of one
10376 available on the path.
10377 @end table
10378
10379 @noindent
10380 @code{gnatelim} sends its output to the standard output stream, and all the
10381 tracing and debug information is sent to the standard error stream.
10382 In order to produce a proper GNAT configuration file
10383 @file{gnat.adc}, redirection must be used:
10384
10385 @smallexample
10386 @ifset vms
10387 $ PIPE GNAT ELIM MAIN_PROG.ADB > GNAT.ADC
10388 @end ifset
10389 @ifclear vms
10390 $ gnatelim main_prog.adb > gnat.adc
10391 @end ifclear
10392 @end smallexample
10393
10394 @ifclear vms
10395 @noindent
10396 or
10397
10398 @smallexample
10399 $ gnatelim main_prog.adb >> gnat.adc
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 @noindent
10403 in order to append the @code{gnatelim} output to the existing contents of
10404 @file{gnat.adc}.
10405 @end ifclear
10406
10407 @node Correcting the List of Eliminate Pragmas
10408 @subsection Correcting the List of Eliminate Pragmas
10409
10410 @noindent
10411 In some rare cases @code{gnatelim} may try to eliminate
10412 subprograms that are actually called in the program. In this case, the
10413 compiler will generate an error message of the form:
10414
10415 @smallexample
10416 file.adb:106:07: cannot call eliminated subprogram "My_Prog"
10417 @end smallexample
10418
10419 @noindent
10420 You will need to manually remove the wrong @code{Eliminate} pragmas from
10421 the @file{gnat.adc} file. You should recompile your program
10422 from scratch after that, because you need a consistent @file{gnat.adc} file
10423 during the entire compilation.
10424
10425 @node Making Your Executables Smaller
10426 @subsection Making Your Executables Smaller
10427
10428 @noindent
10429 In order to get a smaller executable for your program you now have to
10430 recompile the program completely with the new @file{gnat.adc} file
10431 created by @code{gnatelim} in your current directory:
10432
10433 @smallexample
10434 $ gnatmake ^-f main_prog^/FORCE_COMPILE MAIN_PROG^
10435 @end smallexample
10436
10437 @noindent
10438 (Use the @option{^-f^/FORCE_COMPILE^} option for @command{gnatmake} to
10439 recompile everything
10440 with the set of pragmas @code{Eliminate} that you have obtained with
10441 @command{gnatelim}).
10442
10443 Be aware that the set of @code{Eliminate} pragmas is specific to each
10444 program. It is not recommended to merge sets of @code{Eliminate}
10445 pragmas created for different programs in one @file{gnat.adc} file.
10446
10447 @node Summary of the gnatelim Usage Cycle
10448 @subsection Summary of the gnatelim Usage Cycle
10449
10450 @noindent
10451 Here is a quick summary of the steps to be taken in order to reduce
10452 the size of your executables with @code{gnatelim}. You may use
10453 other GNAT options to control the optimization level,
10454 to produce the debugging information, to set search path, etc.
10455
10456 @enumerate
10457 @item
10458 Produce a bind file
10459
10460 @smallexample
10461 $ gnatmake ^-c main_prog^/ACTIONS=COMPILE MAIN_PROG^
10462 $ gnatbind main_prog
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @item
10466 Generate a list of @code{Eliminate} pragmas
10467 @smallexample
10468 @ifset vms
10469 $ PIPE GNAT ELIM MAIN_PROG > GNAT.ADC
10470 @end ifset
10471 @ifclear vms
10472 $ gnatelim main_prog >@r{[}>@r{]} gnat.adc
10473 @end ifclear
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @item
10477 Recompile the application
10478
10479 @smallexample
10480 $ gnatmake ^-f main_prog^/FORCE_COMPILE MAIN_PROG^
10481 @end smallexample
10482
10483 @end enumerate
10484
10485 @node Reducing Size of Executables with unused subprogram/data elimination
10486 @section Reducing Size of Executables with Unused Subprogram/Data Elimination
10487 @findex unused subprogram/data elimination
10488
10489 @noindent
10490 This section describes how you can eliminate unused subprograms and data from
10491 your executable just by setting options at compilation time.
10492
10493 @menu
10494 * About unused subprogram/data elimination::
10495 * Compilation options::
10496 * Example of unused subprogram/data elimination::
10497 @end menu
10498
10499 @node About unused subprogram/data elimination
10500 @subsection About unused subprogram/data elimination
10501
10502 @noindent
10503 By default, an executable contains all code and data of its composing objects
10504 (directly linked or coming from statically linked libraries), even data or code
10505 never used by this executable.
10506
10507 This feature will allow you to eliminate such unused code from your
10508 executable, making it smaller (in disk and in memory).
10509
10510 This functionality is available on all Linux platforms except for the IA-64
10511 architecture and on all cross platforms using the ELF binary file format.
10512 In both cases GNU binutils version 2.16 or later are required to enable it.
10513
10514 @node Compilation options
10515 @subsection Compilation options
10516
10517 @noindent
10518 The operation of eliminating the unused code and data from the final executable
10519 is directly performed by the linker.
10520
10521 In order to do this, it has to work with objects compiled with the
10522 following options:
10523 @option{-ffunction-sections} @option{-fdata-sections}.
10524 @cindex @option{-ffunction-sections} (@command{gcc})
10525 @cindex @option{-fdata-sections} (@command{gcc})
10526 These options are usable with C and Ada files.
10527 They will place respectively each
10528 function or data in a separate section in the resulting object file.
10529
10530 Once the objects and static libraries are created with these options, the
10531 linker can perform the dead code elimination. You can do this by setting
10532 the @option{-Wl,--gc-sections} option to gcc command or in the
10533 @option{-largs} section of @command{gnatmake}. This will perform a
10534 garbage collection of code and data never referenced.
10535
10536 If the linker performs a partial link (@option{-r} ld linker option), then you
10537 will need to provide one or several entry point using the
10538 @option{-e} / @option{--entry} ld option.
10539
10540 Note that objects compiled without the @option{-ffunction-sections} and
10541 @option{-fdata-sections} options can still be linked with the executable.
10542 However, no dead code elimination will be performed on those objects (they will
10543 be linked as is).
10544
10545 The GNAT static library is now compiled with -ffunction-sections and
10546 -fdata-sections on some platforms. This allows you to eliminate the unused code
10547 and data of the GNAT library from your executable.
10548
10549 @node Example of unused subprogram/data elimination
10550 @subsection Example of unused subprogram/data elimination
10551
10552 @noindent
10553 Here is a simple example:
10554
10555 @smallexample @c ada
10556 with Aux;
10557
10558 procedure Test is
10559 begin
10560 Aux.Used (10);
10561 end Test;
10562
10563 package Aux is
10564 Used_Data : Integer;
10565 Unused_Data : Integer;
10566
10567 procedure Used (Data : Integer);
10568 procedure Unused (Data : Integer);
10569 end Aux;
10570
10571 package body Aux is
10572 procedure Used (Data : Integer) is
10573 begin
10574 Used_Data := Data;
10575 end Used;
10576
10577 procedure Unused (Data : Integer) is
10578 begin
10579 Unused_Data := Data;
10580 end Unused;
10581 end Aux;
10582 @end smallexample
10583
10584 @noindent
10585 @code{Unused} and @code{Unused_Data} are never referenced in this code
10586 excerpt, and hence they may be safely removed from the final executable.
10587
10588 @smallexample
10589 $ gnatmake test
10590
10591 $ nm test | grep used
10592 020015f0 T aux__unused
10593 02005d88 B aux__unused_data
10594 020015cc T aux__used
10595 02005d84 B aux__used_data
10596
10597 $ gnatmake test -cargs -fdata-sections -ffunction-sections \
10598 -largs -Wl,--gc-sections
10599
10600 $ nm test | grep used
10601 02005350 T aux__used
10602 0201ffe0 B aux__used_data
10603 @end smallexample
10604
10605 @noindent
10606 It can be observed that the procedure @code{Unused} and the object
10607 @code{Unused_Data} are removed by the linker when using the
10608 appropriate options.
10609
10610 @c ********************************
10611 @node Renaming Files Using gnatchop
10612 @chapter Renaming Files Using @code{gnatchop}
10613 @findex gnatchop
10614
10615 @noindent
10616 This chapter discusses how to handle files with multiple units by using
10617 the @code{gnatchop} utility. This utility is also useful in renaming
10618 files to meet the standard GNAT default file naming conventions.
10619
10620 @menu
10621 * Handling Files with Multiple Units::
10622 * Operating gnatchop in Compilation Mode::
10623 * Command Line for gnatchop::
10624 * Switches for gnatchop::
10625 * Examples of gnatchop Usage::
10626 @end menu
10627
10628 @node Handling Files with Multiple Units
10629 @section Handling Files with Multiple Units
10630
10631 @noindent
10632 The basic compilation model of GNAT requires that a file submitted to the
10633 compiler have only one unit and there be a strict correspondence
10634 between the file name and the unit name.
10635
10636 The @code{gnatchop} utility allows both of these rules to be relaxed,
10637 allowing GNAT to process files which contain multiple compilation units
10638 and files with arbitrary file names. @code{gnatchop}
10639 reads the specified file and generates one or more output files,
10640 containing one unit per file. The unit and the file name correspond,
10641 as required by GNAT.
10642
10643 If you want to permanently restructure a set of ``foreign'' files so that
10644 they match the GNAT rules, and do the remaining development using the
10645 GNAT structure, you can simply use @command{gnatchop} once, generate the
10646 new set of files and work with them from that point on.
10647
10648 Alternatively, if you want to keep your files in the ``foreign'' format,
10649 perhaps to maintain compatibility with some other Ada compilation
10650 system, you can set up a procedure where you use @command{gnatchop} each
10651 time you compile, regarding the source files that it writes as temporary
10652 files that you throw away.
10653
10654 @node Operating gnatchop in Compilation Mode
10655 @section Operating gnatchop in Compilation Mode
10656
10657 @noindent
10658 The basic function of @code{gnatchop} is to take a file with multiple units
10659 and split it into separate files. The boundary between files is reasonably
10660 clear, except for the issue of comments and pragmas. In default mode, the
10661 rule is that any pragmas between units belong to the previous unit, except
10662 that configuration pragmas always belong to the following unit. Any comments
10663 belong to the following unit. These rules
10664 almost always result in the right choice of
10665 the split point without needing to mark it explicitly and most users will
10666 find this default to be what they want. In this default mode it is incorrect to
10667 submit a file containing only configuration pragmas, or one that ends in
10668 configuration pragmas, to @code{gnatchop}.
10669
10670 However, using a special option to activate ``compilation mode'',
10671 @code{gnatchop}
10672 can perform another function, which is to provide exactly the semantics
10673 required by the RM for handling of configuration pragmas in a compilation.
10674 In the absence of configuration pragmas (at the main file level), this
10675 option has no effect, but it causes such configuration pragmas to be handled
10676 in a quite different manner.
10677
10678 First, in compilation mode, if @code{gnatchop} is given a file that consists of
10679 only configuration pragmas, then this file is appended to the
10680 @file{gnat.adc} file in the current directory. This behavior provides
10681 the required behavior described in the RM for the actions to be taken
10682 on submitting such a file to the compiler, namely that these pragmas
10683 should apply to all subsequent compilations in the same compilation
10684 environment. Using GNAT, the current directory, possibly containing a
10685 @file{gnat.adc} file is the representation
10686 of a compilation environment. For more information on the
10687 @file{gnat.adc} file, see @ref{Handling of Configuration Pragmas}.
10688
10689 Second, in compilation mode, if @code{gnatchop}
10690 is given a file that starts with
10691 configuration pragmas, and contains one or more units, then these
10692 configuration pragmas are prepended to each of the chopped files. This
10693 behavior provides the required behavior described in the RM for the
10694 actions to be taken on compiling such a file, namely that the pragmas
10695 apply to all units in the compilation, but not to subsequently compiled
10696 units.
10697
10698 Finally, if configuration pragmas appear between units, they are appended
10699 to the previous unit. This results in the previous unit being illegal,
10700 since the compiler does not accept configuration pragmas that follow
10701 a unit. This provides the required RM behavior that forbids configuration
10702 pragmas other than those preceding the first compilation unit of a
10703 compilation.
10704
10705 For most purposes, @code{gnatchop} will be used in default mode. The
10706 compilation mode described above is used only if you need exactly
10707 accurate behavior with respect to compilations, and you have files
10708 that contain multiple units and configuration pragmas. In this
10709 circumstance the use of @code{gnatchop} with the compilation mode
10710 switch provides the required behavior, and is for example the mode
10711 in which GNAT processes the ACVC tests.
10712
10713 @node Command Line for gnatchop
10714 @section Command Line for @code{gnatchop}
10715
10716 @noindent
10717 The @code{gnatchop} command has the form:
10718
10719 @smallexample
10720 $ gnatchop switches @var{file name} @r{[}@var{file name} @dots{}@r{]}
10721 @ovar{directory}
10722 @end smallexample
10723
10724 @noindent
10725 The only required argument is the file name of the file to be chopped.
10726 There are no restrictions on the form of this file name. The file itself
10727 contains one or more Ada units, in normal GNAT format, concatenated
10728 together. As shown, more than one file may be presented to be chopped.
10729
10730 When run in default mode, @code{gnatchop} generates one output file in
10731 the current directory for each unit in each of the files.
10732
10733 @var{directory}, if specified, gives the name of the directory to which
10734 the output files will be written. If it is not specified, all files are
10735 written to the current directory.
10736
10737 For example, given a
10738 file called @file{hellofiles} containing
10739
10740 @smallexample @c ada
10741 @group
10742 @cartouche
10743 procedure hello;
10744
10745 with Text_IO; use Text_IO;
10746 procedure hello is
10747 begin
10748 Put_Line ("Hello");
10749 end hello;
10750 @end cartouche
10751 @end group
10752 @end smallexample
10753
10754 @noindent
10755 the command
10756
10757 @smallexample
10758 $ gnatchop ^hellofiles^HELLOFILES.^
10759 @end smallexample
10760
10761 @noindent
10762 generates two files in the current directory, one called
10763 @file{hello.ads} containing the single line that is the procedure spec,
10764 and the other called @file{hello.adb} containing the remaining text. The
10765 original file is not affected. The generated files can be compiled in
10766 the normal manner.
10767
10768 @noindent
10769 When gnatchop is invoked on a file that is empty or that contains only empty
10770 lines and/or comments, gnatchop will not fail, but will not produce any
10771 new sources.
10772
10773 For example, given a
10774 file called @file{toto.txt} containing
10775
10776 @smallexample @c ada
10777 @group
10778 @cartouche
10779 -- Just a comment
10780 @end cartouche
10781 @end group
10782 @end smallexample
10783
10784 @noindent
10785 the command
10786
10787 @smallexample
10788 $ gnatchop ^toto.txt^TOT.TXT^
10789 @end smallexample
10790
10791 @noindent
10792 will not produce any new file and will result in the following warnings:
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 toto.txt:1:01: warning: empty file, contains no compilation units
10796 no compilation units found
10797 no source files written
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @node Switches for gnatchop
10801 @section Switches for @code{gnatchop}
10802
10803 @noindent
10804 @command{gnatchop} recognizes the following switches:
10805
10806 @table @option
10807 @c !sort!
10808
10809 @item --version
10810 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatchop}
10811 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
10812
10813 @item --help
10814 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatchop}
10815 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
10816 all other options.
10817
10818 @item ^-c^/COMPILATION^
10819 @cindex @option{^-c^/COMPILATION^} (@code{gnatchop})
10820 Causes @code{gnatchop} to operate in compilation mode, in which
10821 configuration pragmas are handled according to strict RM rules. See
10822 previous section for a full description of this mode.
10823
10824 @ifclear vms
10825 @item -gnat@var{xxx}
10826 This passes the given @option{-gnat@var{xxx}} switch to @code{gnat} which is
10827 used to parse the given file. Not all @var{xxx} options make sense,
10828 but for example, the use of @option{-gnati2} allows @code{gnatchop} to
10829 process a source file that uses Latin-2 coding for identifiers.
10830 @end ifclear
10831
10832 @item ^-h^/HELP^
10833 Causes @code{gnatchop} to generate a brief help summary to the standard
10834 output file showing usage information.
10835
10836 @item ^-k@var{mm}^/FILE_NAME_MAX_LENGTH=@var{mm}^
10837 @cindex @option{^-k^/FILE_NAME_MAX_LENGTH^} (@code{gnatchop})
10838 Limit generated file names to the specified number @code{mm}
10839 of characters.
10840 This is useful if the
10841 resulting set of files is required to be interoperable with systems
10842 which limit the length of file names.
10843 @ifset vms
10844 If no value is given, or
10845 if no @code{/FILE_NAME_MAX_LENGTH} qualifier is given,
10846 a default of 39, suitable for OpenVMS Alpha
10847 Systems, is assumed
10848 @end ifset
10849 @ifclear vms
10850 No space is allowed between the @option{-k} and the numeric value. The numeric
10851 value may be omitted in which case a default of @option{-k8},
10852 suitable for use
10853 with DOS-like file systems, is used. If no @option{-k} switch
10854 is present then
10855 there is no limit on the length of file names.
10856 @end ifclear
10857
10858 @item ^-p^/PRESERVE^
10859 @cindex @option{^-p^/PRESERVE^} (@code{gnatchop})
10860 Causes the file ^modification^creation^ time stamp of the input file to be
10861 preserved and used for the time stamp of the output file(s). This may be
10862 useful for preserving coherency of time stamps in an environment where
10863 @code{gnatchop} is used as part of a standard build process.
10864
10865 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
10866 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@code{gnatchop})
10867 Causes output of informational messages indicating the set of generated
10868 files to be suppressed. Warnings and error messages are unaffected.
10869
10870 @item ^-r^/REFERENCE^
10871 @cindex @option{^-r^/REFERENCE^} (@code{gnatchop})
10872 @findex Source_Reference
10873 Generate @code{Source_Reference} pragmas. Use this switch if the output
10874 files are regarded as temporary and development is to be done in terms
10875 of the original unchopped file. This switch causes
10876 @code{Source_Reference} pragmas to be inserted into each of the
10877 generated files to refers back to the original file name and line number.
10878 The result is that all error messages refer back to the original
10879 unchopped file.
10880 In addition, the debugging information placed into the object file (when
10881 the @option{^-g^/DEBUG^} switch of @command{gcc} or @command{gnatmake} is
10882 specified)
10883 also refers back to this original file so that tools like profilers and
10884 debuggers will give information in terms of the original unchopped file.
10885
10886 If the original file to be chopped itself contains
10887 a @code{Source_Reference}
10888 pragma referencing a third file, then gnatchop respects
10889 this pragma, and the generated @code{Source_Reference} pragmas
10890 in the chopped file refer to the original file, with appropriate
10891 line numbers. This is particularly useful when @code{gnatchop}
10892 is used in conjunction with @code{gnatprep} to compile files that
10893 contain preprocessing statements and multiple units.
10894
10895 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
10896 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatchop})
10897 Causes @code{gnatchop} to operate in verbose mode. The version
10898 number and copyright notice are output, as well as exact copies of
10899 the gnat1 commands spawned to obtain the chop control information.
10900
10901 @item ^-w^/OVERWRITE^
10902 @cindex @option{^-w^/OVERWRITE^} (@code{gnatchop})
10903 Overwrite existing file names. Normally @code{gnatchop} regards it as a
10904 fatal error if there is already a file with the same name as a
10905 file it would otherwise output, in other words if the files to be
10906 chopped contain duplicated units. This switch bypasses this
10907 check, and causes all but the last instance of such duplicated
10908 units to be skipped.
10909
10910 @ifclear vms
10911 @item --GCC=@var{xxxx}
10912 @cindex @option{--GCC=} (@code{gnatchop})
10913 Specify the path of the GNAT parser to be used. When this switch is used,
10914 no attempt is made to add the prefix to the GNAT parser executable.
10915 @end ifclear
10916 @end table
10917
10918 @node Examples of gnatchop Usage
10919 @section Examples of @code{gnatchop} Usage
10920
10921 @table @code
10922 @ifset vms
10923 @item gnatchop /OVERWRITE HELLO_S.ADA [PRERELEASE.FILES]
10924 @end ifset
10925 @ifclear vms
10926 @item gnatchop -w hello_s.ada prerelease/files
10927 @end ifclear
10928
10929 Chops the source file @file{hello_s.ada}. The output files will be
10930 placed in the directory @file{^prerelease/files^[PRERELEASE.FILES]^},
10931 overwriting any
10932 files with matching names in that directory (no files in the current
10933 directory are modified).
10934
10935 @item gnatchop ^archive^ARCHIVE.^
10936 Chops the source file @file{^archive^ARCHIVE.^}
10937 into the current directory. One
10938 useful application of @code{gnatchop} is in sending sets of sources
10939 around, for example in email messages. The required sources are simply
10940 concatenated (for example, using a ^Unix @code{cat}^VMS @code{APPEND/NEW}^
10941 command), and then
10942 @command{gnatchop} is used at the other end to reconstitute the original
10943 file names.
10944
10945 @item gnatchop file1 file2 file3 direc
10946 Chops all units in files @file{file1}, @file{file2}, @file{file3}, placing
10947 the resulting files in the directory @file{direc}. Note that if any units
10948 occur more than once anywhere within this set of files, an error message
10949 is generated, and no files are written. To override this check, use the
10950 @option{^-w^/OVERWRITE^} switch,
10951 in which case the last occurrence in the last file will
10952 be the one that is output, and earlier duplicate occurrences for a given
10953 unit will be skipped.
10954 @end table
10955
10956 @node Configuration Pragmas
10957 @chapter Configuration Pragmas
10958 @cindex Configuration pragmas
10959 @cindex Pragmas, configuration
10960
10961 @noindent
10962 Configuration pragmas include those pragmas described as
10963 such in the Ada Reference Manual, as well as
10964 implementation-dependent pragmas that are configuration pragmas.
10965 @xref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual},
10966 for details on these additional GNAT-specific configuration pragmas.
10967 Most notably, the pragma @code{Source_File_Name}, which allows
10968 specifying non-default names for source files, is a configuration
10969 pragma. The following is a complete list of configuration pragmas
10970 recognized by GNAT:
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 Ada_83
10974 Ada_95
10975 Ada_05
10976 Ada_2005
10977 Assertion_Policy
10978 C_Pass_By_Copy
10979 Check_Name
10980 Check_Policy
10981 Compile_Time_Error
10982 Compile_Time_Warning
10983 Compiler_Unit
10984 Component_Alignment
10985 Debug_Policy
10986 Detect_Blocking
10987 Discard_Names
10988 Elaboration_Checks
10989 Eliminate
10990 Extend_System
10991 External_Name_Casing
10992 Fast_Math
10993 Favor_Top_Level
10994 Float_Representation
10995 Implicit_Packing
10996 Initialize_Scalars
10997 Interrupt_State
10998 License
10999 Locking_Policy
11000 Long_Float
11001 No_Run_Time
11002 No_Strict_Aliasing
11003 Normalize_Scalars
11004 Optimize_Alignment
11005 Persistent_BSS
11006 Polling
11007 Priority_Specific_Dispatching
11008 Profile
11009 Profile_Warnings
11010 Propagate_Exceptions
11011 Queuing_Policy
11012 Ravenscar
11013 Restricted_Run_Time
11014 Restrictions
11015 Restrictions_Warnings
11016 Reviewable
11017 Source_File_Name
11018 Source_File_Name_Project
11019 Style_Checks
11020 Suppress
11021 Suppress_Exception_Locations
11022 Task_Dispatching_Policy
11023 Universal_Data
11024 Unsuppress
11025 Use_VADS_Size
11026 Validity_Checks
11027 Warnings
11028 Wide_Character_Encoding
11029
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 @menu
11033 * Handling of Configuration Pragmas::
11034 * The Configuration Pragmas Files::
11035 @end menu
11036
11037 @node Handling of Configuration Pragmas
11038 @section Handling of Configuration Pragmas
11039
11040 Configuration pragmas may either appear at the start of a compilation
11041 unit, in which case they apply only to that unit, or they may apply to
11042 all compilations performed in a given compilation environment.
11043
11044 GNAT also provides the @code{gnatchop} utility to provide an automatic
11045 way to handle configuration pragmas following the semantics for
11046 compilations (that is, files with multiple units), described in the RM.
11047 See @ref{Operating gnatchop in Compilation Mode} for details.
11048 However, for most purposes, it will be more convenient to edit the
11049 @file{gnat.adc} file that contains configuration pragmas directly,
11050 as described in the following section.
11051
11052 @node The Configuration Pragmas Files
11053 @section The Configuration Pragmas Files
11054 @cindex @file{gnat.adc}
11055
11056 @noindent
11057 In GNAT a compilation environment is defined by the current
11058 directory at the time that a compile command is given. This current
11059 directory is searched for a file whose name is @file{gnat.adc}. If
11060 this file is present, it is expected to contain one or more
11061 configuration pragmas that will be applied to the current compilation.
11062 However, if the switch @option{-gnatA} is used, @file{gnat.adc} is not
11063 considered.
11064
11065 Configuration pragmas may be entered into the @file{gnat.adc} file
11066 either by running @code{gnatchop} on a source file that consists only of
11067 configuration pragmas, or more conveniently by
11068 direct editing of the @file{gnat.adc} file, which is a standard format
11069 source file.
11070
11071 In addition to @file{gnat.adc}, additional files containing configuration
11072 pragmas may be applied to the current compilation using the switch
11073 @option{-gnatec}@var{path}. @var{path} must designate an existing file that
11074 contains only configuration pragmas. These configuration pragmas are
11075 in addition to those found in @file{gnat.adc} (provided @file{gnat.adc}
11076 is present and switch @option{-gnatA} is not used).
11077
11078 It is allowed to specify several switches @option{-gnatec}, all of which
11079 will be taken into account.
11080
11081 If you are using project file, a separate mechanism is provided using
11082 project attributes, see @ref{Specifying Configuration Pragmas} for more
11083 details.
11084
11085 @ifset vms
11086 Of special interest to GNAT OpenVMS Alpha is the following
11087 configuration pragma:
11088
11089 @smallexample @c ada
11090 @cartouche
11091 pragma Extend_System (Aux_DEC);
11092 @end cartouche
11093 @end smallexample
11094
11095 @noindent
11096 In the presence of this pragma, GNAT adds to the definition of the
11097 predefined package SYSTEM all the additional types and subprograms that are
11098 defined in HP Ada. See @ref{Compatibility with HP Ada} for details.
11099 @end ifset
11100
11101 @node Handling Arbitrary File Naming Conventions Using gnatname
11102 @chapter Handling Arbitrary File Naming Conventions Using @code{gnatname}
11103 @cindex Arbitrary File Naming Conventions
11104
11105 @menu
11106 * Arbitrary File Naming Conventions::
11107 * Running gnatname::
11108 * Switches for gnatname::
11109 * Examples of gnatname Usage::
11110 @end menu
11111
11112 @node Arbitrary File Naming Conventions
11113 @section Arbitrary File Naming Conventions
11114
11115 @noindent
11116 The GNAT compiler must be able to know the source file name of a compilation
11117 unit. When using the standard GNAT default file naming conventions
11118 (@code{.ads} for specs, @code{.adb} for bodies), the GNAT compiler
11119 does not need additional information.
11120
11121 @noindent
11122 When the source file names do not follow the standard GNAT default file naming
11123 conventions, the GNAT compiler must be given additional information through
11124 a configuration pragmas file (@pxref{Configuration Pragmas})
11125 or a project file.
11126 When the non-standard file naming conventions are well-defined,
11127 a small number of pragmas @code{Source_File_Name} specifying a naming pattern
11128 (@pxref{Alternative File Naming Schemes}) may be sufficient. However,
11129 if the file naming conventions are irregular or arbitrary, a number
11130 of pragma @code{Source_File_Name} for individual compilation units
11131 must be defined.
11132 To help maintain the correspondence between compilation unit names and
11133 source file names within the compiler,
11134 GNAT provides a tool @code{gnatname} to generate the required pragmas for a
11135 set of files.
11136
11137 @node Running gnatname
11138 @section Running @code{gnatname}
11139
11140 @noindent
11141 The usual form of the @code{gnatname} command is
11142
11143 @smallexample
11144 $ gnatname @ovar{switches} @var{naming_pattern} @ovar{naming_patterns}
11145 @r{[}--and @ovar{switches} @var{naming_pattern} @ovar{naming_patterns}@r{]}
11146 @end smallexample
11147
11148 @noindent
11149 All of the arguments are optional. If invoked without any argument,
11150 @code{gnatname} will display its usage.
11151
11152 @noindent
11153 When used with at least one naming pattern, @code{gnatname} will attempt to
11154 find all the compilation units in files that follow at least one of the
11155 naming patterns. To find these compilation units,
11156 @code{gnatname} will use the GNAT compiler in syntax-check-only mode on all
11157 regular files.
11158
11159 @noindent
11160 One or several Naming Patterns may be given as arguments to @code{gnatname}.
11161 Each Naming Pattern is enclosed between double quotes.
11162 A Naming Pattern is a regular expression similar to the wildcard patterns
11163 used in file names by the Unix shells or the DOS prompt.
11164
11165 @noindent
11166 @code{gnatname} may be called with several sections of directories/patterns.
11167 Sections are separated by switch @code{--and}. In each section, there must be
11168 at least one pattern. If no directory is specified in a section, the current
11169 directory (or the project directory is @code{-P} is used) is implied.
11170 The options other that the directory switches and the patterns apply globally
11171 even if they are in different sections.
11172
11173 @noindent
11174 Examples of Naming Patterns are
11175
11176 @smallexample
11177 "*.[12].ada"
11178 "*.ad[sb]*"
11179 "body_*" "spec_*"
11180 @end smallexample
11181
11182 @noindent
11183 For a more complete description of the syntax of Naming Patterns,
11184 see the second kind of regular expressions described in @file{g-regexp.ads}
11185 (the ``Glob'' regular expressions).
11186
11187 @noindent
11188 When invoked with no switch @code{-P}, @code{gnatname} will create a
11189 configuration pragmas file @file{gnat.adc} in the current working directory,
11190 with pragmas @code{Source_File_Name} for each file that contains a valid Ada
11191 unit.
11192
11193 @node Switches for gnatname
11194 @section Switches for @code{gnatname}
11195
11196 @noindent
11197 Switches for @code{gnatname} must precede any specified Naming Pattern.
11198
11199 @noindent
11200 You may specify any of the following switches to @code{gnatname}:
11201
11202 @table @option
11203 @c !sort!
11204
11205 @item --version
11206 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatname}
11207 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
11208
11209 @item --help
11210 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatname}
11211 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
11212 all other options.
11213
11214 @item --and
11215 Start another section of directories/patterns.
11216
11217 @item ^-c^/CONFIG_FILE=^@file{file}
11218 @cindex @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^} (@code{gnatname})
11219 Create a configuration pragmas file @file{file} (instead of the default
11220 @file{gnat.adc}).
11221 @ifclear vms
11222 There may be zero, one or more space between @option{-c} and
11223 @file{file}.
11224 @end ifclear
11225 @file{file} may include directory information. @file{file} must be
11226 writable. There may be only one switch @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^}.
11227 When a switch @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^} is
11228 specified, no switch @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} may be specified (see below).
11229
11230 @item ^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS=^@file{dir}
11231 @cindex @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^} (@code{gnatname})
11232 Look for source files in directory @file{dir}. There may be zero, one or more
11233 spaces between @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS=^} and @file{dir}.
11234 When a switch @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^}
11235 is specified, the current working directory will not be searched for source
11236 files, unless it is explicitly specified with a @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^}
11237 or @option{^-D^/DIR_FILES^} switch.
11238 Several switches @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^} may be specified.
11239 If @file{dir} is a relative path, it is relative to the directory of
11240 the configuration pragmas file specified with switch
11241 @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^},
11242 or to the directory of the project file specified with switch
11243 @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} or,
11244 if neither switch @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^}
11245 nor switch @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} are specified, it is relative to the
11246 current working directory. The directory
11247 specified with switch @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^} must exist and be readable.
11248
11249 @item ^-D^/DIRS_FILE=^@file{file}
11250 @cindex @option{^-D^/DIRS_FILE^} (@code{gnatname})
11251 Look for source files in all directories listed in text file @file{file}.
11252 There may be zero, one or more spaces between @option{^-D^/DIRS_FILE=^}
11253 and @file{file}.
11254 @file{file} must be an existing, readable text file.
11255 Each nonempty line in @file{file} must be a directory.
11256 Specifying switch @option{^-D^/DIRS_FILE^} is equivalent to specifying as many
11257 switches @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^} as there are nonempty lines in
11258 @file{file}.
11259
11260 @item ^-f^/FOREIGN_PATTERN=^@file{pattern}
11261 @cindex @option{^-f^/FOREIGN_PATTERN^} (@code{gnatname})
11262 Foreign patterns. Using this switch, it is possible to add sources of languages
11263 other than Ada to the list of sources of a project file.
11264 It is only useful if a ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^ switch is used.
11265 For example,
11266 @smallexample
11267 gnatname ^-Pprj -f"*.c"^/PROJECT_FILE=PRJ /FOREIGN_PATTERN=*.C^ "*.ada"
11268 @end smallexample
11269 @noindent
11270 will look for Ada units in all files with the @file{.ada} extension,
11271 and will add to the list of file for project @file{prj.gpr} the C files
11272 with extension @file{.^c^C^}.
11273
11274 @item ^-h^/HELP^
11275 @cindex @option{^-h^/HELP^} (@code{gnatname})
11276 Output usage (help) information. The output is written to @file{stdout}.
11277
11278 @item ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@file{proj}
11279 @cindex @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} (@code{gnatname})
11280 Create or update project file @file{proj}. There may be zero, one or more space
11281 between @option{-P} and @file{proj}. @file{proj} may include directory
11282 information. @file{proj} must be writable.
11283 There may be only one switch @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^}.
11284 When a switch @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} is specified,
11285 no switch @option{^-c^/CONFIG_FILE^} may be specified.
11286
11287 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
11288 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatname})
11289 Verbose mode. Output detailed explanation of behavior to @file{stdout}.
11290 This includes name of the file written, the name of the directories to search
11291 and, for each file in those directories whose name matches at least one of
11292 the Naming Patterns, an indication of whether the file contains a unit,
11293 and if so the name of the unit.
11294
11295 @item ^-v -v^/VERBOSE /VERBOSE^
11296 @cindex @option{^-v -v^/VERBOSE /VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatname})
11297 Very Verbose mode. In addition to the output produced in verbose mode,
11298 for each file in the searched directories whose name matches none of
11299 the Naming Patterns, an indication is given that there is no match.
11300
11301 @item ^-x^/EXCLUDED_PATTERN=^@file{pattern}
11302 @cindex @option{^-x^/EXCLUDED_PATTERN^} (@code{gnatname})
11303 Excluded patterns. Using this switch, it is possible to exclude some files
11304 that would match the name patterns. For example,
11305 @smallexample
11306 gnatname ^-x "*_nt.ada"^/EXCLUDED_PATTERN=*_nt.ada^ "*.ada"
11307 @end smallexample
11308 @noindent
11309 will look for Ada units in all files with the @file{.ada} extension,
11310 except those whose names end with @file{_nt.ada}.
11311
11312 @end table
11313
11314 @node Examples of gnatname Usage
11315 @section Examples of @code{gnatname} Usage
11316
11317 @ifset vms
11318 @smallexample
11319 $ gnatname /CONFIG_FILE=[HOME.ME]NAMES.ADC /SOURCE_DIRS=SOURCES "[a-z]*.ada*"
11320 @end smallexample
11321 @end ifset
11322
11323 @ifclear vms
11324 @smallexample
11325 $ gnatname -c /home/me/names.adc -d sources "[a-z]*.ada*"
11326 @end smallexample
11327 @end ifclear
11328
11329 @noindent
11330 In this example, the directory @file{^/home/me^[HOME.ME]^} must already exist
11331 and be writable. In addition, the directory
11332 @file{^/home/me/sources^[HOME.ME.SOURCES]^} (specified by
11333 @option{^-d sources^/SOURCE_DIRS=SOURCES^}) must exist and be readable.
11334
11335 @ifclear vms
11336 Note the optional spaces after @option{-c} and @option{-d}.
11337 @end ifclear
11338
11339 @smallexample
11340 @ifclear vms
11341 $ gnatname -P/home/me/proj -x "*_nt_body.ada"
11342 -dsources -dsources/plus -Dcommon_dirs.txt "body_*" "spec_*"
11343 @end ifclear
11344 @ifset vms
11345 $ gnatname /PROJECT_FILE=[HOME.ME]PROJ
11346 /EXCLUDED_PATTERN=*_nt_body.ada
11347 /SOURCE_DIRS=(SOURCES,[SOURCES.PLUS])
11348 /DIRS_FILE=COMMON_DIRS.TXT "body_*" "spec_*"
11349 @end ifset
11350 @end smallexample
11351
11352 Note that several switches @option{^-d^/SOURCE_DIRS^} may be used,
11353 even in conjunction with one or several switches
11354 @option{^-D^/DIRS_FILE^}. Several Naming Patterns and one excluded pattern
11355 are used in this example.
11356
11357 @c *****************************************
11358 @c * G N A T P r o j e c t M a n a g e r *
11359 @c *****************************************
11360 @node GNAT Project Manager
11361 @chapter GNAT Project Manager
11362
11363 @menu
11364 * Introduction::
11365 * Examples of Project Files::
11366 * Project File Syntax::
11367 * Objects and Sources in Project Files::
11368 * Importing Projects::
11369 * Project Extension::
11370 * Project Hierarchy Extension::
11371 * External References in Project Files::
11372 * Packages in Project Files::
11373 * Variables from Imported Projects::
11374 * Naming Schemes::
11375 * Library Projects::
11376 * Stand-alone Library Projects::
11377 * Switches Related to Project Files::
11378 * Tools Supporting Project Files::
11379 * An Extended Example::
11380 * Project File Complete Syntax::
11381 @end menu
11382
11383 @c ****************
11384 @c * Introduction *
11385 @c ****************
11386
11387 @node Introduction
11388 @section Introduction
11389
11390 @noindent
11391 This chapter describes GNAT's @emph{Project Manager}, a facility that allows
11392 you to manage complex builds involving a number of source files, directories,
11393 and compilation options for different system configurations. In particular,
11394 project files allow you to specify:
11395 @itemize @bullet
11396 @item
11397 The directory or set of directories containing the source files, and/or the
11398 names of the specific source files themselves
11399 @item
11400 The directory in which the compiler's output
11401 (@file{ALI} files, object files, tree files) is to be placed
11402 @item
11403 The directory in which the executable programs is to be placed
11404 @item
11405 ^Switch^Switch^ settings for any of the project-enabled tools
11406 (@command{gnatmake}, compiler, binder, linker, @code{gnatls}, @code{gnatxref},
11407 @code{gnatfind}); you can apply these settings either globally or to individual
11408 compilation units.
11409 @item
11410 The source files containing the main subprogram(s) to be built
11411 @item
11412 The source programming language(s) (currently Ada and/or C)
11413 @item
11414 Source file naming conventions; you can specify these either globally or for
11415 individual compilation units
11416 @end itemize
11417
11418 @menu
11419 * Project Files::
11420 @end menu
11421
11422 @node Project Files
11423 @subsection Project Files
11424
11425 @noindent
11426 Project files are written in a syntax close to that of Ada, using familiar
11427 notions such as packages, context clauses, declarations, default values,
11428 assignments, and inheritance. Finally, project files can be built
11429 hierarchically from other project files, simplifying complex system
11430 integration and project reuse.
11431
11432 A @dfn{project} is a specific set of values for various compilation properties.
11433 The settings for a given project are described by means of
11434 a @dfn{project file}, which is a text file written in an Ada-like syntax.
11435 Property values in project files are either strings or lists of strings.
11436 Properties that are not explicitly set receive default values. A project
11437 file may interrogate the values of @dfn{external variables} (user-defined
11438 command-line switches or environment variables), and it may specify property
11439 settings conditionally, based on the value of such variables.
11440
11441 In simple cases, a project's source files depend only on other source files
11442 in the same project, or on the predefined libraries. (@emph{Dependence} is
11443 used in
11444 the Ada technical sense; as in one Ada unit @code{with}ing another.) However,
11445 the Project Manager also allows more sophisticated arrangements,
11446 where the source files in one project depend on source files in other
11447 projects:
11448 @itemize @bullet
11449 @item
11450 One project can @emph{import} other projects containing needed source files.
11451 @item
11452 You can organize GNAT projects in a hierarchy: a @emph{child} project
11453 can extend a @emph{parent} project, inheriting the parent's source files and
11454 optionally overriding any of them with alternative versions
11455 @end itemize
11456
11457 @noindent
11458 More generally, the Project Manager lets you structure large development
11459 efforts into hierarchical subsystems, where build decisions are delegated
11460 to the subsystem level, and thus different compilation environments
11461 (^switch^switch^ settings) used for different subsystems.
11462
11463 The Project Manager is invoked through the
11464 @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{projectfile}}
11465 switch to @command{gnatmake} or to the @command{^gnat^GNAT^} front driver.
11466 @ifclear vms
11467 There may be zero, one or more spaces between @option{-P} and
11468 @option{@emph{projectfile}}.
11469 @end ifclear
11470 If you want to define (on the command line) an external variable that is
11471 queried by the project file, you must use the
11472 @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=^@emph{vbl}=@emph{value}} switch.
11473 The Project Manager parses and interprets the project file, and drives the
11474 invoked tool based on the project settings.
11475
11476 The Project Manager supports a wide range of development strategies,
11477 for systems of all sizes. Here are some typical practices that are
11478 easily handled:
11479 @itemize @bullet
11480 @item
11481 Using a common set of source files, but generating object files in different
11482 directories via different ^switch^switch^ settings
11483 @item
11484 Using a mostly-shared set of source files, but with different versions of
11485 some unit or units
11486 @end itemize
11487
11488 @noindent
11489 The destination of an executable can be controlled inside a project file
11490 using the @option{^-o^-o^}
11491 ^switch^switch^.
11492 In the absence of such a ^switch^switch^ either inside
11493 the project file or on the command line, any executable files generated by
11494 @command{gnatmake} are placed in the directory @code{Exec_Dir} specified
11495 in the project file. If no @code{Exec_Dir} is specified, they will be placed
11496 in the object directory of the project.
11497
11498 You can use project files to achieve some of the effects of a source
11499 versioning system (for example, defining separate projects for
11500 the different sets of sources that comprise different releases) but the
11501 Project Manager is independent of any source configuration management tools
11502 that might be used by the developers.
11503
11504 The next section introduces the main features of GNAT's project facility
11505 through a sequence of examples; subsequent sections will present the syntax
11506 and semantics in more detail. A more formal description of the project
11507 facility appears in @ref{Project File Reference,,, gnat_rm, GNAT
11508 Reference Manual}.
11509
11510 @c *****************************
11511 @c * Examples of Project Files *
11512 @c *****************************
11513
11514 @node Examples of Project Files
11515 @section Examples of Project Files
11516 @noindent
11517 This section illustrates some of the typical uses of project files and
11518 explains their basic structure and behavior.
11519
11520 @menu
11521 * Common Sources with Different ^Switches^Switches^ and Directories::
11522 * Using External Variables::
11523 * Importing Other Projects::
11524 * Extending a Project::
11525 @end menu
11526
11527 @node Common Sources with Different ^Switches^Switches^ and Directories
11528 @subsection Common Sources with Different ^Switches^Switches^ and Directories
11529
11530 @menu
11531 * Source Files::
11532 * Specifying the Object Directory::
11533 * Specifying the Exec Directory::
11534 * Project File Packages::
11535 * Specifying ^Switch^Switch^ Settings::
11536 * Main Subprograms::
11537 * Executable File Names::
11538 * Source File Naming Conventions::
11539 * Source Language(s)::
11540 @end menu
11541
11542 @noindent
11543 Suppose that the Ada source files @file{pack.ads}, @file{pack.adb}, and
11544 @file{proc.adb} are in the @file{/common} directory. The file
11545 @file{proc.adb} contains an Ada main subprogram @code{Proc} that @code{with}s
11546 package @code{Pack}. We want to compile these source files under two sets
11547 of ^switches^switches^:
11548 @itemize @bullet
11549 @item
11550 When debugging, we want to pass the @option{-g} switch to @command{gnatmake},
11551 and the @option{^-gnata^-gnata^},
11552 @option{^-gnato^-gnato^},
11553 and @option{^-gnatE^-gnatE^} switches to the
11554 compiler; the compiler's output is to appear in @file{/common/debug}
11555 @item
11556 When preparing a release version, we want to pass the @option{^-O2^O2^} switch
11557 to the compiler; the compiler's output is to appear in @file{/common/release}
11558 @end itemize
11559
11560 @noindent
11561 The GNAT project files shown below, respectively @file{debug.gpr} and
11562 @file{release.gpr} in the @file{/common} directory, achieve these effects.
11563
11564 Schematically:
11565 @smallexample
11566 @group
11567 ^/common^[COMMON]^
11568 debug.gpr
11569 release.gpr
11570 pack.ads
11571 pack.adb
11572 proc.adb
11573 @end group
11574 @group
11575 ^/common/debug^[COMMON.DEBUG]^
11576 proc.ali, proc.o
11577 pack.ali, pack.o
11578 @end group
11579 @group
11580 ^/common/release^[COMMON.RELEASE]^
11581 proc.ali, proc.o
11582 pack.ali, pack.o
11583 @end group
11584 @end smallexample
11585 Here are the corresponding project files:
11586
11587 @smallexample @c projectfile
11588 @group
11589 project Debug is
11590 for Object_Dir use "debug";
11591 for Main use ("proc");
11592
11593 package Builder is
11594 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11595 use ("^-g^-g^");
11596 for Executable ("proc.adb") use "proc1";
11597 end Builder;
11598 @end group
11599
11600 @group
11601 package Compiler is
11602 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11603 use ("-fstack-check",
11604 "^-gnata^-gnata^",
11605 "^-gnato^-gnato^",
11606 "^-gnatE^-gnatE^");
11607 end Compiler;
11608 end Debug;
11609 @end group
11610 @end smallexample
11611
11612 @smallexample @c projectfile
11613 @group
11614 project Release is
11615 for Object_Dir use "release";
11616 for Exec_Dir use ".";
11617 for Main use ("proc");
11618
11619 package Compiler is
11620 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11621 use ("^-O2^-O2^");
11622 end Compiler;
11623 end Release;
11624 @end group
11625 @end smallexample
11626
11627 @noindent
11628 The name of the project defined by @file{debug.gpr} is @code{"Debug"} (case
11629 insensitive), and analogously the project defined by @file{release.gpr} is
11630 @code{"Release"}. For consistency the file should have the same name as the
11631 project, and the project file's extension should be @code{"gpr"}. These
11632 conventions are not required, but a warning is issued if they are not followed.
11633
11634 If the current directory is @file{^/temp^[TEMP]^}, then the command
11635 @smallexample
11636 gnatmake ^-P/common/debug.gpr^/PROJECT_FILE=[COMMON]DEBUG^
11637 @end smallexample
11638
11639 @noindent
11640 generates object and ALI files in @file{^/common/debug^[COMMON.DEBUG]^},
11641 as well as the @code{^proc1^PROC1.EXE^} executable,
11642 using the ^switch^switch^ settings defined in the project file.
11643
11644 Likewise, the command
11645 @smallexample
11646 gnatmake ^-P/common/release.gpr^/PROJECT_FILE=[COMMON]RELEASE^
11647 @end smallexample
11648
11649 @noindent
11650 generates object and ALI files in @file{^/common/release^[COMMON.RELEASE]^},
11651 and the @code{^proc^PROC.EXE^}
11652 executable in @file{^/common^[COMMON]^},
11653 using the ^switch^switch^ settings from the project file.
11654
11655 @node Source Files
11656 @unnumberedsubsubsec Source Files
11657
11658 @noindent
11659 If a project file does not explicitly specify a set of source directories or
11660 a set of source files, then by default the project's source files are the
11661 Ada source files in the project file directory. Thus @file{pack.ads},
11662 @file{pack.adb}, and @file{proc.adb} are the source files for both projects.
11663
11664 @node Specifying the Object Directory
11665 @unnumberedsubsubsec Specifying the Object Directory
11666
11667 @noindent
11668 Several project properties are modeled by Ada-style @emph{attributes};
11669 a property is defined by supplying the equivalent of an Ada attribute
11670 definition clause in the project file.
11671 A project's object directory is another such a property; the corresponding
11672 attribute is @code{Object_Dir}, and its value is also a string expression,
11673 specified either as absolute or relative. In the later case,
11674 it is relative to the project file directory. Thus the compiler's
11675 output is directed to @file{^/common/debug^[COMMON.DEBUG]^}
11676 (for the @code{Debug} project)
11677 and to @file{^/common/release^[COMMON.RELEASE]^}
11678 (for the @code{Release} project).
11679 If @code{Object_Dir} is not specified, then the default is the project file
11680 directory itself.
11681
11682 @node Specifying the Exec Directory
11683 @unnumberedsubsubsec Specifying the Exec Directory
11684
11685 @noindent
11686 A project's exec directory is another property; the corresponding
11687 attribute is @code{Exec_Dir}, and its value is also a string expression,
11688 either specified as relative or absolute. If @code{Exec_Dir} is not specified,
11689 then the default is the object directory (which may also be the project file
11690 directory if attribute @code{Object_Dir} is not specified). Thus the executable
11691 is placed in @file{^/common/debug^[COMMON.DEBUG]^}
11692 for the @code{Debug} project (attribute @code{Exec_Dir} not specified)
11693 and in @file{^/common^[COMMON]^} for the @code{Release} project.
11694
11695 @node Project File Packages
11696 @unnumberedsubsubsec Project File Packages
11697
11698 @noindent
11699 A GNAT tool that is integrated with the Project Manager is modeled by a
11700 corresponding package in the project file. In the example above,
11701 The @code{Debug} project defines the packages @code{Builder}
11702 (for @command{gnatmake}) and @code{Compiler};
11703 the @code{Release} project defines only the @code{Compiler} package.
11704
11705 The Ada-like package syntax is not to be taken literally. Although packages in
11706 project files bear a surface resemblance to packages in Ada source code, the
11707 notation is simply a way to convey a grouping of properties for a named
11708 entity. Indeed, the package names permitted in project files are restricted
11709 to a predefined set, corresponding to the project-aware tools, and the contents
11710 of packages are limited to a small set of constructs.
11711 The packages in the example above contain attribute definitions.
11712
11713 @node Specifying ^Switch^Switch^ Settings
11714 @unnumberedsubsubsec Specifying ^Switch^Switch^ Settings
11715
11716 @noindent
11717 ^Switch^Switch^ settings for a project-aware tool can be specified through
11718 attributes in the package that corresponds to the tool.
11719 The example above illustrates one of the relevant attributes,
11720 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}, which is defined in packages
11721 in both project files.
11722 Unlike simple attributes like @code{Source_Dirs},
11723 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^} is
11724 known as an @emph{associative array}. When you define this attribute, you must
11725 supply an ``index'' (a literal string), and the effect of the attribute
11726 definition is to set the value of the array at the specified index.
11727 For the @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^} attribute,
11728 the index is a programming language (in our case, Ada),
11729 and the value specified (after @code{use}) must be a list
11730 of string expressions.
11731
11732 The attributes permitted in project files are restricted to a predefined set.
11733 Some may appear at project level, others in packages.
11734 For any attribute that is an associative array, the index must always be a
11735 literal string, but the restrictions on this string (e.g., a file name or a
11736 language name) depend on the individual attribute.
11737 Also depending on the attribute, its specified value will need to be either a
11738 string or a string list.
11739
11740 In the @code{Debug} project, we set the switches for two tools,
11741 @command{gnatmake} and the compiler, and thus we include the two corresponding
11742 packages; each package defines the @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}
11743 attribute with index @code{"Ada"}.
11744 Note that the package corresponding to
11745 @command{gnatmake} is named @code{Builder}. The @code{Release} project is
11746 similar, but only includes the @code{Compiler} package.
11747
11748 In project @code{Debug} above, the ^switches^switches^ starting with
11749 @option{-gnat} that are specified in package @code{Compiler}
11750 could have been placed in package @code{Builder}, since @command{gnatmake}
11751 transmits all such ^switches^switches^ to the compiler.
11752
11753 @node Main Subprograms
11754 @unnumberedsubsubsec Main Subprograms
11755
11756 @noindent
11757 One of the specifiable properties of a project is a list of files that contain
11758 main subprograms. This property is captured in the @code{Main} attribute,
11759 whose value is a list of strings. If a project defines the @code{Main}
11760 attribute, it is not necessary to identify the main subprogram(s) when
11761 invoking @command{gnatmake} (@pxref{gnatmake and Project Files}).
11762
11763 @node Executable File Names
11764 @unnumberedsubsubsec Executable File Names
11765
11766 @noindent
11767 By default, the executable file name corresponding to a main source is
11768 deduced from the main source file name. Through the attributes
11769 @code{Executable} and @code{Executable_Suffix} of package @code{Builder},
11770 it is possible to change this default.
11771 In project @code{Debug} above, the executable file name
11772 for main source @file{^proc.adb^PROC.ADB^} is
11773 @file{^proc1^PROC1.EXE^}.
11774 Attribute @code{Executable_Suffix}, when specified, may change the suffix
11775 of the executable files, when no attribute @code{Executable} applies:
11776 its value replace the platform-specific executable suffix.
11777 Attributes @code{Executable} and @code{Executable_Suffix} are the only ways to
11778 specify a non-default executable file name when several mains are built at once
11779 in a single @command{gnatmake} command.
11780
11781 @node Source File Naming Conventions
11782 @unnumberedsubsubsec Source File Naming Conventions
11783
11784 @noindent
11785 Since the project files above do not specify any source file naming
11786 conventions, the GNAT defaults are used. The mechanism for defining source
11787 file naming conventions -- a package named @code{Naming} --
11788 is described below (@pxref{Naming Schemes}).
11789
11790 @node Source Language(s)
11791 @unnumberedsubsubsec Source Language(s)
11792
11793 @noindent
11794 Since the project files do not specify a @code{Languages} attribute, by
11795 default the GNAT tools assume that the language of the project file is Ada.
11796 More generally, a project can comprise source files
11797 in Ada, C, and/or other languages.
11798
11799 @node Using External Variables
11800 @subsection Using External Variables
11801
11802 @noindent
11803 Instead of supplying different project files for debug and release, we can
11804 define a single project file that queries an external variable (set either
11805 on the command line or via an ^environment variable^logical name^) in order to
11806 conditionally define the appropriate settings. Again, assume that the
11807 source files @file{pack.ads}, @file{pack.adb}, and @file{proc.adb} are
11808 located in directory @file{^/common^[COMMON]^}. The following project file,
11809 @file{build.gpr}, queries the external variable named @code{STYLE} and
11810 defines an object directory and ^switch^switch^ settings based on whether
11811 the value is @code{"deb"} (debug) or @code{"rel"} (release), and where
11812 the default is @code{"deb"}.
11813
11814 @smallexample @c projectfile
11815 @group
11816 project Build is
11817 for Main use ("proc");
11818
11819 type Style_Type is ("deb", "rel");
11820 Style : Style_Type := external ("STYLE", "deb");
11821
11822 case Style is
11823 when "deb" =>
11824 for Object_Dir use "debug";
11825
11826 when "rel" =>
11827 for Object_Dir use "release";
11828 for Exec_Dir use ".";
11829 end case;
11830 @end group
11831
11832 @group
11833 package Builder is
11834
11835 case Style is
11836 when "deb" =>
11837 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11838 use ("^-g^-g^");
11839 for Executable ("proc") use "proc1";
11840 when others =>
11841 null;
11842 end case;
11843
11844 end Builder;
11845 @end group
11846
11847 @group
11848 package Compiler is
11849
11850 case Style is
11851 when "deb" =>
11852 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11853 use ("^-gnata^-gnata^",
11854 "^-gnato^-gnato^",
11855 "^-gnatE^-gnatE^");
11856
11857 when "rel" =>
11858 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
11859 use ("^-O2^-O2^");
11860 end case;
11861
11862 end Compiler;
11863
11864 end Build;
11865 @end group
11866 @end smallexample
11867
11868 @noindent
11869 @code{Style_Type} is an example of a @emph{string type}, which is the project
11870 file analog of an Ada enumeration type but whose components are string literals
11871 rather than identifiers. @code{Style} is declared as a variable of this type.
11872
11873 The form @code{external("STYLE", "deb")} is known as an
11874 @emph{external reference}; its first argument is the name of an
11875 @emph{external variable}, and the second argument is a default value to be
11876 used if the external variable doesn't exist. You can define an external
11877 variable on the command line via the @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} switch,
11878 or you can use ^an environment variable^a logical name^
11879 as an external variable.
11880
11881 Each @code{case} construct is expanded by the Project Manager based on the
11882 value of @code{Style}. Thus the command
11883 @ifclear vms
11884 @smallexample
11885 gnatmake -P/common/build.gpr -XSTYLE=deb
11886 @end smallexample
11887 @end ifclear
11888
11889 @ifset vms
11890 @smallexample
11891 gnatmake /PROJECT_FILE=[COMMON]BUILD.GPR /EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=STYLE=deb
11892 @end smallexample
11893 @end ifset
11894
11895 @noindent
11896 is equivalent to the @command{gnatmake} invocation using the project file
11897 @file{debug.gpr} in the earlier example. So is the command
11898 @smallexample
11899 gnatmake ^-P/common/build.gpr^/PROJECT_FILE=[COMMON]BUILD.GPR^
11900 @end smallexample
11901
11902 @noindent
11903 since @code{"deb"} is the default for @code{STYLE}.
11904
11905 Analogously,
11906
11907 @ifclear vms
11908 @smallexample
11909 gnatmake -P/common/build.gpr -XSTYLE=rel
11910 @end smallexample
11911 @end ifclear
11912
11913 @ifset vms
11914 @smallexample
11915 GNAT MAKE /PROJECT_FILE=[COMMON]BUILD.GPR /EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=STYLE=rel
11916 @end smallexample
11917 @end ifset
11918
11919 @noindent
11920 is equivalent to the @command{gnatmake} invocation using the project file
11921 @file{release.gpr} in the earlier example.
11922
11923 @node Importing Other Projects
11924 @subsection Importing Other Projects
11925 @cindex @code{ADA_PROJECT_PATH}
11926
11927 @noindent
11928 A compilation unit in a source file in one project may depend on compilation
11929 units in source files in other projects. To compile this unit under
11930 control of a project file, the
11931 dependent project must @emph{import} the projects containing the needed source
11932 files.
11933 This effect is obtained using syntax similar to an Ada @code{with} clause,
11934 but where @code{with}ed entities are strings that denote project files.
11935
11936 As an example, suppose that the two projects @code{GUI_Proj} and
11937 @code{Comm_Proj} are defined in the project files @file{gui_proj.gpr} and
11938 @file{comm_proj.gpr} in directories @file{^/gui^[GUI]^}
11939 and @file{^/comm^[COMM]^}, respectively.
11940 Suppose that the source files for @code{GUI_Proj} are
11941 @file{gui.ads} and @file{gui.adb}, and that the source files for
11942 @code{Comm_Proj} are @file{comm.ads} and @file{comm.adb}, where each set of
11943 files is located in its respective project file directory. Schematically:
11944
11945 @smallexample
11946 @group
11947 ^/gui^[GUI]^
11948 gui_proj.gpr
11949 gui.ads
11950 gui.adb
11951 @end group
11952
11953 @group
11954 ^/comm^[COMM]^
11955 comm_proj.gpr
11956 comm.ads
11957 comm.adb
11958 @end group
11959 @end smallexample
11960
11961 @noindent
11962 We want to develop an application in directory @file{^/app^[APP]^} that
11963 @code{with} the packages @code{GUI} and @code{Comm}, using the properties of
11964 the corresponding project files (e.g.@: the ^switch^switch^ settings
11965 and object directory).
11966 Skeletal code for a main procedure might be something like the following:
11967
11968 @smallexample @c ada
11969 @group
11970 with GUI, Comm;
11971 procedure App_Main is
11972 @dots{}
11973 begin
11974 @dots{}
11975 end App_Main;
11976 @end group
11977 @end smallexample
11978
11979 @noindent
11980 Here is a project file, @file{app_proj.gpr}, that achieves the desired
11981 effect:
11982
11983 @smallexample @c projectfile
11984 @group
11985 with "/gui/gui_proj", "/comm/comm_proj";
11986 project App_Proj is
11987 for Main use ("app_main");
11988 end App_Proj;
11989 @end group
11990 @end smallexample
11991
11992 @noindent
11993 Building an executable is achieved through the command:
11994 @smallexample
11995 gnatmake ^-P/app/app_proj^/PROJECT_FILE=[APP]APP_PROJ^
11996 @end smallexample
11997 @noindent
11998 which will generate the @code{^app_main^APP_MAIN.EXE^} executable
11999 in the directory where @file{app_proj.gpr} resides.
12000
12001 If an imported project file uses the standard extension (@code{^gpr^GPR^}) then
12002 (as illustrated above) the @code{with} clause can omit the extension.
12003
12004 Our example specified an absolute path for each imported project file.
12005 Alternatively, the directory name of an imported object can be omitted
12006 if either
12007 @itemize @bullet
12008 @item
12009 The imported project file is in the same directory as the importing project
12010 file, or
12011 @item
12012 You have defined ^an environment variable^a logical name^
12013 that includes the directory containing
12014 the needed project file. The syntax of @code{ADA_PROJECT_PATH} is the same as
12015 the syntax of @code{ADA_INCLUDE_PATH} and @code{ADA_OBJECTS_PATH}: a list of
12016 directory names separated by colons (semicolons on Windows).
12017 @end itemize
12018
12019 @noindent
12020 Thus, if we define @code{ADA_PROJECT_PATH} to include @file{^/gui^[GUI]^} and
12021 @file{^/comm^[COMM]^}, then our project file @file{app_proj.gpr} can be written
12022 as follows:
12023
12024 @smallexample @c projectfile
12025 @group
12026 with "gui_proj", "comm_proj";
12027 project App_Proj is
12028 for Main use ("app_main");
12029 end App_Proj;
12030 @end group
12031 @end smallexample
12032
12033 @noindent
12034 Importing other projects can create ambiguities.
12035 For example, the same unit might be present in different imported projects, or
12036 it might be present in both the importing project and in an imported project.
12037 Both of these conditions are errors. Note that in the current version of
12038 the Project Manager, it is illegal to have an ambiguous unit even if the
12039 unit is never referenced by the importing project. This restriction may be
12040 relaxed in a future release.
12041
12042 @node Extending a Project
12043 @subsection Extending a Project
12044
12045 @noindent
12046 In large software systems it is common to have multiple
12047 implementations of a common interface; in Ada terms, multiple versions of a
12048 package body for the same spec. For example, one implementation
12049 might be safe for use in tasking programs, while another might only be used
12050 in sequential applications. This can be modeled in GNAT using the concept
12051 of @emph{project extension}. If one project (the ``child'') @emph{extends}
12052 another project (the ``parent'') then by default all source files of the
12053 parent project are inherited by the child, but the child project can
12054 override any of the parent's source files with new versions, and can also
12055 add new files. This facility is the project analog of a type extension in
12056 Object-Oriented Programming. Project hierarchies are permitted (a child
12057 project may be the parent of yet another project), and a project that
12058 inherits one project can also import other projects.
12059
12060 As an example, suppose that directory @file{^/seq^[SEQ]^} contains the project
12061 file @file{seq_proj.gpr} as well as the source files @file{pack.ads},
12062 @file{pack.adb}, and @file{proc.adb}:
12063
12064 @smallexample
12065 @group
12066 ^/seq^[SEQ]^
12067 pack.ads
12068 pack.adb
12069 proc.adb
12070 seq_proj.gpr
12071 @end group
12072 @end smallexample
12073
12074 @noindent
12075 Note that the project file can simply be empty (that is, no attribute or
12076 package is defined):
12077
12078 @smallexample @c projectfile
12079 @group
12080 project Seq_Proj is
12081 end Seq_Proj;
12082 @end group
12083 @end smallexample
12084
12085 @noindent
12086 implying that its source files are all the Ada source files in the project
12087 directory.
12088
12089 Suppose we want to supply an alternate version of @file{pack.adb}, in
12090 directory @file{^/tasking^[TASKING]^}, but use the existing versions of
12091 @file{pack.ads} and @file{proc.adb}. We can define a project
12092 @code{Tasking_Proj} that inherits @code{Seq_Proj}:
12093
12094 @smallexample
12095 @group
12096 ^/tasking^[TASKING]^
12097 pack.adb
12098 tasking_proj.gpr
12099 @end group
12100
12101 @group
12102 project Tasking_Proj extends "/seq/seq_proj" is
12103 end Tasking_Proj;
12104 @end group
12105 @end smallexample
12106
12107 @noindent
12108 The version of @file{pack.adb} used in a build depends on which project file
12109 is specified.
12110
12111 Note that we could have obtained the desired behavior using project import
12112 rather than project inheritance; a @code{base} project would contain the
12113 sources for @file{pack.ads} and @file{proc.adb}, a sequential project would
12114 import @code{base} and add @file{pack.adb}, and likewise a tasking project
12115 would import @code{base} and add a different version of @file{pack.adb}. The
12116 choice depends on whether other sources in the original project need to be
12117 overridden. If they do, then project extension is necessary, otherwise,
12118 importing is sufficient.
12119
12120 @noindent
12121 In a project file that extends another project file, it is possible to
12122 indicate that an inherited source is not part of the sources of the extending
12123 project. This is necessary sometimes when a package spec has been overloaded
12124 and no longer requires a body: in this case, it is necessary to indicate that
12125 the inherited body is not part of the sources of the project, otherwise there
12126 will be a compilation error when compiling the spec.
12127
12128 For that purpose, the attribute @code{Excluded_Source_Files} is used.
12129 Its value is a string list: a list of file names. It is also possible to use
12130 attribute @code{Excluded_Source_List_File}. Its value is a single string:
12131 the file name of a text file containing a list of file names, one per line.
12132
12133 @smallexample @c @projectfile
12134 project B extends "a" is
12135 for Source_Files use ("pkg.ads");
12136 -- New spec of Pkg does not need a completion
12137 for Excluded_Source_Files use ("pkg.adb");
12138 end B;
12139 @end smallexample
12140
12141 Attribute @code{Excluded_Source_Files} may also be used to check if a source
12142 is still needed: if it is possible to build using @command{gnatmake} when such
12143 a source is put in attribute @code{Excluded_Source_Files} of a project P, then
12144 it is possible to remove the source completely from a system that includes
12145 project P.
12146
12147 @c ***********************
12148 @c * Project File Syntax *
12149 @c ***********************
12150
12151 @node Project File Syntax
12152 @section Project File Syntax
12153
12154 @menu
12155 * Basic Syntax::
12156 * Qualified Projects::
12157 * Packages::
12158 * Expressions::
12159 * String Types::
12160 * Variables::
12161 * Attributes::
12162 * Associative Array Attributes::
12163 * case Constructions::
12164 @end menu
12165
12166 @noindent
12167 This section describes the structure of project files.
12168
12169 A project may be an @emph{independent project}, entirely defined by a single
12170 project file. Any Ada source file in an independent project depends only
12171 on the predefined library and other Ada source files in the same project.
12172
12173 @noindent
12174 A project may also @dfn{depend on} other projects, in either or both of
12175 the following ways:
12176 @itemize @bullet
12177 @item It may import any number of projects
12178 @item It may extend at most one other project
12179 @end itemize
12180
12181 @noindent
12182 The dependence relation is a directed acyclic graph (the subgraph reflecting
12183 the ``extends'' relation is a tree).
12184
12185 A project's @dfn{immediate sources} are the source files directly defined by
12186 that project, either implicitly by residing in the project file's directory,
12187 or explicitly through any of the source-related attributes described below.
12188 More generally, a project @var{proj}'s @dfn{sources} are the immediate sources
12189 of @var{proj} together with the immediate sources (unless overridden) of any
12190 project on which @var{proj} depends (either directly or indirectly).
12191
12192 @node Basic Syntax
12193 @subsection Basic Syntax
12194
12195 @noindent
12196 As seen in the earlier examples, project files have an Ada-like syntax.
12197 The minimal project file is:
12198 @smallexample @c projectfile
12199 @group
12200 project Empty is
12201
12202 end Empty;
12203 @end group
12204 @end smallexample
12205
12206 @noindent
12207 The identifier @code{Empty} is the name of the project.
12208 This project name must be present after the reserved
12209 word @code{end} at the end of the project file, followed by a semi-colon.
12210
12211 Any name in a project file, such as the project name or a variable name,
12212 has the same syntax as an Ada identifier.
12213
12214 The reserved words of project files are the Ada 95 reserved words plus
12215 @code{extends}, @code{external}, and @code{project}. Note that the only Ada
12216 reserved words currently used in project file syntax are:
12217
12218 @itemize @bullet
12219 @item
12220 @code{all}
12221 @item
12222 @code{at}
12223 @item
12224 @code{case}
12225 @item
12226 @code{end}
12227 @item
12228 @code{for}
12229 @item
12230 @code{is}
12231 @item
12232 @code{limited}
12233 @item
12234 @code{null}
12235 @item
12236 @code{others}
12237 @item
12238 @code{package}
12239 @item
12240 @code{renames}
12241 @item
12242 @code{type}
12243 @item
12244 @code{use}
12245 @item
12246 @code{when}
12247 @item
12248 @code{with}
12249 @end itemize
12250
12251 @noindent
12252 Comments in project files have the same syntax as in Ada, two consecutive
12253 hyphens through the end of the line.
12254
12255 @node Qualified Projects
12256 @subsection Qualified Projects
12257
12258 @noindent
12259 Before the reserved @code{project}, there may be one or two "qualifiers", that
12260 is identifiers or other reserved words, to qualify the project.
12261
12262 The current list of qualifiers is:
12263
12264 @itemize @bullet
12265 @item
12266 @code{abstract}: qualify a project with no sources. An abstract project must
12267 have a declaration specifying that there are no sources in the project, and,
12268 if it extends another project, the project it extends must also be a qualified
12269 abstract project.
12270
12271 @item
12272 @code{standard}: a standard project is a non library project with sources.
12273
12274 @item
12275 @code{aggregate}: for future extension
12276
12277 @item
12278 @code{aggregate library}: for future extension
12279
12280 @item
12281 @code{library}: a library project must declare both attributes
12282 @code{Library_Name} and @code{Library_Dir}.
12283
12284 @item
12285 @code{configuration}: a configuration project cannot be in a project tree.
12286 @end itemize
12287
12288 @node Packages
12289 @subsection Packages
12290
12291 @noindent
12292 A project file may contain @emph{packages}. The name of a package must be one
12293 of the identifiers from the following list. A package
12294 with a given name may only appear once in a project file. Package names are
12295 case insensitive. The following package names are legal:
12296
12297 @itemize @bullet
12298 @item
12299 @code{Naming}
12300 @item
12301 @code{Builder}
12302 @item
12303 @code{Compiler}
12304 @item
12305 @code{Binder}
12306 @item
12307 @code{Linker}
12308 @item
12309 @code{Finder}
12310 @item
12311 @code{Cross_Reference}
12312 @item
12313 @code{Eliminate}
12314 @item
12315 @code{Pretty_Printer}
12316 @item
12317 @code{Metrics}
12318 @item
12319 @code{gnatls}
12320 @item
12321 @code{gnatstub}
12322 @item
12323 @code{IDE}
12324 @item
12325 @code{Language_Processing}
12326 @end itemize
12327
12328 @noindent
12329 In its simplest form, a package may be empty:
12330
12331 @smallexample @c projectfile
12332 @group
12333 project Simple is
12334 package Builder is
12335 end Builder;
12336 end Simple;
12337 @end group
12338 @end smallexample
12339
12340 @noindent
12341 A package may contain @emph{attribute declarations},
12342 @emph{variable declarations} and @emph{case constructions}, as will be
12343 described below.
12344
12345 When there is ambiguity between a project name and a package name,
12346 the name always designates the project. To avoid possible confusion, it is
12347 always a good idea to avoid naming a project with one of the
12348 names allowed for packages or any name that starts with @code{gnat}.
12349
12350 @node Expressions
12351 @subsection Expressions
12352
12353 @noindent
12354 An @emph{expression} is either a @emph{string expression} or a
12355 @emph{string list expression}.
12356
12357 A @emph{string expression} is either a @emph{simple string expression} or a
12358 @emph{compound string expression}.
12359
12360 A @emph{simple string expression} is one of the following:
12361 @itemize @bullet
12362 @item A literal string; e.g.@: @code{"comm/my_proj.gpr"}
12363 @item A string-valued variable reference (@pxref{Variables})
12364 @item A string-valued attribute reference (@pxref{Attributes})
12365 @item An external reference (@pxref{External References in Project Files})
12366 @end itemize
12367
12368 @noindent
12369 A @emph{compound string expression} is a concatenation of string expressions,
12370 using the operator @code{"&"}
12371 @smallexample
12372 Path & "/" & File_Name & ".ads"
12373 @end smallexample
12374
12375 @noindent
12376 A @emph{string list expression} is either a
12377 @emph{simple string list expression} or a
12378 @emph{compound string list expression}.
12379
12380 A @emph{simple string list expression} is one of the following:
12381 @itemize @bullet
12382 @item A parenthesized list of zero or more string expressions,
12383 separated by commas
12384 @smallexample
12385 File_Names := (File_Name, "gnat.adc", File_Name & ".orig");
12386 Empty_List := ();
12387 @end smallexample
12388 @item A string list-valued variable reference
12389 @item A string list-valued attribute reference
12390 @end itemize
12391
12392 @noindent
12393 A @emph{compound string list expression} is the concatenation (using
12394 @code{"&"}) of a simple string list expression and an expression. Note that
12395 each term in a compound string list expression, except the first, may be
12396 either a string expression or a string list expression.
12397
12398 @smallexample @c projectfile
12399 @group
12400 File_Name_List := () & File_Name; -- One string in this list
12401 Extended_File_Name_List := File_Name_List & (File_Name & ".orig");
12402 -- Two strings
12403 Big_List := File_Name_List & Extended_File_Name_List;
12404 -- Concatenation of two string lists: three strings
12405 Illegal_List := "gnat.adc" & Extended_File_Name_List;
12406 -- Illegal: must start with a string list
12407 @end group
12408 @end smallexample
12409
12410 @node String Types
12411 @subsection String Types
12412
12413 @noindent
12414 A @emph{string type declaration} introduces a discrete set of string literals.
12415 If a string variable is declared to have this type, its value
12416 is restricted to the given set of literals.
12417
12418 Here is an example of a string type declaration:
12419
12420 @smallexample @c projectfile
12421 type OS is ("NT", "nt", "Unix", "GNU/Linux", "other OS");
12422 @end smallexample
12423
12424 @noindent
12425 Variables of a string type are called @emph{typed variables}; all other
12426 variables are called @emph{untyped variables}. Typed variables are
12427 particularly useful in @code{case} constructions, to support conditional
12428 attribute declarations.
12429 (@pxref{case Constructions}).
12430
12431 The string literals in the list are case sensitive and must all be different.
12432 They may include any graphic characters allowed in Ada, including spaces.
12433
12434 A string type may only be declared at the project level, not inside a package.
12435
12436 A string type may be referenced by its name if it has been declared in the same
12437 project file, or by an expanded name whose prefix is the name of the project
12438 in which it is declared.
12439
12440 @node Variables
12441 @subsection Variables
12442
12443 @noindent
12444 A variable may be declared at the project file level, or within a package.
12445 Here are some examples of variable declarations:
12446
12447 @smallexample @c projectfile
12448 @group
12449 This_OS : OS := external ("OS"); -- a typed variable declaration
12450 That_OS := "GNU/Linux"; -- an untyped variable declaration
12451 @end group
12452 @end smallexample
12453
12454 @noindent
12455 The syntax of a @emph{typed variable declaration} is identical to the Ada
12456 syntax for an object declaration. By contrast, the syntax of an untyped
12457 variable declaration is identical to an Ada assignment statement. In fact,
12458 variable declarations in project files have some of the characteristics of
12459 an assignment, in that successive declarations for the same variable are
12460 allowed. Untyped variable declarations do establish the expected kind of the
12461 variable (string or string list), and successive declarations for it must
12462 respect the initial kind.
12463
12464 @noindent
12465 A string variable declaration (typed or untyped) declares a variable
12466 whose value is a string. This variable may be used as a string expression.
12467 @smallexample @c projectfile
12468 File_Name := "readme.txt";
12469 Saved_File_Name := File_Name & ".saved";
12470 @end smallexample
12471
12472 @noindent
12473 A string list variable declaration declares a variable whose value is a list
12474 of strings. The list may contain any number (zero or more) of strings.
12475
12476 @smallexample @c projectfile
12477 Empty_List := ();
12478 List_With_One_Element := ("^-gnaty^-gnaty^");
12479 List_With_Two_Elements := List_With_One_Element & "^-gnatg^-gnatg^";
12480 Long_List := ("main.ada", "pack1_.ada", "pack1.ada", "pack2_.ada"
12481 "pack2.ada", "util_.ada", "util.ada");
12482 @end smallexample
12483
12484 @noindent
12485 The same typed variable may not be declared more than once at project level,
12486 and it may not be declared more than once in any package; it is in effect
12487 a constant.
12488
12489 The same untyped variable may be declared several times. Declarations are
12490 elaborated in the order in which they appear, so the new value replaces
12491 the old one, and any subsequent reference to the variable uses the new value.
12492 However, as noted above, if a variable has been declared as a string, all
12493 subsequent
12494 declarations must give it a string value. Similarly, if a variable has
12495 been declared as a string list, all subsequent declarations
12496 must give it a string list value.
12497
12498 A @emph{variable reference} may take several forms:
12499
12500 @itemize @bullet
12501 @item The simple variable name, for a variable in the current package (if any)
12502 or in the current project
12503 @item An expanded name, whose prefix is a context name.
12504 @end itemize
12505
12506 @noindent
12507 A @emph{context} may be one of the following:
12508
12509 @itemize @bullet
12510 @item The name of an existing package in the current project
12511 @item The name of an imported project of the current project
12512 @item The name of an ancestor project (i.e., a project extended by the current
12513 project, either directly or indirectly)
12514 @item An expanded name whose prefix is an imported/parent project name, and
12515 whose selector is a package name in that project.
12516 @end itemize
12517
12518 @noindent
12519 A variable reference may be used in an expression.
12520
12521 @node Attributes
12522 @subsection Attributes
12523
12524 @noindent
12525 A project (and its packages) may have @emph{attributes} that define
12526 the project's properties. Some attributes have values that are strings;
12527 others have values that are string lists.
12528
12529 There are two categories of attributes: @emph{simple attributes}
12530 and @emph{associative arrays} (@pxref{Associative Array Attributes}).
12531
12532 Legal project attribute names, and attribute names for each legal package are
12533 listed below. Attributes names are case-insensitive.
12534
12535 The following attributes are defined on projects (all are simple attributes):
12536
12537 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .3
12538 @item @emph{Attribute Name}
12539 @tab @emph{Value}
12540 @item @code{Source_Files}
12541 @tab string list
12542 @item @code{Source_Dirs}
12543 @tab string list
12544 @item @code{Source_List_File}
12545 @tab string
12546 @item @code{Object_Dir}
12547 @tab string
12548 @item @code{Exec_Dir}
12549 @tab string
12550 @item @code{Excluded_Source_Dirs}
12551 @tab string list
12552 @item @code{Excluded_Source_Files}
12553 @tab string list
12554 @item @code{Excluded_Source_List_File}
12555 @tab string
12556 @item @code{Languages}
12557 @tab string list
12558 @item @code{Main}
12559 @tab string list
12560 @item @code{Library_Dir}
12561 @tab string
12562 @item @code{Library_Name}
12563 @tab string
12564 @item @code{Library_Kind}
12565 @tab string
12566 @item @code{Library_Version}
12567 @tab string
12568 @item @code{Library_Interface}
12569 @tab string
12570 @item @code{Library_Auto_Init}
12571 @tab string
12572 @item @code{Library_Options}
12573 @tab string list
12574 @item @code{Library_Src_Dir}
12575 @tab string
12576 @item @code{Library_ALI_Dir}
12577 @tab string
12578 @item @code{Library_GCC}
12579 @tab string
12580 @item @code{Library_Symbol_File}
12581 @tab string
12582 @item @code{Library_Symbol_Policy}
12583 @tab string
12584 @item @code{Library_Reference_Symbol_File}
12585 @tab string
12586 @item @code{Externally_Built}
12587 @tab string
12588 @end multitable
12589
12590 @noindent
12591 The following attributes are defined for package @code{Naming}
12592 (@pxref{Naming Schemes}):
12593
12594 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .2 .2 .2
12595 @item Attribute Name @tab Category @tab Index @tab Value
12596 @item @code{Spec_Suffix}
12597 @tab associative array
12598 @tab language name
12599 @tab string
12600 @item @code{Body_Suffix}
12601 @tab associative array
12602 @tab language name
12603 @tab string
12604 @item @code{Separate_Suffix}
12605 @tab simple attribute
12606 @tab n/a
12607 @tab string
12608 @item @code{Casing}
12609 @tab simple attribute
12610 @tab n/a
12611 @tab string
12612 @item @code{Dot_Replacement}
12613 @tab simple attribute
12614 @tab n/a
12615 @tab string
12616 @item @code{Spec}
12617 @tab associative array
12618 @tab Ada unit name
12619 @tab string
12620 @item @code{Body}
12621 @tab associative array
12622 @tab Ada unit name
12623 @tab string
12624 @item @code{Specification_Exceptions}
12625 @tab associative array
12626 @tab language name
12627 @tab string list
12628 @item @code{Implementation_Exceptions}
12629 @tab associative array
12630 @tab language name
12631 @tab string list
12632 @end multitable
12633
12634 @noindent
12635 The following attributes are defined for packages @code{Builder},
12636 @code{Compiler}, @code{Binder},
12637 @code{Linker}, @code{Cross_Reference}, and @code{Finder}
12638 (@pxref{^Switches^Switches^ and Project Files}).
12639
12640 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .2 .2 .2
12641 @item Attribute Name @tab Category @tab Index @tab Value
12642 @item @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}
12643 @tab associative array
12644 @tab language name
12645 @tab string list
12646 @item @code{^Switches^Switches^}
12647 @tab associative array
12648 @tab file name
12649 @tab string list
12650 @end multitable
12651
12652 @noindent
12653 In addition, package @code{Compiler} has a single string attribute
12654 @code{Local_Configuration_Pragmas} and package @code{Builder} has a single
12655 string attribute @code{Global_Configuration_Pragmas}.
12656
12657 @noindent
12658 Each simple attribute has a default value: the empty string (for string-valued
12659 attributes) and the empty list (for string list-valued attributes).
12660
12661 An attribute declaration defines a new value for an attribute.
12662
12663 Examples of simple attribute declarations:
12664
12665 @smallexample @c projectfile
12666 for Object_Dir use "objects";
12667 for Source_Dirs use ("units", "test/drivers");
12668 @end smallexample
12669
12670 @noindent
12671 The syntax of a @dfn{simple attribute declaration} is similar to that of an
12672 attribute definition clause in Ada.
12673
12674 Attributes references may be appear in expressions.
12675 The general form for such a reference is @code{<entity>'<attribute>}:
12676 Associative array attributes are functions. Associative
12677 array attribute references must have an argument that is a string literal.
12678
12679 Examples are:
12680
12681 @smallexample @c projectfile
12682 project'Object_Dir
12683 Naming'Dot_Replacement
12684 Imported_Project'Source_Dirs
12685 Imported_Project.Naming'Casing
12686 Builder'^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^("Ada")
12687 @end smallexample
12688
12689 @noindent
12690 The prefix of an attribute may be:
12691 @itemize @bullet
12692 @item @code{project} for an attribute of the current project
12693 @item The name of an existing package of the current project
12694 @item The name of an imported project
12695 @item The name of a parent project that is extended by the current project
12696 @item An expanded name whose prefix is imported/parent project name,
12697 and whose selector is a package name
12698 @end itemize
12699
12700 @noindent
12701 Example:
12702 @smallexample @c projectfile
12703 @group
12704 project Prj is
12705 for Source_Dirs use project'Source_Dirs & "units";
12706 for Source_Dirs use project'Source_Dirs & "test/drivers"
12707 end Prj;
12708 @end group
12709 @end smallexample
12710
12711 @noindent
12712 In the first attribute declaration, initially the attribute @code{Source_Dirs}
12713 has the default value: an empty string list. After this declaration,
12714 @code{Source_Dirs} is a string list of one element: @code{"units"}.
12715 After the second attribute declaration @code{Source_Dirs} is a string list of
12716 two elements: @code{"units"} and @code{"test/drivers"}.
12717
12718 Note: this example is for illustration only. In practice,
12719 the project file would contain only one attribute declaration:
12720
12721 @smallexample @c projectfile
12722 for Source_Dirs use ("units", "test/drivers");
12723 @end smallexample
12724
12725 @node Associative Array Attributes
12726 @subsection Associative Array Attributes
12727
12728 @noindent
12729 Some attributes are defined as @emph{associative arrays}. An associative
12730 array may be regarded as a function that takes a string as a parameter
12731 and delivers a string or string list value as its result.
12732
12733 Here are some examples of single associative array attribute associations:
12734
12735 @smallexample @c projectfile
12736 for Body ("main") use "Main.ada";
12737 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main.ada")
12738 use ("^-v^-v^",
12739 "^-gnatv^-gnatv^");
12740 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main.ada")
12741 use Builder'^Switches^Switches^ ("main.ada")
12742 & "^-g^-g^";
12743 @end smallexample
12744
12745 @noindent
12746 Like untyped variables and simple attributes, associative array attributes
12747 may be declared several times. Each declaration supplies a new value for the
12748 attribute, and replaces the previous setting.
12749
12750 @noindent
12751 An associative array attribute may be declared as a full associative array
12752 declaration, with the value of the same attribute in an imported or extended
12753 project.
12754
12755 @smallexample @c projectfile
12756 package Builder is
12757 for Default_Switches use Default.Builder'Default_Switches;
12758 end Builder;
12759 @end smallexample
12760
12761 @noindent
12762 In this example, @code{Default} must be either a project imported by the
12763 current project, or the project that the current project extends. If the
12764 attribute is in a package (in this case, in package @code{Builder}), the same
12765 package needs to be specified.
12766
12767 @noindent
12768 A full associative array declaration replaces any other declaration for the
12769 attribute, including other full associative array declaration. Single
12770 associative array associations may be declare after a full associative
12771 declaration, modifying the value for a single association of the attribute.
12772
12773 @node case Constructions
12774 @subsection @code{case} Constructions
12775
12776 @noindent
12777 A @code{case} construction is used in a project file to effect conditional
12778 behavior.
12779 Here is a typical example:
12780
12781 @smallexample @c projectfile
12782 @group
12783 project MyProj is
12784 type OS_Type is ("GNU/Linux", "Unix", "NT", "VMS");
12785
12786 OS : OS_Type := external ("OS", "GNU/Linux");
12787 @end group
12788
12789 @group
12790 package Compiler is
12791 case OS is
12792 when "GNU/Linux" | "Unix" =>
12793 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
12794 use ("^-gnath^-gnath^");
12795 when "NT" =>
12796 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
12797 use ("^-gnatP^-gnatP^");
12798 when others =>
12799 end case;
12800 end Compiler;
12801 end MyProj;
12802 @end group
12803 @end smallexample
12804
12805 @noindent
12806 The syntax of a @code{case} construction is based on the Ada case statement
12807 (although there is no @code{null} construction for empty alternatives).
12808
12809 The case expression must be a typed string variable.
12810 Each alternative comprises the reserved word @code{when}, either a list of
12811 literal strings separated by the @code{"|"} character or the reserved word
12812 @code{others}, and the @code{"=>"} token.
12813 Each literal string must belong to the string type that is the type of the
12814 case variable.
12815 An @code{others} alternative, if present, must occur last.
12816
12817 After each @code{=>}, there are zero or more constructions. The only
12818 constructions allowed in a case construction are other case constructions,
12819 attribute declarations and variable declarations. String type declarations and
12820 package declarations are not allowed. Variable declarations are restricted to
12821 variables that have already been declared before the case construction.
12822
12823 The value of the case variable is often given by an external reference
12824 (@pxref{External References in Project Files}).
12825
12826 @c ****************************************
12827 @c * Objects and Sources in Project Files *
12828 @c ****************************************
12829
12830 @node Objects and Sources in Project Files
12831 @section Objects and Sources in Project Files
12832
12833 @menu
12834 * Object Directory::
12835 * Exec Directory::
12836 * Source Directories::
12837 * Source File Names::
12838 @end menu
12839
12840 @noindent
12841 Each project has exactly one object directory and one or more source
12842 directories. The source directories must contain at least one source file,
12843 unless the project file explicitly specifies that no source files are present
12844 (@pxref{Source File Names}).
12845
12846 @node Object Directory
12847 @subsection Object Directory
12848
12849 @noindent
12850 The object directory for a project is the directory containing the compiler's
12851 output (such as @file{ALI} files and object files) for the project's immediate
12852 sources.
12853
12854 The object directory is given by the value of the attribute @code{Object_Dir}
12855 in the project file.
12856
12857 @smallexample @c projectfile
12858 for Object_Dir use "objects";
12859 @end smallexample
12860
12861 @noindent
12862 The attribute @code{Object_Dir} has a string value, the path name of the object
12863 directory. The path name may be absolute or relative to the directory of the
12864 project file. This directory must already exist, and be readable and writable.
12865
12866 By default, when the attribute @code{Object_Dir} is not given an explicit value
12867 or when its value is the empty string, the object directory is the same as the
12868 directory containing the project file.
12869
12870 @node Exec Directory
12871 @subsection Exec Directory
12872
12873 @noindent
12874 The exec directory for a project is the directory containing the executables
12875 for the project's main subprograms.
12876
12877 The exec directory is given by the value of the attribute @code{Exec_Dir}
12878 in the project file.
12879
12880 @smallexample @c projectfile
12881 for Exec_Dir use "executables";
12882 @end smallexample
12883
12884 @noindent
12885 The attribute @code{Exec_Dir} has a string value, the path name of the exec
12886 directory. The path name may be absolute or relative to the directory of the
12887 project file. This directory must already exist, and be writable.
12888
12889 By default, when the attribute @code{Exec_Dir} is not given an explicit value
12890 or when its value is the empty string, the exec directory is the same as the
12891 object directory of the project file.
12892
12893 @node Source Directories
12894 @subsection Source Directories
12895
12896 @noindent
12897 The source directories of a project are specified by the project file
12898 attribute @code{Source_Dirs}.
12899
12900 This attribute's value is a string list. If the attribute is not given an
12901 explicit value, then there is only one source directory, the one where the
12902 project file resides.
12903
12904 A @code{Source_Dirs} attribute that is explicitly defined to be the empty list,
12905 as in
12906
12907 @smallexample @c projectfile
12908 for Source_Dirs use ();
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 @noindent
12912 indicates that the project contains no source files.
12913
12914 Otherwise, each string in the string list designates one or more
12915 source directories.
12916
12917 @smallexample @c projectfile
12918 for Source_Dirs use ("sources", "test/drivers");
12919 @end smallexample
12920
12921 @noindent
12922 If a string in the list ends with @code{"/**"}, then the directory whose path
12923 name precedes the two asterisks, as well as all its subdirectories
12924 (recursively), are source directories.
12925
12926 @smallexample @c projectfile
12927 for Source_Dirs use ("/system/sources/**");
12928 @end smallexample
12929
12930 @noindent
12931 Here the directory @code{/system/sources} and all of its subdirectories
12932 (recursively) are source directories.
12933
12934 To specify that the source directories are the directory of the project file
12935 and all of its subdirectories, you can declare @code{Source_Dirs} as follows:
12936 @smallexample @c projectfile
12937 for Source_Dirs use ("./**");
12938 @end smallexample
12939
12940 @noindent
12941 Each of the source directories must exist and be readable.
12942
12943 @node Source File Names
12944 @subsection Source File Names
12945
12946 @noindent
12947 In a project that contains source files, their names may be specified by the
12948 attributes @code{Source_Files} (a string list) or @code{Source_List_File}
12949 (a string). Source file names never include any directory information.
12950
12951 If the attribute @code{Source_Files} is given an explicit value, then each
12952 element of the list is a source file name.
12953
12954 @smallexample @c projectfile
12955 for Source_Files use ("main.adb");
12956 for Source_Files use ("main.adb", "pack1.ads", "pack2.adb");
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 @noindent
12960 If the attribute @code{Source_Files} is not given an explicit value,
12961 but the attribute @code{Source_List_File} is given a string value,
12962 then the source file names are contained in the text file whose path name
12963 (absolute or relative to the directory of the project file) is the
12964 value of the attribute @code{Source_List_File}.
12965
12966 Each line in the file that is not empty or is not a comment
12967 contains a source file name.
12968
12969 @smallexample @c projectfile
12970 for Source_List_File use "source_list.txt";
12971 @end smallexample
12972
12973 @noindent
12974 By default, if neither the attribute @code{Source_Files} nor the attribute
12975 @code{Source_List_File} is given an explicit value, then each file in the
12976 source directories that conforms to the project's naming scheme
12977 (@pxref{Naming Schemes}) is an immediate source of the project.
12978
12979 A warning is issued if both attributes @code{Source_Files} and
12980 @code{Source_List_File} are given explicit values. In this case, the attribute
12981 @code{Source_Files} prevails.
12982
12983 Each source file name must be the name of one existing source file
12984 in one of the source directories.
12985
12986 A @code{Source_Files} attribute whose value is an empty list
12987 indicates that there are no source files in the project.
12988
12989 If the order of the source directories is known statically, that is if
12990 @code{"/**"} is not used in the string list @code{Source_Dirs}, then there may
12991 be several files with the same source file name. In this case, only the file
12992 in the first directory is considered as an immediate source of the project
12993 file. If the order of the source directories is not known statically, it is
12994 an error to have several files with the same source file name.
12995
12996 Projects can be specified to have no Ada source
12997 files: the value of (@code{Source_Dirs} or @code{Source_Files} may be an empty
12998 list, or the @code{"Ada"} may be absent from @code{Languages}:
12999
13000 @smallexample @c projectfile
13001 for Source_Dirs use ();
13002 for Source_Files use ();
13003 for Languages use ("C", "C++");
13004 @end smallexample
13005
13006 @noindent
13007 Otherwise, a project must contain at least one immediate source.
13008
13009 Projects with no source files are useful as template packages
13010 (@pxref{Packages in Project Files}) for other projects; in particular to
13011 define a package @code{Naming} (@pxref{Naming Schemes}).
13012
13013 @c ****************************
13014 @c * Importing Projects *
13015 @c ****************************
13016
13017 @node Importing Projects
13018 @section Importing Projects
13019 @cindex @code{ADA_PROJECT_PATH}
13020
13021 @noindent
13022 An immediate source of a project P may depend on source files that
13023 are neither immediate sources of P nor in the predefined library.
13024 To get this effect, P must @emph{import} the projects that contain the needed
13025 source files.
13026
13027 @smallexample @c projectfile
13028 @group
13029 with "project1", "utilities.gpr";
13030 with "/namings/apex.gpr";
13031 project Main is
13032 @dots{}
13033 @end group
13034 @end smallexample
13035
13036 @noindent
13037 As can be seen in this example, the syntax for importing projects is similar
13038 to the syntax for importing compilation units in Ada. However, project files
13039 use literal strings instead of names, and the @code{with} clause identifies
13040 project files rather than packages.
13041
13042 Each literal string is the file name or path name (absolute or relative) of a
13043 project file. If a string corresponds to a file name, with no path or a
13044 relative path, then its location is determined by the @emph{project path}. The
13045 latter can be queried using @code{gnatls -v}. It contains:
13046
13047 @itemize @bullet
13048 @item
13049 In first position, the directory containing the current project file.
13050 @item
13051 In last position, the default project directory. This default project directory
13052 is part of the GNAT installation and is the standard place to install project
13053 files giving access to standard support libraries.
13054 @ifclear vms
13055 @ref{Installing a library}
13056 @end ifclear
13057
13058 @item
13059 In between, all the directories referenced in the
13060 ^environment variable^logical name^ @env{ADA_PROJECT_PATH} if it exists.
13061 @end itemize
13062
13063 @noindent
13064 If a relative pathname is used, as in
13065
13066 @smallexample @c projectfile
13067 with "tests/proj";
13068 @end smallexample
13069
13070 @noindent
13071 then the full path for the project is constructed by concatenating this
13072 relative path to those in the project path, in order, until a matching file is
13073 found. Any symbolic link will be fully resolved in the directory of the
13074 importing project file before the imported project file is examined.
13075
13076 If the @code{with}'ed project file name does not have an extension,
13077 the default is @file{^.gpr^.GPR^}. If a file with this extension is not found,
13078 then the file name as specified in the @code{with} clause (no extension) will
13079 be used. In the above example, if a file @code{project1.gpr} is found, then it
13080 will be used; otherwise, if a file @code{^project1^PROJECT1^} exists
13081 then it will be used; if neither file exists, this is an error.
13082
13083 A warning is issued if the name of the project file does not match the
13084 name of the project; this check is case insensitive.
13085
13086 Any source file that is an immediate source of the imported project can be
13087 used by the immediate sources of the importing project, transitively. Thus
13088 if @code{A} imports @code{B}, and @code{B} imports @code{C}, the immediate
13089 sources of @code{A} may depend on the immediate sources of @code{C}, even if
13090 @code{A} does not import @code{C} explicitly. However, this is not recommended,
13091 because if and when @code{B} ceases to import @code{C}, some sources in
13092 @code{A} will no longer compile.
13093
13094 A side effect of this capability is that normally cyclic dependencies are not
13095 permitted: if @code{A} imports @code{B} (directly or indirectly) then @code{B}
13096 is not allowed to import @code{A}. However, there are cases when cyclic
13097 dependencies would be beneficial. For these cases, another form of import
13098 between projects exists, the @code{limited with}: a project @code{A} that
13099 imports a project @code{B} with a straight @code{with} may also be imported,
13100 directly or indirectly, by @code{B} on the condition that imports from @code{B}
13101 to @code{A} include at least one @code{limited with}.
13102
13103 @smallexample @c 0projectfile
13104 with "../b/b.gpr";
13105 with "../c/c.gpr";
13106 project A is
13107 end A;
13108
13109 limited with "../a/a.gpr";
13110 project B is
13111 end B;
13112
13113 with "../d/d.gpr";
13114 project C is
13115 end C;
13116
13117 limited with "../a/a.gpr";
13118 project D is
13119 end D;
13120 @end smallexample
13121
13122 @noindent
13123 In the above legal example, there are two project cycles:
13124 @itemize @bullet
13125 @item A-> B-> A
13126 @item A -> C -> D -> A
13127 @end itemize
13128
13129 @noindent
13130 In each of these cycle there is one @code{limited with}: import of @code{A}
13131 from @code{B} and import of @code{A} from @code{D}.
13132
13133 The difference between straight @code{with} and @code{limited with} is that
13134 the name of a project imported with a @code{limited with} cannot be used in the
13135 project that imports it. In particular, its packages cannot be renamed and
13136 its variables cannot be referred to.
13137
13138 An exception to the above rules for @code{limited with} is that for the main
13139 project specified to @command{gnatmake} or to the @command{GNAT} driver a
13140 @code{limited with} is equivalent to a straight @code{with}. For example,
13141 in the example above, projects @code{B} and @code{D} could not be main
13142 projects for @command{gnatmake} or to the @command{GNAT} driver, because they
13143 each have a @code{limited with} that is the only one in a cycle of importing
13144 projects.
13145
13146 @c *********************
13147 @c * Project Extension *
13148 @c *********************
13149
13150 @node Project Extension
13151 @section Project Extension
13152
13153 @noindent
13154 During development of a large system, it is sometimes necessary to use
13155 modified versions of some of the source files, without changing the original
13156 sources. This can be achieved through the @emph{project extension} facility.
13157
13158 @smallexample @c projectfile
13159 project Modified_Utilities extends "/baseline/utilities.gpr" is @dots{}
13160 @end smallexample
13161
13162 @noindent
13163 A project extension declaration introduces an extending project
13164 (the @emph{child}) and a project being extended (the @emph{parent}).
13165
13166 By default, a child project inherits all the sources of its parent.
13167 However, inherited sources can be overridden: a unit in a parent is hidden
13168 by a unit of the same name in the child.
13169
13170 Inherited sources are considered to be sources (but not immediate sources)
13171 of the child project; see @ref{Project File Syntax}.
13172
13173 An inherited source file retains any switches specified in the parent project.
13174
13175 For example if the project @code{Utilities} contains the spec and the
13176 body of an Ada package @code{Util_IO}, then the project
13177 @code{Modified_Utilities} can contain a new body for package @code{Util_IO}.
13178 The original body of @code{Util_IO} will not be considered in program builds.
13179 However, the package spec will still be found in the project
13180 @code{Utilities}.
13181
13182 A child project can have only one parent, except when it is qualified as
13183 abstract. But it may import any number of other projects.
13184
13185 A project is not allowed to import directly or indirectly at the same time a
13186 child project and any of its ancestors.
13187
13188 @c *******************************
13189 @c * Project Hierarchy Extension *
13190 @c *******************************
13191
13192 @node Project Hierarchy Extension
13193 @section Project Hierarchy Extension
13194
13195 @noindent
13196 When extending a large system spanning multiple projects, it is often
13197 inconvenient to extend every project in the hierarchy that is impacted by a
13198 small change introduced. In such cases, it is possible to create a virtual
13199 extension of entire hierarchy using @code{extends all} relationship.
13200
13201 When the project is extended using @code{extends all} inheritance, all projects
13202 that are imported by it, both directly and indirectly, are considered virtually
13203 extended. That is, the Project Manager creates "virtual projects"
13204 that extend every project in the hierarchy; all these virtual projects have
13205 no sources of their own and have as object directory the object directory of
13206 the root of "extending all" project.
13207
13208 It is possible to explicitly extend one or more projects in the hierarchy
13209 in order to modify the sources. These extending projects must be imported by
13210 the "extending all" project, which will replace the corresponding virtual
13211 projects with the explicit ones.
13212
13213 When building such a project hierarchy extension, the Project Manager will
13214 ensure that both modified sources and sources in virtual extending projects
13215 that depend on them, are recompiled.
13216
13217 By means of example, consider the following hierarchy of projects.
13218
13219 @enumerate
13220 @item
13221 project A, containing package P1
13222 @item
13223 project B importing A and containing package P2 which depends on P1
13224 @item
13225 project C importing B and containing package P3 which depends on P2
13226 @end enumerate
13227
13228 @noindent
13229 We want to modify packages P1 and P3.
13230
13231 This project hierarchy will need to be extended as follows:
13232
13233 @enumerate
13234 @item
13235 Create project A1 that extends A, placing modified P1 there:
13236
13237 @smallexample @c 0projectfile
13238 project A1 extends "(@dots{})/A" is
13239 end A1;
13240 @end smallexample
13241
13242 @item
13243 Create project C1 that "extends all" C and imports A1, placing modified
13244 P3 there:
13245
13246 @smallexample @c 0projectfile
13247 with "(@dots{})/A1";
13248 project C1 extends all "(@dots{})/C" is
13249 end C1;
13250 @end smallexample
13251 @end enumerate
13252
13253 When you build project C1, your entire modified project space will be
13254 recompiled, including the virtual project B1 that has been impacted by the
13255 "extending all" inheritance of project C.
13256
13257 Note that if a Library Project in the hierarchy is virtually extended,
13258 the virtual project that extends the Library Project is not a Library Project.
13259
13260 @c ****************************************
13261 @c * External References in Project Files *
13262 @c ****************************************
13263
13264 @node External References in Project Files
13265 @section External References in Project Files
13266
13267 @noindent
13268 A project file may contain references to external variables; such references
13269 are called @emph{external references}.
13270
13271 An external variable is either defined as part of the environment (an
13272 environment variable in Unix, for example) or else specified on the command
13273 line via the @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=^@emph{vbl}=@emph{value}} switch.
13274 If both, then the command line value is used.
13275
13276 The value of an external reference is obtained by means of the built-in
13277 function @code{external}, which returns a string value.
13278 This function has two forms:
13279 @itemize @bullet
13280 @item @code{external (external_variable_name)}
13281 @item @code{external (external_variable_name, default_value)}
13282 @end itemize
13283
13284 @noindent
13285 Each parameter must be a string literal. For example:
13286
13287 @smallexample @c projectfile
13288 external ("USER")
13289 external ("OS", "GNU/Linux")
13290 @end smallexample
13291
13292 @noindent
13293 In the form with one parameter, the function returns the value of
13294 the external variable given as parameter. If this name is not present in the
13295 environment, the function returns an empty string.
13296
13297 In the form with two string parameters, the second argument is
13298 the value returned when the variable given as the first argument is not
13299 present in the environment. In the example above, if @code{"OS"} is not
13300 the name of ^an environment variable^a logical name^ and is not passed on
13301 the command line, then the returned value is @code{"GNU/Linux"}.
13302
13303 An external reference may be part of a string expression or of a string
13304 list expression, and can therefore appear in a variable declaration or
13305 an attribute declaration.
13306
13307 @smallexample @c projectfile
13308 @group
13309 type Mode_Type is ("Debug", "Release");
13310 Mode : Mode_Type := external ("MODE");
13311 case Mode is
13312 when "Debug" =>
13313 @dots{}
13314 @end group
13315 @end smallexample
13316
13317 @c *****************************
13318 @c * Packages in Project Files *
13319 @c *****************************
13320
13321 @node Packages in Project Files
13322 @section Packages in Project Files
13323
13324 @noindent
13325 A @emph{package} defines the settings for project-aware tools within a
13326 project.
13327 For each such tool one can declare a package; the names for these
13328 packages are preset (@pxref{Packages}).
13329 A package may contain variable declarations, attribute declarations, and case
13330 constructions.
13331
13332 @smallexample @c projectfile
13333 @group
13334 project Proj is
13335 package Builder is -- used by gnatmake
13336 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
13337 use ("^-v^-v^",
13338 "^-g^-g^");
13339 end Builder;
13340 end Proj;
13341 @end group
13342 @end smallexample
13343
13344 @noindent
13345 The syntax of package declarations mimics that of package in Ada.
13346
13347 Most of the packages have an attribute
13348 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}.
13349 This attribute is an associative array, and its value is a string list.
13350 The index of the associative array is the name of a programming language (case
13351 insensitive). This attribute indicates the ^switch^switch^
13352 or ^switches^switches^ to be used
13353 with the corresponding tool.
13354
13355 Some packages also have another attribute, @code{^Switches^Switches^},
13356 an associative array whose value is a string list.
13357 The index is the name of a source file.
13358 This attribute indicates the ^switch^switch^
13359 or ^switches^switches^ to be used by the corresponding
13360 tool when dealing with this specific file.
13361
13362 Further information on these ^switch^switch^-related attributes is found in
13363 @ref{^Switches^Switches^ and Project Files}.
13364
13365 A package may be declared as a @emph{renaming} of another package; e.g., from
13366 the project file for an imported project.
13367
13368 @smallexample @c projectfile
13369 @group
13370 with "/global/apex.gpr";
13371 project Example is
13372 package Naming renames Apex.Naming;
13373 @dots{}
13374 end Example;
13375 @end group
13376 @end smallexample
13377
13378 @noindent
13379 Packages that are renamed in other project files often come from project files
13380 that have no sources: they are just used as templates. Any modification in the
13381 template will be reflected automatically in all the project files that rename
13382 a package from the template.
13383
13384 In addition to the tool-oriented packages, you can also declare a package
13385 named @code{Naming} to establish specialized source file naming conventions
13386 (@pxref{Naming Schemes}).
13387
13388 @c ************************************
13389 @c * Variables from Imported Projects *
13390 @c ************************************
13391
13392 @node Variables from Imported Projects
13393 @section Variables from Imported Projects
13394
13395 @noindent
13396 An attribute or variable defined in an imported or parent project can
13397 be used in expressions in the importing / extending project.
13398 Such an attribute or variable is denoted by an expanded name whose prefix
13399 is either the name of the project or the expanded name of a package within
13400 a project.
13401
13402 @smallexample @c projectfile
13403 @group
13404 with "imported";
13405 project Main extends "base" is
13406 Var1 := Imported.Var;
13407 Var2 := Base.Var & ".new";
13408 @end group
13409
13410 @group
13411 package Builder is
13412 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
13413 use Imported.Builder'Ada_^Switches^Switches^ &
13414 "^-gnatg^-gnatg^" &
13415 "^-v^-v^";
13416 end Builder;
13417 @end group
13418
13419 @group
13420 package Compiler is
13421 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
13422 use Base.Compiler'Ada_^Switches^Switches^;
13423 end Compiler;
13424 end Main;
13425 @end group
13426 @end smallexample
13427
13428 @noindent
13429 In this example:
13430
13431 @itemize @bullet
13432 @item
13433 The value of @code{Var1} is a copy of the variable @code{Var} defined
13434 in the project file @file{"imported.gpr"}
13435 @item
13436 the value of @code{Var2} is a copy of the value of variable @code{Var}
13437 defined in the project file @file{base.gpr}, concatenated with @code{".new"}
13438 @item
13439 attribute @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")} in package
13440 @code{Builder} is a string list that includes in its value a copy of the value
13441 of @code{Ada_^Switches^Switches^} defined in the @code{Builder} package
13442 in project file @file{imported.gpr} plus two new elements:
13443 @option{"^-gnatg^-gnatg^"}
13444 and @option{"^-v^-v^"};
13445 @item
13446 attribute @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")} in package
13447 @code{Compiler} is a copy of the variable @code{Ada_^Switches^Switches^}
13448 defined in the @code{Compiler} package in project file @file{base.gpr},
13449 the project being extended.
13450 @end itemize
13451
13452 @c ******************
13453 @c * Naming Schemes *
13454 @c ******************
13455
13456 @node Naming Schemes
13457 @section Naming Schemes
13458
13459 @noindent
13460 Sometimes an Ada software system is ported from a foreign compilation
13461 environment to GNAT, and the file names do not use the default GNAT
13462 conventions. Instead of changing all the file names (which for a variety
13463 of reasons might not be possible), you can define the relevant file
13464 naming scheme in the @code{Naming} package in your project file.
13465
13466 @noindent
13467 Note that the use of pragmas described in
13468 @ref{Alternative File Naming Schemes} by mean of a configuration
13469 pragmas file is not supported when using project files. You must use
13470 the features described in this paragraph. You can however use specify
13471 other configuration pragmas (@pxref{Specifying Configuration Pragmas}).
13472
13473 @ifclear vms
13474 For example, the following
13475 package models the Apex file naming rules:
13476
13477 @smallexample @c projectfile
13478 @group
13479 package Naming is
13480 for Casing use "lowercase";
13481 for Dot_Replacement use ".";
13482 for Spec_Suffix ("Ada") use ".1.ada";
13483 for Body_Suffix ("Ada") use ".2.ada";
13484 end Naming;
13485 @end group
13486 @end smallexample
13487 @end ifclear
13488
13489 @ifset vms
13490 For example, the following package models the HP Ada file naming rules:
13491
13492 @smallexample @c projectfile
13493 @group
13494 package Naming is
13495 for Casing use "lowercase";
13496 for Dot_Replacement use "__";
13497 for Spec_Suffix ("Ada") use "_.^ada^ada^";
13498 for Body_Suffix ("Ada") use ".^ada^ada^";
13499 end Naming;
13500 @end group
13501 @end smallexample
13502
13503 @noindent
13504 (Note that @code{Casing} is @code{"lowercase"} because GNAT gets the file
13505 names in lower case)
13506 @end ifset
13507
13508 @noindent
13509 You can define the following attributes in package @code{Naming}:
13510
13511 @table @code
13512
13513 @item @code{Casing}
13514 This must be a string with one of the three values @code{"lowercase"},
13515 @code{"uppercase"} or @code{"mixedcase"}; these strings are case insensitive.
13516
13517 @noindent
13518 If @code{Casing} is not specified, then the default is @code{"lowercase"}.
13519
13520 @item @code{Dot_Replacement}
13521 This must be a string whose value satisfies the following conditions:
13522
13523 @itemize @bullet
13524 @item It must not be empty
13525 @item It cannot start or end with an alphanumeric character
13526 @item It cannot be a single underscore
13527 @item It cannot start with an underscore followed by an alphanumeric
13528 @item It cannot contain a dot @code{'.'} except if the entire string
13529 is @code{"."}
13530 @end itemize
13531
13532 @noindent
13533 If @code{Dot_Replacement} is not specified, then the default is @code{"-"}.
13534
13535 @item @code{Spec_Suffix}
13536 This is an associative array (indexed by the programming language name, case
13537 insensitive) whose value is a string that must satisfy the following
13538 conditions:
13539
13540 @itemize @bullet
13541 @item It must not be empty
13542 @item It must include at least one dot
13543 @end itemize
13544 @noindent
13545 If @code{Spec_Suffix ("Ada")} is not specified, then the default is
13546 @code{"^.ads^.ADS^"}.
13547
13548 @item @code{Body_Suffix}
13549 This is an associative array (indexed by the programming language name, case
13550 insensitive) whose value is a string that must satisfy the following
13551 conditions:
13552
13553 @itemize @bullet
13554 @item It must not be empty
13555 @item It must include at least one dot
13556 @item It cannot be the same as @code{Spec_Suffix ("Ada")}
13557 @end itemize
13558 @noindent
13559 If @code{Body_Suffix ("Ada")} and @code{Spec_Suffix ("Ada")} end with the
13560 same string, then a file name that ends with the longest of these two suffixes
13561 will be a body if the longest suffix is @code{Body_Suffix ("Ada")} or a spec
13562 if the longest suffix is @code{Spec_Suffix ("Ada")}.
13563
13564 If @code{Body_Suffix ("Ada")} is not specified, then the default is
13565 @code{"^.adb^.ADB^"}.
13566
13567 @item @code{Separate_Suffix}
13568 This must be a string whose value satisfies the same conditions as
13569 @code{Body_Suffix}. The same "longest suffix" rules apply.
13570
13571 @noindent
13572 If @code{Separate_Suffix ("Ada")} is not specified, then it defaults to same
13573 value as @code{Body_Suffix ("Ada")}.
13574
13575 @item @code{Spec}
13576 @noindent
13577 You can use the associative array attribute @code{Spec} to define
13578 the source file name for an individual Ada compilation unit's spec. The array
13579 index must be a string literal that identifies the Ada unit (case insensitive).
13580 The value of this attribute must be a string that identifies the file that
13581 contains this unit's spec (case sensitive or insensitive depending on the
13582 operating system).
13583
13584 @smallexample @c projectfile
13585 for Spec ("MyPack.MyChild") use "mypack.mychild.spec";
13586 @end smallexample
13587
13588 @item @code{Body}
13589
13590 You can use the associative array attribute @code{Body} to
13591 define the source file name for an individual Ada compilation unit's body
13592 (possibly a subunit). The array index must be a string literal that identifies
13593 the Ada unit (case insensitive). The value of this attribute must be a string
13594 that identifies the file that contains this unit's body or subunit (case
13595 sensitive or insensitive depending on the operating system).
13596
13597 @smallexample @c projectfile
13598 for Body ("MyPack.MyChild") use "mypack.mychild.body";
13599 @end smallexample
13600 @end table
13601
13602 @c ********************
13603 @c * Library Projects *
13604 @c ********************
13605
13606 @node Library Projects
13607 @section Library Projects
13608
13609 @noindent
13610 @emph{Library projects} are projects whose object code is placed in a library.
13611 (Note that this facility is not yet supported on all platforms)
13612
13613 To create a library project, you need to define in its project file
13614 two project-level attributes: @code{Library_Name} and @code{Library_Dir}.
13615 Additionally, you may define other library-related attributes such as
13616 @code{Library_Kind}, @code{Library_Version}, @code{Library_Interface},
13617 @code{Library_Auto_Init}, @code{Library_Options} and @code{Library_GCC}.
13618
13619 The @code{Library_Name} attribute has a string value. There is no restriction
13620 on the name of a library. It is the responsibility of the developer to
13621 choose a name that will be accepted by the platform. It is recommended to
13622 choose names that could be Ada identifiers; such names are almost guaranteed
13623 to be acceptable on all platforms.
13624
13625 The @code{Library_Dir} attribute has a string value that designates the path
13626 (absolute or relative) of the directory where the library will reside.
13627 It must designate an existing directory, and this directory must be writable,
13628 different from the project's object directory and from any source directory
13629 in the project tree.
13630
13631 If both @code{Library_Name} and @code{Library_Dir} are specified and
13632 are legal, then the project file defines a library project. The optional
13633 library-related attributes are checked only for such project files.
13634
13635 The @code{Library_Kind} attribute has a string value that must be one of the
13636 following (case insensitive): @code{"static"}, @code{"dynamic"} or
13637 @code{"relocatable"} (which is a synonym for @code{"dynamic"}). If this
13638 attribute is not specified, the library is a static library, that is
13639 an archive of object files that can be potentially linked into a
13640 static executable. Otherwise, the library may be dynamic or
13641 relocatable, that is a library that is loaded only at the start of execution.
13642
13643 If you need to build both a static and a dynamic library, you should use two
13644 different object directories, since in some cases some extra code needs to
13645 be generated for the latter. For such cases, it is recommended to either use
13646 two different project files, or a single one which uses external variables
13647 to indicate what kind of library should be build.
13648
13649 The @code{Library_ALI_Dir} attribute may be specified to indicate the
13650 directory where the ALI files of the library will be copied. When it is
13651 not specified, the ALI files are copied to the directory specified in
13652 attribute @code{Library_Dir}. The directory specified by @code{Library_ALI_Dir}
13653 must be writable and different from the project's object directory and from
13654 any source directory in the project tree.
13655
13656 The @code{Library_Version} attribute has a string value whose interpretation
13657 is platform dependent. It has no effect on VMS and Windows. On Unix, it is
13658 used only for dynamic/relocatable libraries as the internal name of the
13659 library (the @code{"soname"}). If the library file name (built from the
13660 @code{Library_Name}) is different from the @code{Library_Version}, then the
13661 library file will be a symbolic link to the actual file whose name will be
13662 @code{Library_Version}.
13663
13664 Example (on Unix):
13665
13666 @smallexample @c projectfile
13667 @group
13668 project Plib is
13669
13670 Version := "1";
13671
13672 for Library_Dir use "lib_dir";
13673 for Library_Name use "dummy";
13674 for Library_Kind use "relocatable";
13675 for Library_Version use "libdummy.so." & Version;
13676
13677 end Plib;
13678 @end group
13679 @end smallexample
13680
13681 @noindent
13682 Directory @file{lib_dir} will contain the internal library file whose name
13683 will be @file{libdummy.so.1}, and @file{libdummy.so} will be a symbolic link to
13684 @file{libdummy.so.1}.
13685
13686 When @command{gnatmake} detects that a project file
13687 is a library project file, it will check all immediate sources of the project
13688 and rebuild the library if any of the sources have been recompiled.
13689
13690 Standard project files can import library project files. In such cases,
13691 the libraries will only be rebuilt if some of its sources are recompiled
13692 because they are in the closure of some other source in an importing project.
13693 Sources of the library project files that are not in such a closure will
13694 not be checked, unless the full library is checked, because one of its sources
13695 needs to be recompiled.
13696
13697 For instance, assume the project file @code{A} imports the library project file
13698 @code{L}. The immediate sources of A are @file{a1.adb}, @file{a2.ads} and
13699 @file{a2.adb}. The immediate sources of L are @file{l1.ads}, @file{l1.adb},
13700 @file{l2.ads}, @file{l2.adb}.
13701
13702 If @file{l1.adb} has been modified, then the library associated with @code{L}
13703 will be rebuilt when compiling all the immediate sources of @code{A} only
13704 if @file{a1.ads}, @file{a2.ads} or @file{a2.adb} includes a statement
13705 @code{"with L1;"}.
13706
13707 To be sure that all the sources in the library associated with @code{L} are
13708 up to date, and that all the sources of project @code{A} are also up to date,
13709 the following two commands needs to be used:
13710
13711 @smallexample
13712 gnatmake -Pl.gpr
13713 gnatmake -Pa.gpr
13714 @end smallexample
13715
13716 When a library is built or rebuilt, an attempt is made first to delete all
13717 files in the library directory.
13718 All @file{ALI} files will also be copied from the object directory to the
13719 library directory. To build executables, @command{gnatmake} will use the
13720 library rather than the individual object files.
13721
13722 @ifclear vms
13723 It is also possible to create library project files for third-party libraries
13724 that are precompiled and cannot be compiled locally thanks to the
13725 @code{externally_built} attribute. (See @ref{Installing a library}).
13726 @end ifclear
13727
13728 @c *******************************
13729 @c * Stand-alone Library Projects *
13730 @c *******************************
13731
13732 @node Stand-alone Library Projects
13733 @section Stand-alone Library Projects
13734
13735 @noindent
13736 A Stand-alone Library is a library that contains the necessary code to
13737 elaborate the Ada units that are included in the library. A Stand-alone
13738 Library is suitable to be used in an executable when the main is not
13739 in Ada. However, Stand-alone Libraries may also be used with an Ada main
13740 subprogram.
13741
13742 A Stand-alone Library Project is a Library Project where the library is
13743 a Stand-alone Library.
13744
13745 To be a Stand-alone Library Project, in addition to the two attributes
13746 that make a project a Library Project (@code{Library_Name} and
13747 @code{Library_Dir}, see @ref{Library Projects}), the attribute
13748 @code{Library_Interface} must be defined.
13749
13750 @smallexample @c projectfile
13751 @group
13752 for Library_Dir use "lib_dir";
13753 for Library_Name use "dummy";
13754 for Library_Interface use ("int1", "int1.child");
13755 @end group
13756 @end smallexample
13757
13758 Attribute @code{Library_Interface} has a nonempty string list value,
13759 each string in the list designating a unit contained in an immediate source
13760 of the project file.
13761
13762 When a Stand-alone Library is built, first the binder is invoked to build
13763 a package whose name depends on the library name
13764 (^b~dummy.ads/b^B$DUMMY.ADS/B^ in the example above).
13765 This binder-generated package includes initialization and
13766 finalization procedures whose
13767 names depend on the library name (dummyinit and dummyfinal in the example
13768 above). The object corresponding to this package is included in the library.
13769
13770 A dynamic or relocatable Stand-alone Library is automatically initialized
13771 if automatic initialization of Stand-alone Libraries is supported on the
13772 platform and if attribute @code{Library_Auto_Init} is not specified or
13773 is specified with the value "true". A static Stand-alone Library is never
13774 automatically initialized.
13775
13776 Single string attribute @code{Library_Auto_Init} may be specified with only
13777 two possible values: "false" or "true" (case-insensitive). Specifying
13778 "false" for attribute @code{Library_Auto_Init} will prevent automatic
13779 initialization of dynamic or relocatable libraries.
13780
13781 When a non-automatically initialized Stand-alone Library is used
13782 in an executable, its initialization procedure must be called before
13783 any service of the library is used.
13784 When the main subprogram is in Ada, it may mean that the initialization
13785 procedure has to be called during elaboration of another package.
13786
13787 For a Stand-Alone Library, only the @file{ALI} files of the Interface Units
13788 (those that are listed in attribute @code{Library_Interface}) are copied to
13789 the Library Directory. As a consequence, only the Interface Units may be
13790 imported from Ada units outside of the library. If other units are imported,
13791 the binding phase will fail.
13792
13793 When a Stand-Alone Library is bound, the switches that are specified in
13794 the attribute @code{Default_Switches ("Ada")} in package @code{Binder} are
13795 used in the call to @command{gnatbind}.
13796
13797 The string list attribute @code{Library_Options} may be used to specified
13798 additional switches to the call to @command{gcc} to link the library.
13799
13800 The attribute @code{Library_Src_Dir}, may be specified for a
13801 Stand-Alone Library. @code{Library_Src_Dir} is a simple attribute that has a
13802 single string value. Its value must be the path (absolute or relative to the
13803 project directory) of an existing directory. This directory cannot be the
13804 object directory or one of the source directories, but it can be the same as
13805 the library directory. The sources of the Interface
13806 Units of the library, necessary to an Ada client of the library, will be
13807 copied to the designated directory, called Interface Copy directory.
13808 These sources includes the specs of the Interface Units, but they may also
13809 include bodies and subunits, when pragmas @code{Inline} or @code{Inline_Always}
13810 are used, or when there is a generic units in the spec. Before the sources
13811 are copied to the Interface Copy directory, an attempt is made to delete all
13812 files in the Interface Copy directory.
13813
13814 @c *************************************
13815 @c * Switches Related to Project Files *
13816 @c *************************************
13817 @node Switches Related to Project Files
13818 @section Switches Related to Project Files
13819
13820 @noindent
13821 The following switches are used by GNAT tools that support project files:
13822
13823 @table @option
13824
13825 @item ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@var{project}
13826 @cindex @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} (any project-aware tool)
13827 Indicates the name of a project file. This project file will be parsed with
13828 the verbosity indicated by @option{^-vP^MESSAGE_PROJECT_FILES=^@emph{x}},
13829 if any, and using the external references indicated
13830 by @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} switches, if any.
13831 @ifclear vms
13832 There may zero, one or more spaces between @option{-P} and @var{project}.
13833 @end ifclear
13834
13835 @noindent
13836 There must be only one @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} switch on the command line.
13837
13838 @noindent
13839 Since the Project Manager parses the project file only after all the switches
13840 on the command line are checked, the order of the switches
13841 @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^},
13842 @option{^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{x}}
13843 or @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} is not significant.
13844
13845 @item ^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=^@var{name=value}
13846 @cindex @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} (any project-aware tool)
13847 Indicates that external variable @var{name} has the value @var{value}.
13848 The Project Manager will use this value for occurrences of
13849 @code{external(name)} when parsing the project file.
13850
13851 @ifclear vms
13852 @noindent
13853 If @var{name} or @var{value} includes a space, then @var{name=value} should be
13854 put between quotes.
13855 @smallexample
13856 -XOS=NT
13857 -X"user=John Doe"
13858 @end smallexample
13859 @end ifclear
13860
13861 @noindent
13862 Several @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} switches can be used simultaneously.
13863 If several @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} switches specify the same
13864 @var{name}, only the last one is used.
13865
13866 @noindent
13867 An external variable specified with a @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} switch
13868 takes precedence over the value of the same name in the environment.
13869
13870 @item ^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{x}
13871 @cindex @option{^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE^} (any project-aware tool)
13872 Indicates the verbosity of the parsing of GNAT project files.
13873
13874 @ifclear vms
13875 @option{-vP0} means Default;
13876 @option{-vP1} means Medium;
13877 @option{-vP2} means High.
13878 @end ifclear
13879
13880 @ifset vms
13881 There are three possible options for this qualifier: DEFAULT, MEDIUM and
13882 HIGH.
13883 @end ifset
13884
13885 @noindent
13886 The default is ^Default^DEFAULT^: no output for syntactically correct
13887 project files.
13888 @noindent
13889 If several @option{^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{x}} switches are present,
13890 only the last one is used.
13891
13892 @item ^-aP^/ADD_PROJECT_SEARCH_DIR=^<dir>
13893 @cindex @option{^-aP^/ADD_PROJECT_SEARCH_DIR=^} (any project-aware tool)
13894 Add directory <dir> at the beginning of the project search path, in order,
13895 after the current working directory.
13896
13897 @ifclear vms
13898 @item -eL
13899 @cindex @option{-eL} (any project-aware tool)
13900 Follow all symbolic links when processing project files.
13901 @end ifclear
13902
13903 @item ^--subdirs^/SUBDIRS^=<subdir>
13904 @cindex @option{^--subdirs^/SUBDIRS^=} (gnatmake and gnatclean)
13905 This switch is recognized by gnatmake and gnatclean. It indicate that the real
13906 directories (except the source directories) are the subdirectories <subdir>
13907 of the directories specified in the project files. This applies in particular
13908 to object directories, library directories and exec directories. If the
13909 subdirectories do not exist, they are created automatically.
13910
13911 @end table
13912
13913 @c **********************************
13914 @c * Tools Supporting Project Files *
13915 @c **********************************
13916
13917 @node Tools Supporting Project Files
13918 @section Tools Supporting Project Files
13919
13920 @menu
13921 * gnatmake and Project Files::
13922 * The GNAT Driver and Project Files::
13923 @end menu
13924
13925 @node gnatmake and Project Files
13926 @subsection gnatmake and Project Files
13927
13928 @noindent
13929 This section covers several topics related to @command{gnatmake} and
13930 project files: defining ^switches^switches^ for @command{gnatmake}
13931 and for the tools that it invokes; specifying configuration pragmas;
13932 the use of the @code{Main} attribute; building and rebuilding library project
13933 files.
13934
13935 @menu
13936 * ^Switches^Switches^ and Project Files::
13937 * Specifying Configuration Pragmas::
13938 * Project Files and Main Subprograms::
13939 * Library Project Files::
13940 @end menu
13941
13942 @node ^Switches^Switches^ and Project Files
13943 @subsubsection ^Switches^Switches^ and Project Files
13944
13945 @ifset vms
13946 It is not currently possible to specify VMS style qualifiers in the project
13947 files; only Unix style ^switches^switches^ may be specified.
13948 @end ifset
13949
13950 @noindent
13951 For each of the packages @code{Builder}, @code{Compiler}, @code{Binder}, and
13952 @code{Linker}, you can specify a @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}
13953 attribute, a @code{^Switches^Switches^} attribute, or both;
13954 as their names imply, these ^switch^switch^-related
13955 attributes affect the ^switches^switches^ that are used for each of these GNAT
13956 components when
13957 @command{gnatmake} is invoked. As will be explained below, these
13958 component-specific ^switches^switches^ precede
13959 the ^switches^switches^ provided on the @command{gnatmake} command line.
13960
13961 The @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^} attribute is an associative
13962 array indexed by language name (case insensitive) whose value is a string list.
13963 For example:
13964
13965 @smallexample @c projectfile
13966 @group
13967 package Compiler is
13968 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
13969 use ("^-gnaty^-gnaty^",
13970 "^-v^-v^");
13971 end Compiler;
13972 @end group
13973 @end smallexample
13974
13975 @noindent
13976 The @code{^Switches^Switches^} attribute is also an associative array,
13977 indexed by a file name (which may or may not be case sensitive, depending
13978 on the operating system) whose value is a string list. For example:
13979
13980 @smallexample @c projectfile
13981 @group
13982 package Builder is
13983 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main1.adb")
13984 use ("^-O2^-O2^");
13985 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main2.adb")
13986 use ("^-g^-g^");
13987 end Builder;
13988 @end group
13989 @end smallexample
13990
13991 @noindent
13992 For the @code{Builder} package, the file names must designate source files
13993 for main subprograms. For the @code{Binder} and @code{Linker} packages, the
13994 file names must designate @file{ALI} or source files for main subprograms.
13995 In each case just the file name without an explicit extension is acceptable.
13996
13997 For each tool used in a program build (@command{gnatmake}, the compiler, the
13998 binder, and the linker), the corresponding package @dfn{contributes} a set of
13999 ^switches^switches^ for each file on which the tool is invoked, based on the
14000 ^switch^switch^-related attributes defined in the package.
14001 In particular, the ^switches^switches^
14002 that each of these packages contributes for a given file @var{f} comprise:
14003
14004 @itemize @bullet
14005 @item
14006 the value of attribute @code{^Switches^Switches^ (@var{f})},
14007 if it is specified in the package for the given file,
14008 @item
14009 otherwise, the value of @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")},
14010 if it is specified in the package.
14011 @end itemize
14012
14013 @noindent
14014 If neither of these attributes is defined in the package, then the package does
14015 not contribute any ^switches^switches^ for the given file.
14016
14017 When @command{gnatmake} is invoked on a file, the ^switches^switches^ comprise
14018 two sets, in the following order: those contributed for the file
14019 by the @code{Builder} package;
14020 and the switches passed on the command line.
14021
14022 When @command{gnatmake} invokes a tool (compiler, binder, linker) on a file,
14023 the ^switches^switches^ passed to the tool comprise three sets,
14024 in the following order:
14025
14026 @enumerate
14027 @item
14028 the applicable ^switches^switches^ contributed for the file
14029 by the @code{Builder} package in the project file supplied on the command line;
14030
14031 @item
14032 those contributed for the file by the package (in the relevant project file --
14033 see below) corresponding to the tool; and
14034
14035 @item
14036 the applicable switches passed on the command line.
14037 @end enumerate
14038
14039 @noindent
14040 The term @emph{applicable ^switches^switches^} reflects the fact that
14041 @command{gnatmake} ^switches^switches^ may or may not be passed to individual
14042 tools, depending on the individual ^switch^switch^.
14043
14044 @command{gnatmake} may invoke the compiler on source files from different
14045 projects. The Project Manager will use the appropriate project file to
14046 determine the @code{Compiler} package for each source file being compiled.
14047 Likewise for the @code{Binder} and @code{Linker} packages.
14048
14049 As an example, consider the following package in a project file:
14050
14051 @smallexample @c projectfile
14052 @group
14053 project Proj1 is
14054 package Compiler is
14055 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14056 use ("^-g^-g^");
14057 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("a.adb")
14058 use ("^-O1^-O1^");
14059 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("b.adb")
14060 use ("^-O2^-O2^",
14061 "^-gnaty^-gnaty^");
14062 end Compiler;
14063 end Proj1;
14064 @end group
14065 @end smallexample
14066
14067 @noindent
14068 If @command{gnatmake} is invoked with this project file, and it needs to
14069 compile, say, the files @file{a.adb}, @file{b.adb}, and @file{c.adb}, then
14070 @file{a.adb} will be compiled with the ^switch^switch^
14071 @option{^-O1^-O1^},
14072 @file{b.adb} with ^switches^switches^
14073 @option{^-O2^-O2^}
14074 and @option{^-gnaty^-gnaty^},
14075 and @file{c.adb} with @option{^-g^-g^}.
14076
14077 The following example illustrates the ordering of the ^switches^switches^
14078 contributed by different packages:
14079
14080 @smallexample @c projectfile
14081 @group
14082 project Proj2 is
14083 package Builder is
14084 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main.adb")
14085 use ("^-g^-g^",
14086 "^-O1^-)1^",
14087 "^-f^-f^");
14088 end Builder;
14089 @end group
14090
14091 @group
14092 package Compiler is
14093 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main.adb")
14094 use ("^-O2^-O2^");
14095 end Compiler;
14096 end Proj2;
14097 @end group
14098 @end smallexample
14099
14100 @noindent
14101 If you issue the command:
14102
14103 @smallexample
14104 gnatmake ^-Pproj2^/PROJECT_FILE=PROJ2^ -O0 main
14105 @end smallexample
14106
14107 @noindent
14108 then the compiler will be invoked on @file{main.adb} with the following
14109 sequence of ^switches^switches^
14110
14111 @smallexample
14112 ^-g -O1 -O2 -O0^-g -O1 -O2 -O0^
14113 @end smallexample
14114
14115 with the last @option{^-O^-O^}
14116 ^switch^switch^ having precedence over the earlier ones;
14117 several other ^switches^switches^
14118 (such as @option{^-c^-c^}) are added implicitly.
14119
14120 The ^switches^switches^
14121 @option{^-g^-g^}
14122 and @option{^-O1^-O1^} are contributed by package
14123 @code{Builder}, @option{^-O2^-O2^} is contributed
14124 by the package @code{Compiler}
14125 and @option{^-O0^-O0^} comes from the command line.
14126
14127 The @option{^-g^-g^}
14128 ^switch^switch^ will also be passed in the invocation of
14129 @command{Gnatlink.}
14130
14131 A final example illustrates switch contributions from packages in different
14132 project files:
14133
14134 @smallexample @c projectfile
14135 @group
14136 project Proj3 is
14137 for Source_Files use ("pack.ads", "pack.adb");
14138 package Compiler is
14139 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14140 use ("^-gnata^-gnata^");
14141 end Compiler;
14142 end Proj3;
14143 @end group
14144
14145 @group
14146 with "Proj3";
14147 project Proj4 is
14148 for Source_Files use ("foo_main.adb", "bar_main.adb");
14149 package Builder is
14150 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("foo_main.adb")
14151 use ("^-s^-s^",
14152 "^-g^-g^");
14153 end Builder;
14154 end Proj4;
14155 @end group
14156
14157 @group
14158 -- Ada source file:
14159 with Pack;
14160 procedure Foo_Main is
14161 @dots{}
14162 end Foo_Main;
14163 @end group
14164 @end smallexample
14165
14166 If the command is
14167 @smallexample
14168 gnatmake ^-PProj4^/PROJECT_FILE=PROJ4^ foo_main.adb -cargs -gnato
14169 @end smallexample
14170
14171 @noindent
14172 then the ^switches^switches^ passed to the compiler for @file{foo_main.adb} are
14173 @option{^-g^-g^} (contributed by the package @code{Proj4.Builder}) and
14174 @option{^-gnato^-gnato^} (passed on the command line).
14175 When the imported package @code{Pack} is compiled, the ^switches^switches^ used
14176 are @option{^-g^-g^} from @code{Proj4.Builder},
14177 @option{^-gnata^-gnata^} (contributed from package @code{Proj3.Compiler},
14178 and @option{^-gnato^-gnato^} from the command line.
14179
14180 @noindent
14181 When using @command{gnatmake} with project files, some ^switches^switches^ or
14182 arguments may be expressed as relative paths. As the working directory where
14183 compilation occurs may change, these relative paths are converted to absolute
14184 paths. For the ^switches^switches^ found in a project file, the relative paths
14185 are relative to the project file directory, for the switches on the command
14186 line, they are relative to the directory where @command{gnatmake} is invoked.
14187 The ^switches^switches^ for which this occurs are:
14188 ^-I^-I^,
14189 ^-A^-A^,
14190 ^-L^-L^,
14191 ^-aO^-aO^,
14192 ^-aL^-aL^,
14193 ^-aI^-aI^, as well as all arguments that are not switches (arguments to
14194 ^switch^switch^
14195 ^-o^-o^, object files specified in package @code{Linker} or after
14196 -largs on the command line). The exception to this rule is the ^switch^switch^
14197 ^--RTS=^--RTS=^ for which a relative path argument is never converted.
14198
14199 @node Specifying Configuration Pragmas
14200 @subsubsection Specifying Configuration Pragmas
14201
14202 When using @command{gnatmake} with project files, if there exists a file
14203 @file{gnat.adc} that contains configuration pragmas, this file will be
14204 ignored.
14205
14206 Configuration pragmas can be defined by means of the following attributes in
14207 project files: @code{Global_Configuration_Pragmas} in package @code{Builder}
14208 and @code{Local_Configuration_Pragmas} in package @code{Compiler}.
14209
14210 Both these attributes are single string attributes. Their values is the path
14211 name of a file containing configuration pragmas. If a path name is relative,
14212 then it is relative to the project directory of the project file where the
14213 attribute is defined.
14214
14215 When compiling a source, the configuration pragmas used are, in order,
14216 those listed in the file designated by attribute
14217 @code{Global_Configuration_Pragmas} in package @code{Builder} of the main
14218 project file, if it is specified, and those listed in the file designated by
14219 attribute @code{Local_Configuration_Pragmas} in package @code{Compiler} of
14220 the project file of the source, if it exists.
14221
14222 @node Project Files and Main Subprograms
14223 @subsubsection Project Files and Main Subprograms
14224
14225 @noindent
14226 When using a project file, you can invoke @command{gnatmake}
14227 with one or several main subprograms, by specifying their source files on the
14228 command line.
14229
14230 @smallexample
14231 gnatmake ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^prj main1 main2 main3
14232 @end smallexample
14233
14234 @noindent
14235 Each of these needs to be a source file of the same project, except
14236 when the switch ^-u^/UNIQUE^ is used.
14237
14238 @noindent
14239 When ^-u^/UNIQUE^ is not used, all the mains need to be sources of the
14240 same project, one of the project in the tree rooted at the project specified
14241 on the command line. The package @code{Builder} of this common project, the
14242 "main project" is the one that is considered by @command{gnatmake}.
14243
14244 @noindent
14245 When ^-u^/UNIQUE^ is used, the specified source files may be in projects
14246 imported directly or indirectly by the project specified on the command line.
14247 Note that if such a source file is not part of the project specified on the
14248 command line, the ^switches^switches^ found in package @code{Builder} of the
14249 project specified on the command line, if any, that are transmitted
14250 to the compiler will still be used, not those found in the project file of
14251 the source file.
14252
14253 @noindent
14254 When using a project file, you can also invoke @command{gnatmake} without
14255 explicitly specifying any main, and the effect depends on whether you have
14256 defined the @code{Main} attribute. This attribute has a string list value,
14257 where each element in the list is the name of a source file (the file
14258 extension is optional) that contains a unit that can be a main subprogram.
14259
14260 If the @code{Main} attribute is defined in a project file as a non-empty
14261 string list and the switch @option{^-u^/UNIQUE^} is not used on the command
14262 line, then invoking @command{gnatmake} with this project file but without any
14263 main on the command line is equivalent to invoking @command{gnatmake} with all
14264 the file names in the @code{Main} attribute on the command line.
14265
14266 Example:
14267 @smallexample @c projectfile
14268 @group
14269 project Prj is
14270 for Main use ("main1", "main2", "main3");
14271 end Prj;
14272 @end group
14273 @end smallexample
14274
14275 @noindent
14276 With this project file, @code{"gnatmake ^-Pprj^/PROJECT_FILE=PRJ^"}
14277 is equivalent to
14278 @code{"gnatmake ^-Pprj^/PROJECT_FILE=PRJ^ main1 main2 main3"}.
14279
14280 When the project attribute @code{Main} is not specified, or is specified
14281 as an empty string list, or when the switch @option{-u} is used on the command
14282 line, then invoking @command{gnatmake} with no main on the command line will
14283 result in all immediate sources of the project file being checked, and
14284 potentially recompiled. Depending on the presence of the switch @option{-u},
14285 sources from other project files on which the immediate sources of the main
14286 project file depend are also checked and potentially recompiled. In other
14287 words, the @option{-u} switch is applied to all of the immediate sources of the
14288 main project file.
14289
14290 When no main is specified on the command line and attribute @code{Main} exists
14291 and includes several mains, or when several mains are specified on the
14292 command line, the default ^switches^switches^ in package @code{Builder} will
14293 be used for all mains, even if there are specific ^switches^switches^
14294 specified for one or several mains.
14295
14296 But the ^switches^switches^ from package @code{Binder} or @code{Linker} will be
14297 the specific ^switches^switches^ for each main, if they are specified.
14298
14299 @node Library Project Files
14300 @subsubsection Library Project Files
14301
14302 @noindent
14303 When @command{gnatmake} is invoked with a main project file that is a library
14304 project file, it is not allowed to specify one or more mains on the command
14305 line.
14306
14307 @noindent
14308 When a library project file is specified, switches ^-b^/ACTION=BIND^ and
14309 ^-l^/ACTION=LINK^ have special meanings.
14310
14311 @itemize @bullet
14312 @item ^-b^/ACTION=BIND^ is only allowed for stand-alone libraries. It indicates
14313 to @command{gnatmake} that @command{gnatbind} should be invoked for the
14314 library.
14315
14316 @item ^-l^/ACTION=LINK^ may be used for all library projects. It indicates
14317 to @command{gnatmake} that the binder generated file should be compiled
14318 (in the case of a stand-alone library) and that the library should be built.
14319
14320 @end itemize
14321
14322 @node The GNAT Driver and Project Files
14323 @subsection The GNAT Driver and Project Files
14324
14325 @noindent
14326 A number of GNAT tools, other than @command{^gnatmake^gnatmake^}
14327 can benefit from project files:
14328 @command{^gnatbind^gnatbind^},
14329 @command{^gnatcheck^gnatcheck^}),
14330 @command{^gnatclean^gnatclean^}),
14331 @command{^gnatelim^gnatelim^},
14332 @command{^gnatfind^gnatfind^},
14333 @command{^gnatlink^gnatlink^},
14334 @command{^gnatls^gnatls^},
14335 @command{^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^},
14336 @command{^gnatpp^gnatpp^},
14337 @command{^gnatstub^gnatstub^},
14338 and @command{^gnatxref^gnatxref^}. However, none of these tools can be invoked
14339 directly with a project file switch (@option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^}).
14340 They must be invoked through the @command{gnat} driver.
14341
14342 The @command{gnat} driver is a wrapper that accepts a number of commands and
14343 calls the corresponding tool. It was designed initially for VMS platforms (to
14344 convert VMS qualifiers to Unix-style switches), but it is now available on all
14345 GNAT platforms.
14346
14347 On non-VMS platforms, the @command{gnat} driver accepts the following commands
14348 (case insensitive):
14349
14350 @itemize @bullet
14351 @item
14352 BIND to invoke @command{^gnatbind^gnatbind^}
14353 @item
14354 CHOP to invoke @command{^gnatchop^gnatchop^}
14355 @item
14356 CLEAN to invoke @command{^gnatclean^gnatclean^}
14357 @item
14358 COMP or COMPILE to invoke the compiler
14359 @item
14360 ELIM to invoke @command{^gnatelim^gnatelim^}
14361 @item
14362 FIND to invoke @command{^gnatfind^gnatfind^}
14363 @item
14364 KR or KRUNCH to invoke @command{^gnatkr^gnatkr^}
14365 @item
14366 LINK to invoke @command{^gnatlink^gnatlink^}
14367 @item
14368 LS or LIST to invoke @command{^gnatls^gnatls^}
14369 @item
14370 MAKE to invoke @command{^gnatmake^gnatmake^}
14371 @item
14372 NAME to invoke @command{^gnatname^gnatname^}
14373 @item
14374 PREP or PREPROCESS to invoke @command{^gnatprep^gnatprep^}
14375 @item
14376 PP or PRETTY to invoke @command{^gnatpp^gnatpp^}
14377 @item
14378 METRIC to invoke @command{^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^}
14379 @item
14380 STUB to invoke @command{^gnatstub^gnatstub^}
14381 @item
14382 XREF to invoke @command{^gnatxref^gnatxref^}
14383 @end itemize
14384
14385 @noindent
14386 (note that the compiler is invoked using the command
14387 @command{^gnatmake -f -u -c^gnatmake -f -u -c^}).
14388
14389 @noindent
14390 On non-VMS platforms, between @command{gnat} and the command, two
14391 special switches may be used:
14392
14393 @itemize @bullet
14394 @item
14395 @command{-v} to display the invocation of the tool.
14396 @item
14397 @command{-dn} to prevent the @command{gnat} driver from removing
14398 the temporary files it has created. These temporary files are
14399 configuration files and temporary file list files.
14400 @end itemize
14401
14402 @noindent
14403 The command may be followed by switches and arguments for the invoked
14404 tool.
14405
14406 @smallexample
14407 gnat bind -C main.ali
14408 gnat ls -a main
14409 gnat chop foo.txt
14410 @end smallexample
14411
14412 @noindent
14413 Switches may also be put in text files, one switch per line, and the text
14414 files may be specified with their path name preceded by '@@'.
14415
14416 @smallexample
14417 gnat bind @@args.txt main.ali
14418 @end smallexample
14419
14420 @noindent
14421 In addition, for commands BIND, COMP or COMPILE, FIND, ELIM, LS or LIST, LINK,
14422 METRIC, PP or PRETTY, STUB and XREF, the project file related switches
14423 (@option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^},
14424 @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} and
14425 @option{^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^x}) may be used in addition to
14426 the switches of the invoking tool.
14427
14428 @noindent
14429 When GNAT PP or GNAT PRETTY is used with a project file, but with no source
14430 specified on the command line, it invokes @command{^gnatpp^gnatpp^} with all
14431 the immediate sources of the specified project file.
14432
14433 @noindent
14434 When GNAT METRIC is used with a project file, but with no source
14435 specified on the command line, it invokes @command{^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^}
14436 with all the immediate sources of the specified project file and with
14437 @option{^-d^/DIRECTORY^} with the parameter pointing to the object directory
14438 of the project.
14439
14440 @noindent
14441 In addition, when GNAT PP, GNAT PRETTY or GNAT METRIC is used with
14442 a project file, no source is specified on the command line and
14443 switch ^-U^/ALL_PROJECTS^ is specified on the command line, then
14444 the underlying tool (^gnatpp^gnatpp^ or
14445 ^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^) is invoked for all sources of all projects,
14446 not only for the immediate sources of the main project.
14447 @ifclear vms
14448 (-U stands for Universal or Union of the project files of the project tree)
14449 @end ifclear
14450
14451 @noindent
14452 For each of the following commands, there is optionally a corresponding
14453 package in the main project.
14454
14455 @itemize @bullet
14456 @item
14457 package @code{Binder} for command BIND (invoking @code{^gnatbind^gnatbind^})
14458
14459 @item
14460 package @code{Check} for command CHECK (invoking
14461 @code{^gnatcheck^gnatcheck^})
14462
14463 @item
14464 package @code{Compiler} for command COMP or COMPILE (invoking the compiler)
14465
14466 @item
14467 package @code{Cross_Reference} for command XREF (invoking
14468 @code{^gnatxref^gnatxref^})
14469
14470 @item
14471 package @code{Eliminate} for command ELIM (invoking
14472 @code{^gnatelim^gnatelim^})
14473
14474 @item
14475 package @code{Finder} for command FIND (invoking @code{^gnatfind^gnatfind^})
14476
14477 @item
14478 package @code{Gnatls} for command LS or LIST (invoking @code{^gnatls^gnatls^})
14479
14480 @item
14481 package @code{Gnatstub} for command STUB
14482 (invoking @code{^gnatstub^gnatstub^})
14483
14484 @item
14485 package @code{Linker} for command LINK (invoking @code{^gnatlink^gnatlink^})
14486
14487 @item
14488 package @code{Metrics} for command METRIC
14489 (invoking @code{^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^})
14490
14491 @item
14492 package @code{Pretty_Printer} for command PP or PRETTY
14493 (invoking @code{^gnatpp^gnatpp^})
14494
14495 @end itemize
14496
14497 @noindent
14498 Package @code{Gnatls} has a unique attribute @code{^Switches^Switches^},
14499 a simple variable with a string list value. It contains ^switches^switches^
14500 for the invocation of @code{^gnatls^gnatls^}.
14501
14502 @smallexample @c projectfile
14503 @group
14504 project Proj1 is
14505 package gnatls is
14506 for ^Switches^Switches^
14507 use ("^-a^-a^",
14508 "^-v^-v^");
14509 end gnatls;
14510 end Proj1;
14511 @end group
14512 @end smallexample
14513
14514 @noindent
14515 All other packages have two attribute @code{^Switches^Switches^} and
14516 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^}.
14517
14518 @noindent
14519 @code{^Switches^Switches^} is an associative array attribute, indexed by the
14520 source file name, that has a string list value: the ^switches^switches^ to be
14521 used when the tool corresponding to the package is invoked for the specific
14522 source file.
14523
14524 @noindent
14525 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^} is an associative array attribute,
14526 indexed by the programming language that has a string list value.
14527 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")} contains the
14528 ^switches^switches^ for the invocation of the tool corresponding
14529 to the package, except if a specific @code{^Switches^Switches^} attribute
14530 is specified for the source file.
14531
14532 @smallexample @c projectfile
14533 @group
14534 project Proj is
14535
14536 for Source_Dirs use ("./**");
14537
14538 package gnatls is
14539 for ^Switches^Switches^ use
14540 ("^-a^-a^",
14541 "^-v^-v^");
14542 end gnatls;
14543 @end group
14544 @group
14545
14546 package Compiler is
14547 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14548 use ("^-gnatv^-gnatv^",
14549 "^-gnatwa^-gnatwa^");
14550 end Binder;
14551 @end group
14552 @group
14553
14554 package Binder is
14555 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14556 use ("^-C^-C^",
14557 "^-e^-e^");
14558 end Binder;
14559 @end group
14560 @group
14561
14562 package Linker is
14563 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14564 use ("^-C^-C^");
14565 for ^Switches^Switches^ ("main.adb")
14566 use ("^-C^-C^",
14567 "^-v^-v^",
14568 "^-v^-v^");
14569 end Linker;
14570 @end group
14571 @group
14572
14573 package Finder is
14574 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14575 use ("^-a^-a^",
14576 "^-f^-f^");
14577 end Finder;
14578 @end group
14579 @group
14580
14581 package Cross_Reference is
14582 for ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14583 use ("^-a^-a^",
14584 "^-f^-f^",
14585 "^-d^-d^",
14586 "^-u^-u^");
14587 end Cross_Reference;
14588 end Proj;
14589 @end group
14590 @end smallexample
14591
14592 @noindent
14593 With the above project file, commands such as
14594
14595 @smallexample
14596 ^gnat comp -Pproj main^GNAT COMP /PROJECT_FILE=PROJ MAIN^
14597 ^gnat ls -Pproj main^GNAT LIST /PROJECT_FILE=PROJ MAIN^
14598 ^gnat xref -Pproj main^GNAT XREF /PROJECT_FILE=PROJ MAIN^
14599 ^gnat bind -Pproj main.ali^GNAT BIND /PROJECT_FILE=PROJ MAIN.ALI^
14600 ^gnat link -Pproj main.ali^GNAT LINK /PROJECT_FILE=PROJ MAIN.ALI^
14601 @end smallexample
14602
14603 @noindent
14604 will set up the environment properly and invoke the tool with the switches
14605 found in the package corresponding to the tool:
14606 @code{^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")} for all tools,
14607 except @code{^Switches^Switches^ ("main.adb")}
14608 for @code{^gnatlink^gnatlink^}.
14609 It is also possible to invoke some of the tools,
14610 @code{^gnatcheck^gnatcheck^}),
14611 @code{^gnatmetric^gnatmetric^}),
14612 and @code{^gnatpp^gnatpp^})
14613 on a set of project units thanks to the combination of the switches
14614 @option{-P}, @option{-U} and possibly the main unit when one is interested
14615 in its closure. For instance,
14616 @smallexample
14617 gnat metric -Pproj
14618 @end smallexample
14619 will compute the metrics for all the immediate units of project
14620 @code{proj}.
14621 @smallexample
14622 gnat metric -Pproj -U
14623 @end smallexample
14624 will compute the metrics for all the units of the closure of projects
14625 rooted at @code{proj}.
14626 @smallexample
14627 gnat metric -Pproj -U main_unit
14628 @end smallexample
14629 will compute the metrics for the closure of units rooted at
14630 @code{main_unit}. This last possibility relies implicitly
14631 on @command{gnatbind}'s option @option{-R}.
14632
14633 @c **********************
14634 @node An Extended Example
14635 @section An Extended Example
14636
14637 @noindent
14638 Suppose that we have two programs, @var{prog1} and @var{prog2},
14639 whose sources are in corresponding directories. We would like
14640 to build them with a single @command{gnatmake} command, and we want to place
14641 their object files into @file{build} subdirectories of the source directories.
14642 Furthermore, we want to have to have two separate subdirectories
14643 in @file{build} -- @file{release} and @file{debug} -- which will contain
14644 the object files compiled with different set of compilation flags.
14645
14646 In other words, we have the following structure:
14647
14648 @smallexample
14649 @group
14650 main
14651 |- prog1
14652 | |- build
14653 | | debug
14654 | | release
14655 |- prog2
14656 |- build
14657 | debug
14658 | release
14659 @end group
14660 @end smallexample
14661
14662 @noindent
14663 Here are the project files that we must place in a directory @file{main}
14664 to maintain this structure:
14665
14666 @enumerate
14667
14668 @item We create a @code{Common} project with a package @code{Compiler} that
14669 specifies the compilation ^switches^switches^:
14670
14671 @smallexample
14672 File "common.gpr":
14673 @group
14674 @b{project} Common @b{is}
14675
14676 @b{for} Source_Dirs @b{use} (); -- No source files
14677 @end group
14678
14679 @group
14680 @b{type} Build_Type @b{is} ("release", "debug");
14681 Build : Build_Type := External ("BUILD", "debug");
14682 @end group
14683 @group
14684 @b{package} Compiler @b{is}
14685 @b{case} Build @b{is}
14686 @b{when} "release" =>
14687 @b{for} ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14688 @b{use} ("^-O2^-O2^");
14689 @b{when} "debug" =>
14690 @b{for} ^Default_Switches^Default_Switches^ ("Ada")
14691 @b{use} ("^-g^-g^");
14692 @b{end case};
14693 @b{end} Compiler;
14694
14695 @b{end} Common;
14696 @end group
14697 @end smallexample
14698
14699 @item We create separate projects for the two programs:
14700
14701 @smallexample
14702 @group
14703 File "prog1.gpr":
14704
14705 @b{with} "common";
14706 @b{project} Prog1 @b{is}
14707
14708 @b{for} Source_Dirs @b{use} ("prog1");
14709 @b{for} Object_Dir @b{use} "prog1/build/" & Common.Build;
14710
14711 @b{package} Compiler @b{renames} Common.Compiler;
14712
14713 @b{end} Prog1;
14714 @end group
14715 @end smallexample
14716
14717 @smallexample
14718 @group
14719 File "prog2.gpr":
14720
14721 @b{with} "common";
14722 @b{project} Prog2 @b{is}
14723
14724 @b{for} Source_Dirs @b{use} ("prog2");
14725 @b{for} Object_Dir @b{use} "prog2/build/" & Common.Build;
14726
14727 @b{package} Compiler @b{renames} Common.Compiler;
14728
14729 @end group
14730 @b{end} Prog2;
14731 @end smallexample
14732
14733 @item We create a wrapping project @code{Main}:
14734
14735 @smallexample
14736 @group
14737 File "main.gpr":
14738
14739 @b{with} "common";
14740 @b{with} "prog1";
14741 @b{with} "prog2";
14742 @b{project} Main @b{is}
14743
14744 @b{package} Compiler @b{renames} Common.Compiler;
14745
14746 @b{end} Main;
14747 @end group
14748 @end smallexample
14749
14750 @item Finally we need to create a dummy procedure that @code{with}s (either
14751 explicitly or implicitly) all the sources of our two programs.
14752
14753 @end enumerate
14754
14755 @noindent
14756 Now we can build the programs using the command
14757
14758 @smallexample
14759 gnatmake ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^main dummy
14760 @end smallexample
14761
14762 @noindent
14763 for the Debug mode, or
14764
14765 @ifclear vms
14766 @smallexample
14767 gnatmake -Pmain -XBUILD=release
14768 @end smallexample
14769 @end ifclear
14770
14771 @ifset vms
14772 @smallexample
14773 GNAT MAKE /PROJECT_FILE=main /EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=BUILD=release
14774 @end smallexample
14775 @end ifset
14776
14777 @noindent
14778 for the Release mode.
14779
14780 @c ********************************
14781 @c * Project File Complete Syntax *
14782 @c ********************************
14783
14784 @node Project File Complete Syntax
14785 @section Project File Complete Syntax
14786
14787 @smallexample
14788 project ::=
14789 context_clause project_declaration
14790
14791 context_clause ::=
14792 @{with_clause@}
14793
14794 with_clause ::=
14795 @b{with} path_name @{ , path_name @} ;
14796
14797 path_name ::=
14798 string_literal
14799
14800 project_declaration ::=
14801 simple_project_declaration | project_extension
14802
14803 simple_project_declaration ::=
14804 @b{project} <project_>simple_name @b{is}
14805 @{declarative_item@}
14806 @b{end} <project_>simple_name;
14807
14808 project_extension ::=
14809 @b{project} <project_>simple_name @b{extends} path_name @b{is}
14810 @{declarative_item@}
14811 @b{end} <project_>simple_name;
14812
14813 declarative_item ::=
14814 package_declaration |
14815 typed_string_declaration |
14816 other_declarative_item
14817
14818 package_declaration ::=
14819 package_spec | package_renaming
14820
14821 package_spec ::=
14822 @b{package} package_identifier @b{is}
14823 @{simple_declarative_item@}
14824 @b{end} package_identifier ;
14825
14826 package_identifier ::=
14827 @code{Naming} | @code{Builder} | @code{Compiler} | @code{Binder} |
14828 @code{Linker} | @code{Finder} | @code{Cross_Reference} |
14829 @code{^gnatls^gnatls^} | @code{IDE} | @code{Pretty_Printer}
14830
14831 package_renaming ::==
14832 @b{package} package_identifier @b{renames}
14833 <project_>simple_name.package_identifier ;
14834
14835 typed_string_declaration ::=
14836 @b{type} <typed_string_>_simple_name @b{is}
14837 ( string_literal @{, string_literal@} );
14838
14839 other_declarative_item ::=
14840 attribute_declaration |
14841 typed_variable_declaration |
14842 variable_declaration |
14843 case_construction
14844
14845 attribute_declaration ::=
14846 full_associative_array_declaration |
14847 @b{for} attribute_designator @b{use} expression ;
14848
14849 full_associative_array_declaration ::=
14850 @b{for} <associative_array_attribute_>simple_name @b{use}
14851 <project_>simple_name [ . <package_>simple_Name ] ' <attribute_>simple_name ;
14852
14853 attribute_designator ::=
14854 <simple_attribute_>simple_name |
14855 <associative_array_attribute_>simple_name ( string_literal )
14856
14857 typed_variable_declaration ::=
14858 <typed_variable_>simple_name : <typed_string_>name := string_expression ;
14859
14860 variable_declaration ::=
14861 <variable_>simple_name := expression;
14862
14863 expression ::=
14864 term @{& term@}
14865
14866 term ::=
14867 literal_string |
14868 string_list |
14869 <variable_>name |
14870 external_value |
14871 attribute_reference
14872
14873 string_literal ::=
14874 (same as Ada)
14875
14876 string_list ::=
14877 ( <string_>expression @{ , <string_>expression @} )
14878
14879 external_value ::=
14880 @b{external} ( string_literal [, string_literal] )
14881
14882 attribute_reference ::=
14883 attribute_prefix ' <simple_attribute_>simple_name [ ( literal_string ) ]
14884
14885 attribute_prefix ::=
14886 @b{project} |
14887 <project_>simple_name | package_identifier |
14888 <project_>simple_name . package_identifier
14889
14890 case_construction ::=
14891 @b{case} <typed_variable_>name @b{is}
14892 @{case_item@}
14893 @b{end case} ;
14894
14895 case_item ::=
14896 @b{when} discrete_choice_list =>
14897 @{case_construction | attribute_declaration@}
14898
14899 discrete_choice_list ::=
14900 string_literal @{| string_literal@} |
14901 @b{others}
14902
14903 name ::=
14904 simple_name @{. simple_name@}
14905
14906 simple_name ::=
14907 identifier (same as Ada)
14908
14909 @end smallexample
14910
14911 @node The Cross-Referencing Tools gnatxref and gnatfind
14912 @chapter The Cross-Referencing Tools @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind}
14913 @findex gnatxref
14914 @findex gnatfind
14915
14916 @noindent
14917 The compiler generates cross-referencing information (unless
14918 you set the @samp{-gnatx} switch), which are saved in the @file{.ali} files.
14919 This information indicates where in the source each entity is declared and
14920 referenced. Note that entities in package Standard are not included, but
14921 entities in all other predefined units are included in the output.
14922
14923 Before using any of these two tools, you need to compile successfully your
14924 application, so that GNAT gets a chance to generate the cross-referencing
14925 information.
14926
14927 The two tools @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind} take advantage of this
14928 information to provide the user with the capability to easily locate the
14929 declaration and references to an entity. These tools are quite similar,
14930 the difference being that @code{gnatfind} is intended for locating
14931 definitions and/or references to a specified entity or entities, whereas
14932 @code{gnatxref} is oriented to generating a full report of all
14933 cross-references.
14934
14935 To use these tools, you must not compile your application using the
14936 @option{-gnatx} switch on the @command{gnatmake} command line
14937 (@pxref{The GNAT Make Program gnatmake}). Otherwise, cross-referencing
14938 information will not be generated.
14939
14940 Note: to invoke @code{gnatxref} or @code{gnatfind} with a project file,
14941 use the @code{gnat} driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
14942
14943 @menu
14944 * gnatxref Switches::
14945 * gnatfind Switches::
14946 * Project Files for gnatxref and gnatfind::
14947 * Regular Expressions in gnatfind and gnatxref::
14948 * Examples of gnatxref Usage::
14949 * Examples of gnatfind Usage::
14950 @end menu
14951
14952 @node gnatxref Switches
14953 @section @code{gnatxref} Switches
14954
14955 @noindent
14956 The command invocation for @code{gnatxref} is:
14957 @smallexample
14958 $ gnatxref @ovar{switches} @var{sourcefile1} @r{[}@var{sourcefile2} @dots{}@r{]}
14959 @end smallexample
14960
14961 @noindent
14962 where
14963
14964 @table @var
14965 @item sourcefile1
14966 @itemx sourcefile2
14967 identifies the source files for which a report is to be generated. The
14968 ``with''ed units will be processed too. You must provide at least one file.
14969
14970 These file names are considered to be regular expressions, so for instance
14971 specifying @file{source*.adb} is the same as giving every file in the current
14972 directory whose name starts with @file{source} and whose extension is
14973 @file{adb}.
14974
14975 You shouldn't specify any directory name, just base names. @command{gnatxref}
14976 and @command{gnatfind} will be able to locate these files by themselves using
14977 the source path. If you specify directories, no result is produced.
14978
14979 @end table
14980
14981 @noindent
14982 The switches can be:
14983 @table @option
14984 @c !sort!
14985 @item --version
14986 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatxref}
14987 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
14988
14989 @item --help
14990 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatxref}
14991 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
14992 all other options.
14993
14994 @item ^-a^/ALL_FILES^
14995 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} (@command{gnatxref})
14996 If this switch is present, @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref} will parse
14997 the read-only files found in the library search path. Otherwise, these files
14998 will be ignored. This option can be used to protect Gnat sources or your own
14999 libraries from being parsed, thus making @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}
15000 much faster, and their output much smaller. Read-only here refers to access
15001 or permissions status in the file system for the current user.
15002
15003 @item -aIDIR
15004 @cindex @option{-aIDIR} (@command{gnatxref})
15005 When looking for source files also look in directory DIR. The order in which
15006 source file search is undertaken is the same as for @command{gnatmake}.
15007
15008 @item -aODIR
15009 @cindex @option{-aODIR} (@command{gnatxref})
15010 When searching for library and object files, look in directory
15011 DIR. The order in which library files are searched is the same as for
15012 @command{gnatmake}.
15013
15014 @item -nostdinc
15015 @cindex @option{-nostdinc} (@command{gnatxref})
15016 Do not look for sources in the system default directory.
15017
15018 @item -nostdlib
15019 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} (@command{gnatxref})
15020 Do not look for library files in the system default directory.
15021
15022 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
15023 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@command{gnatxref})
15024 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. Same meaning as the
15025 equivalent @command{gnatmake} flag (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
15026
15027 @item ^-d^/DERIVED_TYPES^
15028 @cindex @option{^-d^/DERIVED_TYPES^} (@command{gnatxref})
15029 If this switch is set @code{gnatxref} will output the parent type
15030 reference for each matching derived types.
15031
15032 @item ^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^
15033 @cindex @option{^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^} (@command{gnatxref})
15034 If this switch is set, the output file names will be preceded by their
15035 directory (if the file was found in the search path). If this switch is
15036 not set, the directory will not be printed.
15037
15038 @item ^-g^/IGNORE_LOCALS^
15039 @cindex @option{^-g^/IGNORE_LOCALS^} (@command{gnatxref})
15040 If this switch is set, information is output only for library-level
15041 entities, ignoring local entities. The use of this switch may accelerate
15042 @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}.
15043
15044 @item -IDIR
15045 @cindex @option{-IDIR} (@command{gnatxref})
15046 Equivalent to @samp{-aODIR -aIDIR}.
15047
15048 @item -pFILE
15049 @cindex @option{-pFILE} (@command{gnatxref})
15050 Specify a project file to use @xref{Project Files}.
15051 If you need to use the @file{.gpr}
15052 project files, you should use gnatxref through the GNAT driver
15053 (@command{gnat xref -Pproject}).
15054
15055 By default, @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind} will try to locate a
15056 project file in the current directory.
15057
15058 If a project file is either specified or found by the tools, then the content
15059 of the source directory and object directory lines are added as if they
15060 had been specified respectively by @samp{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^}
15061 and @samp{^-aO^OBJECT_SEARCH^}.
15062 @item ^-u^/UNUSED^
15063 Output only unused symbols. This may be really useful if you give your
15064 main compilation unit on the command line, as @code{gnatxref} will then
15065 display every unused entity and 'with'ed package.
15066
15067 @ifclear vms
15068 @item -v
15069 Instead of producing the default output, @code{gnatxref} will generate a
15070 @file{tags} file that can be used by vi. For examples how to use this
15071 feature, see @ref{Examples of gnatxref Usage}. The tags file is output
15072 to the standard output, thus you will have to redirect it to a file.
15073 @end ifclear
15074
15075 @end table
15076
15077 @noindent
15078 All these switches may be in any order on the command line, and may even
15079 appear after the file names. They need not be separated by spaces, thus
15080 you can say @samp{gnatxref ^-ag^/ALL_FILES/IGNORE_LOCALS^} instead of
15081 @samp{gnatxref ^-a -g^/ALL_FILES /IGNORE_LOCALS^}.
15082
15083 @node gnatfind Switches
15084 @section @code{gnatfind} Switches
15085
15086 @noindent
15087 The command line for @code{gnatfind} is:
15088
15089 @smallexample
15090 $ gnatfind @ovar{switches} @var{pattern}@r{[}:@var{sourcefile}@r{[}:@var{line}@r{[}:@var{column}@r{]]]}
15091 @r{[}@var{file1} @var{file2} @dots{}]
15092 @end smallexample
15093
15094 @noindent
15095 where
15096
15097 @table @var
15098 @item pattern
15099 An entity will be output only if it matches the regular expression found
15100 in @var{pattern}, see @ref{Regular Expressions in gnatfind and gnatxref}.
15101
15102 Omitting the pattern is equivalent to specifying @samp{*}, which
15103 will match any entity. Note that if you do not provide a pattern, you
15104 have to provide both a sourcefile and a line.
15105
15106 Entity names are given in Latin-1, with uppercase/lowercase equivalence
15107 for matching purposes. At the current time there is no support for
15108 8-bit codes other than Latin-1, or for wide characters in identifiers.
15109
15110 @item sourcefile
15111 @code{gnatfind} will look for references, bodies or declarations
15112 of symbols referenced in @file{@var{sourcefile}}, at line @var{line}
15113 and column @var{column}. See @ref{Examples of gnatfind Usage}
15114 for syntax examples.
15115
15116 @item line
15117 is a decimal integer identifying the line number containing
15118 the reference to the entity (or entities) to be located.
15119
15120 @item column
15121 is a decimal integer identifying the exact location on the
15122 line of the first character of the identifier for the
15123 entity reference. Columns are numbered from 1.
15124
15125 @item file1 file2 @dots{}
15126 The search will be restricted to these source files. If none are given, then
15127 the search will be done for every library file in the search path.
15128 These file must appear only after the pattern or sourcefile.
15129
15130 These file names are considered to be regular expressions, so for instance
15131 specifying @file{source*.adb} is the same as giving every file in the current
15132 directory whose name starts with @file{source} and whose extension is
15133 @file{adb}.
15134
15135 The location of the spec of the entity will always be displayed, even if it
15136 isn't in one of @file{@var{file1}}, @file{@var{file2}},@enddots{} The
15137 occurrences of the entity in the separate units of the ones given on the
15138 command line will also be displayed.
15139
15140 Note that if you specify at least one file in this part, @code{gnatfind} may
15141 sometimes not be able to find the body of the subprograms.
15142
15143 @end table
15144
15145 @noindent
15146 At least one of 'sourcefile' or 'pattern' has to be present on
15147 the command line.
15148
15149 The following switches are available:
15150 @table @option
15151 @c !sort!
15152
15153 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatfind}
15154 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
15155
15156 @item --help
15157 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatfind}
15158 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
15159 all other options.
15160
15161 @item ^-a^/ALL_FILES^
15162 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^} (@command{gnatfind})
15163 If this switch is present, @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref} will parse
15164 the read-only files found in the library search path. Otherwise, these files
15165 will be ignored. This option can be used to protect Gnat sources or your own
15166 libraries from being parsed, thus making @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}
15167 much faster, and their output much smaller. Read-only here refers to access
15168 or permission status in the file system for the current user.
15169
15170 @item -aIDIR
15171 @cindex @option{-aIDIR} (@command{gnatfind})
15172 When looking for source files also look in directory DIR. The order in which
15173 source file search is undertaken is the same as for @command{gnatmake}.
15174
15175 @item -aODIR
15176 @cindex @option{-aODIR} (@command{gnatfind})
15177 When searching for library and object files, look in directory
15178 DIR. The order in which library files are searched is the same as for
15179 @command{gnatmake}.
15180
15181 @item -nostdinc
15182 @cindex @option{-nostdinc} (@command{gnatfind})
15183 Do not look for sources in the system default directory.
15184
15185 @item -nostdlib
15186 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} (@command{gnatfind})
15187 Do not look for library files in the system default directory.
15188
15189 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
15190 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@command{gnatfind})
15191 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. Same meaning as the
15192 equivalent @command{gnatmake} flag (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
15193
15194 @item ^-d^/DERIVED_TYPE_INFORMATION^
15195 @cindex @option{^-d^/DERIVED_TYPE_INFORMATION^} (@code{gnatfind})
15196 If this switch is set, then @code{gnatfind} will output the parent type
15197 reference for each matching derived types.
15198
15199 @item ^-e^/EXPRESSIONS^
15200 @cindex @option{^-e^/EXPRESSIONS^} (@command{gnatfind})
15201 By default, @code{gnatfind} accept the simple regular expression set for
15202 @samp{pattern}. If this switch is set, then the pattern will be
15203 considered as full Unix-style regular expression.
15204
15205 @item ^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^
15206 @cindex @option{^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^} (@command{gnatfind})
15207 If this switch is set, the output file names will be preceded by their
15208 directory (if the file was found in the search path). If this switch is
15209 not set, the directory will not be printed.
15210
15211 @item ^-g^/IGNORE_LOCALS^
15212 @cindex @option{^-g^/IGNORE_LOCALS^} (@command{gnatfind})
15213 If this switch is set, information is output only for library-level
15214 entities, ignoring local entities. The use of this switch may accelerate
15215 @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}.
15216
15217 @item -IDIR
15218 @cindex @option{-IDIR} (@command{gnatfind})
15219 Equivalent to @samp{-aODIR -aIDIR}.
15220
15221 @item -pFILE
15222 @cindex @option{-pFILE} (@command{gnatfind})
15223 Specify a project file (@pxref{Project Files}) to use.
15224 By default, @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind} will try to locate a
15225 project file in the current directory.
15226
15227 If a project file is either specified or found by the tools, then the content
15228 of the source directory and object directory lines are added as if they
15229 had been specified respectively by @samp{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} and
15230 @samp{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^}.
15231
15232 @item ^-r^/REFERENCES^
15233 @cindex @option{^-r^/REFERENCES^} (@command{gnatfind})
15234 By default, @code{gnatfind} will output only the information about the
15235 declaration, body or type completion of the entities. If this switch is
15236 set, the @code{gnatfind} will locate every reference to the entities in
15237 the files specified on the command line (or in every file in the search
15238 path if no file is given on the command line).
15239
15240 @item ^-s^/PRINT_LINES^
15241 @cindex @option{^-s^/PRINT_LINES^} (@command{gnatfind})
15242 If this switch is set, then @code{gnatfind} will output the content
15243 of the Ada source file lines were the entity was found.
15244
15245 @item ^-t^/TYPE_HIERARCHY^
15246 @cindex @option{^-t^/TYPE_HIERARCHY^} (@command{gnatfind})
15247 If this switch is set, then @code{gnatfind} will output the type hierarchy for
15248 the specified type. It act like -d option but recursively from parent
15249 type to parent type. When this switch is set it is not possible to
15250 specify more than one file.
15251
15252 @end table
15253
15254 @noindent
15255 All these switches may be in any order on the command line, and may even
15256 appear after the file names. They need not be separated by spaces, thus
15257 you can say @samp{gnatxref ^-ag^/ALL_FILES/IGNORE_LOCALS^} instead of
15258 @samp{gnatxref ^-a -g^/ALL_FILES /IGNORE_LOCALS^}.
15259
15260 As stated previously, gnatfind will search in every directory in the
15261 search path. You can force it to look only in the current directory if
15262 you specify @code{*} at the end of the command line.
15263
15264 @node Project Files for gnatxref and gnatfind
15265 @section Project Files for @command{gnatxref} and @command{gnatfind}
15266
15267 @noindent
15268 Project files allow a programmer to specify how to compile its
15269 application, where to find sources, etc. These files are used
15270 @ifclear vms
15271 primarily by GPS, but they can also be used
15272 @end ifclear
15273 by the two tools
15274 @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind}.
15275
15276 A project file name must end with @file{.gpr}. If a single one is
15277 present in the current directory, then @code{gnatxref} and @code{gnatfind} will
15278 extract the information from it. If multiple project files are found, none of
15279 them is read, and you have to use the @samp{-p} switch to specify the one
15280 you want to use.
15281
15282 The following lines can be included, even though most of them have default
15283 values which can be used in most cases.
15284 The lines can be entered in any order in the file.
15285 Except for @file{src_dir} and @file{obj_dir}, you can only have one instance of
15286 each line. If you have multiple instances, only the last one is taken into
15287 account.
15288
15289 @table @code
15290 @item src_dir=DIR
15291 [default: @code{"^./^[]^"}]
15292 specifies a directory where to look for source files. Multiple @code{src_dir}
15293 lines can be specified and they will be searched in the order they
15294 are specified.
15295
15296 @item obj_dir=DIR
15297 [default: @code{"^./^[]^"}]
15298 specifies a directory where to look for object and library files. Multiple
15299 @code{obj_dir} lines can be specified, and they will be searched in the order
15300 they are specified
15301
15302 @item comp_opt=SWITCHES
15303 [default: @code{""}]
15304 creates a variable which can be referred to subsequently by using
15305 the @code{$@{comp_opt@}} notation. This is intended to store the default
15306 switches given to @command{gnatmake} and @command{gcc}.
15307
15308 @item bind_opt=SWITCHES
15309 [default: @code{""}]
15310 creates a variable which can be referred to subsequently by using
15311 the @samp{$@{bind_opt@}} notation. This is intended to store the default
15312 switches given to @command{gnatbind}.
15313
15314 @item link_opt=SWITCHES
15315 [default: @code{""}]
15316 creates a variable which can be referred to subsequently by using
15317 the @samp{$@{link_opt@}} notation. This is intended to store the default
15318 switches given to @command{gnatlink}.
15319
15320 @item main=EXECUTABLE
15321 [default: @code{""}]
15322 specifies the name of the executable for the application. This variable can
15323 be referred to in the following lines by using the @samp{$@{main@}} notation.
15324
15325 @ifset vms
15326 @item comp_cmd=COMMAND
15327 [default: @code{"GNAT COMPILE /SEARCH=$@{src_dir@} /DEBUG /TRY_SEMANTICS"}]
15328 @end ifset
15329 @ifclear vms
15330 @item comp_cmd=COMMAND
15331 [default: @code{"gcc -c -I$@{src_dir@} -g -gnatq"}]
15332 @end ifclear
15333 specifies the command used to compile a single file in the application.
15334
15335 @ifset vms
15336 @item make_cmd=COMMAND
15337 [default: @code{"GNAT MAKE $@{main@}
15338 /SOURCE_SEARCH=$@{src_dir@} /OBJECT_SEARCH=$@{obj_dir@}
15339 /DEBUG /TRY_SEMANTICS /COMPILER_QUALIFIERS $@{comp_opt@}
15340 /BINDER_QUALIFIERS $@{bind_opt@} /LINKER_QUALIFIERS $@{link_opt@}"}]
15341 @end ifset
15342 @ifclear vms
15343 @item make_cmd=COMMAND
15344 [default: @code{"gnatmake $@{main@} -aI$@{src_dir@}
15345 -aO$@{obj_dir@} -g -gnatq -cargs $@{comp_opt@}
15346 -bargs $@{bind_opt@} -largs $@{link_opt@}"}]
15347 @end ifclear
15348 specifies the command used to recompile the whole application.
15349
15350 @item run_cmd=COMMAND
15351 [default: @code{"$@{main@}"}]
15352 specifies the command used to run the application.
15353
15354 @item debug_cmd=COMMAND
15355 [default: @code{"gdb $@{main@}"}]
15356 specifies the command used to debug the application
15357
15358 @end table
15359
15360 @noindent
15361 @command{gnatxref} and @command{gnatfind} only take into account the
15362 @code{src_dir} and @code{obj_dir} lines, and ignore the others.
15363
15364 @node Regular Expressions in gnatfind and gnatxref
15365 @section Regular Expressions in @code{gnatfind} and @code{gnatxref}
15366
15367 @noindent
15368 As specified in the section about @command{gnatfind}, the pattern can be a
15369 regular expression. Actually, there are to set of regular expressions
15370 which are recognized by the program:
15371
15372 @table @code
15373 @item globbing patterns
15374 These are the most usual regular expression. They are the same that you
15375 generally used in a Unix shell command line, or in a DOS session.
15376
15377 Here is a more formal grammar:
15378 @smallexample
15379 @group
15380 @iftex
15381 @leftskip=.5cm
15382 @end iftex
15383 regexp ::= term
15384 term ::= elmt -- matches elmt
15385 term ::= elmt elmt -- concatenation (elmt then elmt)
15386 term ::= * -- any string of 0 or more characters
15387 term ::= ? -- matches any character
15388 term ::= [char @{char@}] -- matches any character listed
15389 term ::= [char - char] -- matches any character in range
15390 @end group
15391 @end smallexample
15392
15393 @item full regular expression
15394 The second set of regular expressions is much more powerful. This is the
15395 type of regular expressions recognized by utilities such a @file{grep}.
15396
15397 The following is the form of a regular expression, expressed in Ada
15398 reference manual style BNF is as follows
15399
15400 @smallexample
15401 @iftex
15402 @leftskip=.5cm
15403 @end iftex
15404 @group
15405 regexp ::= term @{| term@} -- alternation (term or term @dots{})
15406
15407 term ::= item @{item@} -- concatenation (item then item)
15408
15409 item ::= elmt -- match elmt
15410 item ::= elmt * -- zero or more elmt's
15411 item ::= elmt + -- one or more elmt's
15412 item ::= elmt ? -- matches elmt or nothing
15413 @end group
15414 @group
15415 elmt ::= nschar -- matches given character
15416 elmt ::= [nschar @{nschar@}] -- matches any character listed
15417 elmt ::= [^^^ nschar @{nschar@}] -- matches any character not listed
15418 elmt ::= [char - char] -- matches chars in given range
15419 elmt ::= \ char -- matches given character
15420 elmt ::= . -- matches any single character
15421 elmt ::= ( regexp ) -- parens used for grouping
15422
15423 char ::= any character, including special characters
15424 nschar ::= any character except ()[].*+?^^^
15425 @end group
15426 @end smallexample
15427
15428 Following are a few examples:
15429
15430 @table @samp
15431 @item abcde|fghi
15432 will match any of the two strings @samp{abcde} and @samp{fghi},
15433
15434 @item abc*d
15435 will match any string like @samp{abd}, @samp{abcd}, @samp{abccd},
15436 @samp{abcccd}, and so on,
15437
15438 @item [a-z]+
15439 will match any string which has only lowercase characters in it (and at
15440 least one character.
15441
15442 @end table
15443 @end table
15444
15445 @node Examples of gnatxref Usage
15446 @section Examples of @code{gnatxref} Usage
15447
15448 @subsection General Usage
15449
15450 @noindent
15451 For the following examples, we will consider the following units:
15452
15453 @smallexample @c ada
15454 @group
15455 @cartouche
15456 main.ads:
15457 1: with Bar;
15458 2: package Main is
15459 3: procedure Foo (B : in Integer);
15460 4: C : Integer;
15461 5: private
15462 6: D : Integer;
15463 7: end Main;
15464
15465 main.adb:
15466 1: package body Main is
15467 2: procedure Foo (B : in Integer) is
15468 3: begin
15469 4: C := B;
15470 5: D := B;
15471 6: Bar.Print (B);
15472 7: Bar.Print (C);
15473 8: end Foo;
15474 9: end Main;
15475
15476 bar.ads:
15477 1: package Bar is
15478 2: procedure Print (B : Integer);
15479 3: end bar;
15480 @end cartouche
15481 @end group
15482 @end smallexample
15483
15484 @table @code
15485
15486 @noindent
15487 The first thing to do is to recompile your application (for instance, in
15488 that case just by doing a @samp{gnatmake main}, so that GNAT generates
15489 the cross-referencing information.
15490 You can then issue any of the following commands:
15491
15492 @item gnatxref main.adb
15493 @code{gnatxref} generates cross-reference information for main.adb
15494 and every unit 'with'ed by main.adb.
15495
15496 The output would be:
15497 @smallexample
15498 @iftex
15499 @leftskip=0cm
15500 @end iftex
15501 B Type: Integer
15502 Decl: bar.ads 2:22
15503 B Type: Integer
15504 Decl: main.ads 3:20
15505 Body: main.adb 2:20
15506 Ref: main.adb 4:13 5:13 6:19
15507 Bar Type: Unit
15508 Decl: bar.ads 1:9
15509 Ref: main.adb 6:8 7:8
15510 main.ads 1:6
15511 C Type: Integer
15512 Decl: main.ads 4:5
15513 Modi: main.adb 4:8
15514 Ref: main.adb 7:19
15515 D Type: Integer
15516 Decl: main.ads 6:5
15517 Modi: main.adb 5:8
15518 Foo Type: Unit
15519 Decl: main.ads 3:15
15520 Body: main.adb 2:15
15521 Main Type: Unit
15522 Decl: main.ads 2:9
15523 Body: main.adb 1:14
15524 Print Type: Unit
15525 Decl: bar.ads 2:15
15526 Ref: main.adb 6:12 7:12
15527 @end smallexample
15528
15529 @noindent
15530 that is the entity @code{Main} is declared in main.ads, line 2, column 9,
15531 its body is in main.adb, line 1, column 14 and is not referenced any where.
15532
15533 The entity @code{Print} is declared in bar.ads, line 2, column 15 and it
15534 it referenced in main.adb, line 6 column 12 and line 7 column 12.
15535
15536 @item gnatxref package1.adb package2.ads
15537 @code{gnatxref} will generates cross-reference information for
15538 package1.adb, package2.ads and any other package 'with'ed by any
15539 of these.
15540
15541 @end table
15542
15543 @ifclear vms
15544 @subsection Using gnatxref with vi
15545
15546 @code{gnatxref} can generate a tags file output, which can be used
15547 directly from @command{vi}. Note that the standard version of @command{vi}
15548 will not work properly with overloaded symbols. Consider using another
15549 free implementation of @command{vi}, such as @command{vim}.
15550
15551 @smallexample
15552 $ gnatxref -v gnatfind.adb > tags
15553 @end smallexample
15554
15555 @noindent
15556 will generate the tags file for @code{gnatfind} itself (if the sources
15557 are in the search path!).
15558
15559 From @command{vi}, you can then use the command @samp{:tag @var{entity}}
15560 (replacing @var{entity} by whatever you are looking for), and vi will
15561 display a new file with the corresponding declaration of entity.
15562 @end ifclear
15563
15564 @node Examples of gnatfind Usage
15565 @section Examples of @code{gnatfind} Usage
15566
15567 @table @code
15568
15569 @item gnatfind ^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^ xyz:main.adb
15570 Find declarations for all entities xyz referenced at least once in
15571 main.adb. The references are search in every library file in the search
15572 path.
15573
15574 The directories will be printed as well (as the @samp{^-f^/FULL_PATHNAME^}
15575 switch is set)
15576
15577 The output will look like:
15578 @smallexample
15579 ^directory/^[directory]^main.ads:106:14: xyz <= declaration
15580 ^directory/^[directory]^main.adb:24:10: xyz <= body
15581 ^directory/^[directory]^foo.ads:45:23: xyz <= declaration
15582 @end smallexample
15583
15584 @noindent
15585 that is to say, one of the entities xyz found in main.adb is declared at
15586 line 12 of main.ads (and its body is in main.adb), and another one is
15587 declared at line 45 of foo.ads
15588
15589 @item gnatfind ^-fs^/FULL_PATHNAME/SOURCE_LINE^ xyz:main.adb
15590 This is the same command as the previous one, instead @code{gnatfind} will
15591 display the content of the Ada source file lines.
15592
15593 The output will look like:
15594
15595 @smallexample
15596 ^directory/^[directory]^main.ads:106:14: xyz <= declaration
15597 procedure xyz;
15598 ^directory/^[directory]^main.adb:24:10: xyz <= body
15599 procedure xyz is
15600 ^directory/^[directory]^foo.ads:45:23: xyz <= declaration
15601 xyz : Integer;
15602 @end smallexample
15603
15604 @noindent
15605 This can make it easier to find exactly the location your are looking
15606 for.
15607
15608 @item gnatfind ^-r^/REFERENCES^ "*x*":main.ads:123 foo.adb
15609 Find references to all entities containing an x that are
15610 referenced on line 123 of main.ads.
15611 The references will be searched only in main.ads and foo.adb.
15612
15613 @item gnatfind main.ads:123
15614 Find declarations and bodies for all entities that are referenced on
15615 line 123 of main.ads.
15616
15617 This is the same as @code{gnatfind "*":main.adb:123}.
15618
15619 @item gnatfind ^mydir/^[mydir]^main.adb:123:45
15620 Find the declaration for the entity referenced at column 45 in
15621 line 123 of file main.adb in directory mydir. Note that it
15622 is usual to omit the identifier name when the column is given,
15623 since the column position identifies a unique reference.
15624
15625 The column has to be the beginning of the identifier, and should not
15626 point to any character in the middle of the identifier.
15627
15628 @end table
15629
15630 @c *********************************
15631 @node The GNAT Pretty-Printer gnatpp
15632 @chapter The GNAT Pretty-Printer @command{gnatpp}
15633 @findex gnatpp
15634 @cindex Pretty-Printer
15635
15636 @noindent
15637 ^The @command{gnatpp} tool^GNAT PRETTY^ is an ASIS-based utility
15638 for source reformatting / pretty-printing.
15639 It takes an Ada source file as input and generates a reformatted
15640 version as output.
15641 You can specify various style directives via switches; e.g.,
15642 identifier case conventions, rules of indentation, and comment layout.
15643
15644 To produce a reformatted file, @command{gnatpp} generates and uses the ASIS
15645 tree for the input source and thus requires the input to be syntactically and
15646 semantically legal.
15647 If this condition is not met, @command{gnatpp} will terminate with an
15648 error message; no output file will be generated.
15649
15650 If the source files presented to @command{gnatpp} contain
15651 preprocessing directives, then the output file will
15652 correspond to the generated source after all
15653 preprocessing is carried out. There is no way
15654 using @command{gnatpp} to obtain pretty printed files that
15655 include the preprocessing directives.
15656
15657 If the compilation unit
15658 contained in the input source depends semantically upon units located
15659 outside the current directory, you have to provide the source search path
15660 when invoking @command{gnatpp}, if these units are contained in files with
15661 names that do not follow the GNAT file naming rules, you have to provide
15662 the configuration file describing the corresponding naming scheme;
15663 see the description of the @command{gnatpp}
15664 switches below. Another possibility is to use a project file and to
15665 call @command{gnatpp} through the @command{gnat} driver
15666
15667 The @command{gnatpp} command has the form
15668
15669 @smallexample
15670 $ gnatpp @ovar{switches} @var{filename}
15671 @end smallexample
15672
15673 @noindent
15674 where
15675 @itemize @bullet
15676 @item
15677 @var{switches} is an optional sequence of switches defining such properties as
15678 the formatting rules, the source search path, and the destination for the
15679 output source file
15680
15681 @item
15682 @var{filename} is the name (including the extension) of the source file to
15683 reformat; ``wildcards'' or several file names on the same gnatpp command are
15684 allowed. The file name may contain path information; it does not have to
15685 follow the GNAT file naming rules
15686 @end itemize
15687
15688 @menu
15689 * Switches for gnatpp::
15690 * Formatting Rules::
15691 @end menu
15692
15693 @node Switches for gnatpp
15694 @section Switches for @command{gnatpp}
15695
15696 @noindent
15697 The following subsections describe the various switches accepted by
15698 @command{gnatpp}, organized by category.
15699
15700 @ifclear vms
15701 You specify a switch by supplying a name and generally also a value.
15702 In many cases the values for a switch with a given name are incompatible with
15703 each other
15704 (for example the switch that controls the casing of a reserved word may have
15705 exactly one value: upper case, lower case, or
15706 mixed case) and thus exactly one such switch can be in effect for an
15707 invocation of @command{gnatpp}.
15708 If more than one is supplied, the last one is used.
15709 However, some values for the same switch are mutually compatible.
15710 You may supply several such switches to @command{gnatpp}, but then
15711 each must be specified in full, with both the name and the value.
15712 Abbreviated forms (the name appearing once, followed by each value) are
15713 not permitted.
15714 For example, to set
15715 the alignment of the assignment delimiter both in declarations and in
15716 assignment statements, you must write @option{-A2A3}
15717 (or @option{-A2 -A3}), but not @option{-A23}.
15718 @end ifclear
15719
15720 @ifset vms
15721 In many cases the set of options for a given qualifier are incompatible with
15722 each other (for example the qualifier that controls the casing of a reserved
15723 word may have exactly one option, which specifies either upper case, lower
15724 case, or mixed case), and thus exactly one such option can be in effect for
15725 an invocation of @command{gnatpp}.
15726 If more than one is supplied, the last one is used.
15727 However, some qualifiers have options that are mutually compatible,
15728 and then you may then supply several such options when invoking
15729 @command{gnatpp}.
15730 @end ifset
15731
15732 In most cases, it is obvious whether or not the
15733 ^values for a switch with a given name^options for a given qualifier^
15734 are compatible with each other.
15735 When the semantics might not be evident, the summaries below explicitly
15736 indicate the effect.
15737
15738 @menu
15739 * Alignment Control::
15740 * Casing Control::
15741 * Construct Layout Control::
15742 * General Text Layout Control::
15743 * Other Formatting Options::
15744 * Setting the Source Search Path::
15745 * Output File Control::
15746 * Other gnatpp Switches::
15747 @end menu
15748
15749 @node Alignment Control
15750 @subsection Alignment Control
15751 @cindex Alignment control in @command{gnatpp}
15752
15753 @noindent
15754 Programs can be easier to read if certain constructs are vertically aligned.
15755 By default all alignments are set ON.
15756 Through the @option{^-A0^/ALIGN=OFF^} switch you may reset the default to
15757 OFF, and then use one or more of the other
15758 ^@option{-A@var{n}} switches^@option{/ALIGN} options^
15759 to activate alignment for specific constructs.
15760
15761 @table @option
15762 @cindex @option{^-A@var{n}^/ALIGN^} (@command{gnatpp})
15763
15764 @ifset vms
15765 @item /ALIGN=ON
15766 Set all alignments to ON
15767 @end ifset
15768
15769 @item ^-A0^/ALIGN=OFF^
15770 Set all alignments to OFF
15771
15772 @item ^-A1^/ALIGN=COLONS^
15773 Align @code{:} in declarations
15774
15775 @item ^-A2^/ALIGN=DECLARATIONS^
15776 Align @code{:=} in initializations in declarations
15777
15778 @item ^-A3^/ALIGN=STATEMENTS^
15779 Align @code{:=} in assignment statements
15780
15781 @item ^-A4^/ALIGN=ARROWS^
15782 Align @code{=>} in associations
15783
15784 @item ^-A5^/ALIGN=COMPONENT_CLAUSES^
15785 Align @code{at} keywords in the component clauses in record
15786 representation clauses
15787 @end table
15788
15789 @noindent
15790 The @option{^-A^/ALIGN^} switches are mutually compatible; any combination
15791 is allowed.
15792
15793 @node Casing Control
15794 @subsection Casing Control
15795 @cindex Casing control in @command{gnatpp}
15796
15797 @noindent
15798 @command{gnatpp} allows you to specify the casing for reserved words,
15799 pragma names, attribute designators and identifiers.
15800 For identifiers you may define a
15801 general rule for name casing but also override this rule
15802 via a set of dictionary files.
15803
15804 Three types of casing are supported: lower case, upper case, and mixed case.
15805 Lower and upper case are self-explanatory (but since some letters in
15806 Latin1 and other GNAT-supported character sets
15807 exist only in lower-case form, an upper case conversion will have no
15808 effect on them.)
15809 ``Mixed case'' means that the first letter, and also each letter immediately
15810 following an underscore, are converted to their uppercase forms;
15811 all the other letters are converted to their lowercase forms.
15812
15813 @table @option
15814 @cindex @option{^-a@var{x}^/ATTRIBUTE^} (@command{gnatpp})
15815 @item ^-aL^/ATTRIBUTE_CASING=LOWER_CASE^
15816 Attribute designators are lower case
15817
15818 @item ^-aU^/ATTRIBUTE_CASING=UPPER_CASE^
15819 Attribute designators are upper case
15820
15821 @item ^-aM^/ATTRIBUTE_CASING=MIXED_CASE^
15822 Attribute designators are mixed case (this is the default)
15823
15824 @cindex @option{^-k@var{x}^/KEYWORD_CASING^} (@command{gnatpp})
15825 @item ^-kL^/KEYWORD_CASING=LOWER_CASE^
15826 Keywords (technically, these are known in Ada as @emph{reserved words}) are
15827 lower case (this is the default)
15828
15829 @item ^-kU^/KEYWORD_CASING=UPPER_CASE^
15830 Keywords are upper case
15831
15832 @cindex @option{^-n@var{x}^/NAME_CASING^} (@command{gnatpp})
15833 @item ^-nD^/NAME_CASING=AS_DECLARED^
15834 Name casing for defining occurrences are as they appear in the source file
15835 (this is the default)
15836
15837 @item ^-nU^/NAME_CASING=UPPER_CASE^
15838 Names are in upper case
15839
15840 @item ^-nL^/NAME_CASING=LOWER_CASE^
15841 Names are in lower case
15842
15843 @item ^-nM^/NAME_CASING=MIXED_CASE^
15844 Names are in mixed case
15845
15846 @cindex @option{^-p@var{x}^/PRAGMA_CASING^} (@command{gnatpp})
15847 @item ^-pL^/PRAGMA_CASING=LOWER_CASE^
15848 Pragma names are lower case
15849
15850 @item ^-pU^/PRAGMA_CASING=UPPER_CASE^
15851 Pragma names are upper case
15852
15853 @item ^-pM^/PRAGMA_CASING=MIXED_CASE^
15854 Pragma names are mixed case (this is the default)
15855
15856 @item ^-D@var{file}^/DICTIONARY=@var{file}^
15857 @cindex @option{^-D^/DICTIONARY^} (@command{gnatpp})
15858 Use @var{file} as a @emph{dictionary file} that defines
15859 the casing for a set of specified names,
15860 thereby overriding the effect on these names by
15861 any explicit or implicit
15862 ^-n^/NAME_CASING^ switch.
15863 To supply more than one dictionary file,
15864 use ^several @option{-D} switches^a list of files as options^.
15865
15866 @noindent
15867 @option{gnatpp} implicitly uses a @emph{default dictionary file}
15868 to define the casing for the Ada predefined names and
15869 the names declared in the GNAT libraries.
15870
15871 @item ^-D-^/SPECIFIC_CASING^
15872 @cindex @option{^-D-^/SPECIFIC_CASING^} (@command{gnatpp})
15873 Do not use the default dictionary file;
15874 instead, use the casing
15875 defined by a @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^} switch and any explicit
15876 dictionary file(s)
15877 @end table
15878
15879 @noindent
15880 The structure of a dictionary file, and details on the conventions
15881 used in the default dictionary file, are defined in @ref{Name Casing}.
15882
15883 The @option{^-D-^/SPECIFIC_CASING^} and
15884 @option{^-D@var{file}^/DICTIONARY=@var{file}^} switches are mutually
15885 compatible.
15886
15887 @node Construct Layout Control
15888 @subsection Construct Layout Control
15889 @cindex Layout control in @command{gnatpp}
15890
15891 @noindent
15892 This group of @command{gnatpp} switches controls the layout of comments and
15893 complex syntactic constructs. See @ref{Formatting Comments} for details
15894 on their effect.
15895
15896 @table @option
15897 @cindex @option{^-c@var{n}^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT^} (@command{gnatpp})
15898 @item ^-c0^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=UNTOUCHED^
15899 All the comments remain unchanged
15900
15901 @item ^-c1^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=DEFAULT^
15902 GNAT-style comment line indentation (this is the default).
15903
15904 @item ^-c2^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=STANDARD_INDENT^
15905 Reference-manual comment line indentation.
15906
15907 @item ^-c3^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=GNAT_BEGINNING^
15908 GNAT-style comment beginning
15909
15910 @item ^-c4^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=REFORMAT^
15911 Reformat comment blocks
15912
15913 @item ^-c5^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=KEEP_SPECIAL^
15914 Keep unchanged special form comments
15915
15916 Reformat comment blocks
15917
15918 @cindex @option{^-l@var{n}^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT^} (@command{gnatpp})
15919 @item ^-l1^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=GNAT^
15920 GNAT-style layout (this is the default)
15921
15922 @item ^-l2^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=COMPACT^
15923 Compact layout
15924
15925 @item ^-l3^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=UNCOMPACT^
15926 Uncompact layout
15927
15928 @cindex @option{^-N^/NOTABS^} (@command{gnatpp})
15929 @item ^-N^/NOTABS^
15930 All the VT characters are removed from the comment text. All the HT characters
15931 are expanded with the sequences of space characters to get to the next tab
15932 stops.
15933
15934 @cindex @option{^--no-separate-is^/NO_SEPARATE_IS^} (@command{gnatpp})
15935 @item ^--no-separate-is^/NO_SEPARATE_IS^
15936 Do not place the keyword @code{is} on a separate line in a subprogram body in
15937 case if the spec occupies more then one line.
15938
15939 @cindex @option{^--separate-loop-then^/SEPARATE_LOOP_THEN^} (@command{gnatpp})
15940 @item ^--separate-loop-then^/SEPARATE_LOOP_THEN^
15941 Place the keyword @code{loop} in FOR and WHILE loop statements and the
15942 keyword @code{then} in IF statements on a separate line.
15943
15944 @cindex @option{^--no-separate-loop-then^/NO_SEPARATE_LOOP_THEN^} (@command{gnatpp})
15945 @item ^--no-separate-loop-then^/NO_SEPARATE_LOOP_THEN^
15946 Do not place the keyword @code{loop} in FOR and WHILE loop statements and the
15947 keyword @code{then} in IF statements on a separate line. This option is
15948 incompatible with @option{^--separate-loop-then^/SEPARATE_LOOP_THEN^} option.
15949
15950 @cindex @option{^--use-on-new-line^/USE_ON_NEW_LINE^} (@command{gnatpp})
15951 @item ^--use-on-new-line^/USE_ON_NEW_LINE^
15952 Start each USE clause in a context clause from a separate line.
15953
15954 @cindex @option{^--separate-stmt-name^/STMT_NAME_ON_NEW_LINE^} (@command{gnatpp})
15955 @item ^--separate-stmt-name^/STMT_NAME_ON_NEW_LINE^
15956 Use a separate line for a loop or block statement name, but do not use an extra
15957 indentation level for the statement itself.
15958
15959 @end table
15960
15961 @ifclear vms
15962 @noindent
15963 The @option{-c1} and @option{-c2} switches are incompatible.
15964 The @option{-c3} and @option{-c4} switches are compatible with each other and
15965 also with @option{-c1} and @option{-c2}. The @option{-c0} switch disables all
15966 the other comment formatting switches.
15967
15968 The @option{-l1}, @option{-l2}, and @option{-l3} switches are incompatible.
15969 @end ifclear
15970
15971 @ifset vms
15972 @noindent
15973 For the @option{/COMMENTS_LAYOUT} qualifier:
15974 @itemize @bullet
15975 @item
15976 The @option{DEFAULT} and @option{STANDARD_INDENT} options are incompatible.
15977 @item
15978 The @option{GNAT_BEGINNING} and @option{REFORMAT} options are compatible with
15979 each other and also with @option{DEFAULT} and @option{STANDARD_INDENT}.
15980 @end itemize
15981
15982 @noindent
15983 The @option{GNAT}, @option{COMPACT}, and @option{UNCOMPACT} options for the
15984 @option{/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT} qualifier are incompatible.
15985 @end ifset
15986
15987 @node General Text Layout Control
15988 @subsection General Text Layout Control
15989
15990 @noindent
15991 These switches allow control over line length and indentation.
15992
15993 @table @option
15994 @item ^-M@var{nnn}^/LINE_LENGTH_MAX=@var{nnn}^
15995 @cindex @option{^-M^/LINE_LENGTH^} (@command{gnatpp})
15996 Maximum line length, @var{nnn} from 32@dots{}256, the default value is 79
15997
15998 @item ^-i@var{nnn}^/INDENTATION_LEVEL=@var{nnn}^
15999 @cindex @option{^-i^/INDENTATION_LEVEL^} (@command{gnatpp})
16000 Indentation level, @var{nnn} from 1@dots{}9, the default value is 3
16001
16002 @item ^-cl@var{nnn}^/CONTINUATION_INDENT=@var{nnn}^
16003 @cindex @option{^-cl^/CONTINUATION_INDENT^} (@command{gnatpp})
16004 Indentation level for continuation lines (relative to the line being
16005 continued), @var{nnn} from 1@dots{}9.
16006 The default
16007 value is one less then the (normal) indentation level, unless the
16008 indentation is set to 1 (in which case the default value for continuation
16009 line indentation is also 1)
16010 @end table
16011
16012 @node Other Formatting Options
16013 @subsection Other Formatting Options
16014
16015 @noindent
16016 These switches control the inclusion of missing end/exit labels, and
16017 the indentation level in @b{case} statements.
16018
16019 @table @option
16020 @item ^-e^/NO_MISSED_LABELS^
16021 @cindex @option{^-e^/NO_MISSED_LABELS^} (@command{gnatpp})
16022 Do not insert missing end/exit labels. An end label is the name of
16023 a construct that may optionally be repeated at the end of the
16024 construct's declaration;
16025 e.g., the names of packages, subprograms, and tasks.
16026 An exit label is the name of a loop that may appear as target
16027 of an exit statement within the loop.
16028 By default, @command{gnatpp} inserts these end/exit labels when
16029 they are absent from the original source. This option suppresses such
16030 insertion, so that the formatted source reflects the original.
16031
16032 @item ^-ff^/FORM_FEED_AFTER_PRAGMA_PAGE^
16033 @cindex @option{^-ff^/FORM_FEED_AFTER_PRAGMA_PAGE^} (@command{gnatpp})
16034 Insert a Form Feed character after a pragma Page.
16035
16036 @item ^-T@var{nnn}^/MAX_INDENT=@var{nnn}^
16037 @cindex @option{^-T^/MAX_INDENT^} (@command{gnatpp})
16038 Do not use an additional indentation level for @b{case} alternatives
16039 and variants if there are @var{nnn} or more (the default
16040 value is 10).
16041 If @var{nnn} is 0, an additional indentation level is
16042 used for @b{case} alternatives and variants regardless of their number.
16043 @end table
16044
16045 @node Setting the Source Search Path
16046 @subsection Setting the Source Search Path
16047
16048 @noindent
16049 To define the search path for the input source file, @command{gnatpp}
16050 uses the same switches as the GNAT compiler, with the same effects.
16051
16052 @table @option
16053 @item ^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}
16054 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@code{gnatpp})
16055 The same as the corresponding gcc switch
16056
16057 @item ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
16058 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@code{gnatpp})
16059 The same as the corresponding gcc switch
16060
16061 @item ^-gnatec^/CONFIGURATION_PRAGMAS_FILE^=@var{path}
16062 @cindex @option{^-gnatec^/CONFIGURATION_PRAGMAS_FILE^} (@code{gnatpp})
16063 The same as the corresponding gcc switch
16064
16065 @item ^--RTS^/RUNTIME_SYSTEM^=@var{path}
16066 @cindex @option{^--RTS^/RUNTIME_SYSTEM^} (@code{gnatpp})
16067 The same as the corresponding gcc switch
16068
16069 @end table
16070
16071 @node Output File Control
16072 @subsection Output File Control
16073
16074 @noindent
16075 By default the output is sent to the file whose name is obtained by appending
16076 the ^@file{.pp}^@file{$PP}^ suffix to the name of the input file
16077 (if the file with this name already exists, it is unconditionally overwritten).
16078 Thus if the input file is @file{^my_ada_proc.adb^MY_ADA_PROC.ADB^} then
16079 @command{gnatpp} will produce @file{^my_ada_proc.adb.pp^MY_ADA_PROC.ADB$PP^}
16080 as output file.
16081 The output may be redirected by the following switches:
16082
16083 @table @option
16084 @item ^-pipe^/STANDARD_OUTPUT^
16085 @cindex @option{^-pipe^/STANDARD_OUTPUT^} (@code{gnatpp})
16086 Send the output to @code{Standard_Output}
16087
16088 @item ^-o @var{output_file}^/OUTPUT=@var{output_file}^
16089 @cindex @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} (@code{gnatpp})
16090 Write the output into @var{output_file}.
16091 If @var{output_file} already exists, @command{gnatpp} terminates without
16092 reading or processing the input file.
16093
16094 @item ^-of ^/FORCED_OUTPUT=^@var{output_file}
16095 @cindex @option{^-of^/FORCED_OUTPUT^} (@code{gnatpp})
16096 Write the output into @var{output_file}, overwriting the existing file
16097 (if one is present).
16098
16099 @item ^-r^/REPLACE^
16100 @cindex @option{^-r^/REPLACE^} (@code{gnatpp})
16101 Replace the input source file with the reformatted output, and copy the
16102 original input source into the file whose name is obtained by appending the
16103 ^@file{.npp}^@file{$NPP}^ suffix to the name of the input file.
16104 If a file with this name already exists, @command{gnatpp} terminates without
16105 reading or processing the input file.
16106
16107 @item ^-rf^/OVERRIDING_REPLACE^
16108 @cindex @option{^-rf^/OVERRIDING_REPLACE^} (@code{gnatpp})
16109 Like @option{^-r^/REPLACE^} except that if the file with the specified name
16110 already exists, it is overwritten.
16111
16112 @item ^-rnb^/REPLACE_NO_BACKUP^
16113 @cindex @option{^-rnb^/REPLACE_NO_BACKUP^} (@code{gnatpp})
16114 Replace the input source file with the reformatted output without
16115 creating any backup copy of the input source.
16116
16117 @item ^--eol=@var{xxx}^/END_OF_LINE=@var{xxx}^
16118 @cindex @option{^--eol^/END_OF_LINE^} (@code{gnatpp})
16119 Specifies the format of the reformatted output file. The @var{xxx}
16120 ^string specified with the switch^option^ may be either
16121 @itemize @bullet
16122 @item ``@option{^dos^DOS^}'' MS DOS style, lines end with CR LF characters
16123 @item ``@option{^crlf^CRLF^}''
16124 the same as @option{^crlf^CRLF^}
16125 @item ``@option{^unix^UNIX^}'' UNIX style, lines end with LF character
16126 @item ``@option{^lf^LF^}''
16127 the same as @option{^unix^UNIX^}
16128 @end itemize
16129
16130 @item ^-W^/RESULT_ENCODING=^@var{e}
16131 @cindex @option{^-W^/RESULT_ENCODING=^} (@command{gnatpp})
16132 Specify the wide character encoding method used to write the code in the
16133 result file
16134 @var{e} is one of the following:
16135
16136 @itemize @bullet
16137
16138 @item ^h^HEX^
16139 Hex encoding
16140
16141 @item ^u^UPPER^
16142 Upper half encoding
16143
16144 @item ^s^SHIFT_JIS^
16145 Shift/JIS encoding
16146
16147 @item ^e^EUC^
16148 EUC encoding
16149
16150 @item ^8^UTF8^
16151 UTF-8 encoding
16152
16153 @item ^b^BRACKETS^
16154 Brackets encoding (default value)
16155 @end itemize
16156
16157 @end table
16158
16159 @noindent
16160 Options @option{^-pipe^/STANDARD_OUTPUT^},
16161 @option{^-o^/OUTPUT^} and
16162 @option{^-of^/FORCED_OUTPUT^} are allowed only if the call to gnatpp
16163 contains only one file to reformat.
16164 Option
16165 @option{^--eol^/END_OF_LINE^}
16166 and
16167 @option{^-W^/RESULT_ENCODING^}
16168 cannot be used together
16169 with @option{^-pipe^/STANDARD_OUTPUT^} option.
16170
16171 @node Other gnatpp Switches
16172 @subsection Other @code{gnatpp} Switches
16173
16174 @noindent
16175 The additional @command{gnatpp} switches are defined in this subsection.
16176
16177 @table @option
16178 @item ^-files @var{filename}^/FILES=@var{output_file}^
16179 @cindex @option{^-files^/FILES^} (@code{gnatpp})
16180 Take the argument source files from the specified file. This file should be an
16181 ordinary textual file containing file names separated by spaces or
16182 line breaks. You can use this switch more then once in the same call to
16183 @command{gnatpp}. You also can combine this switch with explicit list of
16184 files.
16185
16186 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
16187 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatpp})
16188 Verbose mode;
16189 @command{gnatpp} generates version information and then
16190 a trace of the actions it takes to produce or obtain the ASIS tree.
16191
16192 @item ^-w^/WARNINGS^
16193 @cindex @option{^-w^/WARNINGS^} (@code{gnatpp})
16194 Warning mode;
16195 @command{gnatpp} generates a warning whenever it cannot provide
16196 a required layout in the result source.
16197 @end table
16198
16199 @node Formatting Rules
16200 @section Formatting Rules
16201
16202 @noindent
16203 The following subsections show how @command{gnatpp} treats ``white space'',
16204 comments, program layout, and name casing.
16205 They provide the detailed descriptions of the switches shown above.
16206
16207 @menu
16208 * White Space and Empty Lines::
16209 * Formatting Comments::
16210 * Construct Layout::
16211 * Name Casing::
16212 @end menu
16213
16214 @node White Space and Empty Lines
16215 @subsection White Space and Empty Lines
16216
16217 @noindent
16218 @command{gnatpp} does not have an option to control space characters.
16219 It will add or remove spaces according to the style illustrated by the
16220 examples in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
16221
16222 The only format effectors
16223 (see @cite{Ada Reference Manual}, paragraph 2.1(13))
16224 that will appear in the output file are platform-specific line breaks,
16225 and also format effectors within (but not at the end of) comments.
16226 In particular, each horizontal tab character that is not inside
16227 a comment will be treated as a space and thus will appear in the
16228 output file as zero or more spaces depending on
16229 the reformatting of the line in which it appears.
16230 The only exception is a Form Feed character, which is inserted after a
16231 pragma @code{Page} when @option{-ff} is set.
16232
16233 The output file will contain no lines with trailing ``white space'' (spaces,
16234 format effectors).
16235
16236 Empty lines in the original source are preserved
16237 only if they separate declarations or statements.
16238 In such contexts, a
16239 sequence of two or more empty lines is replaced by exactly one empty line.
16240 Note that a blank line will be removed if it separates two ``comment blocks''
16241 (a comment block is a sequence of whole-line comments).
16242 In order to preserve a visual separation between comment blocks, use an
16243 ``empty comment'' (a line comprising only hyphens) rather than an empty line.
16244 Likewise, if for some reason you wish to have a sequence of empty lines,
16245 use a sequence of empty comments instead.
16246
16247 @node Formatting Comments
16248 @subsection Formatting Comments
16249
16250 @noindent
16251 Comments in Ada code are of two kinds:
16252 @itemize @bullet
16253 @item
16254 a @emph{whole-line comment}, which appears by itself (possibly preceded by
16255 ``white space'') on a line
16256
16257 @item
16258 an @emph{end-of-line comment}, which follows some other Ada lexical element
16259 on the same line.
16260 @end itemize
16261
16262 @noindent
16263 The indentation of a whole-line comment is that of either
16264 the preceding or following line in
16265 the formatted source, depending on switch settings as will be described below.
16266
16267 For an end-of-line comment, @command{gnatpp} leaves the same number of spaces
16268 between the end of the preceding Ada lexical element and the beginning
16269 of the comment as appear in the original source,
16270 unless either the comment has to be split to
16271 satisfy the line length limitation, or else the next line contains a
16272 whole line comment that is considered a continuation of this end-of-line
16273 comment (because it starts at the same position).
16274 In the latter two
16275 cases, the start of the end-of-line comment is moved right to the nearest
16276 multiple of the indentation level.
16277 This may result in a ``line overflow'' (the right-shifted comment extending
16278 beyond the maximum line length), in which case the comment is split as
16279 described below.
16280
16281 There is a difference between @option{^-c1^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=DEFAULT^}
16282 (GNAT-style comment line indentation)
16283 and @option{^-c2^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=STANDARD_INDENT^}
16284 (reference-manual comment line indentation).
16285 With reference-manual style, a whole-line comment is indented as if it
16286 were a declaration or statement at the same place
16287 (i.e., according to the indentation of the preceding line(s)).
16288 With GNAT style, a whole-line comment that is immediately followed by an
16289 @b{if} or @b{case} statement alternative, a record variant, or the reserved
16290 word @b{begin}, is indented based on the construct that follows it.
16291
16292 For example:
16293 @smallexample @c ada
16294 @cartouche
16295 if A then
16296 null;
16297 -- some comment
16298 else
16299 null;
16300 end if;
16301 @end cartouche
16302 @end smallexample
16303
16304 @noindent
16305 Reference-manual indentation produces:
16306
16307 @smallexample @c ada
16308 @cartouche
16309 if A then
16310 null;
16311 -- some comment
16312 else
16313 null;
16314 end if;
16315 @end cartouche
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 @noindent
16319 while GNAT-style indentation produces:
16320
16321 @smallexample @c ada
16322 @cartouche
16323 if A then
16324 null;
16325 -- some comment
16326 else
16327 null;
16328 end if;
16329 @end cartouche
16330 @end smallexample
16331
16332 @noindent
16333 The @option{^-c3^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=GNAT_BEGINNING^} switch
16334 (GNAT style comment beginning) has the following
16335 effect:
16336
16337 @itemize @bullet
16338 @item
16339 For each whole-line comment that does not end with two hyphens,
16340 @command{gnatpp} inserts spaces if necessary after the starting two hyphens
16341 to ensure that there are at least two spaces between these hyphens and the
16342 first non-blank character of the comment.
16343 @end itemize
16344
16345 @noindent
16346 For an end-of-line comment, if in the original source the next line is a
16347 whole-line comment that starts at the same position
16348 as the end-of-line comment,
16349 then the whole-line comment (and all whole-line comments
16350 that follow it and that start at the same position)
16351 will start at this position in the output file.
16352
16353 @noindent
16354 That is, if in the original source we have:
16355
16356 @smallexample @c ada
16357 @cartouche
16358 begin
16359 A := B + C; -- B must be in the range Low1..High1
16360 -- C must be in the range Low2..High2
16361 --B+C will be in the range Low1+Low2..High1+High2
16362 X := X + 1;
16363 @end cartouche
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366 @noindent
16367 Then in the formatted source we get
16368
16369 @smallexample @c ada
16370 @cartouche
16371 begin
16372 A := B + C; -- B must be in the range Low1..High1
16373 -- C must be in the range Low2..High2
16374 -- B+C will be in the range Low1+Low2..High1+High2
16375 X := X + 1;
16376 @end cartouche
16377 @end smallexample
16378
16379 @noindent
16380 A comment that exceeds the line length limit will be split.
16381 Unless switch
16382 @option{^-c4^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=REFORMAT^} (reformat comment blocks) is set and
16383 the line belongs to a reformattable block, splitting the line generates a
16384 @command{gnatpp} warning.
16385 The @option{^-c4^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=REFORMAT^} switch specifies that whole-line
16386 comments may be reformatted in typical
16387 word processor style (that is, moving words between lines and putting as
16388 many words in a line as possible).
16389
16390 @noindent
16391 The @option{^-c5^/COMMENTS_LAYOUT=KEEP_SPECIAL^} switch specifies, that comments
16392 that has a special format (that is, a character that is neither a letter nor digit
16393 not white space nor line break immediately following the leading @code{--} of
16394 the comment) should be without any change moved from the argument source
16395 into reformatted source. This switch allows to preserve comments that are used
16396 as a special marks in the code (e.g.@: SPARK annotation).
16397
16398 @node Construct Layout
16399 @subsection Construct Layout
16400
16401 @noindent
16402 In several cases the suggested layout in the Ada Reference Manual includes
16403 an extra level of indentation that many programmers prefer to avoid. The
16404 affected cases include:
16405
16406 @itemize @bullet
16407
16408 @item Record type declaration (RM 3.8)
16409
16410 @item Record representation clause (RM 13.5.1)
16411
16412 @item Loop statement in case if a loop has a statement identifier (RM 5.6)
16413
16414 @item Block statement in case if a block has a statement identifier (RM 5.6)
16415 @end itemize
16416
16417 @noindent
16418 In compact mode (when GNAT style layout or compact layout is set),
16419 the pretty printer uses one level of indentation instead
16420 of two. This is achieved in the record definition and record representation
16421 clause cases by putting the @code{record} keyword on the same line as the
16422 start of the declaration or representation clause, and in the block and loop
16423 case by putting the block or loop header on the same line as the statement
16424 identifier.
16425
16426 @noindent
16427 The difference between GNAT style @option{^-l1^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=GNAT^}
16428 and compact @option{^-l2^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=COMPACT^}
16429 layout on the one hand, and uncompact layout
16430 @option{^-l3^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=UNCOMPACT^} on the other hand,
16431 can be illustrated by the following examples:
16432
16433 @iftex
16434 @cartouche
16435 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
16436 @item @i{GNAT style, compact layout} @tab @i{Uncompact layout}
16437
16438 @item
16439 @smallexample @c ada
16440 type q is record
16441 a : integer;
16442 b : integer;
16443 end record;
16444 @end smallexample
16445 @tab
16446 @smallexample @c ada
16447 type q is
16448 record
16449 a : integer;
16450 b : integer;
16451 end record;
16452 @end smallexample
16453
16454 @item
16455 @smallexample @c ada
16456 for q use record
16457 a at 0 range 0 .. 31;
16458 b at 4 range 0 .. 31;
16459 end record;
16460 @end smallexample
16461 @tab
16462 @smallexample @c ada
16463 for q use
16464 record
16465 a at 0 range 0 .. 31;
16466 b at 4 range 0 .. 31;
16467 end record;
16468 @end smallexample
16469
16470 @item
16471 @smallexample @c ada
16472 Block : declare
16473 A : Integer := 3;
16474 begin
16475 Proc (A, A);
16476 end Block;
16477 @end smallexample
16478 @tab
16479 @smallexample @c ada
16480 Block :
16481 declare
16482 A : Integer := 3;
16483 begin
16484 Proc (A, A);
16485 end Block;
16486 @end smallexample
16487
16488 @item
16489 @smallexample @c ada
16490 Clear : for J in 1 .. 10 loop
16491 A (J) := 0;
16492 end loop Clear;
16493 @end smallexample
16494 @tab
16495 @smallexample @c ada
16496 Clear :
16497 for J in 1 .. 10 loop
16498 A (J) := 0;
16499 end loop Clear;
16500 @end smallexample
16501 @end multitable
16502 @end cartouche
16503 @end iftex
16504
16505 @ifnottex
16506 @smallexample
16507 @cartouche
16508 GNAT style, compact layout Uncompact layout
16509
16510 type q is record type q is
16511 a : integer; record
16512 b : integer; a : integer;
16513 end record; b : integer;
16514 end record;
16515
16516 for q use record for q use
16517 a at 0 range 0 .. 31; record
16518 b at 4 range 0 .. 31; a at 0 range 0 .. 31;
16519 end record; b at 4 range 0 .. 31;
16520 end record;
16521
16522 Block : declare Block :
16523 A : Integer := 3; declare
16524 begin A : Integer := 3;
16525 Proc (A, A); begin
16526 end Block; Proc (A, A);
16527 end Block;
16528
16529 Clear : for J in 1 .. 10 loop Clear :
16530 A (J) := 0; for J in 1 .. 10 loop
16531 end loop Clear; A (J) := 0;
16532 end loop Clear;
16533 @end cartouche
16534 @end smallexample
16535 @end ifnottex
16536
16537 @noindent
16538 A further difference between GNAT style layout and compact layout is that
16539 GNAT style layout inserts empty lines as separation for
16540 compound statements, return statements and bodies.
16541
16542 Note that the layout specified by
16543 @option{^--separate-stmt-name^/STMT_NAME_ON_NEW_LINE^}
16544 for named block and loop statements overrides the layout defined by these
16545 constructs by @option{^-l1^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=GNAT^},
16546 @option{^-l2^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=COMPACT^} or
16547 @option{^-l3^/CONSTRUCT_LAYOUT=UNCOMPACT^} option.
16548
16549 @node Name Casing
16550 @subsection Name Casing
16551
16552 @noindent
16553 @command{gnatpp} always converts the usage occurrence of a (simple) name to
16554 the same casing as the corresponding defining identifier.
16555
16556 You control the casing for defining occurrences via the
16557 @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^} switch.
16558 @ifclear vms
16559 With @option{-nD} (``as declared'', which is the default),
16560 @end ifclear
16561 @ifset vms
16562 With @option{/NAME_CASING=AS_DECLARED}, which is the default,
16563 @end ifset
16564 defining occurrences appear exactly as in the source file
16565 where they are declared.
16566 The other ^values for this switch^options for this qualifier^ ---
16567 @option{^-nU^UPPER_CASE^},
16568 @option{^-nL^LOWER_CASE^},
16569 @option{^-nM^MIXED_CASE^} ---
16570 result in
16571 ^upper, lower, or mixed case, respectively^the corresponding casing^.
16572 If @command{gnatpp} changes the casing of a defining
16573 occurrence, it analogously changes the casing of all the
16574 usage occurrences of this name.
16575
16576 If the defining occurrence of a name is not in the source compilation unit
16577 currently being processed by @command{gnatpp}, the casing of each reference to
16578 this name is changed according to the value of the @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^}
16579 switch (subject to the dictionary file mechanism described below).
16580 Thus @command{gnatpp} acts as though the @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^} switch
16581 had affected the
16582 casing for the defining occurrence of the name.
16583
16584 Some names may need to be spelled with casing conventions that are not
16585 covered by the upper-, lower-, and mixed-case transformations.
16586 You can arrange correct casing by placing such names in a
16587 @emph{dictionary file},
16588 and then supplying a @option{^-D^/DICTIONARY^} switch.
16589 The casing of names from dictionary files overrides
16590 any @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^} switch.
16591
16592 To handle the casing of Ada predefined names and the names from GNAT libraries,
16593 @command{gnatpp} assumes a default dictionary file.
16594 The name of each predefined entity is spelled with the same casing as is used
16595 for the entity in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
16596 The name of each entity in the GNAT libraries is spelled with the same casing
16597 as is used in the declaration of that entity.
16598
16599 The @w{@option{^-D-^/SPECIFIC_CASING^}} switch suppresses the use of the
16600 default dictionary file.
16601 Instead, the casing for predefined and GNAT-defined names will be established
16602 by the @option{^-n^/NAME_CASING^} switch or explicit dictionary files.
16603 For example, by default the names @code{Ada.Text_IO} and @code{GNAT.OS_Lib}
16604 will appear as just shown,
16605 even in the presence of a @option{^-nU^/NAME_CASING=UPPER_CASE^} switch.
16606 To ensure that even such names are rendered in uppercase,
16607 additionally supply the @w{@option{^-D-^/SPECIFIC_CASING^}} switch
16608 (or else, less conveniently, place these names in upper case in a dictionary
16609 file).
16610
16611 A dictionary file is
16612 a plain text file; each line in this file can be either a blank line
16613 (containing only space characters and ASCII.HT characters), an Ada comment
16614 line, or the specification of exactly one @emph{casing schema}.
16615
16616 A casing schema is a string that has the following syntax:
16617
16618 @smallexample
16619 @cartouche
16620 @var{casing_schema} ::= @var{identifier} | *@var{simple_identifier}*
16621
16622 @var{simple_identifier} ::= @var{letter}@{@var{letter_or_digit}@}
16623 @end cartouche
16624 @end smallexample
16625
16626 @noindent
16627 (See @cite{Ada Reference Manual}, Section 2.3) for the definition of the
16628 @var{identifier} lexical element and the @var{letter_or_digit} category.)
16629
16630 The casing schema string can be followed by white space and/or an Ada-style
16631 comment; any amount of white space is allowed before the string.
16632
16633 If a dictionary file is passed as
16634 @ifclear vms
16635 the value of a @option{-D@var{file}} switch
16636 @end ifclear
16637 @ifset vms
16638 an option to the @option{/DICTIONARY} qualifier
16639 @end ifset
16640 then for every
16641 simple name and every identifier, @command{gnatpp} checks if the dictionary
16642 defines the casing for the name or for some of its parts (the term ``subword''
16643 is used below to denote the part of a name which is delimited by ``_'' or by
16644 the beginning or end of the word and which does not contain any ``_'' inside):
16645
16646 @itemize @bullet
16647 @item
16648 if the whole name is in the dictionary, @command{gnatpp} uses for this name
16649 the casing defined by the dictionary; no subwords are checked for this word
16650
16651 @item
16652 for every subword @command{gnatpp} checks if the dictionary contains the
16653 corresponding string of the form @code{*@var{simple_identifier}*},
16654 and if it does, the casing of this @var{simple_identifier} is used
16655 for this subword
16656
16657 @item
16658 if the whole name does not contain any ``_'' inside, and if for this name
16659 the dictionary contains two entries - one of the form @var{identifier},
16660 and another - of the form *@var{simple_identifier}*, then the first one
16661 is applied to define the casing of this name
16662
16663 @item
16664 if more than one dictionary file is passed as @command{gnatpp} switches, each
16665 dictionary adds new casing exceptions and overrides all the existing casing
16666 exceptions set by the previous dictionaries
16667
16668 @item
16669 when @command{gnatpp} checks if the word or subword is in the dictionary,
16670 this check is not case sensitive
16671 @end itemize
16672
16673 @noindent
16674 For example, suppose we have the following source to reformat:
16675
16676 @smallexample @c ada
16677 @cartouche
16678 procedure test is
16679 name1 : integer := 1;
16680 name4_name3_name2 : integer := 2;
16681 name2_name3_name4 : Boolean;
16682 name1_var : Float;
16683 begin
16684 name2_name3_name4 := name4_name3_name2 > name1;
16685 end;
16686 @end cartouche
16687 @end smallexample
16688
16689 @noindent
16690 And suppose we have two dictionaries:
16691
16692 @smallexample
16693 @cartouche
16694 @i{dict1:}
16695 NAME1
16696 *NaMe3*
16697 *Name1*
16698 @end cartouche
16699
16700 @cartouche
16701 @i{dict2:}
16702 *NAME3*
16703 @end cartouche
16704 @end smallexample
16705
16706 @noindent
16707 If @command{gnatpp} is called with the following switches:
16708
16709 @smallexample
16710 @ifclear vms
16711 @command{gnatpp -nM -D dict1 -D dict2 test.adb}
16712 @end ifclear
16713 @ifset vms
16714 @command{gnatpp test.adb /NAME_CASING=MIXED_CASE /DICTIONARY=(dict1, dict2)}
16715 @end ifset
16716 @end smallexample
16717
16718 @noindent
16719 then we will get the following name casing in the @command{gnatpp} output:
16720
16721 @smallexample @c ada
16722 @cartouche
16723 procedure Test is
16724 NAME1 : Integer := 1;
16725 Name4_NAME3_Name2 : Integer := 2;
16726 Name2_NAME3_Name4 : Boolean;
16727 Name1_Var : Float;
16728 begin
16729 Name2_NAME3_Name4 := Name4_NAME3_Name2 > NAME1;
16730 end Test;
16731 @end cartouche
16732 @end smallexample
16733
16734 @c *********************************
16735 @node The GNAT Metric Tool gnatmetric
16736 @chapter The GNAT Metric Tool @command{gnatmetric}
16737 @findex gnatmetric
16738 @cindex Metric tool
16739
16740 @noindent
16741 ^The @command{gnatmetric} tool^@command{GNAT METRIC}^ is an ASIS-based utility
16742 for computing various program metrics.
16743 It takes an Ada source file as input and generates a file containing the
16744 metrics data as output. Various switches control which
16745 metrics are computed and output.
16746
16747 @command{gnatmetric} generates and uses the ASIS
16748 tree for the input source and thus requires the input to be syntactically and
16749 semantically legal.
16750 If this condition is not met, @command{gnatmetric} will generate
16751 an error message; no metric information for this file will be
16752 computed and reported.
16753
16754 If the compilation unit contained in the input source depends semantically
16755 upon units in files located outside the current directory, you have to provide
16756 the source search path when invoking @command{gnatmetric}.
16757 If it depends semantically upon units that are contained
16758 in files with names that do not follow the GNAT file naming rules, you have to
16759 provide the configuration file describing the corresponding naming scheme (see
16760 the description of the @command{gnatmetric} switches below.)
16761 Alternatively, you may use a project file and invoke @command{gnatmetric}
16762 through the @command{gnat} driver.
16763
16764 The @command{gnatmetric} command has the form
16765
16766 @smallexample
16767 $ gnatmetric @ovar{switches} @{@var{filename}@} @r{[}-cargs @var{gcc_switches}@r{]}
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 @noindent
16771 where
16772 @itemize @bullet
16773 @item
16774 @var{switches} specify the metrics to compute and define the destination for
16775 the output
16776
16777 @item
16778 Each @var{filename} is the name (including the extension) of a source
16779 file to process. ``Wildcards'' are allowed, and
16780 the file name may contain path information.
16781 If no @var{filename} is supplied, then the @var{switches} list must contain
16782 at least one
16783 @option{-files} switch (@pxref{Other gnatmetric Switches}).
16784 Including both a @option{-files} switch and one or more
16785 @var{filename} arguments is permitted.
16786
16787 @item
16788 @samp{-cargs @var{gcc_switches}} is a list of switches for
16789 @command{gcc}. They will be passed on to all compiler invocations made by
16790 @command{gnatmetric} to generate the ASIS trees. Here you can provide
16791 @option{^-I^/INCLUDE_DIRS=^} switches to form the source search path,
16792 and use the @option{-gnatec} switch to set the configuration file.
16793 @end itemize
16794
16795 @menu
16796 * Switches for gnatmetric::
16797 @end menu
16798
16799 @node Switches for gnatmetric
16800 @section Switches for @command{gnatmetric}
16801
16802 @noindent
16803 The following subsections describe the various switches accepted by
16804 @command{gnatmetric}, organized by category.
16805
16806 @menu
16807 * Output Files Control::
16808 * Disable Metrics For Local Units::
16809 * Specifying a set of metrics to compute::
16810 * Other gnatmetric Switches::
16811 * Generate project-wide metrics::
16812 @end menu
16813
16814 @node Output Files Control
16815 @subsection Output File Control
16816 @cindex Output file control in @command{gnatmetric}
16817
16818 @noindent
16819 @command{gnatmetric} has two output formats. It can generate a
16820 textual (human-readable) form, and also XML. By default only textual
16821 output is generated.
16822
16823 When generating the output in textual form, @command{gnatmetric} creates
16824 for each Ada source file a corresponding text file
16825 containing the computed metrics, except for the case when the set of metrics
16826 specified by gnatmetric parameters consists only of metrics that are computed
16827 for the whole set of analyzed sources, but not for each Ada source.
16828 By default, this file is placed in the same directory as where the source
16829 file is located, and its name is obtained
16830 by appending the ^@file{.metrix}^@file{$METRIX}^ suffix to the name of the
16831 input file.
16832
16833 All the output information generated in XML format is placed in a single
16834 file. By default this file is placed in the current directory and has the
16835 name ^@file{metrix.xml}^@file{METRIX$XML}^.
16836
16837 Some of the computed metrics are summed over the units passed to
16838 @command{gnatmetric}; for example, the total number of lines of code.
16839 By default this information is sent to @file{stdout}, but a file
16840 can be specified with the @option{-og} switch.
16841
16842 The following switches control the @command{gnatmetric} output:
16843
16844 @table @option
16845 @cindex @option{^-x^/XML^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16846 @item ^-x^/XML^
16847 Generate the XML output
16848
16849 @cindex @option{^-nt^/NO_TEXT^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16850 @item ^-nt^/NO_TEXT^
16851 Do not generate the output in text form (implies @option{^-x^/XML^})
16852
16853 @cindex @option{^-d^/DIRECTORY^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16854 @item ^-d @var{output_dir}^/DIRECTORY=@var{output_dir}^
16855 Put textual files with detailed metrics into @var{output_dir}
16856
16857 @cindex @option{^-o^/SUFFIX_DETAILS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16858 @item ^-o @var{file_suffix}^/SUFFIX_DETAILS=@var{file_suffix}^
16859 Use @var{file_suffix}, instead of ^@file{.metrix}^@file{$METRIX}^
16860 in the name of the output file.
16861
16862 @cindex @option{^-og^/GLOBAL_OUTPUT^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16863 @item ^-og @var{file_name}^/GLOBAL_OUTPUT=@var{file_name}^
16864 Put global metrics into @var{file_name}
16865
16866 @cindex @option{^-ox^/XML_OUTPUT^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16867 @item ^-ox @var{file_name}^/XML_OUTPUT=@var{file_name}^
16868 Put the XML output into @var{file_name} (also implies @option{^-x^/XML^})
16869
16870 @cindex @option{^-sfn^/SHORT_SOURCE_FILE_NAME^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16871 @item ^-sfn^/SHORT_SOURCE_FILE_NAME^
16872 Use ``short'' source file names in the output. (The @command{gnatmetric}
16873 output includes the name(s) of the Ada source file(s) from which the metrics
16874 are computed. By default each name includes the absolute path. The
16875 @option{^-sfn^/SHORT_SOURCE_FILE_NAME^} switch causes @command{gnatmetric}
16876 to exclude all directory information from the file names that are output.)
16877
16878 @end table
16879
16880 @node Disable Metrics For Local Units
16881 @subsection Disable Metrics For Local Units
16882 @cindex Disable Metrics For Local Units in @command{gnatmetric}
16883
16884 @noindent
16885 @command{gnatmetric} relies on the GNAT compilation model @minus{}
16886 one compilation
16887 unit per one source file. It computes line metrics for the whole source
16888 file, and it also computes syntax
16889 and complexity metrics for the file's outermost unit.
16890
16891 By default, @command{gnatmetric} will also compute all metrics for certain
16892 kinds of locally declared program units:
16893
16894 @itemize @bullet
16895 @item
16896 subprogram (and generic subprogram) bodies;
16897
16898 @item
16899 package (and generic package) specs and bodies;
16900
16901 @item
16902 task object and type specifications and bodies;
16903
16904 @item
16905 protected object and type specifications and bodies.
16906 @end itemize
16907
16908 @noindent
16909 These kinds of entities will be referred to as
16910 @emph{eligible local program units}, or simply @emph{eligible local units},
16911 @cindex Eligible local unit (for @command{gnatmetric})
16912 in the discussion below.
16913
16914 Note that a subprogram declaration, generic instantiation,
16915 or renaming declaration only receives metrics
16916 computation when it appear as the outermost entity
16917 in a source file.
16918
16919 Suppression of metrics computation for eligible local units can be
16920 obtained via the following switch:
16921
16922 @table @option
16923 @cindex @option{^-n@var{x}^/SUPPRESS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16924 @item ^-nolocal^/SUPPRESS=LOCAL_DETAILS^
16925 Do not compute detailed metrics for eligible local program units
16926
16927 @end table
16928
16929 @node Specifying a set of metrics to compute
16930 @subsection Specifying a set of metrics to compute
16931
16932 @noindent
16933 By default all the metrics are computed and reported. The switches
16934 described in this subsection allow you to control, on an individual
16935 basis, whether metrics are computed and
16936 reported. If at least one positive metric
16937 switch is specified (that is, a switch that defines that a given
16938 metric or set of metrics is to be computed), then only
16939 explicitly specified metrics are reported.
16940
16941 @menu
16942 * Line Metrics Control::
16943 * Syntax Metrics Control::
16944 * Complexity Metrics Control::
16945 * Object-Oriented Metrics Control::
16946 @end menu
16947
16948 @node Line Metrics Control
16949 @subsubsection Line Metrics Control
16950 @cindex Line metrics control in @command{gnatmetric}
16951
16952 @noindent
16953 For any (legal) source file, and for each of its
16954 eligible local program units, @command{gnatmetric} computes the following
16955 metrics:
16956
16957 @itemize @bullet
16958 @item
16959 the total number of lines;
16960
16961 @item
16962 the total number of code lines (i.e., non-blank lines that are not comments)
16963
16964 @item
16965 the number of comment lines
16966
16967 @item
16968 the number of code lines containing end-of-line comments;
16969
16970 @item
16971 the comment percentage: the ratio between the number of lines that contain
16972 comments and the number of all non-blank lines, expressed as a percentage;
16973
16974 @item
16975 the number of empty lines and lines containing only space characters and/or
16976 format effectors (blank lines)
16977
16978 @item
16979 the average number of code lines in subprogram bodies, task bodies, entry
16980 bodies and statement sequences in package bodies (this metric is only computed
16981 across the whole set of the analyzed units)
16982
16983 @end itemize
16984
16985 @noindent
16986 @command{gnatmetric} sums the values of the line metrics for all the
16987 files being processed and then generates the cumulative results. The tool
16988 also computes for all the files being processed the average number of code
16989 lines in bodies.
16990
16991 You can use the following switches to select the specific line metrics
16992 to be computed and reported.
16993
16994 @table @option
16995 @cindex @option{^--lines@var{x}^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
16996
16997 @ifclear vms
16998 @cindex @option{--no-lines@var{x}}
16999 @end ifclear
17000
17001 @item ^--lines-all^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=ALL_ON^
17002 Report all the line metrics
17003
17004 @item ^--no-lines-all^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=ALL_OFF^
17005 Do not report any of line metrics
17006
17007 @item ^--lines^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=ALL_LINES_ON^
17008 Report the number of all lines
17009
17010 @item ^--no-lines^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=ALL_LINES_OFF^
17011 Do not report the number of all lines
17012
17013 @item ^--lines-code^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=CODE_LINES_ON^
17014 Report the number of code lines
17015
17016 @item ^--no-lines-code^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=CODE_LINES_OFF^
17017 Do not report the number of code lines
17018
17019 @item ^--lines-comment^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=COMMENT_LINES_ON^
17020 Report the number of comment lines
17021
17022 @item ^--no-lines-comment^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=COMMENT_LINES_OFF^
17023 Do not report the number of comment lines
17024
17025 @item ^--lines-eol-comment^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=CODE_COMMENT_LINES_ON^
17026 Report the number of code lines containing
17027 end-of-line comments
17028
17029 @item ^--no-lines-eol-comment^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=CODE_COMMENT_LINES_OFF^
17030 Do not report the number of code lines containing
17031 end-of-line comments
17032
17033 @item ^--lines-ratio^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=COMMENT_PERCENTAGE_ON^
17034 Report the comment percentage in the program text
17035
17036 @item ^--no-lines-ratio^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=COMMENT_PERCENTAGE_OFF^
17037 Do not report the comment percentage in the program text
17038
17039 @item ^--lines-blank^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=BLANK_LINES_ON^
17040 Report the number of blank lines
17041
17042 @item ^--no-lines-blank^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=BLANK_LINES_OFF^
17043 Do not report the number of blank lines
17044
17045 @item ^--lines-average^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=AVERAGE_BODY_LINES_ON^
17046 Report the average number of code lines in subprogram bodies, task bodies,
17047 entry bodies and statement sequences in package bodies. The metric is computed
17048 and reported for the whole set of processed Ada sources only.
17049
17050 @item ^--no-lines-average^/LINE_COUNT_METRICS=AVERAGE_BODY_LINES_OFF^
17051 Do not report the average number of code lines in subprogram bodies,
17052 task bodies, entry bodies and statement sequences in package bodies.
17053
17054 @end table
17055
17056 @node Syntax Metrics Control
17057 @subsubsection Syntax Metrics Control
17058 @cindex Syntax metrics control in @command{gnatmetric}
17059
17060 @noindent
17061 @command{gnatmetric} computes various syntactic metrics for the
17062 outermost unit and for each eligible local unit:
17063
17064 @table @emph
17065 @item LSLOC (``Logical Source Lines Of Code'')
17066 The total number of declarations and the total number of statements
17067
17068 @item Maximal static nesting level of inner program units
17069 According to
17070 @cite{Ada Reference Manual}, 10.1(1), ``A program unit is either a
17071 package, a task unit, a protected unit, a
17072 protected entry, a generic unit, or an explicitly declared subprogram other
17073 than an enumeration literal.''
17074
17075 @item Maximal nesting level of composite syntactic constructs
17076 This corresponds to the notion of the
17077 maximum nesting level in the GNAT built-in style checks
17078 (@pxref{Style Checking})
17079 @end table
17080
17081 @noindent
17082 For the outermost unit in the file, @command{gnatmetric} additionally computes
17083 the following metrics:
17084
17085 @table @emph
17086 @item Public subprograms
17087 This metric is computed for package specs. It is the
17088 number of subprograms and generic subprograms declared in the visible
17089 part (including the visible part of nested packages, protected objects, and
17090 protected types).
17091
17092 @item All subprograms
17093 This metric is computed for bodies and subunits. The
17094 metric is equal to a total number of subprogram bodies in the compilation
17095 unit.
17096 Neither generic instantiations nor renamings-as-a-body nor body stubs
17097 are counted. Any subprogram body is counted, independently of its nesting
17098 level and enclosing constructs. Generic bodies and bodies of protected
17099 subprograms are counted in the same way as ``usual'' subprogram bodies.
17100
17101 @item Public types
17102 This metric is computed for package specs and
17103 generic package declarations. It is the total number of types
17104 that can be referenced from outside this compilation unit, plus the
17105 number of types from all the visible parts of all the visible generic
17106 packages. Generic formal types are not counted. Only types, not subtypes,
17107 are included.
17108
17109 @noindent
17110 Along with the total number of public types, the following
17111 types are counted and reported separately:
17112
17113 @itemize @bullet
17114 @item
17115 Abstract types
17116
17117 @item
17118 Root tagged types (abstract, non-abstract, private, non-private). Type
17119 extensions are @emph{not} counted
17120
17121 @item
17122 Private types (including private extensions)
17123
17124 @item
17125 Task types
17126
17127 @item
17128 Protected types
17129
17130 @end itemize
17131
17132 @item All types
17133 This metric is computed for any compilation unit. It is equal to the total
17134 number of the declarations of different types given in the compilation unit.
17135 The private and the corresponding full type declaration are counted as one
17136 type declaration. Incomplete type declarations and generic formal types
17137 are not counted.
17138 No distinction is made among different kinds of types (abstract,
17139 private etc.); the total number of types is computed and reported.
17140
17141 @end table
17142
17143 @noindent
17144 By default, all the syntax metrics are computed and reported. You can use the
17145 following switches to select specific syntax metrics.
17146
17147 @table @option
17148
17149 @cindex @option{^--syntax@var{x}^/SYNTAX_METRICS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
17150
17151 @ifclear vms
17152 @cindex @option{--no-syntax@var{x}} (@command{gnatmetric})
17153 @end ifclear
17154
17155 @item ^--syntax-all^/SYNTAX_METRICS=ALL_ON^
17156 Report all the syntax metrics
17157
17158 @item ^--no-syntax-all^/ALL_OFF^
17159 Do not report any of syntax metrics
17160
17161 @item ^--declarations^/SYNTAX_METRICS=DECLARATIONS_ON^
17162 Report the total number of declarations
17163
17164 @item ^--no-declarations^/SYNTAX_METRICS=DECLARATIONS_OFF^
17165 Do not report the total number of declarations
17166
17167 @item ^--statements^/SYNTAX_METRICS=STATEMENTS_ON^
17168 Report the total number of statements
17169
17170 @item ^--no-statements^/SYNTAX_METRICS=STATEMENTS_OFF^
17171 Do not report the total number of statements
17172
17173 @item ^--public-subprograms^/SYNTAX_METRICS=PUBLIC_SUBPROGRAMS_ON^
17174 Report the number of public subprograms in a compilation unit
17175
17176 @item ^--no-public-subprograms^/SYNTAX_METRICS=PUBLIC_SUBPROGRAMS_OFF^
17177 Do not report the number of public subprograms in a compilation unit
17178
17179 @item ^--all-subprograms^/SYNTAX_METRICS=ALL_SUBPROGRAMS_ON^
17180 Report the number of all the subprograms in a compilation unit
17181
17182 @item ^--no-all-subprograms^/SYNTAX_METRICS=ALL_SUBPROGRAMS_OFF^
17183 Do not report the number of all the subprograms in a compilation unit
17184
17185 @item ^--public-types^/SYNTAX_METRICS=PUBLIC_TYPES_ON^
17186 Report the number of public types in a compilation unit
17187
17188 @item ^--no-public-types^/SYNTAX_METRICS=PUBLIC_TYPES_OFF^
17189 Do not report the number of public types in a compilation unit
17190
17191 @item ^--all-types^/SYNTAX_METRICS=ALL_TYPES_ON^
17192 Report the number of all the types in a compilation unit
17193
17194 @item ^--no-all-types^/SYNTAX_METRICS=ALL_TYPES_OFF^
17195 Do not report the number of all the types in a compilation unit
17196
17197 @item ^--unit-nesting^/SYNTAX_METRICS=UNIT_NESTING_ON^
17198 Report the maximal program unit nesting level
17199
17200 @item ^--no-unit-nesting^/SYNTAX_METRICS=UNIT_NESTING_OFF^
17201 Do not report the maximal program unit nesting level
17202
17203 @item ^--construct-nesting^/SYNTAX_METRICS=CONSTRUCT_NESTING_ON^
17204 Report the maximal construct nesting level
17205
17206 @item ^--no-construct-nesting^/SYNTAX_METRICS=CONSTRUCT_NESTING_OFF^
17207 Do not report the maximal construct nesting level
17208
17209 @end table
17210
17211 @node Complexity Metrics Control
17212 @subsubsection Complexity Metrics Control
17213 @cindex Complexity metrics control in @command{gnatmetric}
17214
17215 @noindent
17216 For a program unit that is an executable body (a subprogram body (including
17217 generic bodies), task body, entry body or a package body containing
17218 its own statement sequence) @command{gnatmetric} computes the following
17219 complexity metrics:
17220
17221 @itemize @bullet
17222 @item
17223 McCabe cyclomatic complexity;
17224
17225 @item
17226 McCabe essential complexity;
17227
17228 @item
17229 maximal loop nesting level
17230
17231 @end itemize
17232
17233 @noindent
17234 The McCabe complexity metrics are defined
17235 in @url{http://www.mccabe.com/pdf/nist235r.pdf}
17236
17237 According to McCabe, both control statements and short-circuit control forms
17238 should be taken into account when computing cyclomatic complexity. For each
17239 body, we compute three metric values:
17240
17241 @itemize @bullet
17242 @item
17243 the complexity introduced by control
17244 statements only, without taking into account short-circuit forms,
17245
17246 @item
17247 the complexity introduced by short-circuit control forms only, and
17248
17249 @item
17250 the total
17251 cyclomatic complexity, which is the sum of these two values.
17252 @end itemize
17253
17254 @noindent
17255 When computing cyclomatic and essential complexity, @command{gnatmetric} skips
17256 the code in the exception handlers and in all the nested program units.
17257
17258 By default, all the complexity metrics are computed and reported.
17259 For more fine-grained control you can use
17260 the following switches:
17261
17262 @table @option
17263 @cindex @option{^-complexity@var{x}^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
17264
17265 @ifclear vms
17266 @cindex @option{--no-complexity@var{x}}
17267 @end ifclear
17268
17269 @item ^--complexity-all^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=ALL_ON^
17270 Report all the complexity metrics
17271
17272 @item ^--no-complexity-all^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=ALL_OFF^
17273 Do not report any of complexity metrics
17274
17275 @item ^--complexity-cyclomatic^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=CYCLOMATIC_ON^
17276 Report the McCabe Cyclomatic Complexity
17277
17278 @item ^--no-complexity-cyclomatic^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=CYCLOMATIC_OFF^
17279 Do not report the McCabe Cyclomatic Complexity
17280
17281 @item ^--complexity-essential^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=ESSENTIAL_ON^
17282 Report the Essential Complexity
17283
17284 @item ^--no-complexity-essential^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=ESSENTIAL_OFF^
17285 Do not report the Essential Complexity
17286
17287 @item ^--loop-nesting^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=LOOP_NESTING_ON^
17288 Report maximal loop nesting level
17289
17290 @item ^--no-loop-nesting^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=LOOP_NESTING_OFF^
17291 Do not report maximal loop nesting level
17292
17293 @item ^--complexity-average^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=AVERAGE_COMPLEXITY_ON^
17294 Report the average McCabe Cyclomatic Complexity for all the subprogram bodies,
17295 task bodies, entry bodies and statement sequences in package bodies.
17296 The metric is computed and reported for whole set of processed Ada sources
17297 only.
17298
17299 @item ^--no-complexity-average^/COMPLEXITY_METRICS=AVERAGE_COMPLEXITY_OFF^
17300 Do not report the average McCabe Cyclomatic Complexity for all the subprogram
17301 bodies, task bodies, entry bodies and statement sequences in package bodies
17302
17303 @cindex @option{^-ne^/NO_EXITS_AS_GOTOS^} (@command{gnatmetric})
17304 @item ^-ne^/NO_EXITS_AS_GOTOS^
17305 Do not consider @code{exit} statements as @code{goto}s when
17306 computing Essential Complexity
17307
17308 @end table
17309
17310
17311 @node Object-Oriented Metrics Control
17312 @subsubsection Object-Oriented Metrics Control
17313 @cindex Object-Oriented metrics control in @command{gnatmetric}
17314
17315 @noindent
17316 @cindex Coupling metrics (in in @command{gnatmetric})
17317 Coupling metrics are object-oriented metrics that measure the
17318 dependencies between a given class (or a group of classes) and the
17319 ``external world'' (that is, the other classes in the program). In this
17320 subsection the term ``class'' is used in its
17321 traditional object-oriented programming sense
17322 (an instantiable module that contains data and/or method members).
17323 A @emph{category} (of classes)
17324 is a group of closely related classes that are reused and/or
17325 modified together.
17326
17327 A class @code{K}'s @emph{efferent coupling} is the number of classes
17328 that @code{K} depends upon.
17329 A category's efferent coupling is the number of classes outside the
17330 category that the classes inside the category depend upon.
17331
17332 A class @code{K}'s @emph{afferent coupling} is the number of classes
17333 that depend upon @code{K}.
17334 A category's afferent coupling is the number of classes outside the
17335 category that depend on classes belonging to the category.
17336
17337 Ada's implementation of the object-oriented paradigm does not use the
17338 traditional class notion, so the definition of the coupling
17339 metrics for Ada maps the class and class category notions
17340 onto Ada constructs.
17341
17342 For the coupling metrics, several kinds of modules -- a library package,
17343 a library generic package, and a library generic package instantiation --
17344 that define a tagged type or an interface type are
17345 considered to be a class. A category consists of a library package (or
17346 a library generic package) that defines a tagged or an interface type,
17347 together with all its descendant (generic) packages that define tagged
17348 or interface types. For any package counted as a class,
17349 its body (if any) is considered
17350 together with its spec when counting the dependencies. For dependencies
17351 between classes, the Ada semantic dependencies are considered.
17352 For coupling metrics, only dependencies on units that are considered as
17353 classes, are considered.
17354
17355 When computing coupling metrics, @command{gnatmetric} counts only
17356 dependencies between units that are arguments of the gnatmetric call.
17357 Coupling metrics are program-wide (or project-wide) metrics, so to
17358 get a valid result, you should call @command{gnatmetric} for
17359 the whole set of sources that make up your program. It can be done
17360 by calling @command{gnatmetric} from the GNAT driver with @option{-U}
17361 option (see See @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files} for details.
17362
17363 By default, all the coupling metrics are disabled. You can use the following
17364 switches to specify the coupling metrics to be computed and reported:
17365
17366 @table @option
17367
17368 @ifclear vms
17369 @cindex @option{--package@var{x}} (@command{gnatmetric})
17370 @cindex @option{--no-package@var{x}} (@command{gnatmetric})
17371 @cindex @option{--category@var{x}} (@command{gnatmetric})
17372 @cindex @option{--no-category@var{x}} (@command{gnatmetric})
17373 @end ifclear
17374
17375 @ifset vms
17376 @cindex @option{/COUPLING_METRICS} (@command{gnatmetric})
17377 @end ifset
17378
17379 @item ^--coupling-all^/COUPLING_METRICS=ALL_ON^
17380 Report all the coupling metrics
17381
17382 @item ^--no-coupling-all^/COUPLING_METRICS=ALL_OFF^
17383 Do not report any of metrics
17384
17385 @item ^--package-efferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=PACKAGE_EFFERENT_ON^
17386 Report package efferent coupling
17387
17388 @item ^--no-package-efferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=PACKAGE_EFFERENT_OFF^
17389 Do not report package efferent coupling
17390
17391 @item ^--package-afferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=PACKAGE_AFFERENT_ON^
17392 Report package afferent coupling
17393
17394 @item ^--no-package-afferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=PACKAGE_AFFERENT_OFF^
17395 Do not report package afferent coupling
17396
17397 @item ^--category-efferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=CATEGORY_EFFERENT_ON^
17398 Report category efferent coupling
17399
17400 @item ^--no-category-efferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=CATEGORY_EFFERENT_OFF^
17401 Do not report category efferent coupling
17402
17403 @item ^--category-afferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=CATEGORY_AFFERENT_ON^
17404 Report category afferent coupling
17405
17406 @item ^--no-category-afferent-coupling^/COUPLING_METRICS=CATEGORY_AFFERENT_OFF^
17407 Do not report category afferent coupling
17408
17409 @end table
17410
17411 @node Other gnatmetric Switches
17412 @subsection Other @code{gnatmetric} Switches
17413
17414 @noindent
17415 Additional @command{gnatmetric} switches are as follows:
17416
17417 @table @option
17418 @item ^-files @var{filename}^/FILES=@var{filename}^
17419 @cindex @option{^-files^/FILES^} (@code{gnatmetric})
17420 Take the argument source files from the specified file. This file should be an
17421 ordinary text file containing file names separated by spaces or
17422 line breaks. You can use this switch more then once in the same call to
17423 @command{gnatmetric}. You also can combine this switch with
17424 an explicit list of files.
17425
17426 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
17427 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatmetric})
17428 Verbose mode;
17429 @command{gnatmetric} generates version information and then
17430 a trace of sources being processed.
17431
17432 @item ^-dv^/DEBUG_OUTPUT^
17433 @cindex @option{^-dv^/DEBUG_OUTPUT^} (@code{gnatmetric})
17434 Debug mode;
17435 @command{gnatmetric} generates various messages useful to understand what
17436 happens during the metrics computation
17437
17438 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
17439 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@code{gnatmetric})
17440 Quiet mode.
17441 @end table
17442
17443 @node Generate project-wide metrics
17444 @subsection Generate project-wide metrics
17445
17446 In order to compute metrics on all units of a given project, you can use
17447 the @command{gnat} driver along with the @option{-P} option:
17448 @smallexample
17449 gnat metric -Pproj
17450 @end smallexample
17451
17452 @noindent
17453 If the project @code{proj} depends upon other projects, you can compute
17454 the metrics on the project closure using the @option{-U} option:
17455 @smallexample
17456 gnat metric -Pproj -U
17457 @end smallexample
17458
17459 @noindent
17460 Finally, if not all the units are relevant to a particular main
17461 program in the project closure, you can generate metrics for the set
17462 of units needed to create a given main program (unit closure) using
17463 the @option{-U} option followed by the name of the main unit:
17464 @smallexample
17465 gnat metric -Pproj -U main
17466 @end smallexample
17467
17468
17469 @c ***********************************
17470 @node File Name Krunching Using gnatkr
17471 @chapter File Name Krunching Using @code{gnatkr}
17472 @findex gnatkr
17473
17474 @noindent
17475 This chapter discusses the method used by the compiler to shorten
17476 the default file names chosen for Ada units so that they do not
17477 exceed the maximum length permitted. It also describes the
17478 @code{gnatkr} utility that can be used to determine the result of
17479 applying this shortening.
17480 @menu
17481 * About gnatkr::
17482 * Using gnatkr::
17483 * Krunching Method::
17484 * Examples of gnatkr Usage::
17485 @end menu
17486
17487 @node About gnatkr
17488 @section About @code{gnatkr}
17489
17490 @noindent
17491 The default file naming rule in GNAT
17492 is that the file name must be derived from
17493 the unit name. The exact default rule is as follows:
17494 @itemize @bullet
17495 @item
17496 Take the unit name and replace all dots by hyphens.
17497 @item
17498 If such a replacement occurs in the
17499 second character position of a name, and the first character is
17500 ^@samp{a}, @samp{g}, @samp{s}, or @samp{i}, ^@samp{A}, @samp{G}, @samp{S}, or @samp{I},^
17501 then replace the dot by the character
17502 ^@samp{~} (tilde)^@samp{$} (dollar sign)^
17503 instead of a minus.
17504 @end itemize
17505 The reason for this exception is to avoid clashes
17506 with the standard names for children of System, Ada, Interfaces,
17507 and GNAT, which use the prefixes
17508 ^@samp{s-}, @samp{a-}, @samp{i-}, and @samp{g-},^@samp{S-}, @samp{A-}, @samp{I-}, and @samp{G-},^
17509 respectively.
17510
17511 The @option{^-gnatk^/FILE_NAME_MAX_LENGTH=^@var{nn}}
17512 switch of the compiler activates a ``krunching''
17513 circuit that limits file names to nn characters (where nn is a decimal
17514 integer). For example, using OpenVMS,
17515 where the maximum file name length is
17516 39, the value of nn is usually set to 39, but if you want to generate
17517 a set of files that would be usable if ported to a system with some
17518 different maximum file length, then a different value can be specified.
17519 The default value of 39 for OpenVMS need not be specified.
17520
17521 The @code{gnatkr} utility can be used to determine the krunched name for
17522 a given file, when krunched to a specified maximum length.
17523
17524 @node Using gnatkr
17525 @section Using @code{gnatkr}
17526
17527 @noindent
17528 The @code{gnatkr} command has the form
17529
17530 @ifclear vms
17531 @smallexample
17532 $ gnatkr @var{name} @ovar{length}
17533 @end smallexample
17534 @end ifclear
17535
17536 @ifset vms
17537 @smallexample
17538 $ gnatkr @var{name} /COUNT=nn
17539 @end smallexample
17540 @end ifset
17541
17542 @noindent
17543 @var{name} is the uncrunched file name, derived from the name of the unit
17544 in the standard manner described in the previous section (i.e., in particular
17545 all dots are replaced by hyphens). The file name may or may not have an
17546 extension (defined as a suffix of the form period followed by arbitrary
17547 characters other than period). If an extension is present then it will
17548 be preserved in the output. For example, when krunching @file{hellofile.ads}
17549 to eight characters, the result will be hellofil.ads.
17550
17551 Note: for compatibility with previous versions of @code{gnatkr} dots may
17552 appear in the name instead of hyphens, but the last dot will always be
17553 taken as the start of an extension. So if @code{gnatkr} is given an argument
17554 such as @file{Hello.World.adb} it will be treated exactly as if the first
17555 period had been a hyphen, and for example krunching to eight characters
17556 gives the result @file{hellworl.adb}.
17557
17558 Note that the result is always all lower case (except on OpenVMS where it is
17559 all upper case). Characters of the other case are folded as required.
17560
17561 @var{length} represents the length of the krunched name. The default
17562 when no argument is given is ^8^39^ characters. A length of zero stands for
17563 unlimited, in other words do not chop except for system files where the
17564 implied crunching length is always eight characters.
17565
17566 @noindent
17567 The output is the krunched name. The output has an extension only if the
17568 original argument was a file name with an extension.
17569
17570 @node Krunching Method
17571 @section Krunching Method
17572
17573 @noindent
17574 The initial file name is determined by the name of the unit that the file
17575 contains. The name is formed by taking the full expanded name of the
17576 unit and replacing the separating dots with hyphens and
17577 using ^lowercase^uppercase^
17578 for all letters, except that a hyphen in the second character position is
17579 replaced by a ^tilde^dollar sign^ if the first character is
17580 ^@samp{a}, @samp{i}, @samp{g}, or @samp{s}^@samp{A}, @samp{I}, @samp{G}, or @samp{S}^.
17581 The extension is @code{.ads} for a
17582 spec and @code{.adb} for a body.
17583 Krunching does not affect the extension, but the file name is shortened to
17584 the specified length by following these rules:
17585
17586 @itemize @bullet
17587 @item
17588 The name is divided into segments separated by hyphens, tildes or
17589 underscores and all hyphens, tildes, and underscores are
17590 eliminated. If this leaves the name short enough, we are done.
17591
17592 @item
17593 If the name is too long, the longest segment is located (left-most
17594 if there are two of equal length), and shortened by dropping
17595 its last character. This is repeated until the name is short enough.
17596
17597 As an example, consider the krunching of @*@file{our-strings-wide_fixed.adb}
17598 to fit the name into 8 characters as required by some operating systems.
17599
17600 @smallexample
17601 our-strings-wide_fixed 22
17602 our strings wide fixed 19
17603 our string wide fixed 18
17604 our strin wide fixed 17
17605 our stri wide fixed 16
17606 our stri wide fixe 15
17607 our str wide fixe 14
17608 our str wid fixe 13
17609 our str wid fix 12
17610 ou str wid fix 11
17611 ou st wid fix 10
17612 ou st wi fix 9
17613 ou st wi fi 8
17614 Final file name: oustwifi.adb
17615 @end smallexample
17616
17617 @item
17618 The file names for all predefined units are always krunched to eight
17619 characters. The krunching of these predefined units uses the following
17620 special prefix replacements:
17621
17622 @table @file
17623 @item ada-
17624 replaced by @file{^a^A^-}
17625
17626 @item gnat-
17627 replaced by @file{^g^G^-}
17628
17629 @item interfaces-
17630 replaced by @file{^i^I^-}
17631
17632 @item system-
17633 replaced by @file{^s^S^-}
17634 @end table
17635
17636 These system files have a hyphen in the second character position. That
17637 is why normal user files replace such a character with a
17638 ^tilde^dollar sign^, to
17639 avoid confusion with system file names.
17640
17641 As an example of this special rule, consider
17642 @*@file{ada-strings-wide_fixed.adb}, which gets krunched as follows:
17643
17644 @smallexample
17645 ada-strings-wide_fixed 22
17646 a- strings wide fixed 18
17647 a- string wide fixed 17
17648 a- strin wide fixed 16
17649 a- stri wide fixed 15
17650 a- stri wide fixe 14
17651 a- str wide fixe 13
17652 a- str wid fixe 12
17653 a- str wid fix 11
17654 a- st wid fix 10
17655 a- st wi fix 9
17656 a- st wi fi 8
17657 Final file name: a-stwifi.adb
17658 @end smallexample
17659 @end itemize
17660
17661 Of course no file shortening algorithm can guarantee uniqueness over all
17662 possible unit names, and if file name krunching is used then it is your
17663 responsibility to ensure that no name clashes occur. The utility
17664 program @code{gnatkr} is supplied for conveniently determining the
17665 krunched name of a file.
17666
17667 @node Examples of gnatkr Usage
17668 @section Examples of @code{gnatkr} Usage
17669
17670 @smallexample
17671 @iftex
17672 @leftskip=0cm
17673 @end iftex
17674 @ifclear vms
17675 $ gnatkr very_long_unit_name.ads --> velounna.ads
17676 $ gnatkr grandparent-parent-child.ads --> grparchi.ads
17677 $ gnatkr Grandparent.Parent.Child.ads --> grparchi.ads
17678 $ gnatkr grandparent-parent-child --> grparchi
17679 @end ifclear
17680 $ gnatkr very_long_unit_name.ads/count=6 --> vlunna.ads
17681 $ gnatkr very_long_unit_name.ads/count=0 --> very_long_unit_name.ads
17682 @end smallexample
17683
17684 @node Preprocessing Using gnatprep
17685 @chapter Preprocessing Using @code{gnatprep}
17686 @findex gnatprep
17687
17688 @noindent
17689 This chapter discusses how to use GNAT's @code{gnatprep} utility for simple
17690 preprocessing.
17691 Although designed for use with GNAT, @code{gnatprep} does not depend on any
17692 special GNAT features.
17693 For further discussion of conditional compilation in general, see
17694 @ref{Conditional Compilation}.
17695
17696 @menu
17697 * Preprocessing Symbols::
17698 * Using gnatprep::
17699 * Switches for gnatprep::
17700 * Form of Definitions File::
17701 * Form of Input Text for gnatprep::
17702 @end menu
17703
17704 @node Preprocessing Symbols
17705 @section Preprocessing Symbols
17706
17707 @noindent
17708 Preprocessing symbols are defined in definition files and referred to in
17709 sources to be preprocessed. A Preprocessing symbol is an identifier, following
17710 normal Ada (case-insensitive) rules for its syntax, with the restriction that
17711 all characters need to be in the ASCII set (no accented letters).
17712
17713 @node Using gnatprep
17714 @section Using @code{gnatprep}
17715
17716 @noindent
17717 To call @code{gnatprep} use
17718
17719 @smallexample
17720 $ gnatprep @ovar{switches} @var{infile} @var{outfile} @ovar{deffile}
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 @noindent
17724 where
17725 @table @var
17726 @item switches
17727 is an optional sequence of switches as described in the next section.
17728
17729 @item infile
17730 is the full name of the input file, which is an Ada source
17731 file containing preprocessor directives.
17732
17733 @item outfile
17734 is the full name of the output file, which is an Ada source
17735 in standard Ada form. When used with GNAT, this file name will
17736 normally have an ads or adb suffix.
17737
17738 @item deffile
17739 is the full name of a text file containing definitions of
17740 preprocessing symbols to be referenced by the preprocessor. This argument is
17741 optional, and can be replaced by the use of the @option{-D} switch.
17742
17743 @end table
17744
17745 @node Switches for gnatprep
17746 @section Switches for @code{gnatprep}
17747
17748 @table @option
17749 @c !sort!
17750
17751 @item ^-b^/BLANK_LINES^
17752 @cindex @option{^-b^/BLANK_LINES^} (@command{gnatprep})
17753 Causes both preprocessor lines and the lines deleted by
17754 preprocessing to be replaced by blank lines in the output source file,
17755 preserving line numbers in the output file.
17756
17757 @item ^-c^/COMMENTS^
17758 @cindex @option{^-c^/COMMENTS^} (@command{gnatprep})
17759 Causes both preprocessor lines and the lines deleted
17760 by preprocessing to be retained in the output source as comments marked
17761 with the special string @code{"--! "}. This option will result in line numbers
17762 being preserved in the output file.
17763
17764 @item ^-C^/REPLACE_IN_COMMENTS^
17765 @cindex @option{^-C^/REPLACE_IN_COMMENTS^} (@command{gnatprep})
17766 Causes comments to be scanned. Normally comments are ignored by gnatprep.
17767 If this option is specified, then comments are scanned and any $symbol
17768 substitutions performed as in program text. This is particularly useful
17769 when structured comments are used (e.g., when writing programs in the
17770 SPARK dialect of Ada). Note that this switch is not available when
17771 doing integrated preprocessing (it would be useless in this context
17772 since comments are ignored by the compiler in any case).
17773
17774 @item ^-Dsymbol=value^/ASSOCIATE="symbol=value"^
17775 @cindex @option{^-D^/ASSOCIATE^} (@command{gnatprep})
17776 Defines a new preprocessing symbol, associated with value. If no value is given
17777 on the command line, then symbol is considered to be @code{True}. This switch
17778 can be used in place of a definition file.
17779
17780 @ifset vms
17781 @item /REMOVE
17782 @cindex @option{/REMOVE} (@command{gnatprep})
17783 This is the default setting which causes lines deleted by preprocessing
17784 to be entirely removed from the output file.
17785 @end ifset
17786
17787 @item ^-r^/REFERENCE^
17788 @cindex @option{^-r^/REFERENCE^} (@command{gnatprep})
17789 Causes a @code{Source_Reference} pragma to be generated that
17790 references the original input file, so that error messages will use
17791 the file name of this original file. The use of this switch implies
17792 that preprocessor lines are not to be removed from the file, so its
17793 use will force @option{^-b^/BLANK_LINES^} mode if
17794 @option{^-c^/COMMENTS^}
17795 has not been specified explicitly.
17796
17797 Note that if the file to be preprocessed contains multiple units, then
17798 it will be necessary to @code{gnatchop} the output file from
17799 @code{gnatprep}. If a @code{Source_Reference} pragma is present
17800 in the preprocessed file, it will be respected by
17801 @code{gnatchop ^-r^/REFERENCE^}
17802 so that the final chopped files will correctly refer to the original
17803 input source file for @code{gnatprep}.
17804
17805 @item ^-s^/SYMBOLS^
17806 @cindex @option{^-s^/SYMBOLS^} (@command{gnatprep})
17807 Causes a sorted list of symbol names and values to be
17808 listed on the standard output file.
17809
17810 @item ^-u^/UNDEFINED^
17811 @cindex @option{^-u^/UNDEFINED^} (@command{gnatprep})
17812 Causes undefined symbols to be treated as having the value FALSE in the context
17813 of a preprocessor test. In the absence of this option, an undefined symbol in
17814 a @code{#if} or @code{#elsif} test will be treated as an error.
17815
17816 @end table
17817
17818 @ifclear vms
17819 @noindent
17820 Note: if neither @option{-b} nor @option{-c} is present,
17821 then preprocessor lines and
17822 deleted lines are completely removed from the output, unless -r is
17823 specified, in which case -b is assumed.
17824 @end ifclear
17825
17826 @node Form of Definitions File
17827 @section Form of Definitions File
17828
17829 @noindent
17830 The definitions file contains lines of the form
17831
17832 @smallexample
17833 symbol := value
17834 @end smallexample
17835
17836 @noindent
17837 where symbol is a preprocessing symbol, and value is one of the following:
17838
17839 @itemize @bullet
17840 @item
17841 Empty, corresponding to a null substitution
17842 @item
17843 A string literal using normal Ada syntax
17844 @item
17845 Any sequence of characters from the set
17846 (letters, digits, period, underline).
17847 @end itemize
17848
17849 @noindent
17850 Comment lines may also appear in the definitions file, starting with
17851 the usual @code{--},
17852 and comments may be added to the definitions lines.
17853
17854 @node Form of Input Text for gnatprep
17855 @section Form of Input Text for @code{gnatprep}
17856
17857 @noindent
17858 The input text may contain preprocessor conditional inclusion lines,
17859 as well as general symbol substitution sequences.
17860
17861 The preprocessor conditional inclusion commands have the form
17862
17863 @smallexample
17864 @group
17865 @cartouche
17866 #if @i{expression} @r{[}then@r{]}
17867 lines
17868 #elsif @i{expression} @r{[}then@r{]}
17869 lines
17870 #elsif @i{expression} @r{[}then@r{]}
17871 lines
17872 @dots{}
17873 #else
17874 lines
17875 #end if;
17876 @end cartouche
17877 @end group
17878 @end smallexample
17879
17880 @noindent
17881 In this example, @i{expression} is defined by the following grammar:
17882 @smallexample
17883 @i{expression} ::= <symbol>
17884 @i{expression} ::= <symbol> = "<value>"
17885 @i{expression} ::= <symbol> = <symbol>
17886 @i{expression} ::= <symbol> 'Defined
17887 @i{expression} ::= not @i{expression}
17888 @i{expression} ::= @i{expression} and @i{expression}
17889 @i{expression} ::= @i{expression} or @i{expression}
17890 @i{expression} ::= @i{expression} and then @i{expression}
17891 @i{expression} ::= @i{expression} or else @i{expression}
17892 @i{expression} ::= ( @i{expression} )
17893 @end smallexample
17894
17895 The following restriction exists: it is not allowed to have "and" or "or"
17896 following "not" in the same expression without parentheses. For example, this
17897 is not allowed:
17898
17899 @smallexample
17900 not X or Y
17901 @end smallexample
17902
17903 This should be one of the following:
17904
17905 @smallexample
17906 (not X) or Y
17907 not (X or Y)
17908 @end smallexample
17909
17910 @noindent
17911 For the first test (@i{expression} ::= <symbol>) the symbol must have
17912 either the value true or false, that is to say the right-hand of the
17913 symbol definition must be one of the (case-insensitive) literals
17914 @code{True} or @code{False}. If the value is true, then the
17915 corresponding lines are included, and if the value is false, they are
17916 excluded.
17917
17918 The test (@i{expression} ::= <symbol> @code{'Defined}) is true only if
17919 the symbol has been defined in the definition file or by a @option{-D}
17920 switch on the command line. Otherwise, the test is false.
17921
17922 The equality tests are case insensitive, as are all the preprocessor lines.
17923
17924 If the symbol referenced is not defined in the symbol definitions file,
17925 then the effect depends on whether or not switch @option{-u}
17926 is specified. If so, then the symbol is treated as if it had the value
17927 false and the test fails. If this switch is not specified, then
17928 it is an error to reference an undefined symbol. It is also an error to
17929 reference a symbol that is defined with a value other than @code{True}
17930 or @code{False}.
17931
17932 The use of the @code{not} operator inverts the sense of this logical test.
17933 The @code{not} operator cannot be combined with the @code{or} or @code{and}
17934 operators, without parentheses. For example, "if not X or Y then" is not
17935 allowed, but "if (not X) or Y then" and "if not (X or Y) then" are.
17936
17937 The @code{then} keyword is optional as shown
17938
17939 The @code{#} must be the first non-blank character on a line, but
17940 otherwise the format is free form. Spaces or tabs may appear between
17941 the @code{#} and the keyword. The keywords and the symbols are case
17942 insensitive as in normal Ada code. Comments may be used on a
17943 preprocessor line, but other than that, no other tokens may appear on a
17944 preprocessor line. Any number of @code{elsif} clauses can be present,
17945 including none at all. The @code{else} is optional, as in Ada.
17946
17947 The @code{#} marking the start of a preprocessor line must be the first
17948 non-blank character on the line, i.e., it must be preceded only by
17949 spaces or horizontal tabs.
17950
17951 Symbol substitution outside of preprocessor lines is obtained by using
17952 the sequence
17953
17954 @smallexample
17955 $symbol
17956 @end smallexample
17957
17958 @noindent
17959 anywhere within a source line, except in a comment or within a
17960 string literal. The identifier
17961 following the @code{$} must match one of the symbols defined in the symbol
17962 definition file, and the result is to substitute the value of the
17963 symbol in place of @code{$symbol} in the output file.
17964
17965 Note that although the substitution of strings within a string literal
17966 is not possible, it is possible to have a symbol whose defined value is
17967 a string literal. So instead of setting XYZ to @code{hello} and writing:
17968
17969 @smallexample
17970 Header : String := "$XYZ";
17971 @end smallexample
17972
17973 @noindent
17974 you should set XYZ to @code{"hello"} and write:
17975
17976 @smallexample
17977 Header : String := $XYZ;
17978 @end smallexample
17979
17980 @noindent
17981 and then the substitution will occur as desired.
17982
17983 @ifset vms
17984 @node The GNAT Run-Time Library Builder gnatlbr
17985 @chapter The GNAT Run-Time Library Builder @code{gnatlbr}
17986 @findex gnatlbr
17987 @cindex Library builder
17988
17989 @noindent
17990 @code{gnatlbr} is a tool for rebuilding the GNAT run time with user
17991 supplied configuration pragmas.
17992
17993 @menu
17994 * Running gnatlbr::
17995 * Switches for gnatlbr::
17996 * Examples of gnatlbr Usage::
17997 @end menu
17998
17999 @node Running gnatlbr
18000 @section Running @code{gnatlbr}
18001
18002 @noindent
18003 The @code{gnatlbr} command has the form
18004
18005 @smallexample
18006 $ GNAT LIBRARY /@r{[}CREATE@r{|}SET@r{|}DELETE@r{]}=directory @r{[}/CONFIG=file@r{]}
18007 @end smallexample
18008
18009 @node Switches for gnatlbr
18010 @section Switches for @code{gnatlbr}
18011
18012 @noindent
18013 @code{gnatlbr} recognizes the following switches:
18014
18015 @table @option
18016 @c !sort!
18017 @item /CREATE=directory
18018 @cindex @code{/CREATE} (@code{gnatlbr})
18019 Create the new run-time library in the specified directory.
18020
18021 @item /SET=directory
18022 @cindex @code{/SET} (@code{gnatlbr})
18023 Make the library in the specified directory the current run-time library.
18024
18025 @item /DELETE=directory
18026 @cindex @code{/DELETE} (@code{gnatlbr})
18027 Delete the run-time library in the specified directory.
18028
18029 @item /CONFIG=file
18030 @cindex @code{/CONFIG} (@code{gnatlbr})
18031 With /CREATE: Use the configuration pragmas in the specified file when
18032 building the library.
18033
18034 With /SET: Use the configuration pragmas in the specified file when
18035 compiling.
18036
18037 @end table
18038
18039 @node Examples of gnatlbr Usage
18040 @section Example of @code{gnatlbr} Usage
18041
18042 @smallexample
18043 Contents of VAXFLOAT.ADC:
18044 pragma Float_Representation (VAX_Float);
18045
18046 $ GNAT LIBRARY /CREATE=[.VAXFLOAT] /CONFIG=VAXFLOAT.ADC
18047
18048 GNAT LIBRARY rebuilds the run-time library in directory [.VAXFLOAT]
18049
18050 @end smallexample
18051 @end ifset
18052
18053 @node The GNAT Library Browser gnatls
18054 @chapter The GNAT Library Browser @code{gnatls}
18055 @findex gnatls
18056 @cindex Library browser
18057
18058 @noindent
18059 @code{gnatls} is a tool that outputs information about compiled
18060 units. It gives the relationship between objects, unit names and source
18061 files. It can also be used to check the source dependencies of a unit
18062 as well as various characteristics.
18063
18064 Note: to invoke @code{gnatls} with a project file, use the @code{gnat}
18065 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
18066
18067 @menu
18068 * Running gnatls::
18069 * Switches for gnatls::
18070 * Examples of gnatls Usage::
18071 @end menu
18072
18073 @node Running gnatls
18074 @section Running @code{gnatls}
18075
18076 @noindent
18077 The @code{gnatls} command has the form
18078
18079 @smallexample
18080 $ gnatls switches @var{object_or_ali_file}
18081 @end smallexample
18082
18083 @noindent
18084 The main argument is the list of object or @file{ali} files
18085 (@pxref{The Ada Library Information Files})
18086 for which information is requested.
18087
18088 In normal mode, without additional option, @code{gnatls} produces a
18089 four-column listing. Each line represents information for a specific
18090 object. The first column gives the full path of the object, the second
18091 column gives the name of the principal unit in this object, the third
18092 column gives the status of the source and the fourth column gives the
18093 full path of the source representing this unit.
18094 Here is a simple example of use:
18095
18096 @smallexample
18097 $ gnatls *.o
18098 ^./^[]^demo1.o demo1 DIF demo1.adb
18099 ^./^[]^demo2.o demo2 OK demo2.adb
18100 ^./^[]^hello.o h1 OK hello.adb
18101 ^./^[]^instr-child.o instr.child MOK instr-child.adb
18102 ^./^[]^instr.o instr OK instr.adb
18103 ^./^[]^tef.o tef DIF tef.adb
18104 ^./^[]^text_io_example.o text_io_example OK text_io_example.adb
18105 ^./^[]^tgef.o tgef DIF tgef.adb
18106 @end smallexample
18107
18108 @noindent
18109 The first line can be interpreted as follows: the main unit which is
18110 contained in
18111 object file @file{demo1.o} is demo1, whose main source is in
18112 @file{demo1.adb}. Furthermore, the version of the source used for the
18113 compilation of demo1 has been modified (DIF). Each source file has a status
18114 qualifier which can be:
18115
18116 @table @code
18117 @item OK (unchanged)
18118 The version of the source file used for the compilation of the
18119 specified unit corresponds exactly to the actual source file.
18120
18121 @item MOK (slightly modified)
18122 The version of the source file used for the compilation of the
18123 specified unit differs from the actual source file but not enough to
18124 require recompilation. If you use gnatmake with the qualifier
18125 @option{^-m (minimal recompilation)^/MINIMAL_RECOMPILATION^}, a file marked
18126 MOK will not be recompiled.
18127
18128 @item DIF (modified)
18129 No version of the source found on the path corresponds to the source
18130 used to build this object.
18131
18132 @item ??? (file not found)
18133 No source file was found for this unit.
18134
18135 @item HID (hidden, unchanged version not first on PATH)
18136 The version of the source that corresponds exactly to the source used
18137 for compilation has been found on the path but it is hidden by another
18138 version of the same source that has been modified.
18139
18140 @end table
18141
18142 @node Switches for gnatls
18143 @section Switches for @code{gnatls}
18144
18145 @noindent
18146 @code{gnatls} recognizes the following switches:
18147
18148 @table @option
18149 @c !sort!
18150 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatls}
18151 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
18152
18153 @item --help
18154 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatls}
18155 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
18156 all other options.
18157
18158 @item ^-a^/ALL_UNITS^
18159 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL_UNITS^} (@code{gnatls})
18160 Consider all units, including those of the predefined Ada library.
18161 Especially useful with @option{^-d^/DEPENDENCIES^}.
18162
18163 @item ^-d^/DEPENDENCIES^
18164 @cindex @option{^-d^/DEPENDENCIES^} (@code{gnatls})
18165 List sources from which specified units depend on.
18166
18167 @item ^-h^/OUTPUT=OPTIONS^
18168 @cindex @option{^-h^/OUTPUT=OPTIONS^} (@code{gnatls})
18169 Output the list of options.
18170
18171 @item ^-o^/OUTPUT=OBJECTS^
18172 @cindex @option{^-o^/OUTPUT=OBJECTS^} (@code{gnatls})
18173 Only output information about object files.
18174
18175 @item ^-s^/OUTPUT=SOURCES^
18176 @cindex @option{^-s^/OUTPUT=SOURCES^} (@code{gnatls})
18177 Only output information about source files.
18178
18179 @item ^-u^/OUTPUT=UNITS^
18180 @cindex @option{^-u^/OUTPUT=UNITS^} (@code{gnatls})
18181 Only output information about compilation units.
18182
18183 @item ^-files^/FILES^=@var{file}
18184 @cindex @option{^-files^/FILES^} (@code{gnatls})
18185 Take as arguments the files listed in text file @var{file}.
18186 Text file @var{file} may contain empty lines that are ignored.
18187 Each nonempty line should contain the name of an existing file.
18188 Several such switches may be specified simultaneously.
18189
18190 @item ^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
18191 @itemx ^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
18192 @itemx ^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}
18193 @itemx ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
18194 @itemx -nostdinc
18195 @cindex @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^} (@code{gnatls})
18196 @cindex @option{^-aI^/SOURCE_SEARCH^} (@code{gnatls})
18197 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@code{gnatls})
18198 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@code{gnatls})
18199 Source path manipulation. Same meaning as the equivalent @command{gnatmake}
18200 flags (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
18201
18202 @item --RTS=@var{rts-path}
18203 @cindex @option{--RTS} (@code{gnatls})
18204 Specifies the default location of the runtime library. Same meaning as the
18205 equivalent @command{gnatmake} flag (@pxref{Switches for gnatmake}).
18206
18207 @item ^-v^/OUTPUT=VERBOSE^
18208 @cindex @option{^-v^/OUTPUT=VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatls})
18209 Verbose mode. Output the complete source, object and project paths. Do not use
18210 the default column layout but instead use long format giving as much as
18211 information possible on each requested units, including special
18212 characteristics such as:
18213
18214 @table @code
18215 @item Preelaborable
18216 The unit is preelaborable in the Ada sense.
18217
18218 @item No_Elab_Code
18219 No elaboration code has been produced by the compiler for this unit.
18220
18221 @item Pure
18222 The unit is pure in the Ada sense.
18223
18224 @item Elaborate_Body
18225 The unit contains a pragma Elaborate_Body.
18226
18227 @item Remote_Types
18228 The unit contains a pragma Remote_Types.
18229
18230 @item Shared_Passive
18231 The unit contains a pragma Shared_Passive.
18232
18233 @item Predefined
18234 This unit is part of the predefined environment and cannot be modified
18235 by the user.
18236
18237 @item Remote_Call_Interface
18238 The unit contains a pragma Remote_Call_Interface.
18239
18240 @end table
18241
18242 @end table
18243
18244 @node Examples of gnatls Usage
18245 @section Example of @code{gnatls} Usage
18246 @ifclear vms
18247
18248 @noindent
18249 Example of using the verbose switch. Note how the source and
18250 object paths are affected by the -I switch.
18251
18252 @smallexample
18253 $ gnatls -v -I.. demo1.o
18254
18255 GNATLS 5.03w (20041123-34)
18256 Copyright 1997-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18257
18258 Source Search Path:
18259 <Current_Directory>
18260 ../
18261 /home/comar/local/adainclude/
18262
18263 Object Search Path:
18264 <Current_Directory>
18265 ../
18266 /home/comar/local/lib/gcc-lib/x86-linux/3.4.3/adalib/
18267
18268 Project Search Path:
18269 <Current_Directory>
18270 /home/comar/local/lib/gnat/
18271
18272 ./demo1.o
18273 Unit =>
18274 Name => demo1
18275 Kind => subprogram body
18276 Flags => No_Elab_Code
18277 Source => demo1.adb modified
18278 @end smallexample
18279
18280 @noindent
18281 The following is an example of use of the dependency list.
18282 Note the use of the -s switch
18283 which gives a straight list of source files. This can be useful for
18284 building specialized scripts.
18285
18286 @smallexample
18287 $ gnatls -d demo2.o
18288 ./demo2.o demo2 OK demo2.adb
18289 OK gen_list.ads
18290 OK gen_list.adb
18291 OK instr.ads
18292 OK instr-child.ads
18293
18294 $ gnatls -d -s -a demo1.o
18295 demo1.adb
18296 /home/comar/local/adainclude/ada.ads
18297 /home/comar/local/adainclude/a-finali.ads
18298 /home/comar/local/adainclude/a-filico.ads
18299 /home/comar/local/adainclude/a-stream.ads
18300 /home/comar/local/adainclude/a-tags.ads
18301 gen_list.ads
18302 gen_list.adb
18303 /home/comar/local/adainclude/gnat.ads
18304 /home/comar/local/adainclude/g-io.ads
18305 instr.ads
18306 /home/comar/local/adainclude/system.ads
18307 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-exctab.ads
18308 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-finimp.ads
18309 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-finroo.ads
18310 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-secsta.ads
18311 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-stalib.ads
18312 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-stoele.ads
18313 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-stratt.ads
18314 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-tasoli.ads
18315 /home/comar/local/adainclude/s-unstyp.ads
18316 /home/comar/local/adainclude/unchconv.ads
18317 @end smallexample
18318 @end ifclear
18319
18320 @ifset vms
18321 @smallexample
18322 GNAT LIST /DEPENDENCIES /OUTPUT=SOURCES /ALL_UNITS DEMO1.ADB
18323
18324 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]ada.ads
18325 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]a-finali.ads
18326 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]a-filico.ads
18327 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]a-stream.ads
18328 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]a-tags.ads
18329 demo1.adb
18330 gen_list.ads
18331 gen_list.adb
18332 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]gnat.ads
18333 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]g-io.ads
18334 instr.ads
18335 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]system.ads
18336 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-exctab.ads
18337 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-finimp.ads
18338 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-finroo.ads
18339 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-secsta.ads
18340 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-stalib.ads
18341 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-stoele.ads
18342 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-stratt.ads
18343 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-tasoli.ads
18344 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]s-unstyp.ads
18345 GNU:[LIB.OPENVMS7_1.2_8_1.ADALIB]unchconv.ads
18346 @end smallexample
18347 @end ifset
18348
18349 @node Cleaning Up Using gnatclean
18350 @chapter Cleaning Up Using @code{gnatclean}
18351 @findex gnatclean
18352 @cindex Cleaning tool
18353
18354 @noindent
18355 @code{gnatclean} is a tool that allows the deletion of files produced by the
18356 compiler, binder and linker, including ALI files, object files, tree files,
18357 expanded source files, library files, interface copy source files, binder
18358 generated files and executable files.
18359
18360 @menu
18361 * Running gnatclean::
18362 * Switches for gnatclean::
18363 @c * Examples of gnatclean Usage::
18364 @end menu
18365
18366 @node Running gnatclean
18367 @section Running @code{gnatclean}
18368
18369 @noindent
18370 The @code{gnatclean} command has the form:
18371
18372 @smallexample
18373 $ gnatclean switches @var{names}
18374 @end smallexample
18375
18376 @noindent
18377 @var{names} is a list of source file names. Suffixes @code{.^ads^ADS^} and
18378 @code{^adb^ADB^} may be omitted. If a project file is specified using switch
18379 @code{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^}, then @var{names} may be completely omitted.
18380
18381 @noindent
18382 In normal mode, @code{gnatclean} delete the files produced by the compiler and,
18383 if switch @code{^-c^/COMPILER_FILES_ONLY^} is not specified, by the binder and
18384 the linker. In informative-only mode, specified by switch
18385 @code{^-n^/NODELETE^}, the list of files that would have been deleted in
18386 normal mode is listed, but no file is actually deleted.
18387
18388 @node Switches for gnatclean
18389 @section Switches for @code{gnatclean}
18390
18391 @noindent
18392 @code{gnatclean} recognizes the following switches:
18393
18394 @table @option
18395 @c !sort!
18396 @cindex @option{--version} @command{gnatclean}
18397 Display Copyright and version, then exit disregarding all other options.
18398
18399 @item --help
18400 @cindex @option{--help} @command{gnatclean}
18401 If @option{--version} was not used, display usage, then exit disregarding
18402 all other options.
18403
18404 @item ^-c^/COMPILER_FILES_ONLY^
18405 @cindex @option{^-c^/COMPILER_FILES_ONLY^} (@code{gnatclean})
18406 Only attempt to delete the files produced by the compiler, not those produced
18407 by the binder or the linker. The files that are not to be deleted are library
18408 files, interface copy files, binder generated files and executable files.
18409
18410 @item ^-D ^/DIRECTORY_OBJECTS=^@var{dir}
18411 @cindex @option{^-D^/DIRECTORY_OBJECTS^} (@code{gnatclean})
18412 Indicate that ALI and object files should normally be found in directory
18413 @var{dir}.
18414
18415 @item ^-F^/FULL_PATH_IN_BRIEF_MESSAGES^
18416 @cindex @option{^-F^/FULL_PATH_IN_BRIEF_MESSAGES^} (@code{gnatclean})
18417 When using project files, if some errors or warnings are detected during
18418 parsing and verbose mode is not in effect (no use of switch
18419 ^-v^/VERBOSE^), then error lines start with the full path name of the project
18420 file, rather than its simple file name.
18421
18422 @item ^-h^/HELP^
18423 @cindex @option{^-h^/HELP^} (@code{gnatclean})
18424 Output a message explaining the usage of @code{^gnatclean^gnatclean^}.
18425
18426 @item ^-n^/NODELETE^
18427 @cindex @option{^-n^/NODELETE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18428 Informative-only mode. Do not delete any files. Output the list of the files
18429 that would have been deleted if this switch was not specified.
18430
18431 @item ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^@var{project}
18432 @cindex @option{^-P^/PROJECT_FILE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18433 Use project file @var{project}. Only one such switch can be used.
18434 When cleaning a project file, the files produced by the compilation of the
18435 immediate sources or inherited sources of the project files are to be
18436 deleted. This is not depending on the presence or not of executable names
18437 on the command line.
18438
18439 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
18440 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@code{gnatclean})
18441 Quiet output. If there are no errors, do not output anything, except in
18442 verbose mode (switch ^-v^/VERBOSE^) or in informative-only mode
18443 (switch ^-n^/NODELETE^).
18444
18445 @item ^-r^/RECURSIVE^
18446 @cindex @option{^-r^/RECURSIVE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18447 When a project file is specified (using switch ^-P^/PROJECT_FILE=^),
18448 clean all imported and extended project files, recursively. If this switch
18449 is not specified, only the files related to the main project file are to be
18450 deleted. This switch has no effect if no project file is specified.
18451
18452 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
18453 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18454 Verbose mode.
18455
18456 @item ^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE=^@emph{x}
18457 @cindex @option{^-vP^/MESSAGES_PROJECT_FILE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18458 Indicates the verbosity of the parsing of GNAT project files.
18459 @xref{Switches Related to Project Files}.
18460
18461 @item ^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE=^@var{name=value}
18462 @cindex @option{^-X^/EXTERNAL_REFERENCE^} (@code{gnatclean})
18463 Indicates that external variable @var{name} has the value @var{value}.
18464 The Project Manager will use this value for occurrences of
18465 @code{external(name)} when parsing the project file.
18466 @xref{Switches Related to Project Files}.
18467
18468 @item ^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^@var{dir}
18469 @cindex @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH^} (@code{gnatclean})
18470 When searching for ALI and object files, look in directory
18471 @var{dir}.
18472
18473 @item ^-I^/SEARCH=^@var{dir}
18474 @cindex @option{^-I^/SEARCH^} (@code{gnatclean})
18475 Equivalent to @option{^-aO^/OBJECT_SEARCH=^@var{dir}}.
18476
18477 @item ^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^
18478 @cindex @option{^-I-^/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY^} (@code{gnatclean})
18479 @cindex Source files, suppressing search
18480 Do not look for ALI or object files in the directory
18481 where @code{gnatclean} was invoked.
18482
18483 @end table
18484
18485 @c @node Examples of gnatclean Usage
18486 @c @section Examples of @code{gnatclean} Usage
18487
18488 @ifclear vms
18489 @node GNAT and Libraries
18490 @chapter GNAT and Libraries
18491 @cindex Library, building, installing, using
18492
18493 @noindent
18494 This chapter describes how to build and use libraries with GNAT, and also shows
18495 how to recompile the GNAT run-time library. You should be familiar with the
18496 Project Manager facility (@pxref{GNAT Project Manager}) before reading this
18497 chapter.
18498
18499 @menu
18500 * Introduction to Libraries in GNAT::
18501 * General Ada Libraries::
18502 * Stand-alone Ada Libraries::
18503 * Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library::
18504 @end menu
18505
18506 @node Introduction to Libraries in GNAT
18507 @section Introduction to Libraries in GNAT
18508
18509 @noindent
18510 A library is, conceptually, a collection of objects which does not have its
18511 own main thread of execution, but rather provides certain services to the
18512 applications that use it. A library can be either statically linked with the
18513 application, in which case its code is directly included in the application,
18514 or, on platforms that support it, be dynamically linked, in which case
18515 its code is shared by all applications making use of this library.
18516
18517 GNAT supports both types of libraries.
18518 In the static case, the compiled code can be provided in different ways. The
18519 simplest approach is to provide directly the set of objects resulting from
18520 compilation of the library source files. Alternatively, you can group the
18521 objects into an archive using whatever commands are provided by the operating
18522 system. For the latter case, the objects are grouped into a shared library.
18523
18524 In the GNAT environment, a library has three types of components:
18525 @itemize @bullet
18526 @item
18527 Source files.
18528 @item
18529 @file{ALI} files.
18530 @xref{The Ada Library Information Files}.
18531 @item
18532 Object files, an archive or a shared library.
18533 @end itemize
18534
18535 @noindent
18536 A GNAT library may expose all its source files, which is useful for
18537 documentation purposes. Alternatively, it may expose only the units needed by
18538 an external user to make use of the library. That is to say, the specs
18539 reflecting the library services along with all the units needed to compile
18540 those specs, which can include generic bodies or any body implementing an
18541 inlined routine. In the case of @emph{stand-alone libraries} those exposed
18542 units are called @emph{interface units} (@pxref{Stand-alone Ada Libraries}).
18543
18544 All compilation units comprising an application, including those in a library,
18545 need to be elaborated in an order partially defined by Ada's semantics. GNAT
18546 computes the elaboration order from the @file{ALI} files and this is why they
18547 constitute a mandatory part of GNAT libraries. Except in the case of
18548 @emph{stand-alone libraries}, where a specific library elaboration routine is
18549 produced independently of the application(s) using the library.
18550
18551 @node General Ada Libraries
18552 @section General Ada Libraries
18553
18554 @menu
18555 * Building a library::
18556 * Installing a library::
18557 * Using a library::
18558 @end menu
18559
18560 @node Building a library
18561 @subsection Building a library
18562
18563 @noindent
18564 The easiest way to build a library is to use the Project Manager,
18565 which supports a special type of project called a @emph{Library Project}
18566 (@pxref{Library Projects}).
18567
18568 A project is considered a library project, when two project-level attributes
18569 are defined in it: @code{Library_Name} and @code{Library_Dir}. In order to
18570 control different aspects of library configuration, additional optional
18571 project-level attributes can be specified:
18572 @table @code
18573 @item Library_Kind
18574 This attribute controls whether the library is to be static or dynamic
18575
18576 @item Library_Version
18577 This attribute specifies the library version; this value is used
18578 during dynamic linking of shared libraries to determine if the currently
18579 installed versions of the binaries are compatible.
18580
18581 @item Library_Options
18582 @item Library_GCC
18583 These attributes specify additional low-level options to be used during
18584 library generation, and redefine the actual application used to generate
18585 library.
18586 @end table
18587
18588 @noindent
18589 The GNAT Project Manager takes full care of the library maintenance task,
18590 including recompilation of the source files for which objects do not exist
18591 or are not up to date, assembly of the library archive, and installation of
18592 the library (i.e., copying associated source, object and @file{ALI} files
18593 to the specified location).
18594
18595 Here is a simple library project file:
18596 @smallexample @c ada
18597 project My_Lib is
18598 for Source_Dirs use ("src1", "src2");
18599 for Object_Dir use "obj";
18600 for Library_Name use "mylib";
18601 for Library_Dir use "lib";
18602 for Library_Kind use "dynamic";
18603 end My_lib;
18604 @end smallexample
18605
18606 @noindent
18607 and the compilation command to build and install the library:
18608
18609 @smallexample @c ada
18610 $ gnatmake -Pmy_lib
18611 @end smallexample
18612
18613 @noindent
18614 It is not entirely trivial to perform manually all the steps required to
18615 produce a library. We recommend that you use the GNAT Project Manager
18616 for this task. In special cases where this is not desired, the necessary
18617 steps are discussed below.
18618
18619 There are various possibilities for compiling the units that make up the
18620 library: for example with a Makefile (@pxref{Using the GNU make Utility}) or
18621 with a conventional script. For simple libraries, it is also possible to create
18622 a dummy main program which depends upon all the packages that comprise the
18623 interface of the library. This dummy main program can then be given to
18624 @command{gnatmake}, which will ensure that all necessary objects are built.
18625
18626 After this task is accomplished, you should follow the standard procedure
18627 of the underlying operating system to produce the static or shared library.
18628
18629 Here is an example of such a dummy program:
18630 @smallexample @c ada
18631 @group
18632 with My_Lib.Service1;
18633 with My_Lib.Service2;
18634 with My_Lib.Service3;
18635 procedure My_Lib_Dummy is
18636 begin
18637 null;
18638 end;
18639 @end group
18640 @end smallexample
18641
18642 @noindent
18643 Here are the generic commands that will build an archive or a shared library.
18644
18645 @smallexample
18646 # compiling the library
18647 $ gnatmake -c my_lib_dummy.adb
18648
18649 # we don't need the dummy object itself
18650 $ rm my_lib_dummy.o my_lib_dummy.ali
18651
18652 # create an archive with the remaining objects
18653 $ ar rc libmy_lib.a *.o
18654 # some systems may require "ranlib" to be run as well
18655
18656 # or create a shared library
18657 $ gcc -shared -o libmy_lib.so *.o
18658 # some systems may require the code to have been compiled with -fPIC
18659
18660 # remove the object files that are now in the library
18661 $ rm *.o
18662
18663 # Make the ALI files read-only so that gnatmake will not try to
18664 # regenerate the objects that are in the library
18665 $ chmod -w *.ali
18666 @end smallexample
18667
18668 @noindent
18669 Please note that the library must have a name of the form @file{lib@var{xxx}.a}
18670 or @file{lib@var{xxx}.so} (or @file{lib@var{xxx}.dll} on Windows) in order to
18671 be accessed by the directive @option{-l@var{xxx}} at link time.
18672
18673 @node Installing a library
18674 @subsection Installing a library
18675 @cindex @code{ADA_PROJECT_PATH}
18676
18677 @noindent
18678 If you use project files, library installation is part of the library build
18679 process. Thus no further action is needed in order to make use of the
18680 libraries that are built as part of the general application build. A usable
18681 version of the library is installed in the directory specified by the
18682 @code{Library_Dir} attribute of the library project file.
18683
18684 You may want to install a library in a context different from where the library
18685 is built. This situation arises with third party suppliers, who may want
18686 to distribute a library in binary form where the user is not expected to be
18687 able to recompile the library. The simplest option in this case is to provide
18688 a project file slightly different from the one used to build the library, by
18689 using the @code{externally_built} attribute. For instance, the project
18690 file used to build the library in the previous section can be changed into the
18691 following one when the library is installed:
18692
18693 @smallexample @c projectfile
18694 project My_Lib is
18695 for Source_Dirs use ("src1", "src2");
18696 for Library_Name use "mylib";
18697 for Library_Dir use "lib";
18698 for Library_Kind use "dynamic";
18699 for Externally_Built use "true";
18700 end My_lib;
18701 @end smallexample
18702
18703 @noindent
18704 This project file assumes that the directories @file{src1},
18705 @file{src2}, and @file{lib} exist in
18706 the directory containing the project file. The @code{externally_built}
18707 attribute makes it clear to the GNAT builder that it should not attempt to
18708 recompile any of the units from this library. It allows the library provider to
18709 restrict the source set to the minimum necessary for clients to make use of the
18710 library as described in the first section of this chapter. It is the
18711 responsibility of the library provider to install the necessary sources, ALI
18712 files and libraries in the directories mentioned in the project file. For
18713 convenience, the user's library project file should be installed in a location
18714 that will be searched automatically by the GNAT
18715 builder. These are the directories referenced in the @env{ADA_PROJECT_PATH}
18716 environment variable (@pxref{Importing Projects}), and also the default GNAT
18717 library location that can be queried with @command{gnatls -v} and is usually of
18718 the form $gnat_install_root/lib/gnat.
18719
18720 When project files are not an option, it is also possible, but not recommended,
18721 to install the library so that the sources needed to use the library are on the
18722 Ada source path and the ALI files & libraries be on the Ada Object path (see
18723 @ref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}. Alternatively, the system
18724 administrator can place general-purpose libraries in the default compiler
18725 paths, by specifying the libraries' location in the configuration files
18726 @file{ada_source_path} and @file{ada_object_path}. These configuration files
18727 must be located in the GNAT installation tree at the same place as the gcc spec
18728 file. The location of the gcc spec file can be determined as follows:
18729 @smallexample
18730 $ gcc -v
18731 @end smallexample
18732
18733 @noindent
18734 The configuration files mentioned above have a simple format: each line
18735 must contain one unique directory name.
18736 Those names are added to the corresponding path
18737 in their order of appearance in the file. The names can be either absolute
18738 or relative; in the latter case, they are relative to where theses files
18739 are located.
18740
18741 The files @file{ada_source_path} and @file{ada_object_path} might not be
18742 present in a
18743 GNAT installation, in which case, GNAT will look for its run-time library in
18744 the directories @file{adainclude} (for the sources) and @file{adalib} (for the
18745 objects and @file{ALI} files). When the files exist, the compiler does not
18746 look in @file{adainclude} and @file{adalib}, and thus the
18747 @file{ada_source_path} file
18748 must contain the location for the GNAT run-time sources (which can simply
18749 be @file{adainclude}). In the same way, the @file{ada_object_path} file must
18750 contain the location for the GNAT run-time objects (which can simply
18751 be @file{adalib}).
18752
18753 You can also specify a new default path to the run-time library at compilation
18754 time with the switch @option{--RTS=rts-path}. You can thus choose / change
18755 the run-time library you want your program to be compiled with. This switch is
18756 recognized by @command{gcc}, @command{gnatmake}, @command{gnatbind},
18757 @command{gnatls}, @command{gnatfind} and @command{gnatxref}.
18758
18759 It is possible to install a library before or after the standard GNAT
18760 library, by reordering the lines in the configuration files. In general, a
18761 library must be installed before the GNAT library if it redefines
18762 any part of it.
18763
18764 @node Using a library
18765 @subsection Using a library
18766
18767 @noindent Once again, the project facility greatly simplifies the use of
18768 libraries. In this context, using a library is just a matter of adding a
18769 @code{with} clause in the user project. For instance, to make use of the
18770 library @code{My_Lib} shown in examples in earlier sections, you can
18771 write:
18772
18773 @smallexample @c projectfile
18774 with "my_lib";
18775 project My_Proj is
18776 @dots{}
18777 end My_Proj;
18778 @end smallexample
18779
18780 Even if you have a third-party, non-Ada library, you can still use GNAT's
18781 Project Manager facility to provide a wrapper for it. For example, the
18782 following project, when @code{with}ed by your main project, will link with the
18783 third-party library @file{liba.a}:
18784
18785 @smallexample @c projectfile
18786 @group
18787 project Liba is
18788 for Externally_Built use "true";
18789 for Source_Files use ();
18790 for Library_Dir use "lib";
18791 for Library_Name use "a";
18792 for Library_Kind use "static";
18793 end Liba;
18794 @end group
18795 @end smallexample
18796 This is an alternative to the use of @code{pragma Linker_Options}. It is
18797 especially interesting in the context of systems with several interdependent
18798 static libraries where finding a proper linker order is not easy and best be
18799 left to the tools having visibility over project dependence information.
18800
18801 @noindent
18802 In order to use an Ada library manually, you need to make sure that this
18803 library is on both your source and object path
18804 (see @ref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}
18805 and @ref{Search Paths for gnatbind}). Furthermore, when the objects are grouped
18806 in an archive or a shared library, you need to specify the desired
18807 library at link time.
18808
18809 For example, you can use the library @file{mylib} installed in
18810 @file{/dir/my_lib_src} and @file{/dir/my_lib_obj} with the following commands:
18811
18812 @smallexample
18813 $ gnatmake -aI/dir/my_lib_src -aO/dir/my_lib_obj my_appl \
18814 -largs -lmy_lib
18815 @end smallexample
18816
18817 @noindent
18818 This can be expressed more simply:
18819 @smallexample
18820 $ gnatmake my_appl
18821 @end smallexample
18822 @noindent
18823 when the following conditions are met:
18824 @itemize @bullet
18825 @item
18826 @file{/dir/my_lib_src} has been added by the user to the environment
18827 variable @env{ADA_INCLUDE_PATH}, or by the administrator to the file
18828 @file{ada_source_path}
18829 @item
18830 @file{/dir/my_lib_obj} has been added by the user to the environment
18831 variable @env{ADA_OBJECTS_PATH}, or by the administrator to the file
18832 @file{ada_object_path}
18833 @item
18834 a pragma @code{Linker_Options} has been added to one of the sources.
18835 For example:
18836
18837 @smallexample @c ada
18838 pragma Linker_Options ("-lmy_lib");
18839 @end smallexample
18840 @end itemize
18841
18842 @node Stand-alone Ada Libraries
18843 @section Stand-alone Ada Libraries
18844 @cindex Stand-alone library, building, using
18845
18846 @menu
18847 * Introduction to Stand-alone Libraries::
18848 * Building a Stand-alone Library::
18849 * Creating a Stand-alone Library to be used in a non-Ada context::
18850 * Restrictions in Stand-alone Libraries::
18851 @end menu
18852
18853 @node Introduction to Stand-alone Libraries
18854 @subsection Introduction to Stand-alone Libraries
18855
18856 @noindent
18857 A Stand-alone Library (abbreviated ``SAL'') is a library that contains the
18858 necessary code to
18859 elaborate the Ada units that are included in the library. In contrast with
18860 an ordinary library, which consists of all sources, objects and @file{ALI}
18861 files of the
18862 library, a SAL may specify a restricted subset of compilation units
18863 to serve as a library interface. In this case, the fully
18864 self-sufficient set of files will normally consist of an objects
18865 archive, the sources of interface units' specs, and the @file{ALI}
18866 files of interface units.
18867 If an interface spec contains a generic unit or an inlined subprogram,
18868 the body's
18869 source must also be provided; if the units that must be provided in the source
18870 form depend on other units, the source and @file{ALI} files of those must
18871 also be provided.
18872
18873 The main purpose of a SAL is to minimize the recompilation overhead of client
18874 applications when a new version of the library is installed. Specifically,
18875 if the interface sources have not changed, client applications do not need to
18876 be recompiled. If, furthermore, a SAL is provided in the shared form and its
18877 version, controlled by @code{Library_Version} attribute, is not changed,
18878 then the clients do not need to be relinked.
18879
18880 SALs also allow the library providers to minimize the amount of library source
18881 text exposed to the clients. Such ``information hiding'' might be useful or
18882 necessary for various reasons.
18883
18884 Stand-alone libraries are also well suited to be used in an executable whose
18885 main routine is not written in Ada.
18886
18887 @node Building a Stand-alone Library
18888 @subsection Building a Stand-alone Library
18889
18890 @noindent
18891 GNAT's Project facility provides a simple way of building and installing
18892 stand-alone libraries; see @ref{Stand-alone Library Projects}.
18893 To be a Stand-alone Library Project, in addition to the two attributes
18894 that make a project a Library Project (@code{Library_Name} and
18895 @code{Library_Dir}; see @ref{Library Projects}), the attribute
18896 @code{Library_Interface} must be defined. For example:
18897
18898 @smallexample @c projectfile
18899 @group
18900 for Library_Dir use "lib_dir";
18901 for Library_Name use "dummy";
18902 for Library_Interface use ("int1", "int1.child");
18903 @end group
18904 @end smallexample
18905
18906 @noindent
18907 Attribute @code{Library_Interface} has a non-empty string list value,
18908 each string in the list designating a unit contained in an immediate source
18909 of the project file.
18910
18911 When a Stand-alone Library is built, first the binder is invoked to build
18912 a package whose name depends on the library name
18913 (@file{^b~dummy.ads/b^B$DUMMY.ADS/B^} in the example above).
18914 This binder-generated package includes initialization and
18915 finalization procedures whose
18916 names depend on the library name (@code{dummyinit} and @code{dummyfinal}
18917 in the example
18918 above). The object corresponding to this package is included in the library.
18919
18920 You must ensure timely (e.g., prior to any use of interfaces in the SAL)
18921 calling of these procedures if a static SAL is built, or if a shared SAL
18922 is built
18923 with the project-level attribute @code{Library_Auto_Init} set to
18924 @code{"false"}.
18925
18926 For a Stand-Alone Library, only the @file{ALI} files of the Interface Units
18927 (those that are listed in attribute @code{Library_Interface}) are copied to
18928 the Library Directory. As a consequence, only the Interface Units may be
18929 imported from Ada units outside of the library. If other units are imported,
18930 the binding phase will fail.
18931
18932 The attribute @code{Library_Src_Dir} may be specified for a
18933 Stand-Alone Library. @code{Library_Src_Dir} is a simple attribute that has a
18934 single string value. Its value must be the path (absolute or relative to the
18935 project directory) of an existing directory. This directory cannot be the
18936 object directory or one of the source directories, but it can be the same as
18937 the library directory. The sources of the Interface
18938 Units of the library that are needed by an Ada client of the library will be
18939 copied to the designated directory, called the Interface Copy directory.
18940 These sources include the specs of the Interface Units, but they may also
18941 include bodies and subunits, when pragmas @code{Inline} or @code{Inline_Always}
18942 are used, or when there is a generic unit in the spec. Before the sources
18943 are copied to the Interface Copy directory, an attempt is made to delete all
18944 files in the Interface Copy directory.
18945
18946 Building stand-alone libraries by hand is somewhat tedious, but for those
18947 occasions when it is necessary here are the steps that you need to perform:
18948 @itemize @bullet
18949 @item
18950 Compile all library sources.
18951
18952 @item
18953 Invoke the binder with the switch @option{-n} (No Ada main program),
18954 with all the @file{ALI} files of the interfaces, and
18955 with the switch @option{-L} to give specific names to the @code{init}
18956 and @code{final} procedures. For example:
18957 @smallexample
18958 gnatbind -n int1.ali int2.ali -Lsal1
18959 @end smallexample
18960
18961 @item
18962 Compile the binder generated file:
18963 @smallexample
18964 gcc -c b~int2.adb
18965 @end smallexample
18966
18967 @item
18968 Link the dynamic library with all the necessary object files,
18969 indicating to the linker the names of the @code{init} (and possibly
18970 @code{final}) procedures for automatic initialization (and finalization).
18971 The built library should be placed in a directory different from
18972 the object directory.
18973
18974 @item
18975 Copy the @code{ALI} files of the interface to the library directory,
18976 add in this copy an indication that it is an interface to a SAL
18977 (i.e., add a word @option{SL} on the line in the @file{ALI} file that starts
18978 with letter ``P'') and make the modified copy of the @file{ALI} file
18979 read-only.
18980 @end itemize
18981
18982 @noindent
18983 Using SALs is not different from using other libraries
18984 (see @ref{Using a library}).
18985
18986 @node Creating a Stand-alone Library to be used in a non-Ada context
18987 @subsection Creating a Stand-alone Library to be used in a non-Ada context
18988
18989 @noindent
18990 It is easy to adapt the SAL build procedure discussed above for use of a SAL in
18991 a non-Ada context.
18992
18993 The only extra step required is to ensure that library interface subprograms
18994 are compatible with the main program, by means of @code{pragma Export}
18995 or @code{pragma Convention}.
18996
18997 Here is an example of simple library interface for use with C main program:
18998
18999 @smallexample @c ada
19000 package Interface is
19001
19002 procedure Do_Something;
19003 pragma Export (C, Do_Something, "do_something");
19004
19005 procedure Do_Something_Else;
19006 pragma Export (C, Do_Something_Else, "do_something_else");
19007
19008 end Interface;
19009 @end smallexample
19010
19011 @noindent
19012 On the foreign language side, you must provide a ``foreign'' view of the
19013 library interface; remember that it should contain elaboration routines in
19014 addition to interface subprograms.
19015
19016 The example below shows the content of @code{mylib_interface.h} (note
19017 that there is no rule for the naming of this file, any name can be used)
19018 @smallexample
19019 /* the library elaboration procedure */
19020 extern void mylibinit (void);
19021
19022 /* the library finalization procedure */
19023 extern void mylibfinal (void);
19024
19025 /* the interface exported by the library */
19026 extern void do_something (void);
19027 extern void do_something_else (void);
19028 @end smallexample
19029
19030 @noindent
19031 Libraries built as explained above can be used from any program, provided
19032 that the elaboration procedures (named @code{mylibinit} in the previous
19033 example) are called before the library services are used. Any number of
19034 libraries can be used simultaneously, as long as the elaboration
19035 procedure of each library is called.
19036
19037 Below is an example of a C program that uses the @code{mylib} library.
19038
19039 @smallexample
19040 #include "mylib_interface.h"
19041
19042 int
19043 main (void)
19044 @{
19045 /* First, elaborate the library before using it */
19046 mylibinit ();
19047
19048 /* Main program, using the library exported entities */
19049 do_something ();
19050 do_something_else ();
19051
19052 /* Library finalization at the end of the program */
19053 mylibfinal ();
19054 return 0;
19055 @}
19056 @end smallexample
19057
19058 @noindent
19059 Note that invoking any library finalization procedure generated by
19060 @code{gnatbind} shuts down the Ada run-time environment.
19061 Consequently, the
19062 finalization of all Ada libraries must be performed at the end of the program.
19063 No call to these libraries or to the Ada run-time library should be made
19064 after the finalization phase.
19065
19066 @node Restrictions in Stand-alone Libraries
19067 @subsection Restrictions in Stand-alone Libraries
19068
19069 @noindent
19070 The pragmas listed below should be used with caution inside libraries,
19071 as they can create incompatibilities with other Ada libraries:
19072 @itemize @bullet
19073 @item pragma @code{Locking_Policy}
19074 @item pragma @code{Queuing_Policy}
19075 @item pragma @code{Task_Dispatching_Policy}
19076 @item pragma @code{Unreserve_All_Interrupts}
19077 @end itemize
19078
19079 @noindent
19080 When using a library that contains such pragmas, the user must make sure
19081 that all libraries use the same pragmas with the same values. Otherwise,
19082 @code{Program_Error} will
19083 be raised during the elaboration of the conflicting
19084 libraries. The usage of these pragmas and its consequences for the user
19085 should therefore be well documented.
19086
19087 Similarly, the traceback in the exception occurrence mechanism should be
19088 enabled or disabled in a consistent manner across all libraries.
19089 Otherwise, Program_Error will be raised during the elaboration of the
19090 conflicting libraries.
19091
19092 If the @code{Version} or @code{Body_Version}
19093 attributes are used inside a library, then you need to
19094 perform a @code{gnatbind} step that specifies all @file{ALI} files in all
19095 libraries, so that version identifiers can be properly computed.
19096 In practice these attributes are rarely used, so this is unlikely
19097 to be a consideration.
19098
19099 @node Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library
19100 @section Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library
19101 @cindex GNAT Run-Time Library, rebuilding
19102 @cindex Building the GNAT Run-Time Library
19103 @cindex Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library
19104 @cindex Run-Time Library, rebuilding
19105
19106 @noindent
19107 It may be useful to recompile the GNAT library in various contexts, the
19108 most important one being the use of partition-wide configuration pragmas
19109 such as @code{Normalize_Scalars}. A special Makefile called
19110 @code{Makefile.adalib} is provided to that effect and can be found in
19111 the directory containing the GNAT library. The location of this
19112 directory depends on the way the GNAT environment has been installed and can
19113 be determined by means of the command:
19114
19115 @smallexample
19116 $ gnatls -v
19117 @end smallexample
19118
19119 @noindent
19120 The last entry in the object search path usually contains the
19121 gnat library. This Makefile contains its own documentation and in
19122 particular the set of instructions needed to rebuild a new library and
19123 to use it.
19124
19125 @node Using the GNU make Utility
19126 @chapter Using the GNU @code{make} Utility
19127 @findex make
19128
19129 @noindent
19130 This chapter offers some examples of makefiles that solve specific
19131 problems. It does not explain how to write a makefile (@pxref{Top,, GNU
19132 make, make, GNU @code{make}}), nor does it try to replace the
19133 @command{gnatmake} utility (@pxref{The GNAT Make Program gnatmake}).
19134
19135 All the examples in this section are specific to the GNU version of
19136 make. Although @command{make} is a standard utility, and the basic language
19137 is the same, these examples use some advanced features found only in
19138 @code{GNU make}.
19139
19140 @menu
19141 * Using gnatmake in a Makefile::
19142 * Automatically Creating a List of Directories::
19143 * Generating the Command Line Switches::
19144 * Overcoming Command Line Length Limits::
19145 @end menu
19146
19147 @node Using gnatmake in a Makefile
19148 @section Using gnatmake in a Makefile
19149 @findex makefile
19150 @cindex GNU make
19151
19152 @noindent
19153 Complex project organizations can be handled in a very powerful way by
19154 using GNU make combined with gnatmake. For instance, here is a Makefile
19155 which allows you to build each subsystem of a big project into a separate
19156 shared library. Such a makefile allows you to significantly reduce the link
19157 time of very big applications while maintaining full coherence at
19158 each step of the build process.
19159
19160 The list of dependencies are handled automatically by
19161 @command{gnatmake}. The Makefile is simply used to call gnatmake in each of
19162 the appropriate directories.
19163
19164 Note that you should also read the example on how to automatically
19165 create the list of directories
19166 (@pxref{Automatically Creating a List of Directories})
19167 which might help you in case your project has a lot of subdirectories.
19168
19169 @smallexample
19170 @iftex
19171 @leftskip=0cm
19172 @font@heightrm=cmr8
19173 @heightrm
19174 @end iftex
19175 ## This Makefile is intended to be used with the following directory
19176 ## configuration:
19177 ## - The sources are split into a series of csc (computer software components)
19178 ## Each of these csc is put in its own directory.
19179 ## Their name are referenced by the directory names.
19180 ## They will be compiled into shared library (although this would also work
19181 ## with static libraries
19182 ## - The main program (and possibly other packages that do not belong to any
19183 ## csc is put in the top level directory (where the Makefile is).
19184 ## toplevel_dir __ first_csc (sources) __ lib (will contain the library)
19185 ## \_ second_csc (sources) __ lib (will contain the library)
19186 ## \_ @dots{}
19187 ## Although this Makefile is build for shared library, it is easy to modify
19188 ## to build partial link objects instead (modify the lines with -shared and
19189 ## gnatlink below)
19190 ##
19191 ## With this makefile, you can change any file in the system or add any new
19192 ## file, and everything will be recompiled correctly (only the relevant shared
19193 ## objects will be recompiled, and the main program will be re-linked).
19194
19195 # The list of computer software component for your project. This might be
19196 # generated automatically.
19197 CSC_LIST=aa bb cc
19198
19199 # Name of the main program (no extension)
19200 MAIN=main
19201
19202 # If we need to build objects with -fPIC, uncomment the following line
19203 #NEED_FPIC=-fPIC
19204
19205 # The following variable should give the directory containing libgnat.so
19206 # You can get this directory through 'gnatls -v'. This is usually the last
19207 # directory in the Object_Path.
19208 GLIB=@dots{}
19209
19210 # The directories for the libraries
19211 # (This macro expands the list of CSC to the list of shared libraries, you
19212 # could simply use the expanded form:
19213 # LIB_DIR=aa/lib/libaa.so bb/lib/libbb.so cc/lib/libcc.so
19214 LIB_DIR=$@{foreach dir,$@{CSC_LIST@},$@{dir@}/lib/lib$@{dir@}.so@}
19215
19216 $@{MAIN@}: objects $@{LIB_DIR@}
19217 gnatbind $@{MAIN@} $@{CSC_LIST:%=-aO%/lib@} -shared
19218 gnatlink $@{MAIN@} $@{CSC_LIST:%=-l%@}
19219
19220 objects::
19221 # recompile the sources
19222 gnatmake -c -i $@{MAIN@}.adb $@{NEED_FPIC@} $@{CSC_LIST:%=-I%@}
19223
19224 # Note: In a future version of GNAT, the following commands will be simplified
19225 # by a new tool, gnatmlib
19226 $@{LIB_DIR@}:
19227 mkdir -p $@{dir $@@ @}
19228 cd $@{dir $@@ @} && gcc -shared -o $@{notdir $@@ @} ../*.o -L$@{GLIB@} -lgnat
19229 cd $@{dir $@@ @} && cp -f ../*.ali .
19230
19231 # The dependencies for the modules
19232 # Note that we have to force the expansion of *.o, since in some cases
19233 # make won't be able to do it itself.
19234 aa/lib/libaa.so: $@{wildcard aa/*.o@}
19235 bb/lib/libbb.so: $@{wildcard bb/*.o@}
19236 cc/lib/libcc.so: $@{wildcard cc/*.o@}
19237
19238 # Make sure all of the shared libraries are in the path before starting the
19239 # program
19240 run::
19241 LD_LIBRARY_PATH=`pwd`/aa/lib:`pwd`/bb/lib:`pwd`/cc/lib ./$@{MAIN@}
19242
19243 clean::
19244 $@{RM@} -rf $@{CSC_LIST:%=%/lib@}
19245 $@{RM@} $@{CSC_LIST:%=%/*.ali@}
19246 $@{RM@} $@{CSC_LIST:%=%/*.o@}
19247 $@{RM@} *.o *.ali $@{MAIN@}
19248 @end smallexample
19249
19250 @node Automatically Creating a List of Directories
19251 @section Automatically Creating a List of Directories
19252
19253 @noindent
19254 In most makefiles, you will have to specify a list of directories, and
19255 store it in a variable. For small projects, it is often easier to
19256 specify each of them by hand, since you then have full control over what
19257 is the proper order for these directories, which ones should be
19258 included.
19259
19260 However, in larger projects, which might involve hundreds of
19261 subdirectories, it might be more convenient to generate this list
19262 automatically.
19263
19264 The example below presents two methods. The first one, although less
19265 general, gives you more control over the list. It involves wildcard
19266 characters, that are automatically expanded by @command{make}. Its
19267 shortcoming is that you need to explicitly specify some of the
19268 organization of your project, such as for instance the directory tree
19269 depth, whether some directories are found in a separate tree, @enddots{}
19270
19271 The second method is the most general one. It requires an external
19272 program, called @command{find}, which is standard on all Unix systems. All
19273 the directories found under a given root directory will be added to the
19274 list.
19275
19276 @smallexample
19277 @iftex
19278 @leftskip=0cm
19279 @font@heightrm=cmr8
19280 @heightrm
19281 @end iftex
19282 # The examples below are based on the following directory hierarchy:
19283 # All the directories can contain any number of files
19284 # ROOT_DIRECTORY -> a -> aa -> aaa
19285 # -> ab
19286 # -> ac
19287 # -> b -> ba -> baa
19288 # -> bb
19289 # -> bc
19290 # This Makefile creates a variable called DIRS, that can be reused any time
19291 # you need this list (see the other examples in this section)
19292
19293 # The root of your project's directory hierarchy
19294 ROOT_DIRECTORY=.
19295
19296 ####
19297 # First method: specify explicitly the list of directories
19298 # This allows you to specify any subset of all the directories you need.
19299 ####
19300
19301 DIRS := a/aa/ a/ab/ b/ba/
19302
19303 ####
19304 # Second method: use wildcards
19305 # Note that the argument(s) to wildcard below should end with a '/'.
19306 # Since wildcards also return file names, we have to filter them out
19307 # to avoid duplicate directory names.
19308 # We thus use make's @code{dir} and @code{sort} functions.
19309 # It sets DIRs to the following value (note that the directories aaa and baa
19310 # are not given, unless you change the arguments to wildcard).
19311 # DIRS= ./a/a/ ./b/ ./a/aa/ ./a/ab/ ./a/ac/ ./b/ba/ ./b/bb/ ./b/bc/
19312 ####
19313
19314 DIRS := $@{sort $@{dir $@{wildcard $@{ROOT_DIRECTORY@}/*/
19315 $@{ROOT_DIRECTORY@}/*/*/@}@}@}
19316
19317 ####
19318 # Third method: use an external program
19319 # This command is much faster if run on local disks, avoiding NFS slowdowns.
19320 # This is the most complete command: it sets DIRs to the following value:
19321 # DIRS= ./a ./a/aa ./a/aa/aaa ./a/ab ./a/ac ./b ./b/ba ./b/ba/baa ./b/bb ./b/bc
19322 ####
19323
19324 DIRS := $@{shell find $@{ROOT_DIRECTORY@} -type d -print@}
19325
19326 @end smallexample
19327
19328 @node Generating the Command Line Switches
19329 @section Generating the Command Line Switches
19330
19331 @noindent
19332 Once you have created the list of directories as explained in the
19333 previous section (@pxref{Automatically Creating a List of Directories}),
19334 you can easily generate the command line arguments to pass to gnatmake.
19335
19336 For the sake of completeness, this example assumes that the source path
19337 is not the same as the object path, and that you have two separate lists
19338 of directories.
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 # see "Automatically creating a list of directories" to create
19342 # these variables
19343 SOURCE_DIRS=
19344 OBJECT_DIRS=
19345
19346 GNATMAKE_SWITCHES := $@{patsubst %,-aI%,$@{SOURCE_DIRS@}@}
19347 GNATMAKE_SWITCHES += $@{patsubst %,-aO%,$@{OBJECT_DIRS@}@}
19348
19349 all:
19350 gnatmake $@{GNATMAKE_SWITCHES@} main_unit
19351 @end smallexample
19352
19353 @node Overcoming Command Line Length Limits
19354 @section Overcoming Command Line Length Limits
19355
19356 @noindent
19357 One problem that might be encountered on big projects is that many
19358 operating systems limit the length of the command line. It is thus hard to give
19359 gnatmake the list of source and object directories.
19360
19361 This example shows how you can set up environment variables, which will
19362 make @command{gnatmake} behave exactly as if the directories had been
19363 specified on the command line, but have a much higher length limit (or
19364 even none on most systems).
19365
19366 It assumes that you have created a list of directories in your Makefile,
19367 using one of the methods presented in
19368 @ref{Automatically Creating a List of Directories}.
19369 For the sake of completeness, we assume that the object
19370 path (where the ALI files are found) is different from the sources patch.
19371
19372 Note a small trick in the Makefile below: for efficiency reasons, we
19373 create two temporary variables (SOURCE_LIST and OBJECT_LIST), that are
19374 expanded immediately by @code{make}. This way we overcome the standard
19375 make behavior which is to expand the variables only when they are
19376 actually used.
19377
19378 On Windows, if you are using the standard Windows command shell, you must
19379 replace colons with semicolons in the assignments to these variables.
19380
19381 @smallexample
19382 @iftex
19383 @leftskip=0cm
19384 @font@heightrm=cmr8
19385 @heightrm
19386 @end iftex
19387 # In this example, we create both ADA_INCLUDE_PATH and ADA_OBJECT_PATH.
19388 # This is the same thing as putting the -I arguments on the command line.
19389 # (the equivalent of using -aI on the command line would be to define
19390 # only ADA_INCLUDE_PATH, the equivalent of -aO is ADA_OBJECT_PATH).
19391 # You can of course have different values for these variables.
19392 #
19393 # Note also that we need to keep the previous values of these variables, since
19394 # they might have been set before running 'make' to specify where the GNAT
19395 # library is installed.
19396
19397 # see "Automatically creating a list of directories" to create these
19398 # variables
19399 SOURCE_DIRS=
19400 OBJECT_DIRS=
19401
19402 empty:=
19403 space:=$@{empty@} $@{empty@}
19404 SOURCE_LIST := $@{subst $@{space@},:,$@{SOURCE_DIRS@}@}
19405 OBJECT_LIST := $@{subst $@{space@},:,$@{OBJECT_DIRS@}@}
19406 ADA_INCLUDE_PATH += $@{SOURCE_LIST@}
19407 ADA_OBJECT_PATH += $@{OBJECT_LIST@}
19408 export ADA_INCLUDE_PATH
19409 export ADA_OBJECT_PATH
19410
19411 all:
19412 gnatmake main_unit
19413 @end smallexample
19414 @end ifclear
19415
19416 @node Memory Management Issues
19417 @chapter Memory Management Issues
19418
19419 @noindent
19420 This chapter describes some useful memory pools provided in the GNAT library
19421 and in particular the GNAT Debug Pool facility, which can be used to detect
19422 incorrect uses of access values (including ``dangling references'').
19423 @ifclear vms
19424 It also describes the @command{gnatmem} tool, which can be used to track down
19425 ``memory leaks''.
19426 @end ifclear
19427
19428 @menu
19429 * Some Useful Memory Pools::
19430 * The GNAT Debug Pool Facility::
19431 @ifclear vms
19432 * The gnatmem Tool::
19433 @end ifclear
19434 @end menu
19435
19436 @node Some Useful Memory Pools
19437 @section Some Useful Memory Pools
19438 @findex Memory Pool
19439 @cindex storage, pool
19440
19441 @noindent
19442 The @code{System.Pool_Global} package offers the Unbounded_No_Reclaim_Pool
19443 storage pool. Allocations use the standard system call @code{malloc} while
19444 deallocations use the standard system call @code{free}. No reclamation is
19445 performed when the pool goes out of scope. For performance reasons, the
19446 standard default Ada allocators/deallocators do not use any explicit storage
19447 pools but if they did, they could use this storage pool without any change in
19448 behavior. That is why this storage pool is used when the user
19449 manages to make the default implicit allocator explicit as in this example:
19450 @smallexample @c ada
19451 type T1 is access Something;
19452 -- no Storage pool is defined for T2
19453 type T2 is access Something_Else;
19454 for T2'Storage_Pool use T1'Storage_Pool;
19455 -- the above is equivalent to
19456 for T2'Storage_Pool use System.Pool_Global.Global_Pool_Object;
19457 @end smallexample
19458
19459 @noindent
19460 The @code{System.Pool_Local} package offers the Unbounded_Reclaim_Pool storage
19461 pool. The allocation strategy is similar to @code{Pool_Local}'s
19462 except that the all
19463 storage allocated with this pool is reclaimed when the pool object goes out of
19464 scope. This pool provides a explicit mechanism similar to the implicit one
19465 provided by several Ada 83 compilers for allocations performed through a local
19466 access type and whose purpose was to reclaim memory when exiting the
19467 scope of a given local access. As an example, the following program does not
19468 leak memory even though it does not perform explicit deallocation:
19469
19470 @smallexample @c ada
19471 with System.Pool_Local;
19472 procedure Pooloc1 is
19473 procedure Internal is
19474 type A is access Integer;
19475 X : System.Pool_Local.Unbounded_Reclaim_Pool;
19476 for A'Storage_Pool use X;
19477 v : A;
19478 begin
19479 for I in 1 .. 50 loop
19480 v := new Integer;
19481 end loop;
19482 end Internal;
19483 begin
19484 for I in 1 .. 100 loop
19485 Internal;
19486 end loop;
19487 end Pooloc1;
19488 @end smallexample
19489
19490 @noindent
19491 The @code{System.Pool_Size} package implements the Stack_Bounded_Pool used when
19492 @code{Storage_Size} is specified for an access type.
19493 The whole storage for the pool is
19494 allocated at once, usually on the stack at the point where the access type is
19495 elaborated. It is automatically reclaimed when exiting the scope where the
19496 access type is defined. This package is not intended to be used directly by the
19497 user and it is implicitly used for each such declaration:
19498
19499 @smallexample @c ada
19500 type T1 is access Something;
19501 for T1'Storage_Size use 10_000;
19502 @end smallexample
19503
19504 @node The GNAT Debug Pool Facility
19505 @section The GNAT Debug Pool Facility
19506 @findex Debug Pool
19507 @cindex storage, pool, memory corruption
19508
19509 @noindent
19510 The use of unchecked deallocation and unchecked conversion can easily
19511 lead to incorrect memory references. The problems generated by such
19512 references are usually difficult to tackle because the symptoms can be
19513 very remote from the origin of the problem. In such cases, it is
19514 very helpful to detect the problem as early as possible. This is the
19515 purpose of the Storage Pool provided by @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools}.
19516
19517 In order to use the GNAT specific debugging pool, the user must
19518 associate a debug pool object with each of the access types that may be
19519 related to suspected memory problems. See Ada Reference Manual 13.11.
19520 @smallexample @c ada
19521 type Ptr is access Some_Type;
19522 Pool : GNAT.Debug_Pools.Debug_Pool;
19523 for Ptr'Storage_Pool use Pool;
19524 @end smallexample
19525
19526 @noindent
19527 @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools} is derived from a GNAT-specific kind of
19528 pool: the @code{Checked_Pool}. Such pools, like standard Ada storage pools,
19529 allow the user to redefine allocation and deallocation strategies. They
19530 also provide a checkpoint for each dereference, through the use of
19531 the primitive operation @code{Dereference} which is implicitly called at
19532 each dereference of an access value.
19533
19534 Once an access type has been associated with a debug pool, operations on
19535 values of the type may raise four distinct exceptions,
19536 which correspond to four potential kinds of memory corruption:
19537 @itemize @bullet
19538 @item
19539 @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools.Accessing_Not_Allocated_Storage}
19540 @item
19541 @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools.Accessing_Deallocated_Storage}
19542 @item
19543 @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools.Freeing_Not_Allocated_Storage}
19544 @item
19545 @code{GNAT.Debug_Pools.Freeing_Deallocated_Storage }
19546 @end itemize
19547
19548 @noindent
19549 For types associated with a Debug_Pool, dynamic allocation is performed using
19550 the standard GNAT allocation routine. References to all allocated chunks of
19551 memory are kept in an internal dictionary. Several deallocation strategies are
19552 provided, whereupon the user can choose to release the memory to the system,
19553 keep it allocated for further invalid access checks, or fill it with an easily
19554 recognizable pattern for debug sessions. The memory pattern is the old IBM
19555 hexadecimal convention: @code{16#DEADBEEF#}.
19556
19557 See the documentation in the file g-debpoo.ads for more information on the
19558 various strategies.
19559
19560 Upon each dereference, a check is made that the access value denotes a
19561 properly allocated memory location. Here is a complete example of use of
19562 @code{Debug_Pools}, that includes typical instances of memory corruption:
19563 @smallexample @c ada
19564 @iftex
19565 @leftskip=0cm
19566 @end iftex
19567 with Gnat.Io; use Gnat.Io;
19568 with Unchecked_Deallocation;
19569 with Unchecked_Conversion;
19570 with GNAT.Debug_Pools;
19571 with System.Storage_Elements;
19572 with Ada.Exceptions; use Ada.Exceptions;
19573 procedure Debug_Pool_Test is
19574
19575 type T is access Integer;
19576 type U is access all T;
19577
19578 P : GNAT.Debug_Pools.Debug_Pool;
19579 for T'Storage_Pool use P;
19580
19581 procedure Free is new Unchecked_Deallocation (Integer, T);
19582 function UC is new Unchecked_Conversion (U, T);
19583 A, B : aliased T;
19584
19585 procedure Info is new GNAT.Debug_Pools.Print_Info(Put_Line);
19586
19587 begin
19588 Info (P);
19589 A := new Integer;
19590 B := new Integer;
19591 B := A;
19592 Info (P);
19593 Free (A);
19594 begin
19595 Put_Line (Integer'Image(B.all));
19596 exception
19597 when E : others => Put_Line ("raised: " & Exception_Name (E));
19598 end;
19599 begin
19600 Free (B);
19601 exception
19602 when E : others => Put_Line ("raised: " & Exception_Name (E));
19603 end;
19604 B := UC(A'Access);
19605 begin
19606 Put_Line (Integer'Image(B.all));
19607 exception
19608 when E : others => Put_Line ("raised: " & Exception_Name (E));
19609 end;
19610 begin
19611 Free (B);
19612 exception
19613 when E : others => Put_Line ("raised: " & Exception_Name (E));
19614 end;
19615 Info (P);
19616 end Debug_Pool_Test;
19617 @end smallexample
19618
19619 @noindent
19620 The debug pool mechanism provides the following precise diagnostics on the
19621 execution of this erroneous program:
19622 @smallexample
19623 Debug Pool info:
19624 Total allocated bytes : 0
19625 Total deallocated bytes : 0
19626 Current Water Mark: 0
19627 High Water Mark: 0
19628
19629 Debug Pool info:
19630 Total allocated bytes : 8
19631 Total deallocated bytes : 0
19632 Current Water Mark: 8
19633 High Water Mark: 8
19634
19635 raised: GNAT.DEBUG_POOLS.ACCESSING_DEALLOCATED_STORAGE
19636 raised: GNAT.DEBUG_POOLS.FREEING_DEALLOCATED_STORAGE
19637 raised: GNAT.DEBUG_POOLS.ACCESSING_NOT_ALLOCATED_STORAGE
19638 raised: GNAT.DEBUG_POOLS.FREEING_NOT_ALLOCATED_STORAGE
19639 Debug Pool info:
19640 Total allocated bytes : 8
19641 Total deallocated bytes : 4
19642 Current Water Mark: 4
19643 High Water Mark: 8
19644 @end smallexample
19645
19646 @ifclear vms
19647 @node The gnatmem Tool
19648 @section The @command{gnatmem} Tool
19649 @findex gnatmem
19650
19651 @noindent
19652 The @code{gnatmem} utility monitors dynamic allocation and
19653 deallocation activity in a program, and displays information about
19654 incorrect deallocations and possible sources of memory leaks.
19655 It provides three type of information:
19656 @itemize @bullet
19657 @item
19658 General information concerning memory management, such as the total
19659 number of allocations and deallocations, the amount of allocated
19660 memory and the high water mark, i.e.@: the largest amount of allocated
19661 memory in the course of program execution.
19662
19663 @item
19664 Backtraces for all incorrect deallocations, that is to say deallocations
19665 which do not correspond to a valid allocation.
19666
19667 @item
19668 Information on each allocation that is potentially the origin of a memory
19669 leak.
19670 @end itemize
19671
19672 @menu
19673 * Running gnatmem::
19674 * Switches for gnatmem::
19675 * Example of gnatmem Usage::
19676 @end menu
19677
19678 @node Running gnatmem
19679 @subsection Running @code{gnatmem}
19680
19681 @noindent
19682 @code{gnatmem} makes use of the output created by the special version of
19683 allocation and deallocation routines that record call information. This
19684 allows to obtain accurate dynamic memory usage history at a minimal cost to
19685 the execution speed. Note however, that @code{gnatmem} is not supported on
19686 all platforms (currently, it is supported on AIX, HP-UX, GNU/Linux,
19687 Solaris and Windows NT/2000/XP (x86).
19688
19689 @noindent
19690 The @code{gnatmem} command has the form
19691
19692 @smallexample
19693 $ gnatmem @ovar{switches} user_program
19694 @end smallexample
19695
19696 @noindent
19697 The program must have been linked with the instrumented version of the
19698 allocation and deallocation routines. This is done by linking with the
19699 @file{libgmem.a} library. For correct symbolic backtrace information,
19700 the user program should be compiled with debugging options
19701 (see @ref{Switches for gcc}). For example to build @file{my_program}:
19702
19703 @smallexample
19704 $ gnatmake -g my_program -largs -lgmem
19705 @end smallexample
19706
19707 @noindent
19708 As library @file{libgmem.a} contains an alternate body for package
19709 @code{System.Memory}, @file{s-memory.adb} should not be compiled and linked
19710 when an executable is linked with library @file{libgmem.a}. It is then not
19711 recommended to use @command{gnatmake} with switch @option{^-a^/ALL_FILES^}.
19712
19713 @noindent
19714 When @file{my_program} is executed, the file @file{gmem.out} is produced.
19715 This file contains information about all allocations and deallocations
19716 performed by the program. It is produced by the instrumented allocations and
19717 deallocations routines and will be used by @code{gnatmem}.
19718
19719 In order to produce symbolic backtrace information for allocations and
19720 deallocations performed by the GNAT run-time library, you need to use a
19721 version of that library that has been compiled with the @option{-g} switch
19722 (see @ref{Rebuilding the GNAT Run-Time Library}).
19723
19724 Gnatmem must be supplied with the @file{gmem.out} file and the executable to
19725 examine. If the location of @file{gmem.out} file was not explicitly supplied by
19726 @option{-i} switch, gnatmem will assume that this file can be found in the
19727 current directory. For example, after you have executed @file{my_program},
19728 @file{gmem.out} can be analyzed by @code{gnatmem} using the command:
19729
19730 @smallexample
19731 $ gnatmem my_program
19732 @end smallexample
19733
19734 @noindent
19735 This will produce the output with the following format:
19736
19737 *************** debut cc
19738 @smallexample
19739 $ gnatmem my_program
19740
19741 Global information
19742 ------------------
19743 Total number of allocations : 45
19744 Total number of deallocations : 6
19745 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 11.29 Kilobytes
19746 High Water Mark : 11.40 Kilobytes
19747
19748 .
19749 .
19750 .
19751 Allocation Root # 2
19752 -------------------
19753 Number of non freed allocations : 11
19754 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 1.16 Kilobytes
19755 High Water Mark : 1.27 Kilobytes
19756 Backtrace :
19757 my_program.adb:23 my_program.alloc
19758 .
19759 .
19760 .
19761 @end smallexample
19762
19763 The first block of output gives general information. In this case, the
19764 Ada construct ``@code{@b{new}}'' was executed 45 times, and only 6 calls to an
19765 Unchecked_Deallocation routine occurred.
19766
19767 @noindent
19768 Subsequent paragraphs display information on all allocation roots.
19769 An allocation root is a specific point in the execution of the program
19770 that generates some dynamic allocation, such as a ``@code{@b{new}}''
19771 construct. This root is represented by an execution backtrace (or subprogram
19772 call stack). By default the backtrace depth for allocations roots is 1, so
19773 that a root corresponds exactly to a source location. The backtrace can
19774 be made deeper, to make the root more specific.
19775
19776 @node Switches for gnatmem
19777 @subsection Switches for @code{gnatmem}
19778
19779 @noindent
19780 @code{gnatmem} recognizes the following switches:
19781
19782 @table @option
19783
19784 @item -q
19785 @cindex @option{-q} (@code{gnatmem})
19786 Quiet. Gives the minimum output needed to identify the origin of the
19787 memory leaks. Omits statistical information.
19788
19789 @item @var{N}
19790 @cindex @var{N} (@code{gnatmem})
19791 N is an integer literal (usually between 1 and 10) which controls the
19792 depth of the backtraces defining allocation root. The default value for
19793 N is 1. The deeper the backtrace, the more precise the localization of
19794 the root. Note that the total number of roots can depend on this
19795 parameter. This parameter must be specified @emph{before} the name of the
19796 executable to be analyzed, to avoid ambiguity.
19797
19798 @item -b n
19799 @cindex @option{-b} (@code{gnatmem})
19800 This switch has the same effect as just depth parameter.
19801
19802 @item -i @var{file}
19803 @cindex @option{-i} (@code{gnatmem})
19804 Do the @code{gnatmem} processing starting from @file{file}, rather than
19805 @file{gmem.out} in the current directory.
19806
19807 @item -m n
19808 @cindex @option{-m} (@code{gnatmem})
19809 This switch causes @code{gnatmem} to mask the allocation roots that have less
19810 than n leaks. The default value is 1. Specifying the value of 0 will allow to
19811 examine even the roots that didn't result in leaks.
19812
19813 @item -s order
19814 @cindex @option{-s} (@code{gnatmem})
19815 This switch causes @code{gnatmem} to sort the allocation roots according to the
19816 specified order of sort criteria, each identified by a single letter. The
19817 currently supported criteria are @code{n, h, w} standing respectively for
19818 number of unfreed allocations, high watermark, and final watermark
19819 corresponding to a specific root. The default order is @code{nwh}.
19820
19821 @end table
19822
19823 @node Example of gnatmem Usage
19824 @subsection Example of @code{gnatmem} Usage
19825
19826 @noindent
19827 The following example shows the use of @code{gnatmem}
19828 on a simple memory-leaking program.
19829 Suppose that we have the following Ada program:
19830
19831 @smallexample @c ada
19832 @group
19833 @cartouche
19834 with Unchecked_Deallocation;
19835 procedure Test_Gm is
19836
19837 type T is array (1..1000) of Integer;
19838 type Ptr is access T;
19839 procedure Free is new Unchecked_Deallocation (T, Ptr);
19840 A : Ptr;
19841
19842 procedure My_Alloc is
19843 begin
19844 A := new T;
19845 end My_Alloc;
19846
19847 procedure My_DeAlloc is
19848 B : Ptr := A;
19849 begin
19850 Free (B);
19851 end My_DeAlloc;
19852
19853 begin
19854 My_Alloc;
19855 for I in 1 .. 5 loop
19856 for J in I .. 5 loop
19857 My_Alloc;
19858 end loop;
19859 My_Dealloc;
19860 end loop;
19861 end;
19862 @end cartouche
19863 @end group
19864 @end smallexample
19865
19866 @noindent
19867 The program needs to be compiled with debugging option and linked with
19868 @code{gmem} library:
19869
19870 @smallexample
19871 $ gnatmake -g test_gm -largs -lgmem
19872 @end smallexample
19873
19874 @noindent
19875 Then we execute the program as usual:
19876
19877 @smallexample
19878 $ test_gm
19879 @end smallexample
19880
19881 @noindent
19882 Then @code{gnatmem} is invoked simply with
19883 @smallexample
19884 $ gnatmem test_gm
19885 @end smallexample
19886
19887 @noindent
19888 which produces the following output (result may vary on different platforms):
19889
19890 @smallexample
19891 Global information
19892 ------------------
19893 Total number of allocations : 18
19894 Total number of deallocations : 5
19895 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 53.00 Kilobytes
19896 High Water Mark : 56.90 Kilobytes
19897
19898 Allocation Root # 1
19899 -------------------
19900 Number of non freed allocations : 11
19901 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 42.97 Kilobytes
19902 High Water Mark : 46.88 Kilobytes
19903 Backtrace :
19904 test_gm.adb:11 test_gm.my_alloc
19905
19906 Allocation Root # 2
19907 -------------------
19908 Number of non freed allocations : 1
19909 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 10.02 Kilobytes
19910 High Water Mark : 10.02 Kilobytes
19911 Backtrace :
19912 s-secsta.adb:81 system.secondary_stack.ss_init
19913
19914 Allocation Root # 3
19915 -------------------
19916 Number of non freed allocations : 1
19917 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 12 Bytes
19918 High Water Mark : 12 Bytes
19919 Backtrace :
19920 s-secsta.adb:181 system.secondary_stack.ss_init
19921 @end smallexample
19922
19923 @noindent
19924 Note that the GNAT run time contains itself a certain number of
19925 allocations that have no corresponding deallocation,
19926 as shown here for root #2 and root
19927 #3. This is a normal behavior when the number of non-freed allocations
19928 is one, it allocates dynamic data structures that the run time needs for
19929 the complete lifetime of the program. Note also that there is only one
19930 allocation root in the user program with a single line back trace:
19931 test_gm.adb:11 test_gm.my_alloc, whereas a careful analysis of the
19932 program shows that 'My_Alloc' is called at 2 different points in the
19933 source (line 21 and line 24). If those two allocation roots need to be
19934 distinguished, the backtrace depth parameter can be used:
19935
19936 @smallexample
19937 $ gnatmem 3 test_gm
19938 @end smallexample
19939
19940 @noindent
19941 which will give the following output:
19942
19943 @smallexample
19944 Global information
19945 ------------------
19946 Total number of allocations : 18
19947 Total number of deallocations : 5
19948 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 53.00 Kilobytes
19949 High Water Mark : 56.90 Kilobytes
19950
19951 Allocation Root # 1
19952 -------------------
19953 Number of non freed allocations : 10
19954 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 39.06 Kilobytes
19955 High Water Mark : 42.97 Kilobytes
19956 Backtrace :
19957 test_gm.adb:11 test_gm.my_alloc
19958 test_gm.adb:24 test_gm
19959 b_test_gm.c:52 main
19960
19961 Allocation Root # 2
19962 -------------------
19963 Number of non freed allocations : 1
19964 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 10.02 Kilobytes
19965 High Water Mark : 10.02 Kilobytes
19966 Backtrace :
19967 s-secsta.adb:81 system.secondary_stack.ss_init
19968 s-secsta.adb:283 <system__secondary_stack___elabb>
19969 b_test_gm.c:33 adainit
19970
19971 Allocation Root # 3
19972 -------------------
19973 Number of non freed allocations : 1
19974 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 3.91 Kilobytes
19975 High Water Mark : 3.91 Kilobytes
19976 Backtrace :
19977 test_gm.adb:11 test_gm.my_alloc
19978 test_gm.adb:21 test_gm
19979 b_test_gm.c:52 main
19980
19981 Allocation Root # 4
19982 -------------------
19983 Number of non freed allocations : 1
19984 Final Water Mark (non freed mem) : 12 Bytes
19985 High Water Mark : 12 Bytes
19986 Backtrace :
19987 s-secsta.adb:181 system.secondary_stack.ss_init
19988 s-secsta.adb:283 <system__secondary_stack___elabb>
19989 b_test_gm.c:33 adainit
19990 @end smallexample
19991
19992 @noindent
19993 The allocation root #1 of the first example has been split in 2 roots #1
19994 and #3 thanks to the more precise associated backtrace.
19995
19996 @end ifclear
19997
19998 @node Stack Related Facilities
19999 @chapter Stack Related Facilities
20000
20001 @noindent
20002 This chapter describes some useful tools associated with stack
20003 checking and analysis. In
20004 particular, it deals with dynamic and static stack usage measurements.
20005
20006 @menu
20007 * Stack Overflow Checking::
20008 * Static Stack Usage Analysis::
20009 * Dynamic Stack Usage Analysis::
20010 @end menu
20011
20012 @node Stack Overflow Checking
20013 @section Stack Overflow Checking
20014 @cindex Stack Overflow Checking
20015 @cindex -fstack-check
20016
20017 @noindent
20018 For most operating systems, @command{gcc} does not perform stack overflow
20019 checking by default. This means that if the main environment task or
20020 some other task exceeds the available stack space, then unpredictable
20021 behavior will occur. Most native systems offer some level of protection by
20022 adding a guard page at the end of each task stack. This mechanism is usually
20023 not enough for dealing properly with stack overflow situations because
20024 a large local variable could ``jump'' above the guard page.
20025 Furthermore, when the
20026 guard page is hit, there may not be any space left on the stack for executing
20027 the exception propagation code. Enabling stack checking avoids
20028 such situations.
20029
20030 To activate stack checking, compile all units with the gcc option
20031 @option{-fstack-check}. For example:
20032
20033 @smallexample
20034 gcc -c -fstack-check package1.adb
20035 @end smallexample
20036
20037 @noindent
20038 Units compiled with this option will generate extra instructions to check
20039 that any use of the stack (for procedure calls or for declaring local
20040 variables in declare blocks) does not exceed the available stack space.
20041 If the space is exceeded, then a @code{Storage_Error} exception is raised.
20042
20043 For declared tasks, the stack size is controlled by the size
20044 given in an applicable @code{Storage_Size} pragma or by the value specified
20045 at bind time with @option{-d} (@pxref{Switches for gnatbind}) or is set to
20046 the default size as defined in the GNAT runtime otherwise.
20047
20048 For the environment task, the stack size depends on
20049 system defaults and is unknown to the compiler. Stack checking
20050 may still work correctly if a fixed
20051 size stack is allocated, but this cannot be guaranteed.
20052 @ifclear vms
20053 To ensure that a clean exception is signalled for stack
20054 overflow, set the environment variable
20055 @env{GNAT_STACK_LIMIT} to indicate the maximum
20056 stack area that can be used, as in:
20057 @cindex GNAT_STACK_LIMIT
20058
20059 @smallexample
20060 SET GNAT_STACK_LIMIT 1600
20061 @end smallexample
20062
20063 @noindent
20064 The limit is given in kilobytes, so the above declaration would
20065 set the stack limit of the environment task to 1.6 megabytes.
20066 Note that the only purpose of this usage is to limit the amount
20067 of stack used by the environment task. If it is necessary to
20068 increase the amount of stack for the environment task, then this
20069 is an operating systems issue, and must be addressed with the
20070 appropriate operating systems commands.
20071 @end ifclear
20072 @ifset vms
20073 To have a fixed size stack in the environment task, the stack must be put
20074 in the P0 address space and its size specified. Use these switches to
20075 create a p0 image:
20076
20077 @smallexample
20078 gnatmake my_progs -largs "-Wl,--opt=STACK=4000,/p0image"
20079 @end smallexample
20080
20081 @noindent
20082 The quotes are required to keep case. The number after @samp{STACK=} is the
20083 size of the environmental task stack in pagelets (512 bytes). In this example
20084 the stack size is about 2 megabytes.
20085
20086 @noindent
20087 A consequence of the @option{/p0image} qualifier is also to makes RMS buffers
20088 be placed in P0 space. Refer to @cite{HP OpenVMS Linker Utility Manual} for
20089 more details about the @option{/p0image} qualifier and the @option{stack}
20090 option.
20091 @end ifset
20092
20093 @node Static Stack Usage Analysis
20094 @section Static Stack Usage Analysis
20095 @cindex Static Stack Usage Analysis
20096 @cindex -fstack-usage
20097
20098 @noindent
20099 A unit compiled with @option{-fstack-usage} will generate an extra file
20100 that specifies
20101 the maximum amount of stack used, on a per-function basis.
20102 The file has the same
20103 basename as the target object file with a @file{.su} extension.
20104 Each line of this file is made up of three fields:
20105
20106 @itemize
20107 @item
20108 The name of the function.
20109 @item
20110 A number of bytes.
20111 @item
20112 One or more qualifiers: @code{static}, @code{dynamic}, @code{bounded}.
20113 @end itemize
20114
20115 The second field corresponds to the size of the known part of the function
20116 frame.
20117
20118 The qualifier @code{static} means that the function frame size
20119 is purely static.
20120 It usually means that all local variables have a static size.
20121 In this case, the second field is a reliable measure of the function stack
20122 utilization.
20123
20124 The qualifier @code{dynamic} means that the function frame size is not static.
20125 It happens mainly when some local variables have a dynamic size. When this
20126 qualifier appears alone, the second field is not a reliable measure
20127 of the function stack analysis. When it is qualified with @code{bounded}, it
20128 means that the second field is a reliable maximum of the function stack
20129 utilization.
20130
20131 @node Dynamic Stack Usage Analysis
20132 @section Dynamic Stack Usage Analysis
20133
20134 @noindent
20135 It is possible to measure the maximum amount of stack used by a task, by
20136 adding a switch to @command{gnatbind}, as:
20137
20138 @smallexample
20139 $ gnatbind -u0 file
20140 @end smallexample
20141
20142 @noindent
20143 With this option, at each task termination, its stack usage is output on
20144 @file{stderr}.
20145 It is not always convenient to output the stack usage when the program
20146 is still running. Hence, it is possible to delay this output until program
20147 termination. for a given number of tasks specified as the argument of the
20148 @option{-u} option. For instance:
20149
20150 @smallexample
20151 $ gnatbind -u100 file
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154 @noindent
20155 will buffer the stack usage information of the first 100 tasks to terminate and
20156 output this info at program termination. Results are displayed in four
20157 columns:
20158
20159 @noindent
20160 Index | Task Name | Stack Size | Actual Use [min - max]
20161
20162 @noindent
20163 where:
20164
20165 @table @emph
20166 @item Index
20167 is a number associated with each task.
20168
20169 @item Task Name
20170 is the name of the task analyzed.
20171
20172 @item Stack Size
20173 is the maximum size for the stack.
20174
20175 @item Actual Use
20176 is the measure done by the stack analyzer. In order to prevent overflow,
20177 the stack is not entirely analyzed, and it's not possible to know exactly how
20178 much has actually been used. The real amount of stack used is between the min
20179 and max values.
20180
20181 @end table
20182
20183 @noindent
20184 The environment task stack, e.g., the stack that contains the main unit, is
20185 only processed when the environment variable GNAT_STACK_LIMIT is set.
20186
20187
20188 @c *********************************
20189 @c * GNATCHECK *
20190 @c *********************************
20191 @node Verifying Properties Using gnatcheck
20192 @chapter Verifying Properties Using @command{gnatcheck}
20193 @findex gnatcheck
20194 @cindex @command{gnatcheck}
20195
20196 @noindent
20197 The @command{gnatcheck} tool is an ASIS-based utility that checks properties
20198 of Ada source files according to a given set of semantic rules.
20199 @cindex ASIS
20200
20201 In order to check compliance with a given rule, @command{gnatcheck} has to
20202 semantically analyze the Ada sources.
20203 Therefore, checks can only be performed on
20204 legal Ada units. Moreover, when a unit depends semantically upon units located
20205 outside the current directory, the source search path has to be provided when
20206 calling @command{gnatcheck}, either through a specified project file or
20207 through @command{gnatcheck} switches as described below.
20208
20209 A number of rules are predefined in @command{gnatcheck} and are described
20210 later in this chapter.
20211 You can also add new rules, by modifying the @command{gnatcheck} code and
20212 rebuilding the tool. In order to add a simple rule making some local checks,
20213 a small amount of straightforward ASIS-based programming is usually needed.
20214
20215 Project support for @command{gnatcheck} is provided by the GNAT
20216 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
20217
20218 Invoking @command{gnatcheck} on the command line has the form:
20219
20220 @smallexample
20221 $ gnatcheck @ovar{switches} @{@var{filename}@}
20222 @r{[}^-files^/FILES^=@{@var{arg_list_filename}@}@r{]}
20223 @r{[}-cargs @var{gcc_switches}@r{]} @r{[}-rules @var{rule_options}@r{]}
20224 @end smallexample
20225
20226 @noindent
20227 where
20228 @itemize @bullet
20229 @item
20230 @var{switches} specify the general tool options
20231
20232 @item
20233 Each @var{filename} is the name (including the extension) of a source
20234 file to process. ``Wildcards'' are allowed, and
20235 the file name may contain path information.
20236
20237 @item
20238 Each @var{arg_list_filename} is the name (including the extension) of a text
20239 file containing the names of the source files to process, separated by spaces
20240 or line breaks.
20241
20242 @item
20243 @var{gcc_switches} is a list of switches for
20244 @command{gcc}. They will be passed on to all compiler invocations made by
20245 @command{gnatcheck} to generate the ASIS trees. Here you can provide
20246 @option{^-I^/INCLUDE_DIRS=^} switches to form the source search path,
20247 and use the @option{-gnatec} switch to set the configuration file.
20248
20249 @item
20250 @var{rule_options} is a list of options for controlling a set of
20251 rules to be checked by @command{gnatcheck} (@pxref{gnatcheck Rule Options}).
20252 @end itemize
20253
20254 @noindent
20255 Either a @file{@var{filename}} or an @file{@var{arg_list_filename}} must be supplied.
20256
20257 @menu
20258 * Format of the Report File::
20259 * General gnatcheck Switches::
20260 * gnatcheck Rule Options::
20261 * Adding the Results of Compiler Checks to gnatcheck Output::
20262 * Project-Wide Checks::
20263 * Predefined Rules::
20264 @end menu
20265
20266 @node Format of the Report File
20267 @section Format of the Report File
20268 @cindex Report file (for @code{gnatcheck})
20269
20270 @noindent
20271 The @command{gnatcheck} tool outputs on @file{stdout} all messages concerning
20272 rule violations.
20273 It also creates, in the current
20274 directory, a text file named @file{^gnatcheck.out^GNATCHECK.OUT^} that
20275 contains the complete report of the last gnatcheck run. This report contains:
20276 @itemize @bullet
20277 @item a list of the Ada source files being checked,
20278 @item a list of enabled and disabled rules,
20279 @item a list of the diagnostic messages, ordered in three different ways
20280 and collected in three separate
20281 sections. Section 1 contains the raw list of diagnostic messages. It
20282 corresponds to the output going to @file{stdout}. Section 2 contains
20283 messages ordered by rules.
20284 Section 3 contains messages ordered by source files.
20285 @end itemize
20286
20287 @node General gnatcheck Switches
20288 @section General @command{gnatcheck} Switches
20289
20290 @noindent
20291 The following switches control the general @command{gnatcheck} behavior
20292
20293 @table @option
20294 @c !sort!
20295 @cindex @option{^-a^/ALL^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20296 @item ^-a^/ALL^
20297 Process all units including those with read-only ALI files such as
20298 those from GNAT Run-Time library.
20299
20300 @ifclear vms
20301 @ignore
20302 @cindex @option{-d} (@command{gnatcheck})
20303 @item -d
20304 Debug mode
20305 @end ignore
20306
20307 @cindex @option{-dd} (@command{gnatcheck})
20308 @item -dd
20309 Progress indicator mode (for use in GPS)
20310 @end ifclear
20311
20312 @cindex @option{^-h^/HELP^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20313 @item ^-h^/HELP^
20314 List the predefined and user-defined rules. For more details see
20315 @ref{Predefined Rules}.
20316
20317 @cindex @option{^-l^/LOCS^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20318 @item ^-l^/LOCS^
20319 Use full source locations references in the report file. For a construct from
20320 a generic instantiation a full source location is a chain from the location
20321 of this construct in the generic unit to the place where this unit is
20322 instantiated.
20323
20324 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20325 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
20326 Quiet mode. All the diagnoses about rule violations are placed in the
20327 @command{gnatcheck} report file only, without duplicating in @file{stdout}.
20328
20329 @cindex @option{^-s^/SHORT^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20330 @item ^-s^/SHORT^
20331 Short format of the report file (no version information, no list of applied
20332 rules, no list of checked sources is included)
20333
20334 @cindex @option{^-s1^/COMPILER_STYLE^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20335 @item ^-s1^/COMPILER_STYLE^
20336 Include the compiler-style section in the report file
20337
20338 @cindex @option{^-s2^/BY_RULES^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20339 @item ^-s2^/BY_RULES^
20340 Include the section containing diagnoses ordered by rules in the report file
20341
20342 @cindex @option{^-s3^/BY_FILES_BY_RULES^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20343 @item ^-s3^/BY_FILES_BY_RULES^
20344 Include the section containing diagnoses ordered by files and then by rules
20345 in the report file
20346
20347 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@command{gnatcheck})
20348 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
20349 Verbose mode; @command{gnatcheck} generates version information and then
20350 a trace of sources being processed.
20351
20352 @end table
20353
20354 @noindent
20355 Note that if any of the options @option{^-s1^/COMPILER_STYLE^},
20356 @option{^-s2^/BY_RULES^} or
20357 @option{^-s3^/BY_FILES_BY_RULES^} is specified,
20358 then the @command{gnatcheck} report file will only contain sections
20359 explicitly denoted by these options.
20360
20361 @node gnatcheck Rule Options
20362 @section @command{gnatcheck} Rule Options
20363
20364 @noindent
20365 The following options control the processing performed by
20366 @command{gnatcheck}.
20367
20368 @table @option
20369 @cindex @option{+ALL} (@command{gnatcheck})
20370 @item +ALL
20371 Turn all the rule checks ON.
20372
20373 @cindex @option{-ALL} (@command{gnatcheck})
20374 @item -ALL
20375 Turn all the rule checks OFF.
20376
20377 @cindex @option{+R} (@command{gnatcheck})
20378 @item +R@var{rule_id}@r{[}:@var{param}@r{]}
20379 Turn on the check for a specified rule with the specified parameter, if any.
20380 @var{rule_id} must be the identifier of one of the currently implemented rules
20381 (use @option{^-h^/HELP^} for the list of implemented rules). Rule identifiers
20382 are not case-sensitive. The @var{param} item must
20383 be a string representing a valid parameter(s) for the specified rule.
20384 If it contains any space characters then this string must be enclosed in
20385 quotation marks.
20386
20387 @cindex @option{-R} (@command{gnatcheck})
20388 @item -R@var{rule_id}@r{[}:@var{param}@r{]}
20389 Turn off the check for a specified rule with the specified parameter, if any.
20390
20391 @cindex @option{-from} (@command{gnatcheck})
20392 @item -from=@var{rule_option_filename}
20393 Read the rule options from the text file @var{rule_option_filename}, referred as
20394 ``rule file'' below.
20395
20396 @end table
20397
20398 @noindent
20399 The default behavior is that all the rule checks are enabled, except for
20400 the checks performed by the compiler.
20401 @ignore
20402 and the checks associated with the
20403 global rules.
20404 @end ignore
20405
20406 A rule file is a text file containing a set of rule options.
20407 @cindex Rule file (for @code{gnatcheck})
20408 The file may contain empty lines and Ada-style comments (comment
20409 lines and end-of-line comments). The rule file has free format; that is,
20410 you do not have to start a new rule option on a new line.
20411
20412 A rule file may contain other @option{-from=@var{rule_option_filename}}
20413 options, each such option being replaced with the content of the
20414 corresponding rule file during the rule files processing. In case a
20415 cycle is detected (that is, @file{@var{rule_file_1}} reads rule options
20416 from @file{@var{rule_file_2}}, and @file{@var{rule_file_2}} reads
20417 (directly or indirectly) rule options from @file{@var{rule_file_1}}),
20418 the processing of rule files is interrupted and a part of their content
20419 is ignored.
20420
20421
20422 @node Adding the Results of Compiler Checks to gnatcheck Output
20423 @section Adding the Results of Compiler Checks to @command{gnatcheck} Output
20424
20425 @noindent
20426 The @command{gnatcheck} tool can include in the generated diagnostic messages
20427 and in
20428 the report file the results of the checks performed by the compiler. Though
20429 disabled by default, this effect may be obtained by using @option{+R} with
20430 the following rule identifiers and parameters:
20431
20432 @table @option
20433 @item Restrictions
20434 To record restrictions violations (that are performed by the compiler if the
20435 pragma @code{Restrictions} or @code{Restriction_Warnings} are given),
20436 use the rule named
20437 @code{Restrictions} with the same parameters as pragma
20438 @code{Restrictions} or @code{Restriction_Warnings}.
20439
20440 @item Style_Checks
20441 To record compiler style checks(@pxref{Style Checking}), use the rule named
20442 @code{Style_Checks}. A parameter of this rule can be either @code{All_Checks},
20443 which enables all the standard style checks that corresponds to @option{-gnatyy}
20444 GNAT style check option, or a string that has exactly the same
20445 structure and semantics as the @code{string_LITERAL} parameter of GNAT pragma
20446 @code{Style_Checks} (for further information about this pragma,
20447 @pxref{Pragma Style_Checks,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}).
20448
20449 @item Warnings
20450 To record compiler warnings (@pxref{Warning Message Control}), use the rule
20451 named @code{Warnings} with a parameter that is a valid
20452 @i{static_string_expression} argument of GNAT pragma @code{Warnings}
20453 (for further information about this pragma, @pxref{Pragma Warnings,,,
20454 gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}). Note, that in case of gnatcheck
20455 's' parameter, that corresponds to the GNAT @option{-gnatws} option, disables
20456 all the specific warnings, but not suppresses the warning mode,
20457 and 'e' parameter, corresponding to @option{-gnatwe} that means
20458 "treat warnings as errors", does not have any effect.
20459
20460 @end table
20461
20462 To disable a specific restriction check, use @code{-RStyle_Checks} gnatcheck
20463 option with the corresponding restriction name as a parameter. @code{-R} is
20464 not available for @code{Style_Checks} and @code{Warnings} options, to disable
20465 warnings and style checks, use the corresponding warning and style options.
20466
20467 @node Project-Wide Checks
20468 @section Project-Wide Checks
20469 @cindex Project-wide checks (for @command{gnatcheck})
20470
20471 @noindent
20472 In order to perform checks on all units of a given project, you can use
20473 the GNAT driver along with the @option{-P} option:
20474 @smallexample
20475 gnat check -Pproj -rules -from=my_rules
20476 @end smallexample
20477
20478 @noindent
20479 If the project @code{proj} depends upon other projects, you can perform
20480 checks on the project closure using the @option{-U} option:
20481 @smallexample
20482 gnat check -Pproj -U -rules -from=my_rules
20483 @end smallexample
20484
20485 @noindent
20486 Finally, if not all the units are relevant to a particular main
20487 program in the project closure, you can perform checks for the set
20488 of units needed to create a given main program (unit closure) using
20489 the @option{-U} option followed by the name of the main unit:
20490 @smallexample
20491 gnat check -Pproj -U main -rules -from=my_rules
20492 @end smallexample
20493
20494
20495 @node Predefined Rules
20496 @section Predefined Rules
20497 @cindex Predefined rules (for @command{gnatcheck})
20498
20499 @ignore
20500 @c (Jan 2007) Since the global rules are still under development and are not
20501 @c documented, there is no point in explaining the difference between
20502 @c global and local rules
20503 @noindent
20504 A rule in @command{gnatcheck} is either local or global.
20505 A @emph{local rule} is a rule that applies to a well-defined section
20506 of a program and that can be checked by analyzing only this section.
20507 A @emph{global rule} requires analysis of some global properties of the
20508 whole program (mostly related to the program call graph).
20509 As of @value{NOW}, the implementation of global rules should be
20510 considered to be at a preliminary stage. You can use the
20511 @option{+GLOBAL} option to enable all the global rules, and the
20512 @option{-GLOBAL} rule option to disable all the global rules.
20513
20514 All the global rules in the list below are
20515 so indicated by marking them ``GLOBAL''.
20516 This +GLOBAL and -GLOBAL options are not
20517 included in the list of gnatcheck options above, because at the moment they
20518 are considered as a temporary debug options.
20519
20520 @command{gnatcheck} performs rule checks for generic
20521 instances only for global rules. This limitation may be relaxed in a later
20522 release.
20523 @end ignore
20524
20525 @noindent
20526 The following subsections document the rules implemented in
20527 @command{gnatcheck}.
20528 The subsection title is the same as the rule identifier, which may be
20529 used as a parameter of the @option{+R} or @option{-R} options.
20530
20531
20532 @menu
20533 * Abstract_Type_Declarations::
20534 * Anonymous_Arrays::
20535 * Anonymous_Subtypes::
20536 * Blocks::
20537 * Boolean_Relational_Operators::
20538 @ignore
20539 * Ceiling_Violations::
20540 @end ignore
20541 * Controlled_Type_Declarations::
20542 * Declarations_In_Blocks::
20543 * Default_Parameters::
20544 * Discriminated_Records::
20545 * Enumeration_Ranges_In_CASE_Statements::
20546 * Exceptions_As_Control_Flow::
20547 * EXIT_Statements_With_No_Loop_Name::
20548 * Expanded_Loop_Exit_Names::
20549 * Explicit_Full_Discrete_Ranges::
20550 * Float_Equality_Checks::
20551 * Forbidden_Pragmas::
20552 * Function_Style_Procedures::
20553 * Generics_In_Subprograms::
20554 * GOTO_Statements::
20555 * Implicit_IN_Mode_Parameters::
20556 * Implicit_SMALL_For_Fixed_Point_Types::
20557 * Improperly_Located_Instantiations::
20558 * Improper_Returns::
20559 * Library_Level_Subprograms::
20560 * Local_Packages::
20561 @ignore
20562 * Improperly_Called_Protected_Entries::
20563 @end ignore
20564 * Metrics::
20565 * Misnamed_Identifiers::
20566 * Multiple_Entries_In_Protected_Definitions::
20567 * Name_Clashes::
20568 * Non_Qualified_Aggregates::
20569 * Non_Short_Circuit_Operators::
20570 * Non_SPARK_Attributes::
20571 * Non_Tagged_Derived_Types::
20572 * Non_Visible_Exceptions::
20573 * Numeric_Literals::
20574 * OTHERS_In_Aggregates::
20575 * OTHERS_In_CASE_Statements::
20576 * OTHERS_In_Exception_Handlers::
20577 * Outer_Loop_Exits::
20578 * Overloaded_Operators::
20579 * Overly_Nested_Control_Structures::
20580 * Parameters_Out_Of_Order::
20581 * Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Generic_Parameters::
20582 * Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Parameters::
20583 * Positional_Components::
20584 * Positional_Generic_Parameters::
20585 * Positional_Parameters::
20586 * Predefined_Numeric_Types::
20587 * Raising_External_Exceptions::
20588 * Raising_Predefined_Exceptions::
20589 * Separate_Numeric_Error_Handlers::
20590 @ignore
20591 * Recursion::
20592 * Side_Effect_Functions::
20593 @end ignore
20594 * Slices::
20595 * Unassigned_OUT_Parameters::
20596 * Uncommented_BEGIN_In_Package_Bodies::
20597 * Unconstrained_Array_Returns::
20598 * Universal_Ranges::
20599 * Unnamed_Blocks_And_Loops::
20600 @ignore
20601 * Unused_Subprograms::
20602 @end ignore
20603 * USE_PACKAGE_Clauses::
20604 * Volatile_Objects_Without_Address_Clauses::
20605 @end menu
20606
20607
20608 @node Abstract_Type_Declarations
20609 @subsection @code{Abstract_Type_Declarations}
20610 @cindex @code{Abstract_Type_Declarations} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20611
20612 @noindent
20613 Flag all declarations of abstract types. For an abstract private
20614 type, both the private and full type declarations are flagged.
20615
20616 This rule has no parameters.
20617
20618
20619 @node Anonymous_Arrays
20620 @subsection @code{Anonymous_Arrays}
20621 @cindex @code{Anonymous_Arrays} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20622
20623 @noindent
20624 Flag all anonymous array type definitions (by Ada semantics these can only
20625 occur in object declarations).
20626
20627 This rule has no parameters.
20628
20629 @node Anonymous_Subtypes
20630 @subsection @code{Anonymous_Subtypes}
20631 @cindex @code{Anonymous_Subtypes} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20632
20633 @noindent
20634 Flag all uses of anonymous subtypes. A use of an anonymous subtype is
20635 any instance of a subtype indication with a constraint, other than one
20636 that occurs immediately within a subtype declaration. Any use of a range
20637 other than as a constraint used immediately within a subtype declaration
20638 is considered as an anonymous subtype.
20639
20640 An effect of this rule is that @code{for} loops such as the following are
20641 flagged (since @code{1..N} is formally a ``range''):
20642
20643 @smallexample @c ada
20644 for I in 1 .. N loop
20645 @dots{}
20646 end loop;
20647 @end smallexample
20648
20649 @noindent
20650 Declaring an explicit subtype solves the problem:
20651
20652 @smallexample @c ada
20653 subtype S is Integer range 1..N;
20654 @dots{}
20655 for I in S loop
20656 @dots{}
20657 end loop;
20658 @end smallexample
20659
20660 @noindent
20661 This rule has no parameters.
20662
20663 @node Blocks
20664 @subsection @code{Blocks}
20665 @cindex @code{Blocks} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20666
20667 @noindent
20668 Flag each block statement.
20669
20670 This rule has no parameters.
20671
20672 @node Boolean_Relational_Operators
20673 @subsection @code{Boolean_Relational_Operators}
20674 @cindex @code{Boolean_Relational_Operators} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20675
20676 @noindent
20677 Flag each call to a predefined relational operator (``<'', ``>'', ``<='',
20678 ``>='', ``='' and ``/='') for the predefined Boolean type.
20679 (This rule is useful in enforcing the SPARK language restrictions.)
20680
20681 Calls to predefined relational operators of any type derived from
20682 @code{Standard.Boolean} are not detected. Calls to user-defined functions
20683 with these designators, and uses of operators that are renamings
20684 of the predefined relational operators for @code{Standard.Boolean},
20685 are likewise not detected.
20686
20687 This rule has no parameters.
20688
20689 @ignore
20690 @node Ceiling_Violations
20691 @subsection @code{Ceiling_Violations} (under construction, GLOBAL)
20692 @cindex @code{Ceiling_Violations} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20693
20694 @noindent
20695 Flag invocations of a protected operation by a task whose priority exceeds
20696 the protected object's ceiling.
20697
20698 As of @value{NOW}, this rule has the following limitations:
20699
20700 @itemize @bullet
20701
20702 @item
20703 We consider only pragmas Priority and Interrupt_Priority as means to define
20704 a task/protected operation priority. We do not consider the effect of using
20705 Ada.Dynamic_Priorities.Set_Priority procedure;
20706
20707 @item
20708 We consider only base task priorities, and no priority inheritance. That is,
20709 we do not make a difference between calls issued during task activation and
20710 execution of the sequence of statements from task body;
20711
20712 @item
20713 Any situation when the priority of protected operation caller is set by a
20714 dynamic expression (that is, the corresponding Priority or
20715 Interrupt_Priority pragma has a non-static expression as an argument) we
20716 treat as a priority inconsistency (and, therefore, detect this situation).
20717 @end itemize
20718
20719 @noindent
20720 At the moment the notion of the main subprogram is not implemented in
20721 gnatcheck, so any pragma Priority in a library level subprogram body (in case
20722 if this subprogram can be a main subprogram of a partition) changes the
20723 priority of an environment task. So if we have more then one such pragma in
20724 the set of processed sources, the pragma that is processed last, defines the
20725 priority of an environment task.
20726
20727 This rule has no parameters.
20728 @end ignore
20729
20730 @node Controlled_Type_Declarations
20731 @subsection @code{Controlled_Type_Declarations}
20732 @cindex @code{Controlled_Type_Declarations} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20733
20734 @noindent
20735 Flag all declarations of controlled types. A declaration of a private type
20736 is flagged if its full declaration declares a controlled type. A declaration
20737 of a derived type is flagged if its ancestor type is controlled. Subtype
20738 declarations are not checked. A declaration of a type that itself is not a
20739 descendant of a type declared in @code{Ada.Finalization} but has a controlled
20740 component is not checked.
20741
20742 This rule has no parameters.
20743
20744
20745
20746 @node Declarations_In_Blocks
20747 @subsection @code{Declarations_In_Blocks}
20748 @cindex @code{Declarations_In_Blocks} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20749
20750 @noindent
20751 Flag all block statements containing local declarations. A @code{declare}
20752 block with an empty @i{declarative_part} or with a @i{declarative part}
20753 containing only pragmas and/or @code{use} clauses is not flagged.
20754
20755 This rule has no parameters.
20756
20757
20758 @node Default_Parameters
20759 @subsection @code{Default_Parameters}
20760 @cindex @code{Default_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20761
20762 @noindent
20763 Flag all default expressions for subprogram parameters. Parameter
20764 declarations of formal and generic subprograms are also checked.
20765
20766 This rule has no parameters.
20767
20768
20769 @node Discriminated_Records
20770 @subsection @code{Discriminated_Records}
20771 @cindex @code{Discriminated_Records} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20772
20773 @noindent
20774 Flag all declarations of record types with discriminants. Only the
20775 declarations of record and record extension types are checked. Incomplete,
20776 formal, private, derived and private extension type declarations are not
20777 checked. Task and protected type declarations also are not checked.
20778
20779 This rule has no parameters.
20780
20781
20782 @node Enumeration_Ranges_In_CASE_Statements
20783 @subsection @code{Enumeration_Ranges_In_CASE_Statements}
20784 @cindex @code{Enumeration_Ranges_In_CASE_Statements} (for @command{gnatcheck})
20785
20786 @noindent
20787 Flag each use of a range of enumeration literals as a choice in a
20788 @code{case} statement.
20789 All forms for specifying a range (explicit ranges
20790 such as @code{A .. B}, subtype marks and @code{'Range} attributes) are flagged.
20791 An enumeration range is
20792 flagged even if contains exactly one enumeration value or no values at all. A
20793 type derived from an enumeration type is considered as an enumeration type.
20794
20795 This rule helps prevent maintenance problems arising from adding an
20796 enumeration value to a type and having it implicitly handled by an existing
20797 @code{case} statement with an enumeration range that includes the new literal.
20798
20799 This rule has no parameters.
20800
20801
20802 @node Exceptions_As_Control_Flow
20803 @subsection @code{Exceptions_As_Control_Flow}
20804 @cindex @code{Exceptions_As_Control_Flow} (for @command{gnatcheck})
20805
20806 @noindent
20807 Flag each place where an exception is explicitly raised and handled in the
20808 same subprogram body. A @code{raise} statement in an exception handler,
20809 package body, task body or entry body is not flagged.
20810
20811 The rule has no parameters.
20812
20813 @node EXIT_Statements_With_No_Loop_Name
20814 @subsection @code{EXIT_Statements_With_No_Loop_Name}
20815 @cindex @code{EXIT_Statements_With_No_Loop_Name} (for @command{gnatcheck})
20816
20817 @noindent
20818 Flag each @code{exit} statement that does not specify the name of the loop
20819 being exited.
20820
20821 The rule has no parameters.
20822
20823
20824 @node Expanded_Loop_Exit_Names
20825 @subsection @code{Expanded_Loop_Exit_Names}
20826 @cindex @code{Expanded_Loop_Exit_Names} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20827
20828 @noindent
20829 Flag all expanded loop names in @code{exit} statements.
20830
20831 This rule has no parameters.
20832
20833 @node Explicit_Full_Discrete_Ranges
20834 @subsection @code{Explicit_Full_Discrete_Ranges}
20835 @cindex @code{Explicit_Full_Discrete_Ranges} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20836
20837 @noindent
20838 Flag each discrete range that has the form @code{A'First .. A'Last}.
20839
20840 This rule has no parameters.
20841
20842 @node Float_Equality_Checks
20843 @subsection @code{Float_Equality_Checks}
20844 @cindex @code{Float_Equality_Checks} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20845
20846 @noindent
20847 Flag all calls to the predefined equality operations for floating-point types.
20848 Both ``@code{=}'' and ``@code{/=}'' operations are checked.
20849 User-defined equality operations are not flagged, nor are ``@code{=}''
20850 and ``@code{/=}'' operations for fixed-point types.
20851
20852 This rule has no parameters.
20853
20854
20855 @node Forbidden_Pragmas
20856 @subsection @code{Forbidden_Pragmas}
20857 @cindex @code{Forbidden_Pragmas} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20858
20859 @noindent
20860 Flag each use of the specified pragmas. The pragmas to be detected
20861 are named in the rule's parameters.
20862
20863 This rule has the following parameters:
20864
20865 @itemize @bullet
20866 @item For the @option{+R} option
20867
20868 @table @asis
20869 @item @emph{Pragma_Name}
20870 Adds the specified pragma to the set of pragmas to be
20871 checked and sets the checks for all the specified pragmas
20872 ON. @emph{Pragma_Name} is treated as a name of a pragma. If it
20873 does not correspond to any pragma name defined in the Ada
20874 standard or to the name of a GNAT-specific pragma defined
20875 in @ref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference
20876 Manual}, it is treated as the name of unknown pragma.
20877
20878 @item @code{GNAT}
20879 All the GNAT-specific pragmas are detected; this sets
20880 the checks for all the specified pragmas ON.
20881
20882 @item @code{ALL}
20883 All pragmas are detected; this sets the rule ON.
20884 @end table
20885
20886 @item For the @option{-R} option
20887 @table @asis
20888 @item @emph{Pragma_Name}
20889 Removes the specified pragma from the set of pragmas to be
20890 checked without affecting checks for
20891 other pragmas. @emph{Pragma_Name} is treated as a name
20892 of a pragma. If it does not correspond to any pragma
20893 defined in the Ada standard or to any name defined in
20894 @ref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual},
20895 this option is treated as turning OFF detection of all unknown pragmas.
20896
20897 @item GNAT
20898 Turn OFF detection of all GNAT-specific pragmas
20899
20900 @item ALL
20901 Clear the list of the pragmas to be detected and
20902 turn the rule OFF.
20903 @end table
20904 @end itemize
20905
20906 @noindent
20907 Parameters are not case sensitive. If @emph{Pragma_Name} does not have
20908 the syntax of an Ada identifier and therefore can not be considered
20909 as a pragma name, a diagnostic message is generated and the corresponding
20910 parameter is ignored.
20911
20912 When more then one parameter is given in the same rule option, the parameters
20913 must be separated by a comma.
20914
20915 If more then one option for this rule is specified for the @command{gnatcheck}
20916 call, a new option overrides the previous one(s).
20917
20918 The @option{+R} option with no parameters turns the rule ON with the set of
20919 pragmas to be detected defined by the previous rule options.
20920 (By default this set is empty, so if the only option specified for the rule is
20921 @option{+RForbidden_Pragmas} (with
20922 no parameter), then the rule is enabled, but it does not detect anything).
20923 The @option{-R} option with no parameter turns the rule OFF, but it does not
20924 affect the set of pragmas to be detected.
20925
20926
20927
20928
20929 @node Function_Style_Procedures
20930 @subsection @code{Function_Style_Procedures}
20931 @cindex @code{Function_Style_Procedures} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20932
20933 @noindent
20934 Flag each procedure that can be rewritten as a function. A procedure can be
20935 converted into a function if it has exactly one parameter of mode @code{out}
20936 and no parameters of mode @code{in out}. Procedure declarations,
20937 formal procedure declarations, and generic procedure declarations are always
20938 checked. Procedure
20939 bodies and body stubs are flagged only if they do not have corresponding
20940 separate declarations. Procedure renamings and procedure instantiations are
20941 not flagged.
20942
20943 If a procedure can be rewritten as a function, but its @code{out} parameter is
20944 of a limited type, it is not flagged.
20945
20946 Protected procedures are not flagged. Null procedures also are not flagged.
20947
20948 This rule has no parameters.
20949
20950
20951 @node Generics_In_Subprograms
20952 @subsection @code{Generics_In_Subprograms}
20953 @cindex @code{Generics_In_Subprograms} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20954
20955 @noindent
20956 Flag each declaration of a generic unit in a subprogram. Generic
20957 declarations in the bodies of generic subprograms are also flagged.
20958 A generic unit nested in another generic unit is not flagged.
20959 If a generic unit is
20960 declared in a local package that is declared in a subprogram body, the
20961 generic unit is flagged.
20962
20963 This rule has no parameters.
20964
20965
20966 @node GOTO_Statements
20967 @subsection @code{GOTO_Statements}
20968 @cindex @code{GOTO_Statements} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20969
20970 @noindent
20971 Flag each occurrence of a @code{goto} statement.
20972
20973 This rule has no parameters.
20974
20975
20976 @node Implicit_IN_Mode_Parameters
20977 @subsection @code{Implicit_IN_Mode_Parameters}
20978 @cindex @code{Implicit_IN_Mode_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20979
20980 @noindent
20981 Flag each occurrence of a formal parameter with an implicit @code{in} mode.
20982 Note that @code{access} parameters, although they technically behave
20983 like @code{in} parameters, are not flagged.
20984
20985 This rule has no parameters.
20986
20987
20988 @node Implicit_SMALL_For_Fixed_Point_Types
20989 @subsection @code{Implicit_SMALL_For_Fixed_Point_Types}
20990 @cindex @code{Implicit_SMALL_For_Fixed_Point_Types} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
20991
20992 @noindent
20993 Flag each fixed point type declaration that lacks an explicit
20994 representation clause to define its @code{'Small} value.
20995 Since @code{'Small} can be defined only for ordinary fixed point types,
20996 decimal fixed point type declarations are not checked.
20997
20998 This rule has no parameters.
20999
21000
21001 @node Improperly_Located_Instantiations
21002 @subsection @code{Improperly_Located_Instantiations}
21003 @cindex @code{Improperly_Located_Instantiations} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21004
21005 @noindent
21006 Flag all generic instantiations in library-level package specs
21007 (including library generic packages) and in all subprogram bodies.
21008
21009 Instantiations in task and entry bodies are not flagged. Instantiations in the
21010 bodies of protected subprograms are flagged.
21011
21012 This rule has no parameters.
21013
21014
21015
21016 @node Improper_Returns
21017 @subsection @code{Improper_Returns}
21018 @cindex @code{Improper_Returns} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21019
21020 @noindent
21021 Flag each explicit @code{return} statement in procedures, and
21022 multiple @code{return} statements in functions.
21023 Diagnostic messages are generated for all @code{return} statements
21024 in a procedure (thus each procedure must be written so that it
21025 returns implicitly at the end of its statement part),
21026 and for all @code{return} statements in a function after the first one.
21027 This rule supports the stylistic convention that each subprogram
21028 should have no more than one point of normal return.
21029
21030 This rule has no parameters.
21031
21032
21033 @node Library_Level_Subprograms
21034 @subsection @code{Library_Level_Subprograms}
21035 @cindex @code{Library_Level_Subprograms} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21036
21037 @noindent
21038 Flag all library-level subprograms (including generic subprogram instantiations).
21039
21040 This rule has no parameters.
21041
21042
21043 @node Local_Packages
21044 @subsection @code{Local_Packages}
21045 @cindex @code{Local_Packages} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21046
21047 @noindent
21048 Flag all local packages declared in package and generic package
21049 specs.
21050 Local packages in bodies are not flagged.
21051
21052 This rule has no parameters.
21053
21054 @ignore
21055 @node Improperly_Called_Protected_Entries
21056 @subsection @code{Improperly_Called_Protected_Entries} (under construction, GLOBAL)
21057 @cindex @code{Improperly_Called_Protected_Entries} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21058
21059 @noindent
21060 Flag each protected entry that can be called from more than one task.
21061
21062 This rule has no parameters.
21063 @end ignore
21064
21065 @node Metrics
21066 @subsection @code{Metrics}
21067 @cindex @code{Metrics} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21068
21069 @noindent
21070 This is an umbrella rule for a set of metrics-based checks. Each metric-based
21071 check has its own rule name that starts from the common prefix
21072 @code{Metrics_}. For @option{+R} option, this name ends with @code{_GT}
21073 (greater then) or @code{_LT} (less then). The parameter of the rule
21074 @option{+R} option specifies bound (upper or lower, depending on the metric)
21075 for the given metric. A construct is flagged if a specified metric can be
21076 computed for it, and the resulting value is higher then the upper bound (or
21077 less than the lower bound) specified. Parameters and metric names are not
21078 case-sensitive @option{-R} option does not have a parameter and it turns OFF
21079 the check for the metric indicated by the metric rule name.
21080
21081 The following table shows the available metrics-based checks, including the
21082 constraint that must be satisfied by the bound that is specified for the check
21083 and what bound - upper (U) or lower (L) - should be specified.
21084
21085 @multitable {@code{Cyclomatic_Complexity}}{Cyclomatic complexity}{Positive integer}
21086 @ifnothtml
21087 @headitem Check Name @tab Description @tab Bounds Value
21088 @end ifnothtml
21089 @ifhtml
21090 @item @b{Check Name} @tab @b{Description} @tab @b{Bounds Value}
21091 @end ifhtml
21092 @c Above conditional code is workaround to bug in texi2html (Feb 2008)
21093 @item @code{Essential_Complexity} @tab Essential complexity @tab Positive integer (U)
21094 @item @code{Cyclomatic_Complexity} @tab Cyclomatic complexity @tab Positive integer (U)
21095 @item @code{LSLOC} @tab Logical Source Lines of Code @tab Positive integer (U)
21096 @end multitable
21097
21098 @noindent
21099 The meaning and the computed values for all these metrics are exactly
21100 the same as for the corresponding metrics in @command{gnatmetric}.
21101
21102 @emph{Example:} the rule
21103 @smallexample
21104 +RMetrics_Cyclomatic_Complexity_GT : 7
21105 @end smallexample
21106 @noindent
21107 means that all bodies with cyclomatic complexity exceeding 7 will be flagged.
21108
21109 To turn OFF the check for cyclomatic complexity metric, use the following option:
21110 @smallexample
21111 -RMetrics_Cyclomatic_Complexity
21112 @end smallexample
21113
21114 @node Misnamed_Identifiers
21115 @subsection @code{Misnamed_Identifiers}
21116 @cindex @code{Misnamed_Identifiers} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21117
21118 @noindent
21119 Flag the declaration of each identifier that does not have a suffix
21120 corresponding to the kind of entity being declared.
21121 The following declarations are checked:
21122
21123 @itemize @bullet
21124 @item
21125 type declarations
21126
21127 @item
21128 constant declarations (but not number declarations)
21129
21130 @item
21131 package renaming declarations (but not generic package renaming
21132 declarations)
21133 @end itemize
21134
21135 @noindent
21136 This rule may have parameters. When used without parameters, the rule enforces
21137 the following checks:
21138
21139 @itemize @bullet
21140 @item
21141 type-defining names end with @code{_T}, unless the type is an access type,
21142 in which case the suffix must be @code{_A}
21143 @item
21144 constant names end with @code{_C}
21145 @item
21146 names defining package renamings end with @code{_R}
21147 @end itemize
21148
21149 @noindent
21150 For a private or incomplete type declaration the following checks are
21151 made for the defining name suffix:
21152
21153 @itemize @bullet
21154 @item
21155 For an incomplete type declaration: if the corresponding full type
21156 declaration is available, the defining identifier from the full type
21157 declaration is checked, but the defining identifier from the incomplete type
21158 declaration is not; otherwise the defining identifier from the incomplete
21159 type declaration is checked against the suffix specified for type
21160 declarations.
21161
21162 @item
21163 For a private type declaration (including private extensions), the defining
21164 identifier from the private type declaration is checked against the type
21165 suffix (even if the corresponding full declaration is an access type
21166 declaration), and the defining identifier from the corresponding full type
21167 declaration is not checked.
21168 @end itemize
21169
21170 @noindent
21171 For a deferred constant, the defining name in the corresponding full constant
21172 declaration is not checked.
21173
21174 Defining names of formal types are not checked.
21175
21176 The rule may have the following parameters:
21177
21178 @itemize @bullet
21179 @item
21180 For the @option{+R} option:
21181 @table @code
21182 @item Default
21183 Sets the default listed above for all the names to be checked.
21184
21185 @item Type_Suffix=@emph{string}
21186 Specifies the suffix for a type name.
21187
21188 @item Access_Suffix=@emph{string}
21189 Specifies the suffix for an access type name. If
21190 this parameter is set, it overrides for access
21191 types the suffix set by the @code{Type_Suffix} parameter.
21192
21193 @item Constant_Suffix=@emph{string}
21194 Specifies the suffix for a constant name.
21195
21196 @item Renaming_Suffix=@emph{string}
21197 Specifies the suffix for a package renaming name.
21198 @end table
21199
21200 @item
21201 For the @option{-R} option:
21202 @table @code
21203 @item All_Suffixes
21204 Remove all the suffixes specified for the
21205 identifier suffix checks, whether by default or
21206 as specified by other rule parameters. All the
21207 checks for this rule are disabled as a result.
21208
21209 @item Type_Suffix
21210 Removes the suffix specified for types. This
21211 disables checks for types but does not disable
21212 any other checks for this rule (including the
21213 check for access type names if @code{Access_Suffix} is
21214 set).
21215
21216 @item Access_Suffix
21217 Removes the suffix specified for access types.
21218 This disables checks for access type names but
21219 does not disable any other checks for this rule.
21220 If @code{Type_Suffix} is set, access type names are
21221 checked as ordinary type names.
21222
21223 @item Constant_Suffix
21224 Removes the suffix specified for constants. This
21225 disables checks for constant names but does not
21226 disable any other checks for this rule.
21227
21228 @item Renaming_Suffix
21229 Removes the suffix specified for package
21230 renamings. This disables checks for package
21231 renamings but does not disable any other checks
21232 for this rule.
21233 @end table
21234 @end itemize
21235
21236 @noindent
21237 If more than one parameter is used, parameters must be separated by commas.
21238
21239 If more than one option is specified for the @command{gnatcheck} invocation,
21240 a new option overrides the previous one(s).
21241
21242 The @option{+RMisnamed_Identifiers} option (with no parameter) enables
21243 checks for all the
21244 name suffixes specified by previous options used for this rule.
21245
21246 The @option{-RMisnamed_Identifiers} option (with no parameter) disables
21247 all the checks but keeps
21248 all the suffixes specified by previous options used for this rule.
21249
21250 The @emph{string} value must be a valid suffix for an Ada identifier (after
21251 trimming all the leading and trailing space characters, if any).
21252 Parameters are not case sensitive, except the @emph{string} part.
21253
21254 If any error is detected in a rule parameter, the parameter is ignored.
21255 In such a case the options that are set for the rule are not
21256 specified.
21257
21258
21259
21260 @node Multiple_Entries_In_Protected_Definitions
21261 @subsection @code{Multiple_Entries_In_Protected_Definitions}
21262 @cindex @code{Multiple_Entries_In_Protected_Definitions} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21263
21264 @noindent
21265 Flag each protected definition (i.e., each protected object/type declaration)
21266 that defines more than one entry.
21267 Diagnostic messages are generated for all the entry declarations
21268 except the first one. An entry family is counted as one entry. Entries from
21269 the private part of the protected definition are also checked.
21270
21271 This rule has no parameters.
21272
21273 @node Name_Clashes
21274 @subsection @code{Name_Clashes}
21275 @cindex @code{Name_Clashes} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21276
21277 @noindent
21278 Check that certain names are not used as defining identifiers. To activate
21279 this rule, you need to supply a reference to the dictionary file(s) as a rule
21280 parameter(s) (more then one dictionary file can be specified). If no
21281 dictionary file is set, this rule will not cause anything to be flagged.
21282 Only defining occurrences, not references, are checked.
21283 The check is not case-sensitive.
21284
21285 This rule is enabled by default, but without setting any corresponding
21286 dictionary file(s); thus the default effect is to do no checks.
21287
21288 A dictionary file is a plain text file. The maximum line length for this file
21289 is 1024 characters. If the line is longer then this limit, extra characters
21290 are ignored.
21291
21292 Each line can be either an empty line, a comment line, or a line containing
21293 a list of identifiers separated by space or HT characters.
21294 A comment is an Ada-style comment (from @code{--} to end-of-line).
21295 Identifiers must follow the Ada syntax for identifiers.
21296 A line containing one or more identifiers may end with a comment.
21297
21298 @node Non_Qualified_Aggregates
21299 @subsection @code{Non_Qualified_Aggregates}
21300 @cindex @code{Non_Qualified_Aggregates} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21301
21302 @noindent
21303 Flag each non-qualified aggregate.
21304 A non-qualified aggregate is an
21305 aggregate that is not the expression of a qualified expression. A
21306 string literal is not considered an aggregate, but an array
21307 aggregate of a string type is considered as a normal aggregate.
21308 Aggregates of anonymous array types are not flagged.
21309
21310 This rule has no parameters.
21311
21312
21313 @node Non_Short_Circuit_Operators
21314 @subsection @code{Non_Short_Circuit_Operators}
21315 @cindex @code{Non_Short_Circuit_Operators} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21316
21317 @noindent
21318 Flag all calls to predefined @code{and} and @code{or} operators for
21319 any boolean type. Calls to
21320 user-defined @code{and} and @code{or} and to operators defined by renaming
21321 declarations are not flagged. Calls to predefined @code{and} and @code{or}
21322 operators for modular types or boolean array types are not flagged.
21323
21324 This rule has no parameters.
21325
21326
21327
21328 @node Non_SPARK_Attributes
21329 @subsection @code{Non_SPARK_Attributes}
21330 @cindex @code{Non_SPARK_Attributes} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21331
21332 @noindent
21333 The SPARK language defines the following subset of Ada 95 attribute
21334 designators as those that can be used in SPARK programs. The use of
21335 any other attribute is flagged.
21336
21337 @itemize @bullet
21338 @item @code{'Adjacent}
21339 @item @code{'Aft}
21340 @item @code{'Base}
21341 @item @code{'Ceiling}
21342 @item @code{'Component_Size}
21343 @item @code{'Compose}
21344 @item @code{'Copy_Sign}
21345 @item @code{'Delta}
21346 @item @code{'Denorm}
21347 @item @code{'Digits}
21348 @item @code{'Exponent}
21349 @item @code{'First}
21350 @item @code{'Floor}
21351 @item @code{'Fore}
21352 @item @code{'Fraction}
21353 @item @code{'Last}
21354 @item @code{'Leading_Part}
21355 @item @code{'Length}
21356 @item @code{'Machine}
21357 @item @code{'Machine_Emax}
21358 @item @code{'Machine_Emin}
21359 @item @code{'Machine_Mantissa}
21360 @item @code{'Machine_Overflows}
21361 @item @code{'Machine_Radix}
21362 @item @code{'Machine_Rounds}
21363 @item @code{'Max}
21364 @item @code{'Min}
21365 @item @code{'Model}
21366 @item @code{'Model_Emin}
21367 @item @code{'Model_Epsilon}
21368 @item @code{'Model_Mantissa}
21369 @item @code{'Model_Small}
21370 @item @code{'Modulus}
21371 @item @code{'Pos}
21372 @item @code{'Pred}
21373 @item @code{'Range}
21374 @item @code{'Remainder}
21375 @item @code{'Rounding}
21376 @item @code{'Safe_First}
21377 @item @code{'Safe_Last}
21378 @item @code{'Scaling}
21379 @item @code{'Signed_Zeros}
21380 @item @code{'Size}
21381 @item @code{'Small}
21382 @item @code{'Succ}
21383 @item @code{'Truncation}
21384 @item @code{'Unbiased_Rounding}
21385 @item @code{'Val}
21386 @item @code{'Valid}
21387 @end itemize
21388
21389 @noindent
21390 This rule has no parameters.
21391
21392
21393 @node Non_Tagged_Derived_Types
21394 @subsection @code{Non_Tagged_Derived_Types}
21395 @cindex @code{Non_Tagged_Derived_Types} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21396
21397 @noindent
21398 Flag all derived type declarations that do not have a record extension part.
21399
21400 This rule has no parameters.
21401
21402
21403
21404 @node Non_Visible_Exceptions
21405 @subsection @code{Non_Visible_Exceptions}
21406 @cindex @code{Non_Visible_Exceptions} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21407
21408 @noindent
21409 Flag constructs leading to the possibility of propagating an exception
21410 out of the scope in which the exception is declared.
21411 Two cases are detected:
21412
21413 @itemize @bullet
21414 @item
21415 An exception declaration in a subprogram body, task body or block
21416 statement is flagged if the body or statement does not contain a handler for
21417 that exception or a handler with an @code{others} choice.
21418
21419 @item
21420 A @code{raise} statement in an exception handler of a subprogram body,
21421 task body or block statement is flagged if it (re)raises a locally
21422 declared exception. This may occur under the following circumstances:
21423 @itemize @minus
21424 @item
21425 it explicitly raises a locally declared exception, or
21426 @item
21427 it does not specify an exception name (i.e., it is simply @code{raise;})
21428 and the enclosing handler contains a locally declared exception in its
21429 exception choices.
21430 @end itemize
21431 @end itemize
21432
21433 @noindent
21434 Renamings of local exceptions are not flagged.
21435
21436 This rule has no parameters.
21437
21438
21439 @node Numeric_Literals
21440 @subsection @code{Numeric_Literals}
21441 @cindex @code{Numeric_Literals} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21442
21443 @noindent
21444 Flag each use of a numeric literal in an index expression, and in any
21445 circumstance except for the following:
21446
21447 @itemize @bullet
21448 @item
21449 a literal occurring in the initialization expression for a constant
21450 declaration or a named number declaration, or
21451
21452 @item
21453 an integer literal that is less than or equal to a value
21454 specified by the @option{N} rule parameter.
21455 @end itemize
21456
21457 @noindent
21458 This rule may have the following parameters for the @option{+R} option:
21459
21460 @table @asis
21461 @item @emph{N}
21462 @emph{N} is an integer literal used as the maximal value that is not flagged
21463 (i.e., integer literals not exceeding this value are allowed)
21464
21465 @item @code{ALL}
21466 All integer literals are flagged
21467 @end table
21468
21469 @noindent
21470 If no parameters are set, the maximum unflagged value is 1.
21471
21472 The last specified check limit (or the fact that there is no limit at
21473 all) is used when multiple @option{+R} options appear.
21474
21475 The @option{-R} option for this rule has no parameters.
21476 It disables the rule but retains the last specified maximum unflagged value.
21477 If the @option{+R} option subsequently appears, this value is used as the
21478 threshold for the check.
21479
21480
21481 @node OTHERS_In_Aggregates
21482 @subsection @code{OTHERS_In_Aggregates}
21483 @cindex @code{OTHERS_In_Aggregates} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21484
21485 @noindent
21486 Flag each use of an @code{others} choice in extension aggregates.
21487 In record and array aggregates, an @code{others} choice is flagged unless
21488 it is used to refer to all components, or to all but one component.
21489
21490 If, in case of a named array aggregate, there are two associations, one
21491 with an @code{others} choice and another with a discrete range, the
21492 @code{others} choice is flagged even if the discrete range specifies
21493 exactly one component; for example, @code{(1..1 => 0, others => 1)}.
21494
21495 This rule has no parameters.
21496
21497 @node OTHERS_In_CASE_Statements
21498 @subsection @code{OTHERS_In_CASE_Statements}
21499 @cindex @code{OTHERS_In_CASE_Statements} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21500
21501 @noindent
21502 Flag any use of an @code{others} choice in a @code{case} statement.
21503
21504 This rule has no parameters.
21505
21506 @node OTHERS_In_Exception_Handlers
21507 @subsection @code{OTHERS_In_Exception_Handlers}
21508 @cindex @code{OTHERS_In_Exception_Handlers} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21509
21510 @noindent
21511 Flag any use of an @code{others} choice in an exception handler.
21512
21513 This rule has no parameters.
21514
21515
21516 @node Outer_Loop_Exits
21517 @subsection @code{Outer_Loop_Exits}
21518 @cindex @code{Outer_Loop_Exits} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21519
21520 @noindent
21521 Flag each @code{exit} statement containing a loop name that is not the name
21522 of the immediately enclosing @code{loop} statement.
21523
21524 This rule has no parameters.
21525
21526
21527 @node Overloaded_Operators
21528 @subsection @code{Overloaded_Operators}
21529 @cindex @code{Overloaded_Operators} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21530
21531 @noindent
21532 Flag each function declaration that overloads an operator symbol.
21533 A function body is checked only if the body does not have a
21534 separate spec. Formal functions are also checked. For a
21535 renaming declaration, only renaming-as-declaration is checked
21536
21537 This rule has no parameters.
21538
21539
21540 @node Overly_Nested_Control_Structures
21541 @subsection @code{Overly_Nested_Control_Structures}
21542 @cindex @code{Overly_Nested_Control_Structures} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21543
21544 @noindent
21545 Flag each control structure whose nesting level exceeds the value provided
21546 in the rule parameter.
21547
21548 The control structures checked are the following:
21549
21550 @itemize @bullet
21551 @item @code{if} statement
21552 @item @code{case} statement
21553 @item @code{loop} statement
21554 @item Selective accept statement
21555 @item Timed entry call statement
21556 @item Conditional entry call
21557 @item Asynchronous select statement
21558 @end itemize
21559
21560 @noindent
21561 The rule has the following parameter for the @option{+R} option:
21562
21563 @table @emph
21564 @item N
21565 Positive integer specifying the maximal control structure nesting
21566 level that is not flagged
21567 @end table
21568
21569 @noindent
21570 If the parameter for the @option{+R} option is not specified or
21571 if it is not a positive integer, @option{+R} option is ignored.
21572
21573 If more then one option is specified for the gnatcheck call, the later option and
21574 new parameter override the previous one(s).
21575
21576
21577 @node Parameters_Out_Of_Order
21578 @subsection @code{Parameters_Out_Of_Order}
21579 @cindex @code{Parameters_Out_Of_Order} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21580
21581 @noindent
21582 Flag each subprogram and entry declaration whose formal parameters are not
21583 ordered according to the following scheme:
21584
21585 @itemize @bullet
21586
21587 @item @code{in} and @code{access} parameters first,
21588 then @code{in out} parameters,
21589 and then @code{out} parameters;
21590
21591 @item for @code{in} mode, parameters with default initialization expressions
21592 occur last
21593 @end itemize
21594
21595 @noindent
21596 Only the first violation of the described order is flagged.
21597
21598 The following constructs are checked:
21599
21600 @itemize @bullet
21601 @item subprogram declarations (including null procedures);
21602 @item generic subprogram declarations;
21603 @item formal subprogram declarations;
21604 @item entry declarations;
21605 @item subprogram bodies and subprogram body stubs that do not
21606 have separate specifications
21607 @end itemize
21608
21609 @noindent
21610 Subprogram renamings are not checked.
21611
21612 This rule has no parameters.
21613
21614
21615 @node Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Generic_Parameters
21616 @subsection @code{Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Generic_Parameters}
21617 @cindex @code{Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Generic_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21618
21619 @noindent
21620 Flag each generic actual parameter corresponding to a generic formal
21621 parameter with a default initialization, if positional notation is used.
21622
21623 This rule has no parameters.
21624
21625 @node Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Parameters
21626 @subsection @code{Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Parameters}
21627 @cindex @code{Positional_Actuals_For_Defaulted_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21628
21629 @noindent
21630 Flag each actual parameter to a subprogram or entry call where the
21631 corresponding formal parameter has a default expression, if positional
21632 notation is used.
21633
21634 This rule has no parameters.
21635
21636 @node Positional_Components
21637 @subsection @code{Positional_Components}
21638 @cindex @code{Positional_Components} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21639
21640 @noindent
21641 Flag each array, record and extension aggregate that includes positional
21642 notation.
21643
21644 This rule has no parameters.
21645
21646
21647 @node Positional_Generic_Parameters
21648 @subsection @code{Positional_Generic_Parameters}
21649 @cindex @code{Positional_Generic_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21650
21651 @noindent
21652 Flag each instantiation using positional parameter notation.
21653
21654 This rule has no parameters.
21655
21656
21657 @node Positional_Parameters
21658 @subsection @code{Positional_Parameters}
21659 @cindex @code{Positional_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21660
21661 @noindent
21662 Flag each subprogram or entry call using positional parameter notation,
21663 except for the following:
21664
21665 @itemize @bullet
21666 @item
21667 Invocations of prefix or infix operators are not flagged
21668 @item
21669 If the called subprogram or entry has only one formal parameter,
21670 the call is not flagged;
21671 @item
21672 If a subprogram call uses the @emph{Object.Operation} notation, then
21673 @itemize @minus
21674 @item
21675 the first parameter (that is, @emph{Object}) is not flagged;
21676 @item
21677 if the called subprogram has only two parameters, the second parameter
21678 of the call is not flagged;
21679 @end itemize
21680 @end itemize
21681
21682 @noindent
21683 This rule has no parameters.
21684
21685
21686
21687
21688 @node Predefined_Numeric_Types
21689 @subsection @code{Predefined_Numeric_Types}
21690 @cindex @code{Predefined_Numeric_Types} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21691
21692 @noindent
21693 Flag each explicit use of the name of any numeric type or subtype defined
21694 in package @code{Standard}.
21695
21696 The rationale for this rule is to detect when the
21697 program may depend on platform-specific characteristics of the implementation
21698 of the predefined numeric types. Note that this rule is over-pessimistic;
21699 for example, a program that uses @code{String} indexing
21700 likely needs a variable of type @code{Integer}.
21701 Another example is the flagging of predefined numeric types with explicit
21702 constraints:
21703
21704 @smallexample @c ada
21705 subtype My_Integer is Integer range Left .. Right;
21706 Vy_Var : My_Integer;
21707 @end smallexample
21708
21709 @noindent
21710 This rule detects only numeric types and subtypes defined in
21711 @code{Standard}. The use of numeric types and subtypes defined in other
21712 predefined packages (such as @code{System.Any_Priority} or
21713 @code{Ada.Text_IO.Count}) is not flagged
21714
21715 This rule has no parameters.
21716
21717
21718
21719 @node Raising_External_Exceptions
21720 @subsection @code{Raising_External_Exceptions}
21721 @cindex @code{Raising_External_Exceptions} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21722
21723 @noindent
21724 Flag any @code{raise} statement, in a program unit declared in a library
21725 package or in a generic library package, for an exception that is
21726 neither a predefined exception nor an exception that is also declared (or
21727 renamed) in the visible part of the package.
21728
21729 This rule has no parameters.
21730
21731
21732
21733 @node Raising_Predefined_Exceptions
21734 @subsection @code{Raising_Predefined_Exceptions}
21735 @cindex @code{Raising_Predefined_Exceptions} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21736
21737 @noindent
21738 Flag each @code{raise} statement that raises a predefined exception
21739 (i.e., one of the exceptions @code{Constraint_Error}, @code{Numeric_Error},
21740 @code{Program_Error}, @code{Storage_Error}, or @code{Tasking_Error}).
21741
21742 This rule has no parameters.
21743
21744 @node Separate_Numeric_Error_Handlers
21745 @subsection @code{Separate_Numeric_Error_Handlers}
21746 @cindex @code{Separate_Numeric_Error_Handlers} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21747
21748 @noindent
21749 Flags each exception handler that contains a choice for
21750 the predefined @code{Constraint_Error} exception, but does not contain
21751 the choice for the predefined @code{Numeric_Error} exception, or
21752 that contains the choice for @code{Numeric_Error}, but does not contain the
21753 choice for @code{Constraint_Error}.
21754
21755 This rule has no parameters.
21756
21757 @ignore
21758 @node Recursion
21759 @subsection @code{Recursion} (under construction, GLOBAL)
21760 @cindex @code{Recursion} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21761
21762 @noindent
21763 Flag recursive subprograms (cycles in the call graph). Declarations, and not
21764 calls, of recursive subprograms are detected.
21765
21766 This rule has no parameters.
21767 @end ignore
21768
21769 @ignore
21770 @node Side_Effect_Functions
21771 @subsection @code{Side_Effect_Functions} (under construction, GLOBAL)
21772 @cindex @code{Side_Effect_Functions} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21773
21774 @noindent
21775 Flag functions with side effects.
21776
21777 We define a side effect as changing any data object that is not local for the
21778 body of this function.
21779
21780 At the moment, we do NOT consider a side effect any input-output operations
21781 (changing a state or a content of any file).
21782
21783 We do not consider protected functions for this rule (???)
21784
21785 There are the following sources of side effect:
21786
21787 @enumerate
21788 @item Explicit (or direct) side-effect:
21789
21790 @itemize @bullet
21791 @item
21792 direct assignment to a non-local variable;
21793
21794 @item
21795 direct call to an entity that is known to change some data object that is
21796 not local for the body of this function (Note, that if F1 calls F2 and F2
21797 does have a side effect, this does not automatically mean that F1 also
21798 have a side effect, because it may be the case that F2 is declared in
21799 F1's body and it changes some data object that is global for F2, but
21800 local for F1);
21801 @end itemize
21802
21803 @item Indirect side-effect:
21804 @itemize @bullet
21805 @item
21806 Subprogram calls implicitly issued by:
21807 @itemize @bullet
21808 @item
21809 computing initialization expressions from type declarations as a part
21810 of object elaboration or allocator evaluation;
21811 @item
21812 computing implicit parameters of subprogram or entry calls or generic
21813 instantiations;
21814 @end itemize
21815
21816 @item
21817 activation of a task that change some non-local data object (directly or
21818 indirectly);
21819
21820 @item
21821 elaboration code of a package that is a result of a package instantiation;
21822
21823 @item
21824 controlled objects;
21825 @end itemize
21826
21827 @item Situations when we can suspect a side-effect, but the full static check
21828 is either impossible or too hard:
21829 @itemize @bullet
21830 @item
21831 assignment to access variables or to the objects pointed by access
21832 variables;
21833
21834 @item
21835 call to a subprogram pointed by access-to-subprogram value
21836
21837 @item
21838 dispatching calls;
21839 @end itemize
21840 @end enumerate
21841
21842 @noindent
21843 This rule has no parameters.
21844 @end ignore
21845
21846 @node Slices
21847 @subsection @code{Slices}
21848 @cindex @code{Slices} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21849
21850 @noindent
21851 Flag all uses of array slicing
21852
21853 This rule has no parameters.
21854
21855
21856 @node Unassigned_OUT_Parameters
21857 @subsection @code{Unassigned_OUT_Parameters}
21858 @cindex @code{Unassigned_OUT_Parameters} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21859
21860 @noindent
21861 Flags procedures' @code{out} parameters that are not assigned, and
21862 identifies the contexts in which the assignments are missing.
21863
21864 An @code{out} parameter is flagged in the statements in the procedure
21865 body's handled sequence of statements (before the procedure body's
21866 @code{exception} part, if any) if this sequence of statements contains
21867 no assignments to the parameter.
21868
21869 An @code{out} parameter is flagged in an exception handler in the exception
21870 part of the procedure body's handled sequence of statements if the handler
21871 contains no assignment to the parameter.
21872
21873 Bodies of generic procedures are also considered.
21874
21875 The following are treated as assignments to an @code{out} parameter:
21876
21877 @itemize @bullet
21878 @item
21879 an assignment statement, with the parameter or some component as the target;
21880
21881 @item
21882 passing the parameter (or one of its components) as an @code{out} or
21883 @code{in out} parameter.
21884 @end itemize
21885
21886 @noindent
21887 This rule does not have any parameters.
21888
21889
21890
21891 @node Uncommented_BEGIN_In_Package_Bodies
21892 @subsection @code{Uncommented_BEGIN_In_Package_Bodies}
21893 @cindex @code{Uncommented_BEGIN_In_Package_Bodies} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21894
21895 @noindent
21896 Flags each package body with declarations and a statement part that does not
21897 include a trailing comment on the line containing the @code{begin} keyword;
21898 this trailing comment needs to specify the package name and nothing else.
21899 The @code{begin} is not flagged if the package body does not
21900 contain any declarations.
21901
21902 If the @code{begin} keyword is placed on the
21903 same line as the last declaration or the first statement, it is flagged
21904 independently of whether the line contains a trailing comment. The
21905 diagnostic message is attached to the line containing the first statement.
21906
21907 This rule has no parameters.
21908
21909
21910 @node Unconstrained_Array_Returns
21911 @subsection @code{Unconstrained_Array_Returns}
21912 @cindex @code{Unconstrained_Array_Returns} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21913
21914 @noindent
21915 Flag each function returning an unconstrained array. Function declarations,
21916 function bodies (and body stubs) having no separate specifications,
21917 and generic function instantiations are checked.
21918 Generic function declarations, function calls and function renamings are
21919 not checked.
21920
21921 This rule has no parameters.
21922
21923 @node Universal_Ranges
21924 @subsection @code{Universal_Ranges}
21925 @cindex @code{Universal_Ranges} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21926
21927 @noindent
21928 Flag discrete ranges that are a part of an index constraint, constrained
21929 array definition, or @code{for}-loop parameter specification, and whose bounds
21930 are both of type @i{universal_integer}. Ranges that have at least one
21931 bound of a specific type (such as @code{1 .. N}, where @code{N} is a variable
21932 or an expression of non-universal type) are not flagged.
21933
21934 This rule has no parameters.
21935
21936
21937 @node Unnamed_Blocks_And_Loops
21938 @subsection @code{Unnamed_Blocks_And_Loops}
21939 @cindex @code{Unnamed_Blocks_And_Loops} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21940
21941 @noindent
21942 Flag each unnamed block statement and loop statement.
21943
21944 The rule has no parameters.
21945
21946
21947
21948 @ignore
21949 @node Unused_Subprograms
21950 @subsection @code{Unused_Subprograms} (under construction, GLOBAL)
21951 @cindex @code{Unused_Subprograms} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21952
21953 @noindent
21954 Flag all unused subprograms.
21955
21956 This rule has no parameters.
21957 @end ignore
21958
21959
21960
21961
21962 @node USE_PACKAGE_Clauses
21963 @subsection @code{USE_PACKAGE_Clauses}
21964 @cindex @code{USE_PACKAGE_Clauses} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21965
21966 @noindent
21967 Flag all @code{use} clauses for packages; @code{use type} clauses are
21968 not flagged.
21969
21970 This rule has no parameters.
21971
21972
21973
21974 @node Volatile_Objects_Without_Address_Clauses
21975 @subsection @code{Volatile_Objects_Without_Address_Clauses}
21976 @cindex @code{Volatile_Objects_Without_Address_Clauses} rule (for @command{gnatcheck})
21977
21978 @noindent
21979 Flag each volatile object that does not have an address clause.
21980
21981 The following check is made: if the pragma @code{Volatile} is applied to a
21982 data object or to its type, then an address clause must
21983 be supplied for this object.
21984
21985 This rule does not check the components of data objects,
21986 array components that are volatile as a result of the pragma
21987 @code{Volatile_Components}, or objects that are volatile because
21988 they are atomic as a result of pragmas @code{Atomic} or
21989 @code{Atomic_Components}.
21990
21991 Only variable declarations, and not constant declarations, are checked.
21992
21993 This rule has no parameters.
21994
21995
21996 @c *********************************
21997 @node Creating Sample Bodies Using gnatstub
21998 @chapter Creating Sample Bodies Using @command{gnatstub}
21999 @findex gnatstub
22000
22001 @noindent
22002 @command{gnatstub} creates body stubs, that is, empty but compilable bodies
22003 for library unit declarations.
22004
22005 Note: to invoke @code{gnatstub} with a project file, use the @code{gnat}
22006 driver (see @ref{The GNAT Driver and Project Files}).
22007
22008 To create a body stub, @command{gnatstub} has to compile the library
22009 unit declaration. Therefore, bodies can be created only for legal
22010 library units. Moreover, if a library unit depends semantically upon
22011 units located outside the current directory, you have to provide
22012 the source search path when calling @command{gnatstub}, see the description
22013 of @command{gnatstub} switches below.
22014
22015 @menu
22016 * Running gnatstub::
22017 * Switches for gnatstub::
22018 @end menu
22019
22020 @node Running gnatstub
22021 @section Running @command{gnatstub}
22022
22023 @noindent
22024 @command{gnatstub} has the command-line interface of the form
22025
22026 @smallexample
22027 $ gnatstub @ovar{switches} @var{filename} @ovar{directory}
22028 @end smallexample
22029
22030 @noindent
22031 where
22032 @table @var
22033 @item filename
22034 is the name of the source file that contains a library unit declaration
22035 for which a body must be created. The file name may contain the path
22036 information.
22037 The file name does not have to follow the GNAT file name conventions. If the
22038 name
22039 does not follow GNAT file naming conventions, the name of the body file must
22040 be provided
22041 explicitly as the value of the @option{^-o^/BODY=^@var{body-name}} option.
22042 If the file name follows the GNAT file naming
22043 conventions and the name of the body file is not provided,
22044 @command{gnatstub}
22045 creates the name
22046 of the body file from the argument file name by replacing the @file{.ads}
22047 suffix
22048 with the @file{.adb} suffix.
22049
22050 @item directory
22051 indicates the directory in which the body stub is to be placed (the default
22052 is the
22053 current directory)
22054
22055 @item switches
22056 is an optional sequence of switches as described in the next section
22057 @end table
22058
22059 @node Switches for gnatstub
22060 @section Switches for @command{gnatstub}
22061
22062 @table @option
22063 @c !sort!
22064
22065 @item ^-f^/FULL^
22066 @cindex @option{^-f^/FULL^} (@command{gnatstub})
22067 If the destination directory already contains a file with the name of the
22068 body file
22069 for the argument spec file, replace it with the generated body stub.
22070
22071 @item ^-hs^/HEADER=SPEC^
22072 @cindex @option{^-hs^/HEADER=SPEC^} (@command{gnatstub})
22073 Put the comment header (i.e., all the comments preceding the
22074 compilation unit) from the source of the library unit declaration
22075 into the body stub.
22076
22077 @item ^-hg^/HEADER=GENERAL^
22078 @cindex @option{^-hg^/HEADER=GENERAL^} (@command{gnatstub})
22079 Put a sample comment header into the body stub.
22080
22081 @item ^--header-file=@var{filename}^/FROM_HEADER_FILE=@var{filename}^
22082 @cindex @option{^--header-file^/FROM_HEADER_FILE=^} (@command{gnatstub})
22083 Use the content of the file as the comment header for a generated body stub.
22084
22085 @ifclear vms
22086 @item -IDIR
22087 @cindex @option{-IDIR} (@command{gnatstub})
22088 @itemx -I-
22089 @cindex @option{-I-} (@command{gnatstub})
22090 @end ifclear
22091 @ifset vms
22092 @item /NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY
22093 @cindex @option{/NOCURRENT_DIRECTORY} (@command{gnatstub})
22094 @end ifset
22095 ^These switches have ^This switch has^ the same meaning as in calls to
22096 @command{gcc}.
22097 ^They define ^It defines ^ the source search path in the call to
22098 @command{gcc} issued
22099 by @command{gnatstub} to compile an argument source file.
22100
22101 @item ^-gnatec^/CONFIGURATION_PRAGMAS_FILE=^@var{PATH}
22102 @cindex @option{^-gnatec^/CONFIGURATION_PRAGMAS_FILE^} (@command{gnatstub})
22103 This switch has the same meaning as in calls to @command{gcc}.
22104 It defines the additional configuration file to be passed to the call to
22105 @command{gcc} issued
22106 by @command{gnatstub} to compile an argument source file.
22107
22108 @item ^-gnatyM^/MAX_LINE_LENGTH=^@var{n}
22109 @cindex @option{^-gnatyM^/MAX_LINE_LENGTH^} (@command{gnatstub})
22110 (@var{n} is a non-negative integer). Set the maximum line length in the
22111 body stub to @var{n}; the default is 79. The maximum value that can be
22112 specified is 32767. Note that in the special case of configuration
22113 pragma files, the maximum is always 32767 regardless of whether or
22114 not this switch appears.
22115
22116 @item ^-gnaty^/STYLE_CHECKS=^@var{n}
22117 @cindex @option{^-gnaty^/STYLE_CHECKS=^} (@command{gnatstub})
22118 (@var{n} is a non-negative integer from 1 to 9). Set the indentation level in
22119 the generated body sample to @var{n}.
22120 The default indentation is 3.
22121
22122 @item ^-gnatyo^/ORDERED_SUBPROGRAMS^
22123 @cindex @option{^-gnato^/ORDERED_SUBPROGRAMS^} (@command{gnatstub})
22124 Order local bodies alphabetically. (By default local bodies are ordered
22125 in the same way as the corresponding local specs in the argument spec file.)
22126
22127 @item ^-i^/INDENTATION=^@var{n}
22128 @cindex @option{^-i^/INDENTATION^} (@command{gnatstub})
22129 Same as @option{^-gnaty^/STYLE_CHECKS=^@var{n}}
22130
22131 @item ^-k^/TREE_FILE=SAVE^
22132 @cindex @option{^-k^/TREE_FILE=SAVE^} (@command{gnatstub})
22133 Do not remove the tree file (i.e., the snapshot of the compiler internal
22134 structures used by @command{gnatstub}) after creating the body stub.
22135
22136 @item ^-l^/LINE_LENGTH=^@var{n}
22137 @cindex @option{^-l^/LINE_LENGTH^} (@command{gnatstub})
22138 Same as @option{^-gnatyM^/MAX_LINE_LENGTH=^@var{n}}
22139
22140 @item ^-o^/BODY=^@var{body-name}
22141 @cindex @option{^-o^/BODY^} (@command{gnatstub})
22142 Body file name. This should be set if the argument file name does not
22143 follow
22144 the GNAT file naming
22145 conventions. If this switch is omitted the default name for the body will be
22146 obtained
22147 from the argument file name according to the GNAT file naming conventions.
22148
22149 @item ^-q^/QUIET^
22150 @cindex @option{^-q^/QUIET^} (@command{gnatstub})
22151 Quiet mode: do not generate a confirmation when a body is
22152 successfully created, and do not generate a message when a body is not
22153 required for an
22154 argument unit.
22155
22156 @item ^-r^/TREE_FILE=REUSE^
22157 @cindex @option{^-r^/TREE_FILE=REUSE^} (@command{gnatstub})
22158 Reuse the tree file (if it exists) instead of creating it. Instead of
22159 creating the tree file for the library unit declaration, @command{gnatstub}
22160 tries to find it in the current directory and use it for creating
22161 a body. If the tree file is not found, no body is created. This option
22162 also implies @option{^-k^/SAVE^}, whether or not
22163 the latter is set explicitly.
22164
22165 @item ^-t^/TREE_FILE=OVERWRITE^
22166 @cindex @option{^-t^/TREE_FILE=OVERWRITE^} (@command{gnatstub})
22167 Overwrite the existing tree file. If the current directory already
22168 contains the file which, according to the GNAT file naming rules should
22169 be considered as a tree file for the argument source file,
22170 @command{gnatstub}
22171 will refuse to create the tree file needed to create a sample body
22172 unless this option is set.
22173
22174 @item ^-v^/VERBOSE^
22175 @cindex @option{^-v^/VERBOSE^} (@command{gnatstub})
22176 Verbose mode: generate version information.
22177
22178 @end table
22179
22180 @node Other Utility Programs
22181 @chapter Other Utility Programs
22182
22183 @noindent
22184 This chapter discusses some other utility programs available in the Ada
22185 environment.
22186
22187 @menu
22188 * Using Other Utility Programs with GNAT::
22189 * The External Symbol Naming Scheme of GNAT::
22190 * Converting Ada Files to html with gnathtml::
22191 * Installing gnathtml::
22192 @ifset vms
22193 * LSE::
22194 * Profiling::
22195 @end ifset
22196 @end menu
22197
22198 @node Using Other Utility Programs with GNAT
22199 @section Using Other Utility Programs with GNAT
22200
22201 @noindent
22202 The object files generated by GNAT are in standard system format and in
22203 particular the debugging information uses this format. This means
22204 programs generated by GNAT can be used with existing utilities that
22205 depend on these formats.
22206
22207 @ifclear vms
22208 In general, any utility program that works with C will also often work with
22209 Ada programs generated by GNAT. This includes software utilities such as
22210 gprof (a profiling program), @code{gdb} (the FSF debugger), and utilities such
22211 as Purify.
22212 @end ifclear
22213
22214 @node The External Symbol Naming Scheme of GNAT
22215 @section The External Symbol Naming Scheme of GNAT
22216
22217 @noindent
22218 In order to interpret the output from GNAT, when using tools that are
22219 originally intended for use with other languages, it is useful to
22220 understand the conventions used to generate link names from the Ada
22221 entity names.
22222
22223 All link names are in all lowercase letters. With the exception of library
22224 procedure names, the mechanism used is simply to use the full expanded
22225 Ada name with dots replaced by double underscores. For example, suppose
22226 we have the following package spec:
22227
22228 @smallexample @c ada
22229 @group
22230 @cartouche
22231 package QRS is
22232 MN : Integer;
22233 end QRS;
22234 @end cartouche
22235 @end group
22236 @end smallexample
22237
22238 @noindent
22239 The variable @code{MN} has a full expanded Ada name of @code{QRS.MN}, so
22240 the corresponding link name is @code{qrs__mn}.
22241 @findex Export
22242 Of course if a @code{pragma Export} is used this may be overridden:
22243
22244 @smallexample @c ada
22245 @group
22246 @cartouche
22247 package Exports is
22248 Var1 : Integer;
22249 pragma Export (Var1, C, External_Name => "var1_name");
22250 Var2 : Integer;
22251 pragma Export (Var2, C, Link_Name => "var2_link_name");
22252 end Exports;
22253 @end cartouche
22254 @end group
22255 @end smallexample
22256
22257 @noindent
22258 In this case, the link name for @var{Var1} is whatever link name the
22259 C compiler would assign for the C function @var{var1_name}. This typically
22260 would be either @var{var1_name} or @var{_var1_name}, depending on operating
22261 system conventions, but other possibilities exist. The link name for
22262 @var{Var2} is @var{var2_link_name}, and this is not operating system
22263 dependent.
22264
22265 @findex _main
22266 One exception occurs for library level procedures. A potential ambiguity
22267 arises between the required name @code{_main} for the C main program,
22268 and the name we would otherwise assign to an Ada library level procedure
22269 called @code{Main} (which might well not be the main program).
22270
22271 To avoid this ambiguity, we attach the prefix @code{_ada_} to such
22272 names. So if we have a library level procedure such as
22273
22274 @smallexample @c ada
22275 @group
22276 @cartouche
22277 procedure Hello (S : String);
22278 @end cartouche
22279 @end group
22280 @end smallexample
22281
22282 @noindent
22283 the external name of this procedure will be @var{_ada_hello}.
22284
22285
22286 @node Converting Ada Files to html with gnathtml
22287 @section Converting Ada Files to HTML with @code{gnathtml}
22288
22289 @noindent
22290 This @code{Perl} script allows Ada source files to be browsed using
22291 standard Web browsers. For installation procedure, see the section
22292 @xref{Installing gnathtml}.
22293
22294 Ada reserved keywords are highlighted in a bold font and Ada comments in
22295 a blue font. Unless your program was compiled with the gcc @option{-gnatx}
22296 switch to suppress the generation of cross-referencing information, user
22297 defined variables and types will appear in a different color; you will
22298 be able to click on any identifier and go to its declaration.
22299
22300 The command line is as follow:
22301 @smallexample
22302 $ perl gnathtml.pl @ovar{^switches^options^} @var{ada-files}
22303 @end smallexample
22304
22305 @noindent
22306 You can pass it as many Ada files as you want. @code{gnathtml} will generate
22307 an html file for every ada file, and a global file called @file{index.htm}.
22308 This file is an index of every identifier defined in the files.
22309
22310 The available ^switches^options^ are the following ones:
22311
22312 @table @option
22313 @item -83
22314 @cindex @option{-83} (@code{gnathtml})
22315 Only the Ada 83 subset of keywords will be highlighted.
22316
22317 @item -cc @var{color}
22318 @cindex @option{-cc} (@code{gnathtml})
22319 This option allows you to change the color used for comments. The default
22320 value is green. The color argument can be any name accepted by html.
22321
22322 @item -d
22323 @cindex @option{-d} (@code{gnathtml})
22324 If the Ada files depend on some other files (for instance through
22325 @code{with} clauses, the latter files will also be converted to html.
22326 Only the files in the user project will be converted to html, not the files
22327 in the run-time library itself.
22328
22329 @item -D
22330 @cindex @option{-D} (@code{gnathtml})
22331 This command is the same as @option{-d} above, but @command{gnathtml} will
22332 also look for files in the run-time library, and generate html files for them.
22333
22334 @item -ext @var{extension}
22335 @cindex @option{-ext} (@code{gnathtml})
22336 This option allows you to change the extension of the generated HTML files.
22337 If you do not specify an extension, it will default to @file{htm}.
22338
22339 @item -f
22340 @cindex @option{-f} (@code{gnathtml})
22341 By default, gnathtml will generate html links only for global entities
22342 ('with'ed units, global variables and types,@dots{}). If you specify
22343 @option{-f} on the command line, then links will be generated for local
22344 entities too.
22345
22346 @item -l @var{number}
22347 @cindex @option{-l} (@code{gnathtml})
22348 If this ^switch^option^ is provided and @var{number} is not 0, then
22349 @code{gnathtml} will number the html files every @var{number} line.
22350
22351 @item -I @var{dir}
22352 @cindex @option{-I} (@code{gnathtml})
22353 Specify a directory to search for library files (@file{.ALI} files) and
22354 source files. You can provide several -I switches on the command line,
22355 and the directories will be parsed in the order of the command line.
22356
22357 @item -o @var{dir}
22358 @cindex @option{-o} (@code{gnathtml})
22359 Specify the output directory for html files. By default, gnathtml will
22360 saved the generated html files in a subdirectory named @file{html/}.
22361
22362 @item -p @var{file}
22363 @cindex @option{-p} (@code{gnathtml})
22364 If you are using Emacs and the most recent Emacs Ada mode, which provides
22365 a full Integrated Development Environment for compiling, checking,
22366 running and debugging applications, you may use @file{.gpr} files
22367 to give the directories where Emacs can find sources and object files.
22368
22369 Using this ^switch^option^, you can tell gnathtml to use these files.
22370 This allows you to get an html version of your application, even if it
22371 is spread over multiple directories.
22372
22373 @item -sc @var{color}
22374 @cindex @option{-sc} (@code{gnathtml})
22375 This ^switch^option^ allows you to change the color used for symbol
22376 definitions.
22377 The default value is red. The color argument can be any name accepted by html.
22378
22379 @item -t @var{file}
22380 @cindex @option{-t} (@code{gnathtml})
22381 This ^switch^option^ provides the name of a file. This file contains a list of
22382 file names to be converted, and the effect is exactly as though they had
22383 appeared explicitly on the command line. This
22384 is the recommended way to work around the command line length limit on some
22385 systems.
22386
22387 @end table
22388
22389 @node Installing gnathtml
22390 @section Installing @code{gnathtml}
22391
22392 @noindent
22393 @code{Perl} needs to be installed on your machine to run this script.
22394 @code{Perl} is freely available for almost every architecture and
22395 Operating System via the Internet.
22396
22397 On Unix systems, you may want to modify the first line of the script
22398 @code{gnathtml}, to explicitly tell the Operating system where Perl
22399 is. The syntax of this line is:
22400 @smallexample
22401 #!full_path_name_to_perl
22402 @end smallexample
22403
22404 @noindent
22405 Alternatively, you may run the script using the following command line:
22406
22407 @smallexample
22408 $ perl gnathtml.pl @ovar{switches} @var{files}
22409 @end smallexample
22410
22411 @ifset vms
22412 @node LSE
22413 @section LSE
22414 @findex LSE
22415
22416 @noindent
22417 The GNAT distribution provides an Ada 95 template for the HP Language
22418 Sensitive Editor (LSE), a component of DECset. In order to
22419 access it, invoke LSE with the qualifier /ENVIRONMENT=GNU:[LIB]ADA95.ENV.
22420
22421 @node Profiling
22422 @section Profiling
22423 @findex PCA
22424
22425 @noindent
22426 GNAT supports The HP Performance Coverage Analyzer (PCA), a component
22427 of DECset. To use it proceed as outlined under ``HELP PCA'', except for running
22428 the collection phase with the /DEBUG qualifier.
22429
22430 @smallexample
22431 $ GNAT MAKE /DEBUG <PROGRAM_NAME>
22432 $ DEFINE LIB$DEBUG PCA$COLLECTOR
22433 $ RUN/DEBUG <PROGRAM_NAME>
22434 @end smallexample
22435 @noindent
22436 @end ifset
22437
22438 @ifclear vms
22439 @c ******************************
22440 @node Code Coverage and Profiling
22441 @chapter Code Coverage and Profiling
22442 @cindex Code Coverage
22443 @cindex Profiling
22444
22445 @noindent
22446 This chapter describes how to use @code{gcov} - coverage testing tool - and
22447 @code{gprof} - profiler tool - on your Ada programs.
22448
22449 @menu
22450 * Code Coverage of Ada Programs using gcov::
22451 * Profiling an Ada Program using gprof::
22452 @end menu
22453
22454 @node Code Coverage of Ada Programs using gcov
22455 @section Code Coverage of Ada Programs using gcov
22456 @cindex gcov
22457 @cindex -fprofile-arcs
22458 @cindex -ftest-coverage
22459 @cindex -coverage
22460 @cindex Code Coverage
22461
22462 @noindent
22463 @code{gcov} is a test coverage program: it analyzes the execution of a given
22464 program on selected tests, to help you determine the portions of the program
22465 that are still untested.
22466
22467 @code{gcov} is part of the GCC suite, and is described in detail in the GCC
22468 User's Guide. You can refer to this documentation for a more complete
22469 description.
22470
22471 This chapter provides a quick startup guide, and
22472 details some Gnat-specific features.
22473
22474 @menu
22475 * Quick startup guide::
22476 * Gnat specifics::
22477 @end menu
22478
22479 @node Quick startup guide
22480 @subsection Quick startup guide
22481
22482 In order to perform coverage analysis of a program using @code{gcov}, 3
22483 steps are needed:
22484
22485 @itemize @bullet
22486 @item
22487 Code instrumentation during the compilation process
22488 @item
22489 Execution of the instrumented program
22490 @item
22491 Execution of the @code{gcov} tool to generate the result.
22492 @end itemize
22493
22494 The code instrumentation needed by gcov is created at the object level:
22495 The source code is not modified in any way, because the instrumentation code is
22496 inserted by gcc during the compilation process. To compile your code with code
22497 coverage activated, you need to recompile your whole project using the
22498 switches
22499 @code{-fprofile-arcs} and @code{-ftest-coverage}, and link it using
22500 @code{-fprofile-arcs}.
22501
22502 @smallexample
22503 $ gnatmake -P my_project.gpr -f -cargs -fprofile-arcs -ftest-coverage \
22504 -largs -fprofile-arcs
22505 @end smallexample
22506
22507 This compilation process will create @file{.gcno} files together with
22508 the usual object files.
22509
22510 Once the program is compiled with coverage instrumentation, you can
22511 run it as many times as needed - on portions of a test suite for
22512 example. The first execution will produce @file{.gcda} files at the
22513 same location as the @file{.gcno} files. The following executions
22514 will update those files, so that a cumulative result of the covered
22515 portions of the program is generated.
22516
22517 Finally, you need to call the @code{gcov} tool. The different options of
22518 @code{gcov} are available in the GCC User's Guide, section 'Invoking gcov'.
22519
22520 This will create annotated source files with a @file{.gcov} extension:
22521 @file{my_main.adb} file will be analysed in @file{my_main.adb.gcov}.
22522
22523 @node Gnat specifics
22524 @subsection Gnat specifics
22525
22526 Because Ada semantics, portions of the source code may be shared among
22527 several object files. This is the case for example when generics are
22528 involved, when inlining is active or when declarations generate initialisation
22529 calls. In order to take
22530 into account this shared code, you need to call @code{gcov} on all
22531 source files of the tested program at once.
22532
22533 The list of source files might exceed the system's maximum command line
22534 length. In order to bypass this limitation, a new mechanism has been
22535 implemented in @code{gcov}: you can now list all your project's files into a
22536 text file, and provide this file to gcov as a parameter, preceded by a @@
22537 (e.g. @samp{gcov @@mysrclist.txt}).
22538
22539 Note that on AIX compiling a static library with @code{-fprofile-arcs} is
22540 not supported as there can be unresolved symbols during the final link.
22541
22542 @node Profiling an Ada Program using gprof
22543 @section Profiling an Ada Program using gprof
22544 @cindex gprof
22545 @cindex -pg
22546 @cindex Profiling
22547
22548 @noindent
22549 This section is not meant to be an exhaustive documentation of @code{gprof}.
22550 Full documentation for it can be found in the GNU Profiler User's Guide
22551 documentation that is part of this GNAT distribution.
22552
22553 Profiling a program helps determine the parts of a program that are executed
22554 most often, and are therefore the most time-consuming.
22555
22556 @code{gprof} is the standard GNU profiling tool; it has been enhanced to
22557 better handle Ada programs and multitasking.
22558 It is currently supported on the following platforms
22559 @itemize @bullet
22560 @item
22561 linux x86/x86_64
22562 @item
22563 solaris sparc/sparc64/x86
22564 @item
22565 windows x86
22566 @end itemize
22567
22568 @noindent
22569 In order to profile a program using @code{gprof}, 3 steps are needed:
22570
22571 @itemize @bullet
22572 @item
22573 Code instrumentation, requiring a full recompilation of the project with the
22574 proper switches.
22575 @item
22576 Execution of the program under the analysis conditions, i.e. with the desired
22577 input.
22578 @item
22579 Analysis of the results using the @code{gprof} tool.
22580 @end itemize
22581
22582 @noindent
22583 The following sections detail the different steps, and indicate how
22584 to interpret the results:
22585 @menu
22586 * Compilation for profiling::
22587 * Program execution::
22588 * Running gprof::
22589 * Interpretation of profiling results::
22590 @end menu
22591
22592 @node Compilation for profiling
22593 @subsection Compilation for profiling
22594 @cindex -pg
22595 @cindex Profiling
22596
22597 In order to profile a program the first step is to tell the compiler
22598 to generate the necessary profiling information. The compiler switch to be used
22599 is @code{-pg}, which must be added to other compilation switches. This
22600 switch needs to be specified both during compilation and link stages, and can
22601 be specified once when using gnatmake:
22602
22603 @smallexample
22604 gnatmake -f -pg -P my_project
22605 @end smallexample
22606
22607 @noindent
22608 Note that only the objects that were compiled with the @samp{-pg} switch will be
22609 profiled; if you need to profile your whole project, use the
22610 @samp{-f} gnatmake switch to force full recompilation.
22611
22612 @node Program execution
22613 @subsection Program execution
22614
22615 @noindent
22616 Once the program has been compiled for profiling, you can run it as usual.
22617
22618 The only constraint imposed by profiling is that the program must terminate
22619 normally. An interrupted program (via a Ctrl-C, kill, etc.) will not be
22620 properly analyzed.
22621
22622 Once the program completes execution, a data file called @file{gmon.out} is
22623 generated in the directory where the program was launched from. If this file
22624 already exists, it will be overwritten.
22625
22626 @node Running gprof
22627 @subsection Running gprof
22628
22629 @noindent
22630 The @code{gprof} tool is called as follow:
22631
22632 @smallexample
22633 gprof my_prog gmon.out
22634 @end smallexample
22635
22636 @noindent
22637 or simpler:
22638
22639 @smallexample
22640 gprof my_prog
22641 @end smallexample
22642
22643 @noindent
22644 The complete form of the gprof command line is the following:
22645
22646 @smallexample
22647 gprof [^switches^options^] [executable [data-file]]
22648 @end smallexample
22649
22650 @noindent
22651 @code{gprof} supports numerous ^switch^options^. The order of these
22652 ^switch^options^ does not matter. The full list of options can be found in
22653 the GNU Profiler User's Guide documentation that comes with this documentation.
22654
22655 The following is the subset of those switches that is most relevant:
22656
22657 @table @option
22658
22659 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
22660 @itemx --no-demangle
22661 @cindex @option{--demangle} (@code{gprof})
22662 These options control whether symbol names should be demangled when
22663 printing output. The default is to demangle C++ symbols. The
22664 @code{--no-demangle} option may be used to turn off demangling. Different
22665 compilers have different mangling styles. The optional demangling style
22666 argument can be used to choose an appropriate demangling style for your
22667 compiler, in particular Ada symbols generated by GNAT can be demangled using
22668 @code{--demangle=gnat}.
22669
22670 @item -e @var{function_name}
22671 @cindex @option{-e} (@code{gprof})
22672 The @samp{-e @var{function}} option tells @code{gprof} not to print
22673 information about the function @var{function_name} (and its
22674 children@dots{}) in the call graph. The function will still be listed
22675 as a child of any functions that call it, but its index number will be
22676 shown as @samp{[not printed]}. More than one @samp{-e} option may be
22677 given; only one @var{function_name} may be indicated with each @samp{-e}
22678 option.
22679
22680 @item -E @var{function_name}
22681 @cindex @option{-E} (@code{gprof})
22682 The @code{-E @var{function}} option works like the @code{-e} option, but
22683 execution time spent in the function (and children who were not called from
22684 anywhere else), will not be used to compute the percentages-of-time for
22685 the call graph. More than one @samp{-E} option may be given; only one
22686 @var{function_name} may be indicated with each @samp{-E} option.
22687
22688 @item -f @var{function_name}
22689 @cindex @option{-f} (@code{gprof})
22690 The @samp{-f @var{function}} option causes @code{gprof} to limit the
22691 call graph to the function @var{function_name} and its children (and
22692 their children@dots{}). More than one @samp{-f} option may be given;
22693 only one @var{function_name} may be indicated with each @samp{-f}
22694 option.
22695
22696 @item -F @var{function_name}
22697 @cindex @option{-F} (@code{gprof})
22698 The @samp{-F @var{function}} option works like the @code{-f} option, but
22699 only time spent in the function and its children (and their
22700 children@dots{}) will be used to determine total-time and
22701 percentages-of-time for the call graph. More than one @samp{-F} option
22702 may be given; only one @var{function_name} may be indicated with each
22703 @samp{-F} option. The @samp{-F} option overrides the @samp{-E} option.
22704
22705 @end table
22706
22707 @node Interpretation of profiling results
22708 @subsection Interpretation of profiling results
22709
22710 @noindent
22711
22712 The results of the profiling analysis are represented by two arrays: the
22713 'flat profile' and the 'call graph'. Full documentation of those outputs
22714 can be found in the GNU Profiler User's Guide.
22715
22716 The flat profile shows the time spent in each function of the program, and how
22717 many time it has been called. This allows you to locate easily the most
22718 time-consuming functions.
22719
22720 The call graph shows, for each subprogram, the subprograms that call it,
22721 and the subprograms that it calls. It also provides an estimate of the time
22722 spent in each of those callers/called subprograms.
22723 @end ifclear
22724
22725 @c ******************************
22726 @node Running and Debugging Ada Programs
22727 @chapter Running and Debugging Ada Programs
22728 @cindex Debugging
22729
22730 @noindent
22731 This chapter discusses how to debug Ada programs.
22732 @ifset vms
22733 It applies to GNAT on the Alpha OpenVMS platform;
22734 for I64 OpenVMS please refer to the @cite{OpenVMS Debugger Manual},
22735 since HP has implemented Ada support in the OpenVMS debugger on I64.
22736 @end ifset
22737
22738 An incorrect Ada program may be handled in three ways by the GNAT compiler:
22739
22740 @enumerate
22741 @item
22742 The illegality may be a violation of the static semantics of Ada. In
22743 that case GNAT diagnoses the constructs in the program that are illegal.
22744 It is then a straightforward matter for the user to modify those parts of
22745 the program.
22746
22747 @item
22748 The illegality may be a violation of the dynamic semantics of Ada. In
22749 that case the program compiles and executes, but may generate incorrect
22750 results, or may terminate abnormally with some exception.
22751
22752 @item
22753 When presented with a program that contains convoluted errors, GNAT
22754 itself may terminate abnormally without providing full diagnostics on
22755 the incorrect user program.
22756 @end enumerate
22757
22758 @menu
22759 * The GNAT Debugger GDB::
22760 * Running GDB::
22761 * Introduction to GDB Commands::
22762 * Using Ada Expressions::
22763 * Calling User-Defined Subprograms::
22764 * Using the Next Command in a Function::
22765 * Ada Exceptions::
22766 * Ada Tasks::
22767 * Debugging Generic Units::
22768 * GNAT Abnormal Termination or Failure to Terminate::
22769 * Naming Conventions for GNAT Source Files::
22770 * Getting Internal Debugging Information::
22771 * Stack Traceback::
22772 @end menu
22773
22774 @cindex Debugger
22775 @findex gdb
22776
22777 @node The GNAT Debugger GDB
22778 @section The GNAT Debugger GDB
22779
22780 @noindent
22781 @code{GDB} is a general purpose, platform-independent debugger that
22782 can be used to debug mixed-language programs compiled with @command{gcc},
22783 and in particular is capable of debugging Ada programs compiled with
22784 GNAT. The latest versions of @code{GDB} are Ada-aware and can handle
22785 complex Ada data structures.
22786
22787 @xref{Top,, Debugging with GDB, gdb, Debugging with GDB},
22788 @ifset vms
22789 located in the GNU:[DOCS] directory,
22790 @end ifset
22791 for full details on the usage of @code{GDB}, including a section on
22792 its usage on programs. This manual should be consulted for full
22793 details. The section that follows is a brief introduction to the
22794 philosophy and use of @code{GDB}.
22795
22796 When GNAT programs are compiled, the compiler optionally writes debugging
22797 information into the generated object file, including information on
22798 line numbers, and on declared types and variables. This information is
22799 separate from the generated code. It makes the object files considerably
22800 larger, but it does not add to the size of the actual executable that
22801 will be loaded into memory, and has no impact on run-time performance. The
22802 generation of debug information is triggered by the use of the
22803 ^-g^/DEBUG^ switch in the @command{gcc} or @command{gnatmake} command
22804 used to carry out the compilations. It is important to emphasize that
22805 the use of these options does not change the generated code.
22806
22807 The debugging information is written in standard system formats that
22808 are used by many tools, including debuggers and profilers. The format
22809 of the information is typically designed to describe C types and
22810 semantics, but GNAT implements a translation scheme which allows full
22811 details about Ada types and variables to be encoded into these
22812 standard C formats. Details of this encoding scheme may be found in
22813 the file exp_dbug.ads in the GNAT source distribution. However, the
22814 details of this encoding are, in general, of no interest to a user,
22815 since @code{GDB} automatically performs the necessary decoding.
22816
22817 When a program is bound and linked, the debugging information is
22818 collected from the object files, and stored in the executable image of
22819 the program. Again, this process significantly increases the size of
22820 the generated executable file, but it does not increase the size of
22821 the executable program itself. Furthermore, if this program is run in
22822 the normal manner, it runs exactly as if the debug information were
22823 not present, and takes no more actual memory.
22824
22825 However, if the program is run under control of @code{GDB}, the
22826 debugger is activated. The image of the program is loaded, at which
22827 point it is ready to run. If a run command is given, then the program
22828 will run exactly as it would have if @code{GDB} were not present. This
22829 is a crucial part of the @code{GDB} design philosophy. @code{GDB} is
22830 entirely non-intrusive until a breakpoint is encountered. If no
22831 breakpoint is ever hit, the program will run exactly as it would if no
22832 debugger were present. When a breakpoint is hit, @code{GDB} accesses
22833 the debugging information and can respond to user commands to inspect
22834 variables, and more generally to report on the state of execution.
22835
22836 @c **************
22837 @node Running GDB
22838 @section Running GDB
22839
22840 @noindent
22841 This section describes how to initiate the debugger.
22842 @c The above sentence is really just filler, but it was otherwise
22843 @c clumsy to get the first paragraph nonindented given the conditional
22844 @c nature of the description
22845
22846 @ifclear vms
22847 The debugger can be launched from a @code{GPS} menu or
22848 directly from the command line. The description below covers the latter use.
22849 All the commands shown can be used in the @code{GPS} debug console window,
22850 but there are usually more GUI-based ways to achieve the same effect.
22851 @end ifclear
22852
22853 The command to run @code{GDB} is
22854
22855 @smallexample
22856 $ ^gdb program^GDB PROGRAM^
22857 @end smallexample
22858
22859 @noindent
22860 where @code{^program^PROGRAM^} is the name of the executable file. This
22861 activates the debugger and results in a prompt for debugger commands.
22862 The simplest command is simply @code{run}, which causes the program to run
22863 exactly as if the debugger were not present. The following section
22864 describes some of the additional commands that can be given to @code{GDB}.
22865
22866 @c *******************************
22867 @node Introduction to GDB Commands
22868 @section Introduction to GDB Commands
22869
22870 @noindent
22871 @code{GDB} contains a large repertoire of commands. @xref{Top,,
22872 Debugging with GDB, gdb, Debugging with GDB},
22873 @ifset vms
22874 located in the GNU:[DOCS] directory,
22875 @end ifset
22876 for extensive documentation on the use
22877 of these commands, together with examples of their use. Furthermore,
22878 the command @command{help} invoked from within GDB activates a simple help
22879 facility which summarizes the available commands and their options.
22880 In this section we summarize a few of the most commonly
22881 used commands to give an idea of what @code{GDB} is about. You should create
22882 a simple program with debugging information and experiment with the use of
22883 these @code{GDB} commands on the program as you read through the
22884 following section.
22885
22886 @table @code
22887 @item set args @var{arguments}
22888 The @var{arguments} list above is a list of arguments to be passed to
22889 the program on a subsequent run command, just as though the arguments
22890 had been entered on a normal invocation of the program. The @code{set args}
22891 command is not needed if the program does not require arguments.
22892
22893 @item run
22894 The @code{run} command causes execution of the program to start from
22895 the beginning. If the program is already running, that is to say if
22896 you are currently positioned at a breakpoint, then a prompt will ask
22897 for confirmation that you want to abandon the current execution and
22898 restart.
22899
22900 @item breakpoint @var{location}
22901 The breakpoint command sets a breakpoint, that is to say a point at which
22902 execution will halt and @code{GDB} will await further
22903 commands. @var{location} is
22904 either a line number within a file, given in the format @code{file:linenumber},
22905 or it is the name of a subprogram. If you request that a breakpoint be set on
22906 a subprogram that is overloaded, a prompt will ask you to specify on which of
22907 those subprograms you want to breakpoint. You can also
22908 specify that all of them should be breakpointed. If the program is run
22909 and execution encounters the breakpoint, then the program
22910 stops and @code{GDB} signals that the breakpoint was encountered by
22911 printing the line of code before which the program is halted.
22912
22913 @item breakpoint exception @var{name}
22914 A special form of the breakpoint command which breakpoints whenever
22915 exception @var{name} is raised.
22916 If @var{name} is omitted,
22917 then a breakpoint will occur when any exception is raised.
22918
22919 @item print @var{expression}
22920 This will print the value of the given expression. Most simple
22921 Ada expression formats are properly handled by @code{GDB}, so the expression
22922 can contain function calls, variables, operators, and attribute references.
22923
22924 @item continue
22925 Continues execution following a breakpoint, until the next breakpoint or the
22926 termination of the program.
22927
22928 @item step
22929 Executes a single line after a breakpoint. If the next statement
22930 is a subprogram call, execution continues into (the first statement of)
22931 the called subprogram.
22932
22933 @item next
22934 Executes a single line. If this line is a subprogram call, executes and
22935 returns from the call.
22936
22937 @item list
22938 Lists a few lines around the current source location. In practice, it
22939 is usually more convenient to have a separate edit window open with the
22940 relevant source file displayed. Successive applications of this command
22941 print subsequent lines. The command can be given an argument which is a
22942 line number, in which case it displays a few lines around the specified one.
22943
22944 @item backtrace
22945 Displays a backtrace of the call chain. This command is typically
22946 used after a breakpoint has occurred, to examine the sequence of calls that
22947 leads to the current breakpoint. The display includes one line for each
22948 activation record (frame) corresponding to an active subprogram.
22949
22950 @item up
22951 At a breakpoint, @code{GDB} can display the values of variables local
22952 to the current frame. The command @code{up} can be used to
22953 examine the contents of other active frames, by moving the focus up
22954 the stack, that is to say from callee to caller, one frame at a time.
22955
22956 @item down
22957 Moves the focus of @code{GDB} down from the frame currently being
22958 examined to the frame of its callee (the reverse of the previous command),
22959
22960 @item frame @var{n}
22961 Inspect the frame with the given number. The value 0 denotes the frame
22962 of the current breakpoint, that is to say the top of the call stack.
22963
22964 @end table
22965
22966 @noindent
22967 The above list is a very short introduction to the commands that
22968 @code{GDB} provides. Important additional capabilities, including conditional
22969 breakpoints, the ability to execute command sequences on a breakpoint,
22970 the ability to debug at the machine instruction level and many other
22971 features are described in detail in @ref{Top,, Debugging with GDB, gdb,
22972 Debugging with GDB}. Note that most commands can be abbreviated
22973 (for example, c for continue, bt for backtrace).
22974
22975 @node Using Ada Expressions
22976 @section Using Ada Expressions
22977 @cindex Ada expressions
22978
22979 @noindent
22980 @code{GDB} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression syntax, with some
22981 extensions. The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
22982
22983 @itemize @bullet
22984 @item
22985 That @code{GDB} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
22986 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
22987 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
22988 program (which therefore may be called from @code{GDB}).
22989
22990 @item
22991 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
22992 are not particularly important to the @code{GDB} user.
22993
22994 @item
22995 That brevity is important to the @code{GDB} user.
22996 @end itemize
22997
22998 @noindent
22999 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
23000 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
23001 packages, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
23002 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
23003 @code{GDB} asks the user's intent.
23004
23005 For details on the supported Ada syntax, see @ref{Top,, Debugging with
23006 GDB, gdb, Debugging with GDB}.
23007
23008 @node Calling User-Defined Subprograms
23009 @section Calling User-Defined Subprograms
23010
23011 @noindent
23012 An important capability of @code{GDB} is the ability to call user-defined
23013 subprograms while debugging. This is achieved simply by entering
23014 a subprogram call statement in the form:
23015
23016 @smallexample
23017 call subprogram-name (parameters)
23018 @end smallexample
23019
23020 @noindent
23021 The keyword @code{call} can be omitted in the normal case where the
23022 @code{subprogram-name} does not coincide with any of the predefined
23023 @code{GDB} commands.
23024
23025 The effect is to invoke the given subprogram, passing it the
23026 list of parameters that is supplied. The parameters can be expressions and
23027 can include variables from the program being debugged. The
23028 subprogram must be defined
23029 at the library level within your program, and @code{GDB} will call the
23030 subprogram within the environment of your program execution (which
23031 means that the subprogram is free to access or even modify variables
23032 within your program).
23033
23034 The most important use of this facility is in allowing the inclusion of
23035 debugging routines that are tailored to particular data structures
23036 in your program. Such debugging routines can be written to provide a suitably
23037 high-level description of an abstract type, rather than a low-level dump
23038 of its physical layout. After all, the standard
23039 @code{GDB print} command only knows the physical layout of your
23040 types, not their abstract meaning. Debugging routines can provide information
23041 at the desired semantic level and are thus enormously useful.
23042
23043 For example, when debugging GNAT itself, it is crucial to have access to
23044 the contents of the tree nodes used to represent the program internally.
23045 But tree nodes are represented simply by an integer value (which in turn
23046 is an index into a table of nodes).
23047 Using the @code{print} command on a tree node would simply print this integer
23048 value, which is not very useful. But the PN routine (defined in file
23049 treepr.adb in the GNAT sources) takes a tree node as input, and displays
23050 a useful high level representation of the tree node, which includes the
23051 syntactic category of the node, its position in the source, the integers
23052 that denote descendant nodes and parent node, as well as varied
23053 semantic information. To study this example in more detail, you might want to
23054 look at the body of the PN procedure in the stated file.
23055
23056 @node Using the Next Command in a Function
23057 @section Using the Next Command in a Function
23058
23059 @noindent
23060 When you use the @code{next} command in a function, the current source
23061 location will advance to the next statement as usual. A special case
23062 arises in the case of a @code{return} statement.
23063
23064 Part of the code for a return statement is the ``epilog'' of the function.
23065 This is the code that returns to the caller. There is only one copy of
23066 this epilog code, and it is typically associated with the last return
23067 statement in the function if there is more than one return. In some
23068 implementations, this epilog is associated with the first statement
23069 of the function.
23070
23071 The result is that if you use the @code{next} command from a return
23072 statement that is not the last return statement of the function you
23073 may see a strange apparent jump to the last return statement or to
23074 the start of the function. You should simply ignore this odd jump.
23075 The value returned is always that from the first return statement
23076 that was stepped through.
23077
23078 @node Ada Exceptions
23079 @section Breaking on Ada Exceptions
23080 @cindex Exceptions
23081
23082 @noindent
23083 You can set breakpoints that trip when your program raises
23084 selected exceptions.
23085
23086 @table @code
23087 @item break exception
23088 Set a breakpoint that trips whenever (any task in the) program raises
23089 any exception.
23090
23091 @item break exception @var{name}
23092 Set a breakpoint that trips whenever (any task in the) program raises
23093 the exception @var{name}.
23094
23095 @item break exception unhandled
23096 Set a breakpoint that trips whenever (any task in the) program raises an
23097 exception for which there is no handler.
23098
23099 @item info exceptions
23100 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
23101 The @code{info exceptions} command permits the user to examine all defined
23102 exceptions within Ada programs. With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as
23103 argument, prints out only those exceptions whose name matches @var{regexp}.
23104 @end table
23105
23106 @node Ada Tasks
23107 @section Ada Tasks
23108 @cindex Tasks
23109
23110 @noindent
23111 @code{GDB} allows the following task-related commands:
23112
23113 @table @code
23114 @item info tasks
23115 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
23116
23117 @smallexample
23118 @iftex
23119 @leftskip=0cm
23120 @end iftex
23121 (gdb) info tasks
23122 ID TID P-ID Thread Pri State Name
23123 1 8088000 0 807e000 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
23124 2 80a4000 1 80ae000 15 Accept/Select Wait b
23125 3 809a800 1 80a4800 15 Child Activation Wait a
23126 * 4 80ae800 3 80b8000 15 Running c
23127 @end smallexample
23128
23129 @noindent
23130 In this listing, the asterisk before the first task indicates it to be the
23131 currently running task. The first column lists the task ID that is used
23132 to refer to tasks in the following commands.
23133
23134 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskid}
23135 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskid} if @dots{}
23136 @cindex Breakpoints and tasks
23137 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}.
23138 @var{linespec} specifies source lines.
23139
23140 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskid}} with a breakpoint command
23141 to specify that you only want @code{GDB} to stop the program when a
23142 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskid} is one of the
23143 numeric task identifiers assigned by @code{GDB}, shown in the first
23144 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
23145
23146 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskid}} when you set a
23147 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
23148 program.
23149
23150 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
23151 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskid}} before the
23152 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
23153
23154 @item task @var{taskno}
23155 @cindex Task switching
23156
23157 This command allows to switch to the task referred by @var{taskno}. In
23158 particular, This allows to browse the backtrace of the specified
23159 task. It is advised to switch back to the original task before
23160 continuing execution otherwise the scheduling of the program may be
23161 perturbed.
23162 @end table
23163
23164 @noindent
23165 For more detailed information on the tasking support,
23166 see @ref{Top,, Debugging with GDB, gdb, Debugging with GDB}.
23167
23168 @node Debugging Generic Units
23169 @section Debugging Generic Units
23170 @cindex Debugging Generic Units
23171 @cindex Generics
23172
23173 @noindent
23174 GNAT always uses code expansion for generic instantiation. This means that
23175 each time an instantiation occurs, a complete copy of the original code is
23176 made, with appropriate substitutions of formals by actuals.
23177
23178 It is not possible to refer to the original generic entities in
23179 @code{GDB}, but it is always possible to debug a particular instance of
23180 a generic, by using the appropriate expanded names. For example, if we have
23181
23182 @smallexample @c ada
23183 @group
23184 @cartouche
23185 procedure g is
23186
23187 generic package k is
23188 procedure kp (v1 : in out integer);
23189 end k;
23190
23191 package body k is
23192 procedure kp (v1 : in out integer) is
23193 begin
23194 v1 := v1 + 1;
23195 end kp;
23196 end k;
23197
23198 package k1 is new k;
23199 package k2 is new k;
23200
23201 var : integer := 1;
23202
23203 begin
23204 k1.kp (var);
23205 k2.kp (var);
23206 k1.kp (var);
23207 k2.kp (var);
23208 end;
23209 @end cartouche
23210 @end group
23211 @end smallexample
23212
23213 @noindent
23214 Then to break on a call to procedure kp in the k2 instance, simply
23215 use the command:
23216
23217 @smallexample
23218 (gdb) break g.k2.kp
23219 @end smallexample
23220
23221 @noindent
23222 When the breakpoint occurs, you can step through the code of the
23223 instance in the normal manner and examine the values of local variables, as for
23224 other units.
23225
23226 @node GNAT Abnormal Termination or Failure to Terminate
23227 @section GNAT Abnormal Termination or Failure to Terminate
23228 @cindex GNAT Abnormal Termination or Failure to Terminate
23229
23230 @noindent
23231 When presented with programs that contain serious errors in syntax
23232 or semantics,
23233 GNAT may on rare occasions experience problems in operation, such
23234 as aborting with a
23235 segmentation fault or illegal memory access, raising an internal
23236 exception, terminating abnormally, or failing to terminate at all.
23237 In such cases, you can activate
23238 various features of GNAT that can help you pinpoint the construct in your
23239 program that is the likely source of the problem.
23240
23241 The following strategies are presented in increasing order of
23242 difficulty, corresponding to your experience in using GNAT and your
23243 familiarity with compiler internals.
23244
23245 @enumerate
23246 @item
23247 Run @command{gcc} with the @option{-gnatf}. This first
23248 switch causes all errors on a given line to be reported. In its absence,
23249 only the first error on a line is displayed.
23250
23251 The @option{-gnatdO} switch causes errors to be displayed as soon as they
23252 are encountered, rather than after compilation is terminated. If GNAT
23253 terminates prematurely or goes into an infinite loop, the last error
23254 message displayed may help to pinpoint the culprit.
23255
23256 @item
23257 Run @command{gcc} with the @option{^-v (verbose)^/VERBOSE^} switch. In this
23258 mode, @command{gcc} produces ongoing information about the progress of the
23259 compilation and provides the name of each procedure as code is
23260 generated. This switch allows you to find which Ada procedure was being
23261 compiled when it encountered a code generation problem.
23262
23263 @item
23264 @cindex @option{-gnatdc} switch
23265 Run @command{gcc} with the @option{-gnatdc} switch. This is a GNAT specific
23266 switch that does for the front-end what @option{^-v^VERBOSE^} does
23267 for the back end. The system prints the name of each unit,
23268 either a compilation unit or nested unit, as it is being analyzed.
23269 @item
23270 Finally, you can start
23271 @code{gdb} directly on the @code{gnat1} executable. @code{gnat1} is the
23272 front-end of GNAT, and can be run independently (normally it is just
23273 called from @command{gcc}). You can use @code{gdb} on @code{gnat1} as you
23274 would on a C program (but @pxref{The GNAT Debugger GDB} for caveats). The
23275 @code{where} command is the first line of attack; the variable
23276 @code{lineno} (seen by @code{print lineno}), used by the second phase of
23277 @code{gnat1} and by the @command{gcc} backend, indicates the source line at
23278 which the execution stopped, and @code{input_file name} indicates the name of
23279 the source file.
23280 @end enumerate
23281
23282 @node Naming Conventions for GNAT Source Files
23283 @section Naming Conventions for GNAT Source Files
23284
23285 @noindent
23286 In order to examine the workings of the GNAT system, the following
23287 brief description of its organization may be helpful:
23288
23289 @itemize @bullet
23290 @item
23291 Files with prefix @file{^sc^SC^} contain the lexical scanner.
23292
23293 @item
23294 All files prefixed with @file{^par^PAR^} are components of the parser. The
23295 numbers correspond to chapters of the Ada Reference Manual. For example,
23296 parsing of select statements can be found in @file{par-ch9.adb}.
23297
23298 @item
23299 All files prefixed with @file{^sem^SEM^} perform semantic analysis. The
23300 numbers correspond to chapters of the Ada standard. For example, all
23301 issues involving context clauses can be found in @file{sem_ch10.adb}. In
23302 addition, some features of the language require sufficient special processing
23303 to justify their own semantic files: sem_aggr for aggregates, sem_disp for
23304 dynamic dispatching, etc.
23305
23306 @item
23307 All files prefixed with @file{^exp^EXP^} perform normalization and
23308 expansion of the intermediate representation (abstract syntax tree, or AST).
23309 these files use the same numbering scheme as the parser and semantics files.
23310 For example, the construction of record initialization procedures is done in
23311 @file{exp_ch3.adb}.
23312
23313 @item
23314 The files prefixed with @file{^bind^BIND^} implement the binder, which
23315 verifies the consistency of the compilation, determines an order of
23316 elaboration, and generates the bind file.
23317
23318 @item
23319 The files @file{atree.ads} and @file{atree.adb} detail the low-level
23320 data structures used by the front-end.
23321
23322 @item
23323 The files @file{sinfo.ads} and @file{sinfo.adb} detail the structure of
23324 the abstract syntax tree as produced by the parser.
23325
23326 @item
23327 The files @file{einfo.ads} and @file{einfo.adb} detail the attributes of
23328 all entities, computed during semantic analysis.
23329
23330 @item
23331 Library management issues are dealt with in files with prefix
23332 @file{^lib^LIB^}.
23333
23334 @item
23335 @findex Ada
23336 @cindex Annex A
23337 Ada files with the prefix @file{^a-^A-^} are children of @code{Ada}, as
23338 defined in Annex A.
23339
23340 @item
23341 @findex Interfaces
23342 @cindex Annex B
23343 Files with prefix @file{^i-^I-^} are children of @code{Interfaces}, as
23344 defined in Annex B.
23345
23346 @item
23347 @findex System
23348 Files with prefix @file{^s-^S-^} are children of @code{System}. This includes
23349 both language-defined children and GNAT run-time routines.
23350
23351 @item
23352 @findex GNAT
23353 Files with prefix @file{^g-^G-^} are children of @code{GNAT}. These are useful
23354 general-purpose packages, fully documented in their specs. All
23355 the other @file{.c} files are modifications of common @command{gcc} files.
23356 @end itemize
23357
23358 @node Getting Internal Debugging Information
23359 @section Getting Internal Debugging Information
23360
23361 @noindent
23362 Most compilers have internal debugging switches and modes. GNAT
23363 does also, except GNAT internal debugging switches and modes are not
23364 secret. A summary and full description of all the compiler and binder
23365 debug flags are in the file @file{debug.adb}. You must obtain the
23366 sources of the compiler to see the full detailed effects of these flags.
23367
23368 The switches that print the source of the program (reconstructed from
23369 the internal tree) are of general interest for user programs, as are the
23370 options to print
23371 the full internal tree, and the entity table (the symbol table
23372 information). The reconstructed source provides a readable version of the
23373 program after the front-end has completed analysis and expansion,
23374 and is useful when studying the performance of specific constructs.
23375 For example, constraint checks are indicated, complex aggregates
23376 are replaced with loops and assignments, and tasking primitives
23377 are replaced with run-time calls.
23378
23379 @node Stack Traceback
23380 @section Stack Traceback
23381 @cindex traceback
23382 @cindex stack traceback
23383 @cindex stack unwinding
23384
23385 @noindent
23386 Traceback is a mechanism to display the sequence of subprogram calls that
23387 leads to a specified execution point in a program. Often (but not always)
23388 the execution point is an instruction at which an exception has been raised.
23389 This mechanism is also known as @i{stack unwinding} because it obtains
23390 its information by scanning the run-time stack and recovering the activation
23391 records of all active subprograms. Stack unwinding is one of the most
23392 important tools for program debugging.
23393
23394 The first entry stored in traceback corresponds to the deepest calling level,
23395 that is to say the subprogram currently executing the instruction
23396 from which we want to obtain the traceback.
23397
23398 Note that there is no runtime performance penalty when stack traceback
23399 is enabled, and no exception is raised during program execution.
23400
23401 @menu
23402 * Non-Symbolic Traceback::
23403 * Symbolic Traceback::
23404 @end menu
23405
23406 @node Non-Symbolic Traceback
23407 @subsection Non-Symbolic Traceback
23408 @cindex traceback, non-symbolic
23409
23410 @noindent
23411 Note: this feature is not supported on all platforms. See
23412 @file{GNAT.Traceback spec in g-traceb.ads} for a complete list of supported
23413 platforms.
23414
23415 @menu
23416 * Tracebacks From an Unhandled Exception::
23417 * Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences (non-symbolic)::
23418 * Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program (non-symbolic)::
23419 @end menu
23420
23421 @node Tracebacks From an Unhandled Exception
23422 @subsubsection Tracebacks From an Unhandled Exception
23423
23424 @noindent
23425 A runtime non-symbolic traceback is a list of addresses of call instructions.
23426 To enable this feature you must use the @option{-E}
23427 @code{gnatbind}'s option. With this option a stack traceback is stored as part
23428 of exception information. You can retrieve this information using the
23429 @code{addr2line} tool.
23430
23431 Here is a simple example:
23432
23433 @smallexample @c ada
23434 @cartouche
23435 procedure STB is
23436
23437 procedure P1 is
23438 begin
23439 raise Constraint_Error;
23440 end P1;
23441
23442 procedure P2 is
23443 begin
23444 P1;
23445 end P2;
23446
23447 begin
23448 P2;
23449 end STB;
23450 @end cartouche
23451 @end smallexample
23452
23453 @smallexample
23454 $ gnatmake stb -bargs -E
23455 $ stb
23456
23457 Execution terminated by unhandled exception
23458 Exception name: CONSTRAINT_ERROR
23459 Message: stb.adb:5
23460 Call stack traceback locations:
23461 0x401373 0x40138b 0x40139c 0x401335 0x4011c4 0x4011f1 0x77e892a4
23462 @end smallexample
23463
23464 @noindent
23465 As we see the traceback lists a sequence of addresses for the unhandled
23466 exception @code{CONSTRAINT_ERROR} raised in procedure P1. It is easy to
23467 guess that this exception come from procedure P1. To translate these
23468 addresses into the source lines where the calls appear, the
23469 @code{addr2line} tool, described below, is invaluable. The use of this tool
23470 requires the program to be compiled with debug information.
23471
23472 @smallexample
23473 $ gnatmake -g stb -bargs -E
23474 $ stb
23475
23476 Execution terminated by unhandled exception
23477 Exception name: CONSTRAINT_ERROR
23478 Message: stb.adb:5
23479 Call stack traceback locations:
23480 0x401373 0x40138b 0x40139c 0x401335 0x4011c4 0x4011f1 0x77e892a4
23481
23482 $ addr2line --exe=stb 0x401373 0x40138b 0x40139c 0x401335 0x4011c4
23483 0x4011f1 0x77e892a4
23484
23485 00401373 at d:/stb/stb.adb:5
23486 0040138B at d:/stb/stb.adb:10
23487 0040139C at d:/stb/stb.adb:14
23488 00401335 at d:/stb/b~stb.adb:104
23489 004011C4 at /build/@dots{}/crt1.c:200
23490 004011F1 at /build/@dots{}/crt1.c:222
23491 77E892A4 in ?? at ??:0
23492 @end smallexample
23493
23494 @noindent
23495 The @code{addr2line} tool has several other useful options:
23496
23497 @table @code
23498 @item --functions
23499 to get the function name corresponding to any location
23500
23501 @item --demangle=gnat
23502 to use the gnat decoding mode for the function names. Note that
23503 for binutils version 2.9.x the option is simply @option{--demangle}.
23504 @end table
23505
23506 @smallexample
23507 $ addr2line --exe=stb --functions --demangle=gnat 0x401373 0x40138b
23508 0x40139c 0x401335 0x4011c4 0x4011f1
23509
23510 00401373 in stb.p1 at d:/stb/stb.adb:5
23511 0040138B in stb.p2 at d:/stb/stb.adb:10
23512 0040139C in stb at d:/stb/stb.adb:14
23513 00401335 in main at d:/stb/b~stb.adb:104
23514 004011C4 in <__mingw_CRTStartup> at /build/@dots{}/crt1.c:200
23515 004011F1 in <mainCRTStartup> at /build/@dots{}/crt1.c:222
23516 @end smallexample
23517
23518 @noindent
23519 From this traceback we can see that the exception was raised in
23520 @file{stb.adb} at line 5, which was reached from a procedure call in
23521 @file{stb.adb} at line 10, and so on. The @file{b~std.adb} is the binder file,
23522 which contains the call to the main program.
23523 @xref{Running gnatbind}. The remaining entries are assorted runtime routines,
23524 and the output will vary from platform to platform.
23525
23526 It is also possible to use @code{GDB} with these traceback addresses to debug
23527 the program. For example, we can break at a given code location, as reported
23528 in the stack traceback:
23529
23530 @smallexample
23531 $ gdb -nw stb
23532 @ifclear vms
23533 @noindent
23534 Furthermore, this feature is not implemented inside Windows DLL. Only
23535 the non-symbolic traceback is reported in this case.
23536 @end ifclear
23537
23538 (gdb) break *0x401373
23539 Breakpoint 1 at 0x401373: file stb.adb, line 5.
23540 @end smallexample
23541
23542 @noindent
23543 It is important to note that the stack traceback addresses
23544 do not change when debug information is included. This is particularly useful
23545 because it makes it possible to release software without debug information (to
23546 minimize object size), get a field report that includes a stack traceback
23547 whenever an internal bug occurs, and then be able to retrieve the sequence
23548 of calls with the same program compiled with debug information.
23549
23550 @node Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences (non-symbolic)
23551 @subsubsection Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences
23552
23553 @noindent
23554 Non-symbolic tracebacks are obtained by using the @option{-E} binder argument.
23555 The stack traceback is attached to the exception information string, and can
23556 be retrieved in an exception handler within the Ada program, by means of the
23557 Ada facilities defined in @code{Ada.Exceptions}. Here is a simple example:
23558
23559 @smallexample @c ada
23560 with Ada.Text_IO;
23561 with Ada.Exceptions;
23562
23563 procedure STB is
23564
23565 use Ada;
23566 use Ada.Exceptions;
23567
23568 procedure P1 is
23569 K : Positive := 1;
23570 begin
23571 K := K - 1;
23572 exception
23573 when E : others =>
23574 Text_IO.Put_Line (Exception_Information (E));
23575 end P1;
23576
23577 procedure P2 is
23578 begin
23579 P1;
23580 end P2;
23581
23582 begin
23583 P2;
23584 end STB;
23585 @end smallexample
23586
23587 @noindent
23588 This program will output:
23589
23590 @smallexample
23591 $ stb
23592
23593 Exception name: CONSTRAINT_ERROR
23594 Message: stb.adb:12
23595 Call stack traceback locations:
23596 0x4015e4 0x401633 0x401644 0x401461 0x4011c4 0x4011f1 0x77e892a4
23597 @end smallexample
23598
23599 @node Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program (non-symbolic)
23600 @subsubsection Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program
23601
23602 @noindent
23603 It is also possible to retrieve a stack traceback from anywhere in a
23604 program. For this you need to
23605 use the @code{GNAT.Traceback} API. This package includes a procedure called
23606 @code{Call_Chain} that computes a complete stack traceback, as well as useful
23607 display procedures described below. It is not necessary to use the
23608 @option{-E gnatbind} option in this case, because the stack traceback mechanism
23609 is invoked explicitly.
23610
23611 @noindent
23612 In the following example we compute a traceback at a specific location in
23613 the program, and we display it using @code{GNAT.Debug_Utilities.Image} to
23614 convert addresses to strings:
23615
23616 @smallexample @c ada
23617 with Ada.Text_IO;
23618 with GNAT.Traceback;
23619 with GNAT.Debug_Utilities;
23620
23621 procedure STB is
23622
23623 use Ada;
23624 use GNAT;
23625 use GNAT.Traceback;
23626
23627 procedure P1 is
23628 TB : Tracebacks_Array (1 .. 10);
23629 -- We are asking for a maximum of 10 stack frames.
23630 Len : Natural;
23631 -- Len will receive the actual number of stack frames returned.
23632 begin
23633 Call_Chain (TB, Len);
23634
23635 Text_IO.Put ("In STB.P1 : ");
23636
23637 for K in 1 .. Len loop
23638 Text_IO.Put (Debug_Utilities.Image (TB (K)));
23639 Text_IO.Put (' ');
23640 end loop;
23641
23642 Text_IO.New_Line;
23643 end P1;
23644
23645 procedure P2 is
23646 begin
23647 P1;
23648 end P2;
23649
23650 begin
23651 P2;
23652 end STB;
23653 @end smallexample
23654
23655 @smallexample
23656 $ gnatmake -g stb
23657 $ stb
23658
23659 In STB.P1 : 16#0040_F1E4# 16#0040_14F2# 16#0040_170B# 16#0040_171C#
23660 16#0040_1461# 16#0040_11C4# 16#0040_11F1# 16#77E8_92A4#
23661 @end smallexample
23662
23663 @noindent
23664 You can then get further information by invoking the @code{addr2line}
23665 tool as described earlier (note that the hexadecimal addresses
23666 need to be specified in C format, with a leading ``0x'').
23667
23668 @node Symbolic Traceback
23669 @subsection Symbolic Traceback
23670 @cindex traceback, symbolic
23671
23672 @noindent
23673 A symbolic traceback is a stack traceback in which procedure names are
23674 associated with each code location.
23675
23676 @noindent
23677 Note that this feature is not supported on all platforms. See
23678 @file{GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic spec in g-trasym.ads} for a complete
23679 list of currently supported platforms.
23680
23681 @noindent
23682 Note that the symbolic traceback requires that the program be compiled
23683 with debug information. If it is not compiled with debug information
23684 only the non-symbolic information will be valid.
23685
23686 @menu
23687 * Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences (symbolic)::
23688 * Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program (symbolic)::
23689 @end menu
23690
23691 @node Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences (symbolic)
23692 @subsubsection Tracebacks From Exception Occurrences
23693
23694 @smallexample @c ada
23695 with Ada.Text_IO;
23696 with GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic;
23697
23698 procedure STB is
23699
23700 procedure P1 is
23701 begin
23702 raise Constraint_Error;
23703 end P1;
23704
23705 procedure P2 is
23706 begin
23707 P1;
23708 end P2;
23709
23710 procedure P3 is
23711 begin
23712 P2;
23713 end P3;
23714
23715 begin
23716 P3;
23717 exception
23718 when E : others =>
23719 Ada.Text_IO.Put_Line (GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic.Symbolic_Traceback (E));
23720 end STB;
23721 @end smallexample
23722
23723 @smallexample
23724 $ gnatmake -g .\stb -bargs -E -largs -lgnat -laddr2line -lintl
23725 $ stb
23726
23727 0040149F in stb.p1 at stb.adb:8
23728 004014B7 in stb.p2 at stb.adb:13
23729 004014CF in stb.p3 at stb.adb:18
23730 004015DD in ada.stb at stb.adb:22
23731 00401461 in main at b~stb.adb:168
23732 004011C4 in __mingw_CRTStartup at crt1.c:200
23733 004011F1 in mainCRTStartup at crt1.c:222
23734 77E892A4 in ?? at ??:0
23735 @end smallexample
23736
23737 @noindent
23738 In the above example the ``.\'' syntax in the @command{gnatmake} command
23739 is currently required by @command{addr2line} for files that are in
23740 the current working directory.
23741 Moreover, the exact sequence of linker options may vary from platform
23742 to platform.
23743 The above @option{-largs} section is for Windows platforms. By contrast,
23744 under Unix there is no need for the @option{-largs} section.
23745 Differences across platforms are due to details of linker implementation.
23746
23747 @node Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program (symbolic)
23748 @subsubsection Tracebacks From Anywhere in a Program
23749
23750 @noindent
23751 It is possible to get a symbolic stack traceback
23752 from anywhere in a program, just as for non-symbolic tracebacks.
23753 The first step is to obtain a non-symbolic
23754 traceback, and then call @code{Symbolic_Traceback} to compute the symbolic
23755 information. Here is an example:
23756
23757 @smallexample @c ada
23758 with Ada.Text_IO;
23759 with GNAT.Traceback;
23760 with GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic;
23761
23762 procedure STB is
23763
23764 use Ada;
23765 use GNAT.Traceback;
23766 use GNAT.Traceback.Symbolic;
23767
23768 procedure P1 is
23769 TB : Tracebacks_Array (1 .. 10);
23770 -- We are asking for a maximum of 10 stack frames.
23771 Len : Natural;
23772 -- Len will receive the actual number of stack frames returned.
23773 begin
23774 Call_Chain (TB, Len);
23775 Text_IO.Put_Line (Symbolic_Traceback (TB (1 .. Len)));
23776 end P1;
23777
23778 procedure P2 is
23779 begin
23780 P1;
23781 end P2;
23782
23783 begin
23784 P2;
23785 end STB;
23786 @end smallexample
23787
23788 @c ******************************
23789 @ifset vms
23790 @node Compatibility with HP Ada
23791 @chapter Compatibility with HP Ada
23792 @cindex Compatibility
23793
23794 @noindent
23795 @cindex DEC Ada
23796 @cindex HP Ada
23797 @cindex Compatibility between GNAT and HP Ada
23798 This chapter compares HP Ada (formerly known as ``DEC Ada'')
23799 for OpenVMS Alpha and GNAT for OpenVMS for Alpha and for I64.
23800 GNAT is highly compatible
23801 with HP Ada, and it should generally be straightforward to port code
23802 from the HP Ada environment to GNAT. However, there are a few language
23803 and implementation differences of which the user must be aware. These
23804 differences are discussed in this chapter. In
23805 addition, the operating environment and command structure for the
23806 compiler are different, and these differences are also discussed.
23807
23808 For further details on these and other compatibility issues,
23809 see Appendix E of the HP publication
23810 @cite{HP Ada, Technical Overview and Comparison on HP Platforms}.
23811
23812 Except where otherwise indicated, the description of GNAT for OpenVMS
23813 applies to both the Alpha and I64 platforms.
23814
23815 For information on porting Ada code from GNAT on Alpha OpenVMS to GNAT on
23816 I64 OpenVMS, see @ref{Transitioning to 64-Bit GNAT for OpenVMS}.
23817
23818 The discussion in this chapter addresses specifically the implementation
23819 of Ada 83 for HP OpenVMS Alpha Systems. In cases where the implementation
23820 of HP Ada differs between OpenVMS Alpha Systems and OpenVMS VAX Systems,
23821 GNAT always follows the Alpha implementation.
23822
23823 For GNAT running on other than VMS systems, all the HP Ada 83 pragmas and
23824 attributes are recognized, although only a subset of them can sensibly
23825 be implemented. The description of pragmas in
23826 @xref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}
23827 indicates whether or not they are applicable to non-VMS systems.
23828
23829 @menu
23830 * Ada Language Compatibility::
23831 * Differences in the Definition of Package System::
23832 * Language-Related Features::
23833 * The Package STANDARD::
23834 * The Package SYSTEM::
23835 * Tasking and Task-Related Features::
23836 * Pragmas and Pragma-Related Features::
23837 * Library of Predefined Units::
23838 * Bindings::
23839 * Main Program Definition::
23840 * Implementation-Defined Attributes::
23841 * Compiler and Run-Time Interfacing::
23842 * Program Compilation and Library Management::
23843 * Input-Output::
23844 * Implementation Limits::
23845 * Tools and Utilities::
23846 @end menu
23847
23848 @node Ada Language Compatibility
23849 @section Ada Language Compatibility
23850
23851 @noindent
23852 GNAT handles Ada 95 and Ada 2005 as well as Ada 83, whereas HP Ada is only
23853 for Ada 83. Ada 95 and Ada 2005 are almost completely upwards compatible
23854 with Ada 83, and therefore Ada 83 programs will compile
23855 and run under GNAT with
23856 no changes or only minor changes. The @cite{Annotated Ada Reference Manual}
23857 provides details on specific incompatibilities.
23858
23859 GNAT provides the switch @option{/83} on the @command{GNAT COMPILE} command,
23860 as well as the pragma @code{ADA_83}, to force the compiler to
23861 operate in Ada 83 mode. This mode does not guarantee complete
23862 conformance to Ada 83, but in practice is sufficient to
23863 eliminate most sources of incompatibilities.
23864 In particular, it eliminates the recognition of the
23865 additional Ada 95 and Ada 2005 keywords, so that their use as identifiers
23866 in Ada 83 programs is legal, and handles the cases of packages
23867 with optional bodies, and generics that instantiate unconstrained
23868 types without the use of @code{(<>)}.
23869
23870 @node Differences in the Definition of Package System
23871 @section Differences in the Definition of Package @code{System}
23872
23873 @noindent
23874 An Ada compiler is allowed to add
23875 implementation-dependent declarations to package @code{System}.
23876 In normal mode,
23877 GNAT does not take advantage of this permission, and the version of
23878 @code{System} provided by GNAT exactly matches that defined in the Ada
23879 Reference Manual.
23880
23881 However, HP Ada adds an extensive set of declarations to package
23882 @code{System},
23883 as fully documented in the HP Ada manuals. To minimize changes required
23884 for programs that make use of these extensions, GNAT provides the pragma
23885 @code{Extend_System} for extending the definition of package System. By using:
23886 @cindex pragma @code{Extend_System}
23887 @cindex @code{Extend_System} pragma
23888
23889 @smallexample @c ada
23890 @group
23891 @cartouche
23892 pragma Extend_System (Aux_DEC);
23893 @end cartouche
23894 @end group
23895 @end smallexample
23896
23897 @noindent
23898 the set of definitions in @code{System} is extended to include those in
23899 package @code{System.Aux_DEC}.
23900 @cindex @code{System.Aux_DEC} package
23901 @cindex @code{Aux_DEC} package (child of @code{System})
23902 These definitions are incorporated directly into package @code{System},
23903 as though they had been declared there. For a
23904 list of the declarations added, see the spec of this package,
23905 which can be found in the file @file{s-auxdec.ads} in the GNAT library.
23906 @cindex @file{s-auxdec.ads} file
23907 The pragma @code{Extend_System} is a configuration pragma, which means that
23908 it can be placed in the file @file{gnat.adc}, so that it will automatically
23909 apply to all subsequent compilations. See @ref{Configuration Pragmas},
23910 for further details.
23911
23912 An alternative approach that avoids the use of the non-standard
23913 @code{Extend_System} pragma is to add a context clause to the unit that
23914 references these facilities:
23915
23916 @smallexample @c ada
23917 @cartouche
23918 with System.Aux_DEC;
23919 use System.Aux_DEC;
23920 @end cartouche
23921 @end smallexample
23922
23923 @noindent
23924 The effect is not quite semantically identical to incorporating
23925 the declarations directly into package @code{System},
23926 but most programs will not notice a difference
23927 unless they use prefix notation (e.g.@: @code{System.Integer_8})
23928 to reference the entities directly in package @code{System}.
23929 For units containing such references,
23930 the prefixes must either be removed, or the pragma @code{Extend_System}
23931 must be used.
23932
23933 @node Language-Related Features
23934 @section Language-Related Features
23935
23936 @noindent
23937 The following sections highlight differences in types,
23938 representations of types, operations, alignment, and
23939 related topics.
23940
23941 @menu
23942 * Integer Types and Representations::
23943 * Floating-Point Types and Representations::
23944 * Pragmas Float_Representation and Long_Float::
23945 * Fixed-Point Types and Representations::
23946 * Record and Array Component Alignment::
23947 * Address Clauses::
23948 * Other Representation Clauses::
23949 @end menu
23950
23951 @node Integer Types and Representations
23952 @subsection Integer Types and Representations
23953
23954 @noindent
23955 The set of predefined integer types is identical in HP Ada and GNAT.
23956 Furthermore the representation of these integer types is also identical,
23957 including the capability of size clauses forcing biased representation.
23958
23959 In addition,
23960 HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha systems has defined the
23961 following additional integer types in package @code{System}:
23962
23963 @itemize @bullet
23964
23965 @item
23966 @code{INTEGER_8}
23967
23968 @item
23969 @code{INTEGER_16}
23970
23971 @item
23972 @code{INTEGER_32}
23973
23974 @item
23975 @code{INTEGER_64}
23976
23977 @item
23978 @code{LARGEST_INTEGER}
23979 @end itemize
23980
23981 @noindent
23982 In GNAT, the first four of these types may be obtained from the
23983 standard Ada package @code{Interfaces}.
23984 Alternatively, by use of the pragma @code{Extend_System}, identical
23985 declarations can be referenced directly in package @code{System}.
23986 On both GNAT and HP Ada, the maximum integer size is 64 bits.
23987
23988 @node Floating-Point Types and Representations
23989 @subsection Floating-Point Types and Representations
23990 @cindex Floating-Point types
23991
23992 @noindent
23993 The set of predefined floating-point types is identical in HP Ada and GNAT.
23994 Furthermore the representation of these floating-point
23995 types is also identical. One important difference is that the default
23996 representation for HP Ada is @code{VAX_Float}, but the default representation
23997 for GNAT is IEEE.
23998
23999 Specific types may be declared to be @code{VAX_Float} or IEEE, using the
24000 pragma @code{Float_Representation} as described in the HP Ada
24001 documentation.
24002 For example, the declarations:
24003
24004 @smallexample @c ada
24005 @cartouche
24006 type F_Float is digits 6;
24007 pragma Float_Representation (VAX_Float, F_Float);
24008 @end cartouche
24009 @end smallexample
24010
24011 @noindent
24012 declares a type @code{F_Float} that will be represented in @code{VAX_Float}
24013 format.
24014 This set of declarations actually appears in @code{System.Aux_DEC},
24015 which contains
24016 the full set of additional floating-point declarations provided in
24017 the HP Ada version of package @code{System}.
24018 This and similar declarations may be accessed in a user program
24019 by using pragma @code{Extend_System}. The use of this
24020 pragma, and the related pragma @code{Long_Float} is described in further
24021 detail in the following section.
24022
24023 @node Pragmas Float_Representation and Long_Float
24024 @subsection Pragmas @code{Float_Representation} and @code{Long_Float}
24025
24026 @noindent
24027 HP Ada provides the pragma @code{Float_Representation}, which
24028 acts as a program library switch to allow control over
24029 the internal representation chosen for the predefined
24030 floating-point types declared in the package @code{Standard}.
24031 The format of this pragma is as follows:
24032
24033 @smallexample @c ada
24034 @cartouche
24035 pragma Float_Representation(VAX_Float | IEEE_Float);
24036 @end cartouche
24037 @end smallexample
24038
24039 @noindent
24040 This pragma controls the representation of floating-point
24041 types as follows:
24042
24043 @itemize @bullet
24044 @item
24045 @code{VAX_Float} specifies that floating-point
24046 types are represented by default with the VAX system hardware types
24047 @code{F-floating}, @code{D-floating}, @code{G-floating}.
24048 Note that the @code{H-floating}
24049 type was available only on VAX systems, and is not available
24050 in either HP Ada or GNAT.
24051
24052 @item
24053 @code{IEEE_Float} specifies that floating-point
24054 types are represented by default with the IEEE single and
24055 double floating-point types.
24056 @end itemize
24057
24058 @noindent
24059 GNAT provides an identical implementation of the pragma
24060 @code{Float_Representation}, except that it functions as a
24061 configuration pragma. Note that the
24062 notion of configuration pragma corresponds closely to the
24063 HP Ada notion of a program library switch.
24064
24065 When no pragma is used in GNAT, the default is @code{IEEE_Float},
24066 which is different
24067 from HP Ada 83, where the default is @code{VAX_Float}. In addition, the
24068 predefined libraries in GNAT are built using @code{IEEE_Float}, so it is not
24069 advisable to change the format of numbers passed to standard library
24070 routines, and if necessary explicit type conversions may be needed.
24071
24072 The use of @code{IEEE_Float} is recommended in GNAT since it is more
24073 efficient, and (given that it conforms to an international standard)
24074 potentially more portable.
24075 The situation in which @code{VAX_Float} may be useful is in interfacing
24076 to existing code and data that expect the use of @code{VAX_Float}.
24077 In such a situation use the predefined @code{VAX_Float}
24078 types in package @code{System}, as extended by
24079 @code{Extend_System}. For example, use @code{System.F_Float}
24080 to specify the 32-bit @code{F-Float} format.
24081
24082 @noindent
24083 On OpenVMS systems, HP Ada provides the pragma @code{Long_Float}
24084 to allow control over the internal representation chosen
24085 for the predefined type @code{Long_Float} and for floating-point
24086 type declarations with digits specified in the range 7 .. 15.
24087 The format of this pragma is as follows:
24088
24089 @smallexample @c ada
24090 @cartouche
24091 pragma Long_Float (D_FLOAT | G_FLOAT);
24092 @end cartouche
24093 @end smallexample
24094
24095 @node Fixed-Point Types and Representations
24096 @subsection Fixed-Point Types and Representations
24097
24098 @noindent
24099 On HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha systems, rounding is
24100 away from zero for both positive and negative numbers.
24101 Therefore, @code{+0.5} rounds to @code{1},
24102 and @code{-0.5} rounds to @code{-1}.
24103
24104 On GNAT the results of operations
24105 on fixed-point types are in accordance with the Ada
24106 rules. In particular, results of operations on decimal
24107 fixed-point types are truncated.
24108
24109 @node Record and Array Component Alignment
24110 @subsection Record and Array Component Alignment
24111
24112 @noindent
24113 On HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha, all non-composite components
24114 are aligned on natural boundaries. For example, 1-byte
24115 components are aligned on byte boundaries, 2-byte
24116 components on 2-byte boundaries, 4-byte components on 4-byte
24117 byte boundaries, and so on. The OpenVMS Alpha hardware
24118 runs more efficiently with naturally aligned data.
24119
24120 On GNAT, alignment rules are compatible
24121 with HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha.
24122
24123 @node Address Clauses
24124 @subsection Address Clauses
24125
24126 @noindent
24127 In HP Ada and GNAT, address clauses are supported for
24128 objects and imported subprograms.
24129 The predefined type @code{System.Address} is a private type
24130 in both compilers on Alpha OpenVMS, with the same representation
24131 (it is simply a machine pointer). Addition, subtraction, and comparison
24132 operations are available in the standard Ada package
24133 @code{System.Storage_Elements}, or in package @code{System}
24134 if it is extended to include @code{System.Aux_DEC} using a
24135 pragma @code{Extend_System} as previously described.
24136
24137 Note that code that @code{with}'s both this extended package @code{System}
24138 and the package @code{System.Storage_Elements} should not @code{use}
24139 both packages, or ambiguities will result. In general it is better
24140 not to mix these two sets of facilities. The Ada package was
24141 designed specifically to provide the kind of features that HP Ada
24142 adds directly to package @code{System}.
24143
24144 The type @code{System.Address} is a 64-bit integer type in GNAT for
24145 I64 OpenVMS. For more information,
24146 see @ref{Transitioning to 64-Bit GNAT for OpenVMS}.
24147
24148 GNAT is compatible with HP Ada in its handling of address
24149 clauses, except for some limitations in
24150 the form of address clauses for composite objects with
24151 initialization. Such address clauses are easily replaced
24152 by the use of an explicitly-defined constant as described
24153 in the Ada Reference Manual (13.1(22)). For example, the sequence
24154 of declarations:
24155
24156 @smallexample @c ada
24157 @cartouche
24158 X, Y : Integer := Init_Func;
24159 Q : String (X .. Y) := "abc";
24160 @dots{}
24161 for Q'Address use Compute_Address;
24162 @end cartouche
24163 @end smallexample
24164
24165 @noindent
24166 will be rejected by GNAT, since the address cannot be computed at the time
24167 that @code{Q} is declared. To achieve the intended effect, write instead:
24168
24169 @smallexample @c ada
24170 @group
24171 @cartouche
24172 X, Y : Integer := Init_Func;
24173 Q_Address : constant Address := Compute_Address;
24174 Q : String (X .. Y) := "abc";
24175 @dots{}
24176 for Q'Address use Q_Address;
24177 @end cartouche
24178 @end group
24179 @end smallexample
24180
24181 @noindent
24182 which will be accepted by GNAT (and other Ada compilers), and is also
24183 compatible with Ada 83. A fuller description of the restrictions
24184 on address specifications is found in @ref{Top, GNAT Reference Manual,
24185 About This Guide, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}.
24186
24187 @node Other Representation Clauses
24188 @subsection Other Representation Clauses
24189
24190 @noindent
24191 GNAT implements in a compatible manner all the representation
24192 clauses supported by HP Ada. In addition, GNAT
24193 implements the representation clause forms that were introduced in Ada 95,
24194 including @code{COMPONENT_SIZE} and @code{SIZE} clauses for objects.
24195
24196 @node The Package STANDARD
24197 @section The Package @code{STANDARD}
24198
24199 @noindent
24200 The package @code{STANDARD}, as implemented by HP Ada, is fully
24201 described in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual} and in the
24202 @cite{HP Ada Language Reference Manual}. As implemented by GNAT, the
24203 package @code{STANDARD} is described in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
24204
24205 In addition, HP Ada supports the Latin-1 character set in
24206 the type @code{CHARACTER}. GNAT supports the Latin-1 character set
24207 in the type @code{CHARACTER} and also Unicode (ISO 10646 BMP) in
24208 the type @code{WIDE_CHARACTER}.
24209
24210 The floating-point types supported by GNAT are those
24211 supported by HP Ada, but the defaults are different, and are controlled by
24212 pragmas. See @ref{Floating-Point Types and Representations}, for details.
24213
24214 @node The Package SYSTEM
24215 @section The Package @code{SYSTEM}
24216
24217 @noindent
24218 HP Ada provides a specific version of the package
24219 @code{SYSTEM} for each platform on which the language is implemented.
24220 For the complete spec of the package @code{SYSTEM}, see
24221 Appendix F of the @cite{HP Ada Language Reference Manual}.
24222
24223 On HP Ada, the package @code{SYSTEM} includes the following conversion
24224 functions:
24225 @itemize @bullet
24226 @item @code{TO_ADDRESS(INTEGER)}
24227
24228 @item @code{TO_ADDRESS(UNSIGNED_LONGWORD)}
24229
24230 @item @code{TO_ADDRESS(}@i{universal_integer}@code{)}
24231
24232 @item @code{TO_INTEGER(ADDRESS)}
24233
24234 @item @code{TO_UNSIGNED_LONGWORD(ADDRESS)}
24235
24236 @item Function @code{IMPORT_VALUE return UNSIGNED_LONGWORD} and the
24237 functions @code{IMPORT_ADDRESS} and @code{IMPORT_LARGEST_VALUE}
24238 @end itemize
24239
24240 @noindent
24241 By default, GNAT supplies a version of @code{SYSTEM} that matches
24242 the definition given in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
24243 This
24244 is a subset of the HP system definitions, which is as
24245 close as possible to the original definitions. The only difference
24246 is that the definition of @code{SYSTEM_NAME} is different:
24247
24248 @smallexample @c ada
24249 @cartouche
24250 type Name is (SYSTEM_NAME_GNAT);
24251 System_Name : constant Name := SYSTEM_NAME_GNAT;
24252 @end cartouche
24253 @end smallexample
24254
24255 @noindent
24256 Also, GNAT adds the Ada declarations for
24257 @code{BIT_ORDER} and @code{DEFAULT_BIT_ORDER}.
24258
24259 However, the use of the following pragma causes GNAT
24260 to extend the definition of package @code{SYSTEM} so that it
24261 encompasses the full set of HP-specific extensions,
24262 including the functions listed above:
24263
24264 @smallexample @c ada
24265 @cartouche
24266 pragma Extend_System (Aux_DEC);
24267 @end cartouche
24268 @end smallexample
24269
24270 @noindent
24271 The pragma @code{Extend_System} is a configuration pragma that
24272 is most conveniently placed in the @file{gnat.adc} file. @xref{Pragma
24273 Extend_System,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual} for further details.
24274
24275 HP Ada does not allow the recompilation of the package
24276 @code{SYSTEM}. Instead HP Ada provides several pragmas
24277 (@code{SYSTEM_NAME}, @code{STORAGE_UNIT}, and @code{MEMORY_SIZE})
24278 to modify values in the package @code{SYSTEM}.
24279 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, the pragma
24280 @code{SYSTEM_NAME} takes the enumeration literal @code{OPENVMS_AXP} as
24281 its single argument.
24282
24283 GNAT does permit the recompilation of package @code{SYSTEM} using
24284 the special switch @option{-gnatg}, and this switch can be used if
24285 it is necessary to modify the definitions in @code{SYSTEM}. GNAT does
24286 not permit the specification of @code{SYSTEM_NAME}, @code{STORAGE_UNIT}
24287 or @code{MEMORY_SIZE} by any other means.
24288
24289 On GNAT systems, the pragma @code{SYSTEM_NAME} takes the
24290 enumeration literal @code{SYSTEM_NAME_GNAT}.
24291
24292 The definitions provided by the use of
24293
24294 @smallexample @c ada
24295 pragma Extend_System (AUX_Dec);
24296 @end smallexample
24297
24298 @noindent
24299 are virtually identical to those provided by the HP Ada 83 package
24300 @code{SYSTEM}. One important difference is that the name of the
24301 @code{TO_ADDRESS}
24302 function for type @code{UNSIGNED_LONGWORD} is changed to
24303 @code{TO_ADDRESS_LONG}.
24304 @xref{Address Clauses,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual} for a
24305 discussion of why this change was necessary.
24306
24307 @noindent
24308 The version of @code{TO_ADDRESS} taking a @i{universal_integer} argument
24309 is in fact
24310 an extension to Ada 83 not strictly compatible with the reference manual.
24311 GNAT, in order to be exactly compatible with the standard,
24312 does not provide this capability. In HP Ada 83, the
24313 point of this definition is to deal with a call like:
24314
24315 @smallexample @c ada
24316 TO_ADDRESS (16#12777#);
24317 @end smallexample
24318
24319 @noindent
24320 Normally, according to Ada 83 semantics, one would expect this to be
24321 ambiguous, since it matches both the @code{INTEGER} and
24322 @code{UNSIGNED_LONGWORD} forms of @code{TO_ADDRESS}.
24323 However, in HP Ada 83, there is no ambiguity, since the
24324 definition using @i{universal_integer} takes precedence.
24325
24326 In GNAT, since the version with @i{universal_integer} cannot be supplied,
24327 it is
24328 not possible to be 100% compatible. Since there are many programs using
24329 numeric constants for the argument to @code{TO_ADDRESS}, the decision in
24330 GNAT was
24331 to change the name of the function in the @code{UNSIGNED_LONGWORD} case,
24332 so the declarations provided in the GNAT version of @code{AUX_Dec} are:
24333
24334 @smallexample @c ada
24335 function To_Address (X : Integer) return Address;
24336 pragma Pure_Function (To_Address);
24337
24338 function To_Address_Long (X : Unsigned_Longword) return Address;
24339 pragma Pure_Function (To_Address_Long);
24340 @end smallexample
24341
24342 @noindent
24343 This means that programs using @code{TO_ADDRESS} for
24344 @code{UNSIGNED_LONGWORD} must change the name to @code{TO_ADDRESS_LONG}.
24345
24346 @node Tasking and Task-Related Features
24347 @section Tasking and Task-Related Features
24348
24349 @noindent
24350 This section compares the treatment of tasking in GNAT
24351 and in HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha.
24352 The GNAT description applies to both Alpha and I64 OpenVMS.
24353 For detailed information on tasking in
24354 HP Ada, see the @cite{HP Ada Language Reference Manual} and the
24355 relevant run-time reference manual.
24356
24357 @menu
24358 * Implementation of Tasks in HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha Systems::
24359 * Assigning Task IDs::
24360 * Task IDs and Delays::
24361 * Task-Related Pragmas::
24362 * Scheduling and Task Priority::
24363 * The Task Stack::
24364 * External Interrupts::
24365 @end menu
24366
24367 @node Implementation of Tasks in HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha Systems
24368 @subsection Implementation of Tasks in HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha Systems
24369
24370 @noindent
24371 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, each Ada task (except a passive
24372 task) is implemented as a single stream of execution
24373 that is created and managed by the kernel. On these
24374 systems, HP Ada tasking support is based on DECthreads,
24375 an implementation of the POSIX standard for threads.
24376
24377 Also, on OpenVMS Alpha systems, HP Ada tasks and foreign
24378 code that calls DECthreads routines can be used together.
24379 The interaction between Ada tasks and DECthreads routines
24380 can have some benefits. For example when on OpenVMS Alpha,
24381 HP Ada can call C code that is already threaded.
24382
24383 GNAT uses the facilities of DECthreads,
24384 and Ada tasks are mapped to threads.
24385
24386 @node Assigning Task IDs
24387 @subsection Assigning Task IDs
24388
24389 @noindent
24390 The HP Ada Run-Time Library always assigns @code{%TASK 1} to
24391 the environment task that executes the main program. On
24392 OpenVMS Alpha systems, @code{%TASK 0} is often used for tasks
24393 that have been created but are not yet activated.
24394
24395 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, task IDs are assigned at
24396 activation. On GNAT systems, task IDs are also assigned at
24397 task creation but do not have the same form or values as
24398 task ID values in HP Ada. There is no null task, and the
24399 environment task does not have a specific task ID value.
24400
24401 @node Task IDs and Delays
24402 @subsection Task IDs and Delays
24403
24404 @noindent
24405 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, tasking delays are implemented
24406 using Timer System Services. The Task ID is used for the
24407 identification of the timer request (the @code{REQIDT} parameter).
24408 If Timers are used in the application take care not to use
24409 @code{0} for the identification, because cancelling such a timer
24410 will cancel all timers and may lead to unpredictable results.
24411
24412 @node Task-Related Pragmas
24413 @subsection Task-Related Pragmas
24414
24415 @noindent
24416 Ada supplies the pragma @code{TASK_STORAGE}, which allows
24417 specification of the size of the guard area for a task
24418 stack. (The guard area forms an area of memory that has no
24419 read or write access and thus helps in the detection of
24420 stack overflow.) On OpenVMS Alpha systems, if the pragma
24421 @code{TASK_STORAGE} specifies a value of zero, a minimal guard
24422 area is created. In the absence of a pragma @code{TASK_STORAGE},
24423 a default guard area is created.
24424
24425 GNAT supplies the following task-related pragmas:
24426
24427 @itemize @bullet
24428 @item @code{TASK_INFO}
24429
24430 This pragma appears within a task definition and
24431 applies to the task in which it appears. The argument
24432 must be of type @code{SYSTEM.TASK_INFO.TASK_INFO_TYPE}.
24433
24434 @item @code{TASK_STORAGE}
24435
24436 GNAT implements pragma @code{TASK_STORAGE} in the same way as HP Ada.
24437 Both HP Ada and GNAT supply the pragmas @code{PASSIVE},
24438 @code{SUPPRESS}, and @code{VOLATILE}.
24439 @end itemize
24440 @node Scheduling and Task Priority
24441 @subsection Scheduling and Task Priority
24442
24443 @noindent
24444 HP Ada implements the Ada language requirement that
24445 when two tasks are eligible for execution and they have
24446 different priorities, the lower priority task does not
24447 execute while the higher priority task is waiting. The HP
24448 Ada Run-Time Library keeps a task running until either the
24449 task is suspended or a higher priority task becomes ready.
24450
24451 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, the default strategy is round-
24452 robin with preemption. Tasks of equal priority take turns
24453 at the processor. A task is run for a certain period of
24454 time and then placed at the tail of the ready queue for
24455 its priority level.
24456
24457 HP Ada provides the implementation-defined pragma @code{TIME_SLICE},
24458 which can be used to enable or disable round-robin
24459 scheduling of tasks with the same priority.
24460 See the relevant HP Ada run-time reference manual for
24461 information on using the pragmas to control HP Ada task
24462 scheduling.
24463
24464 GNAT follows the scheduling rules of Annex D (Real-Time
24465 Annex) of the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}. In general, this
24466 scheduling strategy is fully compatible with HP Ada
24467 although it provides some additional constraints (as
24468 fully documented in Annex D).
24469 GNAT implements time slicing control in a manner compatible with
24470 HP Ada 83, by means of the pragma @code{Time_Slice}, whose semantics
24471 are identical to the HP Ada 83 pragma of the same name.
24472 Note that it is not possible to mix GNAT tasking and
24473 HP Ada 83 tasking in the same program, since the two run-time
24474 libraries are not compatible.
24475
24476 @node The Task Stack
24477 @subsection The Task Stack
24478
24479 @noindent
24480 In HP Ada, a task stack is allocated each time a
24481 non-passive task is activated. As soon as the task is
24482 terminated, the storage for the task stack is deallocated.
24483 If you specify a size of zero (bytes) with @code{T'STORAGE_SIZE},
24484 a default stack size is used. Also, regardless of the size
24485 specified, some additional space is allocated for task
24486 management purposes. On OpenVMS Alpha systems, at least
24487 one page is allocated.
24488
24489 GNAT handles task stacks in a similar manner. In accordance with
24490 the Ada rules, it provides the pragma @code{STORAGE_SIZE} as
24491 an alternative method for controlling the task stack size.
24492 The specification of the attribute @code{T'STORAGE_SIZE} is also
24493 supported in a manner compatible with HP Ada.
24494
24495 @node External Interrupts
24496 @subsection External Interrupts
24497
24498 @noindent
24499 On HP Ada, external interrupts can be associated with task entries.
24500 GNAT is compatible with HP Ada in its handling of external interrupts.
24501
24502 @node Pragmas and Pragma-Related Features
24503 @section Pragmas and Pragma-Related Features
24504
24505 @noindent
24506 Both HP Ada and GNAT supply all language-defined pragmas
24507 as specified by the Ada 83 standard. GNAT also supplies all
24508 language-defined pragmas introduced by Ada 95 and Ada 2005.
24509 In addition, GNAT implements the implementation-defined pragmas
24510 from HP Ada 83.
24511
24512 @itemize @bullet
24513 @item @code{AST_ENTRY}
24514
24515 @item @code{COMMON_OBJECT}
24516
24517 @item @code{COMPONENT_ALIGNMENT}
24518
24519 @item @code{EXPORT_EXCEPTION}
24520
24521 @item @code{EXPORT_FUNCTION}
24522
24523 @item @code{EXPORT_OBJECT}
24524
24525 @item @code{EXPORT_PROCEDURE}
24526
24527 @item @code{EXPORT_VALUED_PROCEDURE}
24528
24529 @item @code{FLOAT_REPRESENTATION}
24530
24531 @item @code{IDENT}
24532
24533 @item @code{IMPORT_EXCEPTION}
24534
24535 @item @code{IMPORT_FUNCTION}
24536
24537 @item @code{IMPORT_OBJECT}
24538
24539 @item @code{IMPORT_PROCEDURE}
24540
24541 @item @code{IMPORT_VALUED_PROCEDURE}
24542
24543 @item @code{INLINE_GENERIC}
24544
24545 @item @code{INTERFACE_NAME}
24546
24547 @item @code{LONG_FLOAT}
24548
24549 @item @code{MAIN_STORAGE}
24550
24551 @item @code{PASSIVE}
24552
24553 @item @code{PSECT_OBJECT}
24554
24555 @item @code{SHARE_GENERIC}
24556
24557 @item @code{SUPPRESS_ALL}
24558
24559 @item @code{TASK_STORAGE}
24560
24561 @item @code{TIME_SLICE}
24562
24563 @item @code{TITLE}
24564 @end itemize
24565
24566 @noindent
24567 These pragmas are all fully implemented, with the exception of @code{TITLE},
24568 @code{PASSIVE}, and @code{SHARE_GENERIC}, which are
24569 recognized, but which have no
24570 effect in GNAT. The effect of @code{PASSIVE} may be obtained by the
24571 use of Ada protected objects. In GNAT, all generics are inlined.
24572
24573 Unlike HP Ada, the GNAT ``@code{EXPORT_}@i{subprogram}'' pragmas require
24574 a separate subprogram specification which must appear before the
24575 subprogram body.
24576
24577 GNAT also supplies a number of implementation-defined pragmas as follows:
24578 @itemize @bullet
24579 @item @code{ABORT_DEFER}
24580
24581 @item @code{ADA_83}
24582
24583 @item @code{ADA_95}
24584
24585 @item @code{ADA_05}
24586
24587 @item @code{ANNOTATE}
24588
24589 @item @code{ASSERT}
24590
24591 @item @code{C_PASS_BY_COPY}
24592
24593 @item @code{CPP_CLASS}
24594
24595 @item @code{CPP_CONSTRUCTOR}
24596
24597 @item @code{CPP_DESTRUCTOR}
24598
24599 @item @code{DEBUG}
24600
24601 @item @code{EXTEND_SYSTEM}
24602
24603 @item @code{LINKER_ALIAS}
24604
24605 @item @code{LINKER_SECTION}
24606
24607 @item @code{MACHINE_ATTRIBUTE}
24608
24609 @item @code{NO_RETURN}
24610
24611 @item @code{PURE_FUNCTION}
24612
24613 @item @code{SOURCE_FILE_NAME}
24614
24615 @item @code{SOURCE_REFERENCE}
24616
24617 @item @code{TASK_INFO}
24618
24619 @item @code{UNCHECKED_UNION}
24620
24621 @item @code{UNIMPLEMENTED_UNIT}
24622
24623 @item @code{UNIVERSAL_DATA}
24624
24625 @item @code{UNSUPPRESS}
24626
24627 @item @code{WARNINGS}
24628
24629 @item @code{WEAK_EXTERNAL}
24630 @end itemize
24631
24632 @noindent
24633 For full details on these GNAT implementation-defined pragmas,
24634 see @ref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference
24635 Manual}.
24636
24637 @menu
24638 * Restrictions on the Pragma INLINE::
24639 * Restrictions on the Pragma INTERFACE::
24640 * Restrictions on the Pragma SYSTEM_NAME::
24641 @end menu
24642
24643 @node Restrictions on the Pragma INLINE
24644 @subsection Restrictions on Pragma @code{INLINE}
24645
24646 @noindent
24647 HP Ada enforces the following restrictions on the pragma @code{INLINE}:
24648 @itemize @bullet
24649 @item Parameters cannot have a task type.
24650
24651 @item Function results cannot be task types, unconstrained
24652 array types, or unconstrained types with discriminants.
24653
24654 @item Bodies cannot declare the following:
24655 @itemize @bullet
24656 @item Subprogram body or stub (imported subprogram is allowed)
24657
24658 @item Tasks
24659
24660 @item Generic declarations
24661
24662 @item Instantiations
24663
24664 @item Exceptions
24665
24666 @item Access types (types derived from access types allowed)
24667
24668 @item Array or record types
24669
24670 @item Dependent tasks
24671
24672 @item Direct recursive calls of subprogram or containing
24673 subprogram, directly or via a renaming
24674
24675 @end itemize
24676 @end itemize
24677
24678 @noindent
24679 In GNAT, the only restriction on pragma @code{INLINE} is that the
24680 body must occur before the call if both are in the same
24681 unit, and the size must be appropriately small. There are
24682 no other specific restrictions which cause subprograms to
24683 be incapable of being inlined.
24684
24685 @node Restrictions on the Pragma INTERFACE
24686 @subsection Restrictions on Pragma @code{INTERFACE}
24687
24688 @noindent
24689 The following restrictions on pragma @code{INTERFACE}
24690 are enforced by both HP Ada and GNAT:
24691 @itemize @bullet
24692 @item Languages accepted: Ada, Bliss, C, Fortran, Default.
24693 Default is the default on OpenVMS Alpha systems.
24694
24695 @item Parameter passing: Language specifies default
24696 mechanisms but can be overridden with an @code{EXPORT} pragma.
24697
24698 @itemize @bullet
24699 @item Ada: Use internal Ada rules.
24700
24701 @item Bliss, C: Parameters must be mode @code{in}; cannot be
24702 record or task type. Result cannot be a string, an
24703 array, or a record.
24704
24705 @item Fortran: Parameters cannot have a task type. Result cannot
24706 be a string, an array, or a record.
24707 @end itemize
24708 @end itemize
24709
24710 @noindent
24711 GNAT is entirely upwards compatible with HP Ada, and in addition allows
24712 record parameters for all languages.
24713
24714 @node Restrictions on the Pragma SYSTEM_NAME
24715 @subsection Restrictions on Pragma @code{SYSTEM_NAME}
24716
24717 @noindent
24718 For HP Ada for OpenVMS Alpha, the enumeration literal
24719 for the type @code{NAME} is @code{OPENVMS_AXP}.
24720 In GNAT, the enumeration
24721 literal for the type @code{NAME} is @code{SYSTEM_NAME_GNAT}.
24722
24723 @node Library of Predefined Units
24724 @section Library of Predefined Units
24725
24726 @noindent
24727 A library of predefined units is provided as part of the
24728 HP Ada and GNAT implementations. HP Ada does not provide
24729 the package @code{MACHINE_CODE} but instead recommends importing
24730 assembler code.
24731
24732 The GNAT versions of the HP Ada Run-Time Library (@code{ADA$PREDEFINED:})
24733 units are taken from the OpenVMS Alpha version, not the OpenVMS VAX
24734 version.
24735 The HP Ada Predefined Library units are modified to remove post-Ada 83
24736 incompatibilities and to make them interoperable with GNAT
24737 (@pxref{Changes to DECLIB}, for details).
24738 The units are located in the @file{DECLIB} directory.
24739
24740 The GNAT RTL is contained in
24741 the @file{ADALIB} directory, and
24742 the default search path is set up to find @code{DECLIB} units in preference
24743 to @code{ADALIB} units with the same name (@code{TEXT_IO},
24744 @code{SEQUENTIAL_IO}, and @code{DIRECT_IO}, for example).
24745
24746 @menu
24747 * Changes to DECLIB::
24748 @end menu
24749
24750 @node Changes to DECLIB
24751 @subsection Changes to @code{DECLIB}
24752
24753 @noindent
24754 The changes made to the HP Ada predefined library for GNAT and post-Ada 83
24755 compatibility are minor and include the following:
24756
24757 @itemize @bullet
24758 @item Adjusting the location of pragmas and record representation
24759 clauses to obey Ada 95 (and thus Ada 2005) rules
24760
24761 @item Adding the proper notation to generic formal parameters
24762 that take unconstrained types in instantiation
24763
24764 @item Adding pragma @code{ELABORATE_BODY} to package specs
24765 that have package bodies not otherwise allowed
24766
24767 @item Replacing occurrences of the identifier ``@code{PROTECTED}'' by
24768 ``@code{PROTECTD}''.
24769 Currently these are found only in the @code{STARLET} package spec.
24770
24771 @item Changing @code{SYSTEM.ADDRESS} to @code{SYSTEM.SHORT_ADDRESS}
24772 where the address size is constrained to 32 bits.
24773 @end itemize
24774
24775 @noindent
24776 None of the above changes is visible to users.
24777
24778 @node Bindings
24779 @section Bindings
24780
24781 @noindent
24782 On OpenVMS Alpha, HP Ada provides the following strongly-typed bindings:
24783 @itemize @bullet
24784
24785 @item Command Language Interpreter (CLI interface)
24786
24787 @item DECtalk Run-Time Library (DTK interface)
24788
24789 @item Librarian utility routines (LBR interface)
24790
24791 @item General Purpose Run-Time Library (LIB interface)
24792
24793 @item Math Run-Time Library (MTH interface)
24794
24795 @item National Character Set Run-Time Library (NCS interface)
24796
24797 @item Compiled Code Support Run-Time Library (OTS interface)
24798
24799 @item Parallel Processing Run-Time Library (PPL interface)
24800
24801 @item Screen Management Run-Time Library (SMG interface)
24802
24803 @item Sort Run-Time Library (SOR interface)
24804
24805 @item String Run-Time Library (STR interface)
24806
24807 @item STARLET System Library
24808 @findex Starlet
24809
24810 @item X Window System Version 11R4 and 11R5 (X, XLIB interface)
24811
24812 @item X Windows Toolkit (XT interface)
24813
24814 @item X/Motif Version 1.1.3 and 1.2 (XM interface)
24815 @end itemize
24816
24817 @noindent
24818 GNAT provides implementations of these HP bindings in the @code{DECLIB}
24819 directory, on both the Alpha and I64 OpenVMS platforms.
24820
24821 The X/Motif bindings used to build @code{DECLIB} are whatever versions are
24822 in the
24823 HP Ada @file{ADA$PREDEFINED} directory with extension @file{.ADC}.
24824 A pragma @code{Linker_Options} has been added to packages @code{Xm},
24825 @code{Xt}, and @code{X_Lib}
24826 causing the default X/Motif sharable image libraries to be linked in. This
24827 is done via options files named @file{xm.opt}, @file{xt.opt}, and
24828 @file{x_lib.opt} (also located in the @file{DECLIB} directory).
24829
24830 It may be necessary to edit these options files to update or correct the
24831 library names if, for example, the newer X/Motif bindings from
24832 @file{ADA$EXAMPLES}
24833 had been (previous to installing GNAT) copied and renamed to supersede the
24834 default @file{ADA$PREDEFINED} versions.
24835
24836 @menu
24837 * Shared Libraries and Options Files::
24838 * Interfaces to C::
24839 @end menu
24840
24841 @node Shared Libraries and Options Files
24842 @subsection Shared Libraries and Options Files
24843
24844 @noindent
24845 When using the HP Ada
24846 predefined X and Motif bindings, the linking with their sharable images is
24847 done automatically by @command{GNAT LINK}.
24848 When using other X and Motif bindings, you need
24849 to add the corresponding sharable images to the command line for
24850 @code{GNAT LINK}. When linking with shared libraries, or with
24851 @file{.OPT} files, you must
24852 also add them to the command line for @command{GNAT LINK}.
24853
24854 A shared library to be used with GNAT is built in the same way as other
24855 libraries under VMS. The VMS Link command can be used in standard fashion.
24856
24857 @node Interfaces to C
24858 @subsection Interfaces to C
24859
24860 @noindent
24861 HP Ada
24862 provides the following Ada types and operations:
24863
24864 @itemize @bullet
24865 @item C types package (@code{C_TYPES})
24866
24867 @item C strings (@code{C_TYPES.NULL_TERMINATED})
24868
24869 @item Other_types (@code{SHORT_INT})
24870 @end itemize
24871
24872 @noindent
24873 Interfacing to C with GNAT, you can use the above approach
24874 described for HP Ada or the facilities of Annex B of
24875 the @cite{Ada Reference Manual} (packages @code{INTERFACES.C},
24876 @code{INTERFACES.C.STRINGS} and @code{INTERFACES.C.POINTERS}). For more
24877 information, see @ref{Interfacing to C,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}.
24878
24879 The @option{-gnatF} qualifier forces default and explicit
24880 @code{External_Name} parameters in pragmas @code{Import} and @code{Export}
24881 to be uppercased for compatibility with the default behavior
24882 of HP C. The qualifier has no effect on @code{Link_Name} parameters.
24883
24884 @node Main Program Definition
24885 @section Main Program Definition
24886
24887 @noindent
24888 The following section discusses differences in the
24889 definition of main programs on HP Ada and GNAT.
24890 On HP Ada, main programs are defined to meet the
24891 following conditions:
24892 @itemize @bullet
24893 @item Procedure with no formal parameters (returns @code{0} upon
24894 normal completion)
24895
24896 @item Procedure with no formal parameters (returns @code{42} when
24897 an unhandled exception is raised)
24898
24899 @item Function with no formal parameters whose returned value
24900 is of a discrete type
24901
24902 @item Procedure with one @code{out} formal of a discrete type for
24903 which a specification of pragma @code{EXPORT_VALUED_PROCEDURE} is given.
24904
24905 @end itemize
24906
24907 @noindent
24908 When declared with the pragma @code{EXPORT_VALUED_PROCEDURE},
24909 a main function or main procedure returns a discrete
24910 value whose size is less than 64 bits (32 on VAX systems),
24911 the value is zero- or sign-extended as appropriate.
24912 On GNAT, main programs are defined as follows:
24913 @itemize @bullet
24914 @item Must be a non-generic, parameterless subprogram that
24915 is either a procedure or function returning an Ada
24916 @code{STANDARD.INTEGER} (the predefined type)
24917
24918 @item Cannot be a generic subprogram or an instantiation of a
24919 generic subprogram
24920 @end itemize
24921
24922 @node Implementation-Defined Attributes
24923 @section Implementation-Defined Attributes
24924
24925 @noindent
24926 GNAT provides all HP Ada implementation-defined
24927 attributes.
24928
24929 @node Compiler and Run-Time Interfacing
24930 @section Compiler and Run-Time Interfacing
24931
24932 @noindent
24933 HP Ada provides the following qualifiers to pass options to the linker
24934 (ACS LINK):
24935 @itemize @bullet
24936 @item @option{/WAIT} and @option{/SUBMIT}
24937
24938 @item @option{/COMMAND}
24939
24940 @item @option{/@r{[}NO@r{]}MAP}
24941
24942 @item @option{/OUTPUT=@var{file-spec}}
24943
24944 @item @option{/@r{[}NO@r{]}DEBUG} and @option{/@r{[}NO@r{]}TRACEBACK}
24945 @end itemize
24946
24947 @noindent
24948 To pass options to the linker, GNAT provides the following
24949 switches:
24950
24951 @itemize @bullet
24952 @item @option{/EXECUTABLE=@var{exec-name}}
24953
24954 @item @option{/VERBOSE}
24955
24956 @item @option{/@r{[}NO@r{]}DEBUG} and @option{/@r{[}NO@r{]}TRACEBACK}
24957 @end itemize
24958
24959 @noindent
24960 For more information on these switches, see
24961 @ref{Switches for gnatlink}.
24962 In HP Ada, the command-line switch @option{/OPTIMIZE} is available
24963 to control optimization. HP Ada also supplies the
24964 following pragmas:
24965 @itemize @bullet
24966 @item @code{OPTIMIZE}
24967
24968 @item @code{INLINE}
24969
24970 @item @code{INLINE_GENERIC}
24971
24972 @item @code{SUPPRESS_ALL}
24973
24974 @item @code{PASSIVE}
24975 @end itemize
24976
24977 @noindent
24978 In GNAT, optimization is controlled strictly by command
24979 line parameters, as described in the corresponding section of this guide.
24980 The HP pragmas for control of optimization are
24981 recognized but ignored.
24982
24983 Note that in GNAT, the default is optimization off, whereas in HP Ada
24984 the default is that optimization is turned on.
24985
24986 @node Program Compilation and Library Management
24987 @section Program Compilation and Library Management
24988
24989 @noindent
24990 HP Ada and GNAT provide a comparable set of commands to
24991 build programs. HP Ada also provides a program library,
24992 which is a concept that does not exist on GNAT. Instead,
24993 GNAT provides directories of sources that are compiled as
24994 needed.
24995
24996 The following table summarizes
24997 the HP Ada commands and provides
24998 equivalent GNAT commands. In this table, some GNAT
24999 equivalents reflect the fact that GNAT does not use the
25000 concept of a program library. Instead, it uses a model
25001 in which collections of source and object files are used
25002 in a manner consistent with other languages like C and
25003 Fortran. Therefore, standard system file commands are used
25004 to manipulate these elements. Those GNAT commands are marked with
25005 an asterisk.
25006 Note that, unlike HP Ada, none of the GNAT commands accepts wild cards.
25007
25008 @need 1500
25009 @multitable @columnfractions .35 .65
25010
25011 @item @emph{HP Ada Command}
25012 @tab @emph{GNAT Equivalent / Description}
25013
25014 @item @command{ADA}
25015 @tab @command{GNAT COMPILE}@*
25016 Invokes the compiler to compile one or more Ada source files.
25017
25018 @item @command{ACS ATTACH}@*
25019 @tab [No equivalent]@*
25020 Switches control of terminal from current process running the program
25021 library manager.
25022
25023 @item @command{ACS CHECK}
25024 @tab @command{GNAT MAKE /DEPENDENCY_LIST}@*
25025 Forms the execution closure of one
25026 or more compiled units and checks completeness and currency.
25027
25028 @item @command{ACS COMPILE}
25029 @tab @command{GNAT MAKE /ACTIONS=COMPILE}@*
25030 Forms the execution closure of one or
25031 more specified units, checks completeness and currency,
25032 identifies units that have revised source files, compiles same,
25033 and recompiles units that are or will become obsolete.
25034 Also completes incomplete generic instantiations.
25035
25036 @item @command{ACS COPY FOREIGN}
25037 @tab Copy (*)@*
25038 Copies a foreign object file into the program library as a
25039 library unit body.
25040
25041 @item @command{ACS COPY UNIT}
25042 @tab Copy (*)@*
25043 Copies a compiled unit from one program library to another.
25044
25045 @item @command{ACS CREATE LIBRARY}
25046 @tab Create /directory (*)@*
25047 Creates a program library.
25048
25049 @item @command{ACS CREATE SUBLIBRARY}
25050 @tab Create /directory (*)@*
25051 Creates a program sublibrary.
25052
25053 @item @command{ACS DELETE LIBRARY}
25054 @tab @*
25055 Deletes a program library and its contents.
25056
25057 @item @command{ACS DELETE SUBLIBRARY}
25058 @tab @*
25059 Deletes a program sublibrary and its contents.
25060
25061 @item @command{ACS DELETE UNIT}
25062 @tab Delete file (*)@*
25063 On OpenVMS systems, deletes one or more compiled units from
25064 the current program library.
25065
25066 @item @command{ACS DIRECTORY}
25067 @tab Directory (*)@*
25068 On OpenVMS systems, lists units contained in the current
25069 program library.
25070
25071 @item @command{ACS ENTER FOREIGN}
25072 @tab Copy (*)@*
25073 Allows the import of a foreign body as an Ada library
25074 spec and enters a reference to a pointer.
25075
25076 @item @command{ACS ENTER UNIT}
25077 @tab Copy (*)@*
25078 Enters a reference (pointer) from the current program library to
25079 a unit compiled into another program library.
25080
25081 @item @command{ACS EXIT}
25082 @tab [No equivalent]@*
25083 Exits from the program library manager.
25084
25085 @item @command{ACS EXPORT}
25086 @tab Copy (*)@*
25087 Creates an object file that contains system-specific object code
25088 for one or more units. With GNAT, object files can simply be copied
25089 into the desired directory.
25090
25091 @item @command{ACS EXTRACT SOURCE}
25092 @tab Copy (*)@*
25093 Allows access to the copied source file for each Ada compilation unit
25094
25095 @item @command{ACS HELP}
25096 @tab @command{HELP GNAT}@*
25097 Provides online help.
25098
25099 @item @command{ACS LINK}
25100 @tab @command{GNAT LINK}@*
25101 Links an object file containing Ada units into an executable file.
25102
25103 @item @command{ACS LOAD}
25104 @tab Copy (*)@*
25105 Loads (partially compiles) Ada units into the program library.
25106 Allows loading a program from a collection of files into a library
25107 without knowing the relationship among units.
25108
25109 @item @command{ACS MERGE}
25110 @tab Copy (*)@*
25111 Merges into the current program library, one or more units from
25112 another library where they were modified.
25113
25114 @item @command{ACS RECOMPILE}
25115 @tab @command{GNAT MAKE /ACTIONS=COMPILE}@*
25116 Recompiles from external or copied source files any obsolete
25117 unit in the closure. Also, completes any incomplete generic
25118 instantiations.
25119
25120 @item @command{ACS REENTER}
25121 @tab @command{GNAT MAKE}@*
25122 Reenters current references to units compiled after last entered
25123 with the @command{ACS ENTER UNIT} command.
25124
25125 @item @command{ACS SET LIBRARY}
25126 @tab Set default (*)@*
25127 Defines a program library to be the compilation context as well
25128 as the target library for compiler output and commands in general.
25129
25130 @item @command{ACS SET PRAGMA}
25131 @tab Edit @file{gnat.adc} (*)@*
25132 Redefines specified values of the library characteristics
25133 @code{LONG_ FLOAT}, @code{MEMORY_SIZE}, @code{SYSTEM_NAME},
25134 and @code{Float_Representation}.
25135
25136 @item @command{ACS SET SOURCE}
25137 @tab Define @code{ADA_INCLUDE_PATH} path (*)@*
25138 Defines the source file search list for the @command{ACS COMPILE} command.
25139
25140 @item @command{ACS SHOW LIBRARY}
25141 @tab Directory (*)@*
25142 Lists information about one or more program libraries.
25143
25144 @item @command{ACS SHOW PROGRAM}
25145 @tab [No equivalent]@*
25146 Lists information about the execution closure of one or
25147 more units in the program library.
25148
25149 @item @command{ACS SHOW SOURCE}
25150 @tab Show logical @code{ADA_INCLUDE_PATH}@*
25151 Shows the source file search used when compiling units.
25152
25153 @item @command{ACS SHOW VERSION}
25154 @tab Compile with @option{VERBOSE} option
25155 Displays the version number of the compiler and program library
25156 manager used.
25157
25158 @item @command{ACS SPAWN}
25159 @tab [No equivalent]@*
25160 Creates a subprocess of the current process (same as @command{DCL SPAWN}
25161 command).
25162
25163 @item @command{ACS VERIFY}
25164 @tab [No equivalent]@*
25165 Performs a series of consistency checks on a program library to
25166 determine whether the library structure and library files are in
25167 valid form.
25168 @end multitable
25169
25170 @noindent
25171
25172 @node Input-Output
25173 @section Input-Output
25174
25175 @noindent
25176 On OpenVMS Alpha systems, HP Ada uses OpenVMS Record
25177 Management Services (RMS) to perform operations on
25178 external files.
25179
25180 @noindent
25181 HP Ada and GNAT predefine an identical set of input-
25182 output packages. To make the use of the
25183 generic @code{TEXT_IO} operations more convenient, HP Ada
25184 provides predefined library packages that instantiate the
25185 integer and floating-point operations for the predefined
25186 integer and floating-point types as shown in the following table.
25187
25188 @multitable @columnfractions .45 .55
25189 @item @emph{Package Name} @tab Instantiation
25190
25191 @item @code{INTEGER_TEXT_IO}
25192 @tab @code{INTEGER_IO(INTEGER)}
25193
25194 @item @code{SHORT_INTEGER_TEXT_IO}
25195 @tab @code{INTEGER_IO(SHORT_INTEGER)}
25196
25197 @item @code{SHORT_SHORT_INTEGER_TEXT_IO}
25198 @tab @code{INTEGER_IO(SHORT_SHORT_INTEGER)}
25199
25200 @item @code{FLOAT_TEXT_IO}
25201 @tab @code{FLOAT_IO(FLOAT)}
25202
25203 @item @code{LONG_FLOAT_TEXT_IO}
25204 @tab @code{FLOAT_IO(LONG_FLOAT)}
25205 @end multitable
25206
25207 @noindent
25208 The HP Ada predefined packages and their operations
25209 are implemented using OpenVMS Alpha files and input-output
25210 facilities. HP Ada supports asynchronous input-output on OpenVMS Alpha.
25211 Familiarity with the following is recommended:
25212 @itemize @bullet
25213 @item RMS file organizations and access methods
25214
25215 @item OpenVMS file specifications and directories
25216
25217 @item OpenVMS File Definition Language (FDL)
25218 @end itemize
25219
25220 @noindent
25221 GNAT provides I/O facilities that are completely
25222 compatible with HP Ada. The distribution includes the
25223 standard HP Ada versions of all I/O packages, operating
25224 in a manner compatible with HP Ada. In particular, the
25225 following packages are by default the HP Ada (Ada 83)
25226 versions of these packages rather than the renamings
25227 suggested in Annex J of the Ada Reference Manual:
25228 @itemize @bullet
25229 @item @code{TEXT_IO}
25230
25231 @item @code{SEQUENTIAL_IO}
25232
25233 @item @code{DIRECT_IO}
25234 @end itemize
25235
25236 @noindent
25237 The use of the standard child package syntax (for
25238 example, @code{ADA.TEXT_IO}) retrieves the post-Ada 83 versions of these
25239 packages.
25240 GNAT provides HP-compatible predefined instantiations
25241 of the @code{TEXT_IO} packages, and also
25242 provides the standard predefined instantiations required
25243 by the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
25244
25245 For further information on how GNAT interfaces to the file
25246 system or how I/O is implemented in programs written in
25247 mixed languages, see @ref{Implementation of the Standard I/O,,,
25248 gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}.
25249 This chapter covers the following:
25250 @itemize @bullet
25251 @item Standard I/O packages
25252
25253 @item @code{FORM} strings
25254
25255 @item @code{ADA.DIRECT_IO}
25256
25257 @item @code{ADA.SEQUENTIAL_IO}
25258
25259 @item @code{ADA.TEXT_IO}
25260
25261 @item Stream pointer positioning
25262
25263 @item Reading and writing non-regular files
25264
25265 @item @code{GET_IMMEDIATE}
25266
25267 @item Treating @code{TEXT_IO} files as streams
25268
25269 @item Shared files
25270
25271 @item Open modes
25272 @end itemize
25273
25274 @node Implementation Limits
25275 @section Implementation Limits
25276
25277 @noindent
25278 The following table lists implementation limits for HP Ada
25279 and GNAT systems.
25280 @multitable @columnfractions .60 .20 .20
25281 @sp 1
25282 @item @emph{Compilation Parameter}
25283 @tab @emph{HP Ada}
25284 @tab @emph{GNAT}
25285 @sp 1
25286
25287 @item In a subprogram or entry declaration, maximum number of
25288 formal parameters that are of an unconstrained record type
25289 @tab 32
25290 @tab No set limit
25291 @sp 1
25292
25293 @item Maximum identifier length (number of characters)
25294 @tab 255
25295 @tab 32766
25296 @sp 1
25297
25298 @item Maximum number of characters in a source line
25299 @tab 255
25300 @tab 32766
25301 @sp 1
25302
25303 @item Maximum collection size (number of bytes)
25304 @tab 2**31-1
25305 @tab 2**31-1
25306 @sp 1
25307
25308 @item Maximum number of discriminants for a record type
25309 @tab 245
25310 @tab No set limit
25311 @sp 1
25312
25313 @item Maximum number of formal parameters in an entry or
25314 subprogram declaration
25315 @tab 246
25316 @tab No set limit
25317 @sp 1
25318
25319 @item Maximum number of dimensions in an array type
25320 @tab 255
25321 @tab No set limit
25322 @sp 1
25323
25324 @item Maximum number of library units and subunits in a compilation.
25325 @tab 4095
25326 @tab No set limit
25327 @sp 1
25328
25329 @item Maximum number of library units and subunits in an execution.
25330 @tab 16383
25331 @tab No set limit
25332 @sp 1
25333
25334 @item Maximum number of objects declared with the pragma @code{COMMON_OBJECT}
25335 or @code{PSECT_OBJECT}
25336 @tab 32757
25337 @tab No set limit
25338 @sp 1
25339
25340 @item Maximum number of enumeration literals in an enumeration type
25341 definition
25342 @tab 65535
25343 @tab No set limit
25344 @sp 1
25345
25346 @item Maximum number of lines in a source file
25347 @tab 65534
25348 @tab No set limit
25349 @sp 1
25350
25351 @item Maximum number of bits in any object
25352 @tab 2**31-1
25353 @tab 2**31-1
25354 @sp 1
25355
25356 @item Maximum size of the static portion of a stack frame (approximate)
25357 @tab 2**31-1
25358 @tab 2**31-1
25359 @end multitable
25360
25361 @node Tools and Utilities
25362 @section Tools and Utilities
25363
25364 @noindent
25365 The following table lists some of the OpenVMS development tools
25366 available for HP Ada, and the corresponding tools for
25367 use with @value{EDITION} on Alpha and I64 platforms.
25368 Aside from the debugger, all the OpenVMS tools identified are part
25369 of the DECset package.
25370
25371 @iftex
25372 @c Specify table in TeX since Texinfo does a poor job
25373 @tex
25374 \smallskip
25375 \smallskip
25376 \settabs\+Language-Sensitive Editor\quad
25377 &Product with HP Ada\quad
25378 &\cr
25379 \+\it Tool
25380 &\it Product with HP Ada
25381 & \it Product with GNAT Pro\cr
25382 \smallskip
25383 \+Code Management System
25384 &HP CMS
25385 & HP CMS\cr
25386 \smallskip
25387 \+Language-Sensitive Editor
25388 &HP LSE
25389 & emacs or HP LSE (Alpha)\cr
25390 \+
25391 &
25392 & HP LSE (I64)\cr
25393 \smallskip
25394 \+Debugger
25395 &OpenVMS Debug
25396 & gdb (Alpha),\cr
25397 \+
25398 &
25399 & OpenVMS Debug (I64)\cr
25400 \smallskip
25401 \+Source Code Analyzer /
25402 &HP SCA
25403 & GNAT XREF\cr
25404 \+Cross Referencer
25405 &
25406 &\cr
25407 \smallskip
25408 \+Test Manager
25409 &HP Digital Test
25410 & HP DTM\cr
25411 \+
25412 &Manager (DTM)
25413 &\cr
25414 \smallskip
25415 \+Performance and
25416 & HP PCA
25417 & HP PCA\cr
25418 \+Coverage Analyzer
25419 &
25420 &\cr
25421 \smallskip
25422 \+Module Management
25423 & HP MMS
25424 & Not applicable\cr
25425 \+ System
25426 &
25427 &\cr
25428 \smallskip
25429 \smallskip
25430 @end tex
25431 @end iftex
25432
25433 @ifnottex
25434 @c This is the Texinfo version of the table. It renders poorly in pdf, hence
25435 @c the TeX version above for the printed version
25436 @flushleft
25437 @c @multitable @columnfractions .3 .4 .4
25438 @multitable {Source Code Analyzer /}{Tool with HP Ada}{Tool with GNAT Pro}
25439 @item @i{Tool}
25440 @tab @i{Tool with HP Ada}
25441 @tab @i{Tool with @value{EDITION}}
25442 @item Code Management@*System
25443 @tab HP CMS
25444 @tab HP CMS
25445 @item Language-Sensitive@*Editor
25446 @tab HP LSE
25447 @tab emacs or HP LSE (Alpha)
25448 @item
25449 @tab
25450 @tab HP LSE (I64)
25451 @item Debugger
25452 @tab OpenVMS Debug
25453 @tab gdb (Alpha),
25454 @item
25455 @tab
25456 @tab OpenVMS Debug (I64)
25457 @item Source Code Analyzer /@*Cross Referencer
25458 @tab HP SCA
25459 @tab GNAT XREF
25460 @item Test Manager
25461 @tab HP Digital Test@*Manager (DTM)
25462 @tab HP DTM
25463 @item Performance and@*Coverage Analyzer
25464 @tab HP PCA
25465 @tab HP PCA
25466 @item Module Management@*System
25467 @tab HP MMS
25468 @tab Not applicable
25469 @end multitable
25470 @end flushleft
25471 @end ifnottex
25472
25473 @end ifset
25474
25475 @c **************************************
25476 @node Platform-Specific Information for the Run-Time Libraries
25477 @appendix Platform-Specific Information for the Run-Time Libraries
25478 @cindex Tasking and threads libraries
25479 @cindex Threads libraries and tasking
25480 @cindex Run-time libraries (platform-specific information)
25481
25482 @noindent
25483 The GNAT run-time implementation may vary with respect to both the
25484 underlying threads library and the exception handling scheme.
25485 For threads support, one or more of the following are supplied:
25486 @itemize @bullet
25487 @item @b{native threads library}, a binding to the thread package from
25488 the underlying operating system
25489
25490 @item @b{pthreads library} (Sparc Solaris only), a binding to the Solaris
25491 POSIX thread package
25492 @end itemize
25493
25494 @noindent
25495 For exception handling, either or both of two models are supplied:
25496 @itemize @bullet
25497 @item @b{Zero-Cost Exceptions} (``ZCX''),@footnote{
25498 Most programs should experience a substantial speed improvement by
25499 being compiled with a ZCX run-time.
25500 This is especially true for
25501 tasking applications or applications with many exception handlers.}
25502 @cindex Zero-Cost Exceptions
25503 @cindex ZCX (Zero-Cost Exceptions)
25504 which uses binder-generated tables that
25505 are interrogated at run time to locate a handler
25506
25507 @item @b{setjmp / longjmp} (``SJLJ''),
25508 @cindex setjmp/longjmp Exception Model
25509 @cindex SJLJ (setjmp/longjmp Exception Model)
25510 which uses dynamically-set data to establish
25511 the set of handlers
25512 @end itemize
25513
25514 @noindent
25515 This appendix summarizes which combinations of threads and exception support
25516 are supplied on various GNAT platforms.
25517 It then shows how to select a particular library either
25518 permanently or temporarily,
25519 explains the properties of (and tradeoffs among) the various threads
25520 libraries, and provides some additional
25521 information about several specific platforms.
25522
25523 @menu
25524 * Summary of Run-Time Configurations::
25525 * Specifying a Run-Time Library::
25526 * Choosing the Scheduling Policy::
25527 * Solaris-Specific Considerations::
25528 * Linux-Specific Considerations::
25529 * AIX-Specific Considerations::
25530 * Irix-Specific Considerations::
25531 * RTX-Specific Considerations::
25532 @end menu
25533
25534 @node Summary of Run-Time Configurations
25535 @section Summary of Run-Time Configurations
25536
25537 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .70
25538 @item @b{alpha-openvms}
25539 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25540 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native VMS threads
25541 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25542 @*
25543 @item @b{alpha-tru64}
25544 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25545 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native TRU64 threads
25546 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25547 @*
25548 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj}
25549 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native TRU64 threads
25550 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25551 @*
25552 @item @b{ia64-hp_linux}
25553 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25554 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25555 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25556 @*
25557 @item @b{ia64-hpux}
25558 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25559 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native HP-UX threads
25560 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25561 @*
25562 @item @b{ia64-openvms}
25563 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25564 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native VMS threads
25565 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25566 @*
25567 @item @b{ia64-sgi_linux}
25568 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25569 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25570 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25571 @*
25572 @item @b{mips-irix}
25573 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25574 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native IRIX threads
25575 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25576 @*
25577 @item @b{pa-hpux}
25578 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25579 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native HP-UX threads
25580 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25581 @*
25582 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj}
25583 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native HP-UX threads
25584 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25585 @*
25586 @item @b{ppc-aix}
25587 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25588 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native AIX threads
25589 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25590 @*
25591 @item @b{ppc-darwin}
25592 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25593 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native MacOS threads
25594 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25595 @*
25596 @item @b{sparc-solaris} @tab
25597 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25598 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Solaris threads library
25599 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25600 @*
25601 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-pthread}
25602 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25603 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25604 @*
25605 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj}
25606 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Solaris threads library
25607 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25608 @*
25609 @item @b{sparc64-solaris} @tab
25610 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25611 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Solaris threads library
25612 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25613 @*
25614 @item @b{x86-linux}
25615 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25616 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25617 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25618 @*
25619 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj}
25620 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25621 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25622 @*
25623 @item @b{x86-lynx}
25624 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25625 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native LynxOS threads
25626 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25627 @*
25628 @item @b{x86-solaris}
25629 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25630 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Solaris threads
25631 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25632 @*
25633 @item @b{x86-windows}
25634 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25635 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Win32 threads
25636 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25637 @*
25638 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj (default)}
25639 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab native Win32 threads
25640 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25641 @*
25642 @item @b{x86-windows-rtx}
25643 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-rtx-rtss (default)}
25644 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab RTX real-time subsystem RTSS threads (kernel mode)
25645 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25646 @*
25647 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-rtx-w32}
25648 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab RTX Win32 threads (user mode)
25649 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25650 @*
25651 @item @b{x86_64-linux}
25652 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-native (default)}
25653 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25654 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab ZCX
25655 @*
25656 @item @code{@ @ }@i{rts-sjlj}
25657 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Tasking @tab pthread library
25658 @item @code{@ @ @ @ }Exceptions @tab SJLJ
25659 @*
25660 @end multitable
25661
25662 @node Specifying a Run-Time Library
25663 @section Specifying a Run-Time Library
25664
25665 @noindent
25666 The @file{adainclude} subdirectory containing the sources of the GNAT
25667 run-time library, and the @file{adalib} subdirectory containing the
25668 @file{ALI} files and the static and/or shared GNAT library, are located
25669 in the gcc target-dependent area:
25670
25671 @smallexample
25672 target=$prefix/lib/gcc/gcc-@i{dumpmachine}/gcc-@i{dumpversion}/
25673 @end smallexample
25674
25675 @noindent
25676 As indicated above, on some platforms several run-time libraries are supplied.
25677 These libraries are installed in the target dependent area and
25678 contain a complete source and binary subdirectory. The detailed description
25679 below explains the differences between the different libraries in terms of
25680 their thread support.
25681
25682 The default run-time library (when GNAT is installed) is @emph{rts-native}.
25683 This default run time is selected by the means of soft links.
25684 For example on x86-linux:
25685
25686 @smallexample
25687 @group
25688 $(target-dir)
25689 |
25690 +--- adainclude----------+
25691 | |
25692 +--- adalib-----------+ |
25693 | | |
25694 +--- rts-native | |
25695 | | | |
25696 | +--- adainclude <---+
25697 | | |
25698 | +--- adalib <----+
25699 |
25700 +--- rts-sjlj
25701 |
25702 +--- adainclude
25703 |
25704 +--- adalib
25705 @end group
25706 @end smallexample
25707
25708 @noindent
25709 If the @i{rts-sjlj} library is to be selected on a permanent basis,
25710 these soft links can be modified with the following commands:
25711
25712 @smallexample
25713 $ cd $target
25714 $ rm -f adainclude adalib
25715 $ ln -s rts-sjlj/adainclude adainclude
25716 $ ln -s rts-sjlj/adalib adalib
25717 @end smallexample
25718
25719 @noindent
25720 Alternatively, you can specify @file{rts-sjlj/adainclude} in the file
25721 @file{$target/ada_source_path} and @file{rts-sjlj/adalib} in
25722 @file{$target/ada_object_path}.
25723
25724 Selecting another run-time library temporarily can be
25725 achieved by using the @option{--RTS} switch, e.g., @option{--RTS=sjlj}
25726 @cindex @option{--RTS} option
25727
25728 @node Choosing the Scheduling Policy
25729 @section Choosing the Scheduling Policy
25730
25731 @noindent
25732 When using a POSIX threads implementation, you have a choice of several
25733 scheduling policies: @code{SCHED_FIFO},
25734 @cindex @code{SCHED_FIFO} scheduling policy
25735 @code{SCHED_RR}
25736 @cindex @code{SCHED_RR} scheduling policy
25737 and @code{SCHED_OTHER}.
25738 @cindex @code{SCHED_OTHER} scheduling policy
25739 Typically, the default is @code{SCHED_OTHER}, while using @code{SCHED_FIFO}
25740 or @code{SCHED_RR} requires special (e.g., root) privileges.
25741
25742 By default, GNAT uses the @code{SCHED_OTHER} policy. To specify
25743 @code{SCHED_FIFO},
25744 @cindex @code{SCHED_FIFO} scheduling policy
25745 you can use one of the following:
25746
25747 @itemize @bullet
25748 @item
25749 @code{pragma Time_Slice (0.0)}
25750 @cindex pragma Time_Slice
25751 @item
25752 the corresponding binder option @option{-T0}
25753 @cindex @option{-T0} option
25754 @item
25755 @code{pragma Task_Dispatching_Policy (FIFO_Within_Priorities)}
25756 @cindex pragma Task_Dispatching_Policy
25757 @end itemize
25758
25759 @noindent
25760 To specify @code{SCHED_RR},
25761 @cindex @code{SCHED_RR} scheduling policy
25762 you should use @code{pragma Time_Slice} with a
25763 value greater than @code{0.0}, or else use the corresponding @option{-T}
25764 binder option.
25765
25766 @node Solaris-Specific Considerations
25767 @section Solaris-Specific Considerations
25768 @cindex Solaris Sparc threads libraries
25769
25770 @noindent
25771 This section addresses some topics related to the various threads libraries
25772 on Sparc Solaris.
25773
25774 @menu
25775 * Solaris Threads Issues::
25776 @end menu
25777
25778 @node Solaris Threads Issues
25779 @subsection Solaris Threads Issues
25780
25781 @noindent
25782 GNAT under Solaris/Sparc 32 bits comes with an alternate tasking run-time
25783 library based on POSIX threads --- @emph{rts-pthread}.
25784 @cindex rts-pthread threads library
25785 This run-time library has the advantage of being mostly shared across all
25786 POSIX-compliant thread implementations, and it also provides under
25787 @w{Solaris 8} the @code{PTHREAD_PRIO_INHERIT}
25788 @cindex @code{PTHREAD_PRIO_INHERIT} policy (under rts-pthread)
25789 and @code{PTHREAD_PRIO_PROTECT}
25790 @cindex @code{PTHREAD_PRIO_PROTECT} policy (under rts-pthread)
25791 semantics that can be selected using the predefined pragma
25792 @code{Locking_Policy}
25793 @cindex pragma Locking_Policy (under rts-pthread)
25794 with respectively
25795 @code{Inheritance_Locking} and @code{Ceiling_Locking} as the policy.
25796 @cindex @code{Inheritance_Locking} (under rts-pthread)
25797 @cindex @code{Ceiling_Locking} (under rts-pthread)
25798
25799 As explained above, the native run-time library is based on the Solaris thread
25800 library (@code{libthread}) and is the default library.
25801
25802 When the Solaris threads library is used (this is the default), programs
25803 compiled with GNAT can automatically take advantage of
25804 and can thus execute on multiple processors.
25805 The user can alternatively specify a processor on which the program should run
25806 to emulate a single-processor system. The multiprocessor / uniprocessor choice
25807 is made by
25808 setting the environment variable @env{GNAT_PROCESSOR}
25809 @cindex @env{GNAT_PROCESSOR} environment variable (on Sparc Solaris)
25810 to one of the following:
25811
25812 @table @code
25813 @item -2
25814 Use the default configuration (run the program on all
25815 available processors) - this is the same as having @code{GNAT_PROCESSOR}
25816 unset
25817
25818 @item -1
25819 Let the run-time implementation choose one processor and run the program on
25820 that processor
25821
25822 @item 0 .. Last_Proc
25823 Run the program on the specified processor.
25824 @code{Last_Proc} is equal to @code{_SC_NPROCESSORS_CONF - 1}
25825 (where @code{_SC_NPROCESSORS_CONF} is a system variable).
25826 @end table
25827
25828 @node Linux-Specific Considerations
25829 @section Linux-Specific Considerations
25830 @cindex Linux threads libraries
25831
25832 @noindent
25833 On GNU/Linux without NPTL support (usually system with GNU C Library
25834 older than 2.3), the signal model is not POSIX compliant, which means
25835 that to send a signal to the process, you need to send the signal to all
25836 threads, e.g.@: by using @code{killpg()}.
25837
25838 @node AIX-Specific Considerations
25839 @section AIX-Specific Considerations
25840 @cindex AIX resolver library
25841
25842 @noindent
25843 On AIX, the resolver library initializes some internal structure on
25844 the first call to @code{get*by*} functions, which are used to implement
25845 @code{GNAT.Sockets.Get_Host_By_Name} and
25846 @code{GNAT.Sockets.Get_Host_By_Address}.
25847 If such initialization occurs within an Ada task, and the stack size for
25848 the task is the default size, a stack overflow may occur.
25849
25850 To avoid this overflow, the user should either ensure that the first call
25851 to @code{GNAT.Sockets.Get_Host_By_Name} or
25852 @code{GNAT.Sockets.Get_Host_By_Addrss}
25853 occurs in the environment task, or use @code{pragma Storage_Size} to
25854 specify a sufficiently large size for the stack of the task that contains
25855 this call.
25856
25857 @node Irix-Specific Considerations
25858 @section Irix-Specific Considerations
25859 @cindex Irix libraries
25860
25861 @noindent
25862 The GCC support libraries coming with the Irix compiler have moved to
25863 their canonical place with respect to the general Irix ABI related
25864 conventions. Running applications built with the default shared GNAT
25865 run-time now requires the LD_LIBRARY_PATH environment variable to
25866 include this location. A possible way to achieve this is to issue the
25867 following command line on a bash prompt:
25868
25869 @smallexample
25870 @group
25871 $ LD_LIBRARY_PATH=$LD_LIBRARY_PATH:`dirname \`gcc --print-file-name=libgcc_s.so\``
25872 @end group
25873 @end smallexample
25874
25875 @node RTX-Specific Considerations
25876 @section RTX-Specific Considerations
25877 @cindex RTX libraries
25878
25879 @noindent
25880 The Real-time Extension (RTX) to Windows is based on the Windows Win32
25881 API. Applications can be built to work in two different modes:
25882
25883 @itemize @bullet
25884 @item
25885 Windows executables that run in Ring 3 to utilize memory protection
25886 (@emph{rts-rtx-w32}).
25887
25888 @item
25889 Real-time subsystem (RTSS) executables that run in Ring 0, where
25890 performance can be optimized with RTSS applications taking precedent
25891 over all Windows applications (@emph{rts-rtx-rtss}).
25892
25893 @end itemize
25894
25895 @c *******************************
25896 @node Example of Binder Output File
25897 @appendix Example of Binder Output File
25898
25899 @noindent
25900 This Appendix displays the source code for @command{gnatbind}'s output
25901 file generated for a simple ``Hello World'' program.
25902 Comments have been added for clarification purposes.
25903
25904 @smallexample @c adanocomment
25905 @iftex
25906 @leftskip=0cm
25907 @end iftex
25908 -- The package is called Ada_Main unless this name is actually used
25909 -- as a unit name in the partition, in which case some other unique
25910 -- name is used.
25911
25912 with System;
25913 package ada_main is
25914
25915 Elab_Final_Code : Integer;
25916 pragma Import (C, Elab_Final_Code, "__gnat_inside_elab_final_code");
25917
25918 -- The main program saves the parameters (argument count,
25919 -- argument values, environment pointer) in global variables
25920 -- for later access by other units including
25921 -- Ada.Command_Line.
25922
25923 gnat_argc : Integer;
25924 gnat_argv : System.Address;
25925 gnat_envp : System.Address;
25926
25927 -- The actual variables are stored in a library routine. This
25928 -- is useful for some shared library situations, where there
25929 -- are problems if variables are not in the library.
25930
25931 pragma Import (C, gnat_argc);
25932 pragma Import (C, gnat_argv);
25933 pragma Import (C, gnat_envp);
25934
25935 -- The exit status is similarly an external location
25936
25937 gnat_exit_status : Integer;
25938 pragma Import (C, gnat_exit_status);
25939
25940 GNAT_Version : constant String :=
25941 "GNAT Version: 6.0.0w (20061115)";
25942 pragma Export (C, GNAT_Version, "__gnat_version");
25943
25944 -- This is the generated adafinal routine that performs
25945 -- finalization at the end of execution. In the case where
25946 -- Ada is the main program, this main program makes a call
25947 -- to adafinal at program termination.
25948
25949 procedure adafinal;
25950 pragma Export (C, adafinal, "adafinal");
25951
25952 -- This is the generated adainit routine that performs
25953 -- initialization at the start of execution. In the case
25954 -- where Ada is the main program, this main program makes
25955 -- a call to adainit at program startup.
25956
25957 procedure adainit;
25958 pragma Export (C, adainit, "adainit");
25959
25960 -- This routine is called at the start of execution. It is
25961 -- a dummy routine that is used by the debugger to breakpoint
25962 -- at the start of execution.
25963
25964 procedure Break_Start;
25965 pragma Import (C, Break_Start, "__gnat_break_start");
25966
25967 -- This is the actual generated main program (it would be
25968 -- suppressed if the no main program switch were used). As
25969 -- required by standard system conventions, this program has
25970 -- the external name main.
25971
25972 function main
25973 (argc : Integer;
25974 argv : System.Address;
25975 envp : System.Address)
25976 return Integer;
25977 pragma Export (C, main, "main");
25978
25979 -- The following set of constants give the version
25980 -- identification values for every unit in the bound
25981 -- partition. This identification is computed from all
25982 -- dependent semantic units, and corresponds to the
25983 -- string that would be returned by use of the
25984 -- Body_Version or Version attributes.
25985
25986 type Version_32 is mod 2 ** 32;
25987 u00001 : constant Version_32 := 16#7880BEB3#;
25988 u00002 : constant Version_32 := 16#0D24CBD0#;
25989 u00003 : constant Version_32 := 16#3283DBEB#;
25990 u00004 : constant Version_32 := 16#2359F9ED#;
25991 u00005 : constant Version_32 := 16#664FB847#;
25992 u00006 : constant Version_32 := 16#68E803DF#;
25993 u00007 : constant Version_32 := 16#5572E604#;
25994 u00008 : constant Version_32 := 16#46B173D8#;
25995 u00009 : constant Version_32 := 16#156A40CF#;
25996 u00010 : constant Version_32 := 16#033DABE0#;
25997 u00011 : constant Version_32 := 16#6AB38FEA#;
25998 u00012 : constant Version_32 := 16#22B6217D#;
25999 u00013 : constant Version_32 := 16#68A22947#;
26000 u00014 : constant Version_32 := 16#18CC4A56#;
26001 u00015 : constant Version_32 := 16#08258E1B#;
26002 u00016 : constant Version_32 := 16#367D5222#;
26003 u00017 : constant Version_32 := 16#20C9ECA4#;
26004 u00018 : constant Version_32 := 16#50D32CB6#;
26005 u00019 : constant Version_32 := 16#39A8BB77#;
26006 u00020 : constant Version_32 := 16#5CF8FA2B#;
26007 u00021 : constant Version_32 := 16#2F1EB794#;
26008 u00022 : constant Version_32 := 16#31AB6444#;
26009 u00023 : constant Version_32 := 16#1574B6E9#;
26010 u00024 : constant Version_32 := 16#5109C189#;
26011 u00025 : constant Version_32 := 16#56D770CD#;
26012 u00026 : constant Version_32 := 16#02F9DE3D#;
26013 u00027 : constant Version_32 := 16#08AB6B2C#;
26014 u00028 : constant Version_32 := 16#3FA37670#;
26015 u00029 : constant Version_32 := 16#476457A0#;
26016 u00030 : constant Version_32 := 16#731E1B6E#;
26017 u00031 : constant Version_32 := 16#23C2E789#;
26018 u00032 : constant Version_32 := 16#0F1BD6A1#;
26019 u00033 : constant Version_32 := 16#7C25DE96#;
26020 u00034 : constant Version_32 := 16#39ADFFA2#;
26021 u00035 : constant Version_32 := 16#571DE3E7#;
26022 u00036 : constant Version_32 := 16#5EB646AB#;
26023 u00037 : constant Version_32 := 16#4249379B#;
26024 u00038 : constant Version_32 := 16#0357E00A#;
26025 u00039 : constant Version_32 := 16#3784FB72#;
26026 u00040 : constant Version_32 := 16#2E723019#;
26027 u00041 : constant Version_32 := 16#623358EA#;
26028 u00042 : constant Version_32 := 16#107F9465#;
26029 u00043 : constant Version_32 := 16#6843F68A#;
26030 u00044 : constant Version_32 := 16#63305874#;
26031 u00045 : constant Version_32 := 16#31E56CE1#;
26032 u00046 : constant Version_32 := 16#02917970#;
26033 u00047 : constant Version_32 := 16#6CCBA70E#;
26034 u00048 : constant Version_32 := 16#41CD4204#;
26035 u00049 : constant Version_32 := 16#572E3F58#;
26036 u00050 : constant Version_32 := 16#20729FF5#;
26037 u00051 : constant Version_32 := 16#1D4F93E8#;
26038 u00052 : constant Version_32 := 16#30B2EC3D#;
26039 u00053 : constant Version_32 := 16#34054F96#;
26040 u00054 : constant Version_32 := 16#5A199860#;
26041 u00055 : constant Version_32 := 16#0E7F912B#;
26042 u00056 : constant Version_32 := 16#5760634A#;
26043 u00057 : constant Version_32 := 16#5D851835#;
26044
26045 -- The following Export pragmas export the version numbers
26046 -- with symbolic names ending in B (for body) or S
26047 -- (for spec) so that they can be located in a link. The
26048 -- information provided here is sufficient to track down
26049 -- the exact versions of units used in a given build.
26050
26051 pragma Export (C, u00001, "helloB");
26052 pragma Export (C, u00002, "system__standard_libraryB");
26053 pragma Export (C, u00003, "system__standard_libraryS");
26054 pragma Export (C, u00004, "adaS");
26055 pragma Export (C, u00005, "ada__text_ioB");
26056 pragma Export (C, u00006, "ada__text_ioS");
26057 pragma Export (C, u00007, "ada__exceptionsB");
26058 pragma Export (C, u00008, "ada__exceptionsS");
26059 pragma Export (C, u00009, "gnatS");
26060 pragma Export (C, u00010, "gnat__heap_sort_aB");
26061 pragma Export (C, u00011, "gnat__heap_sort_aS");
26062 pragma Export (C, u00012, "systemS");
26063 pragma Export (C, u00013, "system__exception_tableB");
26064 pragma Export (C, u00014, "system__exception_tableS");
26065 pragma Export (C, u00015, "gnat__htableB");
26066 pragma Export (C, u00016, "gnat__htableS");
26067 pragma Export (C, u00017, "system__exceptionsS");
26068 pragma Export (C, u00018, "system__machine_state_operationsB");
26069 pragma Export (C, u00019, "system__machine_state_operationsS");
26070 pragma Export (C, u00020, "system__machine_codeS");
26071 pragma Export (C, u00021, "system__storage_elementsB");
26072 pragma Export (C, u00022, "system__storage_elementsS");
26073 pragma Export (C, u00023, "system__secondary_stackB");
26074 pragma Export (C, u00024, "system__secondary_stackS");
26075 pragma Export (C, u00025, "system__parametersB");
26076 pragma Export (C, u00026, "system__parametersS");
26077 pragma Export (C, u00027, "system__soft_linksB");
26078 pragma Export (C, u00028, "system__soft_linksS");
26079 pragma Export (C, u00029, "system__stack_checkingB");
26080 pragma Export (C, u00030, "system__stack_checkingS");
26081 pragma Export (C, u00031, "system__tracebackB");
26082 pragma Export (C, u00032, "system__tracebackS");
26083 pragma Export (C, u00033, "ada__streamsS");
26084 pragma Export (C, u00034, "ada__tagsB");
26085 pragma Export (C, u00035, "ada__tagsS");
26086 pragma Export (C, u00036, "system__string_opsB");
26087 pragma Export (C, u00037, "system__string_opsS");
26088 pragma Export (C, u00038, "interfacesS");
26089 pragma Export (C, u00039, "interfaces__c_streamsB");
26090 pragma Export (C, u00040, "interfaces__c_streamsS");
26091 pragma Export (C, u00041, "system__file_ioB");
26092 pragma Export (C, u00042, "system__file_ioS");
26093 pragma Export (C, u00043, "ada__finalizationB");
26094 pragma Export (C, u00044, "ada__finalizationS");
26095 pragma Export (C, u00045, "system__finalization_rootB");
26096 pragma Export (C, u00046, "system__finalization_rootS");
26097 pragma Export (C, u00047, "system__finalization_implementationB");
26098 pragma Export (C, u00048, "system__finalization_implementationS");
26099 pragma Export (C, u00049, "system__string_ops_concat_3B");
26100 pragma Export (C, u00050, "system__string_ops_concat_3S");
26101 pragma Export (C, u00051, "system__stream_attributesB");
26102 pragma Export (C, u00052, "system__stream_attributesS");
26103 pragma Export (C, u00053, "ada__io_exceptionsS");
26104 pragma Export (C, u00054, "system__unsigned_typesS");
26105 pragma Export (C, u00055, "system__file_control_blockS");
26106 pragma Export (C, u00056, "ada__finalization__list_controllerB");
26107 pragma Export (C, u00057, "ada__finalization__list_controllerS");
26108
26109 -- BEGIN ELABORATION ORDER
26110 -- ada (spec)
26111 -- gnat (spec)
26112 -- gnat.heap_sort_a (spec)
26113 -- gnat.heap_sort_a (body)
26114 -- gnat.htable (spec)
26115 -- gnat.htable (body)
26116 -- interfaces (spec)
26117 -- system (spec)
26118 -- system.machine_code (spec)
26119 -- system.parameters (spec)
26120 -- system.parameters (body)
26121 -- interfaces.c_streams (spec)
26122 -- interfaces.c_streams (body)
26123 -- system.standard_library (spec)
26124 -- ada.exceptions (spec)
26125 -- system.exception_table (spec)
26126 -- system.exception_table (body)
26127 -- ada.io_exceptions (spec)
26128 -- system.exceptions (spec)
26129 -- system.storage_elements (spec)
26130 -- system.storage_elements (body)
26131 -- system.machine_state_operations (spec)
26132 -- system.machine_state_operations (body)
26133 -- system.secondary_stack (spec)
26134 -- system.stack_checking (spec)
26135 -- system.soft_links (spec)
26136 -- system.soft_links (body)
26137 -- system.stack_checking (body)
26138 -- system.secondary_stack (body)
26139 -- system.standard_library (body)
26140 -- system.string_ops (spec)
26141 -- system.string_ops (body)
26142 -- ada.tags (spec)
26143 -- ada.tags (body)
26144 -- ada.streams (spec)
26145 -- system.finalization_root (spec)
26146 -- system.finalization_root (body)
26147 -- system.string_ops_concat_3 (spec)
26148 -- system.string_ops_concat_3 (body)
26149 -- system.traceback (spec)
26150 -- system.traceback (body)
26151 -- ada.exceptions (body)
26152 -- system.unsigned_types (spec)
26153 -- system.stream_attributes (spec)
26154 -- system.stream_attributes (body)
26155 -- system.finalization_implementation (spec)
26156 -- system.finalization_implementation (body)
26157 -- ada.finalization (spec)
26158 -- ada.finalization (body)
26159 -- ada.finalization.list_controller (spec)
26160 -- ada.finalization.list_controller (body)
26161 -- system.file_control_block (spec)
26162 -- system.file_io (spec)
26163 -- system.file_io (body)
26164 -- ada.text_io (spec)
26165 -- ada.text_io (body)
26166 -- hello (body)
26167 -- END ELABORATION ORDER
26168
26169 end ada_main;
26170
26171 -- The following source file name pragmas allow the generated file
26172 -- names to be unique for different main programs. They are needed
26173 -- since the package name will always be Ada_Main.
26174
26175 pragma Source_File_Name (ada_main, Spec_File_Name => "b~hello.ads");
26176 pragma Source_File_Name (ada_main, Body_File_Name => "b~hello.adb");
26177
26178 -- Generated package body for Ada_Main starts here
26179
26180 package body ada_main is
26181
26182 -- The actual finalization is performed by calling the
26183 -- library routine in System.Standard_Library.Adafinal
26184
26185 procedure Do_Finalize;
26186 pragma Import (C, Do_Finalize, "system__standard_library__adafinal");
26187
26188 -------------
26189 -- adainit --
26190 -------------
26191
26192 @findex adainit
26193 procedure adainit is
26194
26195 -- These booleans are set to True once the associated unit has
26196 -- been elaborated. It is also used to avoid elaborating the
26197 -- same unit twice.
26198
26199 E040 : Boolean;
26200 pragma Import (Ada, E040, "interfaces__c_streams_E");
26201
26202 E008 : Boolean;
26203 pragma Import (Ada, E008, "ada__exceptions_E");
26204
26205 E014 : Boolean;
26206 pragma Import (Ada, E014, "system__exception_table_E");
26207
26208 E053 : Boolean;
26209 pragma Import (Ada, E053, "ada__io_exceptions_E");
26210
26211 E017 : Boolean;
26212 pragma Import (Ada, E017, "system__exceptions_E");
26213
26214 E024 : Boolean;
26215 pragma Import (Ada, E024, "system__secondary_stack_E");
26216
26217 E030 : Boolean;
26218 pragma Import (Ada, E030, "system__stack_checking_E");
26219
26220 E028 : Boolean;
26221 pragma Import (Ada, E028, "system__soft_links_E");
26222
26223 E035 : Boolean;
26224 pragma Import (Ada, E035, "ada__tags_E");
26225
26226 E033 : Boolean;
26227 pragma Import (Ada, E033, "ada__streams_E");
26228
26229 E046 : Boolean;
26230 pragma Import (Ada, E046, "system__finalization_root_E");
26231
26232 E048 : Boolean;
26233 pragma Import (Ada, E048, "system__finalization_implementation_E");
26234
26235 E044 : Boolean;
26236 pragma Import (Ada, E044, "ada__finalization_E");
26237
26238 E057 : Boolean;
26239 pragma Import (Ada, E057, "ada__finalization__list_controller_E");
26240
26241 E055 : Boolean;
26242 pragma Import (Ada, E055, "system__file_control_block_E");
26243
26244 E042 : Boolean;
26245 pragma Import (Ada, E042, "system__file_io_E");
26246
26247 E006 : Boolean;
26248 pragma Import (Ada, E006, "ada__text_io_E");
26249
26250 -- Set_Globals is a library routine that stores away the
26251 -- value of the indicated set of global values in global
26252 -- variables within the library.
26253
26254 procedure Set_Globals
26255 (Main_Priority : Integer;
26256 Time_Slice_Value : Integer;
26257 WC_Encoding : Character;
26258 Locking_Policy : Character;
26259 Queuing_Policy : Character;
26260 Task_Dispatching_Policy : Character;
26261 Adafinal : System.Address;
26262 Unreserve_All_Interrupts : Integer;
26263 Exception_Tracebacks : Integer);
26264 @findex __gnat_set_globals
26265 pragma Import (C, Set_Globals, "__gnat_set_globals");
26266
26267 -- SDP_Table_Build is a library routine used to build the
26268 -- exception tables. See unit Ada.Exceptions in files
26269 -- a-except.ads/adb for full details of how zero cost
26270 -- exception handling works. This procedure, the call to
26271 -- it, and the two following tables are all omitted if the
26272 -- build is in longjmp/setjmp exception mode.
26273
26274 @findex SDP_Table_Build
26275 @findex Zero Cost Exceptions
26276 procedure SDP_Table_Build
26277 (SDP_Addresses : System.Address;
26278 SDP_Count : Natural;
26279 Elab_Addresses : System.Address;
26280 Elab_Addr_Count : Natural);
26281 pragma Import (C, SDP_Table_Build, "__gnat_SDP_Table_Build");
26282
26283 -- Table of Unit_Exception_Table addresses. Used for zero
26284 -- cost exception handling to build the top level table.
26285
26286 ST : aliased constant array (1 .. 23) of System.Address := (
26287 Hello'UET_Address,
26288 Ada.Text_Io'UET_Address,
26289 Ada.Exceptions'UET_Address,
26290 Gnat.Heap_Sort_A'UET_Address,
26291 System.Exception_Table'UET_Address,
26292 System.Machine_State_Operations'UET_Address,
26293 System.Secondary_Stack'UET_Address,
26294 System.Parameters'UET_Address,
26295 System.Soft_Links'UET_Address,
26296 System.Stack_Checking'UET_Address,
26297 System.Traceback'UET_Address,
26298 Ada.Streams'UET_Address,
26299 Ada.Tags'UET_Address,
26300 System.String_Ops'UET_Address,
26301 Interfaces.C_Streams'UET_Address,
26302 System.File_Io'UET_Address,
26303 Ada.Finalization'UET_Address,
26304 System.Finalization_Root'UET_Address,
26305 System.Finalization_Implementation'UET_Address,
26306 System.String_Ops_Concat_3'UET_Address,
26307 System.Stream_Attributes'UET_Address,
26308 System.File_Control_Block'UET_Address,
26309 Ada.Finalization.List_Controller'UET_Address);
26310
26311 -- Table of addresses of elaboration routines. Used for
26312 -- zero cost exception handling to make sure these
26313 -- addresses are included in the top level procedure
26314 -- address table.
26315
26316 EA : aliased constant array (1 .. 23) of System.Address := (
26317 adainit'Code_Address,
26318 Do_Finalize'Code_Address,
26319 Ada.Exceptions'Elab_Spec'Address,
26320 System.Exceptions'Elab_Spec'Address,
26321 Interfaces.C_Streams'Elab_Spec'Address,
26322 System.Exception_Table'Elab_Body'Address,
26323 Ada.Io_Exceptions'Elab_Spec'Address,
26324 System.Stack_Checking'Elab_Spec'Address,
26325 System.Soft_Links'Elab_Body'Address,
26326 System.Secondary_Stack'Elab_Body'Address,
26327 Ada.Tags'Elab_Spec'Address,
26328 Ada.Tags'Elab_Body'Address,
26329 Ada.Streams'Elab_Spec'Address,
26330 System.Finalization_Root'Elab_Spec'Address,
26331 Ada.Exceptions'Elab_Body'Address,
26332 System.Finalization_Implementation'Elab_Spec'Address,
26333 System.Finalization_Implementation'Elab_Body'Address,
26334 Ada.Finalization'Elab_Spec'Address,
26335 Ada.Finalization.List_Controller'Elab_Spec'Address,
26336 System.File_Control_Block'Elab_Spec'Address,
26337 System.File_Io'Elab_Body'Address,
26338 Ada.Text_Io'Elab_Spec'Address,
26339 Ada.Text_Io'Elab_Body'Address);
26340
26341 -- Start of processing for adainit
26342
26343 begin
26344
26345 -- Call SDP_Table_Build to build the top level procedure
26346 -- table for zero cost exception handling (omitted in
26347 -- longjmp/setjmp mode).
26348
26349 SDP_Table_Build (ST'Address, 23, EA'Address, 23);
26350
26351 -- Call Set_Globals to record various information for
26352 -- this partition. The values are derived by the binder
26353 -- from information stored in the ali files by the compiler.
26354
26355 @findex __gnat_set_globals
26356 Set_Globals
26357 (Main_Priority => -1,
26358 -- Priority of main program, -1 if no pragma Priority used
26359
26360 Time_Slice_Value => -1,
26361 -- Time slice from Time_Slice pragma, -1 if none used
26362
26363 WC_Encoding => 'b',
26364 -- Wide_Character encoding used, default is brackets
26365
26366 Locking_Policy => ' ',
26367 -- Locking_Policy used, default of space means not
26368 -- specified, otherwise it is the first character of
26369 -- the policy name.
26370
26371 Queuing_Policy => ' ',
26372 -- Queuing_Policy used, default of space means not
26373 -- specified, otherwise it is the first character of
26374 -- the policy name.
26375
26376 Task_Dispatching_Policy => ' ',
26377 -- Task_Dispatching_Policy used, default of space means
26378 -- not specified, otherwise first character of the
26379 -- policy name.
26380
26381 Adafinal => System.Null_Address,
26382 -- Address of Adafinal routine, not used anymore
26383
26384 Unreserve_All_Interrupts => 0,
26385 -- Set true if pragma Unreserve_All_Interrupts was used
26386
26387 Exception_Tracebacks => 0);
26388 -- Indicates if exception tracebacks are enabled
26389
26390 Elab_Final_Code := 1;
26391
26392 -- Now we have the elaboration calls for all units in the partition.
26393 -- The Elab_Spec and Elab_Body attributes generate references to the
26394 -- implicit elaboration procedures generated by the compiler for
26395 -- each unit that requires elaboration.
26396
26397 if not E040 then
26398 Interfaces.C_Streams'Elab_Spec;
26399 end if;
26400 E040 := True;
26401 if not E008 then
26402 Ada.Exceptions'Elab_Spec;
26403 end if;
26404 if not E014 then
26405 System.Exception_Table'Elab_Body;
26406 E014 := True;
26407 end if;
26408 if not E053 then
26409 Ada.Io_Exceptions'Elab_Spec;
26410 E053 := True;
26411 end if;
26412 if not E017 then
26413 System.Exceptions'Elab_Spec;
26414 E017 := True;
26415 end if;
26416 if not E030 then
26417 System.Stack_Checking'Elab_Spec;
26418 end if;
26419 if not E028 then
26420 System.Soft_Links'Elab_Body;
26421 E028 := True;
26422 end if;
26423 E030 := True;
26424 if not E024 then
26425 System.Secondary_Stack'Elab_Body;
26426 E024 := True;
26427 end if;
26428 if not E035 then
26429 Ada.Tags'Elab_Spec;
26430 end if;
26431 if not E035 then
26432 Ada.Tags'Elab_Body;
26433 E035 := True;
26434 end if;
26435 if not E033 then
26436 Ada.Streams'Elab_Spec;
26437 E033 := True;
26438 end if;
26439 if not E046 then
26440 System.Finalization_Root'Elab_Spec;
26441 end if;
26442 E046 := True;
26443 if not E008 then
26444 Ada.Exceptions'Elab_Body;
26445 E008 := True;
26446 end if;
26447 if not E048 then
26448 System.Finalization_Implementation'Elab_Spec;
26449 end if;
26450 if not E048 then
26451 System.Finalization_Implementation'Elab_Body;
26452 E048 := True;
26453 end if;
26454 if not E044 then
26455 Ada.Finalization'Elab_Spec;
26456 end if;
26457 E044 := True;
26458 if not E057 then
26459 Ada.Finalization.List_Controller'Elab_Spec;
26460 end if;
26461 E057 := True;
26462 if not E055 then
26463 System.File_Control_Block'Elab_Spec;
26464 E055 := True;
26465 end if;
26466 if not E042 then
26467 System.File_Io'Elab_Body;
26468 E042 := True;
26469 end if;
26470 if not E006 then
26471 Ada.Text_Io'Elab_Spec;
26472 end if;
26473 if not E006 then
26474 Ada.Text_Io'Elab_Body;
26475 E006 := True;
26476 end if;
26477
26478 Elab_Final_Code := 0;
26479 end adainit;
26480
26481 --------------
26482 -- adafinal --
26483 --------------
26484
26485 @findex adafinal
26486 procedure adafinal is
26487 begin
26488 Do_Finalize;
26489 end adafinal;
26490
26491 ----------
26492 -- main --
26493 ----------
26494
26495 -- main is actually a function, as in the ANSI C standard,
26496 -- defined to return the exit status. The three parameters
26497 -- are the argument count, argument values and environment
26498 -- pointer.
26499
26500 @findex Main Program
26501 function main
26502 (argc : Integer;
26503 argv : System.Address;
26504 envp : System.Address)
26505 return Integer
26506 is
26507 -- The initialize routine performs low level system
26508 -- initialization using a standard library routine which
26509 -- sets up signal handling and performs any other
26510 -- required setup. The routine can be found in file
26511 -- a-init.c.
26512
26513 @findex __gnat_initialize
26514 procedure initialize;
26515 pragma Import (C, initialize, "__gnat_initialize");
26516
26517 -- The finalize routine performs low level system
26518 -- finalization using a standard library routine. The
26519 -- routine is found in file a-final.c and in the standard
26520 -- distribution is a dummy routine that does nothing, so
26521 -- really this is a hook for special user finalization.
26522
26523 @findex __gnat_finalize
26524 procedure finalize;
26525 pragma Import (C, finalize, "__gnat_finalize");
26526
26527 -- We get to the main program of the partition by using
26528 -- pragma Import because if we try to with the unit and
26529 -- call it Ada style, then not only do we waste time
26530 -- recompiling it, but also, we don't really know the right
26531 -- switches (e.g.@: identifier character set) to be used
26532 -- to compile it.
26533
26534 procedure Ada_Main_Program;
26535 pragma Import (Ada, Ada_Main_Program, "_ada_hello");
26536
26537 -- Start of processing for main
26538
26539 begin
26540 -- Save global variables
26541
26542 gnat_argc := argc;
26543 gnat_argv := argv;
26544 gnat_envp := envp;
26545
26546 -- Call low level system initialization
26547
26548 Initialize;
26549
26550 -- Call our generated Ada initialization routine
26551
26552 adainit;
26553
26554 -- This is the point at which we want the debugger to get
26555 -- control
26556
26557 Break_Start;
26558
26559 -- Now we call the main program of the partition
26560
26561 Ada_Main_Program;
26562
26563 -- Perform Ada finalization
26564
26565 adafinal;
26566
26567 -- Perform low level system finalization
26568
26569 Finalize;
26570
26571 -- Return the proper exit status
26572 return (gnat_exit_status);
26573 end;
26574
26575 -- This section is entirely comments, so it has no effect on the
26576 -- compilation of the Ada_Main package. It provides the list of
26577 -- object files and linker options, as well as some standard
26578 -- libraries needed for the link. The gnatlink utility parses
26579 -- this b~hello.adb file to read these comment lines to generate
26580 -- the appropriate command line arguments for the call to the
26581 -- system linker. The BEGIN/END lines are used for sentinels for
26582 -- this parsing operation.
26583
26584 -- The exact file names will of course depend on the environment,
26585 -- host/target and location of files on the host system.
26586
26587 @findex Object file list
26588 -- BEGIN Object file/option list
26589 -- ./hello.o
26590 -- -L./
26591 -- -L/usr/local/gnat/lib/gcc-lib/i686-pc-linux-gnu/2.8.1/adalib/
26592 -- /usr/local/gnat/lib/gcc-lib/i686-pc-linux-gnu/2.8.1/adalib/libgnat.a
26593 -- END Object file/option list
26594
26595 end ada_main;
26596 @end smallexample
26597
26598 @noindent
26599 The Ada code in the above example is exactly what is generated by the
26600 binder. We have added comments to more clearly indicate the function
26601 of each part of the generated @code{Ada_Main} package.
26602
26603 The code is standard Ada in all respects, and can be processed by any
26604 tools that handle Ada. In particular, it is possible to use the debugger
26605 in Ada mode to debug the generated @code{Ada_Main} package. For example,
26606 suppose that for reasons that you do not understand, your program is crashing
26607 during elaboration of the body of @code{Ada.Text_IO}. To locate this bug,
26608 you can place a breakpoint on the call:
26609
26610 @smallexample @c ada
26611 Ada.Text_Io'Elab_Body;
26612 @end smallexample
26613
26614 @noindent
26615 and trace the elaboration routine for this package to find out where
26616 the problem might be (more usually of course you would be debugging
26617 elaboration code in your own application).
26618
26619 @node Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT
26620 @appendix Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT
26621 @cindex Order of elaboration
26622 @cindex Elaboration control
26623
26624 @menu
26625 * Elaboration Code::
26626 * Checking the Elaboration Order::
26627 * Controlling the Elaboration Order::
26628 * Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - Internal Calls::
26629 * Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - External Calls::
26630 * Default Behavior in GNAT - Ensuring Safety::
26631 * Treatment of Pragma Elaborate::
26632 * Elaboration Issues for Library Tasks::
26633 * Mixing Elaboration Models::
26634 * What to Do If the Default Elaboration Behavior Fails::
26635 * Elaboration for Access-to-Subprogram Values::
26636 * Summary of Procedures for Elaboration Control::
26637 * Other Elaboration Order Considerations::
26638 @end menu
26639
26640 @noindent
26641 This chapter describes the handling of elaboration code in Ada and
26642 in GNAT, and discusses how the order of elaboration of program units can
26643 be controlled in GNAT, either automatically or with explicit programming
26644 features.
26645
26646 @node Elaboration Code
26647 @section Elaboration Code
26648
26649 @noindent
26650 Ada provides rather general mechanisms for executing code at elaboration
26651 time, that is to say before the main program starts executing. Such code arises
26652 in three contexts:
26653
26654 @table @asis
26655 @item Initializers for variables.
26656 Variables declared at the library level, in package specs or bodies, can
26657 require initialization that is performed at elaboration time, as in:
26658 @smallexample @c ada
26659 @cartouche
26660 Sqrt_Half : Float := Sqrt (0.5);
26661 @end cartouche
26662 @end smallexample
26663
26664 @item Package initialization code
26665 Code in a @code{BEGIN-END} section at the outer level of a package body is
26666 executed as part of the package body elaboration code.
26667
26668 @item Library level task allocators
26669 Tasks that are declared using task allocators at the library level
26670 start executing immediately and hence can execute at elaboration time.
26671 @end table
26672
26673 @noindent
26674 Subprogram calls are possible in any of these contexts, which means that
26675 any arbitrary part of the program may be executed as part of the elaboration
26676 code. It is even possible to write a program which does all its work at
26677 elaboration time, with a null main program, although stylistically this
26678 would usually be considered an inappropriate way to structure
26679 a program.
26680
26681 An important concern arises in the context of elaboration code:
26682 we have to be sure that it is executed in an appropriate order. What we
26683 have is a series of elaboration code sections, potentially one section
26684 for each unit in the program. It is important that these execute
26685 in the correct order. Correctness here means that, taking the above
26686 example of the declaration of @code{Sqrt_Half},
26687 if some other piece of
26688 elaboration code references @code{Sqrt_Half},
26689 then it must run after the
26690 section of elaboration code that contains the declaration of
26691 @code{Sqrt_Half}.
26692
26693 There would never be any order of elaboration problem if we made a rule
26694 that whenever you @code{with} a unit, you must elaborate both the spec and body
26695 of that unit before elaborating the unit doing the @code{with}'ing:
26696
26697 @smallexample @c ada
26698 @group
26699 @cartouche
26700 with Unit_1;
26701 package Unit_2 is @dots{}
26702 @end cartouche
26703 @end group
26704 @end smallexample
26705
26706 @noindent
26707 would require that both the body and spec of @code{Unit_1} be elaborated
26708 before the spec of @code{Unit_2}. However, a rule like that would be far too
26709 restrictive. In particular, it would make it impossible to have routines
26710 in separate packages that were mutually recursive.
26711
26712 You might think that a clever enough compiler could look at the actual
26713 elaboration code and determine an appropriate correct order of elaboration,
26714 but in the general case, this is not possible. Consider the following
26715 example.
26716
26717 In the body of @code{Unit_1}, we have a procedure @code{Func_1}
26718 that references
26719 the variable @code{Sqrt_1}, which is declared in the elaboration code
26720 of the body of @code{Unit_1}:
26721
26722 @smallexample @c ada
26723 @cartouche
26724 Sqrt_1 : Float := Sqrt (0.1);
26725 @end cartouche
26726 @end smallexample
26727
26728 @noindent
26729 The elaboration code of the body of @code{Unit_1} also contains:
26730
26731 @smallexample @c ada
26732 @group
26733 @cartouche
26734 if expression_1 = 1 then
26735 Q := Unit_2.Func_2;
26736 end if;
26737 @end cartouche
26738 @end group
26739 @end smallexample
26740
26741 @noindent
26742 @code{Unit_2} is exactly parallel,
26743 it has a procedure @code{Func_2} that references
26744 the variable @code{Sqrt_2}, which is declared in the elaboration code of
26745 the body @code{Unit_2}:
26746
26747 @smallexample @c ada
26748 @cartouche
26749 Sqrt_2 : Float := Sqrt (0.1);
26750 @end cartouche
26751 @end smallexample
26752
26753 @noindent
26754 The elaboration code of the body of @code{Unit_2} also contains:
26755
26756 @smallexample @c ada
26757 @group
26758 @cartouche
26759 if expression_2 = 2 then
26760 Q := Unit_1.Func_1;
26761 end if;
26762 @end cartouche
26763 @end group
26764 @end smallexample
26765
26766 @noindent
26767 Now the question is, which of the following orders of elaboration is
26768 acceptable:
26769
26770 @smallexample
26771 @group
26772 Spec of Unit_1
26773 Spec of Unit_2
26774 Body of Unit_1
26775 Body of Unit_2
26776 @end group
26777 @end smallexample
26778
26779 @noindent
26780 or
26781
26782 @smallexample
26783 @group
26784 Spec of Unit_2
26785 Spec of Unit_1
26786 Body of Unit_2
26787 Body of Unit_1
26788 @end group
26789 @end smallexample
26790
26791 @noindent
26792 If you carefully analyze the flow here, you will see that you cannot tell
26793 at compile time the answer to this question.
26794 If @code{expression_1} is not equal to 1,
26795 and @code{expression_2} is not equal to 2,
26796 then either order is acceptable, because neither of the function calls is
26797 executed. If both tests evaluate to true, then neither order is acceptable
26798 and in fact there is no correct order.
26799
26800 If one of the two expressions is true, and the other is false, then one
26801 of the above orders is correct, and the other is incorrect. For example,
26802 if @code{expression_1} /= 1 and @code{expression_2} = 2,
26803 then the call to @code{Func_1}
26804 will occur, but not the call to @code{Func_2.}
26805 This means that it is essential
26806 to elaborate the body of @code{Unit_1} before
26807 the body of @code{Unit_2}, so the first
26808 order of elaboration is correct and the second is wrong.
26809
26810 By making @code{expression_1} and @code{expression_2}
26811 depend on input data, or perhaps
26812 the time of day, we can make it impossible for the compiler or binder
26813 to figure out which of these expressions will be true, and hence it
26814 is impossible to guarantee a safe order of elaboration at run time.
26815
26816 @node Checking the Elaboration Order
26817 @section Checking the Elaboration Order
26818
26819 @noindent
26820 In some languages that involve the same kind of elaboration problems,
26821 e.g.@: Java and C++, the programmer is expected to worry about these
26822 ordering problems himself, and it is common to
26823 write a program in which an incorrect elaboration order gives
26824 surprising results, because it references variables before they
26825 are initialized.
26826 Ada is designed to be a safe language, and a programmer-beware approach is
26827 clearly not sufficient. Consequently, the language provides three lines
26828 of defense:
26829
26830 @table @asis
26831 @item Standard rules
26832 Some standard rules restrict the possible choice of elaboration
26833 order. In particular, if you @code{with} a unit, then its spec is always
26834 elaborated before the unit doing the @code{with}. Similarly, a parent
26835 spec is always elaborated before the child spec, and finally
26836 a spec is always elaborated before its corresponding body.
26837
26838 @item Dynamic elaboration checks
26839 @cindex Elaboration checks
26840 @cindex Checks, elaboration
26841 Dynamic checks are made at run time, so that if some entity is accessed
26842 before it is elaborated (typically by means of a subprogram call)
26843 then the exception (@code{Program_Error}) is raised.
26844
26845 @item Elaboration control
26846 Facilities are provided for the programmer to specify the desired order
26847 of elaboration.
26848 @end table
26849
26850 Let's look at these facilities in more detail. First, the rules for
26851 dynamic checking. One possible rule would be simply to say that the
26852 exception is raised if you access a variable which has not yet been
26853 elaborated. The trouble with this approach is that it could require
26854 expensive checks on every variable reference. Instead Ada has two
26855 rules which are a little more restrictive, but easier to check, and
26856 easier to state:
26857
26858 @table @asis
26859 @item Restrictions on calls
26860 A subprogram can only be called at elaboration time if its body
26861 has been elaborated. The rules for elaboration given above guarantee
26862 that the spec of the subprogram has been elaborated before the
26863 call, but not the body. If this rule is violated, then the
26864 exception @code{Program_Error} is raised.
26865
26866 @item Restrictions on instantiations
26867 A generic unit can only be instantiated if the body of the generic
26868 unit has been elaborated. Again, the rules for elaboration given above
26869 guarantee that the spec of the generic unit has been elaborated
26870 before the instantiation, but not the body. If this rule is
26871 violated, then the exception @code{Program_Error} is raised.
26872 @end table
26873
26874 @noindent
26875 The idea is that if the body has been elaborated, then any variables
26876 it references must have been elaborated; by checking for the body being
26877 elaborated we guarantee that none of its references causes any
26878 trouble. As we noted above, this is a little too restrictive, because a
26879 subprogram that has no non-local references in its body may in fact be safe
26880 to call. However, it really would be unsafe to rely on this, because
26881 it would mean that the caller was aware of details of the implementation
26882 in the body. This goes against the basic tenets of Ada.
26883
26884 A plausible implementation can be described as follows.
26885 A Boolean variable is associated with each subprogram
26886 and each generic unit. This variable is initialized to False, and is set to
26887 True at the point body is elaborated. Every call or instantiation checks the
26888 variable, and raises @code{Program_Error} if the variable is False.
26889
26890 Note that one might think that it would be good enough to have one Boolean
26891 variable for each package, but that would not deal with cases of trying
26892 to call a body in the same package as the call
26893 that has not been elaborated yet.
26894 Of course a compiler may be able to do enough analysis to optimize away
26895 some of the Boolean variables as unnecessary, and @code{GNAT} indeed
26896 does such optimizations, but still the easiest conceptual model is to
26897 think of there being one variable per subprogram.
26898
26899 @node Controlling the Elaboration Order
26900 @section Controlling the Elaboration Order
26901
26902 @noindent
26903 In the previous section we discussed the rules in Ada which ensure
26904 that @code{Program_Error} is raised if an incorrect elaboration order is
26905 chosen. This prevents erroneous executions, but we need mechanisms to
26906 specify a correct execution and avoid the exception altogether.
26907 To achieve this, Ada provides a number of features for controlling
26908 the order of elaboration. We discuss these features in this section.
26909
26910 First, there are several ways of indicating to the compiler that a given
26911 unit has no elaboration problems:
26912
26913 @table @asis
26914 @item packages that do not require a body
26915 A library package that does not require a body does not permit
26916 a body (this rule was introduced in Ada 95).
26917 Thus if we have a such a package, as in:
26918
26919 @smallexample @c ada
26920 @group
26921 @cartouche
26922 package Definitions is
26923 generic
26924 type m is new integer;
26925 package Subp is
26926 type a is array (1 .. 10) of m;
26927 type b is array (1 .. 20) of m;
26928 end Subp;
26929 end Definitions;
26930 @end cartouche
26931 @end group
26932 @end smallexample
26933
26934 @noindent
26935 A package that @code{with}'s @code{Definitions} may safely instantiate
26936 @code{Definitions.Subp} because the compiler can determine that there
26937 definitely is no package body to worry about in this case
26938
26939 @item pragma Pure
26940 @cindex pragma Pure
26941 @findex Pure
26942 Places sufficient restrictions on a unit to guarantee that
26943 no call to any subprogram in the unit can result in an
26944 elaboration problem. This means that the compiler does not need
26945 to worry about the point of elaboration of such units, and in
26946 particular, does not need to check any calls to any subprograms
26947 in this unit.
26948
26949 @item pragma Preelaborate
26950 @findex Preelaborate
26951 @cindex pragma Preelaborate
26952 This pragma places slightly less stringent restrictions on a unit than
26953 does pragma Pure,
26954 but these restrictions are still sufficient to ensure that there
26955 are no elaboration problems with any calls to the unit.
26956
26957 @item pragma Elaborate_Body
26958 @findex Elaborate_Body
26959 @cindex pragma Elaborate_Body
26960 This pragma requires that the body of a unit be elaborated immediately
26961 after its spec. Suppose a unit @code{A} has such a pragma,
26962 and unit @code{B} does
26963 a @code{with} of unit @code{A}. Recall that the standard rules require
26964 the spec of unit @code{A}
26965 to be elaborated before the @code{with}'ing unit; given the pragma in
26966 @code{A}, we also know that the body of @code{A}
26967 will be elaborated before @code{B}, so
26968 that calls to @code{A} are safe and do not need a check.
26969 @end table
26970
26971 @noindent
26972 Note that,
26973 unlike pragma @code{Pure} and pragma @code{Preelaborate},
26974 the use of
26975 @code{Elaborate_Body} does not guarantee that the program is
26976 free of elaboration problems, because it may not be possible
26977 to satisfy the requested elaboration order.
26978 Let's go back to the example with @code{Unit_1} and @code{Unit_2}.
26979 If a programmer
26980 marks @code{Unit_1} as @code{Elaborate_Body},
26981 and not @code{Unit_2,} then the order of
26982 elaboration will be:
26983
26984 @smallexample
26985 @group
26986 Spec of Unit_2
26987 Spec of Unit_1
26988 Body of Unit_1
26989 Body of Unit_2
26990 @end group
26991 @end smallexample
26992
26993 @noindent
26994 Now that means that the call to @code{Func_1} in @code{Unit_2}
26995 need not be checked,
26996 it must be safe. But the call to @code{Func_2} in
26997 @code{Unit_1} may still fail if
26998 @code{Expression_1} is equal to 1,
26999 and the programmer must still take
27000 responsibility for this not being the case.
27001
27002 If all units carry a pragma @code{Elaborate_Body}, then all problems are
27003 eliminated, except for calls entirely within a body, which are
27004 in any case fully under programmer control. However, using the pragma
27005 everywhere is not always possible.
27006 In particular, for our @code{Unit_1}/@code{Unit_2} example, if
27007 we marked both of them as having pragma @code{Elaborate_Body}, then
27008 clearly there would be no possible elaboration order.
27009
27010 The above pragmas allow a server to guarantee safe use by clients, and
27011 clearly this is the preferable approach. Consequently a good rule
27012 is to mark units as @code{Pure} or @code{Preelaborate} if possible,
27013 and if this is not possible,
27014 mark them as @code{Elaborate_Body} if possible.
27015 As we have seen, there are situations where neither of these
27016 three pragmas can be used.
27017 So we also provide methods for clients to control the
27018 order of elaboration of the servers on which they depend:
27019
27020 @table @asis
27021 @item pragma Elaborate (unit)
27022 @findex Elaborate
27023 @cindex pragma Elaborate
27024 This pragma is placed in the context clause, after a @code{with} clause,
27025 and it requires that the body of the named unit be elaborated before
27026 the unit in which the pragma occurs. The idea is to use this pragma
27027 if the current unit calls at elaboration time, directly or indirectly,
27028 some subprogram in the named unit.
27029
27030 @item pragma Elaborate_All (unit)
27031 @findex Elaborate_All
27032 @cindex pragma Elaborate_All
27033 This is a stronger version of the Elaborate pragma. Consider the
27034 following example:
27035
27036 @smallexample
27037 Unit A @code{with}'s unit B and calls B.Func in elab code
27038 Unit B @code{with}'s unit C, and B.Func calls C.Func
27039 @end smallexample
27040
27041 @noindent
27042 Now if we put a pragma @code{Elaborate (B)}
27043 in unit @code{A}, this ensures that the
27044 body of @code{B} is elaborated before the call, but not the
27045 body of @code{C}, so
27046 the call to @code{C.Func} could still cause @code{Program_Error} to
27047 be raised.
27048
27049 The effect of a pragma @code{Elaborate_All} is stronger, it requires
27050 not only that the body of the named unit be elaborated before the
27051 unit doing the @code{with}, but also the bodies of all units that the
27052 named unit uses, following @code{with} links transitively. For example,
27053 if we put a pragma @code{Elaborate_All (B)} in unit @code{A},
27054 then it requires
27055 not only that the body of @code{B} be elaborated before @code{A},
27056 but also the
27057 body of @code{C}, because @code{B} @code{with}'s @code{C}.
27058 @end table
27059
27060 @noindent
27061 We are now in a position to give a usage rule in Ada for avoiding
27062 elaboration problems, at least if dynamic dispatching and access to
27063 subprogram values are not used. We will handle these cases separately
27064 later.
27065
27066 The rule is simple. If a unit has elaboration code that can directly or
27067 indirectly make a call to a subprogram in a @code{with}'ed unit, or instantiate
27068 a generic package in a @code{with}'ed unit,
27069 then if the @code{with}'ed unit does not have
27070 pragma @code{Pure} or @code{Preelaborate}, then the client should have
27071 a pragma @code{Elaborate_All}
27072 for the @code{with}'ed unit. By following this rule a client is
27073 assured that calls can be made without risk of an exception.
27074
27075 For generic subprogram instantiations, the rule can be relaxed to
27076 require only a pragma @code{Elaborate} since elaborating the body
27077 of a subprogram cannot cause any transitive elaboration (we are
27078 not calling the subprogram in this case, just elaborating its
27079 declaration).
27080
27081 If this rule is not followed, then a program may be in one of four
27082 states:
27083
27084 @table @asis
27085 @item No order exists
27086 No order of elaboration exists which follows the rules, taking into
27087 account any @code{Elaborate}, @code{Elaborate_All},
27088 or @code{Elaborate_Body} pragmas. In
27089 this case, an Ada compiler must diagnose the situation at bind
27090 time, and refuse to build an executable program.
27091
27092 @item One or more orders exist, all incorrect
27093 One or more acceptable elaboration orders exist, and all of them
27094 generate an elaboration order problem. In this case, the binder
27095 can build an executable program, but @code{Program_Error} will be raised
27096 when the program is run.
27097
27098 @item Several orders exist, some right, some incorrect
27099 One or more acceptable elaboration orders exists, and some of them
27100 work, and some do not. The programmer has not controlled
27101 the order of elaboration, so the binder may or may not pick one of
27102 the correct orders, and the program may or may not raise an
27103 exception when it is run. This is the worst case, because it means
27104 that the program may fail when moved to another compiler, or even
27105 another version of the same compiler.
27106
27107 @item One or more orders exists, all correct
27108 One ore more acceptable elaboration orders exist, and all of them
27109 work. In this case the program runs successfully. This state of
27110 affairs can be guaranteed by following the rule we gave above, but
27111 may be true even if the rule is not followed.
27112 @end table
27113
27114 @noindent
27115 Note that one additional advantage of following our rules on the use
27116 of @code{Elaborate} and @code{Elaborate_All}
27117 is that the program continues to stay in the ideal (all orders OK) state
27118 even if maintenance
27119 changes some bodies of some units. Conversely, if a program that does
27120 not follow this rule happens to be safe at some point, this state of affairs
27121 may deteriorate silently as a result of maintenance changes.
27122
27123 You may have noticed that the above discussion did not mention
27124 the use of @code{Elaborate_Body}. This was a deliberate omission. If you
27125 @code{with} an @code{Elaborate_Body} unit, it still may be the case that
27126 code in the body makes calls to some other unit, so it is still necessary
27127 to use @code{Elaborate_All} on such units.
27128
27129 @node Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - Internal Calls
27130 @section Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - Internal Calls
27131
27132 @noindent
27133 In the case of internal calls, i.e., calls within a single package, the
27134 programmer has full control over the order of elaboration, and it is up
27135 to the programmer to elaborate declarations in an appropriate order. For
27136 example writing:
27137
27138 @smallexample @c ada
27139 @group
27140 @cartouche
27141 function One return Float;
27142
27143 Q : Float := One;
27144
27145 function One return Float is
27146 begin
27147 return 1.0;
27148 end One;
27149 @end cartouche
27150 @end group
27151 @end smallexample
27152
27153 @noindent
27154 will obviously raise @code{Program_Error} at run time, because function
27155 One will be called before its body is elaborated. In this case GNAT will
27156 generate a warning that the call will raise @code{Program_Error}:
27157
27158 @smallexample
27159 @group
27160 @cartouche
27161 1. procedure y is
27162 2. function One return Float;
27163 3.
27164 4. Q : Float := One;
27165 |
27166 >>> warning: cannot call "One" before body is elaborated
27167 >>> warning: Program_Error will be raised at run time
27168
27169 5.
27170 6. function One return Float is
27171 7. begin
27172 8. return 1.0;
27173 9. end One;
27174 10.
27175 11. begin
27176 12. null;
27177 13. end;
27178 @end cartouche
27179 @end group
27180 @end smallexample
27181
27182 @noindent
27183 Note that in this particular case, it is likely that the call is safe, because
27184 the function @code{One} does not access any global variables.
27185 Nevertheless in Ada, we do not want the validity of the check to depend on
27186 the contents of the body (think about the separate compilation case), so this
27187 is still wrong, as we discussed in the previous sections.
27188
27189 The error is easily corrected by rearranging the declarations so that the
27190 body of @code{One} appears before the declaration containing the call
27191 (note that in Ada 95 and Ada 2005,
27192 declarations can appear in any order, so there is no restriction that
27193 would prevent this reordering, and if we write:
27194
27195 @smallexample @c ada
27196 @group
27197 @cartouche
27198 function One return Float;
27199
27200 function One return Float is
27201 begin
27202 return 1.0;
27203 end One;
27204
27205 Q : Float := One;
27206 @end cartouche
27207 @end group
27208 @end smallexample
27209
27210 @noindent
27211 then all is well, no warning is generated, and no
27212 @code{Program_Error} exception
27213 will be raised.
27214 Things are more complicated when a chain of subprograms is executed:
27215
27216 @smallexample @c ada
27217 @group
27218 @cartouche
27219 function A return Integer;
27220 function B return Integer;
27221 function C return Integer;
27222
27223 function B return Integer is begin return A; end;
27224 function C return Integer is begin return B; end;
27225
27226 X : Integer := C;
27227
27228 function A return Integer is begin return 1; end;
27229 @end cartouche
27230 @end group
27231 @end smallexample
27232
27233 @noindent
27234 Now the call to @code{C}
27235 at elaboration time in the declaration of @code{X} is correct, because
27236 the body of @code{C} is already elaborated,
27237 and the call to @code{B} within the body of
27238 @code{C} is correct, but the call
27239 to @code{A} within the body of @code{B} is incorrect, because the body
27240 of @code{A} has not been elaborated, so @code{Program_Error}
27241 will be raised on the call to @code{A}.
27242 In this case GNAT will generate a
27243 warning that @code{Program_Error} may be
27244 raised at the point of the call. Let's look at the warning:
27245
27246 @smallexample
27247 @group
27248 @cartouche
27249 1. procedure x is
27250 2. function A return Integer;
27251 3. function B return Integer;
27252 4. function C return Integer;
27253 5.
27254 6. function B return Integer is begin return A; end;
27255 |
27256 >>> warning: call to "A" before body is elaborated may
27257 raise Program_Error
27258 >>> warning: "B" called at line 7
27259 >>> warning: "C" called at line 9
27260
27261 7. function C return Integer is begin return B; end;
27262 8.
27263 9. X : Integer := C;
27264 10.
27265 11. function A return Integer is begin return 1; end;
27266 12.
27267 13. begin
27268 14. null;
27269 15. end;
27270 @end cartouche
27271 @end group
27272 @end smallexample
27273
27274 @noindent
27275 Note that the message here says ``may raise'', instead of the direct case,
27276 where the message says ``will be raised''. That's because whether
27277 @code{A} is
27278 actually called depends in general on run-time flow of control.
27279 For example, if the body of @code{B} said
27280
27281 @smallexample @c ada
27282 @group
27283 @cartouche
27284 function B return Integer is
27285 begin
27286 if some-condition-depending-on-input-data then
27287 return A;
27288 else
27289 return 1;
27290 end if;
27291 end B;
27292 @end cartouche
27293 @end group
27294 @end smallexample
27295
27296 @noindent
27297 then we could not know until run time whether the incorrect call to A would
27298 actually occur, so @code{Program_Error} might
27299 or might not be raised. It is possible for a compiler to
27300 do a better job of analyzing bodies, to
27301 determine whether or not @code{Program_Error}
27302 might be raised, but it certainly
27303 couldn't do a perfect job (that would require solving the halting problem
27304 and is provably impossible), and because this is a warning anyway, it does
27305 not seem worth the effort to do the analysis. Cases in which it
27306 would be relevant are rare.
27307
27308 In practice, warnings of either of the forms given
27309 above will usually correspond to
27310 real errors, and should be examined carefully and eliminated.
27311 In the rare case where a warning is bogus, it can be suppressed by any of
27312 the following methods:
27313
27314 @itemize @bullet
27315 @item
27316 Compile with the @option{-gnatws} switch set
27317
27318 @item
27319 Suppress @code{Elaboration_Check} for the called subprogram
27320
27321 @item
27322 Use pragma @code{Warnings_Off} to turn warnings off for the call
27323 @end itemize
27324
27325 @noindent
27326 For the internal elaboration check case,
27327 GNAT by default generates the
27328 necessary run-time checks to ensure
27329 that @code{Program_Error} is raised if any
27330 call fails an elaboration check. Of course this can only happen if a
27331 warning has been issued as described above. The use of pragma
27332 @code{Suppress (Elaboration_Check)} may (but is not guaranteed to) suppress
27333 some of these checks, meaning that it may be possible (but is not
27334 guaranteed) for a program to be able to call a subprogram whose body
27335 is not yet elaborated, without raising a @code{Program_Error} exception.
27336
27337 @node Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - External Calls
27338 @section Controlling Elaboration in GNAT - External Calls
27339
27340 @noindent
27341 The previous section discussed the case in which the execution of a
27342 particular thread of elaboration code occurred entirely within a
27343 single unit. This is the easy case to handle, because a programmer
27344 has direct and total control over the order of elaboration, and
27345 furthermore, checks need only be generated in cases which are rare
27346 and which the compiler can easily detect.
27347 The situation is more complex when separate compilation is taken into account.
27348 Consider the following:
27349
27350 @smallexample @c ada
27351 @cartouche
27352 @group
27353 package Math is
27354 function Sqrt (Arg : Float) return Float;
27355 end Math;
27356
27357 package body Math is
27358 function Sqrt (Arg : Float) return Float is
27359 begin
27360 @dots{}
27361 end Sqrt;
27362 end Math;
27363 @end group
27364 @group
27365 with Math;
27366 package Stuff is
27367 X : Float := Math.Sqrt (0.5);
27368 end Stuff;
27369
27370 with Stuff;
27371 procedure Main is
27372 begin
27373 @dots{}
27374 end Main;
27375 @end group
27376 @end cartouche
27377 @end smallexample
27378
27379 @noindent
27380 where @code{Main} is the main program. When this program is executed, the
27381 elaboration code must first be executed, and one of the jobs of the
27382 binder is to determine the order in which the units of a program are
27383 to be elaborated. In this case we have four units: the spec and body
27384 of @code{Math},
27385 the spec of @code{Stuff} and the body of @code{Main}).
27386 In what order should the four separate sections of elaboration code
27387 be executed?
27388
27389 There are some restrictions in the order of elaboration that the binder
27390 can choose. In particular, if unit U has a @code{with}
27391 for a package @code{X}, then you
27392 are assured that the spec of @code{X}
27393 is elaborated before U , but you are
27394 not assured that the body of @code{X}
27395 is elaborated before U.
27396 This means that in the above case, the binder is allowed to choose the
27397 order:
27398
27399 @smallexample
27400 spec of Math
27401 spec of Stuff
27402 body of Math
27403 body of Main
27404 @end smallexample
27405
27406 @noindent
27407 but that's not good, because now the call to @code{Math.Sqrt}
27408 that happens during
27409 the elaboration of the @code{Stuff}
27410 spec happens before the body of @code{Math.Sqrt} is
27411 elaborated, and hence causes @code{Program_Error} exception to be raised.
27412 At first glance, one might say that the binder is misbehaving, because
27413 obviously you want to elaborate the body of something you @code{with}
27414 first, but
27415 that is not a general rule that can be followed in all cases. Consider
27416
27417 @smallexample @c ada
27418 @group
27419 @cartouche
27420 package X is @dots{}
27421
27422 package Y is @dots{}
27423
27424 with X;
27425 package body Y is @dots{}
27426
27427 with Y;
27428 package body X is @dots{}
27429 @end cartouche
27430 @end group
27431 @end smallexample
27432
27433 @noindent
27434 This is a common arrangement, and, apart from the order of elaboration
27435 problems that might arise in connection with elaboration code, this works fine.
27436 A rule that says that you must first elaborate the body of anything you
27437 @code{with} cannot work in this case:
27438 the body of @code{X} @code{with}'s @code{Y},
27439 which means you would have to
27440 elaborate the body of @code{Y} first, but that @code{with}'s @code{X},
27441 which means
27442 you have to elaborate the body of @code{X} first, but @dots{} and we have a
27443 loop that cannot be broken.
27444
27445 It is true that the binder can in many cases guess an order of elaboration
27446 that is unlikely to cause a @code{Program_Error}
27447 exception to be raised, and it tries to do so (in the
27448 above example of @code{Math/Stuff/Spec}, the GNAT binder will
27449 by default
27450 elaborate the body of @code{Math} right after its spec, so all will be well).
27451
27452 However, a program that blindly relies on the binder to be helpful can
27453 get into trouble, as we discussed in the previous sections, so
27454 GNAT
27455 provides a number of facilities for assisting the programmer in
27456 developing programs that are robust with respect to elaboration order.
27457
27458 @node Default Behavior in GNAT - Ensuring Safety
27459 @section Default Behavior in GNAT - Ensuring Safety
27460
27461 @noindent
27462 The default behavior in GNAT ensures elaboration safety. In its
27463 default mode GNAT implements the
27464 rule we previously described as the right approach. Let's restate it:
27465
27466 @itemize
27467 @item
27468 @emph{If a unit has elaboration code that can directly or indirectly make a
27469 call to a subprogram in a @code{with}'ed unit, or instantiate a generic
27470 package in a @code{with}'ed unit, then if the @code{with}'ed unit
27471 does not have pragma @code{Pure} or
27472 @code{Preelaborate}, then the client should have an
27473 @code{Elaborate_All} pragma for the @code{with}'ed unit.}
27474
27475 @emph{In the case of instantiating a generic subprogram, it is always
27476 sufficient to have only an @code{Elaborate} pragma for the
27477 @code{with}'ed unit.}
27478 @end itemize
27479
27480 @noindent
27481 By following this rule a client is assured that calls and instantiations
27482 can be made without risk of an exception.
27483
27484 In this mode GNAT traces all calls that are potentially made from
27485 elaboration code, and puts in any missing implicit @code{Elaborate}
27486 and @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas.
27487 The advantage of this approach is that no elaboration problems
27488 are possible if the binder can find an elaboration order that is
27489 consistent with these implicit @code{Elaborate} and
27490 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas. The
27491 disadvantage of this approach is that no such order may exist.
27492
27493 If the binder does not generate any diagnostics, then it means that it has
27494 found an elaboration order that is guaranteed to be safe. However, the binder
27495 may still be relying on implicitly generated @code{Elaborate} and
27496 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas so portability to other compilers than GNAT is not
27497 guaranteed.
27498
27499 If it is important to guarantee portability, then the compilations should
27500 use the
27501 @option{-gnatwl}
27502 (warn on elaboration problems) switch. This will cause warning messages
27503 to be generated indicating the missing @code{Elaborate} and
27504 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas.
27505 Consider the following source program:
27506
27507 @smallexample @c ada
27508 @group
27509 @cartouche
27510 with k;
27511 package j is
27512 m : integer := k.r;
27513 end;
27514 @end cartouche
27515 @end group
27516 @end smallexample
27517
27518 @noindent
27519 where it is clear that there
27520 should be a pragma @code{Elaborate_All}
27521 for unit @code{k}. An implicit pragma will be generated, and it is
27522 likely that the binder will be able to honor it. However, if you want
27523 to port this program to some other Ada compiler than GNAT.
27524 it is safer to include the pragma explicitly in the source. If this
27525 unit is compiled with the
27526 @option{-gnatwl}
27527 switch, then the compiler outputs a warning:
27528
27529 @smallexample
27530 @group
27531 @cartouche
27532 1. with k;
27533 2. package j is
27534 3. m : integer := k.r;
27535 |
27536 >>> warning: call to "r" may raise Program_Error
27537 >>> warning: missing pragma Elaborate_All for "k"
27538
27539 4. end;
27540 @end cartouche
27541 @end group
27542 @end smallexample
27543
27544 @noindent
27545 and these warnings can be used as a guide for supplying manually
27546 the missing pragmas. It is usually a bad idea to use this warning
27547 option during development. That's because it will warn you when
27548 you need to put in a pragma, but cannot warn you when it is time
27549 to take it out. So the use of pragma @code{Elaborate_All} may lead to
27550 unnecessary dependencies and even false circularities.
27551
27552 This default mode is more restrictive than the Ada Reference
27553 Manual, and it is possible to construct programs which will compile
27554 using the dynamic model described there, but will run into a
27555 circularity using the safer static model we have described.
27556
27557 Of course any Ada compiler must be able to operate in a mode
27558 consistent with the requirements of the Ada Reference Manual,
27559 and in particular must have the capability of implementing the
27560 standard dynamic model of elaboration with run-time checks.
27561
27562 In GNAT, this standard mode can be achieved either by the use of
27563 the @option{-gnatE} switch on the compiler (@command{gcc} or
27564 @command{gnatmake}) command, or by the use of the configuration pragma:
27565
27566 @smallexample @c ada
27567 pragma Elaboration_Checks (RM);
27568 @end smallexample
27569
27570 @noindent
27571 Either approach will cause the unit affected to be compiled using the
27572 standard dynamic run-time elaboration checks described in the Ada
27573 Reference Manual. The static model is generally preferable, since it
27574 is clearly safer to rely on compile and link time checks rather than
27575 run-time checks. However, in the case of legacy code, it may be
27576 difficult to meet the requirements of the static model. This
27577 issue is further discussed in
27578 @ref{What to Do If the Default Elaboration Behavior Fails}.
27579
27580 Note that the static model provides a strict subset of the allowed
27581 behavior and programs of the Ada Reference Manual, so if you do
27582 adhere to the static model and no circularities exist,
27583 then you are assured that your program will
27584 work using the dynamic model, providing that you remove any
27585 pragma Elaborate statements from the source.
27586
27587 @node Treatment of Pragma Elaborate
27588 @section Treatment of Pragma Elaborate
27589 @cindex Pragma Elaborate
27590
27591 @noindent
27592 The use of @code{pragma Elaborate}
27593 should generally be avoided in Ada 95 and Ada 2005 programs,
27594 since there is no guarantee that transitive calls
27595 will be properly handled. Indeed at one point, this pragma was placed
27596 in Annex J (Obsolescent Features), on the grounds that it is never useful.
27597
27598 Now that's a bit restrictive. In practice, the case in which
27599 @code{pragma Elaborate} is useful is when the caller knows that there
27600 are no transitive calls, or that the called unit contains all necessary
27601 transitive @code{pragma Elaborate} statements, and legacy code often
27602 contains such uses.
27603
27604 Strictly speaking the static mode in GNAT should ignore such pragmas,
27605 since there is no assurance at compile time that the necessary safety
27606 conditions are met. In practice, this would cause GNAT to be incompatible
27607 with correctly written Ada 83 code that had all necessary
27608 @code{pragma Elaborate} statements in place. Consequently, we made the
27609 decision that GNAT in its default mode will believe that if it encounters
27610 a @code{pragma Elaborate} then the programmer knows what they are doing,
27611 and it will trust that no elaboration errors can occur.
27612
27613 The result of this decision is two-fold. First to be safe using the
27614 static mode, you should remove all @code{pragma Elaborate} statements.
27615 Second, when fixing circularities in existing code, you can selectively
27616 use @code{pragma Elaborate} statements to convince the static mode of
27617 GNAT that it need not generate an implicit @code{pragma Elaborate_All}
27618 statement.
27619
27620 When using the static mode with @option{-gnatwl}, any use of
27621 @code{pragma Elaborate} will generate a warning about possible
27622 problems.
27623
27624 @node Elaboration Issues for Library Tasks
27625 @section Elaboration Issues for Library Tasks
27626 @cindex Library tasks, elaboration issues
27627 @cindex Elaboration of library tasks
27628
27629 @noindent
27630 In this section we examine special elaboration issues that arise for
27631 programs that declare library level tasks.
27632
27633 Generally the model of execution of an Ada program is that all units are
27634 elaborated, and then execution of the program starts. However, the
27635 declaration of library tasks definitely does not fit this model. The
27636 reason for this is that library tasks start as soon as they are declared
27637 (more precisely, as soon as the statement part of the enclosing package
27638 body is reached), that is to say before elaboration
27639 of the program is complete. This means that if such a task calls a
27640 subprogram, or an entry in another task, the callee may or may not be
27641 elaborated yet, and in the standard
27642 Reference Manual model of dynamic elaboration checks, you can even
27643 get timing dependent Program_Error exceptions, since there can be
27644 a race between the elaboration code and the task code.
27645
27646 The static model of elaboration in GNAT seeks to avoid all such
27647 dynamic behavior, by being conservative, and the conservative
27648 approach in this particular case is to assume that all the code
27649 in a task body is potentially executed at elaboration time if
27650 a task is declared at the library level.
27651
27652 This can definitely result in unexpected circularities. Consider
27653 the following example
27654
27655 @smallexample @c ada
27656 package Decls is
27657 task Lib_Task is
27658 entry Start;
27659 end Lib_Task;
27660
27661 type My_Int is new Integer;
27662
27663 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int;
27664 end Decls;
27665
27666 with Utils;
27667 package body Decls is
27668 task body Lib_Task is
27669 begin
27670 accept Start;
27671 Utils.Put_Val (2);
27672 end Lib_Task;
27673
27674 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int is
27675 begin
27676 return M;
27677 end Ident;
27678 end Decls;
27679
27680 with Decls;
27681 package Utils is
27682 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls.My_Int);
27683 end Utils;
27684
27685 with Text_IO;
27686 package body Utils is
27687 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls.My_Int) is
27688 begin
27689 Text_IO.Put_Line (Decls.My_Int'Image (Decls.Ident (Arg)));
27690 end Put_Val;
27691 end Utils;
27692
27693 with Decls;
27694 procedure Main is
27695 begin
27696 Decls.Lib_Task.Start;
27697 end;
27698 @end smallexample
27699
27700 @noindent
27701 If the above example is compiled in the default static elaboration
27702 mode, then a circularity occurs. The circularity comes from the call
27703 @code{Utils.Put_Val} in the task body of @code{Decls.Lib_Task}. Since
27704 this call occurs in elaboration code, we need an implicit pragma
27705 @code{Elaborate_All} for @code{Utils}. This means that not only must
27706 the spec and body of @code{Utils} be elaborated before the body
27707 of @code{Decls}, but also the spec and body of any unit that is
27708 @code{with'ed} by the body of @code{Utils} must also be elaborated before
27709 the body of @code{Decls}. This is the transitive implication of
27710 pragma @code{Elaborate_All} and it makes sense, because in general
27711 the body of @code{Put_Val} might have a call to something in a
27712 @code{with'ed} unit.
27713
27714 In this case, the body of Utils (actually its spec) @code{with's}
27715 @code{Decls}. Unfortunately this means that the body of @code{Decls}
27716 must be elaborated before itself, in case there is a call from the
27717 body of @code{Utils}.
27718
27719 Here is the exact chain of events we are worrying about:
27720
27721 @enumerate
27722 @item
27723 In the body of @code{Decls} a call is made from within the body of a library
27724 task to a subprogram in the package @code{Utils}. Since this call may
27725 occur at elaboration time (given that the task is activated at elaboration
27726 time), we have to assume the worst, i.e., that the
27727 call does happen at elaboration time.
27728
27729 @item
27730 This means that the body and spec of @code{Util} must be elaborated before
27731 the body of @code{Decls} so that this call does not cause an access before
27732 elaboration.
27733
27734 @item
27735 Within the body of @code{Util}, specifically within the body of
27736 @code{Util.Put_Val} there may be calls to any unit @code{with}'ed
27737 by this package.
27738
27739 @item
27740 One such @code{with}'ed package is package @code{Decls}, so there
27741 might be a call to a subprogram in @code{Decls} in @code{Put_Val}.
27742 In fact there is such a call in this example, but we would have to
27743 assume that there was such a call even if it were not there, since
27744 we are not supposed to write the body of @code{Decls} knowing what
27745 is in the body of @code{Utils}; certainly in the case of the
27746 static elaboration model, the compiler does not know what is in
27747 other bodies and must assume the worst.
27748
27749 @item
27750 This means that the spec and body of @code{Decls} must also be
27751 elaborated before we elaborate the unit containing the call, but
27752 that unit is @code{Decls}! This means that the body of @code{Decls}
27753 must be elaborated before itself, and that's a circularity.
27754 @end enumerate
27755
27756 @noindent
27757 Indeed, if you add an explicit pragma @code{Elaborate_All} for @code{Utils} in
27758 the body of @code{Decls} you will get a true Ada Reference Manual
27759 circularity that makes the program illegal.
27760
27761 In practice, we have found that problems with the static model of
27762 elaboration in existing code often arise from library tasks, so
27763 we must address this particular situation.
27764
27765 Note that if we compile and run the program above, using the dynamic model of
27766 elaboration (that is to say use the @option{-gnatE} switch),
27767 then it compiles, binds,
27768 links, and runs, printing the expected result of 2. Therefore in some sense
27769 the circularity here is only apparent, and we need to capture
27770 the properties of this program that distinguish it from other library-level
27771 tasks that have real elaboration problems.
27772
27773 We have four possible answers to this question:
27774
27775 @itemize @bullet
27776
27777 @item
27778 Use the dynamic model of elaboration.
27779
27780 If we use the @option{-gnatE} switch, then as noted above, the program works.
27781 Why is this? If we examine the task body, it is apparent that the task cannot
27782 proceed past the
27783 @code{accept} statement until after elaboration has been completed, because
27784 the corresponding entry call comes from the main program, not earlier.
27785 This is why the dynamic model works here. But that's really giving
27786 up on a precise analysis, and we prefer to take this approach only if we cannot
27787 solve the
27788 problem in any other manner. So let us examine two ways to reorganize
27789 the program to avoid the potential elaboration problem.
27790
27791 @item
27792 Split library tasks into separate packages.
27793
27794 Write separate packages, so that library tasks are isolated from
27795 other declarations as much as possible. Let us look at a variation on
27796 the above program.
27797
27798 @smallexample @c ada
27799 package Decls1 is
27800 task Lib_Task is
27801 entry Start;
27802 end Lib_Task;
27803 end Decls1;
27804
27805 with Utils;
27806 package body Decls1 is
27807 task body Lib_Task is
27808 begin
27809 accept Start;
27810 Utils.Put_Val (2);
27811 end Lib_Task;
27812 end Decls1;
27813
27814 package Decls2 is
27815 type My_Int is new Integer;
27816 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int;
27817 end Decls2;
27818
27819 with Utils;
27820 package body Decls2 is
27821 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int is
27822 begin
27823 return M;
27824 end Ident;
27825 end Decls2;
27826
27827 with Decls2;
27828 package Utils is
27829 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls2.My_Int);
27830 end Utils;
27831
27832 with Text_IO;
27833 package body Utils is
27834 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls2.My_Int) is
27835 begin
27836 Text_IO.Put_Line (Decls2.My_Int'Image (Decls2.Ident (Arg)));
27837 end Put_Val;
27838 end Utils;
27839
27840 with Decls1;
27841 procedure Main is
27842 begin
27843 Decls1.Lib_Task.Start;
27844 end;
27845 @end smallexample
27846
27847 @noindent
27848 All we have done is to split @code{Decls} into two packages, one
27849 containing the library task, and one containing everything else. Now
27850 there is no cycle, and the program compiles, binds, links and executes
27851 using the default static model of elaboration.
27852
27853 @item
27854 Declare separate task types.
27855
27856 A significant part of the problem arises because of the use of the
27857 single task declaration form. This means that the elaboration of
27858 the task type, and the elaboration of the task itself (i.e.@: the
27859 creation of the task) happen at the same time. A good rule
27860 of style in Ada is to always create explicit task types. By
27861 following the additional step of placing task objects in separate
27862 packages from the task type declaration, many elaboration problems
27863 are avoided. Here is another modified example of the example program:
27864
27865 @smallexample @c ada
27866 package Decls is
27867 task type Lib_Task_Type is
27868 entry Start;
27869 end Lib_Task_Type;
27870
27871 type My_Int is new Integer;
27872
27873 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int;
27874 end Decls;
27875
27876 with Utils;
27877 package body Decls is
27878 task body Lib_Task_Type is
27879 begin
27880 accept Start;
27881 Utils.Put_Val (2);
27882 end Lib_Task_Type;
27883
27884 function Ident (M : My_Int) return My_Int is
27885 begin
27886 return M;
27887 end Ident;
27888 end Decls;
27889
27890 with Decls;
27891 package Utils is
27892 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls.My_Int);
27893 end Utils;
27894
27895 with Text_IO;
27896 package body Utils is
27897 procedure Put_Val (Arg : Decls.My_Int) is
27898 begin
27899 Text_IO.Put_Line (Decls.My_Int'Image (Decls.Ident (Arg)));
27900 end Put_Val;
27901 end Utils;
27902
27903 with Decls;
27904 package Declst is
27905 Lib_Task : Decls.Lib_Task_Type;
27906 end Declst;
27907
27908 with Declst;
27909 procedure Main is
27910 begin
27911 Declst.Lib_Task.Start;
27912 end;
27913 @end smallexample
27914
27915 @noindent
27916 What we have done here is to replace the @code{task} declaration in
27917 package @code{Decls} with a @code{task type} declaration. Then we
27918 introduce a separate package @code{Declst} to contain the actual
27919 task object. This separates the elaboration issues for
27920 the @code{task type}
27921 declaration, which causes no trouble, from the elaboration issues
27922 of the task object, which is also unproblematic, since it is now independent
27923 of the elaboration of @code{Utils}.
27924 This separation of concerns also corresponds to
27925 a generally sound engineering principle of separating declarations
27926 from instances. This version of the program also compiles, binds, links,
27927 and executes, generating the expected output.
27928
27929 @item
27930 Use No_Entry_Calls_In_Elaboration_Code restriction.
27931 @cindex No_Entry_Calls_In_Elaboration_Code
27932
27933 The previous two approaches described how a program can be restructured
27934 to avoid the special problems caused by library task bodies. in practice,
27935 however, such restructuring may be difficult to apply to existing legacy code,
27936 so we must consider solutions that do not require massive rewriting.
27937
27938 Let us consider more carefully why our original sample program works
27939 under the dynamic model of elaboration. The reason is that the code
27940 in the task body blocks immediately on the @code{accept}
27941 statement. Now of course there is nothing to prohibit elaboration
27942 code from making entry calls (for example from another library level task),
27943 so we cannot tell in isolation that
27944 the task will not execute the accept statement during elaboration.
27945
27946 However, in practice it is very unusual to see elaboration code
27947 make any entry calls, and the pattern of tasks starting
27948 at elaboration time and then immediately blocking on @code{accept} or
27949 @code{select} statements is very common. What this means is that
27950 the compiler is being too pessimistic when it analyzes the
27951 whole package body as though it might be executed at elaboration
27952 time.
27953
27954 If we know that the elaboration code contains no entry calls, (a very safe
27955 assumption most of the time, that could almost be made the default
27956 behavior), then we can compile all units of the program under control
27957 of the following configuration pragma:
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 pragma Restrictions (No_Entry_Calls_In_Elaboration_Code);
27961 @end smallexample
27962
27963 @noindent
27964 This pragma can be placed in the @file{gnat.adc} file in the usual
27965 manner. If we take our original unmodified program and compile it
27966 in the presence of a @file{gnat.adc} containing the above pragma,
27967 then once again, we can compile, bind, link, and execute, obtaining
27968 the expected result. In the presence of this pragma, the compiler does
27969 not trace calls in a task body, that appear after the first @code{accept}
27970 or @code{select} statement, and therefore does not report a potential
27971 circularity in the original program.
27972
27973 The compiler will check to the extent it can that the above
27974 restriction is not violated, but it is not always possible to do a
27975 complete check at compile time, so it is important to use this
27976 pragma only if the stated restriction is in fact met, that is to say
27977 no task receives an entry call before elaboration of all units is completed.
27978
27979 @end itemize
27980
27981 @node Mixing Elaboration Models
27982 @section Mixing Elaboration Models
27983 @noindent
27984 So far, we have assumed that the entire program is either compiled
27985 using the dynamic model or static model, ensuring consistency. It
27986 is possible to mix the two models, but rules have to be followed
27987 if this mixing is done to ensure that elaboration checks are not
27988 omitted.
27989
27990 The basic rule is that @emph{a unit compiled with the static model cannot
27991 be @code{with'ed} by a unit compiled with the dynamic model}. The
27992 reason for this is that in the static model, a unit assumes that
27993 its clients guarantee to use (the equivalent of) pragma
27994 @code{Elaborate_All} so that no elaboration checks are required
27995 in inner subprograms, and this assumption is violated if the
27996 client is compiled with dynamic checks.
27997
27998 The precise rule is as follows. A unit that is compiled with dynamic
27999 checks can only @code{with} a unit that meets at least one of the
28000 following criteria:
28001
28002 @itemize @bullet
28003
28004 @item
28005 The @code{with'ed} unit is itself compiled with dynamic elaboration
28006 checks (that is with the @option{-gnatE} switch.
28007
28008 @item
28009 The @code{with'ed} unit is an internal GNAT implementation unit from
28010 the System, Interfaces, Ada, or GNAT hierarchies.
28011
28012 @item
28013 The @code{with'ed} unit has pragma Preelaborate or pragma Pure.
28014
28015 @item
28016 The @code{with'ing} unit (that is the client) has an explicit pragma
28017 @code{Elaborate_All} for the @code{with'ed} unit.
28018
28019 @end itemize
28020
28021 @noindent
28022 If this rule is violated, that is if a unit with dynamic elaboration
28023 checks @code{with's} a unit that does not meet one of the above four
28024 criteria, then the binder (@code{gnatbind}) will issue a warning
28025 similar to that in the following example:
28026
28027 @smallexample
28028 warning: "x.ads" has dynamic elaboration checks and with's
28029 warning: "y.ads" which has static elaboration checks
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032 @noindent
28033 These warnings indicate that the rule has been violated, and that as a result
28034 elaboration checks may be missed in the resulting executable file.
28035 This warning may be suppressed using the @option{-ws} binder switch
28036 in the usual manner.
28037
28038 One useful application of this mixing rule is in the case of a subsystem
28039 which does not itself @code{with} units from the remainder of the
28040 application. In this case, the entire subsystem can be compiled with
28041 dynamic checks to resolve a circularity in the subsystem, while
28042 allowing the main application that uses this subsystem to be compiled
28043 using the more reliable default static model.
28044
28045 @node What to Do If the Default Elaboration Behavior Fails
28046 @section What to Do If the Default Elaboration Behavior Fails
28047
28048 @noindent
28049 If the binder cannot find an acceptable order, it outputs detailed
28050 diagnostics. For example:
28051 @smallexample
28052 @group
28053 @iftex
28054 @leftskip=0cm
28055 @end iftex
28056 error: elaboration circularity detected
28057 info: "proc (body)" must be elaborated before "pack (body)"
28058 info: reason: Elaborate_All probably needed in unit "pack (body)"
28059 info: recompile "pack (body)" with -gnatwl
28060 info: for full details
28061 info: "proc (body)"
28062 info: is needed by its spec:
28063 info: "proc (spec)"
28064 info: which is withed by:
28065 info: "pack (body)"
28066 info: "pack (body)" must be elaborated before "proc (body)"
28067 info: reason: pragma Elaborate in unit "proc (body)"
28068 @end group
28069
28070 @end smallexample
28071
28072 @noindent
28073 In this case we have a cycle that the binder cannot break. On the one
28074 hand, there is an explicit pragma Elaborate in @code{proc} for
28075 @code{pack}. This means that the body of @code{pack} must be elaborated
28076 before the body of @code{proc}. On the other hand, there is elaboration
28077 code in @code{pack} that calls a subprogram in @code{proc}. This means
28078 that for maximum safety, there should really be a pragma
28079 Elaborate_All in @code{pack} for @code{proc} which would require that
28080 the body of @code{proc} be elaborated before the body of
28081 @code{pack}. Clearly both requirements cannot be satisfied.
28082 Faced with a circularity of this kind, you have three different options.
28083
28084 @table @asis
28085 @item Fix the program
28086 The most desirable option from the point of view of long-term maintenance
28087 is to rearrange the program so that the elaboration problems are avoided.
28088 One useful technique is to place the elaboration code into separate
28089 child packages. Another is to move some of the initialization code to
28090 explicitly called subprograms, where the program controls the order
28091 of initialization explicitly. Although this is the most desirable option,
28092 it may be impractical and involve too much modification, especially in
28093 the case of complex legacy code.
28094
28095 @item Perform dynamic checks
28096 If the compilations are done using the
28097 @option{-gnatE}
28098 (dynamic elaboration check) switch, then GNAT behaves in a quite different
28099 manner. Dynamic checks are generated for all calls that could possibly result
28100 in raising an exception. With this switch, the compiler does not generate
28101 implicit @code{Elaborate} or @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas. The behavior then is
28102 exactly as specified in the @cite{Ada Reference Manual}.
28103 The binder will generate
28104 an executable program that may or may not raise @code{Program_Error}, and then
28105 it is the programmer's job to ensure that it does not raise an exception. Note
28106 that it is important to compile all units with the switch, it cannot be used
28107 selectively.
28108
28109 @item Suppress checks
28110 The drawback of dynamic checks is that they generate a
28111 significant overhead at run time, both in space and time. If you
28112 are absolutely sure that your program cannot raise any elaboration
28113 exceptions, and you still want to use the dynamic elaboration model,
28114 then you can use the configuration pragma
28115 @code{Suppress (Elaboration_Check)} to suppress all such checks. For
28116 example this pragma could be placed in the @file{gnat.adc} file.
28117
28118 @item Suppress checks selectively
28119 When you know that certain calls or instantiations in elaboration code cannot
28120 possibly lead to an elaboration error, and the binder nevertheless complains
28121 about implicit @code{Elaborate} and @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas that lead to
28122 elaboration circularities, it is possible to remove those warnings locally and
28123 obtain a program that will bind. Clearly this can be unsafe, and it is the
28124 responsibility of the programmer to make sure that the resulting program has no
28125 elaboration anomalies. The pragma @code{Suppress (Elaboration_Check)} can be
28126 used with different granularity to suppress warnings and break elaboration
28127 circularities:
28128
28129 @itemize @bullet
28130 @item
28131 Place the pragma that names the called subprogram in the declarative part
28132 that contains the call.
28133
28134 @item
28135 Place the pragma in the declarative part, without naming an entity. This
28136 disables warnings on all calls in the corresponding declarative region.
28137
28138 @item
28139 Place the pragma in the package spec that declares the called subprogram,
28140 and name the subprogram. This disables warnings on all elaboration calls to
28141 that subprogram.
28142
28143 @item
28144 Place the pragma in the package spec that declares the called subprogram,
28145 without naming any entity. This disables warnings on all elaboration calls to
28146 all subprograms declared in this spec.
28147
28148 @item Use Pragma Elaborate
28149 As previously described in section @xref{Treatment of Pragma Elaborate},
28150 GNAT in static mode assumes that a @code{pragma} Elaborate indicates correctly
28151 that no elaboration checks are required on calls to the designated unit.
28152 There may be cases in which the caller knows that no transitive calls
28153 can occur, so that a @code{pragma Elaborate} will be sufficient in a
28154 case where @code{pragma Elaborate_All} would cause a circularity.
28155 @end itemize
28156
28157 @noindent
28158 These five cases are listed in order of decreasing safety, and therefore
28159 require increasing programmer care in their application. Consider the
28160 following program:
28161
28162 @smallexample @c adanocomment
28163 package Pack1 is
28164 function F1 return Integer;
28165 X1 : Integer;
28166 end Pack1;
28167
28168 package Pack2 is
28169 function F2 return Integer;
28170 function Pure (x : integer) return integer;
28171 -- pragma Suppress (Elaboration_Check, On => Pure); -- (3)
28172 -- pragma Suppress (Elaboration_Check); -- (4)
28173 end Pack2;
28174
28175 with Pack2;
28176 package body Pack1 is
28177 function F1 return Integer is
28178 begin
28179 return 100;
28180 end F1;
28181 Val : integer := Pack2.Pure (11); -- Elab. call (1)
28182 begin
28183 declare
28184 -- pragma Suppress(Elaboration_Check, Pack2.F2); -- (1)
28185 -- pragma Suppress(Elaboration_Check); -- (2)
28186 begin
28187 X1 := Pack2.F2 + 1; -- Elab. call (2)
28188 end;
28189 end Pack1;
28190
28191 with Pack1;
28192 package body Pack2 is
28193 function F2 return Integer is
28194 begin
28195 return Pack1.F1;
28196 end F2;
28197 function Pure (x : integer) return integer is
28198 begin
28199 return x ** 3 - 3 * x;
28200 end;
28201 end Pack2;
28202
28203 with Pack1, Ada.Text_IO;
28204 procedure Proc3 is
28205 begin
28206 Ada.Text_IO.Put_Line(Pack1.X1'Img); -- 101
28207 end Proc3;
28208 @end smallexample
28209 In the absence of any pragmas, an attempt to bind this program produces
28210 the following diagnostics:
28211 @smallexample
28212 @group
28213 @iftex
28214 @leftskip=.5cm
28215 @end iftex
28216 error: elaboration circularity detected
28217 info: "pack1 (body)" must be elaborated before "pack1 (body)"
28218 info: reason: Elaborate_All probably needed in unit "pack1 (body)"
28219 info: recompile "pack1 (body)" with -gnatwl for full details
28220 info: "pack1 (body)"
28221 info: must be elaborated along with its spec:
28222 info: "pack1 (spec)"
28223 info: which is withed by:
28224 info: "pack2 (body)"
28225 info: which must be elaborated along with its spec:
28226 info: "pack2 (spec)"
28227 info: which is withed by:
28228 info: "pack1 (body)"
28229 @end group
28230 @end smallexample
28231 The sources of the circularity are the two calls to @code{Pack2.Pure} and
28232 @code{Pack2.F2} in the body of @code{Pack1}. We can see that the call to
28233 F2 is safe, even though F2 calls F1, because the call appears after the
28234 elaboration of the body of F1. Therefore the pragma (1) is safe, and will
28235 remove the warning on the call. It is also possible to use pragma (2)
28236 because there are no other potentially unsafe calls in the block.
28237
28238 @noindent
28239 The call to @code{Pure} is safe because this function does not depend on the
28240 state of @code{Pack2}. Therefore any call to this function is safe, and it
28241 is correct to place pragma (3) in the corresponding package spec.
28242
28243 @noindent
28244 Finally, we could place pragma (4) in the spec of @code{Pack2} to disable
28245 warnings on all calls to functions declared therein. Note that this is not
28246 necessarily safe, and requires more detailed examination of the subprogram
28247 bodies involved. In particular, a call to @code{F2} requires that @code{F1}
28248 be already elaborated.
28249 @end table
28250
28251 @noindent
28252 It is hard to generalize on which of these four approaches should be
28253 taken. Obviously if it is possible to fix the program so that the default
28254 treatment works, this is preferable, but this may not always be practical.
28255 It is certainly simple enough to use
28256 @option{-gnatE}
28257 but the danger in this case is that, even if the GNAT binder
28258 finds a correct elaboration order, it may not always do so,
28259 and certainly a binder from another Ada compiler might not. A
28260 combination of testing and analysis (for which the warnings generated
28261 with the
28262 @option{-gnatwl}
28263 switch can be useful) must be used to ensure that the program is free
28264 of errors. One switch that is useful in this testing is the
28265 @option{^-p (pessimistic elaboration order)^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION_ORDER^}
28266 switch for
28267 @code{gnatbind}.
28268 Normally the binder tries to find an order that has the best chance
28269 of avoiding elaboration problems. However, if this switch is used, the binder
28270 plays a devil's advocate role, and tries to choose the order that
28271 has the best chance of failing. If your program works even with this
28272 switch, then it has a better chance of being error free, but this is still
28273 not a guarantee.
28274
28275 For an example of this approach in action, consider the C-tests (executable
28276 tests) from the ACVC suite. If these are compiled and run with the default
28277 treatment, then all but one of them succeed without generating any error
28278 diagnostics from the binder. However, there is one test that fails, and
28279 this is not surprising, because the whole point of this test is to ensure
28280 that the compiler can handle cases where it is impossible to determine
28281 a correct order statically, and it checks that an exception is indeed
28282 raised at run time.
28283
28284 This one test must be compiled and run using the
28285 @option{-gnatE}
28286 switch, and then it passes. Alternatively, the entire suite can
28287 be run using this switch. It is never wrong to run with the dynamic
28288 elaboration switch if your code is correct, and we assume that the
28289 C-tests are indeed correct (it is less efficient, but efficiency is
28290 not a factor in running the ACVC tests.)
28291
28292 @node Elaboration for Access-to-Subprogram Values
28293 @section Elaboration for Access-to-Subprogram Values
28294 @cindex Access-to-subprogram
28295
28296 @noindent
28297 Access-to-subprogram types (introduced in Ada 95) complicate
28298 the handling of elaboration. The trouble is that it becomes
28299 impossible to tell at compile time which procedure
28300 is being called. This means that it is not possible for the binder
28301 to analyze the elaboration requirements in this case.
28302
28303 If at the point at which the access value is created
28304 (i.e., the evaluation of @code{P'Access} for a subprogram @code{P}),
28305 the body of the subprogram is
28306 known to have been elaborated, then the access value is safe, and its use
28307 does not require a check. This may be achieved by appropriate arrangement
28308 of the order of declarations if the subprogram is in the current unit,
28309 or, if the subprogram is in another unit, by using pragma
28310 @code{Pure}, @code{Preelaborate}, or @code{Elaborate_Body}
28311 on the referenced unit.
28312
28313 If the referenced body is not known to have been elaborated at the point
28314 the access value is created, then any use of the access value must do a
28315 dynamic check, and this dynamic check will fail and raise a
28316 @code{Program_Error} exception if the body has not been elaborated yet.
28317 GNAT will generate the necessary checks, and in addition, if the
28318 @option{-gnatwl}
28319 switch is set, will generate warnings that such checks are required.
28320
28321 The use of dynamic dispatching for tagged types similarly generates
28322 a requirement for dynamic checks, and premature calls to any primitive
28323 operation of a tagged type before the body of the operation has been
28324 elaborated, will result in the raising of @code{Program_Error}.
28325
28326 @node Summary of Procedures for Elaboration Control
28327 @section Summary of Procedures for Elaboration Control
28328 @cindex Elaboration control
28329
28330 @noindent
28331 First, compile your program with the default options, using none of
28332 the special elaboration control switches. If the binder successfully
28333 binds your program, then you can be confident that, apart from issues
28334 raised by the use of access-to-subprogram types and dynamic dispatching,
28335 the program is free of elaboration errors. If it is important that the
28336 program be portable, then use the
28337 @option{-gnatwl}
28338 switch to generate warnings about missing @code{Elaborate} or
28339 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas, and supply the missing pragmas.
28340
28341 If the program fails to bind using the default static elaboration
28342 handling, then you can fix the program to eliminate the binder
28343 message, or recompile the entire program with the
28344 @option{-gnatE} switch to generate dynamic elaboration checks,
28345 and, if you are sure there really are no elaboration problems,
28346 use a global pragma @code{Suppress (Elaboration_Check)}.
28347
28348 @node Other Elaboration Order Considerations
28349 @section Other Elaboration Order Considerations
28350 @noindent
28351 This section has been entirely concerned with the issue of finding a valid
28352 elaboration order, as defined by the Ada Reference Manual. In a case
28353 where several elaboration orders are valid, the task is to find one
28354 of the possible valid elaboration orders (and the static model in GNAT
28355 will ensure that this is achieved).
28356
28357 The purpose of the elaboration rules in the Ada Reference Manual is to
28358 make sure that no entity is accessed before it has been elaborated. For
28359 a subprogram, this means that the spec and body must have been elaborated
28360 before the subprogram is called. For an object, this means that the object
28361 must have been elaborated before its value is read or written. A violation
28362 of either of these two requirements is an access before elaboration order,
28363 and this section has been all about avoiding such errors.
28364
28365 In the case where more than one order of elaboration is possible, in the
28366 sense that access before elaboration errors are avoided, then any one of
28367 the orders is ``correct'' in the sense that it meets the requirements of
28368 the Ada Reference Manual, and no such error occurs.
28369
28370 However, it may be the case for a given program, that there are
28371 constraints on the order of elaboration that come not from consideration
28372 of avoiding elaboration errors, but rather from extra-lingual logic
28373 requirements. Consider this example:
28374
28375 @smallexample @c ada
28376 with Init_Constants;
28377 package Constants is
28378 X : Integer := 0;
28379 Y : Integer := 0;
28380 end Constants;
28381
28382 package Init_Constants is
28383 procedure P; -- require a body
28384 end Init_Constants;
28385
28386 with Constants;
28387 package body Init_Constants is
28388 procedure P is begin null; end;
28389 begin
28390 Constants.X := 3;
28391 Constants.Y := 4;
28392 end Init_Constants;
28393
28394 with Constants;
28395 package Calc is
28396 Z : Integer := Constants.X + Constants.Y;
28397 end Calc;
28398
28399 with Calc;
28400 with Text_IO; use Text_IO;
28401 procedure Main is
28402 begin
28403 Put_Line (Calc.Z'Img);
28404 end Main;
28405 @end smallexample
28406
28407 @noindent
28408 In this example, there is more than one valid order of elaboration. For
28409 example both the following are correct orders:
28410
28411 @smallexample
28412 Init_Constants spec
28413 Constants spec
28414 Calc spec
28415 Init_Constants body
28416 Main body
28417
28418 and
28419
28420 Init_Constants spec
28421 Init_Constants body
28422 Constants spec
28423 Calc spec
28424 Main body
28425 @end smallexample
28426
28427 @noindent
28428 There is no language rule to prefer one or the other, both are correct
28429 from an order of elaboration point of view. But the programmatic effects
28430 of the two orders are very different. In the first, the elaboration routine
28431 of @code{Calc} initializes @code{Z} to zero, and then the main program
28432 runs with this value of zero. But in the second order, the elaboration
28433 routine of @code{Calc} runs after the body of Init_Constants has set
28434 @code{X} and @code{Y} and thus @code{Z} is set to 7 before @code{Main}
28435 runs.
28436
28437 One could perhaps by applying pretty clever non-artificial intelligence
28438 to the situation guess that it is more likely that the second order of
28439 elaboration is the one desired, but there is no formal linguistic reason
28440 to prefer one over the other. In fact in this particular case, GNAT will
28441 prefer the second order, because of the rule that bodies are elaborated
28442 as soon as possible, but it's just luck that this is what was wanted
28443 (if indeed the second order was preferred).
28444
28445 If the program cares about the order of elaboration routines in a case like
28446 this, it is important to specify the order required. In this particular
28447 case, that could have been achieved by adding to the spec of Calc:
28448
28449 @smallexample @c ada
28450 pragma Elaborate_All (Constants);
28451 @end smallexample
28452
28453 @noindent
28454 which requires that the body (if any) and spec of @code{Constants},
28455 as well as the body and spec of any unit @code{with}'ed by
28456 @code{Constants} be elaborated before @code{Calc} is elaborated.
28457
28458 Clearly no automatic method can always guess which alternative you require,
28459 and if you are working with legacy code that had constraints of this kind
28460 which were not properly specified by adding @code{Elaborate} or
28461 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas, then indeed it is possible that two different
28462 compilers can choose different orders.
28463
28464 However, GNAT does attempt to diagnose the common situation where there
28465 are uninitialized variables in the visible part of a package spec, and the
28466 corresponding package body has an elaboration block that directly or
28467 indirectly initialized one or more of these variables. This is the situation
28468 in which a pragma Elaborate_Body is usually desirable, and GNAT will generate
28469 a warning that suggests this addition if it detects this situation.
28470
28471 The @code{gnatbind}
28472 @option{^-p^/PESSIMISTIC_ELABORATION^} switch may be useful in smoking
28473 out problems. This switch causes bodies to be elaborated as late as possible
28474 instead of as early as possible. In the example above, it would have forced
28475 the choice of the first elaboration order. If you get different results
28476 when using this switch, and particularly if one set of results is right,
28477 and one is wrong as far as you are concerned, it shows that you have some
28478 missing @code{Elaborate} pragmas. For the example above, we have the
28479 following output:
28480
28481 @smallexample
28482 gnatmake -f -q main
28483 main
28484 7
28485 gnatmake -f -q main -bargs -p
28486 main
28487 0
28488 @end smallexample
28489
28490 @noindent
28491 It is of course quite unlikely that both these results are correct, so
28492 it is up to you in a case like this to investigate the source of the
28493 difference, by looking at the two elaboration orders that are chosen,
28494 and figuring out which is correct, and then adding the necessary
28495 @code{Elaborate} or @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas to ensure the desired order.
28496
28497
28498
28499 @c *******************************
28500 @node Conditional Compilation
28501 @appendix Conditional Compilation
28502 @c *******************************
28503 @cindex Conditional compilation
28504
28505 @noindent
28506 It is often necessary to arrange for a single source program
28507 to serve multiple purposes, where it is compiled in different
28508 ways to achieve these different goals. Some examples of the
28509 need for this feature are
28510
28511 @itemize @bullet
28512 @item Adapting a program to a different hardware environment
28513 @item Adapting a program to a different target architecture
28514 @item Turning debugging features on and off
28515 @item Arranging for a program to compile with different compilers
28516 @end itemize
28517
28518 @noindent
28519 In C, or C++, the typical approach would be to use the preprocessor
28520 that is defined as part of the language. The Ada language does not
28521 contain such a feature. This is not an oversight, but rather a very
28522 deliberate design decision, based on the experience that overuse of
28523 the preprocessing features in C and C++ can result in programs that
28524 are extremely difficult to maintain. For example, if we have ten
28525 switches that can be on or off, this means that there are a thousand
28526 separate programs, any one of which might not even be syntactically
28527 correct, and even if syntactically correct, the resulting program
28528 might not work correctly. Testing all combinations can quickly become
28529 impossible.
28530
28531 Nevertheless, the need to tailor programs certainly exists, and in
28532 this Appendix we will discuss how this can
28533 be achieved using Ada in general, and GNAT in particular.
28534
28535 @menu
28536 * Use of Boolean Constants::
28537 * Debugging - A Special Case::
28538 * Conditionalizing Declarations::
28539 * Use of Alternative Implementations::
28540 * Preprocessing::
28541 @end menu
28542
28543 @node Use of Boolean Constants
28544 @section Use of Boolean Constants
28545
28546 @noindent
28547 In the case where the difference is simply which code
28548 sequence is executed, the cleanest solution is to use Boolean
28549 constants to control which code is executed.
28550
28551 @smallexample @c ada
28552 @group
28553 FP_Initialize_Required : constant Boolean := True;
28554 @dots{}
28555 if FP_Initialize_Required then
28556 @dots{}
28557 end if;
28558 @end group
28559 @end smallexample
28560
28561 @noindent
28562 Not only will the code inside the @code{if} statement not be executed if
28563 the constant Boolean is @code{False}, but it will also be completely
28564 deleted from the program.
28565 However, the code is only deleted after the @code{if} statement
28566 has been checked for syntactic and semantic correctness.
28567 (In contrast, with preprocessors the code is deleted before the
28568 compiler ever gets to see it, so it is not checked until the switch
28569 is turned on.)
28570 @cindex Preprocessors (contrasted with conditional compilation)
28571
28572 Typically the Boolean constants will be in a separate package,
28573 something like:
28574
28575 @smallexample @c ada
28576 @group
28577 package Config is
28578 FP_Initialize_Required : constant Boolean := True;
28579 Reset_Available : constant Boolean := False;
28580 @dots{}
28581 end Config;
28582 @end group
28583 @end smallexample
28584
28585 @noindent
28586 The @code{Config} package exists in multiple forms for the various targets,
28587 with an appropriate script selecting the version of @code{Config} needed.
28588 Then any other unit requiring conditional compilation can do a @code{with}
28589 of @code{Config} to make the constants visible.
28590
28591
28592 @node Debugging - A Special Case
28593 @section Debugging - A Special Case
28594
28595 @noindent
28596 A common use of conditional code is to execute statements (for example
28597 dynamic checks, or output of intermediate results) under control of a
28598 debug switch, so that the debugging behavior can be turned on and off.
28599 This can be done using a Boolean constant to control whether the code
28600 is active:
28601
28602 @smallexample @c ada
28603 @group
28604 if Debugging then
28605 Put_Line ("got to the first stage!");
28606 end if;
28607 @end group
28608 @end smallexample
28609
28610 @noindent
28611 or
28612
28613 @smallexample @c ada
28614 @group
28615 if Debugging and then Temperature > 999.0 then
28616 raise Temperature_Crazy;
28617 end if;
28618 @end group
28619 @end smallexample
28620
28621 @noindent
28622 Since this is a common case, there are special features to deal with
28623 this in a convenient manner. For the case of tests, Ada 2005 has added
28624 a pragma @code{Assert} that can be used for such tests. This pragma is modeled
28625 @cindex pragma @code{Assert}
28626 on the @code{Assert} pragma that has always been available in GNAT, so this
28627 feature may be used with GNAT even if you are not using Ada 2005 features.
28628 The use of pragma @code{Assert} is described in
28629 @ref{Pragma Assert,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}, but as an
28630 example, the last test could be written:
28631
28632 @smallexample @c ada
28633 pragma Assert (Temperature <= 999.0, "Temperature Crazy");
28634 @end smallexample
28635
28636 @noindent
28637 or simply
28638
28639 @smallexample @c ada
28640 pragma Assert (Temperature <= 999.0);
28641 @end smallexample
28642
28643 @noindent
28644 In both cases, if assertions are active and the temperature is excessive,
28645 the exception @code{Assert_Failure} will be raised, with the given string in
28646 the first case or a string indicating the location of the pragma in the second
28647 case used as the exception message.
28648
28649 You can turn assertions on and off by using the @code{Assertion_Policy}
28650 pragma.
28651 @cindex pragma @code{Assertion_Policy}
28652 This is an Ada 2005 pragma which is implemented in all modes by
28653 GNAT, but only in the latest versions of GNAT which include Ada 2005
28654 capability. Alternatively, you can use the @option{-gnata} switch
28655 @cindex @option{-gnata} switch
28656 to enable assertions from the command line (this is recognized by all versions
28657 of GNAT).
28658
28659 For the example above with the @code{Put_Line}, the GNAT-specific pragma
28660 @code{Debug} can be used:
28661 @cindex pragma @code{Debug}
28662
28663 @smallexample @c ada
28664 pragma Debug (Put_Line ("got to the first stage!"));
28665 @end smallexample
28666
28667 @noindent
28668 If debug pragmas are enabled, the argument, which must be of the form of
28669 a procedure call, is executed (in this case, @code{Put_Line} will be called).
28670 Only one call can be present, but of course a special debugging procedure
28671 containing any code you like can be included in the program and then
28672 called in a pragma @code{Debug} argument as needed.
28673
28674 One advantage of pragma @code{Debug} over the @code{if Debugging then}
28675 construct is that pragma @code{Debug} can appear in declarative contexts,
28676 such as at the very beginning of a procedure, before local declarations have
28677 been elaborated.
28678
28679 Debug pragmas are enabled using either the @option{-gnata} switch that also
28680 controls assertions, or with a separate Debug_Policy pragma.
28681 @cindex pragma @code{Debug_Policy}
28682 The latter pragma is new in the Ada 2005 versions of GNAT (but it can be used
28683 in Ada 95 and Ada 83 programs as well), and is analogous to
28684 pragma @code{Assertion_Policy} to control assertions.
28685
28686 @code{Assertion_Policy} and @code{Debug_Policy} are configuration pragmas,
28687 and thus they can appear in @file{gnat.adc} if you are not using a
28688 project file, or in the file designated to contain configuration pragmas
28689 in a project file.
28690 They then apply to all subsequent compilations. In practice the use of
28691 the @option{-gnata} switch is often the most convenient method of controlling
28692 the status of these pragmas.
28693
28694 Note that a pragma is not a statement, so in contexts where a statement
28695 sequence is required, you can't just write a pragma on its own. You have
28696 to add a @code{null} statement.
28697
28698 @smallexample @c ada
28699 @group
28700 if @dots{} then
28701 @dots{} -- some statements
28702 else
28703 pragma Assert (Num_Cases < 10);
28704 null;
28705 end if;
28706 @end group
28707 @end smallexample
28708
28709
28710 @node Conditionalizing Declarations
28711 @section Conditionalizing Declarations
28712
28713 @noindent
28714 In some cases, it may be necessary to conditionalize declarations to meet
28715 different requirements. For example we might want a bit string whose length
28716 is set to meet some hardware message requirement.
28717
28718 In some cases, it may be possible to do this using declare blocks controlled
28719 by conditional constants:
28720
28721 @smallexample @c ada
28722 @group
28723 if Small_Machine then
28724 declare
28725 X : Bit_String (1 .. 10);
28726 begin
28727 @dots{}
28728 end;
28729 else
28730 declare
28731 X : Large_Bit_String (1 .. 1000);
28732 begin
28733 @dots{}
28734 end;
28735 end if;
28736 @end group
28737 @end smallexample
28738
28739 @noindent
28740 Note that in this approach, both declarations are analyzed by the
28741 compiler so this can only be used where both declarations are legal,
28742 even though one of them will not be used.
28743
28744 Another approach is to define integer constants, e.g.@: @code{Bits_Per_Word}, or
28745 Boolean constants, e.g.@: @code{Little_Endian}, and then write declarations
28746 that are parameterized by these constants. For example
28747
28748 @smallexample @c ada
28749 @group
28750 for Rec use
28751 Field1 at 0 range Boolean'Pos (Little_Endian) * 10 .. Bits_Per_Word;
28752 end record;
28753 @end group
28754 @end smallexample
28755
28756 @noindent
28757 If @code{Bits_Per_Word} is set to 32, this generates either
28758
28759 @smallexample @c ada
28760 @group
28761 for Rec use
28762 Field1 at 0 range 0 .. 32;
28763 end record;
28764 @end group
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 @noindent
28768 for the big endian case, or
28769
28770 @smallexample @c ada
28771 @group
28772 for Rec use record
28773 Field1 at 0 range 10 .. 32;
28774 end record;
28775 @end group
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 @noindent
28779 for the little endian case. Since a powerful subset of Ada expression
28780 notation is usable for creating static constants, clever use of this
28781 feature can often solve quite difficult problems in conditionalizing
28782 compilation (note incidentally that in Ada 95, the little endian
28783 constant was introduced as @code{System.Default_Bit_Order}, so you do not
28784 need to define this one yourself).
28785
28786
28787 @node Use of Alternative Implementations
28788 @section Use of Alternative Implementations
28789
28790 @noindent
28791 In some cases, none of the approaches described above are adequate. This
28792 can occur for example if the set of declarations required is radically
28793 different for two different configurations.
28794
28795 In this situation, the official Ada way of dealing with conditionalizing
28796 such code is to write separate units for the different cases. As long as
28797 this does not result in excessive duplication of code, this can be done
28798 without creating maintenance problems. The approach is to share common
28799 code as far as possible, and then isolate the code and declarations
28800 that are different. Subunits are often a convenient method for breaking
28801 out a piece of a unit that is to be conditionalized, with separate files
28802 for different versions of the subunit for different targets, where the
28803 build script selects the right one to give to the compiler.
28804 @cindex Subunits (and conditional compilation)
28805
28806 As an example, consider a situation where a new feature in Ada 2005
28807 allows something to be done in a really nice way. But your code must be able
28808 to compile with an Ada 95 compiler. Conceptually you want to say:
28809
28810 @smallexample @c ada
28811 @group
28812 if Ada_2005 then
28813 @dots{} neat Ada 2005 code
28814 else
28815 @dots{} not quite as neat Ada 95 code
28816 end if;
28817 @end group
28818 @end smallexample
28819
28820 @noindent
28821 where @code{Ada_2005} is a Boolean constant.
28822
28823 But this won't work when @code{Ada_2005} is set to @code{False},
28824 since the @code{then} clause will be illegal for an Ada 95 compiler.
28825 (Recall that although such unreachable code would eventually be deleted
28826 by the compiler, it still needs to be legal. If it uses features
28827 introduced in Ada 2005, it will be illegal in Ada 95.)
28828
28829 So instead we write
28830
28831 @smallexample @c ada
28832 procedure Insert is separate;
28833 @end smallexample
28834
28835 @noindent
28836 Then we have two files for the subunit @code{Insert}, with the two sets of
28837 code.
28838 If the package containing this is called @code{File_Queries}, then we might
28839 have two files
28840
28841 @itemize @bullet
28842 @item @file{file_queries-insert-2005.adb}
28843 @item @file{file_queries-insert-95.adb}
28844 @end itemize
28845
28846 @noindent
28847 and the build script renames the appropriate file to
28848
28849 @smallexample
28850 file_queries-insert.adb
28851 @end smallexample
28852
28853 @noindent
28854 and then carries out the compilation.
28855
28856 This can also be done with project files' naming schemes. For example:
28857
28858 @smallexample @c project
28859 For Body ("File_Queries.Insert") use "file_queries-insert-2005.ada";
28860 @end smallexample
28861
28862 @noindent
28863 Note also that with project files it is desirable to use a different extension
28864 than @file{ads} / @file{adb} for alternative versions. Otherwise a naming
28865 conflict may arise through another commonly used feature: to declare as part
28866 of the project a set of directories containing all the sources obeying the
28867 default naming scheme.
28868
28869 The use of alternative units is certainly feasible in all situations,
28870 and for example the Ada part of the GNAT run-time is conditionalized
28871 based on the target architecture using this approach. As a specific example,
28872 consider the implementation of the AST feature in VMS. There is one
28873 spec:
28874
28875 @smallexample
28876 s-asthan.ads
28877 @end smallexample
28878
28879 @noindent
28880 which is the same for all architectures, and three bodies:
28881
28882 @table @file
28883 @item s-asthan.adb
28884 used for all non-VMS operating systems
28885 @item s-asthan-vms-alpha.adb
28886 used for VMS on the Alpha
28887 @item s-asthan-vms-ia64.adb
28888 used for VMS on the ia64
28889 @end table
28890
28891 @noindent
28892 The dummy version @file{s-asthan.adb} simply raises exceptions noting that
28893 this operating system feature is not available, and the two remaining
28894 versions interface with the corresponding versions of VMS to provide
28895 VMS-compatible AST handling. The GNAT build script knows the architecture
28896 and operating system, and automatically selects the right version,
28897 renaming it if necessary to @file{s-asthan.adb} before the run-time build.
28898
28899 Another style for arranging alternative implementations is through Ada's
28900 access-to-subprogram facility.
28901 In case some functionality is to be conditionally included,
28902 you can declare an access-to-procedure variable @code{Ref} that is initialized
28903 to designate a ``do nothing'' procedure, and then invoke @code{Ref.all}
28904 when appropriate.
28905 In some library package, set @code{Ref} to @code{Proc'Access} for some
28906 procedure @code{Proc} that performs the relevant processing.
28907 The initialization only occurs if the library package is included in the
28908 program.
28909 The same idea can also be implemented using tagged types and dispatching
28910 calls.
28911
28912
28913 @node Preprocessing
28914 @section Preprocessing
28915 @cindex Preprocessing
28916
28917 @noindent
28918 Although it is quite possible to conditionalize code without the use of
28919 C-style preprocessing, as described earlier in this section, it is
28920 nevertheless convenient in some cases to use the C approach. Moreover,
28921 older Ada compilers have often provided some preprocessing capability,
28922 so legacy code may depend on this approach, even though it is not
28923 standard.
28924
28925 To accommodate such use, GNAT provides a preprocessor (modeled to a large
28926 extent on the various preprocessors that have been used
28927 with legacy code on other compilers, to enable easier transition).
28928
28929 The preprocessor may be used in two separate modes. It can be used quite
28930 separately from the compiler, to generate a separate output source file
28931 that is then fed to the compiler as a separate step. This is the
28932 @code{gnatprep} utility, whose use is fully described in
28933 @ref{Preprocessing Using gnatprep}.
28934 @cindex @code{gnatprep}
28935
28936 The preprocessing language allows such constructs as
28937
28938 @smallexample
28939 @group
28940 #if DEBUG or PRIORITY > 4 then
28941 bunch of declarations
28942 #else
28943 completely different bunch of declarations
28944 #end if;
28945 @end group
28946 @end smallexample
28947
28948 @noindent
28949 The values of the symbols @code{DEBUG} and @code{PRIORITY} can be
28950 defined either on the command line or in a separate file.
28951
28952 The other way of running the preprocessor is even closer to the C style and
28953 often more convenient. In this approach the preprocessing is integrated into
28954 the compilation process. The compiler is fed the preprocessor input which
28955 includes @code{#if} lines etc, and then the compiler carries out the
28956 preprocessing internally and processes the resulting output.
28957 For more details on this approach, see @ref{Integrated Preprocessing}.
28958
28959
28960 @c *******************************
28961 @node Inline Assembler
28962 @appendix Inline Assembler
28963 @c *******************************
28964
28965 @noindent
28966 If you need to write low-level software that interacts directly
28967 with the hardware, Ada provides two ways to incorporate assembly
28968 language code into your program. First, you can import and invoke
28969 external routines written in assembly language, an Ada feature fully
28970 supported by GNAT@. However, for small sections of code it may be simpler
28971 or more efficient to include assembly language statements directly
28972 in your Ada source program, using the facilities of the implementation-defined
28973 package @code{System.Machine_Code}, which incorporates the gcc
28974 Inline Assembler. The Inline Assembler approach offers a number of advantages,
28975 including the following:
28976
28977 @itemize @bullet
28978 @item No need to use non-Ada tools
28979 @item Consistent interface over different targets
28980 @item Automatic usage of the proper calling conventions
28981 @item Access to Ada constants and variables
28982 @item Definition of intrinsic routines
28983 @item Possibility of inlining a subprogram comprising assembler code
28984 @item Code optimizer can take Inline Assembler code into account
28985 @end itemize
28986
28987 This chapter presents a series of examples to show you how to use
28988 the Inline Assembler. Although it focuses on the Intel x86,
28989 the general approach applies also to other processors.
28990 It is assumed that you are familiar with Ada
28991 and with assembly language programming.
28992
28993 @menu
28994 * Basic Assembler Syntax::
28995 * A Simple Example of Inline Assembler::
28996 * Output Variables in Inline Assembler::
28997 * Input Variables in Inline Assembler::
28998 * Inlining Inline Assembler Code::
28999 * Other Asm Functionality::
29000 @end menu
29001
29002 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29003 @node Basic Assembler Syntax
29004 @section Basic Assembler Syntax
29005
29006 @noindent
29007 The assembler used by GNAT and gcc is based not on the Intel assembly
29008 language, but rather on a language that descends from the AT&T Unix
29009 assembler @emph{as} (and which is often referred to as ``AT&T syntax'').
29010 The following table summarizes the main features of @emph{as} syntax
29011 and points out the differences from the Intel conventions.
29012 See the gcc @emph{as} and @emph{gas} (an @emph{as} macro
29013 pre-processor) documentation for further information.
29014
29015 @table @asis
29016 @item Register names
29017 gcc / @emph{as}: Prefix with ``%''; for example @code{%eax}
29018 @*
29019 Intel: No extra punctuation; for example @code{eax}
29020
29021 @item Immediate operand
29022 gcc / @emph{as}: Prefix with ``$''; for example @code{$4}
29023 @*
29024 Intel: No extra punctuation; for example @code{4}
29025
29026 @item Address
29027 gcc / @emph{as}: Prefix with ``$''; for example @code{$loc}
29028 @*
29029 Intel: No extra punctuation; for example @code{loc}
29030
29031 @item Memory contents
29032 gcc / @emph{as}: No extra punctuation; for example @code{loc}
29033 @*
29034 Intel: Square brackets; for example @code{[loc]}
29035
29036 @item Register contents
29037 gcc / @emph{as}: Parentheses; for example @code{(%eax)}
29038 @*
29039 Intel: Square brackets; for example @code{[eax]}
29040
29041 @item Hexadecimal numbers
29042 gcc / @emph{as}: Leading ``0x'' (C language syntax); for example @code{0xA0}
29043 @*
29044 Intel: Trailing ``h''; for example @code{A0h}
29045
29046 @item Operand size
29047 gcc / @emph{as}: Explicit in op code; for example @code{movw} to move
29048 a 16-bit word
29049 @*
29050 Intel: Implicit, deduced by assembler; for example @code{mov}
29051
29052 @item Instruction repetition
29053 gcc / @emph{as}: Split into two lines; for example
29054 @*
29055 @code{rep}
29056 @*
29057 @code{stosl}
29058 @*
29059 Intel: Keep on one line; for example @code{rep stosl}
29060
29061 @item Order of operands
29062 gcc / @emph{as}: Source first; for example @code{movw $4, %eax}
29063 @*
29064 Intel: Destination first; for example @code{mov eax, 4}
29065 @end table
29066
29067 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29068 @node A Simple Example of Inline Assembler
29069 @section A Simple Example of Inline Assembler
29070
29071 @noindent
29072 The following example will generate a single assembly language statement,
29073 @code{nop}, which does nothing. Despite its lack of run-time effect,
29074 the example will be useful in illustrating the basics of
29075 the Inline Assembler facility.
29076
29077 @smallexample @c ada
29078 @group
29079 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29080 procedure Nothing is
29081 begin
29082 Asm ("nop");
29083 end Nothing;
29084 @end group
29085 @end smallexample
29086
29087 @code{Asm} is a procedure declared in package @code{System.Machine_Code};
29088 here it takes one parameter, a @emph{template string} that must be a static
29089 expression and that will form the generated instruction.
29090 @code{Asm} may be regarded as a compile-time procedure that parses
29091 the template string and additional parameters (none here),
29092 from which it generates a sequence of assembly language instructions.
29093
29094 The examples in this chapter will illustrate several of the forms
29095 for invoking @code{Asm}; a complete specification of the syntax
29096 is found in @ref{Machine Code Insertions,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference
29097 Manual}.
29098
29099 Under the standard GNAT conventions, the @code{Nothing} procedure
29100 should be in a file named @file{nothing.adb}.
29101 You can build the executable in the usual way:
29102 @smallexample
29103 gnatmake nothing
29104 @end smallexample
29105 However, the interesting aspect of this example is not its run-time behavior
29106 but rather the generated assembly code.
29107 To see this output, invoke the compiler as follows:
29108 @smallexample
29109 gcc -c -S -fomit-frame-pointer -gnatp @file{nothing.adb}
29110 @end smallexample
29111 where the options are:
29112
29113 @table @code
29114 @item -c
29115 compile only (no bind or link)
29116 @item -S
29117 generate assembler listing
29118 @item -fomit-frame-pointer
29119 do not set up separate stack frames
29120 @item -gnatp
29121 do not add runtime checks
29122 @end table
29123
29124 This gives a human-readable assembler version of the code. The resulting
29125 file will have the same name as the Ada source file, but with a @code{.s}
29126 extension. In our example, the file @file{nothing.s} has the following
29127 contents:
29128
29129 @smallexample
29130 @group
29131 .file "nothing.adb"
29132 gcc2_compiled.:
29133 ___gnu_compiled_ada:
29134 .text
29135 .align 4
29136 .globl __ada_nothing
29137 __ada_nothing:
29138 #APP
29139 nop
29140 #NO_APP
29141 jmp L1
29142 .align 2,0x90
29143 L1:
29144 ret
29145 @end group
29146 @end smallexample
29147
29148 The assembly code you included is clearly indicated by
29149 the compiler, between the @code{#APP} and @code{#NO_APP}
29150 delimiters. The character before the 'APP' and 'NOAPP'
29151 can differ on different targets. For example, GNU/Linux uses '#APP' while
29152 on NT you will see '/APP'.
29153
29154 If you make a mistake in your assembler code (such as using the
29155 wrong size modifier, or using a wrong operand for the instruction) GNAT
29156 will report this error in a temporary file, which will be deleted when
29157 the compilation is finished. Generating an assembler file will help
29158 in such cases, since you can assemble this file separately using the
29159 @emph{as} assembler that comes with gcc.
29160
29161 Assembling the file using the command
29162
29163 @smallexample
29164 as @file{nothing.s}
29165 @end smallexample
29166 @noindent
29167 will give you error messages whose lines correspond to the assembler
29168 input file, so you can easily find and correct any mistakes you made.
29169 If there are no errors, @emph{as} will generate an object file
29170 @file{nothing.out}.
29171
29172 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29173 @node Output Variables in Inline Assembler
29174 @section Output Variables in Inline Assembler
29175
29176 @noindent
29177 The examples in this section, showing how to access the processor flags,
29178 illustrate how to specify the destination operands for assembly language
29179 statements.
29180
29181 @smallexample @c ada
29182 @group
29183 with Interfaces; use Interfaces;
29184 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
29185 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29186 procedure Get_Flags is
29187 Flags : Unsigned_32;
29188 use ASCII;
29189 begin
29190 Asm ("pushfl" & LF & HT & -- push flags on stack
29191 "popl %%eax" & LF & HT & -- load eax with flags
29192 "movl %%eax, %0", -- store flags in variable
29193 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Flags));
29194 Put_Line ("Flags register:" & Flags'Img);
29195 end Get_Flags;
29196 @end group
29197 @end smallexample
29198
29199 In order to have a nicely aligned assembly listing, we have separated
29200 multiple assembler statements in the Asm template string with linefeed
29201 (ASCII.LF) and horizontal tab (ASCII.HT) characters.
29202 The resulting section of the assembly output file is:
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 @group
29206 #APP
29207 pushfl
29208 popl %eax
29209 movl %eax, -40(%ebp)
29210 #NO_APP
29211 @end group
29212 @end smallexample
29213
29214 It would have been legal to write the Asm invocation as:
29215
29216 @smallexample
29217 Asm ("pushfl popl %%eax movl %%eax, %0")
29218 @end smallexample
29219
29220 but in the generated assembler file, this would come out as:
29221
29222 @smallexample
29223 #APP
29224 pushfl popl %eax movl %eax, -40(%ebp)
29225 #NO_APP
29226 @end smallexample
29227
29228 which is not so convenient for the human reader.
29229
29230 We use Ada comments
29231 at the end of each line to explain what the assembler instructions
29232 actually do. This is a useful convention.
29233
29234 When writing Inline Assembler instructions, you need to precede each register
29235 and variable name with a percent sign. Since the assembler already requires
29236 a percent sign at the beginning of a register name, you need two consecutive
29237 percent signs for such names in the Asm template string, thus @code{%%eax}.
29238 In the generated assembly code, one of the percent signs will be stripped off.
29239
29240 Names such as @code{%0}, @code{%1}, @code{%2}, etc., denote input or output
29241 variables: operands you later define using @code{Input} or @code{Output}
29242 parameters to @code{Asm}.
29243 An output variable is illustrated in
29244 the third statement in the Asm template string:
29245 @smallexample
29246 movl %%eax, %0
29247 @end smallexample
29248 The intent is to store the contents of the eax register in a variable that can
29249 be accessed in Ada. Simply writing @code{movl %%eax, Flags} would not
29250 necessarily work, since the compiler might optimize by using a register
29251 to hold Flags, and the expansion of the @code{movl} instruction would not be
29252 aware of this optimization. The solution is not to store the result directly
29253 but rather to advise the compiler to choose the correct operand form;
29254 that is the purpose of the @code{%0} output variable.
29255
29256 Information about the output variable is supplied in the @code{Outputs}
29257 parameter to @code{Asm}:
29258 @smallexample
29259 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Flags));
29260 @end smallexample
29261
29262 The output is defined by the @code{Asm_Output} attribute of the target type;
29263 the general format is
29264 @smallexample
29265 Type'Asm_Output (constraint_string, variable_name)
29266 @end smallexample
29267
29268 The constraint string directs the compiler how
29269 to store/access the associated variable. In the example
29270 @smallexample
29271 Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=m", Flags);
29272 @end smallexample
29273 the @code{"m"} (memory) constraint tells the compiler that the variable
29274 @code{Flags} should be stored in a memory variable, thus preventing
29275 the optimizer from keeping it in a register. In contrast,
29276 @smallexample
29277 Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=r", Flags);
29278 @end smallexample
29279 uses the @code{"r"} (register) constraint, telling the compiler to
29280 store the variable in a register.
29281
29282 If the constraint is preceded by the equal character (@strong{=}), it tells
29283 the compiler that the variable will be used to store data into it.
29284
29285 In the @code{Get_Flags} example, we used the @code{"g"} (global) constraint,
29286 allowing the optimizer to choose whatever it deems best.
29287
29288 There are a fairly large number of constraints, but the ones that are
29289 most useful (for the Intel x86 processor) are the following:
29290
29291 @table @code
29292 @item =
29293 output constraint
29294 @item g
29295 global (i.e.@: can be stored anywhere)
29296 @item m
29297 in memory
29298 @item I
29299 a constant
29300 @item a
29301 use eax
29302 @item b
29303 use ebx
29304 @item c
29305 use ecx
29306 @item d
29307 use edx
29308 @item S
29309 use esi
29310 @item D
29311 use edi
29312 @item r
29313 use one of eax, ebx, ecx or edx
29314 @item q
29315 use one of eax, ebx, ecx, edx, esi or edi
29316 @end table
29317
29318 The full set of constraints is described in the gcc and @emph{as}
29319 documentation; note that it is possible to combine certain constraints
29320 in one constraint string.
29321
29322 You specify the association of an output variable with an assembler operand
29323 through the @code{%}@emph{n} notation, where @emph{n} is a non-negative
29324 integer. Thus in
29325 @smallexample @c ada
29326 @group
29327 Asm ("pushfl" & LF & HT & -- push flags on stack
29328 "popl %%eax" & LF & HT & -- load eax with flags
29329 "movl %%eax, %0", -- store flags in variable
29330 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Flags));
29331 @end group
29332 @end smallexample
29333 @noindent
29334 @code{%0} will be replaced in the expanded code by the appropriate operand,
29335 whatever
29336 the compiler decided for the @code{Flags} variable.
29337
29338 In general, you may have any number of output variables:
29339 @itemize @bullet
29340 @item
29341 Count the operands starting at 0; thus @code{%0}, @code{%1}, etc.
29342 @item
29343 Specify the @code{Outputs} parameter as a parenthesized comma-separated list
29344 of @code{Asm_Output} attributes
29345 @end itemize
29346
29347 For example:
29348 @smallexample @c ada
29349 @group
29350 Asm ("movl %%eax, %0" & LF & HT &
29351 "movl %%ebx, %1" & LF & HT &
29352 "movl %%ecx, %2",
29353 Outputs => (Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_A), -- %0 = Var_A
29354 Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_B), -- %1 = Var_B
29355 Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_C))); -- %2 = Var_C
29356 @end group
29357 @end smallexample
29358 @noindent
29359 where @code{Var_A}, @code{Var_B}, and @code{Var_C} are variables
29360 in the Ada program.
29361
29362 As a variation on the @code{Get_Flags} example, we can use the constraints
29363 string to direct the compiler to store the eax register into the @code{Flags}
29364 variable, instead of including the store instruction explicitly in the
29365 @code{Asm} template string:
29366
29367 @smallexample @c ada
29368 @group
29369 with Interfaces; use Interfaces;
29370 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
29371 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29372 procedure Get_Flags_2 is
29373 Flags : Unsigned_32;
29374 use ASCII;
29375 begin
29376 Asm ("pushfl" & LF & HT & -- push flags on stack
29377 "popl %%eax", -- save flags in eax
29378 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=a", Flags));
29379 Put_Line ("Flags register:" & Flags'Img);
29380 end Get_Flags_2;
29381 @end group
29382 @end smallexample
29383
29384 @noindent
29385 The @code{"a"} constraint tells the compiler that the @code{Flags}
29386 variable will come from the eax register. Here is the resulting code:
29387
29388 @smallexample
29389 @group
29390 #APP
29391 pushfl
29392 popl %eax
29393 #NO_APP
29394 movl %eax,-40(%ebp)
29395 @end group
29396 @end smallexample
29397
29398 @noindent
29399 The compiler generated the store of eax into Flags after
29400 expanding the assembler code.
29401
29402 Actually, there was no need to pop the flags into the eax register;
29403 more simply, we could just pop the flags directly into the program variable:
29404
29405 @smallexample @c ada
29406 @group
29407 with Interfaces; use Interfaces;
29408 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
29409 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29410 procedure Get_Flags_3 is
29411 Flags : Unsigned_32;
29412 use ASCII;
29413 begin
29414 Asm ("pushfl" & LF & HT & -- push flags on stack
29415 "pop %0", -- save flags in Flags
29416 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Flags));
29417 Put_Line ("Flags register:" & Flags'Img);
29418 end Get_Flags_3;
29419 @end group
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29423 @node Input Variables in Inline Assembler
29424 @section Input Variables in Inline Assembler
29425
29426 @noindent
29427 The example in this section illustrates how to specify the source operands
29428 for assembly language statements.
29429 The program simply increments its input value by 1:
29430
29431 @smallexample @c ada
29432 @group
29433 with Interfaces; use Interfaces;
29434 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
29435 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29436 procedure Increment is
29437
29438 function Incr (Value : Unsigned_32) return Unsigned_32 is
29439 Result : Unsigned_32;
29440 begin
29441 Asm ("incl %0",
29442 Inputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Input ("a", Value),
29443 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=a", Result));
29444 return Result;
29445 end Incr;
29446
29447 Value : Unsigned_32;
29448
29449 begin
29450 Value := 5;
29451 Put_Line ("Value before is" & Value'Img);
29452 Value := Incr (Value);
29453 Put_Line ("Value after is" & Value'Img);
29454 end Increment;
29455 @end group
29456 @end smallexample
29457
29458 The @code{Outputs} parameter to @code{Asm} specifies
29459 that the result will be in the eax register and that it is to be stored
29460 in the @code{Result} variable.
29461
29462 The @code{Inputs} parameter looks much like the @code{Outputs} parameter,
29463 but with an @code{Asm_Input} attribute.
29464 The @code{"="} constraint, indicating an output value, is not present.
29465
29466 You can have multiple input variables, in the same way that you can have more
29467 than one output variable.
29468
29469 The parameter count (%0, %1) etc, now starts at the first input
29470 statement, and continues with the output statements.
29471 When both parameters use the same variable, the
29472 compiler will treat them as the same %n operand, which is the case here.
29473
29474 Just as the @code{Outputs} parameter causes the register to be stored into the
29475 target variable after execution of the assembler statements, so does the
29476 @code{Inputs} parameter cause its variable to be loaded into the register
29477 before execution of the assembler statements.
29478
29479 Thus the effect of the @code{Asm} invocation is:
29480 @enumerate
29481 @item load the 32-bit value of @code{Value} into eax
29482 @item execute the @code{incl %eax} instruction
29483 @item store the contents of eax into the @code{Result} variable
29484 @end enumerate
29485
29486 The resulting assembler file (with @option{-O2} optimization) contains:
29487 @smallexample
29488 @group
29489 _increment__incr.1:
29490 subl $4,%esp
29491 movl 8(%esp),%eax
29492 #APP
29493 incl %eax
29494 #NO_APP
29495 movl %eax,%edx
29496 movl %ecx,(%esp)
29497 addl $4,%esp
29498 ret
29499 @end group
29500 @end smallexample
29501
29502 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29503 @node Inlining Inline Assembler Code
29504 @section Inlining Inline Assembler Code
29505
29506 @noindent
29507 For a short subprogram such as the @code{Incr} function in the previous
29508 section, the overhead of the call and return (creating / deleting the stack
29509 frame) can be significant, compared to the amount of code in the subprogram
29510 body. A solution is to apply Ada's @code{Inline} pragma to the subprogram,
29511 which directs the compiler to expand invocations of the subprogram at the
29512 point(s) of call, instead of setting up a stack frame for out-of-line calls.
29513 Here is the resulting program:
29514
29515 @smallexample @c ada
29516 @group
29517 with Interfaces; use Interfaces;
29518 with Ada.Text_IO; use Ada.Text_IO;
29519 with System.Machine_Code; use System.Machine_Code;
29520 procedure Increment_2 is
29521
29522 function Incr (Value : Unsigned_32) return Unsigned_32 is
29523 Result : Unsigned_32;
29524 begin
29525 Asm ("incl %0",
29526 Inputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Input ("a", Value),
29527 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=a", Result));
29528 return Result;
29529 end Incr;
29530 pragma Inline (Increment);
29531
29532 Value : Unsigned_32;
29533
29534 begin
29535 Value := 5;
29536 Put_Line ("Value before is" & Value'Img);
29537 Value := Increment (Value);
29538 Put_Line ("Value after is" & Value'Img);
29539 end Increment_2;
29540 @end group
29541 @end smallexample
29542
29543 Compile the program with both optimization (@option{-O2}) and inlining
29544 (@option{-gnatn}) enabled.
29545
29546 The @code{Incr} function is still compiled as usual, but at the
29547 point in @code{Increment} where our function used to be called:
29548
29549 @smallexample
29550 @group
29551 pushl %edi
29552 call _increment__incr.1
29553 @end group
29554 @end smallexample
29555
29556 @noindent
29557 the code for the function body directly appears:
29558
29559 @smallexample
29560 @group
29561 movl %esi,%eax
29562 #APP
29563 incl %eax
29564 #NO_APP
29565 movl %eax,%edx
29566 @end group
29567 @end smallexample
29568
29569 @noindent
29570 thus saving the overhead of stack frame setup and an out-of-line call.
29571
29572 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29573 @node Other Asm Functionality
29574 @section Other @code{Asm} Functionality
29575
29576 @noindent
29577 This section describes two important parameters to the @code{Asm}
29578 procedure: @code{Clobber}, which identifies register usage;
29579 and @code{Volatile}, which inhibits unwanted optimizations.
29580
29581 @menu
29582 * The Clobber Parameter::
29583 * The Volatile Parameter::
29584 @end menu
29585
29586 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29587 @node The Clobber Parameter
29588 @subsection The @code{Clobber} Parameter
29589
29590 @noindent
29591 One of the dangers of intermixing assembly language and a compiled language
29592 such as Ada is that the compiler needs to be aware of which registers are
29593 being used by the assembly code. In some cases, such as the earlier examples,
29594 the constraint string is sufficient to indicate register usage (e.g.,
29595 @code{"a"} for
29596 the eax register). But more generally, the compiler needs an explicit
29597 identification of the registers that are used by the Inline Assembly
29598 statements.
29599
29600 Using a register that the compiler doesn't know about
29601 could be a side effect of an instruction (like @code{mull}
29602 storing its result in both eax and edx).
29603 It can also arise from explicit register usage in your
29604 assembly code; for example:
29605 @smallexample
29606 @group
29607 Asm ("movl %0, %%ebx" & LF & HT &
29608 "movl %%ebx, %1",
29609 Inputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Input ("g", Var_In),
29610 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_Out));
29611 @end group
29612 @end smallexample
29613 @noindent
29614 where the compiler (since it does not analyze the @code{Asm} template string)
29615 does not know you are using the ebx register.
29616
29617 In such cases you need to supply the @code{Clobber} parameter to @code{Asm},
29618 to identify the registers that will be used by your assembly code:
29619
29620 @smallexample
29621 @group
29622 Asm ("movl %0, %%ebx" & LF & HT &
29623 "movl %%ebx, %1",
29624 Inputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Input ("g", Var_In),
29625 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_Out),
29626 Clobber => "ebx");
29627 @end group
29628 @end smallexample
29629
29630 The Clobber parameter is a static string expression specifying the
29631 register(s) you are using. Note that register names are @emph{not} prefixed
29632 by a percent sign. Also, if more than one register is used then their names
29633 are separated by commas; e.g., @code{"eax, ebx"}
29634
29635 The @code{Clobber} parameter has several additional uses:
29636 @enumerate
29637 @item Use ``register'' name @code{cc} to indicate that flags might have changed
29638 @item Use ``register'' name @code{memory} if you changed a memory location
29639 @end enumerate
29640
29641 @c ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
29642 @node The Volatile Parameter
29643 @subsection The @code{Volatile} Parameter
29644 @cindex Volatile parameter
29645
29646 @noindent
29647 Compiler optimizations in the presence of Inline Assembler may sometimes have
29648 unwanted effects. For example, when an @code{Asm} invocation with an input
29649 variable is inside a loop, the compiler might move the loading of the input
29650 variable outside the loop, regarding it as a one-time initialization.
29651
29652 If this effect is not desired, you can disable such optimizations by setting
29653 the @code{Volatile} parameter to @code{True}; for example:
29654
29655 @smallexample @c ada
29656 @group
29657 Asm ("movl %0, %%ebx" & LF & HT &
29658 "movl %%ebx, %1",
29659 Inputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Input ("g", Var_In),
29660 Outputs => Unsigned_32'Asm_Output ("=g", Var_Out),
29661 Clobber => "ebx",
29662 Volatile => True);
29663 @end group
29664 @end smallexample
29665
29666 By default, @code{Volatile} is set to @code{False} unless there is no
29667 @code{Outputs} parameter.
29668
29669 Although setting @code{Volatile} to @code{True} prevents unwanted
29670 optimizations, it will also disable other optimizations that might be
29671 important for efficiency. In general, you should set @code{Volatile}
29672 to @code{True} only if the compiler's optimizations have created
29673 problems.
29674 @c END OF INLINE ASSEMBLER CHAPTER
29675 @c ===============================
29676
29677 @c ***********************************
29678 @c * Compatibility and Porting Guide *
29679 @c ***********************************
29680 @node Compatibility and Porting Guide
29681 @appendix Compatibility and Porting Guide
29682
29683 @noindent
29684 This chapter describes the compatibility issues that may arise between
29685 GNAT and other Ada compilation systems (including those for Ada 83),
29686 and shows how GNAT can expedite porting
29687 applications developed in other Ada environments.
29688
29689 @menu
29690 * Compatibility with Ada 83::
29691 * Compatibility between Ada 95 and Ada 2005::
29692 * Implementation-dependent characteristics::
29693 * Compatibility with Other Ada Systems::
29694 * Representation Clauses::
29695 @ifclear vms
29696 @c Brief section is only in non-VMS version
29697 @c Full chapter is in VMS version
29698 * Compatibility with HP Ada 83::
29699 @end ifclear
29700 @ifset vms
29701 * Transitioning to 64-Bit GNAT for OpenVMS::
29702 @end ifset
29703 @end menu
29704
29705 @node Compatibility with Ada 83
29706 @section Compatibility with Ada 83
29707 @cindex Compatibility (between Ada 83 and Ada 95 / Ada 2005)
29708
29709 @noindent
29710 Ada 95 and Ada 2005 are highly upwards compatible with Ada 83. In
29711 particular, the design intention was that the difficulties associated
29712 with moving from Ada 83 to Ada 95 or Ada 2005 should be no greater than those
29713 that occur when moving from one Ada 83 system to another.
29714
29715 However, there are a number of points at which there are minor
29716 incompatibilities. The @cite{Ada 95 Annotated Reference Manual} contains
29717 full details of these issues,
29718 and should be consulted for a complete treatment.
29719 In practice the
29720 following subsections treat the most likely issues to be encountered.
29721
29722 @menu
29723 * Legal Ada 83 programs that are illegal in Ada 95::
29724 * More deterministic semantics::
29725 * Changed semantics::
29726 * Other language compatibility issues::
29727 @end menu
29728
29729 @node Legal Ada 83 programs that are illegal in Ada 95
29730 @subsection Legal Ada 83 programs that are illegal in Ada 95
29731
29732 Some legal Ada 83 programs are illegal (i.e., they will fail to compile) in
29733 Ada 95 and thus also in Ada 2005:
29734
29735 @table @emph
29736 @item Character literals
29737 Some uses of character literals are ambiguous. Since Ada 95 has introduced
29738 @code{Wide_Character} as a new predefined character type, some uses of
29739 character literals that were legal in Ada 83 are illegal in Ada 95.
29740 For example:
29741 @smallexample @c ada
29742 for Char in 'A' .. 'Z' loop @dots{} end loop;
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 @noindent
29746 The problem is that @code{'A'} and @code{'Z'} could be from either
29747 @code{Character} or @code{Wide_Character}. The simplest correction
29748 is to make the type explicit; e.g.:
29749 @smallexample @c ada
29750 for Char in Character range 'A' .. 'Z' loop @dots{} end loop;
29751 @end smallexample
29752
29753 @item New reserved words
29754 The identifiers @code{abstract}, @code{aliased}, @code{protected},
29755 @code{requeue}, @code{tagged}, and @code{until} are reserved in Ada 95.
29756 Existing Ada 83 code using any of these identifiers must be edited to
29757 use some alternative name.
29758
29759 @item Freezing rules
29760 The rules in Ada 95 are slightly different with regard to the point at
29761 which entities are frozen, and representation pragmas and clauses are
29762 not permitted past the freeze point. This shows up most typically in
29763 the form of an error message complaining that a representation item
29764 appears too late, and the appropriate corrective action is to move
29765 the item nearer to the declaration of the entity to which it refers.
29766
29767 A particular case is that representation pragmas
29768 @ifset vms
29769 (including the
29770 extended HP Ada 83 compatibility pragmas such as @code{Export_Procedure})
29771 @end ifset
29772 cannot be applied to a subprogram body. If necessary, a separate subprogram
29773 declaration must be introduced to which the pragma can be applied.
29774
29775 @item Optional bodies for library packages
29776 In Ada 83, a package that did not require a package body was nevertheless
29777 allowed to have one. This lead to certain surprises in compiling large
29778 systems (situations in which the body could be unexpectedly ignored by the
29779 binder). In Ada 95, if a package does not require a body then it is not
29780 permitted to have a body. To fix this problem, simply remove a redundant
29781 body if it is empty, or, if it is non-empty, introduce a dummy declaration
29782 into the spec that makes the body required. One approach is to add a private
29783 part to the package declaration (if necessary), and define a parameterless
29784 procedure called @code{Requires_Body}, which must then be given a dummy
29785 procedure body in the package body, which then becomes required.
29786 Another approach (assuming that this does not introduce elaboration
29787 circularities) is to add an @code{Elaborate_Body} pragma to the package spec,
29788 since one effect of this pragma is to require the presence of a package body.
29789
29790 @item @code{Numeric_Error} is now the same as @code{Constraint_Error}
29791 In Ada 95, the exception @code{Numeric_Error} is a renaming of
29792 @code{Constraint_Error}.
29793 This means that it is illegal to have separate exception handlers for
29794 the two exceptions. The fix is simply to remove the handler for the
29795 @code{Numeric_Error} case (since even in Ada 83, a compiler was free to raise
29796 @code{Constraint_Error} in place of @code{Numeric_Error} in all cases).
29797
29798 @item Indefinite subtypes in generics
29799 In Ada 83, it was permissible to pass an indefinite type (e.g.@: @code{String})
29800 as the actual for a generic formal private type, but then the instantiation
29801 would be illegal if there were any instances of declarations of variables
29802 of this type in the generic body. In Ada 95, to avoid this clear violation
29803 of the methodological principle known as the ``contract model'',
29804 the generic declaration explicitly indicates whether
29805 or not such instantiations are permitted. If a generic formal parameter
29806 has explicit unknown discriminants, indicated by using @code{(<>)} after the
29807 type name, then it can be instantiated with indefinite types, but no
29808 stand-alone variables can be declared of this type. Any attempt to declare
29809 such a variable will result in an illegality at the time the generic is
29810 declared. If the @code{(<>)} notation is not used, then it is illegal
29811 to instantiate the generic with an indefinite type.
29812 This is the potential incompatibility issue when porting Ada 83 code to Ada 95.
29813 It will show up as a compile time error, and
29814 the fix is usually simply to add the @code{(<>)} to the generic declaration.
29815 @end table
29816
29817 @node More deterministic semantics
29818 @subsection More deterministic semantics
29819
29820 @table @emph
29821 @item Conversions
29822 Conversions from real types to integer types round away from 0. In Ada 83
29823 the conversion Integer(2.5) could deliver either 2 or 3 as its value. This
29824 implementation freedom was intended to support unbiased rounding in
29825 statistical applications, but in practice it interfered with portability.
29826 In Ada 95 the conversion semantics are unambiguous, and rounding away from 0
29827 is required. Numeric code may be affected by this change in semantics.
29828 Note, though, that this issue is no worse than already existed in Ada 83
29829 when porting code from one vendor to another.
29830
29831 @item Tasking
29832 The Real-Time Annex introduces a set of policies that define the behavior of
29833 features that were implementation dependent in Ada 83, such as the order in
29834 which open select branches are executed.
29835 @end table
29836
29837 @node Changed semantics
29838 @subsection Changed semantics
29839
29840 @noindent
29841 The worst kind of incompatibility is one where a program that is legal in
29842 Ada 83 is also legal in Ada 95 but can have an effect in Ada 95 that was not
29843 possible in Ada 83. Fortunately this is extremely rare, but the one
29844 situation that you should be alert to is the change in the predefined type
29845 @code{Character} from 7-bit ASCII to 8-bit Latin-1.
29846
29847 @table @emph
29848 @item Range of type @code{Character}
29849 The range of @code{Standard.Character} is now the full 256 characters
29850 of Latin-1, whereas in most Ada 83 implementations it was restricted
29851 to 128 characters. Although some of the effects of
29852 this change will be manifest in compile-time rejection of legal
29853 Ada 83 programs it is possible for a working Ada 83 program to have
29854 a different effect in Ada 95, one that was not permitted in Ada 83.
29855 As an example, the expression
29856 @code{Character'Pos(Character'Last)} returned @code{127} in Ada 83 and now
29857 delivers @code{255} as its value.
29858 In general, you should look at the logic of any
29859 character-processing Ada 83 program and see whether it needs to be adapted
29860 to work correctly with Latin-1. Note that the predefined Ada 95 API has a
29861 character handling package that may be relevant if code needs to be adapted
29862 to account for the additional Latin-1 elements.
29863 The desirable fix is to
29864 modify the program to accommodate the full character set, but in some cases
29865 it may be convenient to define a subtype or derived type of Character that
29866 covers only the restricted range.
29867 @cindex Latin-1
29868 @end table
29869
29870 @node Other language compatibility issues
29871 @subsection Other language compatibility issues
29872
29873 @table @emph
29874 @item @option{-gnat83} switch
29875 All implementations of GNAT provide a switch that causes GNAT to operate
29876 in Ada 83 mode. In this mode, some but not all compatibility problems
29877 of the type described above are handled automatically. For example, the
29878 new reserved words introduced in Ada 95 and Ada 2005 are treated simply
29879 as identifiers as in Ada 83.
29880 However,
29881 in practice, it is usually advisable to make the necessary modifications
29882 to the program to remove the need for using this switch.
29883 See @ref{Compiling Different Versions of Ada}.
29884
29885 @item Support for removed Ada 83 pragmas and attributes
29886 A number of pragmas and attributes from Ada 83 were removed from Ada 95,
29887 generally because they were replaced by other mechanisms. Ada 95 and Ada 2005
29888 compilers are allowed, but not required, to implement these missing
29889 elements. In contrast with some other compilers, GNAT implements all
29890 such pragmas and attributes, eliminating this compatibility concern. These
29891 include @code{pragma Interface} and the floating point type attributes
29892 (@code{Emax}, @code{Mantissa}, etc.), among other items.
29893 @end table
29894
29895
29896 @node Compatibility between Ada 95 and Ada 2005
29897 @section Compatibility between Ada 95 and Ada 2005
29898 @cindex Compatibility between Ada 95 and Ada 2005
29899
29900 @noindent
29901 Although Ada 2005 was designed to be upwards compatible with Ada 95, there are
29902 a number of incompatibilities. Several are enumerated below;
29903 for a complete description please see the
29904 Annotated Ada 2005 Reference Manual, or section 9.1.1 in
29905 @cite{Rationale for Ada 2005}.
29906
29907 @table @emph
29908 @item New reserved words.
29909 The words @code{interface}, @code{overriding} and @code{synchronized} are
29910 reserved in Ada 2005.
29911 A pre-Ada 2005 program that uses any of these as an identifier will be
29912 illegal.
29913
29914 @item New declarations in predefined packages.
29915 A number of packages in the predefined environment contain new declarations:
29916 @code{Ada.Exceptions}, @code{Ada.Real_Time}, @code{Ada.Strings},
29917 @code{Ada.Strings.Fixed}, @code{Ada.Strings.Bounded},
29918 @code{Ada.Strings.Unbounded}, @code{Ada.Strings.Wide_Fixed},
29919 @code{Ada.Strings.Wide_Bounded}, @code{Ada.Strings.Wide_Unbounded},
29920 @code{Ada.Tags}, @code{Ada.Text_IO}, and @code{Interfaces.C}.
29921 If an Ada 95 program does a @code{with} and @code{use} of any of these
29922 packages, the new declarations may cause name clashes.
29923
29924 @item Access parameters.
29925 A nondispatching subprogram with an access parameter cannot be renamed
29926 as a dispatching operation. This was permitted in Ada 95.
29927
29928 @item Access types, discriminants, and constraints.
29929 Rule changes in this area have led to some incompatibilities; for example,
29930 constrained subtypes of some access types are not permitted in Ada 2005.
29931
29932 @item Aggregates for limited types.
29933 The allowance of aggregates for limited types in Ada 2005 raises the
29934 possibility of ambiguities in legal Ada 95 programs, since additional types
29935 now need to be considered in expression resolution.
29936
29937 @item Fixed-point multiplication and division.
29938 Certain expressions involving ``*'' or ``/'' for a fixed-point type, which
29939 were legal in Ada 95 and invoked the predefined versions of these operations,
29940 are now ambiguous.
29941 The ambiguity may be resolved either by applying a type conversion to the
29942 expression, or by explicitly invoking the operation from package
29943 @code{Standard}.
29944
29945 @item Return-by-reference types.
29946 The Ada 95 return-by-reference mechanism has been removed. Instead, the user
29947 can declare a function returning a value from an anonymous access type.
29948 @end table
29949
29950
29951 @node Implementation-dependent characteristics
29952 @section Implementation-dependent characteristics
29953 @noindent
29954 Although the Ada language defines the semantics of each construct as
29955 precisely as practical, in some situations (for example for reasons of
29956 efficiency, or where the effect is heavily dependent on the host or target
29957 platform) the implementation is allowed some freedom. In porting Ada 83
29958 code to GNAT, you need to be aware of whether / how the existing code
29959 exercised such implementation dependencies. Such characteristics fall into
29960 several categories, and GNAT offers specific support in assisting the
29961 transition from certain Ada 83 compilers.
29962
29963 @menu
29964 * Implementation-defined pragmas::
29965 * Implementation-defined attributes::
29966 * Libraries::
29967 * Elaboration order::
29968 * Target-specific aspects::
29969 @end menu
29970
29971 @node Implementation-defined pragmas
29972 @subsection Implementation-defined pragmas
29973
29974 @noindent
29975 Ada compilers are allowed to supplement the language-defined pragmas, and
29976 these are a potential source of non-portability. All GNAT-defined pragmas
29977 are described in @ref{Implementation Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT
29978 Reference Manual}, and these include several that are specifically
29979 intended to correspond to other vendors' Ada 83 pragmas.
29980 For migrating from VADS, the pragma @code{Use_VADS_Size} may be useful.
29981 For compatibility with HP Ada 83, GNAT supplies the pragmas
29982 @code{Extend_System}, @code{Ident}, @code{Inline_Generic},
29983 @code{Interface_Name}, @code{Passive}, @code{Suppress_All},
29984 and @code{Volatile}.
29985 Other relevant pragmas include @code{External} and @code{Link_With}.
29986 Some vendor-specific
29987 Ada 83 pragmas (@code{Share_Generic}, @code{Subtitle}, and @code{Title}) are
29988 recognized, thus
29989 avoiding compiler rejection of units that contain such pragmas; they are not
29990 relevant in a GNAT context and hence are not otherwise implemented.
29991
29992 @node Implementation-defined attributes
29993 @subsection Implementation-defined attributes
29994
29995 Analogous to pragmas, the set of attributes may be extended by an
29996 implementation. All GNAT-defined attributes are described in
29997 @ref{Implementation Defined Attributes,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference
29998 Manual}, and these include several that are specifically intended
29999 to correspond to other vendors' Ada 83 attributes. For migrating from VADS,
30000 the attribute @code{VADS_Size} may be useful. For compatibility with HP
30001 Ada 83, GNAT supplies the attributes @code{Bit}, @code{Machine_Size} and
30002 @code{Type_Class}.
30003
30004 @node Libraries
30005 @subsection Libraries
30006 @noindent
30007 Vendors may supply libraries to supplement the standard Ada API. If Ada 83
30008 code uses vendor-specific libraries then there are several ways to manage
30009 this in Ada 95 or Ada 2005:
30010 @enumerate
30011 @item
30012 If the source code for the libraries (specs and bodies) are
30013 available, then the libraries can be migrated in the same way as the
30014 application.
30015 @item
30016 If the source code for the specs but not the bodies are
30017 available, then you can reimplement the bodies.
30018 @item
30019 Some features introduced by Ada 95 obviate the need for library support. For
30020 example most Ada 83 vendors supplied a package for unsigned integers. The
30021 Ada 95 modular type feature is the preferred way to handle this need, so
30022 instead of migrating or reimplementing the unsigned integer package it may
30023 be preferable to retrofit the application using modular types.
30024 @end enumerate
30025
30026 @node Elaboration order
30027 @subsection Elaboration order
30028 @noindent
30029 The implementation can choose any elaboration order consistent with the unit
30030 dependency relationship. This freedom means that some orders can result in
30031 Program_Error being raised due to an ``Access Before Elaboration'': an attempt
30032 to invoke a subprogram its body has been elaborated, or to instantiate a
30033 generic before the generic body has been elaborated. By default GNAT
30034 attempts to choose a safe order (one that will not encounter access before
30035 elaboration problems) by implicitly inserting @code{Elaborate} or
30036 @code{Elaborate_All} pragmas where
30037 needed. However, this can lead to the creation of elaboration circularities
30038 and a resulting rejection of the program by gnatbind. This issue is
30039 thoroughly described in @ref{Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT}.
30040 In brief, there are several
30041 ways to deal with this situation:
30042
30043 @itemize @bullet
30044 @item
30045 Modify the program to eliminate the circularities, e.g.@: by moving
30046 elaboration-time code into explicitly-invoked procedures
30047 @item
30048 Constrain the elaboration order by including explicit @code{Elaborate_Body} or
30049 @code{Elaborate} pragmas, and then inhibit the generation of implicit
30050 @code{Elaborate_All}
30051 pragmas either globally (as an effect of the @option{-gnatE} switch) or locally
30052 (by selectively suppressing elaboration checks via pragma
30053 @code{Suppress(Elaboration_Check)} when it is safe to do so).
30054 @end itemize
30055
30056 @node Target-specific aspects
30057 @subsection Target-specific aspects
30058 @noindent
30059 Low-level applications need to deal with machine addresses, data
30060 representations, interfacing with assembler code, and similar issues. If
30061 such an Ada 83 application is being ported to different target hardware (for
30062 example where the byte endianness has changed) then you will need to
30063 carefully examine the program logic; the porting effort will heavily depend
30064 on the robustness of the original design. Moreover, Ada 95 (and thus
30065 Ada 2005) are sometimes
30066 incompatible with typical Ada 83 compiler practices regarding implicit
30067 packing, the meaning of the Size attribute, and the size of access values.
30068 GNAT's approach to these issues is described in @ref{Representation Clauses}.
30069
30070 @node Compatibility with Other Ada Systems
30071 @section Compatibility with Other Ada Systems
30072
30073 @noindent
30074 If programs avoid the use of implementation dependent and
30075 implementation defined features, as documented in the @cite{Ada
30076 Reference Manual}, there should be a high degree of portability between
30077 GNAT and other Ada systems. The following are specific items which
30078 have proved troublesome in moving Ada 95 programs from GNAT to other Ada 95
30079 compilers, but do not affect porting code to GNAT@.
30080 (As of @value{NOW}, GNAT is the only compiler available for Ada 2005;
30081 the following issues may or may not arise for Ada 2005 programs
30082 when other compilers appear.)
30083
30084 @table @emph
30085 @item Ada 83 Pragmas and Attributes
30086 Ada 95 compilers are allowed, but not required, to implement the missing
30087 Ada 83 pragmas and attributes that are no longer defined in Ada 95.
30088 GNAT implements all such pragmas and attributes, eliminating this as
30089 a compatibility concern, but some other Ada 95 compilers reject these
30090 pragmas and attributes.
30091
30092 @item Specialized Needs Annexes
30093 GNAT implements the full set of special needs annexes. At the
30094 current time, it is the only Ada 95 compiler to do so. This means that
30095 programs making use of these features may not be portable to other Ada
30096 95 compilation systems.
30097
30098 @item Representation Clauses
30099 Some other Ada 95 compilers implement only the minimal set of
30100 representation clauses required by the Ada 95 reference manual. GNAT goes
30101 far beyond this minimal set, as described in the next section.
30102 @end table
30103
30104 @node Representation Clauses
30105 @section Representation Clauses
30106
30107 @noindent
30108 The Ada 83 reference manual was quite vague in describing both the minimal
30109 required implementation of representation clauses, and also their precise
30110 effects. Ada 95 (and thus also Ada 2005) are much more explicit, but the
30111 minimal set of capabilities required is still quite limited.
30112
30113 GNAT implements the full required set of capabilities in
30114 Ada 95 and Ada 2005, but also goes much further, and in particular
30115 an effort has been made to be compatible with existing Ada 83 usage to the
30116 greatest extent possible.
30117
30118 A few cases exist in which Ada 83 compiler behavior is incompatible with
30119 the requirements in Ada 95 (and thus also Ada 2005). These are instances of
30120 intentional or accidental dependence on specific implementation dependent
30121 characteristics of these Ada 83 compilers. The following is a list of
30122 the cases most likely to arise in existing Ada 83 code.
30123
30124 @table @emph
30125 @item Implicit Packing
30126 Some Ada 83 compilers allowed a Size specification to cause implicit
30127 packing of an array or record. This could cause expensive implicit
30128 conversions for change of representation in the presence of derived
30129 types, and the Ada design intends to avoid this possibility.
30130 Subsequent AI's were issued to make it clear that such implicit
30131 change of representation in response to a Size clause is inadvisable,
30132 and this recommendation is represented explicitly in the Ada 95 (and Ada 2005)
30133 Reference Manuals as implementation advice that is followed by GNAT@.
30134 The problem will show up as an error
30135 message rejecting the size clause. The fix is simply to provide
30136 the explicit pragma @code{Pack}, or for more fine tuned control, provide
30137 a Component_Size clause.
30138
30139 @item Meaning of Size Attribute
30140 The Size attribute in Ada 95 (and Ada 2005) for discrete types is defined as
30141 the minimal number of bits required to hold values of the type. For example,
30142 on a 32-bit machine, the size of @code{Natural} will typically be 31 and not
30143 32 (since no sign bit is required). Some Ada 83 compilers gave 31, and
30144 some 32 in this situation. This problem will usually show up as a compile
30145 time error, but not always. It is a good idea to check all uses of the
30146 'Size attribute when porting Ada 83 code. The GNAT specific attribute
30147 Object_Size can provide a useful way of duplicating the behavior of
30148 some Ada 83 compiler systems.
30149
30150 @item Size of Access Types
30151 A common assumption in Ada 83 code is that an access type is in fact a pointer,
30152 and that therefore it will be the same size as a System.Address value. This
30153 assumption is true for GNAT in most cases with one exception. For the case of
30154 a pointer to an unconstrained array type (where the bounds may vary from one
30155 value of the access type to another), the default is to use a ``fat pointer'',
30156 which is represented as two separate pointers, one to the bounds, and one to
30157 the array. This representation has a number of advantages, including improved
30158 efficiency. However, it may cause some difficulties in porting existing Ada 83
30159 code which makes the assumption that, for example, pointers fit in 32 bits on
30160 a machine with 32-bit addressing.
30161
30162 To get around this problem, GNAT also permits the use of ``thin pointers'' for
30163 access types in this case (where the designated type is an unconstrained array
30164 type). These thin pointers are indeed the same size as a System.Address value.
30165 To specify a thin pointer, use a size clause for the type, for example:
30166
30167 @smallexample @c ada
30168 type X is access all String;
30169 for X'Size use Standard'Address_Size;
30170 @end smallexample
30171
30172 @noindent
30173 which will cause the type X to be represented using a single pointer.
30174 When using this representation, the bounds are right behind the array.
30175 This representation is slightly less efficient, and does not allow quite
30176 such flexibility in the use of foreign pointers or in using the
30177 Unrestricted_Access attribute to create pointers to non-aliased objects.
30178 But for any standard portable use of the access type it will work in
30179 a functionally correct manner and allow porting of existing code.
30180 Note that another way of forcing a thin pointer representation
30181 is to use a component size clause for the element size in an array,
30182 or a record representation clause for an access field in a record.
30183 @end table
30184
30185 @ifclear vms
30186 @c This brief section is only in the non-VMS version
30187 @c The complete chapter on HP Ada is in the VMS version
30188 @node Compatibility with HP Ada 83
30189 @section Compatibility with HP Ada 83
30190
30191 @noindent
30192 The VMS version of GNAT fully implements all the pragmas and attributes
30193 provided by HP Ada 83, as well as providing the standard HP Ada 83
30194 libraries, including Starlet. In addition, data layouts and parameter
30195 passing conventions are highly compatible. This means that porting
30196 existing HP Ada 83 code to GNAT in VMS systems should be easier than
30197 most other porting efforts. The following are some of the most
30198 significant differences between GNAT and HP Ada 83.
30199
30200 @table @emph
30201 @item Default floating-point representation
30202 In GNAT, the default floating-point format is IEEE, whereas in HP Ada 83,
30203 it is VMS format. GNAT does implement the necessary pragmas
30204 (Long_Float, Float_Representation) for changing this default.
30205
30206 @item System
30207 The package System in GNAT exactly corresponds to the definition in the
30208 Ada 95 reference manual, which means that it excludes many of the
30209 HP Ada 83 extensions. However, a separate package Aux_DEC is provided
30210 that contains the additional definitions, and a special pragma,
30211 Extend_System allows this package to be treated transparently as an
30212 extension of package System.
30213
30214 @item To_Address
30215 The definitions provided by Aux_DEC are exactly compatible with those
30216 in the HP Ada 83 version of System, with one exception.
30217 HP Ada provides the following declarations:
30218
30219 @smallexample @c ada
30220 TO_ADDRESS (INTEGER)
30221 TO_ADDRESS (UNSIGNED_LONGWORD)
30222 TO_ADDRESS (@i{universal_integer})
30223 @end smallexample
30224
30225 @noindent
30226 The version of TO_ADDRESS taking a @i{universal integer} argument is in fact
30227 an extension to Ada 83 not strictly compatible with the reference manual.
30228 In GNAT, we are constrained to be exactly compatible with the standard,
30229 and this means we cannot provide this capability. In HP Ada 83, the
30230 point of this definition is to deal with a call like:
30231
30232 @smallexample @c ada
30233 TO_ADDRESS (16#12777#);
30234 @end smallexample
30235
30236 @noindent
30237 Normally, according to the Ada 83 standard, one would expect this to be
30238 ambiguous, since it matches both the INTEGER and UNSIGNED_LONGWORD forms
30239 of TO_ADDRESS@. However, in HP Ada 83, there is no ambiguity, since the
30240 definition using @i{universal_integer} takes precedence.
30241
30242 In GNAT, since the version with @i{universal_integer} cannot be supplied, it
30243 is not possible to be 100% compatible. Since there are many programs using
30244 numeric constants for the argument to TO_ADDRESS, the decision in GNAT was
30245 to change the name of the function in the UNSIGNED_LONGWORD case, so the
30246 declarations provided in the GNAT version of AUX_Dec are:
30247
30248 @smallexample @c ada
30249 function To_Address (X : Integer) return Address;
30250 pragma Pure_Function (To_Address);
30251
30252 function To_Address_Long (X : Unsigned_Longword)
30253 return Address;
30254 pragma Pure_Function (To_Address_Long);
30255 @end smallexample
30256
30257 @noindent
30258 This means that programs using TO_ADDRESS for UNSIGNED_LONGWORD must
30259 change the name to TO_ADDRESS_LONG@.
30260
30261 @item Task_Id values
30262 The Task_Id values assigned will be different in the two systems, and GNAT
30263 does not provide a specified value for the Task_Id of the environment task,
30264 which in GNAT is treated like any other declared task.
30265 @end table
30266
30267 @noindent
30268 For full details on these and other less significant compatibility issues,
30269 see appendix E of the HP publication entitled @cite{HP Ada, Technical
30270 Overview and Comparison on HP Platforms}.
30271
30272 For GNAT running on other than VMS systems, all the HP Ada 83 pragmas and
30273 attributes are recognized, although only a subset of them can sensibly
30274 be implemented. The description of pragmas in @ref{Implementation
30275 Defined Pragmas,,, gnat_rm, GNAT Reference Manual}
30276 indicates whether or not they are applicable to non-VMS systems.
30277 @end ifclear
30278
30279 @ifset vms
30280 @node Transitioning to 64-Bit GNAT for OpenVMS
30281 @section Transitioning to 64-Bit @value{EDITION} for OpenVMS
30282
30283 @noindent
30284 This section is meant to assist users of pre-2006 @value{EDITION}
30285 for Alpha OpenVMS who are transitioning to 64-bit @value{EDITION},
30286 the version of the GNAT technology supplied in 2006 and later for
30287 OpenVMS on both Alpha and I64.
30288
30289 @menu
30290 * Introduction to transitioning::
30291 * Migration of 32 bit code::
30292 * Taking advantage of 64 bit addressing::
30293 * Technical details::
30294 @end menu
30295
30296 @node Introduction to transitioning
30297 @subsection Introduction
30298
30299 @noindent
30300 64-bit @value{EDITION} for Open VMS has been designed to meet
30301 three main goals:
30302
30303 @enumerate
30304 @item
30305 Providing a full conforming implementation of Ada 95 and Ada 2005
30306
30307 @item
30308 Allowing maximum backward compatibility, thus easing migration of existing
30309 Ada source code
30310
30311 @item
30312 Supplying a path for exploiting the full 64-bit address range
30313 @end enumerate
30314
30315 @noindent
30316 Ada's strong typing semantics has made it
30317 impractical to have different 32-bit and 64-bit modes. As soon as
30318 one object could possibly be outside the 32-bit address space, this
30319 would make it necessary for the @code{System.Address} type to be 64 bits.
30320 In particular, this would cause inconsistencies if 32-bit code is
30321 called from 64-bit code that raises an exception.
30322
30323 This issue has been resolved by always using 64-bit addressing
30324 at the system level, but allowing for automatic conversions between
30325 32-bit and 64-bit addresses where required. Thus users who
30326 do not currently require 64-bit addressing capabilities, can
30327 recompile their code with only minimal changes (and indeed
30328 if the code is written in portable Ada, with no assumptions about
30329 the size of the @code{Address} type, then no changes at all are necessary).
30330 At the same time,
30331 this approach provides a simple, gradual upgrade path to future
30332 use of larger memories than available for 32-bit systems.
30333 Also, newly written applications or libraries will by default
30334 be fully compatible with future systems exploiting 64-bit
30335 addressing capabilities.
30336
30337 @ref{Migration of 32 bit code}, will focus on porting applications
30338 that do not require more than 2 GB of
30339 addressable memory. This code will be referred to as
30340 @emph{32-bit code}.
30341 For applications intending to exploit the full 64-bit address space,
30342 @ref{Taking advantage of 64 bit addressing},
30343 will consider further changes that may be required.
30344 Such code will be referred to below as @emph{64-bit code}.
30345
30346 @node Migration of 32 bit code
30347 @subsection Migration of 32-bit code
30348
30349 @menu
30350 * Address types::
30351 * Access types::
30352 * Unchecked conversions::
30353 * Predefined constants::
30354 * Interfacing with C::
30355 * Experience with source compatibility::
30356 @end menu
30357
30358 @node Address types
30359 @subsubsection Address types
30360
30361 @noindent
30362 To solve the problem of mixing 64-bit and 32-bit addressing,
30363 while maintaining maximum backward compatibility, the following
30364 approach has been taken:
30365
30366 @itemize @bullet
30367 @item
30368 @code{System.Address} always has a size of 64 bits
30369
30370 @item
30371 @code{System.Short_Address} is a 32-bit subtype of @code{System.Address}
30372 @end itemize
30373
30374 @noindent
30375 Since @code{System.Short_Address} is a subtype of @code{System.Address},
30376 a @code{Short_Address}
30377 may be used where an @code{Address} is required, and vice versa, without
30378 needing explicit type conversions.
30379 By virtue of the Open VMS parameter passing conventions,
30380 even imported
30381 and exported subprograms that have 32-bit address parameters are
30382 compatible with those that have 64-bit address parameters.
30383 (See @ref{Making code 64 bit clean} for details.)
30384
30385 The areas that may need attention are those where record types have
30386 been defined that contain components of the type @code{System.Address}, and
30387 where objects of this type are passed to code expecting a record layout with
30388 32-bit addresses.
30389
30390 Different compilers on different platforms cannot be
30391 expected to represent the same type in the same way,
30392 since alignment constraints
30393 and other system-dependent properties affect the compiler's decision.
30394 For that reason, Ada code
30395 generally uses representation clauses to specify the expected
30396 layout where required.
30397
30398 If such a representation clause uses 32 bits for a component having
30399 the type @code{System.Address}, 64-bit @value{EDITION} for OpenVMS
30400 will detect that error and produce a specific diagnostic message.
30401 The developer should then determine whether the representation
30402 should be 64 bits or not and make either of two changes:
30403 change the size to 64 bits and leave the type as @code{System.Address}, or
30404 leave the size as 32 bits and change the type to @code{System.Short_Address}.
30405 Since @code{Short_Address} is a subtype of @code{Address}, no changes are
30406 required in any code setting or accessing the field; the compiler will
30407 automatically perform any needed conversions between address
30408 formats.
30409
30410 @node Access types
30411 @subsubsection Access types
30412
30413 @noindent
30414 By default, objects designated by access values are always
30415 allocated in the 32-bit
30416 address space. Thus legacy code will never contain
30417 any objects that are not addressable with 32-bit addresses, and
30418 the compiler will never raise exceptions as result of mixing
30419 32-bit and 64-bit addresses.
30420
30421 However, the access values themselves are represented in 64 bits, for optimum
30422 performance and future compatibility with 64-bit code. As was
30423 the case with @code{System.Address}, the compiler will give an error message
30424 if an object or record component has a representation clause that
30425 requires the access value to fit in 32 bits. In such a situation,
30426 an explicit size clause for the access type, specifying 32 bits,
30427 will have the desired effect.
30428
30429 General access types (declared with @code{access all}) can never be
30430 32 bits, as values of such types must be able to refer to any object
30431 of the designated type,
30432 including objects residing outside the 32-bit address range.
30433 Existing Ada 83 code will not contain such type definitions,
30434 however, since general access types were introduced in Ada 95.
30435
30436 @node Unchecked conversions
30437 @subsubsection Unchecked conversions
30438
30439 @noindent
30440 In the case of an @code{Unchecked_Conversion} where the source type is a
30441 64-bit access type or the type @code{System.Address}, and the target
30442 type is a 32-bit type, the compiler will generate a warning.
30443 Even though the generated code will still perform the required
30444 conversions, it is highly recommended in these cases to use
30445 respectively a 32-bit access type or @code{System.Short_Address}
30446 as the source type.
30447
30448 @node Predefined constants
30449 @subsubsection Predefined constants
30450
30451 @noindent
30452 The following table shows the correspondence between pre-2006 versions of
30453 @value{EDITION} on Alpha OpenVMS (``Old'') and 64-bit @value{EDITION}
30454 (``New''):
30455
30456 @multitable {@code{System.Short_Memory_Size}} {2**32} {2**64}
30457 @item @b{Constant} @tab @b{Old} @tab @b{New}
30458 @item @code{System.Word_Size} @tab 32 @tab 64
30459 @item @code{System.Memory_Size} @tab 2**32 @tab 2**64
30460 @item @code{System.Short_Memory_Size} @tab 2**32 @tab 2**32
30461 @item @code{System.Address_Size} @tab 32 @tab 64
30462 @end multitable
30463
30464 @noindent
30465 If you need to refer to the specific
30466 memory size of a 32-bit implementation, instead of the
30467 actual memory size, use @code{System.Short_Memory_Size}
30468 rather than @code{System.Memory_Size}.
30469 Similarly, references to @code{System.Address_Size} may need
30470 to be replaced by @code{System.Short_Address'Size}.
30471 The program @command{gnatfind} may be useful for locating
30472 references to the above constants, so that you can verify that they
30473 are still correct.
30474
30475 @node Interfacing with C
30476 @subsubsection Interfacing with C
30477
30478 @noindent
30479 In order to minimize the impact of the transition to 64-bit addresses on
30480 legacy programs, some fundamental types in the @code{Interfaces.C}
30481 package hierarchy continue to be represented in 32 bits.
30482 These types are: @code{ptrdiff_t}, @code{size_t}, and @code{chars_ptr}.
30483 This eases integration with the default HP C layout choices, for example
30484 as found in the system routines in @code{DECC$SHR.EXE}.
30485 Because of this implementation choice, the type fully compatible with
30486 @code{chars_ptr} is now @code{Short_Address} and not @code{Address}.
30487 Depending on the context the compiler will issue a
30488 warning or an error when type @code{Address} is used, alerting the user to a
30489 potential problem. Otherwise 32-bit programs that use
30490 @code{Interfaces.C} should normally not require code modifications
30491
30492 The other issue arising with C interfacing concerns pragma @code{Convention}.
30493 For VMS 64-bit systems, there is an issue of the appropriate default size
30494 of C convention pointers in the absence of an explicit size clause. The HP
30495 C compiler can choose either 32 or 64 bits depending on compiler options.
30496 GNAT chooses 32-bits rather than 64-bits in the default case where no size
30497 clause is given. This proves a better choice for porting 32-bit legacy
30498 applications. In order to have a 64-bit representation, it is necessary to
30499 specify a size representation clause. For example:
30500
30501 @smallexample @c ada
30502 type int_star is access Interfaces.C.int;
30503 pragma Convention(C, int_star);
30504 for int_star'Size use 64; -- Necessary to get 64 and not 32 bits
30505 @end smallexample
30506
30507 @node Experience with source compatibility
30508 @subsubsection Experience with source compatibility
30509
30510 @noindent
30511 The Security Server and STARLET on I64 provide an interesting ``test case''
30512 for source compatibility issues, since it is in such system code
30513 where assumptions about @code{Address} size might be expected to occur.
30514 Indeed, there were a small number of occasions in the Security Server
30515 file @file{jibdef.ads}
30516 where a representation clause for a record type specified
30517 32 bits for a component of type @code{Address}.
30518 All of these errors were detected by the compiler.
30519 The repair was obvious and immediate; to simply replace @code{Address} by
30520 @code{Short_Address}.
30521
30522 In the case of STARLET, there were several record types that should
30523 have had representation clauses but did not. In these record types
30524 there was an implicit assumption that an @code{Address} value occupied
30525 32 bits.
30526 These compiled without error, but their usage resulted in run-time error
30527 returns from STARLET system calls.
30528 Future GNAT technology enhancements may include a tool that detects and flags
30529 these sorts of potential source code porting problems.
30530
30531 @c ****************************************
30532 @node Taking advantage of 64 bit addressing
30533 @subsection Taking advantage of 64-bit addressing
30534
30535 @menu
30536 * Making code 64 bit clean::
30537 * Allocating memory from the 64 bit storage pool::
30538 * Restrictions on use of 64 bit objects::
30539 * Using 64 bit storage pools by default::
30540 * General access types::
30541 * STARLET and other predefined libraries::
30542 @end menu
30543
30544 @node Making code 64 bit clean
30545 @subsubsection Making code 64-bit clean
30546
30547 @noindent
30548 In order to prevent problems that may occur when (parts of) a
30549 system start using memory outside the 32-bit address range,
30550 we recommend some additional guidelines:
30551
30552 @itemize @bullet
30553 @item
30554 For imported subprograms that take parameters of the
30555 type @code{System.Address}, ensure that these subprograms can
30556 indeed handle 64-bit addresses. If not, or when in doubt,
30557 change the subprogram declaration to specify
30558 @code{System.Short_Address} instead.
30559
30560 @item
30561 Resolve all warnings related to size mismatches in
30562 unchecked conversions. Failing to do so causes
30563 erroneous execution if the source object is outside
30564 the 32-bit address space.
30565
30566 @item
30567 (optional) Explicitly use the 32-bit storage pool
30568 for access types used in a 32-bit context, or use
30569 generic access types where possible
30570 (@pxref{Restrictions on use of 64 bit objects}).
30571 @end itemize
30572
30573 @noindent
30574 If these rules are followed, the compiler will automatically insert
30575 any necessary checks to ensure that no addresses or access values
30576 passed to 32-bit code ever refer to objects outside the 32-bit
30577 address range.
30578 Any attempt to do this will raise @code{Constraint_Error}.
30579
30580 @node Allocating memory from the 64 bit storage pool
30581 @subsubsection Allocating memory from the 64-bit storage pool
30582
30583 @noindent
30584 For any access type @code{T} that potentially requires memory allocations
30585 beyond the 32-bit address space,
30586 use the following representation clause:
30587
30588 @smallexample @c ada
30589 for T'Storage_Pool use System.Pool_64;
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592 @node Restrictions on use of 64 bit objects
30593 @subsubsection Restrictions on use of 64-bit objects
30594
30595 @noindent
30596 Taking the address of an object allocated from a 64-bit storage pool,
30597 and then passing this address to a subprogram expecting
30598 @code{System.Short_Address},
30599 or assigning it to a variable of type @code{Short_Address}, will cause
30600 @code{Constraint_Error} to be raised. In case the code is not 64-bit clean
30601 (@pxref{Making code 64 bit clean}), or checks are suppressed,
30602 no exception is raised and execution
30603 will become erroneous.
30604
30605 @node Using 64 bit storage pools by default
30606 @subsubsection Using 64-bit storage pools by default
30607
30608 @noindent
30609 In some cases it may be desirable to have the compiler allocate
30610 from 64-bit storage pools by default. This may be the case for
30611 libraries that are 64-bit clean, but may be used in both 32-bit
30612 and 64-bit contexts. For these cases the following configuration
30613 pragma may be specified:
30614
30615 @smallexample @c ada
30616 pragma Pool_64_Default;
30617 @end smallexample
30618
30619 @noindent
30620 Any code compiled in the context of this pragma will by default
30621 use the @code{System.Pool_64} storage pool. This default may be overridden
30622 for a specific access type @code{T} by the representation clause:
30623
30624 @smallexample @c ada
30625 for T'Storage_Pool use System.Pool_32;
30626 @end smallexample
30627
30628 @noindent
30629 Any object whose address may be passed to a subprogram with a
30630 @code{Short_Address} argument, or assigned to a variable of type
30631 @code{Short_Address}, needs to be allocated from this pool.
30632
30633 @node General access types
30634 @subsubsection General access types
30635
30636 @noindent
30637 Objects designated by access values from a
30638 general access type (declared with @code{access all}) are never allocated
30639 from a 64-bit storage pool. Code that uses general access types will
30640 accept objects allocated in either 32-bit or 64-bit address spaces,
30641 but never allocate objects outside the 32-bit address space.
30642 Using general access types ensures maximum compatibility with both
30643 32-bit and 64-bit code.
30644
30645 @node STARLET and other predefined libraries
30646 @subsubsection STARLET and other predefined libraries
30647
30648 @noindent
30649 All code that comes as part of GNAT is 64-bit clean, but the
30650 restrictions given in @ref{Restrictions on use of 64 bit objects},
30651 still apply. Look at the package
30652 specs to see in which contexts objects allocated
30653 in 64-bit address space are acceptable.
30654
30655 @node Technical details
30656 @subsection Technical details
30657
30658 @noindent
30659 64-bit @value{EDITION} for Open VMS takes advantage of the freedom given in the
30660 Ada standard with respect to the type of @code{System.Address}. Previous
30661 versions of GNAT Pro have defined this type as private and implemented it as a
30662 modular type.
30663
30664 In order to allow defining @code{System.Short_Address} as a proper subtype,
30665 and to match the implicit sign extension in parameter passing,
30666 in 64-bit @value{EDITION} for Open VMS, @code{System.Address} is defined as a
30667 visible (i.e., non-private) integer type.
30668 Standard operations on the type, such as the binary operators ``+'', ``-'',
30669 etc., that take @code{Address} operands and return an @code{Address} result,
30670 have been hidden by declaring these
30671 @code{abstract}, a feature introduced in Ada 95 that helps avoid the potential
30672 ambiguities that would otherwise result from overloading.
30673 (Note that, although @code{Address} is a visible integer type,
30674 good programming practice dictates against exploiting the type's
30675 integer properties such as literals, since this will compromise
30676 code portability.)
30677
30678 Defining @code{Address} as a visible integer type helps achieve
30679 maximum compatibility for existing Ada code,
30680 without sacrificing the capabilities of the 64-bit architecture.
30681 @end ifset
30682
30683 @c ************************************************
30684 @ifset unw
30685 @node Microsoft Windows Topics
30686 @appendix Microsoft Windows Topics
30687 @cindex Windows NT
30688 @cindex Windows 95
30689 @cindex Windows 98
30690
30691 @noindent
30692 This chapter describes topics that are specific to the Microsoft Windows
30693 platforms (NT, 2000, and XP Professional).
30694
30695 @menu
30696 * Using GNAT on Windows::
30697 * Using a network installation of GNAT::
30698 * CONSOLE and WINDOWS subsystems::
30699 * Temporary Files::
30700 * Mixed-Language Programming on Windows::
30701 * Windows Calling Conventions::
30702 * Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)::
30703 * Using DLLs with GNAT::
30704 * Building DLLs with GNAT::
30705 * Building DLLs with GNAT Project files::
30706 * Building DLLs with gnatdll::
30707 * GNAT and Windows Resources::
30708 * Debugging a DLL::
30709 * Setting Stack Size from gnatlink::
30710 * Setting Heap Size from gnatlink::
30711 @end menu
30712
30713 @node Using GNAT on Windows
30714 @section Using GNAT on Windows
30715
30716 @noindent
30717 One of the strengths of the GNAT technology is that its tool set
30718 (@command{gcc}, @command{gnatbind}, @command{gnatlink}, @command{gnatmake}, the
30719 @code{gdb} debugger, etc.) is used in the same way regardless of the
30720 platform.
30721
30722 On Windows this tool set is complemented by a number of Microsoft-specific
30723 tools that have been provided to facilitate interoperability with Windows
30724 when this is required. With these tools:
30725
30726 @itemize @bullet
30727
30728 @item
30729 You can build applications using the @code{CONSOLE} or @code{WINDOWS}
30730 subsystems.
30731
30732 @item
30733 You can use any Dynamically Linked Library (DLL) in your Ada code (both
30734 relocatable and non-relocatable DLLs are supported).
30735
30736 @item
30737 You can build Ada DLLs for use in other applications. These applications
30738 can be written in a language other than Ada (e.g., C, C++, etc). Again both
30739 relocatable and non-relocatable Ada DLLs are supported.
30740
30741 @item
30742 You can include Windows resources in your Ada application.
30743
30744 @item
30745 You can use or create COM/DCOM objects.
30746 @end itemize
30747
30748 @noindent
30749 Immediately below are listed all known general GNAT-for-Windows restrictions.
30750 Other restrictions about specific features like Windows Resources and DLLs
30751 are listed in separate sections below.
30752
30753 @itemize @bullet
30754
30755 @item
30756 It is not possible to use @code{GetLastError} and @code{SetLastError}
30757 when tasking, protected records, or exceptions are used. In these
30758 cases, in order to implement Ada semantics, the GNAT run-time system
30759 calls certain Win32 routines that set the last error variable to 0 upon
30760 success. It should be possible to use @code{GetLastError} and
30761 @code{SetLastError} when tasking, protected record, and exception
30762 features are not used, but it is not guaranteed to work.
30763
30764 @item
30765 It is not possible to link against Microsoft libraries except for
30766 import libraries. The library must be built to be compatible with
30767 @file{MSVCRT.LIB} (/MD Microsoft compiler option), @file{LIBC.LIB} and
30768 @file{LIBCMT.LIB} (/ML or /MT Microsoft compiler options) are known to
30769 not be compatible with the GNAT runtime. Even if the library is
30770 compatible with @file{MSVCRT.LIB} it is not guaranteed to work.
30771
30772 @item
30773 When the compilation environment is located on FAT32 drives, users may
30774 experience recompilations of the source files that have not changed if
30775 Daylight Saving Time (DST) state has changed since the last time files
30776 were compiled. NTFS drives do not have this problem.
30777
30778 @item
30779 No components of the GNAT toolset use any entries in the Windows
30780 registry. The only entries that can be created are file associations and
30781 PATH settings, provided the user has chosen to create them at installation
30782 time, as well as some minimal book-keeping information needed to correctly
30783 uninstall or integrate different GNAT products.
30784 @end itemize
30785
30786 @node Using a network installation of GNAT
30787 @section Using a network installation of GNAT
30788
30789 @noindent
30790 Make sure the system on which GNAT is installed is accessible from the
30791 current machine, i.e., the install location is shared over the network.
30792 Shared resources are accessed on Windows by means of UNC paths, which
30793 have the format @code{\\server\sharename\path}
30794
30795 In order to use such a network installation, simply add the UNC path of the
30796 @file{bin} directory of your GNAT installation in front of your PATH. For
30797 example, if GNAT is installed in @file{\GNAT} directory of a share location
30798 called @file{c-drive} on a machine @file{LOKI}, the following command will
30799 make it available:
30800
30801 @code{@ @ @ path \\loki\c-drive\gnat\bin;%path%}
30802
30803 Be aware that every compilation using the network installation results in the
30804 transfer of large amounts of data across the network and will likely cause
30805 serious performance penalty.
30806
30807 @node CONSOLE and WINDOWS subsystems
30808 @section CONSOLE and WINDOWS subsystems
30809 @cindex CONSOLE Subsystem
30810 @cindex WINDOWS Subsystem
30811 @cindex -mwindows
30812
30813 @noindent
30814 There are two main subsystems under Windows. The @code{CONSOLE} subsystem
30815 (which is the default subsystem) will always create a console when
30816 launching the application. This is not something desirable when the
30817 application has a Windows GUI. To get rid of this console the
30818 application must be using the @code{WINDOWS} subsystem. To do so
30819 the @option{-mwindows} linker option must be specified.
30820
30821 @smallexample
30822 $ gnatmake winprog -largs -mwindows
30823 @end smallexample
30824
30825 @node Temporary Files
30826 @section Temporary Files
30827 @cindex Temporary files
30828
30829 @noindent
30830 It is possible to control where temporary files gets created by setting
30831 the @env{TMP} environment variable. The file will be created:
30832
30833 @itemize
30834 @item Under the directory pointed to by the @env{TMP} environment variable if
30835 this directory exists.
30836
30837 @item Under @file{c:\temp}, if the @env{TMP} environment variable is not
30838 set (or not pointing to a directory) and if this directory exists.
30839
30840 @item Under the current working directory otherwise.
30841 @end itemize
30842
30843 @noindent
30844 This allows you to determine exactly where the temporary
30845 file will be created. This is particularly useful in networked
30846 environments where you may not have write access to some
30847 directories.
30848
30849 @node Mixed-Language Programming on Windows
30850 @section Mixed-Language Programming on Windows
30851
30852 @noindent
30853 Developing pure Ada applications on Windows is no different than on
30854 other GNAT-supported platforms. However, when developing or porting an
30855 application that contains a mix of Ada and C/C++, the choice of your
30856 Windows C/C++ development environment conditions your overall
30857 interoperability strategy.
30858
30859 If you use @command{gcc} to compile the non-Ada part of your application,
30860 there are no Windows-specific restrictions that affect the overall
30861 interoperability with your Ada code. If you plan to use
30862 Microsoft tools (e.g.@: Microsoft Visual C/C++), you should be aware of
30863 the following limitations:
30864
30865 @itemize @bullet
30866 @item
30867 You cannot link your Ada code with an object or library generated with
30868 Microsoft tools if these use the @code{.tls} section (Thread Local
30869 Storage section) since the GNAT linker does not yet support this section.
30870
30871 @item
30872 You cannot link your Ada code with an object or library generated with
30873 Microsoft tools if these use I/O routines other than those provided in
30874 the Microsoft DLL: @code{msvcrt.dll}. This is because the GNAT run time
30875 uses the services of @code{msvcrt.dll} for its I/Os. Use of other I/O
30876 libraries can cause a conflict with @code{msvcrt.dll} services. For
30877 instance Visual C++ I/O stream routines conflict with those in
30878 @code{msvcrt.dll}.
30879 @end itemize
30880
30881 @noindent
30882 If you do want to use the Microsoft tools for your non-Ada code and hit one
30883 of the above limitations, you have two choices:
30884
30885 @enumerate
30886 @item
30887 Encapsulate your non-Ada code in a DLL to be linked with your Ada
30888 application. In this case, use the Microsoft or whatever environment to
30889 build the DLL and use GNAT to build your executable
30890 (@pxref{Using DLLs with GNAT}).
30891
30892 @item
30893 Or you can encapsulate your Ada code in a DLL to be linked with the
30894 other part of your application. In this case, use GNAT to build the DLL
30895 (@pxref{Building DLLs with GNAT}) and use the Microsoft or whatever
30896 environment to build your executable.
30897 @end enumerate
30898
30899 @node Windows Calling Conventions
30900 @section Windows Calling Conventions
30901 @findex Stdcall
30902 @findex APIENTRY
30903
30904 @menu
30905 * C Calling Convention::
30906 * Stdcall Calling Convention::
30907 * Win32 Calling Convention::
30908 * DLL Calling Convention::
30909 @end menu
30910
30911 @noindent
30912 When a subprogram @code{F} (caller) calls a subprogram @code{G}
30913 (callee), there are several ways to push @code{G}'s parameters on the
30914 stack and there are several possible scenarios to clean up the stack
30915 upon @code{G}'s return. A calling convention is an agreed upon software
30916 protocol whereby the responsibilities between the caller (@code{F}) and
30917 the callee (@code{G}) are clearly defined. Several calling conventions
30918 are available for Windows:
30919
30920 @itemize @bullet
30921 @item
30922 @code{C} (Microsoft defined)
30923
30924 @item
30925 @code{Stdcall} (Microsoft defined)
30926
30927 @item
30928 @code{Win32} (GNAT specific)
30929
30930 @item
30931 @code{DLL} (GNAT specific)
30932 @end itemize
30933
30934 @node C Calling Convention
30935 @subsection @code{C} Calling Convention
30936
30937 @noindent
30938 This is the default calling convention used when interfacing to C/C++
30939 routines compiled with either @command{gcc} or Microsoft Visual C++.
30940
30941 In the @code{C} calling convention subprogram parameters are pushed on the
30942 stack by the caller from right to left. The caller itself is in charge of
30943 cleaning up the stack after the call. In addition, the name of a routine
30944 with @code{C} calling convention is mangled by adding a leading underscore.
30945
30946 The name to use on the Ada side when importing (or exporting) a routine
30947 with @code{C} calling convention is the name of the routine. For
30948 instance the C function:
30949
30950 @smallexample
30951 int get_val (long);
30952 @end smallexample
30953
30954 @noindent
30955 should be imported from Ada as follows:
30956
30957 @smallexample @c ada
30958 @group
30959 function Get_Val (V : Interfaces.C.long) return Interfaces.C.int;
30960 pragma Import (C, Get_Val, External_Name => "get_val");
30961 @end group
30962 @end smallexample
30963
30964 @noindent
30965 Note that in this particular case the @code{External_Name} parameter could
30966 have been omitted since, when missing, this parameter is taken to be the
30967 name of the Ada entity in lower case. When the @code{Link_Name} parameter
30968 is missing, as in the above example, this parameter is set to be the
30969 @code{External_Name} with a leading underscore.
30970
30971 When importing a variable defined in C, you should always use the @code{C}
30972 calling convention unless the object containing the variable is part of a
30973 DLL (in which case you should use the @code{Stdcall} calling
30974 convention, @pxref{Stdcall Calling Convention}).
30975
30976 @node Stdcall Calling Convention
30977 @subsection @code{Stdcall} Calling Convention
30978
30979 @noindent
30980 This convention, which was the calling convention used for Pascal
30981 programs, is used by Microsoft for all the routines in the Win32 API for
30982 efficiency reasons. It must be used to import any routine for which this
30983 convention was specified.
30984
30985 In the @code{Stdcall} calling convention subprogram parameters are pushed
30986 on the stack by the caller from right to left. The callee (and not the
30987 caller) is in charge of cleaning the stack on routine exit. In addition,
30988 the name of a routine with @code{Stdcall} calling convention is mangled by
30989 adding a leading underscore (as for the @code{C} calling convention) and a
30990 trailing @code{@@}@code{@var{nn}}, where @var{nn} is the overall size (in
30991 bytes) of the parameters passed to the routine.
30992
30993 The name to use on the Ada side when importing a C routine with a
30994 @code{Stdcall} calling convention is the name of the C routine. The leading
30995 underscore and trailing @code{@@}@code{@var{nn}} are added automatically by
30996 the compiler. For instance the Win32 function:
30997
30998 @smallexample
30999 @b{APIENTRY} int get_val (long);
31000 @end smallexample
31001
31002 @noindent
31003 should be imported from Ada as follows:
31004
31005 @smallexample @c ada
31006 @group
31007 function Get_Val (V : Interfaces.C.long) return Interfaces.C.int;
31008 pragma Import (Stdcall, Get_Val);
31009 -- On the x86 a long is 4 bytes, so the Link_Name is "_get_val@@4"
31010 @end group
31011 @end smallexample
31012
31013 @noindent
31014 As for the @code{C} calling convention, when the @code{External_Name}
31015 parameter is missing, it is taken to be the name of the Ada entity in lower
31016 case. If instead of writing the above import pragma you write:
31017
31018 @smallexample @c ada
31019 @group
31020 function Get_Val (V : Interfaces.C.long) return Interfaces.C.int;
31021 pragma Import (Stdcall, Get_Val, External_Name => "retrieve_val");
31022 @end group
31023 @end smallexample
31024
31025 @noindent
31026 then the imported routine is @code{_retrieve_val@@4}. However, if instead
31027 of specifying the @code{External_Name} parameter you specify the
31028 @code{Link_Name} as in the following example:
31029
31030 @smallexample @c ada
31031 @group
31032 function Get_Val (V : Interfaces.C.long) return Interfaces.C.int;
31033 pragma Import (Stdcall, Get_Val, Link_Name => "retrieve_val");
31034 @end group
31035 @end smallexample
31036
31037 @noindent
31038 then the imported routine is @code{retrieve_val}, that is, there is no
31039 decoration at all. No leading underscore and no Stdcall suffix
31040 @code{@@}@code{@var{nn}}.
31041
31042 @noindent
31043 This is especially important as in some special cases a DLL's entry
31044 point name lacks a trailing @code{@@}@code{@var{nn}} while the exported
31045 name generated for a call has it.
31046
31047 @noindent
31048 It is also possible to import variables defined in a DLL by using an
31049 import pragma for a variable. As an example, if a DLL contains a
31050 variable defined as:
31051
31052 @smallexample
31053 int my_var;
31054 @end smallexample
31055
31056 @noindent
31057 then, to access this variable from Ada you should write:
31058
31059 @smallexample @c ada
31060 @group
31061 My_Var : Interfaces.C.int;
31062 pragma Import (Stdcall, My_Var);
31063 @end group
31064 @end smallexample
31065
31066 @noindent
31067 Note that to ease building cross-platform bindings this convention
31068 will be handled as a @code{C} calling convention on non-Windows platforms.
31069
31070 @node Win32 Calling Convention
31071 @subsection @code{Win32} Calling Convention
31072
31073 @noindent
31074 This convention, which is GNAT-specific is fully equivalent to the
31075 @code{Stdcall} calling convention described above.
31076
31077 @node DLL Calling Convention
31078 @subsection @code{DLL} Calling Convention
31079
31080 @noindent
31081 This convention, which is GNAT-specific is fully equivalent to the
31082 @code{Stdcall} calling convention described above.
31083
31084 @node Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)
31085 @section Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)
31086 @findex DLL
31087
31088 @noindent
31089 A Dynamically Linked Library (DLL) is a library that can be shared by
31090 several applications running under Windows. A DLL can contain any number of
31091 routines and variables.
31092
31093 One advantage of DLLs is that you can change and enhance them without
31094 forcing all the applications that depend on them to be relinked or
31095 recompiled. However, you should be aware than all calls to DLL routines are
31096 slower since, as you will understand below, such calls are indirect.
31097
31098 To illustrate the remainder of this section, suppose that an application
31099 wants to use the services of a DLL @file{API.dll}. To use the services
31100 provided by @file{API.dll} you must statically link against the DLL or
31101 an import library which contains a jump table with an entry for each
31102 routine and variable exported by the DLL. In the Microsoft world this
31103 import library is called @file{API.lib}. When using GNAT this import
31104 library is called either @file{libAPI.dll.a}, @file{libapi.dll.a},
31105 @file{libAPI.a} or @file{libapi.a} (names are case insensitive).
31106
31107 After you have linked your application with the DLL or the import library
31108 and you run your application, here is what happens:
31109
31110 @enumerate
31111 @item
31112 Your application is loaded into memory.
31113
31114 @item
31115 The DLL @file{API.dll} is mapped into the address space of your
31116 application. This means that:
31117
31118 @itemize @bullet
31119 @item
31120 The DLL will use the stack of the calling thread.
31121
31122 @item
31123 The DLL will use the virtual address space of the calling process.
31124
31125 @item
31126 The DLL will allocate memory from the virtual address space of the calling
31127 process.
31128
31129 @item
31130 Handles (pointers) can be safely exchanged between routines in the DLL
31131 routines and routines in the application using the DLL.
31132 @end itemize
31133
31134 @item
31135 The entries in the jump table (from the import library @file{libAPI.dll.a}
31136 or @file{API.lib} or automatically created when linking against a DLL)
31137 which is part of your application are initialized with the addresses
31138 of the routines and variables in @file{API.dll}.
31139
31140 @item
31141 If present in @file{API.dll}, routines @code{DllMain} or
31142 @code{DllMainCRTStartup} are invoked. These routines typically contain
31143 the initialization code needed for the well-being of the routines and
31144 variables exported by the DLL.
31145 @end enumerate
31146
31147 @noindent
31148 There is an additional point which is worth mentioning. In the Windows
31149 world there are two kind of DLLs: relocatable and non-relocatable
31150 DLLs. Non-relocatable DLLs can only be loaded at a very specific address
31151 in the target application address space. If the addresses of two
31152 non-relocatable DLLs overlap and these happen to be used by the same
31153 application, a conflict will occur and the application will run
31154 incorrectly. Hence, when possible, it is always preferable to use and
31155 build relocatable DLLs. Both relocatable and non-relocatable DLLs are
31156 supported by GNAT. Note that the @option{-s} linker option (see GNU Linker
31157 User's Guide) removes the debugging symbols from the DLL but the DLL can
31158 still be relocated.
31159
31160 As a side note, an interesting difference between Microsoft DLLs and
31161 Unix shared libraries, is the fact that on most Unix systems all public
31162 routines are exported by default in a Unix shared library, while under
31163 Windows it is possible (but not required) to list exported routines in
31164 a definition file (@pxref{The Definition File}).
31165
31166 @node Using DLLs with GNAT
31167 @section Using DLLs with GNAT
31168
31169 @menu
31170 * Creating an Ada Spec for the DLL Services::
31171 * Creating an Import Library::
31172 @end menu
31173
31174 @noindent
31175 To use the services of a DLL, say @file{API.dll}, in your Ada application
31176 you must have:
31177
31178 @enumerate
31179 @item
31180 The Ada spec for the routines and/or variables you want to access in
31181 @file{API.dll}. If not available this Ada spec must be built from the C/C++
31182 header files provided with the DLL.
31183
31184 @item
31185 The import library (@file{libAPI.dll.a} or @file{API.lib}). As previously
31186 mentioned an import library is a statically linked library containing the
31187 import table which will be filled at load time to point to the actual
31188 @file{API.dll} routines. Sometimes you don't have an import library for the
31189 DLL you want to use. The following sections will explain how to build
31190 one. Note that this is optional.
31191
31192 @item
31193 The actual DLL, @file{API.dll}.
31194 @end enumerate
31195
31196 @noindent
31197 Once you have all the above, to compile an Ada application that uses the
31198 services of @file{API.dll} and whose main subprogram is @code{My_Ada_App},
31199 you simply issue the command
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 $ gnatmake my_ada_app -largs -lAPI
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205 @noindent
31206 The argument @option{-largs -lAPI} at the end of the @command{gnatmake} command
31207 tells the GNAT linker to look first for a library named @file{API.lib}
31208 (Microsoft-style name) and if not found for a libraries named
31209 @file{libAPI.dll.a}, @file{API.dll.a} or @file{libAPI.a}.
31210 (GNAT-style name). Note that if the Ada package spec for @file{API.dll}
31211 contains the following pragma
31212
31213 @smallexample @c ada
31214 pragma Linker_Options ("-lAPI");
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217 @noindent
31218 you do not have to add @option{-largs -lAPI} at the end of the
31219 @command{gnatmake} command.
31220
31221 If any one of the items above is missing you will have to create it
31222 yourself. The following sections explain how to do so using as an
31223 example a fictitious DLL called @file{API.dll}.
31224
31225 @node Creating an Ada Spec for the DLL Services
31226 @subsection Creating an Ada Spec for the DLL Services
31227
31228 @noindent
31229 A DLL typically comes with a C/C++ header file which provides the
31230 definitions of the routines and variables exported by the DLL. The Ada
31231 equivalent of this header file is a package spec that contains definitions
31232 for the imported entities. If the DLL you intend to use does not come with
31233 an Ada spec you have to generate one such spec yourself. For example if
31234 the header file of @file{API.dll} is a file @file{api.h} containing the
31235 following two definitions:
31236
31237 @smallexample
31238 @group
31239 @cartouche
31240 int some_var;
31241 int get (char *);
31242 @end cartouche
31243 @end group
31244 @end smallexample
31245
31246 @noindent
31247 then the equivalent Ada spec could be:
31248
31249 @smallexample @c ada
31250 @group
31251 @cartouche
31252 with Interfaces.C.Strings;
31253 package API is
31254 use Interfaces;
31255
31256 Some_Var : C.int;
31257 function Get (Str : C.Strings.Chars_Ptr) return C.int;
31258
31259 private
31260 pragma Import (C, Get);
31261 pragma Import (DLL, Some_Var);
31262 end API;
31263 @end cartouche
31264 @end group
31265 @end smallexample
31266
31267 @noindent
31268 Note that a variable is
31269 @strong{always imported with a Stdcall convention}. A function
31270 can have @code{C} or @code{Stdcall} convention.
31271 (@pxref{Windows Calling Conventions}).
31272
31273 @node Creating an Import Library
31274 @subsection Creating an Import Library
31275 @cindex Import library
31276
31277 @menu
31278 * The Definition File::
31279 * GNAT-Style Import Library::
31280 * Microsoft-Style Import Library::
31281 @end menu
31282
31283 @noindent
31284 If a Microsoft-style import library @file{API.lib} or a GNAT-style
31285 import library @file{libAPI.dll.a} or @file{libAPI.a} is available
31286 with @file{API.dll} you can skip this section. You can also skip this
31287 section if @file{API.dll} or @file{libAPI.dll} is built with GNU tools
31288 as in this case it is possible to link directly against the
31289 DLL. Otherwise read on.
31290
31291 @node The Definition File
31292 @subsubsection The Definition File
31293 @cindex Definition file
31294 @findex .def
31295
31296 @noindent
31297 As previously mentioned, and unlike Unix systems, the list of symbols
31298 that are exported from a DLL must be provided explicitly in Windows.
31299 The main goal of a definition file is precisely that: list the symbols
31300 exported by a DLL. A definition file (usually a file with a @code{.def}
31301 suffix) has the following structure:
31302
31303 @smallexample
31304 @group
31305 @cartouche
31306 @r{[}LIBRARY @var{name}@r{]}
31307 @r{[}DESCRIPTION @var{string}@r{]}
31308 EXPORTS
31309 @var{symbol1}
31310 @var{symbol2}
31311 @dots{}
31312 @end cartouche
31313 @end group
31314 @end smallexample
31315
31316 @table @code
31317 @item LIBRARY @var{name}
31318 This section, which is optional, gives the name of the DLL.
31319
31320 @item DESCRIPTION @var{string}
31321 This section, which is optional, gives a description string that will be
31322 embedded in the import library.
31323
31324 @item EXPORTS
31325 This section gives the list of exported symbols (procedures, functions or
31326 variables). For instance in the case of @file{API.dll} the @code{EXPORTS}
31327 section of @file{API.def} looks like:
31328
31329 @smallexample
31330 @group
31331 @cartouche
31332 EXPORTS
31333 some_var
31334 get
31335 @end cartouche
31336 @end group
31337 @end smallexample
31338 @end table
31339
31340 @noindent
31341 Note that you must specify the correct suffix (@code{@@}@code{@var{nn}})
31342 (@pxref{Windows Calling Conventions}) for a Stdcall
31343 calling convention function in the exported symbols list.
31344
31345 @noindent
31346 There can actually be other sections in a definition file, but these
31347 sections are not relevant to the discussion at hand.
31348
31349 @node GNAT-Style Import Library
31350 @subsubsection GNAT-Style Import Library
31351
31352 @noindent
31353 To create a static import library from @file{API.dll} with the GNAT tools
31354 you should proceed as follows:
31355
31356 @enumerate
31357 @item
31358 Create the definition file @file{API.def} (@pxref{The Definition File}).
31359 For that use the @code{dll2def} tool as follows:
31360
31361 @smallexample
31362 $ dll2def API.dll > API.def
31363 @end smallexample
31364
31365 @noindent
31366 @code{dll2def} is a very simple tool: it takes as input a DLL and prints
31367 to standard output the list of entry points in the DLL. Note that if
31368 some routines in the DLL have the @code{Stdcall} convention
31369 (@pxref{Windows Calling Conventions}) with stripped @code{@@}@var{nn}
31370 suffix then you'll have to edit @file{api.def} to add it, and specify
31371 @option{-k} to @command{gnatdll} when creating the import library.
31372
31373 @noindent
31374 Here are some hints to find the right @code{@@}@var{nn} suffix.
31375
31376 @enumerate
31377 @item
31378 If you have the Microsoft import library (.lib), it is possible to get
31379 the right symbols by using Microsoft @code{dumpbin} tool (see the
31380 corresponding Microsoft documentation for further details).
31381
31382 @smallexample
31383 $ dumpbin /exports api.lib
31384 @end smallexample
31385
31386 @item
31387 If you have a message about a missing symbol at link time the compiler
31388 tells you what symbol is expected. You just have to go back to the
31389 definition file and add the right suffix.
31390 @end enumerate
31391
31392 @item
31393 Build the import library @code{libAPI.dll.a}, using @code{gnatdll}
31394 (@pxref{Using gnatdll}) as follows:
31395
31396 @smallexample
31397 $ gnatdll -e API.def -d API.dll
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 @noindent
31401 @code{gnatdll} takes as input a definition file @file{API.def} and the
31402 name of the DLL containing the services listed in the definition file
31403 @file{API.dll}. The name of the static import library generated is
31404 computed from the name of the definition file as follows: if the
31405 definition file name is @var{xyz}@code{.def}, the import library name will
31406 be @code{lib}@var{xyz}@code{.a}. Note that in the previous example option
31407 @option{-e} could have been removed because the name of the definition
31408 file (before the ``@code{.def}'' suffix) is the same as the name of the
31409 DLL (@pxref{Using gnatdll} for more information about @code{gnatdll}).
31410 @end enumerate
31411
31412 @node Microsoft-Style Import Library
31413 @subsubsection Microsoft-Style Import Library
31414
31415 @noindent
31416 With GNAT you can either use a GNAT-style or Microsoft-style import
31417 library. A Microsoft import library is needed only if you plan to make an
31418 Ada DLL available to applications developed with Microsoft
31419 tools (@pxref{Mixed-Language Programming on Windows}).
31420
31421 To create a Microsoft-style import library for @file{API.dll} you
31422 should proceed as follows:
31423
31424 @enumerate
31425 @item
31426 Create the definition file @file{API.def} from the DLL. For this use either
31427 the @code{dll2def} tool as described above or the Microsoft @code{dumpbin}
31428 tool (see the corresponding Microsoft documentation for further details).
31429
31430 @item
31431 Build the actual import library using Microsoft's @code{lib} utility:
31432
31433 @smallexample
31434 $ lib -machine:IX86 -def:API.def -out:API.lib
31435 @end smallexample
31436
31437 @noindent
31438 If you use the above command the definition file @file{API.def} must
31439 contain a line giving the name of the DLL:
31440
31441 @smallexample
31442 LIBRARY "API"
31443 @end smallexample
31444
31445 @noindent
31446 See the Microsoft documentation for further details about the usage of
31447 @code{lib}.
31448 @end enumerate
31449
31450 @node Building DLLs with GNAT
31451 @section Building DLLs with GNAT
31452 @cindex DLLs, building
31453
31454 @noindent
31455 This section explain how to build DLLs using the GNAT built-in DLL
31456 support. With the following procedure it is straight forward to build
31457 and use DLLs with GNAT.
31458
31459 @enumerate
31460
31461 @item building object files
31462
31463 The first step is to build all objects files that are to be included
31464 into the DLL. This is done by using the standard @command{gnatmake} tool.
31465
31466 @item building the DLL
31467
31468 To build the DLL you must use @command{gcc}'s @option{-shared}
31469 option. It is quite simple to use this method:
31470
31471 @smallexample
31472 $ gcc -shared -o api.dll obj1.o obj2.o @dots{}
31473 @end smallexample
31474
31475 It is important to note that in this case all symbols found in the
31476 object files are automatically exported. It is possible to restrict
31477 the set of symbols to export by passing to @command{gcc} a definition
31478 file, @pxref{The Definition File}. For example:
31479
31480 @smallexample
31481 $ gcc -shared -o api.dll api.def obj1.o obj2.o @dots{}
31482 @end smallexample
31483
31484 If you use a definition file you must export the elaboration procedures
31485 for every package that required one. Elaboration procedures are named
31486 using the package name followed by "_E".
31487
31488 @item preparing DLL to be used
31489
31490 For the DLL to be used by client programs the bodies must be hidden
31491 from it and the .ali set with read-only attribute. This is very important
31492 otherwise GNAT will recompile all packages and will not actually use
31493 the code in the DLL. For example:
31494
31495 @smallexample
31496 $ mkdir apilib
31497 $ copy *.ads *.ali api.dll apilib
31498 $ attrib +R apilib\*.ali
31499 @end smallexample
31500
31501 @end enumerate
31502
31503 At this point it is possible to use the DLL by directly linking
31504 against it. Note that you must use the GNAT shared runtime when using
31505 GNAT shared libraries. This is achieved by using @option{-shared} binder's
31506 option.
31507
31508 @smallexample
31509 $ gnatmake main -Iapilib -bargs -shared -largs -Lapilib -lAPI
31510 @end smallexample
31511
31512 @node Building DLLs with GNAT Project files
31513 @section Building DLLs with GNAT Project files
31514 @cindex DLLs, building
31515
31516 @noindent
31517 There is nothing specific to Windows in the build process.
31518 @pxref{Library Projects}.
31519
31520 @noindent
31521 Due to a system limitation, it is not possible under Windows to create threads
31522 when inside the @code{DllMain} routine which is used for auto-initialization
31523 of shared libraries, so it is not possible to have library level tasks in SALs.
31524
31525 @node Building DLLs with gnatdll
31526 @section Building DLLs with gnatdll
31527 @cindex DLLs, building
31528
31529 @menu
31530 * Limitations When Using Ada DLLs from Ada::
31531 * Exporting Ada Entities::
31532 * Ada DLLs and Elaboration::
31533 * Ada DLLs and Finalization::
31534 * Creating a Spec for Ada DLLs::
31535 * Creating the Definition File::
31536 * Using gnatdll::
31537 @end menu
31538
31539 @noindent
31540 Note that it is preferred to use the built-in GNAT DLL support
31541 (@pxref{Building DLLs with GNAT}) or GNAT Project files
31542 (@pxref{Building DLLs with GNAT Project files}) to build DLLs.
31543
31544 This section explains how to build DLLs containing Ada code using
31545 @code{gnatdll}. These DLLs will be referred to as Ada DLLs in the
31546 remainder of this section.
31547
31548 The steps required to build an Ada DLL that is to be used by Ada as well as
31549 non-Ada applications are as follows:
31550
31551 @enumerate
31552 @item
31553 You need to mark each Ada @i{entity} exported by the DLL with a @code{C} or
31554 @code{Stdcall} calling convention to avoid any Ada name mangling for the
31555 entities exported by the DLL (@pxref{Exporting Ada Entities}). You can
31556 skip this step if you plan to use the Ada DLL only from Ada applications.
31557
31558 @item
31559 Your Ada code must export an initialization routine which calls the routine
31560 @code{adainit} generated by @command{gnatbind} to perform the elaboration of
31561 the Ada code in the DLL (@pxref{Ada DLLs and Elaboration}). The initialization
31562 routine exported by the Ada DLL must be invoked by the clients of the DLL
31563 to initialize the DLL.
31564
31565 @item
31566 When useful, the DLL should also export a finalization routine which calls
31567 routine @code{adafinal} generated by @command{gnatbind} to perform the
31568 finalization of the Ada code in the DLL (@pxref{Ada DLLs and Finalization}).
31569 The finalization routine exported by the Ada DLL must be invoked by the
31570 clients of the DLL when the DLL services are no further needed.
31571
31572 @item
31573 You must provide a spec for the services exported by the Ada DLL in each
31574 of the programming languages to which you plan to make the DLL available.
31575
31576 @item
31577 You must provide a definition file listing the exported entities
31578 (@pxref{The Definition File}).
31579
31580 @item
31581 Finally you must use @code{gnatdll} to produce the DLL and the import
31582 library (@pxref{Using gnatdll}).
31583 @end enumerate
31584
31585 @noindent
31586 Note that a relocatable DLL stripped using the @code{strip}
31587 binutils tool will not be relocatable anymore. To build a DLL without
31588 debug information pass @code{-largs -s} to @code{gnatdll}. This
31589 restriction does not apply to a DLL built using a Library Project.
31590 @pxref{Library Projects}.
31591
31592 @node Limitations When Using Ada DLLs from Ada
31593 @subsection Limitations When Using Ada DLLs from Ada
31594
31595 @noindent
31596 When using Ada DLLs from Ada applications there is a limitation users
31597 should be aware of. Because on Windows the GNAT run time is not in a DLL of
31598 its own, each Ada DLL includes a part of the GNAT run time. Specifically,
31599 each Ada DLL includes the services of the GNAT run time that are necessary
31600 to the Ada code inside the DLL. As a result, when an Ada program uses an
31601 Ada DLL there are two independent GNAT run times: one in the Ada DLL and
31602 one in the main program.
31603
31604 It is therefore not possible to exchange GNAT run-time objects between the
31605 Ada DLL and the main Ada program. Example of GNAT run-time objects are file
31606 handles (e.g.@: @code{Text_IO.File_Type}), tasks types, protected objects
31607 types, etc.
31608
31609 It is completely safe to exchange plain elementary, array or record types,
31610 Windows object handles, etc.
31611
31612 @node Exporting Ada Entities
31613 @subsection Exporting Ada Entities
31614 @cindex Export table
31615
31616 @noindent
31617 Building a DLL is a way to encapsulate a set of services usable from any
31618 application. As a result, the Ada entities exported by a DLL should be
31619 exported with the @code{C} or @code{Stdcall} calling conventions to avoid
31620 any Ada name mangling. As an example here is an Ada package
31621 @code{API}, spec and body, exporting two procedures, a function, and a
31622 variable:
31623
31624 @smallexample @c ada
31625 @group
31626 @cartouche
31627 with Interfaces.C; use Interfaces;
31628 package API is
31629 Count : C.int := 0;
31630 function Factorial (Val : C.int) return C.int;
31631
31632 procedure Initialize_API;
31633 procedure Finalize_API;
31634 -- Initialization & Finalization routines. More in the next section.
31635 private
31636 pragma Export (C, Initialize_API);
31637 pragma Export (C, Finalize_API);
31638 pragma Export (C, Count);
31639 pragma Export (C, Factorial);
31640 end API;
31641 @end cartouche
31642 @end group
31643 @end smallexample
31644
31645 @smallexample @c ada
31646 @group
31647 @cartouche
31648 package body API is
31649 function Factorial (Val : C.int) return C.int is
31650 Fact : C.int := 1;
31651 begin
31652 Count := Count + 1;
31653 for K in 1 .. Val loop
31654 Fact := Fact * K;
31655 end loop;
31656 return Fact;
31657 end Factorial;
31658
31659 procedure Initialize_API is
31660 procedure Adainit;
31661 pragma Import (C, Adainit);
31662 begin
31663 Adainit;
31664 end Initialize_API;
31665
31666 procedure Finalize_API is
31667 procedure Adafinal;
31668 pragma Import (C, Adafinal);
31669 begin
31670 Adafinal;
31671 end Finalize_API;
31672 end API;
31673 @end cartouche
31674 @end group
31675 @end smallexample
31676
31677 @noindent
31678 If the Ada DLL you are building will only be used by Ada applications
31679 you do not have to export Ada entities with a @code{C} or @code{Stdcall}
31680 convention. As an example, the previous package could be written as
31681 follows:
31682
31683 @smallexample @c ada
31684 @group
31685 @cartouche
31686 package API is
31687 Count : Integer := 0;
31688 function Factorial (Val : Integer) return Integer;
31689
31690 procedure Initialize_API;
31691 procedure Finalize_API;
31692 -- Initialization and Finalization routines.
31693 end API;
31694 @end cartouche
31695 @end group
31696 @end smallexample
31697
31698 @smallexample @c ada
31699 @group
31700 @cartouche
31701 package body API is
31702 function Factorial (Val : Integer) return Integer is
31703 Fact : Integer := 1;
31704 begin
31705 Count := Count + 1;
31706 for K in 1 .. Val loop
31707 Fact := Fact * K;
31708 end loop;
31709 return Fact;
31710 end Factorial;
31711
31712 @dots{}
31713 -- The remainder of this package body is unchanged.
31714 end API;
31715 @end cartouche
31716 @end group
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 @noindent
31720 Note that if you do not export the Ada entities with a @code{C} or
31721 @code{Stdcall} convention you will have to provide the mangled Ada names
31722 in the definition file of the Ada DLL
31723 (@pxref{Creating the Definition File}).
31724
31725 @node Ada DLLs and Elaboration
31726 @subsection Ada DLLs and Elaboration
31727 @cindex DLLs and elaboration
31728
31729 @noindent
31730 The DLL that you are building contains your Ada code as well as all the
31731 routines in the Ada library that are needed by it. The first thing a
31732 user of your DLL must do is elaborate the Ada code
31733 (@pxref{Elaboration Order Handling in GNAT}).
31734
31735 To achieve this you must export an initialization routine
31736 (@code{Initialize_API} in the previous example), which must be invoked
31737 before using any of the DLL services. This elaboration routine must call
31738 the Ada elaboration routine @code{adainit} generated by the GNAT binder
31739 (@pxref{Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs}). See the body of
31740 @code{Initialize_Api} for an example. Note that the GNAT binder is
31741 automatically invoked during the DLL build process by the @code{gnatdll}
31742 tool (@pxref{Using gnatdll}).
31743
31744 When a DLL is loaded, Windows systematically invokes a routine called
31745 @code{DllMain}. It would therefore be possible to call @code{adainit}
31746 directly from @code{DllMain} without having to provide an explicit
31747 initialization routine. Unfortunately, it is not possible to call
31748 @code{adainit} from the @code{DllMain} if your program has library level
31749 tasks because access to the @code{DllMain} entry point is serialized by
31750 the system (that is, only a single thread can execute ``through'' it at a
31751 time), which means that the GNAT run time will deadlock waiting for the
31752 newly created task to complete its initialization.
31753
31754 @node Ada DLLs and Finalization
31755 @subsection Ada DLLs and Finalization
31756 @cindex DLLs and finalization
31757
31758 @noindent
31759 When the services of an Ada DLL are no longer needed, the client code should
31760 invoke the DLL finalization routine, if available. The DLL finalization
31761 routine is in charge of releasing all resources acquired by the DLL. In the
31762 case of the Ada code contained in the DLL, this is achieved by calling
31763 routine @code{adafinal} generated by the GNAT binder
31764 (@pxref{Binding with Non-Ada Main Programs}).
31765 See the body of @code{Finalize_Api} for an
31766 example. As already pointed out the GNAT binder is automatically invoked
31767 during the DLL build process by the @code{gnatdll} tool
31768 (@pxref{Using gnatdll}).
31769
31770 @node Creating a Spec for Ada DLLs
31771 @subsection Creating a Spec for Ada DLLs
31772
31773 @noindent
31774 To use the services exported by the Ada DLL from another programming
31775 language (e.g.@: C), you have to translate the specs of the exported Ada
31776 entities in that language. For instance in the case of @code{API.dll},
31777 the corresponding C header file could look like:
31778
31779 @smallexample
31780 @group
31781 @cartouche
31782 extern int *_imp__count;
31783 #define count (*_imp__count)
31784 int factorial (int);
31785 @end cartouche
31786 @end group
31787 @end smallexample
31788
31789 @noindent
31790 It is important to understand that when building an Ada DLL to be used by
31791 other Ada applications, you need two different specs for the packages
31792 contained in the DLL: one for building the DLL and the other for using
31793 the DLL. This is because the @code{DLL} calling convention is needed to
31794 use a variable defined in a DLL, but when building the DLL, the variable
31795 must have either the @code{Ada} or @code{C} calling convention. As an
31796 example consider a DLL comprising the following package @code{API}:
31797
31798 @smallexample @c ada
31799 @group
31800 @cartouche
31801 package API is
31802 Count : Integer := 0;
31803 @dots{}
31804 -- Remainder of the package omitted.
31805 end API;
31806 @end cartouche
31807 @end group
31808 @end smallexample
31809
31810 @noindent
31811 After producing a DLL containing package @code{API}, the spec that
31812 must be used to import @code{API.Count} from Ada code outside of the
31813 DLL is:
31814
31815 @smallexample @c ada
31816 @group
31817 @cartouche
31818 package API is
31819 Count : Integer;
31820 pragma Import (DLL, Count);
31821 end API;
31822 @end cartouche
31823 @end group
31824 @end smallexample
31825
31826 @node Creating the Definition File
31827 @subsection Creating the Definition File
31828
31829 @noindent
31830 The definition file is the last file needed to build the DLL. It lists
31831 the exported symbols. As an example, the definition file for a DLL
31832 containing only package @code{API} (where all the entities are exported
31833 with a @code{C} calling convention) is:
31834
31835 @smallexample
31836 @group
31837 @cartouche
31838 EXPORTS
31839 count
31840 factorial
31841 finalize_api
31842 initialize_api
31843 @end cartouche
31844 @end group
31845 @end smallexample
31846
31847 @noindent
31848 If the @code{C} calling convention is missing from package @code{API},
31849 then the definition file contains the mangled Ada names of the above
31850 entities, which in this case are:
31851
31852 @smallexample
31853 @group
31854 @cartouche
31855 EXPORTS
31856 api__count
31857 api__factorial
31858 api__finalize_api
31859 api__initialize_api
31860 @end cartouche
31861 @end group
31862 @end smallexample
31863
31864 @node Using gnatdll
31865 @subsection Using @code{gnatdll}
31866 @findex gnatdll
31867
31868 @menu
31869 * gnatdll Example::
31870 * gnatdll behind the Scenes::
31871 * Using dlltool::
31872 @end menu
31873
31874 @noindent
31875 @code{gnatdll} is a tool to automate the DLL build process once all the Ada
31876 and non-Ada sources that make up your DLL have been compiled.
31877 @code{gnatdll} is actually in charge of two distinct tasks: build the
31878 static import library for the DLL and the actual DLL. The form of the
31879 @code{gnatdll} command is
31880
31881 @smallexample
31882 @cartouche
31883 $ gnatdll @ovar{switches} @var{list-of-files} @r{[}-largs @var{opts}@r{]}
31884 @end cartouche
31885 @end smallexample
31886
31887 @noindent
31888 where @var{list-of-files} is a list of ALI and object files. The object
31889 file list must be the exact list of objects corresponding to the non-Ada
31890 sources whose services are to be included in the DLL. The ALI file list
31891 must be the exact list of ALI files for the corresponding Ada sources
31892 whose services are to be included in the DLL. If @var{list-of-files} is
31893 missing, only the static import library is generated.
31894
31895 @noindent
31896 You may specify any of the following switches to @code{gnatdll}:
31897
31898 @table @code
31899 @item -a@ovar{address}
31900 @cindex @option{-a} (@code{gnatdll})
31901 Build a non-relocatable DLL at @var{address}. If @var{address} is not
31902 specified the default address @var{0x11000000} will be used. By default,
31903 when this switch is missing, @code{gnatdll} builds relocatable DLL. We
31904 advise the reader to build relocatable DLL.
31905
31906 @item -b @var{address}
31907 @cindex @option{-b} (@code{gnatdll})
31908 Set the relocatable DLL base address. By default the address is
31909 @code{0x11000000}.
31910
31911 @item -bargs @var{opts}
31912 @cindex @option{-bargs} (@code{gnatdll})
31913 Binder options. Pass @var{opts} to the binder.
31914
31915 @item -d @var{dllfile}
31916 @cindex @option{-d} (@code{gnatdll})
31917 @var{dllfile} is the name of the DLL. This switch must be present for
31918 @code{gnatdll} to do anything. The name of the generated import library is
31919 obtained algorithmically from @var{dllfile} as shown in the following
31920 example: if @var{dllfile} is @code{xyz.dll}, the import library name is
31921 @code{libxyz.dll.a}. The name of the definition file to use (if not specified
31922 by option @option{-e}) is obtained algorithmically from @var{dllfile}
31923 as shown in the following example:
31924 if @var{dllfile} is @code{xyz.dll}, the definition
31925 file used is @code{xyz.def}.
31926
31927 @item -e @var{deffile}
31928 @cindex @option{-e} (@code{gnatdll})
31929 @var{deffile} is the name of the definition file.
31930
31931 @item -g
31932 @cindex @option{-g} (@code{gnatdll})
31933 Generate debugging information. This information is stored in the object
31934 file and copied from there to the final DLL file by the linker,
31935 where it can be read by the debugger. You must use the
31936 @option{-g} switch if you plan on using the debugger or the symbolic
31937 stack traceback.
31938
31939 @item -h
31940 @cindex @option{-h} (@code{gnatdll})
31941 Help mode. Displays @code{gnatdll} switch usage information.
31942
31943 @item -Idir
31944 @cindex @option{-I} (@code{gnatdll})
31945 Direct @code{gnatdll} to search the @var{dir} directory for source and
31946 object files needed to build the DLL.
31947 (@pxref{Search Paths and the Run-Time Library (RTL)}).
31948
31949 @item -k
31950 @cindex @option{-k} (@code{gnatdll})
31951 Removes the @code{@@}@var{nn} suffix from the import library's exported
31952 names, but keeps them for the link names. You must specify this
31953 option if you want to use a @code{Stdcall} function in a DLL for which
31954 the @code{@@}@var{nn} suffix has been removed. This is the case for most
31955 of the Windows NT DLL for example. This option has no effect when
31956 @option{-n} option is specified.
31957
31958 @item -l @var{file}
31959 @cindex @option{-l} (@code{gnatdll})
31960 The list of ALI and object files used to build the DLL are listed in
31961 @var{file}, instead of being given in the command line. Each line in
31962 @var{file} contains the name of an ALI or object file.
31963
31964 @item -n
31965 @cindex @option{-n} (@code{gnatdll})
31966 No Import. Do not create the import library.
31967
31968 @item -q
31969 @cindex @option{-q} (@code{gnatdll})
31970 Quiet mode. Do not display unnecessary messages.
31971
31972 @item -v
31973 @cindex @option{-v} (@code{gnatdll})
31974 Verbose mode. Display extra information.
31975
31976 @item -largs @var{opts}
31977 @cindex @option{-largs} (@code{gnatdll})
31978 Linker options. Pass @var{opts} to the linker.
31979 @end table
31980
31981 @node gnatdll Example
31982 @subsubsection @code{gnatdll} Example
31983
31984 @noindent
31985 As an example the command to build a relocatable DLL from @file{api.adb}
31986 once @file{api.adb} has been compiled and @file{api.def} created is
31987
31988 @smallexample
31989 $ gnatdll -d api.dll api.ali
31990 @end smallexample
31991
31992 @noindent
31993 The above command creates two files: @file{libapi.dll.a} (the import
31994 library) and @file{api.dll} (the actual DLL). If you want to create
31995 only the DLL, just type:
31996
31997 @smallexample
31998 $ gnatdll -d api.dll -n api.ali
31999 @end smallexample
32000
32001 @noindent
32002 Alternatively if you want to create just the import library, type:
32003
32004 @smallexample
32005 $ gnatdll -d api.dll
32006 @end smallexample
32007
32008 @node gnatdll behind the Scenes
32009 @subsubsection @code{gnatdll} behind the Scenes
32010
32011 @noindent
32012 This section details the steps involved in creating a DLL. @code{gnatdll}
32013 does these steps for you. Unless you are interested in understanding what
32014 goes on behind the scenes, you should skip this section.
32015
32016 We use the previous example of a DLL containing the Ada package @code{API},
32017 to illustrate the steps necessary to build a DLL. The starting point is a
32018 set of objects that will make up the DLL and the corresponding ALI
32019 files. In the case of this example this means that @file{api.o} and
32020 @file{api.ali} are available. To build a relocatable DLL, @code{gnatdll} does
32021 the following:
32022
32023 @enumerate
32024 @item
32025 @code{gnatdll} builds the base file (@file{api.base}). A base file gives
32026 the information necessary to generate relocation information for the
32027 DLL.
32028
32029 @smallexample
32030 @group
32031 $ gnatbind -n api
32032 $ gnatlink api -o api.jnk -mdll -Wl,--base-file,api.base
32033 @end group
32034 @end smallexample
32035
32036 @noindent
32037 In addition to the base file, the @command{gnatlink} command generates an
32038 output file @file{api.jnk} which can be discarded. The @option{-mdll} switch
32039 asks @command{gnatlink} to generate the routines @code{DllMain} and
32040 @code{DllMainCRTStartup} that are called by the Windows loader when the DLL
32041 is loaded into memory.
32042
32043 @item
32044 @code{gnatdll} uses @code{dlltool} (@pxref{Using dlltool}) to build the
32045 export table (@file{api.exp}). The export table contains the relocation
32046 information in a form which can be used during the final link to ensure
32047 that the Windows loader is able to place the DLL anywhere in memory.
32048
32049 @smallexample
32050 @group
32051 $ dlltool --dllname api.dll --def api.def --base-file api.base \
32052 --output-exp api.exp
32053 @end group
32054 @end smallexample
32055
32056 @item
32057 @code{gnatdll} builds the base file using the new export table. Note that
32058 @command{gnatbind} must be called once again since the binder generated file
32059 has been deleted during the previous call to @command{gnatlink}.
32060
32061 @smallexample
32062 @group
32063 $ gnatbind -n api
32064 $ gnatlink api -o api.jnk api.exp -mdll
32065 -Wl,--base-file,api.base
32066 @end group
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 @item
32070 @code{gnatdll} builds the new export table using the new base file and
32071 generates the DLL import library @file{libAPI.dll.a}.
32072
32073 @smallexample
32074 @group
32075 $ dlltool --dllname api.dll --def api.def --base-file api.base \
32076 --output-exp api.exp --output-lib libAPI.a
32077 @end group
32078 @end smallexample
32079
32080 @item
32081 Finally @code{gnatdll} builds the relocatable DLL using the final export
32082 table.
32083
32084 @smallexample
32085 @group
32086 $ gnatbind -n api
32087 $ gnatlink api api.exp -o api.dll -mdll
32088 @end group
32089 @end smallexample
32090 @end enumerate
32091
32092 @node Using dlltool
32093 @subsubsection Using @code{dlltool}
32094
32095 @noindent
32096 @code{dlltool} is the low-level tool used by @code{gnatdll} to build
32097 DLLs and static import libraries. This section summarizes the most
32098 common @code{dlltool} switches. The form of the @code{dlltool} command
32099 is
32100
32101 @smallexample
32102 $ dlltool @ovar{switches}
32103 @end smallexample
32104
32105 @noindent
32106 @code{dlltool} switches include:
32107
32108 @table @option
32109 @item --base-file @var{basefile}
32110 @cindex @option{--base-file} (@command{dlltool})
32111 Read the base file @var{basefile} generated by the linker. This switch
32112 is used to create a relocatable DLL.
32113
32114 @item --def @var{deffile}
32115 @cindex @option{--def} (@command{dlltool})
32116 Read the definition file.
32117
32118 @item --dllname @var{name}
32119 @cindex @option{--dllname} (@command{dlltool})
32120 Gives the name of the DLL. This switch is used to embed the name of the
32121 DLL in the static import library generated by @code{dlltool} with switch
32122 @option{--output-lib}.
32123
32124 @item -k
32125 @cindex @option{-k} (@command{dlltool})
32126 Kill @code{@@}@var{nn} from exported names
32127 (@pxref{Windows Calling Conventions}
32128 for a discussion about @code{Stdcall}-style symbols.
32129
32130 @item --help
32131 @cindex @option{--help} (@command{dlltool})
32132 Prints the @code{dlltool} switches with a concise description.
32133
32134 @item --output-exp @var{exportfile}
32135 @cindex @option{--output-exp} (@command{dlltool})
32136 Generate an export file @var{exportfile}. The export file contains the
32137 export table (list of symbols in the DLL) and is used to create the DLL.
32138
32139 @item --output-lib @var{libfile}
32140 @cindex @option{--output-lib} (@command{dlltool})
32141 Generate a static import library @var{libfile}.
32142
32143 @item -v
32144 @cindex @option{-v} (@command{dlltool})
32145 Verbose mode.
32146
32147 @item --as @var{assembler-name}
32148 @cindex @option{--as} (@command{dlltool})
32149 Use @var{assembler-name} as the assembler. The default is @code{as}.
32150 @end table
32151
32152 @node GNAT and Windows Resources
32153 @section GNAT and Windows Resources
32154 @cindex Resources, windows
32155
32156 @menu
32157 * Building Resources::
32158 * Compiling Resources::
32159 * Using Resources::
32160 @end menu
32161
32162 @noindent
32163 Resources are an easy way to add Windows specific objects to your
32164 application. The objects that can be added as resources include:
32165
32166 @itemize @bullet
32167 @item
32168 menus
32169
32170 @item
32171 accelerators
32172
32173 @item
32174 dialog boxes
32175
32176 @item
32177 string tables
32178
32179 @item
32180 bitmaps
32181
32182 @item
32183 cursors
32184
32185 @item
32186 icons
32187
32188 @item
32189 fonts
32190 @end itemize
32191
32192 @noindent
32193 This section explains how to build, compile and use resources.
32194
32195 @node Building Resources
32196 @subsection Building Resources
32197 @cindex Resources, building
32198
32199 @noindent
32200 A resource file is an ASCII file. By convention resource files have an
32201 @file{.rc} extension.
32202 The easiest way to build a resource file is to use Microsoft tools
32203 such as @code{imagedit.exe} to build bitmaps, icons and cursors and
32204 @code{dlgedit.exe} to build dialogs.
32205 It is always possible to build an @file{.rc} file yourself by writing a
32206 resource script.
32207
32208 It is not our objective to explain how to write a resource file. A
32209 complete description of the resource script language can be found in the
32210 Microsoft documentation.
32211
32212 @node Compiling Resources
32213 @subsection Compiling Resources
32214 @findex rc
32215 @findex windres
32216 @cindex Resources, compiling
32217
32218 @noindent
32219 This section describes how to build a GNAT-compatible (COFF) object file
32220 containing the resources. This is done using the Resource Compiler
32221 @code{windres} as follows:
32222
32223 @smallexample
32224 $ windres -i myres.rc -o myres.o
32225 @end smallexample
32226
32227 @noindent
32228 By default @code{windres} will run @command{gcc} to preprocess the @file{.rc}
32229 file. You can specify an alternate preprocessor (usually named
32230 @file{cpp.exe}) using the @code{windres} @option{--preprocessor}
32231 parameter. A list of all possible options may be obtained by entering
32232 the command @code{windres} @option{--help}.
32233
32234 It is also possible to use the Microsoft resource compiler @code{rc.exe}
32235 to produce a @file{.res} file (binary resource file). See the
32236 corresponding Microsoft documentation for further details. In this case
32237 you need to use @code{windres} to translate the @file{.res} file to a
32238 GNAT-compatible object file as follows:
32239
32240 @smallexample
32241 $ windres -i myres.res -o myres.o
32242 @end smallexample
32243
32244 @node Using Resources
32245 @subsection Using Resources
32246 @cindex Resources, using
32247
32248 @noindent
32249 To include the resource file in your program just add the
32250 GNAT-compatible object file for the resource(s) to the linker
32251 arguments. With @command{gnatmake} this is done by using the @option{-largs}
32252 option:
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 $ gnatmake myprog -largs myres.o
32256 @end smallexample
32257
32258 @node Debugging a DLL
32259 @section Debugging a DLL
32260 @cindex DLL debugging
32261
32262 @menu
32263 * Program and DLL Both Built with GCC/GNAT::
32264 * Program Built with Foreign Tools and DLL Built with GCC/GNAT::
32265 @end menu
32266
32267 @noindent
32268 Debugging a DLL is similar to debugging a standard program. But
32269 we have to deal with two different executable parts: the DLL and the
32270 program that uses it. We have the following four possibilities:
32271
32272 @enumerate 1
32273 @item
32274 The program and the DLL are built with @code{GCC/GNAT}.
32275 @item
32276 The program is built with foreign tools and the DLL is built with
32277 @code{GCC/GNAT}.
32278 @item
32279 The program is built with @code{GCC/GNAT} and the DLL is built with
32280 foreign tools.
32281 @item
32282 @end enumerate
32283
32284 @noindent
32285 In this section we address only cases one and two above.
32286 There is no point in trying to debug
32287 a DLL with @code{GNU/GDB}, if there is no GDB-compatible debugging
32288 information in it. To do so you must use a debugger compatible with the
32289 tools suite used to build the DLL.
32290
32291 @node Program and DLL Both Built with GCC/GNAT
32292 @subsection Program and DLL Both Built with GCC/GNAT
32293
32294 @noindent
32295 This is the simplest case. Both the DLL and the program have @code{GDB}
32296 compatible debugging information. It is then possible to break anywhere in
32297 the process. Let's suppose here that the main procedure is named
32298 @code{ada_main} and that in the DLL there is an entry point named
32299 @code{ada_dll}.
32300
32301 @noindent
32302 The DLL (@pxref{Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)}) and
32303 program must have been built with the debugging information (see GNAT -g
32304 switch). Here are the step-by-step instructions for debugging it:
32305
32306 @enumerate 1
32307 @item Launch @code{GDB} on the main program.
32308
32309 @smallexample
32310 $ gdb -nw ada_main
32311 @end smallexample
32312
32313 @item Start the program and stop at the beginning of the main procedure
32314
32315 @smallexample
32316 (gdb) start
32317 @end smallexample
32318
32319 @noindent
32320 This step is required to be able to set a breakpoint inside the DLL. As long
32321 as the program is not run, the DLL is not loaded. This has the
32322 consequence that the DLL debugging information is also not loaded, so it is not
32323 possible to set a breakpoint in the DLL.
32324
32325 @item Set a breakpoint inside the DLL
32326
32327 @smallexample
32328 (gdb) break ada_dll
32329 (gdb) cont
32330 @end smallexample
32331
32332 @end enumerate
32333
32334 @noindent
32335 At this stage a breakpoint is set inside the DLL. From there on
32336 you can use the standard approach to debug the whole program
32337 (@pxref{Running and Debugging Ada Programs}).
32338
32339 @ignore
32340 @c This used to work, probably because the DLLs were non-relocatable
32341 @c keep this section around until the problem is sorted out.
32342
32343 To break on the @code{DllMain} routine it is not possible to follow
32344 the procedure above. At the time the program stop on @code{ada_main}
32345 the @code{DllMain} routine as already been called. Either you can use
32346 the procedure below @pxref{Debugging the DLL Directly} or this procedure:
32347
32348 @enumerate 1
32349 @item Launch @code{GDB} on the main program.
32350
32351 @smallexample
32352 $ gdb ada_main
32353 @end smallexample
32354
32355 @item Load DLL symbols
32356
32357 @smallexample
32358 (gdb) add-sym api.dll
32359 @end smallexample
32360
32361 @item Set a breakpoint inside the DLL
32362
32363 @smallexample
32364 (gdb) break ada_dll.adb:45
32365 @end smallexample
32366
32367 Note that at this point it is not possible to break using the routine symbol
32368 directly as the program is not yet running. The solution is to break
32369 on the proper line (break in @file{ada_dll.adb} line 45).
32370
32371 @item Start the program
32372
32373 @smallexample
32374 (gdb) run
32375 @end smallexample
32376
32377 @end enumerate
32378 @end ignore
32379
32380 @node Program Built with Foreign Tools and DLL Built with GCC/GNAT
32381 @subsection Program Built with Foreign Tools and DLL Built with GCC/GNAT
32382
32383 @menu
32384 * Debugging the DLL Directly::
32385 * Attaching to a Running Process::
32386 @end menu
32387
32388 @noindent
32389 In this case things are slightly more complex because it is not possible to
32390 start the main program and then break at the beginning to load the DLL and the
32391 associated DLL debugging information. It is not possible to break at the
32392 beginning of the program because there is no @code{GDB} debugging information,
32393 and therefore there is no direct way of getting initial control. This
32394 section addresses this issue by describing some methods that can be used
32395 to break somewhere in the DLL to debug it.
32396
32397 @noindent
32398 First suppose that the main procedure is named @code{main} (this is for
32399 example some C code built with Microsoft Visual C) and that there is a
32400 DLL named @code{test.dll} containing an Ada entry point named
32401 @code{ada_dll}.
32402
32403 @noindent
32404 The DLL (@pxref{Introduction to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs)}) must have
32405 been built with debugging information (see GNAT -g option).
32406
32407 @node Debugging the DLL Directly
32408 @subsubsection Debugging the DLL Directly
32409
32410 @enumerate 1
32411 @item
32412 Find out the executable starting address
32413
32414 @smallexample
32415 $ objdump --file-header main.exe
32416 @end smallexample
32417
32418 The starting address is reported on the last line. For example:
32419
32420 @smallexample
32421 main.exe: file format pei-i386
32422 architecture: i386, flags 0x0000010a:
32423 EXEC_P, HAS_DEBUG, D_PAGED
32424 start address 0x00401010
32425 @end smallexample
32426
32427 @item
32428 Launch the debugger on the executable.
32429
32430 @smallexample
32431 $ gdb main.exe
32432 @end smallexample
32433
32434 @item
32435 Set a breakpoint at the starting address, and launch the program.
32436
32437 @smallexample
32438 $ (gdb) break *0x00401010
32439 $ (gdb) run
32440 @end smallexample
32441
32442 The program will stop at the given address.
32443
32444 @item
32445 Set a breakpoint on a DLL subroutine.
32446
32447 @smallexample
32448 (gdb) break ada_dll.adb:45
32449 @end smallexample
32450
32451 Or if you want to break using a symbol on the DLL, you need first to
32452 select the Ada language (language used by the DLL).
32453
32454 @smallexample
32455 (gdb) set language ada
32456 (gdb) break ada_dll
32457 @end smallexample
32458
32459 @item
32460 Continue the program.
32461
32462 @smallexample
32463 (gdb) cont
32464 @end smallexample
32465
32466 @noindent
32467 This will run the program until it reaches the breakpoint that has been
32468 set. From that point you can use the standard way to debug a program
32469 as described in (@pxref{Running and Debugging Ada Programs}).
32470
32471 @end enumerate
32472
32473 @noindent
32474 It is also possible to debug the DLL by attaching to a running process.
32475
32476 @node Attaching to a Running Process
32477 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Process
32478 @cindex DLL debugging, attach to process
32479
32480 @noindent
32481 With @code{GDB} it is always possible to debug a running process by
32482 attaching to it. It is possible to debug a DLL this way. The limitation
32483 of this approach is that the DLL must run long enough to perform the
32484 attach operation. It may be useful for instance to insert a time wasting
32485 loop in the code of the DLL to meet this criterion.
32486
32487 @enumerate 1
32488
32489 @item Launch the main program @file{main.exe}.
32490
32491 @smallexample
32492 $ main
32493 @end smallexample
32494
32495 @item Use the Windows @i{Task Manager} to find the process ID. Let's say
32496 that the process PID for @file{main.exe} is 208.
32497
32498 @item Launch gdb.
32499
32500 @smallexample
32501 $ gdb
32502 @end smallexample
32503
32504 @item Attach to the running process to be debugged.
32505
32506 @smallexample
32507 (gdb) attach 208
32508 @end smallexample
32509
32510 @item Load the process debugging information.
32511
32512 @smallexample
32513 (gdb) symbol-file main.exe
32514 @end smallexample
32515
32516 @item Break somewhere in the DLL.
32517
32518 @smallexample
32519 (gdb) break ada_dll
32520 @end smallexample
32521
32522 @item Continue process execution.
32523
32524 @smallexample
32525 (gdb) cont
32526 @end smallexample
32527
32528 @end enumerate
32529
32530 @noindent
32531 This last step will resume the process execution, and stop at
32532 the breakpoint we have set. From there you can use the standard
32533 approach to debug a program as described in
32534 (@pxref{Running and Debugging Ada Programs}).
32535
32536 @node Setting Stack Size from gnatlink
32537 @section Setting Stack Size from @command{gnatlink}
32538
32539 @noindent
32540 It is possible to specify the program stack size at link time. On modern
32541 versions of Windows, starting with XP, this is mostly useful to set the size of
32542 the main stack (environment task). The other task stacks are set with pragma
32543 Storage_Size or with the @command{gnatbind -d} command.
32544
32545 Since older versions of Windows (2000, NT4, etc.) do not allow setting the
32546 reserve size of individual tasks, the link-time stack size applies to all
32547 tasks, and pragma Storage_Size has no effect.
32548 In particular, Stack Overflow checks are made against this
32549 link-time specified size.
32550
32551 This setting can be done with
32552 @command{gnatlink} using either:
32553
32554 @itemize @bullet
32555
32556 @item using @option{-Xlinker} linker option
32557
32558 @smallexample
32559 $ gnatlink hello -Xlinker --stack=0x10000,0x1000
32560 @end smallexample
32561
32562 This sets the stack reserve size to 0x10000 bytes and the stack commit
32563 size to 0x1000 bytes.
32564
32565 @item using @option{-Wl} linker option
32566
32567 @smallexample
32568 $ gnatlink hello -Wl,--stack=0x1000000
32569 @end smallexample
32570
32571 This sets the stack reserve size to 0x1000000 bytes. Note that with
32572 @option{-Wl} option it is not possible to set the stack commit size
32573 because the coma is a separator for this option.
32574
32575 @end itemize
32576
32577 @node Setting Heap Size from gnatlink
32578 @section Setting Heap Size from @command{gnatlink}
32579
32580 @noindent
32581 Under Windows systems, it is possible to specify the program heap size from
32582 @command{gnatlink} using either:
32583
32584 @itemize @bullet
32585
32586 @item using @option{-Xlinker} linker option
32587
32588 @smallexample
32589 $ gnatlink hello -Xlinker --heap=0x10000,0x1000
32590 @end smallexample
32591
32592 This sets the heap reserve size to 0x10000 bytes and the heap commit
32593 size to 0x1000 bytes.
32594
32595 @item using @option{-Wl} linker option
32596
32597 @smallexample
32598 $ gnatlink hello -Wl,--heap=0x1000000
32599 @end smallexample
32600
32601 This sets the heap reserve size to 0x1000000 bytes. Note that with
32602 @option{-Wl} option it is not possible to set the heap commit size
32603 because the coma is a separator for this option.
32604
32605 @end itemize
32606
32607 @end ifset
32608
32609 @c **********************************
32610 @c * GNU Free Documentation License *
32611 @c **********************************
32612 @include fdl.texi
32613 @c GNU Free Documentation License
32614
32615 @node Index,,GNU Free Documentation License, Top
32616 @unnumbered Index
32617
32618 @printindex cp
32619
32620 @contents
32621 @c Put table of contents at end, otherwise it precedes the "title page" in
32622 @c the .txt version
32623 @c Edit the pdf file to move the contents to the beginning, after the title
32624 @c page
32625
32626 @bye